Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Chevrolet
Model
S10
Engine and year
S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7
C350 - Remote Keyless Entry Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 16
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 17
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D >
Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 18
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 24
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 25
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 26
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 31
C350 - Remote Keyless Entry Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Power Window And Door Lock Body Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 35
C240A - Power Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Window Release Forward Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 39
C246 - Liftgate Release Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations
ABS Main Relay: Locations
FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (4WAL)
Brake Pressure Modulator Valve
The relay is located inside the Brake Pressure Modulator Valve (BPMV) and is not serviced
seperately.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Forward Lamps Harness, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (EHCU)
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (EHCU)
Fig. 34 ABS Connector Terminal Identification.
Fig. 32 ALDL Connector Terminal Identification.
ABS Connector Terminals.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (EHCU) > Page 49
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Rear Wheel Antilock Brake Module (RWAL EHCU)
Fig. 13 RWAL System Electrical Connectors.
RWAL system electrical connectors.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 50
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 225 EHCU/BPMV Mounting.
(EHCU) Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit / (BPMV) Brake Pressure Modulator Valve Module is not
serviceable and must be replaced as a unit.
1. Remove washer tank attaching bolts, then position aside.
2. Remove EHCU/BPMV electrical connectors.
3. Disconnect module brake lines.
Use caution not to get brake fluid on paint or electrical connections.
4. Remove upper to lower bracket assembly attaching bolts.
5. Remove EHCU/BPMV module and upper bracket assembly from vehicle.
6. Remove upper mounting bracket to EHCU/BPMV module attaching bolts, Fig. 225. 7. Reverse
procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Torque EHCU/BPMV module to bracket attaching bolts to 5 ft. lbs. b. Torque EHCU/BPMV
bracket assembly attaching bolts to 20 ft. lbs. c. Torque brake line fittings to 16 ft. lbs. d. Bleed
EHCU/BPMV module. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Brake Bleeding
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cruise Control Module: > 569002A > Jul > 95
> Stepper Motor Cruise Control - Will Not Resume/Reset
Cruise Control Module: Customer Interest Stepper Motor Cruise Control - Will Not Resume/Reset
FILE IN SECTION: 9 - Accessories
BULLETIN NO.: 56-90-02A
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Stepper Motor Cruise Control will not Resume or Reset (Replace SMCC Module)
MODELS: 1993-95
Chevrolet Camaro
1993-95 Pontiac Firebird
with 3.4L V6 Engine (VIN S - RPO L32) and Automatic Transmission (M30) only OR with 5.7L V8
Engine (VIN P - RPO LT1) and any Transmission
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, M/L Models
This bulletin is being revised to add F car information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
56-90-02 (Section 9 - Accessories).
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Stepper Motor Cruise Control (SMCC) will intermittently cut
out and will not resume or reset unless the ignition key is cycled.
CAUSE
The SMCC is sensitive to any brake switch contact bounce of less than 32 milliseconds. This
contact bounce may cause the SMCC to go into a diagnostic shut down mode until the module is
reset by turning the ignition off. For trucks, the 1994 Zero Adjust Brake switches tend to aggravate
this sensitivity.
CORRECTION
Replace the SMCC module only if the diagnosis in the Service Manual, Section 8A Cruise Control
does not resolve the concern.
Service Procedure
For 1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, M/L Models: Follow the SMCC MODULE remove
and install procedure using the appropriate service manual.
For F-car models, use the following procedure.
Remove
Before removing cruise control module, disconnect cruise control cable to obtain the necessary
clearance.
1. Disconnect cruise control cable end fitting from throttle body lever stud.
If vehicle is equipped with accelerator control/cruise control cable adjuster (throttle relaxer), remove
cruise control cable end fitting from adjuster. Note location of pulley for end fitting.
2. Unlock cruise control cable conduit by pulling up on unlock button.
3. Push conduit together to obtain the additional cable slack.
4. Remove cruise control module per Section 9B of the Service Manual.
Important:
It is not necessary to remove cruise control cable from vehicle.
Install
1. Install cruise control cable to cruise control module per Section 9B of the Service Manual,
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cruise Control Module: > 569002A > Jul > 95
> Stepper Motor Cruise Control - Will Not Resume/Reset > Page 60
Important:
Cruise control module ribbon must not be twisted when installed to cruise control module.
2. Install cruise control module per Section 9B of the Service Manual.
3. Connect cruise control cable end fitting to throttle body lever stud.
If vehicle is equipped with accelerator control/cruise control cable adjuster (throttle relaxer),
connect cruise control cable end fitting to adjuster. Note correct location of pulley for end fitting.
4. Adjust cruise cable per "Cable Assembly Adjustment" procedure in Section 9B of the Service
Manual.
Important:
Excessive cable slack in cruise control cable will result in perceived slow module response.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
R1220 Module, C/C Replace Use Published Labor Operation time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cruise Control Module: >
569002A > Jul > 95 > Stepper Motor Cruise Control - Will Not Resume/Reset
Cruise Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Stepper Motor Cruise Control - Will Not
Resume/Reset
FILE IN SECTION: 9 - Accessories
BULLETIN NO.: 56-90-02A
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Stepper Motor Cruise Control will not Resume or Reset (Replace SMCC Module)
MODELS: 1993-95
Chevrolet Camaro
1993-95 Pontiac Firebird
with 3.4L V6 Engine (VIN S - RPO L32) and Automatic Transmission (M30) only OR with 5.7L V8
Engine (VIN P - RPO LT1) and any Transmission
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, M/L Models
This bulletin is being revised to add F car information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
56-90-02 (Section 9 - Accessories).
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Stepper Motor Cruise Control (SMCC) will intermittently cut
out and will not resume or reset unless the ignition key is cycled.
CAUSE
The SMCC is sensitive to any brake switch contact bounce of less than 32 milliseconds. This
contact bounce may cause the SMCC to go into a diagnostic shut down mode until the module is
reset by turning the ignition off. For trucks, the 1994 Zero Adjust Brake switches tend to aggravate
this sensitivity.
CORRECTION
Replace the SMCC module only if the diagnosis in the Service Manual, Section 8A Cruise Control
does not resolve the concern.
Service Procedure
For 1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, M/L Models: Follow the SMCC MODULE remove
and install procedure using the appropriate service manual.
For F-car models, use the following procedure.
Remove
Before removing cruise control module, disconnect cruise control cable to obtain the necessary
clearance.
1. Disconnect cruise control cable end fitting from throttle body lever stud.
If vehicle is equipped with accelerator control/cruise control cable adjuster (throttle relaxer), remove
cruise control cable end fitting from adjuster. Note location of pulley for end fitting.
2. Unlock cruise control cable conduit by pulling up on unlock button.
3. Push conduit together to obtain the additional cable slack.
4. Remove cruise control module per Section 9B of the Service Manual.
Important:
It is not necessary to remove cruise control cable from vehicle.
Install
1. Install cruise control cable to cruise control module per Section 9B of the Service Manual,
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cruise Control Module: >
569002A > Jul > 95 > Stepper Motor Cruise Control - Will Not Resume/Reset > Page 66
Important:
Cruise control module ribbon must not be twisted when installed to cruise control module.
2. Install cruise control module per Section 9B of the Service Manual.
3. Connect cruise control cable end fitting to throttle body lever stud.
If vehicle is equipped with accelerator control/cruise control cable adjuster (throttle relaxer),
connect cruise control cable end fitting to adjuster. Note correct location of pulley for end fitting.
4. Adjust cruise cable per "Cable Assembly Adjustment" procedure in Section 9B of the Service
Manual.
Important:
Excessive cable slack in cruise control cable will result in perceived slow module response.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
R1220 Module, C/C Replace Use Published Labor Operation time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 67
Cruise Control Module: Locations
Cruise Control I/P Wiring
Under the L/H side of the I/P, left of the steering column.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cruise Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 70
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 71
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 72
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 73
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 74
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 75
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 76
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 77
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 78
Cruise Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 79
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 80
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 81
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 82
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 83
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 84
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 85
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 86
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 87
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 88
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 89
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 90
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 91
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 92
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 93
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 94
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 95
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 96
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 97
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 98
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 99
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 100
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 101
C250 - Cruise Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Blower Motor Relay: Locations
A/C And Heater Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 106
A/C And Heater Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 107
Blower Motor Relay: Diagrams
C158 - Inline To High Blower Relay
C158 - Inline To High Blower Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 108
Blower Motor Relay: Description and Operation
The blower motor relay is used to provide battery voltage to the blower motor assembly only during
high blower motor assembly speed. The blower motor resistor is used to provide power to the
blower motor assembly in all other speed settings.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 109
Blower Motor Relay: Service and Repair
Figure 52: Evaporator And Blower Assembly
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Electrical connectors, as necessary.
3. Screws (34).
4. Relay (42).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Relay (42).
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
2. Screws (34).
- Tighten screws (34) to 1.4 Nm (12 lbs. in.).
3. Electrical connectors, as necessary.
4. Negative battery cable.
- Check circuit operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
A/C COMPRESSOR CONTROL RELAY
Fender Wiring RH
The A/C Compressor Control Relay is located in Engine Compartment, on LH side of cowl.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 113
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
The compressor relay is used to provide battery voltage to the compressor clutch coil. The relay is
controlled by the engine control module (ECM).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamps-I/P Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 118
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Diagrams
C239 - DEL Module
C238 - DRL Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamps-I/P Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay
> Component Information > Diagrams
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Diagrams
C227 - Fog Lamp Relay
C225 - Fog Lamp Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Relay Convenience Center, Under LH Side Of I/Panel
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations
Relay Box: Locations
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 132
Turn Signal And Hazard Flashers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Page 133
Horn Relay Installation
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Relay Box: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 136
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 137
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 138
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 139
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 140
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 141
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 142
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 143
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 144
Relay Box: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 145
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 146
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 147
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 148
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 149
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 150
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 151
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 152
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 153
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 154
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 155
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 156
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 157
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 158
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 159
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 160
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 161
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 162
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 163
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 164
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 165
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 166
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 167
Relay Box: Electrical Diagrams
Convenience Center Details (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 168
Convenience Center Details (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Shift Indicator Light Application and
Operation
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 36-72-07A
Date: February, 1995
Subject: Manual Transmission Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Models: 1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K and S/T Models with Manual Transmission
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year. Please discard bulletin number 367207
(Group Reference - Transmission).
Certain trucks are not equipped with a shift indicator light. The shift light is commonly used to
achieve improved fuel economy by prompting the driver when to upshift. Depending on the
engine/transmission installed in the vehicle, the shift light can have the following characteristics:
^ Indicates proper shift point for maximum fuel economy.
^ Indicates engine over-speed.
^ Shift light is inoperative.
The following charts detail normal shift light operation:
1993 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation > Page 175
1994 Models:
1995 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 180
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 181
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program
Adapter
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 73-65-13
Date: March, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Reprogramming Capability using the Off Board Programming Adapter
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 182
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 183
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 184
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 185
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 186
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 187
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 188
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 189
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Replacement Component Text Deletion
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-33
Date: October, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 3A - Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis - Text Deletion
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck & T Models with 2.2L Gasoline Engine (VIN 4 - RPO LN2)
or 4.3L Engine (VINs Z, W - RPOs LB4, L35)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, M/L, G, P3, PG Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO
LB4), 5.0L Engine (VIN H - RPO L03), 5.7L Engine VIN K - RPO L05) or 7.4L Engine (VIN N - RPO
L19)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, G, P3 Models with 6.5L Diesel Engine (VINs F, P, S RPOs L65, L49, L56)
This bulletin contains revisions to the "Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnostic" Service
Manuals for the following pages:
1994 S/T Truck - 3A-5
1994-1995 G Van - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 M/L Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 PG/P3 Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K, G, P Truck - 3-17 and Supplement
This Text is to be Deleted
"The replacement PCM may be faulty - After the PCM is replaced, the system should be rechecked
for proper operation. If the Diagnostic Chart again indicates that the PCM is the problem, substitute
a known good PCM".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 190
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Engine VIN Code ID [1] .......................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. Z
Engine Displacement ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L (262 cid)
Engine Configuration ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................................ V6
Fuel Control System
......................................................................................................................................................
Throttle Body Fuel Injection (TBI)
Ignition System ....................................................................................................... Distributor
Ignition W/Ignition Control and Knock Sensor(DI-IC-KS)
Control Module Systems
S/T Pickup Automatic Transmission
......................................................................................................................... Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Utility Manual Transmission
.............................................................................................................................. Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Pickup Manual Transmission
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicle
Control Module (VCM)
Remarks:
[1] The eighth digit of the VIN denotes engine code.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 191
Engine Control Module: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer And Electric Shift Transfer Case
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 192
Engine Or Powertrain Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 Red (32 Pin)
Manual Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 195
Manual Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 196
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2-Blue (32 Pin)
Automatic Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 197
Automatic Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 198
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C210
C210 - PCM
C210 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 199
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C211
C211 - PCM
C211 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 200
Engine Control Module: Diagrams With Manual Transmission
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 201
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 202
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 203
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 204
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Engine Control Module
Fig. 5 ECM Unit (Showing PROM & CALPAK Locations)
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
PURPOSE
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is the control center of the fuel injection system. It
constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and controls the systems (outputs)
that affect vehicle performance. The PCM also performs the diagnostic function of the system. It
can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
"Service Engine Soon" light on the instrument panel and store a Diagnostic Trouble Code(s) (DTC)
in the PCM memory. The DTC identifies the problem areas to aid the technician in performing
repairs.
OPERATION
The PCM is an electronic computer designed to process the various input information, and send
the necessary electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control
systems. The PCM can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 205
When the PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The PCM has two parts for service: Controller which is the PCM (93 PCM6), without the PROM (MEM-CAL).
- PROM (Programmable Read Only Memory) which is a separate memory calibrator unit
PCM Learning Ability
The PCM has a "learning" ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the fuel
system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected, to clear diagnostic trouble codes or for
other repairs. the "learning" process resets and begins again. A change may be noted in the
vehicle's performance. To "teach" the vehicle, ensure the engine is at operating temperature. The
vehicle should be driven at part throttle, with moderate acceleration and idle conditions until normal
performance returns.
NOTE The PCM must be maintained at a temperature below 85°C (185°F) at all times. This is most
essential if the vehicle is put through a baking process. The PCM will become inoperative if it's
temperature exceeds 85°C (185°F). It is recommended that temporary insulation be placed around
the PCM during the time the vehicle is in a paint oven or other high temperature processes.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 206
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Figure 1
CAUTION
[a] The ignition must be "OFF," when disconnecting or reconnecting the control module connector,
to prevent internal damage to the control module.
[b] To prevent possible Electrostatic Discharge to the control module, Do NOT touch the connector
pins or soldered components on the circuit
boards.
NOTE When replacing a production control module with a service controller, transfer the broadcast
code and production control module part number to the controller label. DO NOT record information
on the access cover.
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery terminal.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Mounting screw.
- Control module from mounting bracket.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease removal.
- Control module harness connectors.
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Remove new control module from its packaging and check the service number to make sure it is
the same as the defective control module.
- PROM removal. Refer to PROM (MEM-CAL) replacement.
NOTE
Replacement control module is supplied without a PROM, so care should be used when removing
it from the defective control module, because it will be reused in the new control module.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Control module harness connectors.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease installation.
- Control module into mounting bracket.
- Mounting screw.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Negative battery terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: Customer Interest Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 216
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 217
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 218
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking >
Page 224
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking >
Page 225
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking >
Page 226
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 227
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Fuel Pump Relay
The Fuel Pump Relay is located on the driver side firewall, near brake booster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 228
C124 - Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 229
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the control module will energize the fuel
pump relay as long as the engine is cranking or running, and the control module is receiving
distributor reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the control module will shut "OFF" the
fuel pump relay within two seconds.
An inoperative fuel pump relay can result in extended crank times, particularily if the engine is cold.
The oil pressure switch will turn "ON" the fuel pump, as soon as oil pressure reaches about 28 kPa
(4 psi).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 230
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
*** UPDATED BY TSB 893206E, DATED OCTOBER 90
When the key is first turned ON, without the engine running, the ECM will turn the fuel pump relay
ON for two seconds. This builds up the fuel pressure to normal operating pressure. If the engine is
not started within two seconds, the ECM will shut the fuel pump OFF and wait until ignition
reference pulses are present. As soon as the engine is cranked, the ECM turns the relay ON,
which powers the fuel pump. The ECM continues to power the fuel pump during engine operation.
If the fuel pump relay fails, it is backed up by the oil pressure switch, which continues to operate
the fuel pump as long as oil pressure remains above 28.0 kPa (4 psi).
RESULTS OF INCORRECT FUEL PUMP SYSTEM OPERATION
- A faulty fuel pump relay can result in long cranking times, particularly if the engine is cold.
- An inoperative fuel pump would cause a no start condition.
- A fuel pump which does not provide enough pressure can result in poor performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 231
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
Relay Center 2.5L,2.8L S
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
1. Verify that ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Retainer, if installed. 3. Electrical connector.
4. Fuel pump relay by depressing bracket clip at rear of relay, or removing bolts from retaining
bracket.
INSTALL/DISCONNECT
1. Fuel pump relay. 2. Electrical connector. 3. Retainer. 4. Verify correct operation to confirm repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Ignition Module
Typical Distributor Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Ignition Module > Page 237
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 238
C121 - Ignition Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 239
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
Typical Distributor Components
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
NOTE It is not necessary to remove ignition distributor assembly from engine.
- Distributor cap and rotor.
- Connectors from module.
- Two module attaching screws.
- Lift module from housing and remove.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
NOTE: Do not wipe silicone grease from metal face of module or distributor base (where the
module seats), when reinstalling the same module. If new module is to be installed clean distributor
module base and spread new silicone grease on base and metal face of ignition module. The
purpose of the silicone grease is to cool module.
- Module onto housing.
- Module attaching screws. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb.in.)
- Connectors to module.
- Rotor and cap.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
A function of the DERM is to supply the deployment loop with a 36 volt loop reserve to ensure
sufficient energy to deploy the air bag if the ignition feed to the arming sensor is lost during a frontal
collision. Another function of the DERM is electrical system diagnostics. The DERM can detect
circuit and component malfunctions within the deployment loop. Voltage drops across components
within the loop are measured during non-deployment conditions. If the monitored voltages fall
outside of the expected limits, the DERM will indicate a malfunction through the storage of a
diagnostic trouble code and the illumination of the air bag warning light.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 244
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
Prior to performing replacement procedures, disarm air bag system. Refer to, Service and Repair/
Air Bag System Disarming & Air Bag System Arming. Refer to, / Specifications/ Mechanical for
torque values when installing components. All sensors and mounting bracket bolts must be
carefully torqued to assure proper operation. Never power up the air bag system when any sensor
is not rigidly attached to the vehicle, since the sensor could be activated when not attached,
causing air bag deployment.
Do not open DERM case for any reason. Touching connector pins or soldered components may
cause electrostatic discharge damage. Repair of a malfunctioning DERM is by replacement only.
1. Remove righthand sound insulator, then the righthand sill plate. 2. Remove righthand cowl side
trim plate. 3. Remove DERM from mounting bracket. 4. Remove Connector Position Assurance
(CPA) lock, then disconnect DERM electrical connector from DERM. 5. Reverse procedure to
install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Mounted on the back of the Electronic Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 250
C202A - Transfer Case Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting
Control Module: Description and Operation Electric 4WD Shifting
Transfer Case 4WD Selector Switch
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
On vehicles equipped with the Model 233 transfer case, there is no transfer case selector lever in
the cab. The operator selects 4HI or 4LO by pushing a three-position (4HI, 4LO, 2HI) rocker-type
selector switch mounted on the instrument panel. During normal driving the transfer case is in the
2HI mode. The switch is spring-loaded to the center position. When the transfer case is in 2HI both
the 4HI and 4L0 switch circuits are open, and both lights are off. When shifting to 4HI or 4LO the
rocker switch will still return to the center position and the 4HI or 4LO light will be on. The above
image shows the wiring schematic of the transfer case selector switch.
Mode Shifts Mode shifts are shifts from:
- 2HI to 4HI
- 4HI to 2HI
A mode shift can be accomplished in any gear position and at any vehicle speed. If the system is in
2HI, the operator can shift into 4HI merely by pressing and releasing the 4HI area of the selector
rocker switch. The green 4HI status lamp flashes whenever a 2HI or 4HI shift is initiated and
continues to flash until the TCCM completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). After the shift
into 4HI is accomplished, the 4HI status lamp remains lit to indicate that the system is in 4HI. The
operator can shift from 4HI back to 2HI by again pressing 4HI on the selector switch. Again, the
green 4HI status lamp flashes until the shift to 2HI is complete, and then extinguishes once the shift
is complete. Both the 4HI and 4LO lamps remain oft when the vehicle is in 2HI.
Range Shifts Range shifts are shifts between the HI and LO ranges, from:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 253
- 2HI to 4LO
- 4HI to 4LO
- 4LO to 4HI
A range shift from 4L0 directly to 2HI cannot be made. The operator must first make range shift
from 4LO to 4HI, then a mode shift from 4HI to 2HI. A range shift can only be made with the
automatic transmission in neutral or with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed. The
vehicle speed must also be below three miles per hour before the shift can occur. Whenever a shift
into 4LO is initiated, the amber 4LO status lamp flashes and continues to flash until the TCCM
completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). The 4LO status lamp must glow steadily before
the vehicle transmission is shifted into gear or before the clutch pedal is released. If a range shift is
initiated when the transmission is engaged or when the vehicle speed is above 3 mph, the 4LO
status lamp flashes for 30 seconds and no range shift actually occurs; the system returns to the
position before the shift was initiated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 254
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Power and Ground
Fig. 1, Memory Power, System Power, And Ground Circuit
Fig. 2, Fuse Block And Cavity Location
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 255
POWER, CIRCUIT PROTECTION, AND GROUND
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) memory power, system power, and the ground circuit
are shown in Figure 1. The vehicle fuse block and cavity location for memory power, system power,
and motor power are shown in Figure 2.
Memory Power Trouble code memory power is protected by a 5-amp TCCM fuse. Memory power
is supplied to TCCM connector pin C6 through circuit 140.
System Power Operating power is controlled by the ignition switch and is protected by a 15-amp
radio fuse. System power is supplied to TCCM connector pin C8 through circuit 141. This fuse also
supplies, voltage to pin B of the transfer case switch. The system power will shut down if either the
5-amp TCCM fuse or the 15-amp radio fuse are removed or blown.
System Ground System ground is supplied to TCCM connector pin C10 through circuit 150. Circuit
150 is connected to the bus bar ground located on the left side of the steering column support.
Refer to Figure 1.
Turn/BU Fuse A 15-amp TURN/BU fuse supplies ignition voltage to the park/neutral position
switch. This voltage enables the park switch to send a park signal to TCCM connector pin D2.
Power Accessory Circuit Breaker The 30-amp power accessory circuit breaker supplies ignition
voltage to TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This voltage is used to control the electric-shift
motor circuit.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 256
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Inputs and Outputs
General Description
INPUTS
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) receives input signals from the following sources:
- Transfer case selector switch on the instrument panel.
- Park/neutral position switch on vehicles with automatic transmissions.
- Clutch safety switch on vehicles with manual transmissions.
- Vehicle speed sensor buffer which supplies vehicle speed signals.
- Encoder switch within the electric-shift motor which provides actual mode and range information
signals.
- Data link connector (DLC) pin J which provides diagnostic enable.
OUTPUTS
After processing the input information, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) outputs signals
to the following:
- Electric shift motor to effect mode and range shifts.
- Selector switch status lamps to provide transfer case status information.
- Diagnostic trouble codes (DTC) which are output via the selector switch status lamps.
2HI to 4HI Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the transfer case is in 2HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the
4HI contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564, and furnishing 12-volts
to pin C5 of the TCCM connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5 commands the Transfer Case
Control Module (TCCM) to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. The contacts return to the
open position as soon as the switch is released.
4HI to 2HI Selector Switch Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 257
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
If the transfer case is in 4HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the 4HI
contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564 and furnishing 12-volts to
pin C5 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5
commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. Again, the contacts return to
the open position as soon as the switch is released.
2HI to 4HI to 4LO Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the operator presses the 4LO area of the rocker switch while the transfer case is in either
2HI or 4HI, the 4LO contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1559, and
furnishing 12-volts to pin C3 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt
signal at pin C3 commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift the transfer case into
4LO. Once more, the contacts return to the open position as soon as the switch is released.
Park/Neutral Position Switch Inputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 258
Automatic Transmission Neutral Start Switch
Neutral Start Switch Voltages
OPERATION
Because range shift should only be made with the automatic transmission in neutral, the
park/neutral position switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle
automatic transmission is in either:
- Park
- Neutral
- One of the drive positions
The park/neutral position switch consists of three switches together in one unit, and it provides
three signals:
- Park - When the automatic transmission is in park, the contacts of both the park switch and the
park neutral switch are closed. When these contacts are closed, a battery voltage signal is sent to
TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 voltage). The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in park.
- Neutral - When the automatic transmission is in neutral, the contacts of the park switch are open
and the contacts of the park neutral position switch are closed. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal
is sent to TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 volts). The
TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in neutral.
- In gear - When the automatic transmission is in any other gear position, the contacts of both the
park switch and park neutral switch are open. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal is sent to TCCM
connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is neither
park or neutral.
Important
- If the backup switch connector were to be plugged in upside down, the park switch would receive
no power. Such a condition would cause a 0-voltage signal at both pin D2 and pin D16 in neutral
and in park. The transfer case, accordingly, would perform a range shift in park as well as in
neutral.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 259
- An open in circuit 75, or an open in the Turn/BU fuse would also cause this condition.
- Additionally, a park/neutral position switch that is out of adjustment may prevent a range shift in
park.
Clutch Safety Switch Inputs
Clutch Safety Switch Schematic
Clutch Safety Switch Voltage Signals
OPERATION
Because range shifts should only be made with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed, the
clutch safety switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle clutch
pedal is fully depressed or released. The clutch safety switch is connected to TCCM connector pin
D16. When the clutch pedal is released, the contacts of the clutch safety switch are open. When
these contacts are open, a battery voltage signal is seen at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the clutch is released. When the clutch is fully depressed, the
contacts of the clutch safety switch are closed. When the contacts are closed, voltage is pulled low
to 0 at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the clutch pedal is fully
depressed. Because TCCM connector pin D2 is not connected when the vehicle is equipped with a
manual transmission, the TCCM reads a 0-volt signal at pin D2 at all times. All readings are taken
while back-probing the TCCM pins with the ignition in the "Run" position. A reading of less than 0.5
volt is considered to be zero.
Vehicle Speed Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 260
Vehicle Sensor Buffer And TCCM Schematic
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor buffer informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) about the
speed of the vehicle in miles per hour. Such information is essential to inform the TCCM to prohibit
range shifts at speeds above 3 mph. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) is a variable-reluctance
magnetic sensing device that converts tone wheel rotation into a frequency and voltage output
proportional to the vehicle speed. The frequency and voltage signal is sent to the vehicle speed
sensor buffer which converts the speed sensor output into a useful pulse signal. The vehicle speed
sensor buffer then, pulses circuit 1567 to ground at a rate of 4000 pulses per mile. Whenever the
vehicle speed sensor buffer grounds circuit 1567, the voltage at TCCM connector pin D8 returns to
5 volts. The TCCM reads the 4000 pulses-per-mile (1.11 Hz per mph) signal to determine vehicle
speed.
Encoder Switch Inputs
Fig 1, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Layout
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 261
Fig 2, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Schematic
Fig 3, Encoder Switch Channel Signals And Positions
OPERATION
The four-channel encoder switch indicates the current transfer case mode and range to the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM). The encoder switch is located inside the encoder itself and
is not serviceable. The TCCM reads the status of the four channels to determine the range and
mode in which the transfer case is operating or whether the transfer case is shifting between
modes and/or ranges. The encoder assembly is composed of an inner ground ring in contact with a
three-leg wiper arm. The three legs of the wiper, spaced 120 degrees apart, make contact with the
conductive areas of the four channels. When any leg of the wiper arm is in contact with the
conductive area of any channel, a path to ground is provided to the inner ground ring. A schematic
of the encoder switch is shown in Figure 2. The channel signals in various transfer case operating
modes and ranges are shown in Figure 3. Any combination of signals not listed in Figure 3 are
considered invalid by the TCCM.
Encoder Switch Channel Positions These voltage readings can be obtained by back-probing either
the TCCM connector pins or the transfer case connector pins. For TCCM pin numbers and encoder
channels, refer to Figure 2.
Diagnostic Enable Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 262
Wiring Schematic For Enabling The Status Lamps
OPERATION
When pin J of the Data Link Connector (DLC) is connected either to pin A of the DLC or to a good
ground while the ignition is on, the diagnostics routine of the Transfer Case Control Module
(TCCM) is activated. When the diagnostics routine is activated, the transfer case selector switch
4HI and 4LO status lamps flash the diagnostic codes.
Electric Shift Motor Outputs
Electric Shift Motor Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) provides the output for the electric shift motor as the
schematic shows.
- Motor control is achieved by energizing one of the two motor control relays located in the TCCM,
by way of the transfer case selector switch.
The TCCM operates the motor in one direction by energizing one relay while the second relay is
de-energized. The TCCM operates the motor in the reverse direction by energizing the second
relay while the first relay is de-energized.
- Motor power to actuate the motor drive relays is input at TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This
power is supplied by the ignition through the 30-amp power circuit breaker.
- Motor ground is input at TCCM connector pins D12 and D13 to provide the return line for the
motor drive relays.
4HI and 4LO Status Lamps Outputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric
4WD Shifting > Page 263
Selector Switch Status Lamp Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) controls the operation of the 4HI and 4LO status lamps
in the transfer case selector switch. The status lamps also show the transfer case mode and range
of operation. The status lamps also provide a self-test when the ignition is first turned on.
Additionally, the status lamps are used to alert the driver that there is a problem somewhere in the
four-wheel drive system, and also to flash diagnostic trouble codes (DTC's).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
264
Control Module: Service and Repair
TRANSFER CASE MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. ECM (utility only). 3. Cowl side panel (pickup only). 4. Electrical
connection. 5. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 6. Module.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Module. 2. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 3. Electrical connection. 4. ECM (utility
only). 5. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Rear Window Release And Defogger Forward Wiring - 4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 269
C244 - Defogger Timer Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Window Release Forward Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Wiper/Washer Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Right Front
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Right Front
Power Door Lock Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Right Front > Page 283
Power Window And Door Lock Body Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Right Front > Page 284
RH Door Harness (LH Typical)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch
C504 - Front LH Power Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 287
C604 - Front RH Power Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Outside Rearview Mirror Switch Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 291
C298A - Power Outside Rearview Mirror Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Seat And Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Passenger's
C334 - Passenger's Seat Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Passenger's > Page 297
C333 - Driver's Seat Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > I/P to Liftgate Release Switch
C242 - I/P To Liftgate Release Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > I/P to Liftgate Release Switch > Page 302
C247A - I/P To Liftgate Release/Defogger
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > I/P to Liftgate Release Switch > Page 303
C242 - Liftgate Release Switch To I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
Technical Service Bulletin # 99-041 Date: 000501
Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
File in: Product
Section: Campaigns
Bulletin No: 99041
Dates: May, 2000
SUBJECT: 99041 - INCORRECT FRONT AXLE STATUS SIGNAL TO EBC4 ABS
MODELS: 1991-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC 4WD T UTILITIES 1994-1996 CHEVROLET AND
GMC 4WD T PICKUP TRUCKS
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS CAMPAIGN WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. YOU WILL RECEIVE A DEALER LISTING AS PHASES ARE RELEASED.
CONDITION
General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in certain
1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T pickup
trucks. Some of these vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch that signals the antilock brake
system (ABS) module when the vehicle is in four-wheel drive (4WD) may malfunction. The ABS
module is designed with two different operating algorithms; one for two-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied tot he rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunctioning switch may send an incorrect signal tot he ABS
module. If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result a vehicle crash.
CORRECTION
Dealers are to install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and an additional switch
to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in 4WD.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 313
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 314
Involved are certain 1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and
GMC 4WD T pickup truck built within these VIN breakpoints as shown.
IMPORTANT
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) or GM
Access Screen (Canada only) or DCS Screen 445 (IPC only) before beginning campaign repairs.
[Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
Involved vehicles have been identified by Vehicle Identification Number. Computer listing
containing the complete Vehicle Identification, customer name address data have been prepared,
and are being furnished to involved dealers with the campaign bulletin. The customer name
address data furnished will enable dealers to follow up with the campaign bulletin has no involved
vehicles currently assigned.
These dealer listings may contain customer names and addresses obtained from Motor Vehicle
Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any other purpose is a
violation of law in several states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of
this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this campaign.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts required to complete this campaign are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO = Daily Replenishment Order, in an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Part Number Description Quantity/Vehicle
88880028 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1991-94 Utility)
88880029 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1995-96 Utility, 1994-96 Pickup)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 315
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For US IPC
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the
instructions outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the
campaign number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service.
This Information may be inserted with a typewriter a ball point pen.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For CANADA
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the instruction
outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the campaign
number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service. This
information may be inserted with a typewriter or a ball point pen.
CLAIM INFORMATION
Submit a Product Campaign Claim with the information indicated.
Refer to the General Motors WINS claims processing Manual for details on Product Campaign
Claim Submission.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For US and CANADA
Customers will be notified of this campaign on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
customer letter included with this bulletin.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 316
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For IPC
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the attached suggested dealer letter.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - For US and IPC (US States, Territories, and
Possessions)
The US National Traffic end Motor Vehicle safety Act provides that each vehicle that is subject to
recall campaign of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the
customer has tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of vehicle is
prima facie evidence of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately
repaired within a reasonable time the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably
equivalent vehicle at no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for
depreciation. To avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made
to promptly schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as
possible. In the recall campaign notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration if the campaign is not completed within a
reasonable time.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - ALL
All unsold new vehicle in dealers' possession and subject to this campaign must be held an
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this campaign bulletin before customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this campaign at no charge to customers, regardless
of mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. This could be done by mailing to such customers, a copy of the customer
letter accompanying this bulletin. Campaign follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose,
since the customer may not as yet have received the notification letter. In summary, whenever a
vehicle subject to this campaign enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your dealership for service in
the future, you must take the steps necessary to be sure the campaign correction has been made
before selling or releasing the vehicle.
Disclaimer
1991-94 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching bolt.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the bolt removed in the previous step.
Important
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coolant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the bolt or nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 317
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 1 and tighten the
bolt to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted bon the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is routed
along the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel well towards the cowl area of the
engine compartment. On some vehicle this hose may be covered with a black convoluted
protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at me point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conitions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness is shown in Figure 1 and secure it to the existing Underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front exle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area above the brake booster assembly, and jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Loate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 318
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1994 T-Pickup
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Locate the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly so that the hole in the bracket align
with the front inboard nut that is molded into the top of the coolant reservoir as shown in Figure 2.
3. Using the bolt provided in the kit, switch the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly to the
coolant reservoir by hand at starting the bolt.
4. With the vacuum switch, bracket and hose assembly positioned as shown in Figure 2, tighten the
bolt to 10 Nm (88 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This hose is routed up from the axle
vacuum actuator and then rearward towards the cowl area inside the right fender as shown in
Figure 2.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is a part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 319
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the harness as shown in Figure 2 and secure the new harness to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kits.
10. Disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector, located in the
area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and jumper in the new
wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to engage
the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1995-96 T-Pickup and 1995-96 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching nut and discard.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the new nut contained in the kit.
Important:
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coalant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 320
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 3 and tighten the
nut to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is route along
the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel welt towards the cowl area of the engine
compartment. On come vehicle this hose may be covered with black convoluted protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that Will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line le tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the looking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness as shown in Figure 3 and secure it to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and
jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 321
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft)
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
Owner Letter
99041
(Sample Of Notification Used)
May, 2000
Dear General Motors Customer:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Reason For This Recall: General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle
safety exists in certain 1991-1996 4WD wheel drive (4WD) Blazers and Jimmys, and 1994-1996
4WD S-10 and Sonoma pickup trucks. Some of these Vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch
that signals the antilook brake system (ADS) module when the vehicle is in 4WD may malfunction.
The ABS module is designed with two different operating algorithms: one for 2-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied to the rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunction switch may send an incorrect signal to the ABS module.
If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result in a vehicle crash.
What Will Be Done: Your dealer will install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and
an additional switch to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in
4WD. This service will be performed for you at no charge.
How Long Will The Repair Take? The length of time required to perform this service correction is
approximately 30 minutes. Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If
your dealer has a large number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant.
Please ask your dealer if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed to schedule
process and repair your vehicle.
Contacting Your Dealer: Please contact your Chevrolet/GMC dealer as soon as possible to arrange
a service date. Parts are available and instructions for making this correction have been sent to
your dealer. Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer is best equipped to obtain parts and provide services to
correct you vehicle as promptly as possible. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service
date within a reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at
the listed number below:
Division Number Deaf, Hearing Impaired or Speech
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583 Utilize Telecommunication Devices
If, after contacting the appropriate Customer Assistance Center, you are still not satisfied that we
have done our best to remedy this condition without charge and within a reasonable time, you may
wish to write the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400 Seventh Street,
SW, Washington, DC 20590 or call 1-800-424-9393 (Washington, DC residents use
(202-366-0123).
Customer Reply Card: The customer reply card identifies your vehicle. Presentation of this card to
your dealer will assist in making necessary correction in the shortest possible time. If you no longer
own this vehicle, please let us know by completing the attached and mailing it in the postage paid
envelope.
We are sorry to cause you this inconvenience; however, we have taken this action in the interest of
your safety and continued satisfaction with our products.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
Technical Service Bulletin # 99-041 Date: 000501
Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
File in: Product
Section: Campaigns
Bulletin No: 99041
Dates: May, 2000
SUBJECT: 99041 - INCORRECT FRONT AXLE STATUS SIGNAL TO EBC4 ABS
MODELS: 1991-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC 4WD T UTILITIES 1994-1996 CHEVROLET AND
GMC 4WD T PICKUP TRUCKS
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS CAMPAIGN WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. YOU WILL RECEIVE A DEALER LISTING AS PHASES ARE RELEASED.
CONDITION
General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in certain
1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T pickup
trucks. Some of these vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch that signals the antilock brake
system (ABS) module when the vehicle is in four-wheel drive (4WD) may malfunction. The ABS
module is designed with two different operating algorithms; one for two-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied tot he rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunctioning switch may send an incorrect signal tot he ABS
module. If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result a vehicle crash.
CORRECTION
Dealers are to install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and an additional switch
to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in 4WD.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 327
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 328
Involved are certain 1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and
GMC 4WD T pickup truck built within these VIN breakpoints as shown.
IMPORTANT
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) or GM
Access Screen (Canada only) or DCS Screen 445 (IPC only) before beginning campaign repairs.
[Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
Involved vehicles have been identified by Vehicle Identification Number. Computer listing
containing the complete Vehicle Identification, customer name address data have been prepared,
and are being furnished to involved dealers with the campaign bulletin. The customer name
address data furnished will enable dealers to follow up with the campaign bulletin has no involved
vehicles currently assigned.
These dealer listings may contain customer names and addresses obtained from Motor Vehicle
Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any other purpose is a
violation of law in several states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of
this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this campaign.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts required to complete this campaign are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO = Daily Replenishment Order, in an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Part Number Description Quantity/Vehicle
88880028 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1991-94 Utility)
88880029 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1995-96 Utility, 1994-96 Pickup)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 329
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For US IPC
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the
instructions outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the
campaign number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service.
This Information may be inserted with a typewriter a ball point pen.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For CANADA
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the instruction
outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the campaign
number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service. This
information may be inserted with a typewriter or a ball point pen.
CLAIM INFORMATION
Submit a Product Campaign Claim with the information indicated.
Refer to the General Motors WINS claims processing Manual for details on Product Campaign
Claim Submission.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For US and CANADA
Customers will be notified of this campaign on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
customer letter included with this bulletin.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 330
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For IPC
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the attached suggested dealer letter.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - For US and IPC (US States, Territories, and
Possessions)
The US National Traffic end Motor Vehicle safety Act provides that each vehicle that is subject to
recall campaign of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the
customer has tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of vehicle is
prima facie evidence of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately
repaired within a reasonable time the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably
equivalent vehicle at no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for
depreciation. To avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made
to promptly schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as
possible. In the recall campaign notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration if the campaign is not completed within a
reasonable time.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - ALL
All unsold new vehicle in dealers' possession and subject to this campaign must be held an
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this campaign bulletin before customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this campaign at no charge to customers, regardless
of mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. This could be done by mailing to such customers, a copy of the customer
letter accompanying this bulletin. Campaign follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose,
since the customer may not as yet have received the notification letter. In summary, whenever a
vehicle subject to this campaign enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your dealership for service in
the future, you must take the steps necessary to be sure the campaign correction has been made
before selling or releasing the vehicle.
Disclaimer
1991-94 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching bolt.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the bolt removed in the previous step.
Important
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coolant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the bolt or nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 331
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 1 and tighten the
bolt to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted bon the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is routed
along the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel well towards the cowl area of the
engine compartment. On some vehicle this hose may be covered with a black convoluted
protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at me point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conitions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness is shown in Figure 1 and secure it to the existing Underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front exle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area above the brake booster assembly, and jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Loate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 332
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1994 T-Pickup
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Locate the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly so that the hole in the bracket align
with the front inboard nut that is molded into the top of the coolant reservoir as shown in Figure 2.
3. Using the bolt provided in the kit, switch the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly to the
coolant reservoir by hand at starting the bolt.
4. With the vacuum switch, bracket and hose assembly positioned as shown in Figure 2, tighten the
bolt to 10 Nm (88 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This hose is routed up from the axle
vacuum actuator and then rearward towards the cowl area inside the right fender as shown in
Figure 2.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is a part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 333
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the harness as shown in Figure 2 and secure the new harness to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kits.
10. Disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector, located in the
area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and jumper in the new
wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to engage
the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1995-96 T-Pickup and 1995-96 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching nut and discard.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the new nut contained in the kit.
Important:
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coalant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 334
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 3 and tighten the
nut to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is route along
the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel welt towards the cowl area of the engine
compartment. On come vehicle this hose may be covered with black convoluted protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that Will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line le tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the looking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness as shown in Figure 3 and secure it to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and
jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > 4WD
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 >
May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 335
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft)
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
Owner Letter
99041
(Sample Of Notification Used)
May, 2000
Dear General Motors Customer:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Reason For This Recall: General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle
safety exists in certain 1991-1996 4WD wheel drive (4WD) Blazers and Jimmys, and 1994-1996
4WD S-10 and Sonoma pickup trucks. Some of these Vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch
that signals the antilook brake system (ADS) module when the vehicle is in 4WD may malfunction.
The ABS module is designed with two different operating algorithms: one for 2-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied to the rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunction switch may send an incorrect signal to the ABS module.
If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result in a vehicle crash.
What Will Be Done: Your dealer will install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and
an additional switch to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in
4WD. This service will be performed for you at no charge.
How Long Will The Repair Take? The length of time required to perform this service correction is
approximately 30 minutes. Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If
your dealer has a large number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant.
Please ask your dealer if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed to schedule
process and repair your vehicle.
Contacting Your Dealer: Please contact your Chevrolet/GMC dealer as soon as possible to arrange
a service date. Parts are available and instructions for making this correction have been sent to
your dealer. Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer is best equipped to obtain parts and provide services to
correct you vehicle as promptly as possible. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service
date within a reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at
the listed number below:
Division Number Deaf, Hearing Impaired or Speech
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583 Utilize Telecommunication Devices
If, after contacting the appropriate Customer Assistance Center, you are still not satisfied that we
have done our best to remedy this condition without charge and within a reasonable time, you may
wish to write the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400 Seventh Street,
SW, Washington, DC 20590 or call 1-800-424-9393 (Washington, DC residents use
(202-366-0123).
Customer Reply Card: The customer reply card identifies your vehicle. Presentation of this card to
your dealer will assist in making necessary correction in the shortest possible time. If you no longer
own this vehicle, please let us know by completing the attached and mailing it in the postage paid
envelope.
We are sorry to cause you this inconvenience; however, we have taken this action in the interest of
your safety and continued satisfaction with our products.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
C150 - Brake Pressure Warning Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Release Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
LH I/P Harness Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 345
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 346
C208 - Park Brake Warning Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor ...........................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 900-2000 ohms
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 350
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 2. Disconnect brake caliper
assembly and position aside. 3. Remove rotor, then hub and bearing assembly. 4. Disconnect
wheel sensor electrical connector 5. Remove sensor wire form upper control arm clip. 6. Remove
sensor and splash shield assembly attaching bolts, then remove sensor. 7. Reverse procedure to
install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 356
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 357
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 360
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 361
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 362
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 363
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 364
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 365
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 366
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 367
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 368
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 369
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 370
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 371
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 372
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 373
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 374
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 375
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 376
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 377
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 378
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 379
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 380
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 381
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 382
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 383
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 384
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 385
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 386
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 387
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 388
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 389
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 390
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 391
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 392
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 393
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Right Front Engine Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations > Page 397
Engine Harness, Right Front
NOTE: The OEM service manual provides multiple location views for this component.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations > Page 398
C108 - Eng Coolant Temp Sender
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Locations > Manual Transmission
Cruise Control Brake Switch And Vacuum Release Valve (W/Man Trans)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Locations > Manual Transmission > Page 404
Cruise Control Brake Switch And Vacuum Release Valve (W/Auto Trans)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 407
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 408
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 409
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 410
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 411
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 412
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 413
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 414
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 415
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 416
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 417
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 418
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 419
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 420
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 421
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 422
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 423
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 424
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 425
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 426
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 427
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 428
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 429
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 430
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 431
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 432
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 433
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 434
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 435
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 436
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 437
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 438
C252 - Cruise Control Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations
Clutch Switch: Locations
Brake Pedal Switches.
On the Clutch Pedal Support bracket.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Clutch Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 444
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 445
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 446
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 447
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 448
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 449
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 450
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 451
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 452
Clutch Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 453
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 454
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 455
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 456
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 457
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 458
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 459
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 460
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 461
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 462
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 463
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 464
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 465
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 466
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 467
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 468
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 469
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 470
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 471
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 472
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 473
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 474
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control Switch: Locations
Cruise Control I/P Wiring
Part of the multi-function lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cruise Control Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 480
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 481
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 482
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 483
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 484
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 485
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 486
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 487
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 488
Cruise Control Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 489
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 490
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 491
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 492
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 493
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 494
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 495
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 496
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 497
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 498
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 499
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 500
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 501
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 502
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 503
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 504
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 505
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 506
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 507
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 508
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 509
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 510
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 511
C251 - Cruise Control Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 512
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove steering wheel, lower steering column covers and steering lock plate cover, if equipped.
2. Disconnect cruise control connector from main harness connector and attach a suitable length of
flexible wire to cruise control harness.
Fig. 10 Cruise Control Switch replacement
3. Tape joint between main and control harness to aid removal, then remove control assembly, Fig.
10.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Locations
Components
Behind the right hand side of the I/P near the ECM, PCM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
518
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
519
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
520
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
521
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
522
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
523
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
524
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
525
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
526
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
527
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
528
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
529
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
530
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
531
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
532
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
533
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
534
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
535
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
536
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
537
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
538
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
539
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
540
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
541
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
542
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
543
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
544
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
545
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
546
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
547
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
548
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 476149 > Dec > 94 > Oil Pressure Gauge Erratic Reading Concerns
Oil Pressure Sender: Customer Interest Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
File In Section: 6 - Engine Bulletin No. 47-61-49 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Oil Pressure Gauge Reading Concerns (Replace Oil Pressure Sending Unit)
Models: 1991-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, P Models, M/L, G Vans 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 2.2L, 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 7.4L Engines (VINs 4, Z, H, K, N - RPOs LN2, LB4, L03, L05,
L19)
CONDITION Some owners may comment on one or all of the following conditions:
^ High oil pressure when starting engine cold. ^ Low oil pressure when engine is at idle hot. ^
Erratic gauge readings.
CAUSE Oil pressure sending unit was not optimally calibrated for all operating conditions.
CORRECTION If actual oil pressures are within tolerances listed in Section 6A of the Service
Manual, and gauge circuit electrical diagnostics in Section SC of the Service Manual do not
uncover the source of the problem, an improved oil pressure sending unit should be installed.
Parts Information
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER
Oil Pressure Sending Unit 12553175
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
LABOR OPERATION LABOR TIME N222O
Use published labor operation and time.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 476149 > Dec > 94 > Oil Pressure
Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
Oil Pressure Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading
Concerns
File In Section: 6 - Engine Bulletin No. 47-61-49 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Oil Pressure Gauge Reading Concerns (Replace Oil Pressure Sending Unit)
Models: 1991-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, P Models, M/L, G Vans 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 2.2L, 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 7.4L Engines (VINs 4, Z, H, K, N - RPOs LN2, LB4, L03, L05,
L19)
CONDITION Some owners may comment on one or all of the following conditions:
^ High oil pressure when starting engine cold. ^ Low oil pressure when engine is at idle hot. ^
Erratic gauge readings.
CAUSE Oil pressure sending unit was not optimally calibrated for all operating conditions.
CORRECTION If actual oil pressures are within tolerances listed in Section 6A of the Service
Manual, and gauge circuit electrical diagnostics in Section SC of the Service Manual do not
uncover the source of the problem, an improved oil pressure sending unit should be installed.
Parts Information
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER
Oil Pressure Sending Unit 12553175
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
LABOR OPERATION LABOR TIME N222O
Use published labor operation and time.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service
Center Locations
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 66-83-04A
Date: September, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: AC Delco Service Center Locations for Odometer/Speedometer Service
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (excluding Cadillac)
This bulletin is being revised to provide the necessary contact information only. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 66-83-04 (Section 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical)
General Motors provides service for sophisticated electronic products through the authorized AC
Delco Service Center Program. This program is designed to provide GM vehicle owners with the
highest quality and most technically up-to-date product available. Repair products from
unauthorized service outlets are not acceptable as warranty replacements.
Currently, there are 25 authorized AC Delco Service Centers who exchange and remanufacture
odometer/speedometers (list included). Only these Centers should be contacted for service.
Important:
W series and 1997 T series Medium Duty truck odometer/speedometers must be ordered directly
from GMSPO.
The following steps should be taken when utilizing the AC Delco Service Centers: Dealers should
contact their local AC Delco Service Center (list included). Any listed facility may be used.
The following information must be provided:
Part number VIN, Mileage, Vehicle Year, Make and Model Dealer Name and Address Delivery
Date of Vehicle Name of the person requesting exchange or service Phone number Repair Order
Number P.O. number (if non - warranty)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 568
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 569
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 570
AC Delco Service Centers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 468304 > Oct
> 94 > Speedometer - Momentary Drop With Flashers On
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Speedometer - Momentary Drop With Flashers
On
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical Bulletin No.: 46-83-04 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Speedometer Momentary Drop when Turning on Park Lamps, Turn Signals or Hazard
Flashers (Send I/P Cluster to Delco Repair Station)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T
Pickup Models
Condition
Some speedometers in the above vehicles may momentarily drop when the turn signal, park lamp,
or hazard flasher is turned on. This condition often occurs at speeds over 60 miles per hour.
Cause
Slight system voltage drop when the extra load from the lights is added.
Correction
Remove the instrument cluster and send it to the local Delco Repair Station. Repair stations are
aware of the condition and have parts available to repair the cluster. They will add a capacitor to
the power circuit to assure a consistent power flow during power up of the above mentioned lamps.
Be sure to clearly describe the condition on the Delco Repair Order accompanying the cluster.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 580
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 581
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 668304A >
Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 582
AC Delco Service Centers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission > Page 591
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 592
C120 - Fuel Pump Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 593
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable from battery.
- Sensor or switch connectors.
- Sensor or switch.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Sensor or switch.
- Sensor or switch.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Air Conditioning Switch: Locations
A/C And Heater Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 598
A/C And Heater Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Pressure Cycling Switch
Air Conditioning Switch: Description and Operation Pressure Cycling Switch
The refrigeration cycle (on and off operation of the compressor) is controlled by a switch which
senses the low-side pressure as an indicator of evaporator temperature. The pressure cycling
switch is the freeze protection device in the system and senses refrigerant pressure on the suction
side of the system. This switch is mounted on a standard service fitting on the accumulator. This
switch also provides compressor cutoff during cold weather.
Additional compressor protection results from the operating characteristics of the low-side pressure
cycling system. If a massive discharge occurs in the low side of the system, or the orifice tube
becomes plugged, low-side pressures could be insufficient to close the contacts of the pressure
switch. In the event of a low charge, insufficient cooling accompanied by rapid compressor clutch
cycling will be noticed at high outside (ambient) air temperatures.
If replacement of the pressure cycling switch is necessary, it is important to note that this may be
done without removing the refrigerant charge. During replacement of the pressure switch, a new
O-ring seal must be installed and the switch assembled to the specified torque of 4.5 Nm (40 lbs.
in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Pressure Cycling Switch > Page 601
Air Conditioning Switch: Description and Operation High Pressure Cutoff Switch
This system is equipped with a high pressure cutoff switch. This switch is normally closed, and
opens at 2827-3103 kPa (410-450 psi) to interrupt the voltage to the compressor clutch coil. This
will stop the compressor from cycling and prevent the pressure relief valve from discharging
refrigerant and oil.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Blower Control Switch
C267 - Blower Control Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Blower Control Switch > Page 606
C267 - Heater Blower Control Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > With A/C
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair With A/C
Heater Control Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > With A/C > Page 609
Temperature Control Cable
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (64).
2. Control assembly (63).
3. Electrical connectors, as necessary.
4. Vacuum connectors, as necessary.
5. Temperature cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > With A/C > Page 610
6. Blower switch, if necessary.
NOTICE: Remove the blower switch knob and spring clip, and remove the blower switch.
Inspect
- Electrical terminals for corrosion. Remove the corrosion or replace the component as necessary.
- Temperature and mode levers for freedom of movement. Lubricate, repair, or replace as
necessary.
- Temperature control cable for kinks, binding, and other damage. Repair or replace as necessary.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater blower switch, if removed.
- Hold the blower switch in position and install the spring clip.
- Install the blower switch knob.
2. Temperature cable.
3. Vacuum connectors, as necessary.
4. Electrical connectors, as necessary.
5. Control assembly (63).
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
6. Screws (64).
- Tighten Screws (64) to 1.6 Nm (14 lbs. in.).
7. Check circuit operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > With A/C > Page 611
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair Without A/C
Heater Control Assembly
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (64).
2. Control assembly (63).
3. Electrical connectors, as necessary.
4. Vacuum connectors, as necessary.
5. Temperature cable.
6. Blower switch, if necessary.
- Remove the blower switch knob and spring clip, and remove the blower switch.
Inspect
- Electrical terminals for corrosion. Remove the corrosion or replace the component as necessary.
- Temperature and mode levers for freedom of movement. Lubricate, repair, or replace as
necessary.
- Temperature control cable for kinks, binding, and other damage. Repair or replace as necessary.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater blower switch, if removed.
- Hold the blower switch in position and install the spring clip.
- Install the blower switch knob.
2. Temperature cable.
3. Vacuum connectors, as necessary.
4. Electrical connectors, as necessary.
5. Control assembly (63).
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
6. Screws (64).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > With A/C > Page 612
- Tighten screws (64) to 1.6 Nm (14 lbs. in.).
7. Check circuit operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Heater Lockout Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Heater Lockout Switch: Diagrams
C266 - A/C-Heater Selector Switch
C266 - A/C-Heater Selector Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
A/C Compressor Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > A/C High Pressure Cutout Switch
C190 - A/C High Pressure Cutout Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams > A/C High Pressure Cutout Switch > Page 621
C138 - A/C Low Pressure Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Compressor Cut-Off/Cycling Switch
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Compressor Cut-Off/Cycling
Switch
The refrigeration cycle (on and off operation of the compressor) is controlled by a switch which
senses the low-side pressure as an indicator of evaporator temperature. The pressure cycling
switch is the freeze protection device in the system and senses refrigerant pressure on the suction
side of the system. This switch is mounted on a standard service fitting on the accumulator. This
switch also provides compressor cutoff during cold weather.
Additional compressor protection results from the operating characteristics of the low-side pressure
cycling system. If a massive discharge occurs in the low side of the system, or the orifice tube
becomes plugged, low-side pressures could be insufficient to close the contacts of the pressure
switch. In the event of a low charge, insufficient cooling accompanied by rapid compressor clutch
cycling will be noticed at high outside (ambient) air temperatures.
If replacement of the pressure cycling switch is necessary, it is important to note that this may be
done without removing the refrigerant charge. During replacement of the pressure switch, a new
O-ring seal must be installed and the switch assembled to the specified torque of 4.5 Nm (40 lbs.
in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Compressor Cut-Off/Cycling Switch > Page 624
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Compressor High Side Cut-Off
Switch
This system is equipped with a high pressure cutoff switch. This switch is normally closed, and
opens at 2827-3103 kPa (410-450 psi) to interrupt the voltage to the compressor clutch coil. This
will stop the compressor from cycling and prevent the pressure relief valve from discharging
refrigerant and oil.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Dimmer Switch: Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 630
Dimmer Switch: Locations
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 631
LH I/P Harness Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 632
C219 - Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 633
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 5 Lock Plate Compression
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove steering wheel.
WARNING: Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts/ Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems)/ Service
and Repair/ Air Bag System Disarming & Arming.
3. Using a screwdriver, pry cover from lock plate. 4. Using lock plate compressing tool No. J-23653,
or equivalent, remove lock plate as follows:
a. Compress lock plate and pry retaining ring from groove on shaft, Fig. 5. b. Slowly release lock
plate compressing tool, then remove tool and lock plate from shaft end.
5. Slide canceling cam and upper bearing preload spring from end of shaft. 6. Remove turn signal
(multi-function) lever. 7. Remove hazard warning knob retaining screw, button, spring and knob. 8.
Remove pivot arm. 9. Remove switch retaining screws and pull switch up from column, guiding
wire harness through column.
10. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch
Dome Lamp Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 638
Door Switch: Locations Door Jamb Switch, LH Front
LH Door Jamb Switch Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 639
Interior Lamp Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 640
Power Mirrors Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 641
Door Switch: Locations Door Jamb Switch, RH Front
Interior Lamp Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 642
Power Mirrors Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 643
Door Switch: Locations Door Jamb Switch, 4-Door
Power Door Lock Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 644
Power Window And Door Lock Body Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 645
Door Switch: Diagrams
C205 - LH Door Jamb Wiring
C205 - LH Door Jamb Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Sending Unit
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Sending Unit
Rear Lamps Crossbody Harness W/O Trailer Tow
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Sending Unit > Page 650
Rear Lamps Harness W/Trailer Tow
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Sending Unit > Page 651
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly (Typical)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 652
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly (Typical)
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle.
- Fuel tank.
- Pump and sending unit assembly by turning cam lock counterclockwise using tool J-36608 or
J-24187 or equivalent.
Pull fuel pump up into attaching hose while pulling outward from the bottom support. Do not
damage rubber insulator or strainer.
INSPECT
- Inspect fuel pump attaching hose for signs of deterioration.
- Inspect rubber sound insulation at bottom of pump for deterioration.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Pump assembly into attaching hose.
NOTE: Care should be taken not to fold over or twist strainer when installing sending unit as this
will restrict fuel flow. Sending unit and fuel pump assembly into fuel tank. (Always use a new O-ring seal).
- Cam lock assembly. Turn cam lock clockwise to lock it.
- Fuel tank assembly.
- Negative battery cable.
- START vehicle and check for fuel leaks.
- Lower vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
LH I/P Harness Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 656
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 657
C208 - Park Brake Warning Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission
Backup Lamp And Park/Neutral Position Switch (Auto Trans)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission > Page 663
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Manual Transmission
Backup Lamp Switch Wiring-Four-Wheel Drive Models
Backup Lamp Switch Wiring-Four-Wheel Drive Models
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Brake Light Switch
LH I/P Harness Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Brake Light Switch > Page 668
Brake Light Switch: Locations Stop Lamp Switch
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Brake Light Switch > Page 669
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Light Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 672
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 673
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 674
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 675
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 676
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 677
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 678
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 679
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 680
Brake Light Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 681
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 682
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 683
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 684
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 685
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 686
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 687
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 688
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 689
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 690
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 691
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 692
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 693
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 694
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 695
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 696
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 697
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 698
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 699
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 700
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 701
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 702
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 703
Brake Light Switch: Connector Views
C264 - Backup Lamp Switch
C321 - Backup Lamp Switch
C264 - Backup Lamp Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 704
Brake Light Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Exterior Lamps: Standard I/P (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 705
Cruise Control
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 706
Fig. 5 Cruise Control Wiring Diagram.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 707
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The brake switch signals the control module to turn "OFF" the torque converter clutch when the
brakes are applied.
OPERATION
The brake switch is normally closed. When the brake pedal is applied the switch will open,
changing the signal to the control module. The control module uses this signal to de-energize the
TCC solenoid when brake pedal is applied.
LOCATION
The brake switch is located on the brake pedal mounting bracket.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 708
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Below LH Side Of I/P - Clutch And Brake Pedal Bracket Areas
All Except Utility Truck Brake Switch
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect wiring connector from brake light switch located
on brake pedal bracket. 3. Disconnect retainer from brake pedal pin. 4. Disconnect switch by
unsnapping from pushrod. 5. Reverse procedure to install.
Fig. 4 Stop Light Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 709
Utility Truck Brake Switch
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect wiring connector from brake light switch located
on brake pedal bracket. 3. Pull switch from mounting bracket. 4. Depress brake pedal, then push
new switch into clip until shoulder bottoms out, Fig. 4. 5. Pull brake pedal rearward against pedal
stop to adjust switch. Switch is properly adjusted when brake lights operate when brake pedal is
depressed
0.53 inch from normal position. If further adjustment of switch is necessary, switch can be rotated
or pulled in clip.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch
Dome Lamp Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 714
Door Switch: Locations Door Jamb Switch, LH Front
LH Door Jamb Switch Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 715
Interior Lamp Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 716
Power Mirrors Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 717
Door Switch: Locations Door Jamb Switch, RH Front
Interior Lamp Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 718
Power Mirrors Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 719
Door Switch: Locations Door Jamb Switch, 4-Door
Power Door Lock Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Jamb Switch > Page 720
Power Window And Door Lock Body Wiring-4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 721
Door Switch: Diagrams
C205 - LH Door Jamb Wiring
C205 - LH Door Jamb Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Fog Lamp Switch And Relay Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 725
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Diagrams
C225 - Fog Lamp Switch
C225 - Fog Lamp Switch
C146 - Fog LP Switch Harness
C146 - Fog LP Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Locations
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 729
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 730
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 731
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 732
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 733
C203 - Headlamp Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
I/P Harness Wiring, LH
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 737
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
HEADLAMPS
Voltage is supplied to the Light Switch at all times. The Light Switch includes a Self-Resetting
Circuit Breaker. The Circuit Breaker opens when the Circuit Breaker opens, it interrupts the current
flow. With no current flow, the Circuit Breaker cools off the resets automatically. When the Light
Switch is in HEAD, the Headlamps Dimmer Switch directs voltage to either the Low Beams or High
Beams. The High Beams Indicator also receives voltage along with the High Beams.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 738
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEADLAMPS
Voltage is supplied to the Light Switch at all times. The Light Switch includes a Self-Resetting
Circuit Breaker. The Circuit Breaker opens when the Circuit Breaker opens, it interrupts the current
flow. With no current flow, the Circuit Breaker cools off the resets automatically. When the Light
Switch is in HEAD, the Headlamps Dimmer Switch directs voltage to either the Low Beams or High
Beams. The High Beams Indicator also receives voltage along with the High Beams.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 739
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove Headlamp switch trim plate and switch assembly
attaching screws. 3. Disconnect electrical connectors from Headlamp switch, then remove switch
assembly from dash panel. 4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Turn Signal Switch - Damage During I/P Replacement
Turn Signal Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Turn Signal Switch - Damage During I/P
Replacement
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 56-83-03
Date: September, 1995
INFORMATION
Subject: Hazard Button/Multi-Function Signal Switch Damage During I/P or Cluster Removal or
Replacement
Models: 1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
The following is an update on the installation and replacement of the I/P cluster and the procedure
necessary to avoid possible damage to the Multi-function Switch (MFS) and especially the hazard
button. These hazard buttons which are part of the MFS are common for both S/T and C/K
vehicles. The damage to the hazard button is most common when installing an after-market radio
or when doing repairs to the I/P.
If for any reason the I/P trim bezel needs to be removed, the procedure for instrument cluster
replacement (1995 S/T Service Manual, Section 8C-6) must be followed exactly. This includes
removing the steering column nuts and lowering the steering column. If not, the possibility of
damage of the hazard button is increased.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
C2323 Lower I/P Trim Panel R&R; 0.3 hr
C2327 Steering Column Lower 0.3 hr
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 744
Hazard Flasher And Multi-Function Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 745
Turn Signal Switch: Diagrams
C204 - Turn Signal Switch
C204 - Turn Signal Switch In-Line
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 746
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 5 Lock Plate Compression
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove steering wheel.
WARNING: Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts/ Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems)/ Service
and Repair/ Air Bag System Disarming & Arming.
3. Using a screwdriver, pry cover from lock plate. 4. Using lock plate compressing tool No. J-23653,
or equivalent, remove lock plate as follows:
a. Compress lock plate and pry retaining ring from groove on shaft, Fig. 5. b. Slowly release lock
plate compressing tool, then remove tool and lock plate from shaft end.
5. Slide canceling cam and upper bearing preload spring from end of shaft. 6. Remove turn signal
(multi-function) lever. 7. Remove hazard warning knob retaining screw, button, spring and knob. 8.
Remove pivot arm. 9. Remove switch retaining screws and pull switch up from column, guiding
wire harness through column.
10. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 752
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 753
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 756
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 757
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 758
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 759
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 760
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 761
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 762
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 763
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 764
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 765
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 766
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 767
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 768
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 769
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 770
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 771
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 772
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 773
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 774
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 775
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 776
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 777
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 778
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 779
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 780
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 781
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 782
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 783
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 784
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 785
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 786
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 787
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 788
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 789
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 794
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 799
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
800
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View >
Page 803
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View >
Page 804
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 805
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 806
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 807
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 808
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 809
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
Voltage 3.6 to 5.2 V at 1000 to 2000 ft
3.5 to 5.1 V at 2000 to 3000 ft
3.3 to 5.0 V at 3000 to 4000 ft
3.2 to 4.8 V at 4000 to 5000 ft
3.0 to 4.6 V at 5000 to 6000 ft
2.9 to 4.5 V at 6000 to 7000 ft
2.8 to 4.3 V at 7000 to 8000 ft
2.6 to 4.2 V at 8000 to 9000 ft
2.5 to 4.0 V at 9000 to 10000 ft
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 813
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 814
MAP Sensor 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 817
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 818
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 819
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 820
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 821
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 822
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 823
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 824
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 825
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 826
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 827
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 828
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 829
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 830
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 831
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 832
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 833
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 834
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 835
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 836
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 837
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 838
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 839
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 840
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 841
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 842
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 843
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 844
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 845
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 846
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 847
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 848
C109 - MAP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 849
MAP Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 850
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Map Sensor Circuit (GM Generic)
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
PURPOSE
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures changes in the intake manifold pressure
resulting from engine load and speed changes. As intake manifold pressure increases, the air
density in the intake manifold also increases and additional fuel is required. Under certain
conditions, the MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure. This allows the control
module to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
The PCM uses information from the MAP sensor to calculate spark advance and fuel as follows: Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in more spark advance.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in less spark advance.
- Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in less fuel.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in more fuel.
OPERATION
The control module supplies a 5 volt reference signal to the MAP sensor and the sensor provides a
path to ground through its variable resistor. The control module by monitoring the sensor output
voltage can determine the manifold pressure. A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a
relatively low MAP output, while a wide open throttle will produce a high output. At higher pressure
or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The higher the MAP
voltage output the lower the engine vacuum, which requires more fuel. The lower the MAP voltage
output the higher the engine vacuum. At lower pressure output voltage will be about 1 to 2 volts at
idle.
A failure in the MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) 33 or 34 with
PCM/ECM systems and DTC P0107 or P0108 with VCM systems.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 851
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Output Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 852
MAP Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changes, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. At lower pressure output voltage will
be about 1 to 2 volts at idle. While at higher pressure or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output
voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The MAP sensor is also used, under certain conditions, to
measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different altitudes. The
PCM uses the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Important
^ Be sure to use the same Diagnostic Test Equipment for all measurements.
1. Checks MAP sensor output voltage to the PCM. This voltage, without engine running, represents
a barometer reading to the PCM.
^ When comparing Tech 1 scan readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number. Refer to figures on facing page.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change.
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage
value should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
NOTICE:Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
4. Disconnect sensor from bracket and twist sensor by hand (only) to check for intermittent
connection. Output changes greater than .1 volt
indicate a bad connector or connection. If OK, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 861
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear >
Page 867
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Closed Loop 100 - 0.999 mV
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 879
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor > Page 882
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 885
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 886
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 887
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 888
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 889
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 890
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 891
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 892
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 893
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 894
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 895
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 896
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 897
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 898
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 899
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 900
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 901
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 902
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 903
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 904
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 905
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 906
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 907
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 908
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 909
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 910
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 911
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 912
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 913
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 914
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 915
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 916
C116 - Oxygen Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 917
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 918
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE
The Oxygen sensor (O2 Sensor) has the ability to produce a low voltage signal that feeds
information on engine exhaust content to the control module.
CONSTRUCTION
The O2 Sensor is constructed from a zirconia/platinum electrolytic element. Zirconia is an
electrolyte that conducts electricity under certain chemical conditions. The element is made of a
ceramic material and is an insulator when cold. At operating temperature, 315°C (600°F), the
element becomes a semiconductor. A platinum coating on the outer surface of the element
stimulates further combustion of the exhaust gases right at the surface and this helps deep the
element up to the desired temperature. The O2 Sensor has an inter cavity which is filled with
atmospheric (reference) air. The atmosphere has approximately 21% oxygen in it. In the electrical
circuit this inter cavity is the positive (+) terminal. The outer surface of the element is exposed to
the exhaust gas stream. It is the negative (-) terminal.
Oxygen Sensor Output Voltage vs. Air/Fuel Ratio
The difference in oxygen concentration in the narrow range of optimum air/fuel ratio causes a large
voltage change that is easily measured.
OPERATION
A rich exhaust (excessive fuel) has almost no oxygen. When there is a large difference in the
amount of oxygen touching the inside and outside surfaces, there is more conduction, and the
sensor puts out a voltage signal above 0.6 volts (600 mV). With lean exhaust (excessive oxygen)
there is about two percent oxygen in the exhaust. This is a smaller difference in oxygen from the
outside surfaces which results in less conduction and a voltage signal below 0.3 volts (300 mV).
The voltages are monitored and used by the control module to "fine tune" the air/fuel ratio to
achieve the ideal mixture desired.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 919
The control module puts out a reference signal of 0.45 volts (450 mV). The reference signal serves
two purposes. The first is to run the engine when it is in OPEN LOOP mode of operation. When the
air/fuel ratio is correct the control module senses 450 mV. When the engine is operating with a rich
air/fuel ratio there is a reduction of free oxygen in the exhaust stream and the O2 sensor voltage
rises above the reference voltage.
When the engine is running lean the voltage drops below the reference voltage due to the excess
oxygen in the exhaust stream. The O2 sensor provides the feedback information for the CLOSED
LOOP operating mode of the fuel delivery system. The O2 sensor indicates to the control module
what is happening in the exhaust. It does not cause things to happen. It is a type of gauge: Low
voltage output = lean mixture = high oxygen content in the exhaust; high voltage output = rich
mixture = low oxygen content in the exhaust.
CONDITIONS THAT CAN SET CODES
An open O2 sensor, should set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 13. A constant low voltage in the
O2 sensor circuit should set a DTC 44. A constant high voltage in the circuit should set a DTC 45.
DTC 44 and DTC 45 could be set as a result of fuel system problems. REFER TO COMPUTERS
AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSTIC CHARTS for diagnosis of these codes.
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR TYPE
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating element that is part of the sensor itself. The heater
helps the control module control the fuel injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) to detect if the heater part of the sensor is working. To check
the heater, REFER TO COMPUTERS AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
PROCEDURES/OXYGEN SENSOR TESTING.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 920
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION
- Connectors and wires
- Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
- Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
CAUTION Do NOT perform the following test for more than 2 minutes, as this may cause damage
to the catalytic converter.
PERFORMANCE TEST
Checks working range and response (speed). Warm engine
- Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt D.C. range)
- "RUN" engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm) Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
- Drive system rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow-meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
- Drive system lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an control module input or
output. Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds. NOTE After each test
the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three seconds.
- O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above. NOTE A CEC system
that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its maximum range and should
be repaired first and not diagnosed as a 02 sensor failure.
- Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
HEATING ELEMENT (H20S only)
- Turn ignition "OFF". Disconnect electrical connector.
- Connect test light between harness terminals "A" and "B".
- Turn ignition "ON". Test light should be "ON". If test light is "OFF", connect test light to harness terminal "A" to ground. Light should be "ON"
ensuring power circuit is operating correctly.
- Turn ignition "OFF".
- Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals A and B.
Resistance @ Specified Temperature
3.5 ohms @ 20°C (68°F) 14 ohms @ 350°C (662°F)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 921
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE The oxygen sensor has a permanently attached pig-tail and connector. This pig-tail should
not be removed, since removal will affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
REMOVAL
- Disconnect electrical connector from oxygen sensor.
- Using suitable wrench, carefully remove sensor from exhaust manifold or pipe.
Caution
The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when engine temperature is below 120°F. Excessive
force may damage threads in exhaust manifold or pipe.
INSTALLATION
- If new sensor is being used, install sensor into manifold or pipe.
- If old sensor is being reused, coat threads with anti-seize compound, Part No. 5613695 or
equivalent, then install into manifold or pipe.
- Torque oxygen sensor to 41 N-m (30 lb. ft.), then reconnect electrical connector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
925
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 928
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 929
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 930
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 931
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 932
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 933
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 934
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 935
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 936
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 937
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 938
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 939
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 940
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 941
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 942
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 943
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 944
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 945
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 946
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 947
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 948
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 949
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 950
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 951
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 952
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 953
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 954
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 955
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 956
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 957
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 958
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 959
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 960
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 961
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 962
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 963
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) - Service
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) Service
Group Ref.: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 448301
Date: August, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: NEW PROCEDURE FOR OBTAINING SERVICE DRACS (DIGITAL RATIO
ADAPTOR/CONTROLLER)
MODELS: 1989-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK M/L VANS, S/T MODELS 1990-94
CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK G VANS, R/V MODELS 1992-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC
TRUCK C/K MODELS 1991-94 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
If a dealer is contacted about or is in need of a service DRAC (Digital Ratio Adaptor/Controller) for
any of the following reasons:
1. Radio interference (EMI).
2. Speedometer fluctuation or flaring.
3. Erratic/surging cruise control operation.
4. Different tire size.
5. Defective part.
The dealer must contact an AC-Delco Service Center authorized to repair electronic instrument
clusters for a new service DRAC, P/N 16202915.
NOTE:
This part is a service part and has to be programmed for the vehicle. It cannot be used until this
procedure has been done by the authorized Service Center.
The dealer will need the P/N and the broadcast code (the 3 bold letters located on the printed label
of the old DRAC). The Service Center will program the DRAC according to this information.
If the customer is changing the tire size, the Service Center will need the axle ratio and tire sized in
order to program the DRAC to the new tire specifications. The AC-Delco Service Center will send
the programmed DRAC via common carrier to the dealership.
For further information, consult the AC-Delco authorized Service Center Manual WA-2 (September
1990 or later). AC-Delco centers are subject to change.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly
View
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Assembly View
LOCATION
Mounted To Transmisssion Tailshaft.
2WD Automatic Transmission
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
2WD Manual Transmission
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
4WD Automatic and Manual Transmission
VSS 4WD Or AWD
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly
View > Page 973
Speed Sensor, Backup Lamp Switch & Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 974
C320 - Vehicle Speed Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 975
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
2 Wheel Drive (Manual Transmission)
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
2 Wheel Drive (Automatic Transmission)
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
4 Wheel Drive
VSS 4WD Or AWD
PURPOSE
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) provides information to the control module for control of: Transmission Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Speedometer
- Odometer
- Cruise control
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 976
- ANTILOCK brake system.
CONSTRUCTION
The VSS is made up of: Permanent Magnet (PM) generator (coil), which is mounted on the transmission.
- Rotor (tooth), which is mounted on the output shaft in the transmission.
- VSS Buffer, which is mounted to the control module bracket.
OPERATION
The VSS is a Permanent Magnet (PM) generator that produces a pulsing Alternating Current (AC)
voltage as each rotor tooth nears the coil. As the vehicle speed increases, the number of AC
voltage pulses increase. The VSS buffer processes inputs from the VSS and outputs signal to the
speedometer control module and cruise module. The VSS buffer takes the voltage pulses from the
VSS and uses them to open and close four solid state output switches to ground at a rate
proportional to vehicle speed. The VSS buffer is matched to the vehicle based on final drive ratio
and tire size.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 977
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Speed sensor resistance should be 900-2000 ohms. The sensor is not serviceable and should be
replaced if defective. The speed sensor is located on the transfer case.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then disconnect electrical connector from speed sensor. 2. Loosen
sensor with suitable wrench. 3. Position suitable container under sensor, then remove sensor and
O-ring. 4. Coat O-ring with transmission fluid, then install O-ring and speed sensor. 5. Torque
sensor to 32 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Automatic Transmission
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Automatic Transmission > Page 983
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 984
C120 - Fuel Pump Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 985
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable from battery.
- Sensor or switch connectors.
- Sensor or switch.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Sensor or switch.
- Sensor or switch.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 989
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 992
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 993
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 994
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 995
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 996
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 997
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 998
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 999
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1000
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1001
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1002
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1003
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1004
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1005
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1006
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1007
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1008
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1009
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1010
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1011
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1012
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1013
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1014
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1015
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1016
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1017
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1018
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1019
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1020
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1021
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1022
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1023
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1024
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1025
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1026
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1027
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 1033
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1034
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 1037
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 1038
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1039
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1040
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1041
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1042
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1043
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Arming Sensor
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Arming Sensor
The arming sensor is a protective switch located in the power side of the deployment loop. It is
calibrated to close at low level speed changes. This ensures that the inflator module is connected
directly to the 36 Volt Loop Reserve (VLR) output of the DERM when either of the discriminating
sensors close.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Arming Sensor > Page 1049
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Discriminating Sensors
There are two discriminating sensors in the air bag system. They are wired in parallel on the low
(ground) side of the deployment loop. These sensors are calibrated to close with speed changes
severe enough to warrant deployment. A diagnostic resistor is connected in parallel with the switch
contacts within each of the discriminating sensors. These parallel resistors supply the ground path
for the current passing through the deployment loop during normal operation. This current flow
results in voltage drops across each component in the deployment loop. The DERM monitors these
voltage drops to detect malfunctions.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Arming Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Arming Sensor
Prior to performing replacement procedures, disarm air bag system. Refer to, Service and Repair/
Air Bag System Disarming & Air Bag System Arming. Refer to, / Specifications/ Mechanical for
torque values when installing components. All sensors and mounting bracket bolts must be
carefully torqued to assure proper operation. Never power up the air bag system when any sensor
is not rigidly attached to the vehicle, since the sensor could be activated when not attached,
causing air bag deployment.
1. disconnect sensor electrical connector from retainer, remove Connector Position Assurance
(CPA) lock from connector, then disconnect
connector.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolts and sensor from vehicle. 3. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Arming Sensor > Page 1052
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Forward Discriminating Sensor
Prior to performing replacement procedures, disarm air bag system. Refer to, Service and Repair/
Air Bag System Disarming & Air Bag System Arming. Refer to, / Specifications/ Mechanical for
torque values when installing components. All sensors and mounting bracket bolts must be
carefully torqued to assure proper operation. Never power up the air bag system when any sensor
is not rigidly attached to the vehicle, since the sensor could be activated when not attached,
causing air bag deployment.
1. Drill out mounting rivets. 2. Remove discriminating sensor electrical connector from retainer,
then the Connector Position Assurance (CPA) lock from connector. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
connector. 4. Remove sensor from vehicle. 5. Reverse procedure to install. Ensure arrow on
sensor is pointing toward front of vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Switch
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations Safety Belt Switch
Safety Belt Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Switch > Page 1057
Safety Belt Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Switch > Page 1058
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations Safety Belt Switch Jumper Harness
Safety Belt Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Switch > Page 1059
Safety Belt Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations
I/P Wiring, Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1068
C253 - Clutch Release Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1069
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove lower instrument panel trim. 2. Remove clutch start switch electrical connector, Fig. 3.
3. Remove clutch start switch from clutch pedal. 4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1074
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1075
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1076
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1077
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1078
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1079
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1080
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1081
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1082
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1083
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1084
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1085
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1086
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1087
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1088
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1089
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1090
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1091
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1092
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1093
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1094
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1095
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1096
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1097
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1098
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1099
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1100
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1101
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1102
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1103
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1104
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1105
Neutral Safety Switch: Connector Views
C209 - Park/Neutral Position Switch
C247 - Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1106
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
The neutral start switch also incorporates the back-up light switch in these vehicles.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
1. Remove battery ground cable. 2. Remove lower insulator panel. 3. Remove neutral start switch
electrical connector. 4. Remove neutral start switch. 5. Reverse procedure to install, noting the
following:
a. Align actuator on the switch with holes in shift tube. b. Press down on front of switch until tangs
snap into rectangular holes in the steering column jacket. c. Adjust switch by moving the gear
selector to park.
MANUAL TRANSMISSION
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect back-up lamp switch electrical connector. 3.
Disconnect switch wiring from transmission bracket. 4. Remove switch from transmission. 5.
Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch > Page
1113
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1114
C217 - Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Plugs (1/8 - 27) .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Pressure Plugs (1/4 - 18) ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 18 Pressure Switches ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs. Vehicle Speed Sensor Retainer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
The Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor is used by the control module to control: Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) apply and release schedule.
- Hot mode determination.
- Shift quality.
OPERATION
The TFT is a thermistor used to indicate transmission fluid temperature. The control module sends
a 5.0 volt signal to the TFT through a resistor in the computer and measures the voltage. High
sensor resistance produces high signal input voltage which corresponds to low fluid temperature.
Low sensor resistance produces low signal input voltage which corresponds to high fluid
temperature. With the TFT varying its resistance, the control module can sense transmission fluid
temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION
The sensor is part of the transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly and is attached to the
control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Pickup
Transfer Case Select Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Pickup > Page
1132
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1133
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 4 Selector Switch Installation. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove console, then disconnect console wiring harness.
3. Remove shifter boot retaining screws and slide boot up shift lever.
4. Remove switch attaching screw, then the switch and harness, Fig. 2.
5. Position new switch on mounting bracket and install attaching screw.Ensure shift lever assembly
pawl is on the switch contact carrier.
6. Route wiring as shown in Fig. 4.
7. Place shifter boot in proper position, then install retaining screws.
8. Connect console wiring harness, then install console.
9. Connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift
Transfer Case Switch
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift
Transfer Case Switch > Page 1138
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift
Transfer Case Switch > Page 1139
4WD Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn.
Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor
Conn.
Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001
Date: May 17, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed
Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab
9-7X
with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive
Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is
removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer
case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the
plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past,
the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair
procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This
connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time.
A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This
new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass
Element Switch > Component Information > Locations
Heated Glass Element Switch: Locations
Rear Window Release And Defogger Forward Wiring - 4-Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass
Element Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1148
Rear Window Release Forward Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Rear Door Power Window-4Door
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1152
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
C503 - Front LH Power Window Switch
C503 - Front LH Power Window Switch
C512 - Rear LH Power Window Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1153
C603 - Front RH Power Window Switch
C603 - Front RH Power Window Switch
C612 - Rear RH Power Window Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
Rear Wiper/Washer Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
C218 - Wiper/Washer Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch > Page 1160
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagrams Window Wiper/Washer Switch, Rear
C211A - Rear Wiper/Washer To Rear Body
C207 - Rear Wiper/Washer Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Rear Wiper/Washer Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Wiper/Washer Switch
C218 - Wiper/Washer Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Wiper/Washer Switch > Page 1166
C207 - Rear Wiper/Washer Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Wiper/Washer Switch > Page 1167
C211A - Rear Wiper/Washer To Rear Body
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1168
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts/ Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems)/ Service
and Repair/ Air Bag System Disarming & Arming.
1. Remove ignition lock. 2. Remove shift lever clevis, then the lever from vehicle. 3. Remove wire
harness straps, then disconnect steering column bulkhead connector from vehicle wire harness. 4.
Disconnect turn signal switch gray and black connectors from column bulkhead connector. 5.
Remove pan head tapping screws, then the turn signal switch assembly from column. 6. Reverse
procedure to install. Torque pan head tapping screws to 53 inch lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By
Symptom
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 463501 Date: 950401
Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
File in Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 46-35-01
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Front Tire Wear and/or Steering Returnability (Set to New Alignment Specification)
Models: 1991-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models 1991-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
CONDITION Some owners may comment on excessive front tire wear and/or steering returnability.
PERFORM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION BEFORE ALIGNMENT
CORRECTION The following procedures should be used to address customer's concerns about
front tire wear and/or steering returnability:
1. Check to be sure the tire pressure is set to GVW Certification/Tire label specifications located on
the driver's door lock pillar.
Important:
It is essential proper tire rotation schedule be followed at proper intervals to minimize tire wear.
2. 4WD ONLY, front suspension "Z" height dimension and setting must be made prior to any other
alignment changes.
3. Perform front wheel alignment to the specifications in chart (figure).
Notice:
Vehicle must be jounced three times before checking alignment to eliminate false geometry
readings.
a. For 4WD only, front suspension "Z" height dimension 122 ± 6.0 mm (4.8 ± 0.2 inch), left and
right side to be equal within 6 mm.
b. Left and right side to be equal within 0.5".
c. Left and right side to be equal within 1.0".
d. Steering wheel must be held in straight ahead position with ± 3.0". Front individual toe must be
equalized relative to rear wheel thrust angle.
e. GVW alignment is the same for all vehicles.
Technical Service Bulletin # 463501 Date: 950401
Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
File in Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By
Symptom > Page 1174
Bulletin No.: 46-35-01
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Front Tire Wear and/or Steering Returnability (Set to New Alignment Specification)
Models: 1991-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models 1991-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
CONDITION Some owners may comment on excessive front tire wear and/or steering returnability.
PERFORM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION BEFORE ALIGNMENT
CORRECTION The following procedures should be used to address customer's concerns about
front tire wear and/or steering returnability:
1. Check to be sure the tire pressure is set to GVW Certification/Tire label specifications located on
the driver's door lock pillar.
Important:
It is essential proper tire rotation schedule be followed at proper intervals to minimize tire wear.
2. 4WD ONLY, front suspension "Z" height dimension and setting must be made prior to any other
alignment changes.
3. Perform front wheel alignment to the specifications in chart (figure).
Notice:
Vehicle must be jounced three times before checking alignment to eliminate false geometry
readings.
a. For 4WD only, front suspension "Z" height dimension 122 ± 6.0 mm (4.8 ± 0.2 inch), left and
right side to be equal within 6 mm.
b. Left and right side to be equal within 0.5".
c. Left and right side to be equal within 1.0".
d. Steering wheel must be held in straight ahead position with ± 3.0". Front individual toe must be
equalized relative to rear wheel thrust angle.
e. GVW alignment is the same for all vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1180
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1181
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1182
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1183
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1184
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1185
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 1186
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 463501 > Apr > 95 > Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
File in Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 46-35-01
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Front Tire Wear and/or Steering Returnability (Set to New Alignment Specification)
Models: 1991-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models 1991-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
CONDITION Some owners may comment on excessive front tire wear and/or steering returnability.
PERFORM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION BEFORE ALIGNMENT
CORRECTION The following procedures should be used to address customer's concerns about
front tire wear and/or steering returnability:
1. Check to be sure the tire pressure is set to GVW Certification/Tire label specifications located on
the driver's door lock pillar.
Important:
It is essential proper tire rotation schedule be followed at proper intervals to minimize tire wear.
2. 4WD ONLY, front suspension "Z" height dimension and setting must be made prior to any other
alignment changes.
3. Perform front wheel alignment to the specifications in chart (figure).
Notice:
Vehicle must be jounced three times before checking alignment to eliminate false geometry
readings.
a. For 4WD only, front suspension "Z" height dimension 122 ± 6.0 mm (4.8 ± 0.2 inch), left and
right side to be equal within 6 mm.
b. Left and right side to be equal within 0.5".
c. Left and right side to be equal within 1.0".
d. Steering wheel must be held in straight ahead position with ± 3.0". Front individual toe must be
equalized relative to rear wheel thrust angle.
e. GVW alignment is the same for all vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride (Trim)
Height Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Vehicle Ride (Trim) Height Specifications
Fig. 4 Vehicle Ride Height Measurement Locations And Specifications
Refer to Fig. 4 for ride height measurements and specifications.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride (Trim)
Height Specifications > Page 1193
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Caster, Deg. ........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ +1.0 to +3.0 Camber, Deg. .................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... +0.0
to +1.6 Toe-In, Deg. ............................................................................................................................
....................................................................... +0.05 to +0.25 Ball Joint Wear, Inches ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............. [01]
[01] Refer to Steering & Suspension/ Suspension/ Ball Joint/ Testing and Inspection.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Diagnostic
Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
Component Location - "S/T" 4.3Z Utility - Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Idle Speed - Specification Revised
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission Bulletin No.: 41-65-22 Date: September, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 4 - Revised Controlled Idle Speed Specification
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck Light Duty Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with
Gasoline Engines
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised > Page 1203
This service bulletin supersedes Service Manual information for the Controlled Idle Speed
Specification on Page 4-3 of the Driveability, Emissions, and Electrical Diagnosis Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1204
Idle Speed: Specifications
Refer to Adjustment Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1214
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1220
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-6-5-4-3-2
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Ignition
Timing Connector > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location
Correction
Ignition Timing Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location
Correction
File in Section: Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-41
Date: January, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 6A - Ignition Set Timing Connector Location
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine
(VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
The location of the Set Timing Connector is incorrectly called out in "Section 6A" (Page 6A-8) of the
"Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis", Service Manual and in the 1994 Oldsmobile
Bravada Service Manual Supplement (Page 6E3-C4-8).
The correct location of the Set Timing Connector is inside the cab where the Heater Box and the
carpet meet on the passenger side floor.
Pull carpet back to expose the single wire and connectors on the outside of the control module
harness. The wire colors are tan with a black stripe.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Ignition
Timing Connector > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1234
Timing Connector-In Pass Comp Behind Carpet, Below Heater
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Timing Marks
and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Timing Mark
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
RESISTANCE VALUES
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 3,000 - 10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 4,000 - 15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 6,000 - 20,000 ohms.
NOTE: Longer wires should measure about 5,000 to 10,000 ohms per foot.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1245
Ignition Cable: Locations
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications
Distributor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1249
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1250
Distributor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The distributor reference signal provides the ECM with both engine RPM and crankshaft position
information. This enables the ECM to operate the fuel pump relay and energize the fuel injector.
OPERATION
When the engine is cranking or running the ECM receives Distributor Ignition (DI) reference pulses
from the ignition module. If the wire becomes open or grounded the engine will not run, as the ECM
will not operate the injector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1251
Distributor: Service and Repair
Distributor
Remove or Disconnect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1252
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1253
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1254
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1255
- Make sure the ignition switch is "OFF."
1. Air cleaner and hoses (4.3L VIN Z). 2. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor
cap. 3. Two screws on the sides of the distributor cap. 4. Coil wire and spark plug wires on either
the left or right side of the distributor. 5. Distributor cap and move it aside.
A. Use chalk to note the position of the rotor in relation to the engine. B. Use chalk to note the
position of the distributor housing in relation to the engine.
6. Distributor bolt and hold-down clamp. 7. Distributor and gasket, when present.
Install or Connect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1256
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1257
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1258
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1259
A. To ensure correct timing of the distributor, it must be installed with the rotor correctly positioned
as noted in step 5 of the removal procedure. Line
up the rotor to the mark on the engine, and the mark on the housing to the engine.
B. If the distributor shaft won't drop into the engine, remove the distributor, insert a screwdriver into
the hole for the distributor and rotate the oil
pump driveshaft so that it lines up with the distributor driver gear.
1. Distributor and gasket, where present. 2. Hold-down clamp and bolt.
- Bolt on the 4.3L to 27 Nm (20 lbs. ft.).
3. Distributor cap. 4. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor. 5. Spark plug wires
and coil wire. 6. Air Cleaner and hoses.
- Check the engine timing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
........................................ N/A see NOTE following.
Spark Plug Torque ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 15 N-m (11 lb.ft.)
Spark Plug Type ..................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... AC CR43TSM
NOTE Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Minimum, 698 kPa (100 psi) @ 200 rpm. The lowest cylinder reading should not be less than 80%
of the highest. Perform compression test with engine at normal operating temperature, spark plugs
removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
VALVE ADJUSTMENT (VIN Z)
WITH SCREW-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS AND POSITIVE STOP SHOULDERS
Valve Rocker Arm Nuts .......................................................................................................................
.......................................... 27 Nm (20 lb. ft.).
WITH PRESSED-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS
Refer to Rocker Arm / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 1270
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
4.3L/V6-262 Left Side...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. E-I-E-I-I-E Right Side.........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1271
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 10 Valve Adjustment
The 4.3L VIN Z engine can be equipped with two different rocker arm stud configurations that
require different valve lash procedures.
TYPE 1 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has screw-in rocker arm studs with positive stop shoulders, no
valve adjustment is necessary. When the valve train requires service, you simply tighten the rocker
arm nuts to 27 Nm (20 ft lb).
TYPE 2 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has pressed-in rocker arm studs, you must follow the valve
adjustment procedure outlined below.
1. Remove rocker arm cover. 2. Rotate engine until mark on torsional damper is aligned with "0"
mark on timing tab fastened to crankcase front cover. To ensure engine is at No.
1 cylinder firing position, place fingers on No. 1 cylinder valves as the mark on damper approaches
the "0" mark on timing tab. If valves are not moving, engine is in the No. 1 cylinder firing position. If
valves are moving, engine is in the No. 4 cylinder firing position and should be rotated one
revolution.
3. With engine in No. 1 cylinder firing position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 1, 5 and 6.
^ Intake valves 1, 2 and 3.
NOTE: Even numbered cylinders are in the left bank and odd numbered cylinders are in the right
bank, when viewed from front of the engine.
4. Back off adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then tighten nut until all lash is removed. This
can be determined by rotating pushrod while
turning adjusting nut. When all lash is removed, tighten adjusting nut 1 and 3/4 turns to center lifter
plunger.
5. Crank engine one full revolution until mark on torsional damper and "0" mark on timing tab are
again in alignment. This is the No. 4 cylinder
firing position. With engine in this position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 2, 3 and 4.
^ Intake valves 4, 5 and 6.
6. Install valve covers and related components, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1272
Valve Clearance: Service and Repair
For Valve Adjustment, Refer to Valve Clearance / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of
Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine).
Background
Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be
very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges
from $160 - $200.
EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser
tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the
guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from:
- Drive Belt Noise
- Accelerated Drive Belt Wear
- Drive Belt Slippage
Instructions
The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These
instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal
instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt.
Caution
- Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser.
- Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses
help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances.
- Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to
protect eyes from direct laser exposure.
1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1277
2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system.
3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves
of the pulley, farthest from the front of the
engine.
4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool.
5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the
tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light
beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley
alignment.
- If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly.
- If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the
position of the power steering pulley as required.
- Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures.
9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation.
10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present.
Tool Information
Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1278
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1279
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Serpentine Drive Belt Wear Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-013
Date: April 29, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Serpentine Belt Wear
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
All current GM vehicles designed and manufactured in North America were assembled with
serpentine belts that are made with an EPDM material and should last the life of the vehicle. It is
extremely rare to observe any cracks in EPDM belts and it is not expected that they will require
maintenance before 10 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi) of use.
Older style belts, which were manufactured with a chloroprene compound, may exhibit cracks
depending on age. However, the onset of cracking typically signals that the belt is only about
halfway through its usable life.
A good rule of thumb for chloroprene-based belts is that if cracks are observed 3 mm (1/8 in) apart,
ALL AROUND THE BELT, the belt may be reaching the end of its serviceable life and should be
considered a candidate for changing. Small cracks spaced at greater intervals should not be
considered as indicative that the belt needs changing.
Any belt that exhibits chunking should be replaced.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
1280
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Serpentine Drive Belt Routing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
1281
Serpentine Belt Routing
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Use a 1/2 inch breaker bar with a socket placed on the tensioner pulley axis bolt and rotate the
tensioner to the left (counterclockwise).
CAUTION: Do NOT allow the drive belt tensioner to snap into the "free" position as this may
damage the tensioner.
2. Remove belt.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Route belt over pulleys except the belt tensioner. 2. Use a 1/2 inch breaker bar with a socket
placed on the tensioner pulley axis bolt and rotate the tensioner to the left (counterclockwise). 3.
Belt over the tensioner pulley. 4. Check the belt for correct "V" groove tracking around each pulley.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1292
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine,
A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine,
A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1298
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair
Inspection
The crankcase ventilation system should be checked every 30,000 miles and also during regular
engine tune-ups. If the crankcase ventilation system includes a breather filter, located in the air
cleaner housing, this filter should be replaced whenever the crankcase ventilation valve or air
cleaner is replaced. When a periodic inspection indicates the crankcase ventilation is not
functioning properly, it should be serviced by replacement only.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > EGR Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
EGR Filter: Service and Repair
EVRV Filter Replacment
REMOVE AND INSTALL
- Grasp and pull the filter OFF with a rocking motion.
- Push the new filter on making sure that the cut-out for the wires is properly aligned.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Locations
Vapor Canister 2.5;2.8;4.3;5.0;5.7;7.4L
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Fuel Evaporative Canister Filter Replacement
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair Fuel Evaporative Canister Filter Replacement
PROCEDURE
At intervals recommended, usually every 24 months or 30,000 miles, the filter on an open bottom
canister should be replaced,
- Remove all hoses from the top of the canister and mark. Remove the canister.
- Remove the filter element by squeezing it out from under the lip surface at bottom of canister and
from under retainer bar, where used.
- Squeeze the new element under retainer bar, where used, and position it evenly around the entire
bottom of the canister. Tuck the edges under the lip of canister.
- Reinstall the canister to its original position on the vehicle, following normal service procedures.
- Reconnect the hoses to the top of the canister, according to the labeling on top of canister.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Fuel Evaporative Canister Filter Replacement > Page 1310
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair EVRV Filter Replacement
EVRV Filter Replacment
Removal and Installation
- Grasp and pull the filter OFF with a rocking motion.
- Push the new filter on making sure that the cut-out for the wires is properly aligned.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - Updated Design Oil Filter Assembly & Seal
Fluid Filter - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Updated Design Oil Filter Assembly & Seal
Group Ref.: Transmission
Bulletin No.: 377142A
Date: February, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: NEW TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY
MODELS: 1994 BUICK ROADMASTER 1994 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD 1994 CHEVROLET
CAPRICE, CAMARO, CORVETTE 1994 PONTIAC FIREBIRD 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K
AND S/T TRUCKS 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC M/L AND G VANS 1994 OLDSMOBILE
BRAVADA
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E (M30)
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING REVISED TO CLARIFY TRANSMISSION USAGE. PLEASE DISCARD
BULLETIN 377142.
BULLETIN COVERS:
New product information for 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions. Be certain to familiarize
yourself with these updates to properly repair the 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - Updated Design Oil Filter Assembly & Seal > Page 1315
DATE OF PRODUCTION CHANGE: (Figure 1 and 2)
On August 10, 1993 (Julian Date 222), HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions were built with a new
filter seal (ill. 71) and transmission oil filter assembly (ill. 72).
The previous transmission oil filter assembly and filter seal had an assembly method of installing
the seal on the filter neck and then installing the filter in the transmission.
When using the new filter seal and transmission oil filter assembly, the filter seal must be installed
in the transmission first and then install the transmission oil filter assembly into the transmission.
NOTE:
The new filter seal and transmission oil filter assembly can be used on all HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E
transmissions 1993-1994. The new filter seal and transmission oil filter assembly cannot be used
on any HYDRA-MATIC 4L60 transmission.
The new filter seal cannot be used with the old transmission oil filter assembly and the new
transmission oil filter assembly cannot be used with the old filter seal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information >
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
Oil Filter: Customer Interest Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1328
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1329
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1330
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1331
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1332
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1333
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page
1334
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 07-06-01-016B > Jul > 09 > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter
Application Importance
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1344
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1345
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1346
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1347
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1348
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1349
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 1350
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 476118 > Jun > 94 > Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
GROUP REF.: 6 - Engine
BULLETIN NO.: 476118
DATE: June, 1994
SUBJECT: ENHANCED PF52 AND PF1218 OIL FILTERS
MODELS: 1986-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K, S/T, M/L, R/V, AND G MODELS 1991-94
OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
THIS BULLETIN CANCELS AND SUPERSEDES BULLETIN 476502 TO CORRECT THE
CATEGORY IDENTIFIER/GROUP REFERENCE. PLEASE DISCARD BULLETIN 476502 (GROUP
REFERENCE 6E- ENGINE FUEL & EMISSION).
AC Rochester will be supplying a limited number of new oil filters with enhanced anti-drainback
valves to GMSPO. Oil filters with effective anti-drainback valves may reduce or eliminate short
duration cold knock. Due to limited production capacity, the new filters are only to be used on the
following special cases.
1. Trucks or vans with short duration cold knock.
2. Routine maintenance of 1994 trucks or vans. Use the existing PF52 (P/N 25012760) and
PF1218 (P/N 25013977) oil filters for applications other
than the special cases listed above.
PART INFORMATION:
For "cold knock" vehicles or 1994 vehicle maintenance:
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER REPLACES
PF52 25160560 PF51
PF1218 25160561 PF35
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 420502 > May > 94 > Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters
Revised
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 420502
Date: May, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: AC ROCHESTER ENGINE OIL FILTER IDENTIFICATION
MODELS: 1994 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: DEALER SERVICE MANAGER/WARRANTY ADMINISTRATOR
The purpose of this bulletin is to notify retail/wholesale service personnel of a running change to
the AC Rochester Original Equipment engine oil filters.
Due to an agreement to decrease the number of GMSPO part numbers, AC Rochester will phase
in a decision to make all Original Equipment engine oil filters blue; same color used on AC
aftermarket engine oil filters. This means that eventually the use of black Original Equipment
engine oil filters will be discontinued.
For the purpose of Warranty/Policy administration, the following will assist retail/wholesale service
personnel in identifying the difference between blue Original Equipment and aftermarket engine oil
filters:
^ AFTERMARKET FILTER: will continue to use "AC DURAGUARD OIL FILTER" label.
^ OE FILTER: will have a black bar code, Julian date code and the letters "OE" printed on the
dome of the filter. At this time, it is anticipated that all OE engine oil filters will be changed by May
1994.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 07-06-01-016B > Jul > 09 > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter
Application Importance
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 476118 > Jun > 94 > Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
GROUP REF.: 6 - Engine
BULLETIN NO.: 476118
DATE: June, 1994
SUBJECT: ENHANCED PF52 AND PF1218 OIL FILTERS
MODELS: 1986-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K, S/T, M/L, R/V, AND G MODELS 1991-94
OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
THIS BULLETIN CANCELS AND SUPERSEDES BULLETIN 476502 TO CORRECT THE
CATEGORY IDENTIFIER/GROUP REFERENCE. PLEASE DISCARD BULLETIN 476502 (GROUP
REFERENCE 6E- ENGINE FUEL & EMISSION).
AC Rochester will be supplying a limited number of new oil filters with enhanced anti-drainback
valves to GMSPO. Oil filters with effective anti-drainback valves may reduce or eliminate short
duration cold knock. Due to limited production capacity, the new filters are only to be used on the
following special cases.
1. Trucks or vans with short duration cold knock.
2. Routine maintenance of 1994 trucks or vans. Use the existing PF52 (P/N 25012760) and
PF1218 (P/N 25013977) oil filters for applications other
than the special cases listed above.
PART INFORMATION:
For "cold knock" vehicles or 1994 vehicle maintenance:
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER REPLACES
PF52 25160560 PF51
PF1218 25160561 PF35
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 420502 > May > 94 > Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 420502
Date: May, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: AC ROCHESTER ENGINE OIL FILTER IDENTIFICATION
MODELS: 1994 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: DEALER SERVICE MANAGER/WARRANTY ADMINISTRATOR
The purpose of this bulletin is to notify retail/wholesale service personnel of a running change to
the AC Rochester Original Equipment engine oil filters.
Due to an agreement to decrease the number of GMSPO part numbers, AC Rochester will phase
in a decision to make all Original Equipment engine oil filters blue; same color used on AC
aftermarket engine oil filters. This means that eventually the use of black Original Equipment
engine oil filters will be discontinued.
For the purpose of Warranty/Policy administration, the following will assist retail/wholesale service
personnel in identifying the difference between blue Original Equipment and aftermarket engine oil
filters:
^ AFTERMARKET FILTER: will continue to use "AC DURAGUARD OIL FILTER" label.
^ OE FILTER: will have a black bar code, Julian date code and the letters "OE" printed on the
dome of the filter. At this time, it is anticipated that all OE engine oil filters will be changed by May
1994.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Heater Hose: Specifications
Heater Inlet Hose Mounting Screw
....................................................................................................................................................... 1.4
Nm (12 lbs. in.)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose
With A/C
Heater Hose Routing-With A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
Tool Required:
- J 38723 Heater Line Quick Connect Separator or Equivalent
1. Air cleaner.
2. Engine coolant.
3. Inlet hose mounting screw.
4. Inlet hose clamp at heater core.
NOTE: Loosen the clamp enough to slide away from the fitting on the inlet hose (72).
5. Inlet hose (72) from heater core.
6. Push inlet hose (72) into connector and insert J 38723 or equivalent into connector to release
locking tabs.
7. Pull retainer and hose (72) from heater inlet connector.
Inspect
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose > Page 1378
- O-ring sealing surface on hose/pipe. Adjust
- If replacing heater inlet connector remove retainer from hose and discard as new connector is
equipped with retainer.
- If replacing hose, remove retainer from hose and reinsert in connector.
- If reusing hose and connector, retainer can remain in place on hose.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Push hose (72) into connector until retainer tabs lock.
NOTE: Pull back on hose to check for proper engagement.
2. Inlet hose (72) to heater core.
3. Inlet hose clamp.
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
4. Inlet hose mounting screw.
- Tighten screw to 1.4 Nm (12 lbs. in.).
5. Engine coolant.
6. Air cleaner.
- Check the system for leaks.
Without A/C
Heater Hose Routing W/out A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
Tool Required:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose > Page 1379
- J 38723 Heater Line Quick Connect Separator or Equivalent
1. Air cleaner.
2. Engine coolant.
3. Inlet hose mounting screw.
4. Inlet hose clamp at heater core.
NOTE: Loosen the clamp enough to slide away from the fitting on the inlet hose (72).
5. Inlet hose (72) from heater core.
6. Push inlet hose (72) into connector and insert J 38723 or equivalent into connector to release
locking tabs.
7. Pull retainer and hose (72) from heater inlet connector.
Inspect
- O-ring sealing surface on hose/pipe. Adjust
- If replacing heater inlet connector remove retainer from hose and discard as new connector is
equipped with retainer.
- If replacing hose, remove retainer from hose and reinsert in connector.
- If reusing hose and connector, retainer can remain in place on hose.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Push hose (72) into connector until retainer tabs lock.
NOTE: Pull back on hose to check for proper engagement.
2. Inlet hose (72) to heater core.
3. Inlet hose clamp.
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
4. Inlet hose mounting screw.
- Tighten screw to 1.4 Nm (12 lbs. in.).
5. Engine coolant.
6. Air cleaner.
- Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose > Page 1380
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Outlet Hose
With A/C
Heater Hose Routing-With A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Engine coolant.
2. Hose clamps.
3. Outlet hose (70) from heater core.
4. Outlet hose (70) from radiator.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Outlet hose (70) to radiator.
2. Outlet hose (70) to heater core.
3. Hose clamps.
4. Engine coolant.
- Check the system for leaks.
Without A/C
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose > Page 1381
Heater Hose Routing W/out A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Engine coolant.
2. Hose clamps.
3. Outlet hose (70) from heater core.
4. Outlet hose (70) from radiator.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Outlet hose (70) to radiator.
2. Outlet hose (70) to heater core.
3. Hose clamps.
4. Engine coolant.
- Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1382
Special Tool
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions
Hose/Line HVAC: Service Precautions
The life and efficient operation of the air conditioning system depends upon the chemical stability of
the refrigerant system. When foreign materials, such as dirt, air, or moisture, contaminate the
refrigeration system, they change the stability of the Refrigerant-12 or Refrigerant-134a and 525
viscosity or polyalkaline glycol (PAG) refrigerant oil. They will also affect the pressure-temperature
relationship, reduce efficiency, and could cause internal corrosion and abnormal wear of moving
parts. The following general practices should be followed to ensure chemical stability in the system:
1. Whenever it becomes necessary to disconnect a hose connection, wipe away any dirt or oil at or
near the connection to eliminate the possibility of
dirt entering the system. Both sides of the connection should be capped, plugged, or taped as soon
as possible to prevent the entrance of dirt and moisture. (Remember that all air contains moisture.
Air that enters any part of the refrigeration system will carry moisture with it, and the exposed
surfaces will collect the moisture quickly.)
2. Keep tools clean and dry. This includes the Manifold Gage Set and all replacement parts.
3. When adding 525 viscosity or polyalkaline glycol (PAG) refrigerant oil, the container/transfer tube
through which the oil will flow should be
exceptionally clean and dry. Refrigerant oil must be as moisture-free as possible.
4. When it is necessary to "open" an air conditioning system, have everything needed ready so that
as little time as possible will be required to
perform the operation. Do not leave the air conditioning system open any longer than necessary.
5. Anytime the air conditioning system has been "opened," it should be properly evacuated before
recharging.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions
> Page 1386
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
Compressor And Condenser Hose Routing-Utility
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Discharge and recover refrigerant from the system.
3. Bolt (7) and washer (8).
4. Hose assembly (3) from compressor (1).
5. Sealing washers. Refer to "Compressor Sealing Washers."
6. Hose assembly (3) from accumulator (6).
7. O-ring seal.
8. Hose assembly (3) from condenser (4).
9. O-ring seal.
- Cap or plug all open connections.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
NOTICE: For steps 2, 4, and 7, refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
1. New O-ring seal.
- Coat O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
2. Hose assembly (3) to condenser (4).
- Tighten hose assembly (3) to 24 Nm (18 lbs. ft.).
3. New O-ring seal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions
> Page 1387
- Coat O-ring seal with 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
4. Hose assembly (3) to accumulator (6).
- Tighten hose assembly (3) to 41 Nm (30 lbs. ft.).
5. Sealing washers.
6. Hose assembly (3) to compressor (1).
7. Washer (8) and bolt (7).
- Tighten bolt (7) to 34 Nm (25 lbs. ft.).
8. Negative battery cable.
9. Refrigerant to the system.
- Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 1391
When either a hose is reinstalled or replaced, the following points are essential:
- Route return and feed hoses in the same position they were in before removal.
- Route return and feed hoses smoothly, avoid sharp bends and chinking.
- After return and feed hoses are installed, check for leaks while the system is being bled. Refer to
"Bleeding The Power Steering System."
NOTICE: Do not start the engine with any power steering hose disconnected, or damage to the
components could occur.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations
Brake Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations
File In Section: 05 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 00-05-22-004
Date: May, 2000
INFORMATION
Subject: Brake Fluid Level and Filling Recommendations
Models: 2001 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Many dealers and after-market repair shops advertise multi-point fluid "top-ups" in conjunction with
oil changes or regular maintenance packages. These offers often include adding brake fluid to the
master cylinder reservoir. There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the brake
reservoir might go down. The first is that the brake fluid level goes down an acceptable level during
normal brake lining wear. When the linings are replaced, the fluid will return to it's original level.
The second possible reason for a low fluid level is that fluid is leaking out of the brake system. If
fluid is leaking, the brake system requires repair and adding additional fluid will not correct the leak.
If the system was properly filled during delivery of the vehicle, no additional fluid should be required
under most circumstances between brake pad and/or shoe replacements. This information can be
reinforced with the customer by referring them to the Brake Fluid section of their vehicle's Owner's
Manual.
Guidelines
GM vehicles have incorporated a variety of brake fluid reservoir styles. The following guidelines are
restricted to the plastic bodied fluid reservoirs and do not affect the original service
recommendations for the older style metal bodied units.
You may encounter both black plastic and translucent style reservoirs. You may have reservoirs
with:
^ A MAX fill mark only
^ A MIN fill mark only
^ Both MAX and MIN marks
The translucent style reservoirs do not have to have the covers removed in order to view the fluid
level. It is a good practice not to remove the reservoir cover unless necessary to reduce the
possibility of contaminating the system. Use the following guidelines to assist in determining the
proper fluid level.
Important:
When adding brake fluid, use Delco Supreme II(R) Brake Fluid, GM P/N 12377967 or equivalent
brand bearing the DOT-3 rating only.
Important:
At no time should the fluid level be allowed to remain in an overfilled condition. Overfilling the brake
reservoir may put unnecessary stress on the seals and cover of the reservoir. Use the following
guidelines to properly maintain the fluid level. If the reservoir is overfilled, siphon out the additional
fluid to comply with the guidelines below.
Important:
If under any circumstance the brake fluid level is extremely low in the reservoir or the BRAKE
warning indicator is illuminated, the brake system should be checked for leaks and the system
repaired in addition to bringing the fluid level up to the recommended guidelines outlined below. A
leaking brake system will have reduced braking performance and will eventually not work at all.
Important:
Some vehicles have reservoirs that are very sensitive to brake fluid levels and may cause the
BRAKE indicator to flicker on turns as the fluid approaches the minimum required level. If you
encounter a vehicle with this concern, increase the fluid level staying within the guidelines outlined
below.
^ If the reservoir has a MAX level indicator, the reservoir should be returned to the MAX marking
only at the time new brake pads and/or shoes are installed. If the reservoir fluid level is at the
half-way point or above do not attempt to add additional brake fluid during routine fluid checks.
^ If the reservoir has both MAX and MIN indicators, the fluid level should be maintained above the
MIN indicator during routine fluid checks and returned to the MAX indication only after new brake
pads and/or shoes are installed.
^ For reservoirs with only a MIN indication, the fluid level should be maintained above the MIN
indicator during routine fluid checks. Return the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations > Page 1397
reservoir fluid level to full only after installing new brake pads and/or shoes. A full reservoir is
indicated on translucent, snap cover reservoirs by a fluid level even with the top level of the view
window imprinted into the side of the reservoir. On screw top models in black or translucent plastic,
the full level is just below the bottom of the filler neck.
Parts Information
Part Number Description
12377967 Brake Fluid
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 1398
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Brake System DOT 3
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Fill the clutch master cylinder to the "Full" or "MAX" mark on the reservoir. Do not overfill.
Caution: Should accidental spillage occur, rinse the area thoroughly with water. Pay special
attention to any electrical wires, parts, harnesses, rubber or painted surfaces.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1403
Clutch Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
Hydraulic Clutch Fluid
...........................................................................................................................................................
DOT 3 or DOT 4 Brake Fluid
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D
Date: August 15, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Coolant Reimbursement Policy
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at
the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement
is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant
concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of
pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement
for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the
appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers
Important:
USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE
FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM
ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE
COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY.
Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products
that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not
been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1408
coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant.
Coolant Removal Services/Recycling
The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a
primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with
used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or
equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or
DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this
bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period.
DEX-COOL(R) Recycling
The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste
engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000
km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled
DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages.
This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be
expanded as demand increases.
Conventional (Green) Recycling
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1409
Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or
conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be
accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number
in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your
facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of
these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the
operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective
(GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer.
Sealing Tablets
Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item
after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs
have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over
the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a
small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be
recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage.
Water Quality
The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water.
DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service
interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor
quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you
use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R).
"Pink" DEX-COOL(R)
DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the
mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color
shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5
yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval.
Back Service
Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1410
Contamination
Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5
yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated
condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and
re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced
properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R).
After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant
exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems
with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same,
and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
Equipment (Coolant Exchangers)
The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant
exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be
used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They
can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling
system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature
facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over
repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows
venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available
through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program.
For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant
replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of
trapped air from the cooling system during refill.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1411
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Coolant - Information on Back Service
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No: 53-62-02
Date: November, 1995
Subject: DEX-COOL(TM) Engine Coolant - Information on Back service
Models: 1994-95 Passenger Cars and Trucks
A new extended-life engine coolant called DEX-COOL(TM) is currently being used in all General
Motors' vehicles (excluding Chevrolet Geo and Saturn). Refer to bulletin 53-62-01 for general
service information.
Backservice
DEX-COOL(TM) may be used in General Motors vehicles originally built with conventional (green)
coolant with the following considerations:
^ Vehicles eligible for back service are 1994 and 1995 models (excluding 1994 J Body with 4
cylinder engines).
^ The service interval for DEX-COOL(TM) introduced into an older model vehicle originally built
with "green" coolant will be 2 years/30,000 miles (50,000 Km) (not 5 years/100,000 miles (160,000
Km)).
^ All the "green" coolant must be removed from the cooling system by means of a system flush.
This may be accomplished with a water flushing device or a GMDE waterless coolant changer (use
a unit dedicated to "green" coolant, not DEX-COOL TM).
Important:
When using a GMDE waterless coolant changer, conduct the procedure twice, once with water,
and once with DEX-COOL(TM)
Backservice with DEX-COOL(TM) is advocated because of enhanced water pump seal durability
experienced with this coolant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1412
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Recycled Engine Coolant Policy
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration Bulletin No.: 310504 Date: February, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: RECYCLED ENGINE COOLANT POLICY
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: WARRANTY CLAIMS ADMINISTRATOR AND SERVICE MANAGER
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. For detailed information on GM approved
engine coolant recycling equipment guidelines refer to the following bulletins: Cadillac 93-1-18,
GMC Truck 93-6B-34, Chevrolet 93-73-6B, Pontiac 93-6-18, Oldsmobile 1-93-43, Buick 93-6B-1
(Corporate Number 236203).
Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the
appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial to
assure that only the relative amount of engine coolant concentrate be charged, not the total diluted
volume. In other words, if you are using two gallons of pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant
to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement for one gallon of Goodwrench engine coolant
concentrate at the dealer price plus the appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1413
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Coolant - Information on Propylene Glycol Usage
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 43-62-01B
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Propylene Glycol Engine Coolant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to reflect most current information on propylene glycol engine coolant.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 4362O1A (Group Reference 6 - Engine).
General Motors has been reviewing data supplied on the performance of propylene glycol engine
coolant in GM vehicles. It is our conclusion that propylene glycol engine coolant will perform
adequately under most vehicle operating conditions. As a result, propylene glycol engine coolant
(meeting performance specification GM 1825M) may be used in GM vehicles and will not affect the
warranty coverage.
Prior to adding propylene glycol engine coolant to the cooling system, all the existing (ethylene
glycol) coolant must be removed. This can be accomplished either by utilizing water-based coolant
flushing equipment or "waterless quick change" equipment available in the GMDE program. As with
any coolant change procedure, be sure to thoroughly purge the heater core and block as well as
the radiator before attempting to convert the system to propylene glycol coolant.
Freeze/Boil point levels are different for propylene glycol than for ethylene glycol engine coolant.
To accurately determine freeze/boil protection level, it is imperative that coolants not be mixed.
Removing all the used coolant as previously discussed resolves this concern. Freeze protection of
propylene glycol cannot be determined using a standard hydrometer. Rather, a refractometer or
test strip must be used.
Propylene glycol engine coolants may be recycled in the same manner as conventional ethylene
glycol coolant. No adverse effects will be encountered if these coolants are mixed prior to recycling,
however, the ratio of propylene glycol coolant to ethylene glycol coolant should be kept low to
minimize the effects on freeze point measurements.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1414
Coolant: Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Qts.
Less A/C ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 12.1 With A/C .............................................................
........................................................................................................................................................
12.1
Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. .....................................................................................................
............................................................................... 15 Thermo. Opening Temp., deg.F .....................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 195
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E
Date: April 07, 2011
Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Models:
2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008
HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION
2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo,
Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except
2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only
Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT
(MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra
Attention:
DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs
for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING
The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle
that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use
P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual
transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be
checked when servicing any of these components.
Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid.
Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations.
Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some
concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and
transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for
General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the
J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with
DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as
noted above).
DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair
or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use
in automatic transmissions/transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-VI ATF
General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle
production.
Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use
DEXRON(R)-VI.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1419
All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with
DEXRON(R)-VI fluid.
DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas:
* These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being.
2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing
Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the
machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1420
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1421
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1422
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Dexron IIE Preferred Fluid for All Hydra-matic
BULLETIN No.: 9274T60-E-02
CORP. REF. NO.: 177125
DATE: October 1991
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: All
TRANSMISSION MODELS: All
SUBJECT: Dexron(R)-IIE Automatic Transmission/Transaxle Fluid
VEHICLE APPLICATIONS: All Hydra-matic Automatic Transmissions/Transaxles
BULLETIN COVERS:
General Motors has developed a new service fill automatic transmission/transaxle fluid which is
designated DEXRON(R)-IIE. This fluid is the preferred fluid for all HYDRA-MATIC automatic
transmissions/transaxles and will eventually replace DEXRON(R)-II. DEXRON(R)-IIE is acceptable
for use whenever DEXRON(R)-II was previously specified. DEXRON(R)-II is acceptable for use
when DEXRON(R)-IIE is not available. DEXRON(R)-II and DEXRON(R)-IIE can be used in both
electronically and hydraulically controlled transmissions/ transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-IIE Advantages Over DEXRON(R)-II:
^ Has better anti-foaming characteristic.
^ Improved high temperature oxidation stability and improved low temperature flow characteristics
(low temperature viscosity).
^ DEXRON(R)-IIE and DEXRON(R)-II can be mixed in any ratio. No draining or flushing of system
is required.
^ DEXRON(R)-IIE is back serviceable to 1949 for all General Motors automatic
transmissions/transaxles.
^ No change in transmission/transaxle calibration or reduction in transmission/transaxle durability
will occur as a result of using DEXRON(R)-IIE.
SERVICE PART INFORMATION:
PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION
12345881 1 quart container
12345882 1 gallon container
12345883 55 gallon drum
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1423
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON III Fluid Introduction
File In Section: 0 - General Information
Bulletin No.: 57-02-01
Date: March, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 0 - General Information - DEXRON(R)-III Transmission Fluid Introduction
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors has phased in a new automatic transmission fluid, DEXRON(R)-III, that does not
need replacing under normal service. DEXRON(R)-III is designed to help the transmission deliver
the best possible performance under all conditions. Refer to Figure 1.
The improvements in DEXRON(R)-III include better friction stability, more high temperature
oxidation stability and better material compatibility. DEXRON(R)-III has the same low temperature
fluidity as DEXRON(R)-IIE, for better transmission performance in cold weather.
DEXRON(R)-IIE and DEXRON(R)-III are fully compatible.
DEXRON(R)-III is fully compatible with any General Motors passenger vehicle or light truck with
automatic transmission and built since 1949.
Dealers should require their supplier to include the DEXRON(R)-III license number on all automatic
transmission fluid invoices.
Starting February 1, 1994 DEXRON(R)-III was phased into all North American assembly plants.
DEXRON(R)-III fluid is available from GMSPO (see fluid numbers below):
U.S.
1 Quart 12346143
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1424
1 Gallon 12346144
55 Gallon 12346145
In Canada
1 Liter 10952622
4 Liter 10952623
200 Liter 10952624
The 1995 Automatic Transmission/Transaxle fluid change intervals are the following:
(1994 and prior should use the schedules as written in the Owner's Manual.)
If the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions:
In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90°F (32°C) or higher.
In hilly or mountainous terrain.
When doing frequent trailer towing.
Uses such as found in taxi, police car or delivery service.
Change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (63,000 km).
If the vehicle is not used mainly under any of these conditions, the fluid and filter do not require
periodic changing for vehicles under 8,600 GVWR.
Vehicles over 8,600 GVWR change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (83,000 km) regardless
of driving conditions.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
CAPACITIES .......................................................................................................................................
................................................................ QUARTS
Pan Capacity .......................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 5.0 Total (Overhaul) Capacity ...............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 11.2
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1427
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... Dexron IIE
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1428
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Fluid level should be checked at every engine oil change. Frequency of change for transmission
fluid is dependent on the type of driving conditions in which the vehicle is used. If the transmission
is subjected to severe service such as: use in heavy city traffic when the outside temperature
regularly reaches 90°F, use in very hilly or mountainous areas, commercial use such as taxi or
delivery service, the fluid should be changed every 15,000 miles when using Dexron II and 50,000
miles when using Dexron III or equivalent. Otherwise, change the fluid every 100,000 miles, using
Dexron II, III or equivalent automatic transmission fluid. When checking fluid, ensure vehicle is at
operating temperature (190°-200°F), which can be obtained by 15 miles of highway-type driving.
After transmission fluid is at operating temperature, use the following procedure to check fluid level:
1. Ensure vehicle is on a level surface, then move gear selector to the Park position. 2. Apply
parking brake and block wheels, then allow engine to run at idle speed for three minutes with
accessories off. 3. Check fluid level, color and condition.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Changing Fluid
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Changing Fluid
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Loosen two bolts attaching right side of transmission support to
frame rail. 3. Remove two bolts attaching left side transmission support to frame rail. 4. Using
suitable transmission jack, support and slightly raise transmission. 5. Slide transmission support
rearward enough to access rear oil pan attaching bolts. 6. Place drain pan under transmission oil
pan, loosen pan bolts on front of pan, pry carefully with screwdriver to loosen oil pan, and allow
fluid to
drain.
7. Remove remaining oil pan bolts, oil pan, and gasket. 8. Drain fluid from pan, then clean pan and
dry thoroughly with compressed air. 9. Remove oil filter to valve body bolt, then remove filter and
gasket, replace with new filter and gasket.
10. Install new gasket on oil pan, then oil pan and attaching bolts. Tighten attaching bolts to
specification. 11. Lower vehicle and add five quarts of automatic transmission fluid through filler
tube. 12. With selector lever in Park and parking brake applied, start engine and let idle. Do not
race engine. 13. Move selector lever through each gear range, then return lever to park. 14. Check
fluid, then add additional fluid to bring level between dimples on dipstick.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Changing Fluid > Page 1431
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Adding Fluid to A DRY Transmission
1. Add transmission fluid through filler tube until oil level is between the "ADD" and "HOT" marks on
dipstick. 2. Place selector lever in park, depress accelerator to place carburetor on fast idle cam,
and move selector lever through each range. Do not race
engine.
3. With selector lever in park, engine running at idle (1-3 minutes), and vehicle on level surface,
check fluid level and add additional fluid to bring
level between dimples on dipstick.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Fluid Capacity ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 6.0 Pts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1436
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission
Manual .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ [01]
[01] New Venture Gear 3500; synchromesh transmission fluid, G.M. P/N 12345349 or equivalent.
Borg Warner T5; DEXRON IIE automatic transmission fluid, G.M. P/N 12345881 or equivalent.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Drivetrain - Recommended Axle Lubricant
Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Recommended Axle Lubricant
File In Section: 0 - General Information
Bulletin No.: 76-02-02A
Date: October, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: Recommended Axle Lubricant
Models: 1999 and Prior Rear Wheel Drive Passenger Cars, Light and Medium Duty Trucks, and
Four Wheel Drive Vehicles
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1998 and 1999 Model Years and add Vehicle Line and
Recommended Axle Lubricant Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 76-02-02
(Section 0 - General Information).
The following tables provide the latest information on recommended axle lubricant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Drivetrain - Recommended Axle Lubricant > Page 1441
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Rear Axle Oil, Pints [05] ......................................................................................................................
............................................................................. 3.9
[05] Front drive axle, 2.6 pts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1444
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Front Axle
SAE 80W-90 GL5 Gear Lubricant. GM P/N 1052271
Locking Differential (G80)
This Article has been updated by TSB # 76-02-02A.
SAE 80W-90 GL5 Gear Lubricant, GM P/N 1052271. Do not use limited slip additive.
Non-Locking Differential
Rear Axle with Non Limited Slip or Non Locking Differentials
HD-3500 Trucks (Dana 11.0 axles)
Recommended Lubricant - GM P/N 12346140, SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Gear Lubricant.
1999 GMT 800 Trucks
Recommended Lubricant - GM P/N 12378261, SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant.
All other non limited-slip or non locking differentials including B and D cars, S/T, M/L, G, P, and C/K
trucks except GMT 800 trucks, and as noted above.
Recommended Lubricant - GM P/N 1052271 or an SAE 80W90 GL-5 Gear Lubricant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Fluid Capacity ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 2.5 Pts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1449
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
Lubricant Type .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... Dexron II E ATF *
* 1996 Models, Dexron III ATF
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001
Date: March 14, 2011
Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for
Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or
Complete Oil Change
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with
Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines
GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM)
specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
1(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification
Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General
Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The
oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains
acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be
used in those older vehicles.
In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine
oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil
specification are as follows:
- To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions.
- To promote long engine life.
- To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the
industry's overall dependence on crude oil.
dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the
following benefits:
- Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE)
requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits
throughout the life of the oil.
- More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1454
- Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life
has been depleted.
- Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil
specifications.
International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
GF-5 Standard
In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010.
- There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4
standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos
1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a
statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for
GF-4.
- It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard.
However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification.
- Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API
will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified
products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils.
Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy
Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than
doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed
CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet
these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than
ever before.
New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel
economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM).
The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when
determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy.
However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and
exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil.
Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower
viscosity oils.
dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs:
SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30.
Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the
Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being
serviced.
GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals
To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the
GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000
mile (4,830 km) recommendation.
The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the
GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle.
If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended,
GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually.
GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1455
The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos
(TM)specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
2(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification
- dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010
vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines.
Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting
specification CJ-4.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and
replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025.
- dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on
certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction
systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum
performance longer.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
TYPE....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................................SG, SH Note: 1992-93 Syclone, and Typhoon engine
oil must be Mobile 1 synthetic or equivalent
CAPACITY, Refill: 4-cyl. 2.5L...............................................................................................................
..............................................................................2.8 Liters 3.0 Quarts Others...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...3.8 Liters 4.0 Quarts Capacity shown is without filter. When replacing filter, additional oil may be
needed
1987-88 4.3L: Above 40°F (4°C)..........................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................30‡ Above 0°F to (-18°C)................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................10W-30* Below 60°F (16°C)..............................................................................................
..........................................................................................................5W-30
1987-88 others, 1988-94 except Syclone & Typhoon: Above 40°F (4°C)............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....30‡ Above 0°F to (-18°C)................................................................................................................
...................................................................................10W-30 All temperatures...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..........5W-30*
1992-93 Syclone, Typhoon: All temperatures......................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................10W-30
*Preferred, except V6 4.3L ‡May be used when other recommended viscosities are unavailable
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Power Steering Fluid: Customer Interest P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 1466
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 1467
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 1468
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 1474
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 1475
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 1476
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service
Center Locations
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 66-83-04A
Date: September, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: AC Delco Service Center Locations for Odometer/Speedometer Service
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (excluding Cadillac)
This bulletin is being revised to provide the necessary contact information only. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 66-83-04 (Section 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical)
General Motors provides service for sophisticated electronic products through the authorized AC
Delco Service Center Program. This program is designed to provide GM vehicle owners with the
highest quality and most technically up-to-date product available. Repair products from
unauthorized service outlets are not acceptable as warranty replacements.
Currently, there are 25 authorized AC Delco Service Centers who exchange and remanufacture
odometer/speedometers (list included). Only these Centers should be contacted for service.
Important:
W series and 1997 T series Medium Duty truck odometer/speedometers must be ordered directly
from GMSPO.
The following steps should be taken when utilizing the AC Delco Service Centers: Dealers should
contact their local AC Delco Service Center (list included). Any listed facility may be used.
The following information must be provided:
Part number VIN, Mileage, Vehicle Year, Make and Model Dealer Name and Address Delivery
Date of Vehicle Name of the person requesting exchange or service Phone number Repair Order
Number P.O. number (if non - warranty)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations > Page 1482
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations > Page 1483
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations > Page 1484
AC Delco Service Centers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 468304 > Oct > 94 > Speedometer - Momentary Drop
With Flashers On
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Speedometer - Momentary Drop With Flashers
On
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical Bulletin No.: 46-83-04 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Speedometer Momentary Drop when Turning on Park Lamps, Turn Signals or Hazard
Flashers (Send I/P Cluster to Delco Repair Station)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T
Pickup Models
Condition
Some speedometers in the above vehicles may momentarily drop when the turn signal, park lamp,
or hazard flasher is turned on. This condition often occurs at speeds over 60 miles per hour.
Cause
Slight system voltage drop when the extra load from the lights is added.
Correction
Remove the instrument cluster and send it to the local Delco Repair Station. Repair stations are
aware of the condition and have parts available to repair the cluster. They will add a capacitor to
the power circuit to assure a consistent power flow during power up of the above mentioned lamps.
Be sure to clearly describe the condition on the Delco Repair Order accompanying the cluster.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations > Page 1494
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations > Page 1495
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 668304A > Sep > 96 > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco
Service Center Locations > Page 1496
AC Delco Service Centers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 08-01-38-001 > Jan > 08 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant > Page
1514
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge
Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge
Equipment > Page 1519
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
Technical Service Bulletin # 431207E Date: 970101
A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-07E
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Guidelines for Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134a
Models: 1984-94 Passenger Cars and Trucks (See List Below)
This bulletin is being revised with the following changes:
1. Addition of all remaining GM vehicles, as listed.
2. Format rearranged for easier use.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-12-07D (Section 1 - HVAC).
Car/Truck Platform Coverage Starts:
1984 - A, B, D, E, F, J, K, P, Y Carlines
1985 - C, M, N, R, S Carlines
1986 - H Carline
1987 - L, V (Allante) Car lines; M/L, G, R/V, S/T, P Truck lines
1988 - T (LeMans), E (Reatta), W Car lines; C/k, MED. Duty Truck lines
1989 - Tracker
1990 - U Van
Vehicles Not Covered: T (Chevette and T1000), G RWD, C RWD, and X Car
If a vehicle is not covered in the list above, GM's recommendation is that the vehicle continue to be
serviced with R-12.
This bulletin outlines the detailed retrofit procedures, as well as providing background information
on many components and procedures. It is important to follow the bulletin, since each car and truck
line has unique parts and procedures. However, the basic procedure is simple, and will become
easier as you complete more retrofits.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1524
Retrofit Requirements
The customer should be reminded that there is NO requirement in the U.S. to retrofit any vehicle
produced with R-12. Vehicles built with R-12 can be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available
(except in certain Canadian Provinces). GM has taken steps to extend the supply of R-12 and
recommends that all R-12 vehicles continue to be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available.
Training Video
Before doing a retrofit the first time, it is recommended that you view the Certified Plus Training
Video, Program number 51010.15, "R-134a Retrofit for GM Cars and Trucks".
Table of Contents
A. Retrofit Procedure
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
2. Recover the R-12 (new method)
3. Install the service port conversion fittings
4. Install any additional parts needed
5. Evacuate and recharge with new PAG or V5 retrofit oil and R-134a
6. Install the retrofit label
Platform Details
Compressor Replacement Chart
B. General Information
1. Performance
2. Leakage
3. Desiccant
4. Improved Cooling Performance
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
6. Refrigerant Oil Level
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1525
C. Parts Information
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still in Warranty
2. Customer Paid' Retrofitting Costs
3. Labor Time Information
Notes on Retrofit
Important:
Before proceeding with any retrofit, make sure you have all component Parts required on hand to
perform a proper and complete repair with Minimal downtime.
R-12 Removal Prior to Retrofit
To prepare a system for retrofitting, the R-12 must be recovered and the system must be
completely evacuated. Evacuation is necessary to insure that small amounts of R-12 and air
remaining in the system are removed. This will prevent cross contamination of the two refrigerants,
which could lead to reduced A/C system reliability and performance.
It is very important that the specified times for waiting after recovery and evacuation not be
reduced. This time is required to sufficiently remove residual R-12 from the oil in the system.
A considerable amount of testing has determined that the following procedure is required to
achieve satisfactory results and conform to SAE J 1661:
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
Install the gauge set on the high and low side ports.
Use normal diagnostic procedures to find the cause of the vehicle's reported condition. One of
three conditions will exist with the refrigerant system:
a. System pressure correct, no leaks - proceed to Step 2 (Recovery). This would normally apply
when:
1. The system must be recovered/recharged for a repair to a system other than the A/C system, or
2. Where the A/C system condition did not involve leaks, but requires recovery/recharge to replace
a component.
b. Compressor not operating, but some charge. Leak test to find the leak, complete Step 2
(Recovery), then correct the leak before proceeding with Step 3 (Conversion port installation).
c. No charge in system - proceed with the Conversion port installation in Step 3. Use the ACR4 to
evacuate for 5 minutes. If the leak can be heard, repair the leak. If the leak cannot be heard,
charge with 1/2 pound of R-134a. Leak test with the J 39400 Leak Detector, recover the R-134a,
repair any additional leaks found, and proceed with the evacuation in Step 5.
2. Recover the R-12 from the System
Notice:
THIS PROCEDURE IS DIFFERENT THAN THE NORMAL (NON-RETROFIT) RECOVERY
PROCEDURE. R-12 will be recovered through the HIGH SIDE SERVICE PORT ONLY, WITH THE
ENGINE RUNNING. Recovery through the low side will not effectively remove the R-12 from the
accumulator, resulting in possible damage to the retrofitted system.
Important:
Vehicle must be above 50° F (10° C) to allow for complete recovery of the R-12. If it is not, either
allow it to warm up in the shop overnight, or increase the evacuation time in Step 5.a to 30 minutes.
a. Connect the recovery hose from the R-12 recovery cart (ACR3) to the middle port of the A/C
gauge set. Open the oil drain valve on the ACR3 cart long enough to drain the oil. Failure to do so
could cause excessive amounts of oil to build up in the separator, resulting in damage to the
recovery cart compressor.
b. Start the engine. Leave the hood up, and the windows open. On vehicles with manual A/C
controls, set the A/C controls to normal A/C mode, high blower, and temperature control to full cold.
On cars with automatic A/C controls, set the temperature to 75° F, "AUTO" mode, and manually
select high blower.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1526
Make sure the vehicle compressor is engaged. Turn the cart on and start the recovery cycle. OPEN
ONLY THE HIGH SIDE VALVE ON THE GAUGE SET. The vehicle system should eventually shut
the compressor off. If the low side pressure drops below 15 psi, and the compressor does not turn
off, turn it off now (go to "VENT" or "ECON" mode), but leave the engine running and the blower on
"high".
c. After the recovery cart shuts off the first time, wait 5 minutes. If the pressure on either the high or
the low side rises above 0 psi, restart the recovery process. After the second shutoff, wait 2
minutes. If the pressure again rises above 0 psi, restart, and after shutoff, again wait 2 minutes.
The process can be stopped when the pressure does not rise above 0 psi after 2 minutes. The
engine can be shut off at this time.
d. Remove the R-12 reclaim hose and the gauge set from the vehicle.
Any repairs needed should be done at this time. If any components other than the compressor are
replaced, they should be installed dry, and no extra oil should be added.
3. Install the Service Port Conversion Fittings
Important:
For GEO vehicles, skip to Step 4. Fitting installation is covered in that step. For vehicles that
require a HPCOS, see Step 4. Some of these vehicles use a specific combination fitting to mount
the HPCOS, which includes the high side service port fitting and the HPCOS port. The low side
fitting is installed as detailed below. See "Platform Details" for further information.
Important:
A new tool kit, P/N J 39500-250, has been released. This kit contains the following items:
^ J 39500-71 Oil Injection Bottle Conversion Kit (includes 3 12 oz bottles, an extender tube, caps,
and fittings)
^ J 39500-275 Tool kit, including the following: (See Figure 2)
- J 34611-A Double ended valve core remover
- J 25498-A High side adapter fitting
- J 38702 Deep valve core adapter fitting
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1527
- J 41265 Thread cleaning wire brush
- J 41266 Low side port thread restorer
- J 41267 High side port thread restorer
- J 39037 High side octagon socket
- J 41256 Low side octagon socket
New low profile, quick connect couplers, J 39500-20A (High side), and J 39500-24A (Low side),
have been released as essential tools, to attach to the ACR4 (see Figure 3). These are much
smaller couplers than the existing ones, and will allow attachment to the port fittings in much tighter
quarters.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1528
Select and install the proper R-134a fittings (shown in Figure 4) from the chart below, based on
how the ACR4 couplers will attach. Also, remember to check for proper hood clearance with the
conversion fittings. Try the straight fittings first. The two-piece high side fitting is used when the
existing fitting is screwed into the pipe fitting (some 1992, and nearly all 1993 models, use these
fittings). Use the 90° elbow if the straight fitting does not allow the ACR4 couplers to connect.
Fitting Type High Side Low Side
Straight 52467941 52467943
Straight Two-piece 52467324 N/A
90° Elbow 52469054 52469055
The fittings should be installed as follows:
a. Remove the caps from the R-12 fittings. Remove any dirt or grease from the port threads using
the thread cleaning wire brush, J 41265. Inspect the fittings for thread damage. If any damage is
found, use the port thread restorer (J 41266 low side, J 41267 high side) to repair the thread.
For the two-piece fitting, remove the existing R-12 fitting and discard it. Use tool J 38704A
(previously released, not part of the above kit) to remove the fitting. Make sure to hold the line
securely to prevent damage when removing the existing fitting. If the fitting cannot be removed
easily, use the saddle clamp valve listed below and seal the R-12 port and cap permanently.
b. Install the selected fitting onto the existing R-12 fitting. Leave the valve core in the straight
fittings, and remove the valve core when using the 90° fittings.
If the valve cores need to be removed at a later time, they can be removed with the straight
conversion fittings in place. On the low side straight fitting, use the J 34611-A tool to remove the
core pin in the conversion fitting, then remove the core valve from the original R-12 fitting. Always
recover the charge before valve core removal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1529
Use the octagon sockets on the straight fittings (J 39037 high side, and J 41256 low side). Torque
the new fitting until it seats. The fitting should seat fully BEFORE reaching 11 N.m (8 lb ft). If 11
N.m (8 lb ft) of torque is reached and the fitting has not seated, it is probable that the threads have
been damaged. In this case, remove the fitting and use the thread restorer listed above. Reinstall
the fitting, adding one drop of a thread locking compound such as Loctite(R) 242.
The fittings (except the two-piece) have a thread locking compound applied to the threads. This
compound will set up enough to restrict removal of the fitting in about 15 minutes. The fittings can
now be used to evacuate the system (see Step 5).
An additional type of conversion port fitting has been developed. This fitting is called a saddle
clamp valve (see Figure 5). It can be clamped directly on a metal refrigerant line, and will be used if
the existing fitting is damaged or is inaccessible. A drop of a thread locking compound, such as
Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt to prevent the threads from loosening.
The R134a saddle clamp valve part numbers are:
If an existing R-12 service port is not used, it must be rendered inoperative. Place several drops of
a thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 243, in the valve core, and onto the cap threads.
Secure the cap and let it set for 15 minutes.
4. Install Any Additional Parts Needed
See "Platform Details" after Step 6. If a vehicle is listed as a "Basic Retrofit", no additional parts are
required (except for compressors, see the Compressor Replacement Chart at the beginning of
Platform Details). If no parts are required, PROCEED TO STEP 5.
Compressors
Compressors do not need to be replaced as part of a normal retrofit, unless indicated in the
Compressor Replacement Chart. An R-12 compressor that is operating properly can, in most
cases, be left in the vehicle when it is retrofitted to R134a. However, if a compressor failure is the
reason the vehicle is in for service, and the vehicle will be retrofitted, OR if a vehicle has already
been retrofitted with R-134a and the compressor fails at some time in the future, new compressors
for use with R-134a are available. See the GMSPO Parts Catalog for specific part numbers. DO
NOT use a replacement R-12 compressor for any vehicle retrofitted to R-134a (unless it is the new
"oil-less" design). See "Compressor Availability" at the end of the Compressor Replacement Chart.
Accumulator /Dryer
If the vehicle is more than 5 years old, the Accumulator/Dryer (A/D) should be replaced to ensure
that moisture is removed from the system. See the instructions for proper A/D identification in
General Information.
High Pressure Cut-Off Switch (HPCOS)
Most trucks, and some 1984-93 B and D cars, require that a HPCOS be added to protect the
refrigerant system during long idles at high temperature. The HPCOS kit (P/N 15981985) contains
the switch, wire harness, heat sealing splice connectors, switch "0" ring, and installation
instructions. A saddle clamp adapter (P/N 15985307), or a special dual fitting, is mounted to the
high pressure line, and provides the port to mount the switch. A drop of a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1530
thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt of the saddle clamp
to prevent the threads from loosening.
Some vehicles produced during the second half of the 1993 model year will already have a factory
installed HPCOS. Check the back of the compressor for this switch. If present, the above switch
will not have to be added.
5. Evacuate the System, and Recharge with PAG or V5 Retrofit Oil and R-134a
Newly designed low profile quick connect couplers for the ACR4, J 39500-20A and J 39500-24A,
have been released. These should be installed before proceeding with the evacuation. See Step 3,
and Figure 3.
a. Connect the R-134a cart (ACR4) to the system. Open the coupler valves on the hoses so that
the pressures can be read on the gauges. On the cart, open the HIGH SIDE VALVE ONLY. DO
NOT OPEN THE LOW SIDE VALVE! Program the cart for a 15 minute evacuation.
Important:
If the vehicle has been at outside temperatures of less than 50° F (10° C), or at high altitudes
(above 3000 ft), use a 30 minute evacuation to insure complete removal of the R-12.
If the vacuum pump will not start and a "H-P" reading is indicated on the ACR4 display, loosen the
fitting at the high side line connection to the ACR4 to relieve pressure in the line. Tighten the fitting
after pressure has been relieved. DO NOT USE THE RECOVERY MODE TO RELIEVE LINE
PRESSURE.
b. Start the evacuation. For a proper evacuation, the cart must pull down to 28-29 in. Hg. at sea
level (reduce by 1 in. for each 1000 ft above sea level). Check the low side gauge for proper
vacuum level, to make sure the new fittings are operating properly.
While the evacuation is being done, the Retrofit label can be filled out and installed (see Step 6).
Important:
If the compressor was replaced at the same time as this retrofit, and the new compressor was
shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil already in it, DO NOT add any additional oil to the
system! Go to Step D. If an "oil-less" compressor was installed, add oil in Step C.
A new retrofit oil for use with V5 compressor vehicles has been released. This oil will be used
ONLY for retrofitted vehicles in which the original V5 compressor is retained. IT WILL NOT BE
USED IF A COMPRESSOR IS REPLACED AT THE TIME OF THE RETROFIT. Failure to use this
oil may significantly shorten the useful life of the compressor.
Important:
If the V5 Retrofit oil is not available from GMSPO, the compressor MUST BE REPLACED!
To summarize the correct retrofit oil usage:
^ Compressor replaced during retrofit
- NO OIL ADDED if new compressor shipped with oil
- 8 oz. of PAG oil (9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor) added if compressor shipped without oil
("oil-less" design)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1531
^ PAG oil used for future service if needed (mark PAG on box on label, Figure 6).
^ HR6 or R4 original compressor RETAINED - add 8 oz FAG oil to system
^ V5 original compressor RETAINED - add 9 oz V5 Retrofit oil to system. If V5 Retrofit oil is not
available from GMSPO, REPLACE THE COMPRESSOR.
c. Based on the above chart, add oil if needed. Use the new oil bottle and the extended tube kit, J
39500-71. Fill the bottle with at least 10 oz of oil. Attach the new bottle to the back of the ACR4,
and open the oil fill valve. Allow the correct amount of oil to be drawn into the system. DO NOT
allow the oil level to drop below the end of the pickup tube. This will prevent any air from being
drawn into the system. If any oil was removed during the R-12 recovery evacuation steps, DO NOT
add additional oil to replace it.
d. Determine the correct amount of R-134a to use. Check the existing label of the vehicle for the
R-12 charge amount.
Use the formula {(R12 x .9) - .25 lb = R-134a} to determine the correct charge. This can also be
stated as: Take 90% of the R12 charge, and subtract 1/4 lb.
Follow the directions for the ACR4 cart to recharge the system. At the end of the process, "CPL"
will be displayed. Close the high side valve.
e. Start the vehicle, turn on the A/C system, and confirm that pressures are within normal operating
ranges, as shown in the 1994 Service Manual. The 1994 Service Manuals can be used as a
reference for diagnosis and specification of retrofitted systems.
On some vehicles with automatic A/C controls or low charge diagnostics, the A/C compressor may
not engage if any diagnostic codes were set during the retrofit. Check to see if any codes were set
in either the HVAC or Engine Control systems. If they were, clear the codes following the directions
in the Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1532
f. TO INSURE AN ACCURATE CHARGE AMOUNT, IT IS IMPORTANT TO CLEAR THE ACR4 OF
ANY REMAINING REFRIGERANT. Close the high side coupler valve and remove the high side
hose from the vehicle. Then, open both the high and low side valves on the ACR4. After the
pressures on both gages are at low side pressure, close the low side coupler valve. See Step G
below, then remove the low side hose from the vehicle. Shut off the engine. Install the service port
caps on the new fittings. These serve as a seal and can prevent system leaks.
g. In the unlikely event that the low side fitting leaks when the coupler is removed, use the following
procedure:
1. Immediately reinstall the coupler on the fitting.
2. Find the valve core remover J 34611-A.
3. Remove the coupler.
4. Use the double-ended valve core remover to turn the valve core pin counter-clockwise until the
leak stops.
5. Install the cap.
If the leak was substantial or continued for an extended period of time, it is highly recommended to
evacuate and recharge the system to insure proper performance. If there is any question, the
system can be rechecked by repeating Step F.
h. Leak test any new port fittings, adapters, or valves that were installed, and any joints that were
opened or repaired during the retrofit process, using tool J 39400.
6. Install the Retrofit Label
The retrofit label (P/N 21030857, roll of 250) has been developed following SAF specifications to
insure a smooth transition from R-12 to R-134a, and to insure a professional approach to the
retrofit and a quality repair. Following the instructions in this bulletin will insure that the retrofit
meets the SAE standards.
Fill in the new label using a typewriter or a ball-point pen (see Figure 6). Select a location for the
label that will be easily visible. Some suggested areas are the radiator support panel, an area near
the existing R-12 charge label, or a flat surface near the high or low side service ports. The area
selected should be a clean, underhood, painted sheet metal surface, and should be degreased and
wiped down with a non-petroleum based cleaner. Do not install the label on a rubber surface. Apply
the label, then apply the clear overlay to the label.
Do not remove, cover, or render unreadable the existing R-12 charge label. DO cover the R-12
refrigerant charge amount on the existing label with an indelible, preferably black, marker.
Platform Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1533
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1534
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1535
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1536
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1537
FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT GEO, see the "Compressor Replacement Chart" at the end of this
section. Compressor replacement requirements ARE NOT LISTED in the platform details (except
for application details), except as noted below for Y car and P and Medium Duty truck.
Compressor Replacement Chart
Important:
It is important to check the date code on the compressor. Any vehicle may have had a compressor
replaced either during or after the warranty period. The date code will determine whether or not the
compressor must be replaced.
Compressor Availability
A new compressor for use with R-134a systems will be shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil
installed (see "IMPORTANT" below). Do not add any additional oil in Step 5 of the retrofit
procedure if a compressor is to be replaced with a new R-134a compressor at the same time the
initial retrofit is
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1538
being done.
Important:
During 1996, "oil-less" compressors began to be serviced with NO added oil. New part numbers
will be issued, and both the box and the compressor will be clearly marked to indicate that no oil is
present. If you receive one of these newer compressors, simply add the normal amount of oil to the
system in Step 5 of the retrofit procedure (8 oz of PAG oil, or 9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor).
These "oil-less" compressors are compatible with EITHER R12 or R-134a.
Geo Models
Compressors DO NOT HAVE TO BE REPLACED as part of the retrofit. New compressors are
shipped with enough oil to accommodate the entire A/C system. Do not add additional PAG oil to
the system it the compressor is being replaced.
1985-88 Nova, 1989-93 Prizm (S)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Loosen evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe (to be reinstalled)
c. 1985-92 only: Loosen compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe (to be reinstalled).
d. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor (to be installed).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor using new 0-rings. Six small
0-rings and one large 0-ring are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe 0-ring.
e. 1985-92 Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
R-134a amount: 85-92 - 650 grams (1.43 lb)
93 - 700 grams (1.54 lb) PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz) Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-88 - 94855761
89-93 - 94855762
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 94855760
High Side - 94855759
0-Rings:
85-88 Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required) - 94857336 - Large 0-ring - 94857337
85-93 Receiver/Dryer (2) - 94845949
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1539
85-93 Suction hose - 94855765
85-92 Discharge hose - 94845943
1985-88 Sprint, 1989-93 Metro (M)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 500 grams (1.10 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-86 - 91172081
87-88 - 91172079
89-93 - 96068480
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 91172092
85-88 - High Side - 91172094
89-93 - High Side - 52467941
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required)
- 91172095
- Large 0-ring - 96068915
Receiver/Dryer (2) - 96068488
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1540
89-93 - Suction hose - 96068490
89-93 - Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose:
85-86 - 91172086
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172087
87-88 - 91172088
89-93 - w/turbo - 96069121 - w/o turbo
- 91172089
Discharge hose:
85-86 - 91172082
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172083
87-88 - 91172084
89-93 - 96069024
1989-93 Tracker
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the Retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 550 grams (1.21 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer - 91172080
Adapter, Low Side - 91172092
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1541
Adapter, High Side - 91172093
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small (6) - 91172095 Large - 96068915
Receiver/dryer (2) - 96068488
Suction hose - 96068490
Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose - 91172091
Discharge hose - 91172085
1985-89 Spectrum and 1990-93 Storm (R)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Condenser (Storm) or radiator grille (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
b. Triple switch (Storm) or dual pressure switch (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
c. Receiver/dryer.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
e. Check valve from high side service valve (discard).
f. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High side adapter fitting (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation instructions).
Low Side - Part of suction hose
c. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-rings.
d. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
e. Triple switch or dual switch, and new 0-ring.
f. Condenser or radiator grille.
R-134a amount: 91 - 500 grams (1.10 lb)
92-93 - 600 grams (1.32 lb)
PAG oil amount: 150 cc (4.50 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-89 - 97104795
90-91 - 97104797
92-93 - 97104798
Adapter, High Side:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1542
85-89 - 97104794
90-93 - 97104793
Adapter, Low Side: Part of Hose Asm.
0-rings:
Receiver/dryer 85-91 - 94154048
92-93 - 94461700
Switch/pipe - 94461902
Suction hose:
85-86: 1.5L - 97104799; 1.6L - 97104800
90-93: 1.6L - 97104801; 1.8L - 97104803
B. General Information
Several items affecting the performance and durability of the system should be considered:
1. Performance
When performed properly, the retrofit from R-12 to R-134a will have minimal effect on the system's
performance in most climatic conditions found in the United States and Canada.
2. Leakage
Experience has shown that most leakage in an A/C system is due to leaks at the joints, or through
a small leak in a hose, usually at the coupling. The R-134a molecules are smaller than R-12, and a
small leak may result in a faster loss of refrigerant with R-134a. Because of this, it is very important
to leak check all vehicles using the J 39400 leak detector, BEFORE the retrofit is performed, and
repair any leaks found.
"0" rings and hoses used in most GM vehicles are compatible with R-134a and do not need
replacement during a retrofit. "0" rings or hoses installed in previous repairs may have been of
non-compatible materials if GM parts were not used and will be more likely to deteriorate and leak
than the original equipment materials. All "0" rings and hoses available through GMSP0 are
compatible with R-134a. Remember that the normal policy is to replace the "0" rings whenever a
joint is opened for any reason.
3. Desiccant
You may have heard that the currently used desiccant in the accumulator is not compatible with
R-134a. Extensive testing has shown that it is, in fact, suitable for use with R-134a, once it has
been in service in an R-12 system. The accumulator in these models will not have to be changed
during the retrofit procedure, unless the vehicle is more than 5 years old. Vehicles more than 5
years old should have the A/D replaced to add new desiccant for proper system drying.
In the event that an accumulator/dryer (A/D) needs to be replaced on a retrofitted system in the
future, only A/D's with XH-7 desiccant should be used. The service parts for the 1993 vehicles
contain only XH-7 desiccant. The parts for the 1992 and older vehicles may contain either XH-5 or
XH-7. Parts containing XH-7 can be identified (see Figure 1) by 1) an "A" printed on the top of the
A/D; or 2) if there is a label on top of the A/D, there will be a square with an "A" inside; or 3) if there
is a time code and date printed on top of the A/D just under the "Harrison" logo, the A/D contains
XH-7. A/D's containing XH-5 can still be used on R-12 vehicles.
4. Improved Cooling Performance
There have been service bulletins issued in the past with information improving the cooling
performance of existing R-12 systems. These bulletins can also be used to improve the
performance of retrofitted vehicles in high ambient temperature climates.
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
Contrary to information published to date outside of General Motors, mineral oil and PAG or V5 oil
ARE chemically compatible. The mineral oil left in the system after reclaiming the R-12 can remain
in the system with no harmful effects. However, the mineral oil will not mix with the R-134a, and so
will not circulate and perform its lubricating function. Testing has shown that most of the mineral oil
will eventually collect in the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1543
accumulator. The system will operate properly as long as refrigerant charge amounts are strictly
adhered to.
6. Refrigerant Charge Level
The retrofit R-134a charge level is more critical than with R-12 systems. Overcharging may push
the mineral oil out of the AID, and cause it to circulate as a liquid. This is more likely to result in
compressor damage. Undercharging may lead to loss of performance. It is very important to clear
the hoses during the charging operation, to insure that all the refrigerant is delivered to the vehicle
A/C system. This is covered in Step 6D of the Retrofit Procedure.
C. Parts Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1544
Important:
All of the following parts are NOT NEEDED for a normal retrofit. Follow the bulletin procedures to
determine which parts you need! Individual vehicle kits are not necessary, since most of the parts
are generic and only a few parts are needed for most vehicles.
GEO Parts are listed in "Platform Details."
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still Within the Original New Vehicle Limited Warranty Period
When GM models for the years listed in the bulletin require repairs to the refrigerant system and
the vehicles are still covered under the New
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1545
Vehicle Limited Warranty, dealers are instructed to proceed as follows:
Important:
On vehicles equipped with A/C systems NOT produced by GM (i.e., rear A/C systems in van
conversions), consult the manufacturer of that A/C system for retrofit guidelines.
^ Offer the customer the option of repairing and recharging the system with R12, or retrofitting after
repair and recharging with R-134a at no additional charge.
^ Provide the owner with, and review the information contained in, the "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant" brochure. (Brochure, Form GM-0011, can be
ordered free of charge from GM Fulfillment HQ, Phone 1-800-269-5100).
^ Record the customer's choice on the repair order and, as with all properly completed repair
orders, ask the customer to sign on the appropriate line acknowledging the repairs requested.
^ Under no circumstances should the retrofit to R-134a be performed unless the customer has had
the option explained prior to repair. Once the vehicle has been retrofitted to R-134a, a significant
expenditure would be incurred to go back to R-12, in the event the customer has changed his/her
mind.
THIS OFFER APPLIES ONLY TO VEHICLES REQUIRING A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
REPAIRS UNDER THE TERMS OF THE NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY. It is not a special
policy, and any existing deductibles still apply. This is simply an option being offered to the
customer during the warranty period at this time. GM reserves the right to terminate this offer at
any time.
If the R-12 refrigerant system does not require discharging for a warranty repair, but the customer
requests a retrofit to R-134a, the retrofit WOULD BE PERFORMED AT THE CUSTOMER'S
EXPENSE, EVEN DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD.
2. Customer Paid Retrofitting Costs
If the customer requests a retrofit to R-134a, for a specific vehicle whose retrofit parts and
procedures have been released in this bulletin, the customer would be expected to pay the costs to
retrofit under the following conditions:
^ The vehicle is no longer covered by the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
^ The vehicle is covered by warranty, but the repair covered under the warranty does not require
evacuating and recharging the refrigerant system.
3. Labor Time Information
For Vehicles Repaired Under Warranty: Use existing labor operations for correcting the original
condition. The quantity of R-134a used should be charged to the normal labor operation (not
D4500), just as if it were R-12.
Use D4500, 0.3 HR., to charge for parts and labor, for all of the following items:
^ Additional time for recovery of R-12 to meet SAE standards;
^ Install high and low side service port converter fittings;
^ Add PAG or V5 retrofit oil;
^ Complete label information and install.
Add 0.2 hours to D4500 for installation of the HPCOS.
Use T5321, 0.3 HR., for the Pontiac Bonneville hood seal installation.
ANY PARTS OR LABOR TIME OTHER THAN THOSE LISTED ABOVE SHOULD BE CHARGED
TO THE REGULAR LABOR OPERATION CORRESPONDING TO THE ORIGINAL CONDITION
THAT 1S BEING REPAIRED.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 631209 Date: 960501
A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 63-12-09
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Issues for Vehicles with R12 or R134a Air Conditioning Systems
Models: 1988-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
R12 Service Recommendations
As you know, production of R12 refrigerant ceased on December 31, 1995. Although R12 will no
longer be manufactured, there is a reserve supply of R12 available. This reserve, along with strict
A/C repair service adherence to proper refrigerant recycling procedures, should assure continued
availability to meet consumers' needs.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 A/C systems as long as
it is available. If R12 is no longer available or affordable, a system retrofit utilizing R134a is
recommended. R134a IS THE ONLY SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT RECOMMENDED BY GM
FOR USE IN GM VEHICLE A/C SYSTEMS, AND THEN ONLY AFTER FOLLOWING THE
PROPER RETROFIT PROCEDURES FOR THE SPECIFIC MODEL. All new vehicle
manufacturers have chosen R134a for retrofit. One of the key reasons is to protect both the service
industry and consumers from the high costs that would result from purchasing equipment
necessary to service multiple refrigerants. This position also reduces the threat of recycled
refrigerant contamination.
GM currently offers a simple, low cost R12 to R134a retrofit on many of its late model, front wheel
drive passenger cars. Dealers should discuss this capability with owners of these specific models,
listed in Retrofit Corporate Bulletin # 43-12-07D, whenever a repair to the A/C refrigerant system is
required. Early retrofit of these specific models will aid in prolonging availability of the R12 supply
and provide dealer service technicians the opportunity to become more familiar with the proper
procedures for performing a retrofit.
Remember - R12 and R134a refrigerant are not interchangeable! They cannot be mixed together.
In fact, despite the claims of some refrigerant manufacturers, no proposed R12 refrigerant
substitute can be added to, mixed with or used to "top off" an R12 system. Under provisions of law
covering the service of refrigerants, mixing dissimilar refrigerant products during service is
prohibited.
To Summarize GM R12 Service Policy
1. Service R12 vehicles with good quality new or recycled R12 as long as it is available.
2. Purchase R12 from a reliable supplier. GMSPO has a supply of high quality R12 available.
Dealers are requested to use only R12 supplied by GMSPO for warranty repairs. This high quality
refrigerant will insure system performance and avoid the possibility of introducing contaminated
material into the customer's A/C system.
3. Carefully test recovered R12 using the PureGuard monitor. On recovery equipment not
protected by the PureGuard, always test the recovery cylinder prior to recharging a vehicle A/C
system.
4. Discuss the R12 to R134a retrofit option with owners of GM vehicles listed in Retrofit Corporate
Bulletin # 43-12-07D. Provide owner with a copy of the pamphlet "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant".
5. Become familiar with retrofit procedures and exercise care in the handling of dissimilar
refrigerants to prevent contamination.
R134A Service Recommendations
When servicing a previously retrofitted vehicle, there is concern that if all of the R12 is not
completely removed prior to the retrofit procedure, it could contaminate your R134a equipment and
recovery tank when a subsequent A/C repair is performed. Although the number of retrofits being
performed today is minimal, the volume will increase as R12 prices rise.
GM Service Technology Group is in the process of field testing a new R134a refrigerant purity
tester similar to the PureGuard R12 refrigerant tester you now use. This new tool will mount to your
ACR4 R134a Recovery Recycle and Recharge cart and sample all R134a refrigerant prior to
recovery. It is expected that testing of this tool will be completed this year.
This new tool, the Pureguard 2, will also test vehicles and your recycle tank for air contamination,
which is threatening A/C system performance. High levels of air have been found in the recovery
tanks on a number of R12 and R134a recovery carts. Air contamination is caused by improper
recovery
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations >
Page 1550
procedures and short-cutting refrigerant recycling times. Use the following procedure for testing
and correcting air contamination in your A/C service equipment.
1. Make certain that the ACR4 equipment has not been used for at least 12 hours. It is
recommended that the equipment be left in an area where the temperature will remain constant
overnight to allow the temperature of the refrigerant in the tank to stabilize.
2. Record the surrounding air temperature next to the ACR4 refrigerant tank.
Important:
A major assumption is that the ambient air temperature next to the tank represents the refrigerant
temperature in the tank. Failure to take care in measuring the temperature could result in
unnecessary work.
3. Close both liquid (blue) and vapor (red) valves on the ACR4 tank.
4. Disconnect low side (blue) service hose from the back of the ACR4.
5. Slowly disconnect the tank vapor hose (red) from the back of the ACR4 and connect it to the low
side service port.
6. Open the vapor (red) valve on the tank and record the tank pressure on the low side gage.
7. Restore hoses to the original position.
8. Referring to the Table, find the ambient temperature measured in Step 2. Compare the pressure
reading from Step 6 to the "maximum allowable pressure". If the pressure reading from Step 6 is
less than the "maximum allowable pressure", no further action is necessary.
Important:
The closer the tank pressure is to the desired tank pressure, the better the A/C system will perform.
9. If the pressure reading from Step 6 exceeds the maximum allowable pressure from the Table,
open both tank valves and operate the ACR4 through 4 or 5 evacuation cycles. This will activate
the automatic air purge to lower the tank pressure.
Important:
Station should not be connected to vehicle.
10. Repeat the tank pressure checking procedure the next day to determine if the pressure has
been reduced to acceptable levels. If the tank pressure has been reduced but is not acceptable,
cycle with ACR4 through more evacuation cycles and recheck the next day. Continue process until
acceptable pressure is obtained. If the tank pressure is not reduced through the evacuation cycling,
then Kent-Moore should be contacted at 1-800-345-2233.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
FILE IN SECTION: 1 - HVAC
BULLETIN NO.: 53-12-05
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Contaminated R12 Refrigerant Testing and Handling
MODELS: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 A/C Systems
The J 39851 "PureGuard" R12 refrigerant monitor was recently shipped to all GM dealers as an
essential tool to test R12 refrigerant. Dealers are strongly urged to install this protective device on
their ACR3 or other R12 recovery equipment immediately. The PureGuard is easily installed on any
recovery cart (20 minutes), requires no recovery cart modifications, is fully automatic (no training
required) and does not increase the time required to perform normal A/C service procedures.
Proper use of this tool can:
^ Prevent damage to your R12 recovery/recycling equipment.
^ Prevent contamination of previously recovered R12 in the recovery tank.
^ Prevent loss of your recovered R12 as contaminated refrigerant will activate automatic air purge
system.
^ Prevent the spread of contaminated R12 to other vehicles you service.
If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery stations which are not protected, use the PureGuard
to check the refrigerant in these recovery tanks for contamination at least once each week. Simply
connect the PureGuard blue service hose (that would normally be connected to the vehicle low
side service port) to the red or vapor side of any recovery cart tank and run the test. It is also
important to check a tank containing recovered/recycled material for purity before installation on
your charging equipment. Even new R12 refrigerant purchased from sources other than GM should
be tested for contamination prior to use.
Sources of Contaminated R12 Refrigerant
Since refrigerant testing has not been a standard practice in the mobile A/C repair industry, the
amount of R12 refrigerant contamination is unknown. As R12 prices rise and supplies are depleted,
it is anticipated that contaminated R12 refrigerant may become more prevalent from the following
as well as other sources:
^ The use of R12 refrigerant substitutes without installation of unique service fittings and proper
identification labeling.
^ Improper use of R12 substitutes, such as topping off R12 systems with R134a or other
refrigerants available to "do-it-yourselfers".
^ Poor quality or contaminated new or reprocessed R12 refrigerant.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 as long as it is available.
Combining any refrigerant with R12 results in a refrigerant mixture which cannot be used in an A/C
system.
R134a is the only substitute refrigerant approved by GM and should only be used when the
appropriate retrofit service bulletin procedures are explicitly followed. Use of any other substitute
refrigerant requires the purchase of additional dedicated recovery, recycling (if applicable) and
charging equipment to service each substitute refrigerant used.
However, you should know that the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has listed several
products as acceptable replacements for R12 mobile A/C systems under the Significant New
Alternatives Policy (SNAP). Some of these products are: R134a, R401c (a DuPont refrigerant
blend) and FRIGC (another refrigerant blend). It is important to understand that the SNAP program
only considers the health, safety and environmental characteristics of a chemical. It does not test
for A/C system cooling performance or durability. That judgment is deferred to the vehicle
manufacturer. Use of any R12 refrigerant substitute without dedicated service equipment, unique
fittings, labels and refrigerant testing prior to recovery, could result in contamination of the R12
supply and the loss of the R12 recycling program.
What To Do When Contamination is Detected
Repeat the test to verify contaminated refrigerant is present. Clear the PureGuard following the
instructions listed on the face panel, then perform a second test to verify that the vehicle A/C
system contains contaminated or mixed refrigerant.
Contact the vehicle owner to advise that previous A/C system repairs were apparently performed
with an R12 refrigerant substitute. Suggest the owner
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling >
Page 1555
contact or return to the previous repair facility. Explain that environmental regulations prohibit repair
facilities from discharging ozone depleting A/C refrigerants into the atmosphere. Explain that
recovery of this unknown refrigerant could damage your service equipment.
If the customer wishes to pursue repairs through your facility, it is recommended that the proper
A/C service equipment be purchased. General Motors recommends the Kent-Moore J 41428
"Scavenger", an air operated refrigerant recovery station, be used to remove unknown refrigerants.
The air operated feature reduces the hazard of recovering potentially flammable refrigerants.
Dealers should evaluate the need to purchase the equipment based on the number of
contaminated vehicles they encounter.
As an alternative to the initial purchase of a recovery only station, dealers should check locally for
A/C specialty shops which may have the equipment to service substitute or contaminated
refrigerants. They may be able to provide contaminated refrigerant recovery service to the dealer.
The GM Service Technology Group has tested a recovery procedure where a 15 or 30 pound DOT
approved refillable tank is fully evacuated then connected to a vehicle A/C system to recover the
charge. Testing has shown that even when the recovery tank is cooled down in dry ice, the
procedure does not guarantee the entire charge will be recovered. Since EPA regulations require
full recovery of ozone depleting substances, GM does not recommend this procedure.
Contaminated Refrigerant Disposal
Although A/C refrigerant testing and disposal have not been a service practice in the mobile A/C
industry, It has been common in the stationary A/C service industry for many years. Listed at the
end of this bulletin are companies that provide refrigerant disposal service for the stationary A/C
industry. Please be advised that GM has not independently evaluated these companies and is not
in any way endorsing or promoting the use of these companies. Each of these companies has
expressed an interest in providing refrigerant disposal service to GM dealers.
In working with the stationary A/C industry, these companies typically receive large volumes of
different refrigerants that have been mixed together. Unfortunately, because the volume of material
returned by the mobile A/C industry will be in much smaller quantities, the cost of handling will be
greater.
To arrange for return of the refrigerant, simply call the company nearest you using the phone
number listed below. The company will advise you on billing and shipping procedures. Disposal
cost will vary between $3.00 and $5.00 per pound plus freight and handling. Shipping charges will
vary by distance and location. In general, a 7 to 10 day turn-around time on the tank can be
expected. The tank can be shipped via common carrier. Documents that your refrigerant has been
properly disposed of will be sent to you with the return of your tank.
As an alternative, many dealerships already have contracts in place with a disposal company who
manages their hazardous wastes. In these cases, the disposal service may agree to handle
containers of mixed refrigerants. Initially, the local disposal companies may be surprised by this
inquiry. They may want to evaluate how much material will be collected before deciding whether to
provide this service.
As we move forward with the practice of testing R12 refrigerant, it will take time for all the questions
to be answered. STG will provide additional information as soon as it is available.
Understanding The PureGuard
The PureGuard is a highly sensitive instrument capable of detecting R12 with 3% or less
cross-contamination with other refrigerants. Any refrigerant mixture in excess of this amount poses
a threat to both your refrigerant supply and recovery equipment. The PureGuard uses a pass/fail
approach when monitoring the refrigerant and is precisely calibrated to cut power to the recovery
machine if it encounters R12 mixed with any substitute refrigerants. The PureGuard ignores the
presence of the air, dyes or oils in the refrigerant sampled.
At least 20 psi must be present in the vehicle's A/C system for the PureGuard to function.
Otherwise, refrigerant cannot be introduced to the PureGuard's test chamber. If a vehicle's A/C
system contains less than 20 psi, it is an indication that the vehicle's system is nearly depleted of
refrigerant.
Occasionally, erratic PureGuard operation or service code 002 display will be encountered when
A/C system pressure is exactly 20 psi. If this occurs, simply cycle the on/off switch to reset the
PureGuard. After the 30 second PureGuard warm-up cycle, proceed immediately with vehicle
recovery operation.
Feedback from the field has indicated PureGuard service code 002 will also be displayed if the oil
drain port is not sealed. Make sure the "0" ring seal in the cap is in place and that the cap is tight.
If the PureGuard fails to clear or if you experience any other problems operating the PureGuard,
contact Kent-Moore Technical Service at 1-800-345-2233. The unit should not be returned without
first contacting Kent-Moore to obtain return authorization.
Refrigerant Disposal Locations:
United States Refrigerant Reclamation Inc. 12420 North Green River Rd. Evansville, IN 47711
800-207-5931, FAX - 812-867-1463
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling >
Page 1556
Omega Refrigerant Reclamation 5263 North Fourth St. Irwindale, CA 91706 310-698-0991, FAX 310-696-1908
Refrigerant Management Svcs of Georgia 216 F. Atlanta Hwy. Cumming, GA 30130 Ph/FAX 800-347-5872
Refrigerant Reclaim Inc. 122 Old Stage Coach Rd. Dumfries, VA 22026 800-238-5902, FAX 703-441-0393
Gartech Refrigerant Reclamation Ctr. 2002 Platinum Garland, TX 75042 214-272-4070, FAX 214-272-8548
National Refrigerants, Inc. 11401 Roosevelt Blvd. Philadelphia, PA 19154 215-698-6620, FAX 215-602-8205
CFC Reclamation 1321 Swift North Kansas City, MO 64116 816-471-2511
Full Cycle-Global 550 James Street Lakewood, NJ 08701 908-370-3400, FAX - 908-370-3088
Refrigerant Reclaim Svcs, Inc. dba Full Cycle-Global 121 S. Norwood Drive Ft. Worth, TX
76053-7807 817-282-0022, FAX - 800-831-6182
Full Cycle-Global 2055 Silber, Ste. 109 Houston, TX 77055 713-681-7370, FAX - 713-681-9947
Full Cycle-Global 343 South Airline Hwy. Gonzales, LA 70737 504-644-5303, FAX - 504-644-1809
Full Cycle-Global 2966 Wireton Blue Island, IL 60406 708-388-8551, FAX - 708-388-8550
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-15
Date: November, 1994
Subject: R134a Leak Detection with Tracer Dye
Models: All 1993-95 Vehicles with OEM R134a Systems All R12 Vehicles Retrofitted to R134a
Systems
R134a refrigerant is uniquely different from R12 refrigerant and requires some changes in the
repair methods, tools and materials used in A/C service. Two important differences between R134a
and R12 which affect the technicians ability to locate refrigerant leaks are:
1. The R134a molecule is smaller than the R12 molecule and therefore will leak through smaller
openings. For the same size opening the smaller R134a molecule will leak out faster than the R12.
2. R134a refrigerant does not contain chlorine which the older R12 electronic leak detectors found
very easy to identify. Many of today's electronic leak detectors have difficulty locating small R134a
refrigerant leaks.
In order to insure the highest quality in A/C system service, the J 39400 electronic leak detector
was released as an essential tool for all GM dealers. This is the only refrigerant leak detector
approved by GM for service on R134a vehicles. If maintained properly (Reference Bulletin No.
431218) and used in accordance with Service Manual procedures, the J 39400 will provide the
most accurate and efficient method of locating R134a refrigerant leaks under most conditions.
If the technician cannot find the leak with the J 39400 and the system is known to have lost charge,
a new fluorescent leak tracer dye Kent-Moore* P/N J 41447, has been released that mixes with the
R134a PAG oil. This dye is detectable through the use of an ultraviolet (black) light and glows
yellow/green at the leak location (similar to using dye in engine leak detection). J 41447 IS THE
ONLY APPROVED DYE BY GENERAL MOTORS. Not all R134a dyes are compatible with GM's
PAG oil. Some dyes decrease the oil viscosity or chemically react with the oil. Use of alternate
products may affect system reliability and cause premature compressor failure.
Note:
THIS DYE IS NOT TO BE USED IN R-12 SYSTEMS.
Unlike mineral oil, the R134a PAG oil has special properties the technician should keep in mind.
1. PAG oil is water soluble and traces of PAG oil found at leaking joints are subject to "washing
out". Condensation on refrigerant lines or the evaporator core may wash the PAG oil and leak dye
off the line or off the core and out the condensate drain. This can make some leaks harder to find
using the dye detector. Fluorescence at the drain opening would indicate a core leak.
2. Use of the R134a tracer dye requires time. Depending upon the leak rate, it may take between
15 minutes and 7 days for the leak to become visible.
3. The dye, mixed with the PAG oil, is retained in the system and is detectable for 2+ years. Do not
double or triple charge the system with dye as this may cause reliability concerns. Use only the 1/4
oz. charge.
The dye has a refrigerant leak detection notice sticker included with the package. Complete the
sticker information and place near the charge label.
Dye Injection R-134a dye can be injected two ways:
1. With the A/C system charged, use the instructions provided with the new R134a leak dye
injection tool, J 41436.
2. With A/C system discharged, add dye into the newly replaced component assembly.
It is important to note that it is normal to find oil traces at the compressor shaft seal during
compressor operation, some oil will hydraulically seep past the shaft seal. This does not mean that
the shaft seal is defective or that the refrigerant has leaked. Refrigerant leaks at the shaft seal
should be verified with the electronic leak detector (J 39400) following the procedure detailed in the
Service Manual. If, however, the amount of oil is excessive, the shaft seal is suspect and should be
replaced. (For example, refrigerant oil has coated the clutch plate edge at gap between clutch and
pulley, or oil slinging has occurred-oil line shows on underside of hood, etc.).
Also, after working on A/C components with dye, it is important to wipe the joint and/or access
ports clean of any residual dye with GM solvent (GM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye > Page
1561
P/N 1050436) to prevent false diagnosis at a later point.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information GM solvent, P/N 1050436, is currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
File In Section: 1 - HVAC Bulletin No.: 43-12-23 Date: September, 1994
Subject: Contaminated A/C Refrigerant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 Air Conditioning Systems
Government regulations limit the production of R12 refrigerant, commonly referred to as Freon,
during 1994/1995 and restrict manufacture of new R12 material effective January 1, 1996. As R12
prices rise and supplies are depleted, it is anticipated non-approved substitute refrigerants and/or
poor quality R12 material sold as new or reprocessed may become more prevalent.
The Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) recently expressed concern over reports of the sale of
R12 refrigerant containing as high as 15% contamination by R22, a refrigerant commonly used in
stationary home systems but unsuitable for use in mobile units. GM dealers should be careful to
protect against contaminating their existing supplies of R12 or the A/C systems in customers'
vehicles they service by dealing with reputable suppliers. All R12 refrigerant purchased for
warranty repairs should be purchased through GM SPO to ensure GM quality standards are met.
The use of non-approved R12 refrigerant substitutes, some of which contain flammable materials,
has also been reported by MACS. These products are available to "do-it-yourselfers" who, in many
cases, believe they are harmless replacements for the small cans of R12 used so commonly in the
past. Once added to the A/C system, the vehicle can no longer be serviced using R12
recovery/recycling equipment without:
- Risking permanent damage to recovery/recycling equipment
- Contaminating the previously recovered R12 material in the recovery tank
- Spreading the contamination when the recovered material is used to charge other vehicles
or
- Possible loss of the recovered material if the contaminated level is high enough to activate the air
purge system
Contaminated refrigerant also impacts customer satisfaction through poor vehicle A/C performance
and loss of A/C system compressor/component durability. System or component failure resulting
from the use of refrigerant which does not meet GM specification is not covered by the "New
Vehicle Warranty".
Unfortunately, there is no simple method to identify if a "do-it-yourselfer" or repair shop has added
to or recharged a system with a non-approved refrigerant. The inability to protect against the
spread of contaminated refrigerant threatens the recycling program and the industry's desire to
maximize use of the remaining R12 supply.
Beginning in 1993, General Motors STG, Harrison Division, Research Labs and Kent-Moore
worked in conjunction with suppliers of various technologies to develop a tester to identify
contaminated refrigerant in vehicle A/C systems before recovery. During development of the
technology, several dealer service manager focus group studies were conducted to identify design
features to best suit dealership needs.
The discussions and surveys clearly indicated the desire for a dedicated instrument, permanently
mounted to the refrigerant recovery cart to ensure ALL vehicles are automatically tested prior to
recovering refrigerant. Testing ALL refrigerant for contamination prior to recovery is the ONLY
means to ensure customer satisfaction, protect recovery equipment and avoid unintentional venting
of refrigerant by your dealership.
General Motors has evaluated all available technology for this project and only the J 39851 R12
"Pureguard" meets General Motors' specifications. The J 39851 R12 Pureguard Refrigerant
Monitor has been classified as an essential tool and will be shipped by Kent-Moore to your
dealership beginning in September of 1994. The essential price of the R12 "Pureguard" is $561 (for
Canadian dealers the price is $800 Canadian). If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery
equipment, additional units may be ordered from Kent-Moore for $561 at 1-800-345-2233. Features
of the R12 "Pureguard" include:
- Universally mounts to R12 Recovery Equipment
- Automatically interrupts power to the Recovery Equipment when contaminated refrigerant is
identified
- Fully automatic design does not require technician action, training or interpretation
- LCD displays Pureguard functions
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination > Page 1566
- Meets GM contamination sensitivity requirements
- Self calibrating
- Micro-processor controlled
- Audio alarm alerts technician
Other Refrigerant Identifiers are being advertised which may be available this A/C season.
However, ONLY the Kent-Moore J 39851 R12 "Pureguard" meets General Motors' current
specifications which ensure recovered refrigerant is compatible with General Motors vehicles and
General Motors approved recovery systems.
An R134a Pureguard Refrigerant Identifier is currently under development and is anticipated to be
available in early 1995. The contamination of R134a refrigerant is not expected to be a concern
until the program to retrofit R12 vehicles to R134a becomes more widely used.
Future bulletins will be issued to address the recovery and disposal of contaminated refrigerant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331226
Date: January, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: RETROFITTING R-12 VEHICLES TO R-134a
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR YEARS, PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS WITH R-12 A/C
SYSTEMS
There has been a great deal of information presented by the media regarding the need to retrofit
vehicles produced with R-12, to a substitute refrigerant. This bulletin will outline GM's position and
future plans on this subject.
Most important, there is currently NO requirement to retrofit any R-12 vehicle. Vehicles built with
R-12 can be serviced with R-12, as long as the refrigerant is available. At some point in time, R-12
may become either too scarce or too expensive to economically justify service on some vehicles
with R-12. By that time, GM will provide you with instructions on retrofitting those vehicles from
R-12 to R-134a.
GM vehicle divisions, platforms, and component suppliers have been actively working on the
details of retrofitting R-12 vehicles. An enormous amount of work is required to determine how
hundreds of vehicle models can be satisfactorily retrofitted. Additional information will be provided
as it becomes available.
The following items contain important technical information that should answer many of the
questions, and correct some misconceptions reported in the media.
SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANTS
R-134a is the only approved substitute refrigerant that GM recommends and it should only be used
if a complete retrofit procedure has been performed. None of the other refrigerants currently being
marketed as replacement or drop-in substitutes for R-12 are approved for use in GM vehicles.
R-12 and R-134a are not interchangeable. R-134a cannot be added to fill a low R-12 system. The
combination of the two materials can cause high system pressures, which could cause damage to
the system.
Retrofitting an R-12 vehicle to R-134a requires careful preparation to insure that neither the vehicle
nor the A/C service equipment has become contaminated.
RESIDUAL MINERAL OIL
The concern that mineral oil is chemically incompatible with R-134a and/or PAG lubricant has been
proven to be untrue. A normal charge of mineral oil left in the A/C system after a retrofit to R-134a
will not damage the system. Mineral oil, however, does not mix well with R-134a, and will not
provide adequate lubrication. Tests on both the orifice tube and TXV systems show that the mineral
oil parks in places such as the accumulator, and does not appreciably affect performance or
damage the system. The retrofit service bulletin will specify the correct oil to be used. It is important
that this oil recommendation be followed carefully.
RESIDUAL R-12
Residual R-12 left in a system, due to improper retrofit service procedures, may result in system
damage unless the residual R-12 is kept below the 2 percent limit specified by the Society of
Automotive Engineers' Specification J-1661. New service methods are being developed to
minimize the level of R-12 remaining in the A/C system after the retrofit procedure is completed.
Following these new procedures will be critical to insure that the above limits are met.
SYSTEM FLUSHING
R-11, a material commonly used as an A/C system flushing solvent, has been found to be
chemically incompatible with PAG lubricant. Technicians should be aware that residual R-11
remaining in an R-12 system will be very damaging if the vehicle is retrofitted to R-134a later in its
life. For many years GM has recommended the use of in-line filters as an alternative to system
flushing.
SYSTEM FLUSHING, USING EITHER R-11 OR ANY OTHER FLUSHING MATERIAL, IS NOT
APPROVED BY GM FOR ANY A/C SYSTEM.
DESICCANT PROTECTION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A > Page
1571
It has been reported that the desiccant (moisture absorption material) used in 1992 and older R-12
A/C systems is incompatible with R-134a and PAG oil. The older desiccant was designed
specifically for R-12 systems, but testing has shown that it is NOT necessary to replace the older
desiccant just because the vehicle is being retrofitted to R-134a. 1993 and newer GM vehicles use
desiccant designed to be compatible with both R-12 and R-134a systems.
The amount of desiccant used in most GM vehicles is designed to last for at least seven years. To
help maintain adequate protection for vehicles that must be retrofitted, it is recommended that the
accumulator/dryer, which contains the desiccant, be replaced if the vehicle is more than five years
old.
"O" RINGS
While continuing to service with R-12, be sure to use "O" rings and seal materials which are
compatible with R-134a and PAG oil. This practice will eliminate concern in case the vehicle
requires retrofitting later in its life. All "O" rings and seal materials available from GMSPO are
compatible with R-134a systems.
RETROFITTED SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
Currently, it appears that for most GM vehicles, the retrofit procedure will require minimal changes
to the existing system. Some vehicles may need additional parts and/or procedures to provide
acceptable performance and/or durability. Our testing has shown that vehicles that have undergone
recommended retrofit procedures will, in most climatic conditions, be minimally affected in terms of
A/C performance.
SERVICE POLICY
Basic service policy is as follows:
During Warranty - If an R-12 produced vehicle A/C system must be repaired or recharged under
warranty, repairs will be completed using R-12. If R-12 is unavailable or unaffordable, GM will notify
the dealer body and will pay for the warranty repair and the retrofit to R-134a.
NOTE:
It a customer requests that an in-warranty vehicle be converted to R-134a, and the R-12 system is
functioning properly, the customer will be expected to pay for the retrofit.
Out of Warranty - The cost of the conversion will be the responsibility of the customer.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 922501A > Aug > 92 > A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Number: 92-250-1A
Section: 0A
Date: AUGUST 1992
Corporate Bulletin No.: 231205
ASE No.: A7
Subject: USE OF ALTERNATE REFRIGERANTS IN CFC 12 REFRIGERANT MOBILE AIR
CONDITIONERS
Model and Year: GALL MODEL YEARS - ALL PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS INCLUDING
GEO
A number of inquiries have been received concerning the use of "alternate refrigerants" as a
replacement for R-12 refrigerant in General Motors air conditioning systems.
Regardless of any advertised claims, there are currently no substitutes for refrigerant R-12
approved by General Motors. At the present time, only new or recycled R-12 is approved for use in
General Motors R-12 air conditioning systems.
Based on studies performed to date, the use of "alternate refrigerants" in General Motors R-12 air
conditioning systems may result in higher system pressures, higher leak rates or incompatibility
with drying and sealing materials. System performance and reliability may also be affected.
Service equipment manufacturers have indicated that cross-contaminating R-12 recovery/recycling
equipment with "alternate refrigerants" may damage the equipment. General Motors supports the
Society of Automotive Engineers recommended service procedures for recovery and recycling of
R-12. The use of known "alternate refrigerants" without proper service practices for identifying
vehicle systems containing these "alternate refrigerants" and dedicated recovery equipment to
service those vehicles will contaminate the recycled supply of R-12 refrigerant. Contamination of
the recycled R-12 refrigerant makes the refrigerant unusable for recharging air conditioning
systems and could jeopardize the recycling program.
At the present time, General Motors has not approved any "alternate refrigerant" for R-12 in R-12
air conditioning systems. Therefore, R-12 systems should continue to be serviced with new or
recycled R-12 only.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1576
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1577
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1578
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1579
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1580
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331226
Date: January, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: RETROFITTING R-12 VEHICLES TO R-134a
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR YEARS, PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS WITH R-12 A/C
SYSTEMS
There has been a great deal of information presented by the media regarding the need to retrofit
vehicles produced with R-12, to a substitute refrigerant. This bulletin will outline GM's position and
future plans on this subject.
Most important, there is currently NO requirement to retrofit any R-12 vehicle. Vehicles built with
R-12 can be serviced with R-12, as long as the refrigerant is available. At some point in time, R-12
may become either too scarce or too expensive to economically justify service on some vehicles
with R-12. By that time, GM will provide you with instructions on retrofitting those vehicles from
R-12 to R-134a.
GM vehicle divisions, platforms, and component suppliers have been actively working on the
details of retrofitting R-12 vehicles. An enormous amount of work is required to determine how
hundreds of vehicle models can be satisfactorily retrofitted. Additional information will be provided
as it becomes available.
The following items contain important technical information that should answer many of the
questions, and correct some misconceptions reported in the media.
SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANTS
R-134a is the only approved substitute refrigerant that GM recommends and it should only be used
if a complete retrofit procedure has been performed. None of the other refrigerants currently being
marketed as replacement or drop-in substitutes for R-12 are approved for use in GM vehicles.
R-12 and R-134a are not interchangeable. R-134a cannot be added to fill a low R-12 system. The
combination of the two materials can cause high system pressures, which could cause damage to
the system.
Retrofitting an R-12 vehicle to R-134a requires careful preparation to insure that neither the vehicle
nor the A/C service equipment has become contaminated.
RESIDUAL MINERAL OIL
The concern that mineral oil is chemically incompatible with R-134a and/or PAG lubricant has been
proven to be untrue. A normal charge of mineral oil left in the A/C system after a retrofit to R-134a
will not damage the system. Mineral oil, however, does not mix well with R-134a, and will not
provide adequate lubrication. Tests on both the orifice tube and TXV systems show that the mineral
oil parks in places such as the accumulator, and does not appreciably affect performance or
damage the system. The retrofit service bulletin will specify the correct oil to be used. It is important
that this oil recommendation be followed carefully.
RESIDUAL R-12
Residual R-12 left in a system, due to improper retrofit service procedures, may result in system
damage unless the residual R-12 is kept below the 2 percent limit specified by the Society of
Automotive Engineers' Specification J-1661. New service methods are being developed to
minimize the level of R-12 remaining in the A/C system after the retrofit procedure is completed.
Following these new procedures will be critical to insure that the above limits are met.
SYSTEM FLUSHING
R-11, a material commonly used as an A/C system flushing solvent, has been found to be
chemically incompatible with PAG lubricant. Technicians should be aware that residual R-11
remaining in an R-12 system will be very damaging if the vehicle is retrofitted to R-134a later in its
life. For many years GM has recommended the use of in-line filters as an alternative to system
flushing.
SYSTEM FLUSHING, USING EITHER R-11 OR ANY OTHER FLUSHING MATERIAL, IS NOT
APPROVED BY GM FOR ANY A/C SYSTEM.
DESICCANT PROTECTION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1581
It has been reported that the desiccant (moisture absorption material) used in 1992 and older R-12
A/C systems is incompatible with R-134a and PAG oil. The older desiccant was designed
specifically for R-12 systems, but testing has shown that it is NOT necessary to replace the older
desiccant just because the vehicle is being retrofitted to R-134a. 1993 and newer GM vehicles use
desiccant designed to be compatible with both R-12 and R-134a systems.
The amount of desiccant used in most GM vehicles is designed to last for at least seven years. To
help maintain adequate protection for vehicles that must be retrofitted, it is recommended that the
accumulator/dryer, which contains the desiccant, be replaced if the vehicle is more than five years
old.
"O" RINGS
While continuing to service with R-12, be sure to use "O" rings and seal materials which are
compatible with R-134a and PAG oil. This practice will eliminate concern in case the vehicle
requires retrofitting later in its life. All "O" rings and seal materials available from GMSPO are
compatible with R-134a systems.
RETROFITTED SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
Currently, it appears that for most GM vehicles, the retrofit procedure will require minimal changes
to the existing system. Some vehicles may need additional parts and/or procedures to provide
acceptable performance and/or durability. Our testing has shown that vehicles that have undergone
recommended retrofit procedures will, in most climatic conditions, be minimally affected in terms of
A/C performance.
SERVICE POLICY
Basic service policy is as follows:
During Warranty - If an R-12 produced vehicle A/C system must be repaired or recharged under
warranty, repairs will be completed using R-12. If R-12 is unavailable or unaffordable, GM will notify
the dealer body and will pay for the warranty repair and the retrofit to R-134a.
NOTE:
It a customer requests that an in-warranty vehicle be converted to R-134a, and the R-12 system is
functioning properly, the customer will be expected to pay for the retrofit.
Out of Warranty - The cost of the conversion will be the responsibility of the customer.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 1582
Refrigerant: Specifications
REFRIGERANT AND OIL CAPACITY
The refrigerant system requires refrigerant and oil in quantities listed:
Refrigerant
Refrigerant-12 ......................................................................................................................................
................................................. 1.134 kg (2.5 lbs.)
Refrigerant Oil
525 Viscosity Refrigerant Oil ...............................................................................................................
.................................................. 240 ml (8 fl. oz.)
CAUTION: Overcharging a system may allow liquid Refrigerant-12 or Refrigerant-134a to get into
the compressor, causing compressor noise and damage. Undercharging will cause insufficient
cooling.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 1583
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
Like the coolant in an engine cooling system, the refrigerant is the substance in the air conditioning
system that absorbs, carries, and then releases heat. Although various substances are used as
refrigerants in other types of refrigeration systems, most automotive air conditioning systems use
the Refrigerant-12. This compound is not explosive, not flammable, not corrosive except when in
contact with water, and not poisonous except when in contact with an open flame or hot metal. It is
soluble in oil.
Refrigerant-12 carries a charge of a special lubricating oil, normally 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
Since the refrigerant has an affinity for oil, the two compounds mix easily and completely. Even the
refrigerant vapor carries small particles of oil. As the liquid or vapor moves through the system, it
keeps the moving parts of the compressor lubricated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Proper Flushing Procedures
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Proper Flushing Procedures
General Information
This article has been updated with bulletin No. 01-01-38-006A.
CONTAMINATED R-134A A/C SYSTEMS - AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLUSHING
PROCEDURES AND GUIDELINES
A/C system flushing should NOT be routinely performed when a system failure is encountered.
System flushing takes a considerable amount of time to perform and is NOT necessary on most
system failures and should be performed only when any one of the following conditions is found.
- Desiccant bag failure
- Gross overcharge of PAG oil
- Refrigerant contamination
- Contaminated PAG oil
- Catastrophic compressor failure causing oil contamination
A/C system flushing will remove some of the metal particles during a flush, but flushing is not
completely effective in removing all metallic debris. System flushing should not be considered if
removal of metallic debris is the only objective. GM Service Operations continues to recommend
the use of LIQUID LINE FILTERS and SUCTION SCREENS to control this type of system
contamination and avoid repeat failures.
A/C System Flushing Procedure
A/C SYSTEM FLUSHING PROCEDURE
TOOLS REQUIRED:
- J 43600 ACR 2000
- J 45263 Flush Adapter Kit
- J 41447 Leak Detection Dye or equivalent
- J 41459 Leak Detection Dye Injector or equivalent
- J 42220 Universal 12V Leak Detection Lamp or equivalent
- J 39400-A Leak Detector
- J 44551 A/C Suction Screen Kit
A warm engine compartment or higher ambient temperatures speed the refrigerant recovery time
during the A/C flush procedure. Whenever possible, warm the engine prior to system flushing. The
use of an external fan blowing across the condenser may also be helpful to speed recovery.
FRONT ONLY A/C SYSTEMS
1. Recover system refrigerant. 2. Remove the expansion device (orifice tube or TXV). 3. Connect
the A/C lines with the orifice tube removed or install the appropriate TXV Adapter from kit J 45268.
4. Remove the A/C compressor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Proper Flushing Procedures > Page 1586
5. Inspect the end of the suction hose for a suction screen. Remove the suction screen using the J
44551 A/C suction screen kit, if installed. 6. Install the appropriate A/C compressor hose assembly
flush adapter(s) from kit J 45268. 7. Configure the flush adapter and hose for either a forward flush
or reverse flush. Refer to the Flushing Configuration section of this bulletin.
FRONT/REAR (DUAL CIRCUIT) A/C SYSTEMS
Each circuit of a front/rear A/C system must be flushed separately. Flow to one circuit must be
blocked with the use of a blocked orifice tube or blocked TXV. The front circuit should always be
flushed first.
FRONT CIRCUIT
1. Recover system refrigerant. 2. Remove the expansion device (TXV or orifice tube) from the front
circuit. 3. Reconnect the A/C lines with the orifice tube removed or install the appropriate
non-blocked (open) TXV Adapter from kit J 45268.
IMPORTANT: A blocked orifice tube is not supplied with the J 45268 Adapter kit. A blocked orifice
can be made as follows: Cut the orifice tube frame and screen. Remove enough of the frame and
screen to access the end of the orifice tube. Seal the tube by pinching oft the end of the orifice
tube.
4. Remove the expansion device (TXV or orifice tube) from the rear circuit and install a plugged
expansion device (TXV or orifice tube) into the
rear circuit.
5. Remove the A/C compressor. 6. Inspect the end of the suction hose for a suction screen.
Remove the suction screen using the J 44551 A/C suction screen kit, if installed. 7. Install the
appropriate A/C compressor hose assembly flush adapter(s) from kit J 45268. 8. Configure the
flush adapter and hose for either a forward flush or reverse flush. Refer to the Flushing
Configuration section of this bulletin. 9. Perform the flush of the front system by following the
instructions supplied with the J 43600 ACR 2000.
10. Replace the plugged expansion device (TXV or orifice tube) in the rear circuit with an open
expansion device (TXV or orifice tube). 11. Replace the open expansion device (TXV or orifice
tube) in the front circuit with a plugged expansion device (TXV or orifice tube). 12. Flush the rear
system by following the instructions supplied with the J 43600 ACR 2000.
Flushing Configuration - Forward Flush
FORWARD FLUSH
Forward flushing (the same flow as normal system operation) is recommended for contaminated
refrigerant or RAG oil.
IMPORTANT: Install a new filter inside the J 45268-1 for every flush. Service the filter with GM P/N
5651802 (in Canada, use P/N 729832). Remove and discard the check valve filter from the filter.
IMPORTANT: Always close the valve on the J 43600 ACR 2000 external refrigerant tank before
starting the flush process.
To perform the forward flush, follow these steps: 1. Connect the flush filter adapter J 45268-1 to the
suction port of the A/C compressor hose assembly flush adapter. 2. Connect the blue hose from
the J 43600 ACR 2000 to the J 45268-1 flush filter adapter. 3. Connect the red hose from the J
43600 ACR 2000 to the discharge port of the A/C compressor hose assembly flush adapter. 4.
Follow the instructions supplied with the J 43600 ACR 2000 and flush the A/C system.
Flushing Configuration - Reverse Flush
REVERSE FLUSH
Reverse flushing (the opposite flow of normal operation) is recommended for desiccant bag failure.
Always replace the accumulator after the reverse flushing procedure is complete.
IMPORTANT: Install a new filter inside the J 45268-1 for every flush. Service the filter with GM P/N
5651802 (in Canada, use P/N 729832). Remove and discard the check valve from the filter.
IMPORTANT: Always close the valve on the J 43600 external refrigerant tank before starting the
flush process.
To perform the reverse flush, follow these steps: 1. Connect the J 45268-1 flush filter adapter to the
discharge port of the A/C compressor hose assembly flush adapter. 2. Connect the blue hose from
the J 45268-1 flush filter adapter. 3. Connect the red hose to the suction port of the A/C
compressor hose assembly flush adapter. 4. Follow the instructions supplied with the J 43600 ACR
2000 and flush the A/C system.
After Flushing Is Complete
AFTER FLUSHING IS COMPLETE
IMPORTANT: Flushing will remove all the PAG oil and leak detection dye from the A/C system.
After a catastrophic compressor failure, it is extremely important to eliminate and/or contain debris
that cause repeat repairs. The debris generated from a catastrophic compressor failure is
discharged into the compressor suction line, discharge line, condenser and liquid line. The use of
the J 44551 Suction Screen kit DOES NOT replace the need for liquid line filters as described in
the vehicle specific Service Information. Liquid line filters
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Proper Flushing Procedures > Page 1587
should be used whenever possible (after a catastrophic compressor failure) to protect the
expansion device (orifice tube or TXV) from debris. Delphi V5 and V7 compressors already have
this screen installed in the suction port of the compressor and do not need an additional screen
installed.
The J 44551 Suction Screen kit contains three different screen sizes. It is important to select the
correct size screen that will press fit into the suction port of the compressor hose assembly. The
screen should not be installed loose inside the hose assembly.
1. Insert the J 44551-6 sizing tool into the suction hose to select the correct size suction screen. 2.
Insert the suction screen into the compressor end of the suction hose. 3. Select and install the
correct mandrel to the J 44551-5. 4. Install the J 44551-5 screen installation tool over the end of the
suction hose and the suction screen.
IMPORTANT: Correct placement of the J 44551 is critical.
5. Tighten the forcing screw of the J 44551-5. The suction screen is fully installed when the screen
is flush with the end of the suction hose fitting. 6. Remove the J 44551-5 suction screen tool from
the suction hose. 7. Install the J 44551-1 Suction Screen Notification Label. 8. Remove the A/C
compressor drain plug, if equipped. Drain the PAG oil from the A/C compressor. Rotate the
compressor input shaft to assist in
draining the PAG oil from the A/C compressor.
9. Install the A/C compressor drain plug, if equipped.
10. Install the A/C compressor. 11. Remove the blocked orifice tube or TXV adapter (front/rear
systems only). 12. Install a new orifice tube or remove the TXV adapter.
- Inspect the original TXV for debris.
- Clean or replace the original TXV as needed.
- For front/rear systems, be sure both expansion devices (orifices or TXVs) are installed.
IMPORTANT:
- Install the in-line filter on front A/C systems before the orifice tube.
- Install the in-line filter on front/rear A/C systems before the "Y" in the evaporator tube.
- Do not allow metal burrs to enter the evaporator tube during cuffing or when removing the burrs.
Because of limited space in the engine compartment, it may be necessary to remove the system's
existing orifice tube and install a filter with an orifice.
13. Follow these steps for in-line filter installation:
13.1. Using a tubing cutter, cut the marked section of the evaporator tube. 13.2. Remove the burrs
from the evaporator tube.
13.3. Remove the nuts (4), the ferrules (3) and the O-rings (2) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
IMPORTANT: Do not install the O-rings (2)in this step.
13.4. Push the nuts (4) and the ferrules (3) over each of the evaporator tube halves. Install the
ferrules (3) with the small end toward the nut (4). 13.5. Install the A/C refrigerant filter (3) to the
evaporator tube (2) with the flow arrow pointing towards the evaporator. 13.6. While holding the
evaporator tube in the A/C refrigerant filter (1), tighten the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
TIGHTEN
Nuts to 15 Nm (11 lb ft).
13.7. Remove the nuts (4) from the A/C refrigerant filter (1). 13.8. Coat the O-rings (2) with 525
viscosity refrigerant PAG oil 13.9. Install the O-rings (2) to the evaporator tube halves.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Proper Flushing Procedures > Page 1588
13.10. Install the nuts (4) to the A/C refrigerant filter (1).
TIGHTEN
Nuts to 15 Nm (11 lb ft).
14. Add the total system capacity of PAG oil to the A/C system. Refer to the System Capacities
table in the appropriate Service Manual. 15. Add one bottle of J 41447 dye, GM P/N 12346303 (in
Canada, use 10953458), or the equivalent using the J 41459 dye injector (or the
equivalent).
16. Recharge the A/C system. 17. Leak test all connections using the J 44220 Universal 12V Leak
Detection Lamp or the J 39400-A Leak Detector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - New PAG Oil
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - New PAG Oil
Bulletin No.: 02-01-39-004B
Date: November 16, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: New PAG Oil Released
Models: 2006 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2006 HUMMER
H2 2006 HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
Built With R-134a Refrigeration System
All Air Conditioning Compressor Types (Excluding R4 and A6 Type Compressors)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the PAG oil part number used for R4 and A6 compressors
with R-134a refrigerant systems. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-01-39-004A
(Section 01 - HVAC).
All General Motors vehicles built with R-134a refrigerant systems shall now be serviced with GM
Universal PAG Oil (excluding vehicles equipped with an R4 or A6 compressor).
R4 and A6 compressors with R-134a refrigerant systems shall use PAG OIL, GM P/N 12356151
(A/C Delco part number 15-118) (in Canada, use P/N 10953486).
Important:
The PAG oil referenced in this bulletin is formulated with specific additive packages that meet
General Motors specifications and use of another oil may void the A/C systems warranty.
Use this new PAG oil when servicing the A/C system on the vehicles listed above. Oil packaged in
an 8 oz tube should be installed using A/C Oil Injector, J 45037. Refer to the HVAC Section of
Service Information for detailed information on Oil Balancing and Capacities.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL DISTRIBUTION
The Harrison HR1OOT, HR11OMD (CCOT), and V-5 (VDOT) compressor systems used on S/T
models require 525 viscosity or polyalkaline glycol (PAG) refrigerant oil in the quantities listed
below.
- CCOT System-240 ml (8 fl. oz.)
- VDOT System-265 ml (9 fl. oz.)
New oil quantities must be added to the system during component replacement and conditions
stated as follows:
- With no signs of excessive oil leakage, add:
A. All Compressors (drain and measure the oil).
- If less than 30 ml (1 fl. oz.) is drained-add 60 ml (2 fl. oz.) to the new compressor.
- If more than 30 ml (1 fl. oz.) is drained-add same amount that was drained to the new
compressor.
B. Accumulator-Add 105 ml (3.5 fl. oz.) of new oil to the replacement accumulator to compensate
for oil retained by original accumulator desiccant
and bag assemblies. The accumulator should only be replaced if leaking due to a perforation,
damaged O-ring seal seat, or damaged threads.
C. Evaporator-Add 90 ml (3 fl. oz.) of new refrigerant oil. D. Condenser-Add 30 ml (1 fl. oz.) of new
refrigerant oil.
REFRIGERANT OIL LOSS DUE TO A LARGE LEAK
If the refrigerant charge is abruptly lost due to a large refrigerant leak, approximately 90 ml (3 fl.
oz.) of refrigerant oil will be carried out of the system suspended in the refrigerant. Any malfunction
that caused an abrupt refrigerant discharge will experience this oil loss. Malfunctions that allow the
refrigerant to seep or bleed off over time do not experience this oil loss. After replacing a
component which caused a large refrigerant leak, add 90 ml (3 fl. oz.) of new 525 viscosity or
polyalkaline glycol (PAG) refrigerant oil plus the desired amount of oil for the particular component.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1595
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Polyalkaline Glycol (PAG) Refrigerant Oil
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1596
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
Refrigerant Oil
The PAG lubricant may be poured into the suction port.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair General Information
BLEEDING BRAKE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Bleeding is necessary if air has entered the hydraulic brake system.
It may be necessary to bleed the system at all four wheels if a low fluid level allowed air to enter the
system, or the brake pipes have been disconnected at the master cylinder or combination valve. If
a pipe is disconnected at one wheel, then only bleed that wheel.
The time required to bleed the hydraulic system when the master cylinder is removed can be
reduced by bleeding the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1601
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE BLEEDING
The 4WAL brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is
trapped in it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the
BPMV. There are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels.
Open the internal bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it
must be bled after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 provided that
the dimple is removed from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1602
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed.
6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools. 9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the function tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1603
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With VCM/Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
VCM/FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is trapped in
it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the BPMV. There
are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels. Open the internal
bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it must be bled
after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required:
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool (Three required) - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 providing you
remove the dimple from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1604
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed. 6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools. 9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the tunction tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1605
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With Rear Wheel Antilock Brake System
REAR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false DTCs could be set to memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWALI4WAL Cartridge Kit or 7000001 Mass Storage Cartridge
1. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 2. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
it needed. 3. Bleed wheel cylinders and calipers. 4. Turn ignition switch "ON" and do three function
tests with the Tech-1 scan tool. 5. Re-bleed the rear brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
6. Evaluate brake pedal feel. 7. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1606
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
General Information
BLEEDING BRAKE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Bleeding is necessary if air has entered the hydraulic brake system.
It may be necessary to bleed the system at all four wheels if a low fluid level allowed air to enter the
system, or the brake pipes have been disconnected at the master cylinder or combination valve. If
a pipe is disconnected at one wheel, then only bleed that wheel.
The time required to bleed the hydraulic system when the master cylinder is removed can be
reduced by bleeding the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle.
With Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE BLEEDING
The 4WAL brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is
trapped in it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the
BPMV. There are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels.
Open the internal bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it
must be bled after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 provided that
the dimple is removed from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1607
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed.
6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools. 9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the function tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
With VCM/Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
VCM/FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is trapped in
it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the BPMV. There
are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels. Open the internal
bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it must be bled
after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required:
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool (Three required) - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 providing you
remove the dimple from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1608
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed. 6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1609
9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the tunction tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
With Rear Wheel Antilock Brake System
REAR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false DTCs could be set to memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWALI4WAL Cartridge Kit or 7000001 Mass Storage Cartridge
1. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 2. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
it needed. 3. Bleed wheel cylinders and calipers. 4. Turn ignition switch "ON" and do three function
tests with the Tech-1 scan tool. 5. Re-bleed the rear brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
6. Evaluate brake pedal feel. 7. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
Hydraulic System Flushing
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM FLUSHING
Flushing is done at each bleeder valve similar to the bleeding procedure. The difference-is that the
bleeder valve is opened 1 1/2 turns and fluid is forced through the pipes, hoses, and bleeder valves
until it comes out clear in color. Refer to Hydraulic System, Service and Repair.
Check the master cylinder fluid level after flushing at each bleeder valve and refill as required. After
flushing, make sure the master cylinder reservoir is filled to the correct level.
Manual Bleeding
MANUAL BLEEDING
NOTICE: Brake fluid will damage electrical connections and painted surfaces. Use shop cloths,
suitable containers, and tender covers to prevent brake fluid from contacting these areas. Always
re-seal and wipe off brake fluid containers to prevent spills.
Tool Required: J 28434 Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Wrench
- Relieve the vacuum reserve by applying the brakes several times with the ignition "OFF"
1. Fill the master cylinder reservoirs with Delco Supreme No. 11 Hydraulic Brake Fluid (GM P/N
1052535) or an equivalent DOT 3 motor vehicle
brake fluid.
- Maintain the fluid level during bleeding.
2. If the master cylinder is suspected to have air in the bore, bleed it before any wheel cylinder or
caliper.
A. Disconnect the forward brake pipe connection at the master cylinder. B. Allow the brake fluid to
flow from the connector port. C. Connect the brake pipe but do not tighten. D. Slowly apply the
brake pedal and allow the air to bleed from the loose fitting. E. Tighten the fitting before releasing
the pedal. F. Wait 15 seconds. G. Repeat this sequence, including the 15-second wait, until all air
is purged from the bore. H. After all air has been removed from the forward connection, repeat this
procedure for the rear pipe.
3. If the BPMV of the 4WAL system is replaced or suspected to have air trapped inside, it must be
bled next. Refer to With ABS.
4. Bleed each wheel in the following sequence:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1610
A. Right rear B. Left rear C. Right front D. Left front
5. Attach J 28434 to the wheel cylinder/caliper bleeder valve.
- Immerse the opposite end of the hose into a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
6. Slowly apply the brake pedal one time and hold. 7. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge the air
from the wheel cylinder/caliper. 8. Tighten the bleeder valve and slowly release the pedal. 9. Wait
15 seconds.
10. Repeat this sequence, including the 15-second wait, until all air is purged from the wheel
cylinder/caliper. 11. Tighten the bleeder valve to 7 N.m (62 lbs. in.). 12. Continue steps 5 through
11 at each wheel until the system is bled. 13. Check the brake pedal for "sponginess" and the
brake warning lamp for an indication of unbalanced pressure. Repeat the bleeding procedure to
correct either of these conditions.
Pressure Bleeding
PRESSURE BLEEDING
A diaphragm-type pressure bleeder must be used. It must have a rubber diaphragm between the
air supply and brake fluid to prevent air, moisture, oil, and other contaminants from entering the
hydraulic system.
NOTICE: Brake fluid will damage electrical connections and painted surfaces. Use shop cloths,
suitable containers, and fender covers to prevent brake fluid from contacting these areas. Always
reseal and wipe off brake fluid containers to prevent spills.
Tools Required: - J 29567 Brake Bleeder Adapter - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding
Tool - J 28434 Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Wrench
1. Fill the pressure tank at least 2/3 full of brake fluid. The bleeder must be bled each time fluid is
added. 2. Charge the bleeder to 140-170 kPa (20-25 psi).
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
3. Use J 39177 to depress and hold the valve stem on the combination valve.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > General
Information > Page 1611
4. Install the bleeder adapter. 5. If the BPMV of the 4WAL system is replaced or suspected to air
trapped inside, it must be bled next. 6. Bleed each wheel in the following sequence:
A. Right rear B. Left rear C. Right front D. Left front
7. Connect the hose from the bleeder to the adapter at the master cylinder. 8. Open the tank valve.
9. Attach J 28434 to a bleeder valve.
10. Immerse the opposite end of the hose into a contamer partially filled with clean brake fluid. 11.
Open the bleeder valve at least 3/4 of a turn and allow the fluid to flow until no air is seen in the
fluid. 12. Tighten the bleeder valve to 7 Nm (62 lbs. in.). 13. Repeat steps 9 through 12 at all the
wheels. 14. Check the brake pedal for "sponginess".
- Repeat the bleeding procedure if this condition is found.
15. Remove J 39177. 16. Disconnect the hose from the bleeder adapter. 17. Remove the bleeder
adapter. 18. Fill the master cylinder to the proper level.
Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
MASTER CYLINDER BENCH BLEEDING
Bench bleed the master cylinder to remove the air from it prior to installation. This reduces the
amount of bleeding needed after it is installed on the vehicle.
1. Plug the outlet ports and mount the master cylinder in a vise with the front end tilted slightly
down. 2. Fill the reservoir with clean brake fluid. 3. Using a tool with a smooth rounded end, stroke
the primary piston about 25 mm (1 inch) several times.
- As air is bled from the master cylinder, the primary piston will not travel the full 25-mm (1-inch)
stroke.
4. Reposition the master cylinder in the vise with the front end tilted slightly up. 5. Again stroke the
primary piston about 25 mm (1 inch) several times. 6. Reposition the master cylinder in the vise to
the level position. 7. Loosen the plugs one at a time and push the piston into the bore to force the
air from the cylinder.
- To prevent air from being sucked back into the cylinder, tighten the plug(s) before allowing the
piston to return to its original position.
8. Fill the reservoir.
- Normal bleeding procedures should be followed after the master cylinder is installed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Breaker: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1617
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1618
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1619
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1620
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1621
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1622
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1623
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1624
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1625
Circuit Breaker: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1626
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1627
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1628
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1629
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1630
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1631
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1632
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1633
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1634
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1635
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1636
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1637
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1638
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1639
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1640
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1641
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1642
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1643
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1644
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1645
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1646
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1647
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1648
Circuit Breaker: Connector Views
Fuse Block Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1649
Fuse Block Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1650
Circuit Breaker: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1651
Fuse Block Details (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1652
Fuse Block Details (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1653
Fuse Block Details (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1654
Fuse Block Details (Part 2 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1655
Fuse Block Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1656
Fuse And Circuit Breaker Identification
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks
Fuse: Customer Interest A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 361102
Date: February, 1994
SUBJECT: BLOWN FUSE, ERRATIC HVAC OPERATION, AND SELF DIAGNOSTIC FEATURE
BLINKS (INSULATE WIRES)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K TRUCKS
CONDITION:
Some owners may experience a blown fuse, erratic HVAC operation, or a blinking HVAC control
head self diagnostic indicator.
CAUSE:
Two possible hard to find causes have been discovered for the above symptoms:
- Six way I/P to HVAC connector terminals may short to the ashtray. The connector has slots to
accommodate the terminal positive attachment locks that allow metal to metal contact between the
exposed terminals and the ashtray (Figure 1).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks > Page
1665
- The HVAC Harness from the control head to the blower and mode door motors, running across
the vehicle just under the dash panel, may chafe against the cassette deck support bracket (Figure
2).
CORRECTION:
Both conditions can be corrected by taping or otherwise shielding the wires from contact with the
respective metal edges. If the second condition has caused significant wire damage, repair
according to guidelines found in the wire repair section of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Op Description Labor Time
N6030 Wiring and/or Use Published
connector repair, A/C Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse: > 07-08-45-002 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse
Warning
Fuse: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse: > 361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self
Diagnostic Blinks
Fuse: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 361102
Date: February, 1994
SUBJECT: BLOWN FUSE, ERRATIC HVAC OPERATION, AND SELF DIAGNOSTIC FEATURE
BLINKS (INSULATE WIRES)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K TRUCKS
CONDITION:
Some owners may experience a blown fuse, erratic HVAC operation, or a blinking HVAC control
head self diagnostic indicator.
CAUSE:
Two possible hard to find causes have been discovered for the above symptoms:
- Six way I/P to HVAC connector terminals may short to the ashtray. The connector has slots to
accommodate the terminal positive attachment locks that allow metal to metal contact between the
exposed terminals and the ashtray (Figure 1).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse: > 361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self
Diagnostic Blinks > Page 1675
- The HVAC Harness from the control head to the blower and mode door motors, running across
the vehicle just under the dash panel, may chafe against the cassette deck support bracket (Figure
2).
CORRECTION:
Both conditions can be corrected by taping or otherwise shielding the wires from contact with the
respective metal edges. If the second condition has caused significant wire damage, repair
according to guidelines found in the wire repair section of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Op Description Labor Time
N6030 Wiring and/or Use Published
connector repair, A/C Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuse: > 07-08-45-002 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
In-Line Fuse
Trailer Tow Harness Engine Compartment Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
In-Line Fuse > Page 1683
Fuse: Locations In-Line Fuse Holder
Underhood Lamp
Floor Parcel Tray Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
In-Line Fuse > Page 1684
Underhood Lamp
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations
Fuse Block: Locations
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1688
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1689
Turn Signal And Hazard Flashers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1690
Safety Belt Wiring
Bus Bar Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1693
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1694
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1695
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1696
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1697
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1698
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1699
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1700
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1701
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1702
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1703
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1704
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1705
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1706
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1707
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1708
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1709
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1710
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1711
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1712
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1713
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1714
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1715
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1716
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1717
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1718
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1719
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1720
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1721
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1722
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1723
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1724
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1725
Fuse Block Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1726
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1727
Fuse Block Details (Part 2 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1728
Fuse Block Details (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1729
Fuse Block Details (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1730
Fuse Block Details (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1731
Fuse Block Details
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1732
Fuse And Circuit Breaker Identification
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fusible Link > Component Information >
Locations
Forward Lamps Harness - RH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations
Relay Box: Locations
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1739
Turn Signal And Hazard Flashers
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1740
Horn Relay Installation
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Relay Box: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1743
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1744
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1745
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1746
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1747
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1748
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1749
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1750
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1751
Relay Box: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1752
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1753
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1754
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1755
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1756
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1757
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1758
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1759
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1760
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1761
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1762
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1763
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1764
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1765
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1766
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1767
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1768
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1769
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1770
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1771
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1772
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1773
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1774
Relay Box: Electrical Diagrams
Convenience Center Details (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1775
Convenience Center Details (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
This system uses a sensor mounted on the radiator and an indicator light mounted in the
instrument panel to warn the driver if coolant level is too low. This light is wired in series with the
ignition switch, ECM and the sensor. When the ignition switch is turned to the crank position, the
circuit is energized and the indicator light will illuminate. When the ignition switch is turned to the
ON position and coolant level is sufficient, the sensor will indicate this to the ECM and the light will
turn off.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated
1. Turn ignition switch to the On position, then check coolant level and add coolant as necessary. If
lamp remains illuminated, proceed to step 2.
2. Disconnect electrical connector at the sensor. If lamp does not illuminate replace the sensor. If
lamp remains illuminated, proceed to step 3.
3. Connect electrical lead to the sensor and check for an open circuit between the sensor and the
module. Repair or replace as necessary. If circuit is satisfactory, replace the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated > Page 1782
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Lamp Will Not Illuminate
1. Turn ignition switch to the crank position, and proceed as follows: a.
If lamp illuminates, lamp is satisfactory and connector is properly installed. Proceed to step 2.
b. If lamp does not illuminate, check bulb, socket and wiring between socket and module
connector. Replace or repair as necessary.
2. Turn ignition switch to the On position and disconnect electrical lead at coolant level sensor
mounted on the radiator. If lamp fails to illuminate, check wiring between coolant level sensor
connector and ECM for a short circuit to ground. If circuit is satisfactory, replace the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Locations
Instrument cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1786
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL), "Service Engine Soon" light has the following purposes: Inform the driver that a problem has occurred, and that the vehicle should be taken for service as
soon as reasonably possible.
- Displays Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) stored by the ECM helping the technician diagnose
system faults.
- Indicates "Open Loop" or "Closed Loop" operation.
OPERATION
The MIL will come "ON" with the key "ON" and the engine not running. When the engine is started,
the light will turn "OFF.". This is a bulb and system check. If the light remains "ON," the
self-diagnostic system has detected a problem. If the problem goes away, the light will go out in
most cases after 10 seconds, but a DTC will remain stored in the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1787
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
The CHECK ENGINE LAMP will be illuminated when the ignition switch is placed in the "ON"
position. When the engine is started, the lamp should turn "OFF". If the lamp remains "ON" for 10
seconds or constantly after the engine is started, the self diagnosis system has detected a problem
and has stored a code in the system Control Module.
After diagnosis and repair, the ECM memory can be cleared of codes by removing the Control
Module fuse or disconnecting the battery ground cable for approximately 30 seconds, with ignition
switch in the "OFF" position. NOTE If battery ground cable is disconnected to clear codes, components such as clocks, electronically
tuned radios etc., will have to be reset.
- It is a good idea to record preset radio stations before disconnecting the negative battery cable.
This will allow the stations to be reset as to not inconvenience the customer.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 662003 > Nov > 96 > Front Tire Tread - Contacts Inner Fender Bolts
Tires: Customer Interest Front Tire Tread - Contacts Inner Fender Bolts
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 66-20-03
Date: November, 1996
Subject: Front Tire Tread Contacts Lower Inner Fender Bolts (Replace Lower Bolts)
Models: 1994-96 Chevrolet and GMC T Models with High Wider Option (RPO ZR2)
Condition
Some owners may comment that when turning, the front tire tread rubs against the inner fender
lower bolts and damages the tread.
Cause
The installation of non-OEM wheels and/or tires may contribute to tire to inner fender bolt contact.
Also, if the steering alignment, including suspension "Z" height is not within the specifications in
Section 3A of the S/T Truck Service Manual, tire tread to inner fender bolt contact can occur.
Correction
Replace the two lower rear inner fender Hex Head Bolts with Pan Head Bolts. These bolts provide
additional tire to bolt head clearance and reduce the possibility of tread damage.
Service Procedure
Notice:
Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use ONLY the
exact part number for that application General Motors will call out the fasteners that require thread
lockers or thread sealant. Unless otherwise specified, do not use supplemental coatings (paints,
greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint interfaces. Generally,
such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and joint clamping force, and may damage the
fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening sequence and specifications.
Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and systems.
1. Remove the two rear lower inner fender to wheel house panel bolts.
2. Install new bolts (P/N 15715627) and torque to 29 N.m (21 lb ft).
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
15715627 Pan Head Bolt 4/vehicle
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair Procedures
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-001F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Puncture Repair Procedures For All Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-03-10-001E (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin covers puncture repair procedures for passenger car and light duty truck radial tires in
the tread area only. The tire manufacturer must be contacted for its individual repair policy and
whether or not the speed rating is retained after repair.
Caution
- Tire changing can be dangerous and should be done by trained professionals using proper tools
and procedures. Always read and understand any manufacturer's warnings contained in their
customers literature or molded into the tire sidewall.
- Serious eye and ear injury may result from not wearing adequate eye and ear protection while
repairing tires.
- NEVER inflate beyond 275 kPa (40 pounds) pressure to seat beads.
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
- NEVER stand, lean or reach over the assembly during inflation.
Repairable area on a radial tire.
Important
- NEVER repair tires worn to the tread indicators 1.59 mm (2/32") remaining depth).
- NEVER repair tires with a tread puncture larger than 6.35 mm (1/4").
- NEVER substitute an inner tube for a permissible or non-permissible repair.
- NEVER perform an outside-in tire repair (plug only, on the wheel).
- Every tire must be removed from the wheel for proper inspection and repair.
- Regardless of the type of repair used, the repair must seal the inner liner and fill the injury.
- Consult with repair material supplier/manufacturer for repair unit application procedures and
repair tools/repair material recommendations.
Three basic steps for tire puncture repair:
1. Remove the tire from the wheel for inspection and repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1802
2. Fill the injury (puncture) to keep moisture out. 3. Seal the inner liner with a repair unit to prevent
air loss.
External Inspection
1. Prior to demounting, inspect the tire surface, the valve and the wheel for the source of the leak
by using a water and soap solution. Mark the
injured area and totally deflate the tire by removing the valve core.
2. Demount the tire from the wheel and place the tire on a well-lighted spreader.
Internal Inspection
1. Spread the beads and mark the puncture with a tire crayon. 2. Inspect the inner tire for any signs
of internal damage. 3. Remove the puncturing object, noting the direction of the penetration. 4.
Probe the injury with a blunt awl in order to determine the extent and direction of the injury. 5.
Remove any loose foreign material from the injury. 6. Punctures exceeding 6.35 mm (1/4") should
not be repaired.
Cleaning
1. Clean the area around the puncture thoroughly with a proper liner cleaner, clean cloth and a
scraper. This step serves to remove dirt and mold
lubricants to insure proper adhesion and non-contamination of the buffing tool.
2. Refer to information on the product or manufacturer's Material Safety Data Sheet and follow
guidelines for handling and disposal.
Clean the Injury Channel
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1803
1. Use a proper hand reamer, carbide cutter or drill bit to ream the puncture channel from the inside
of the tire in order to clean the injury. 2. Remove steel wires protruding above the liner surface to
prevent damage to the repair unit. 3. Consult your repair material supplier for recommended
reaming tool(s).
Fill the Injury
1. It is necessary to fill the injury channel to provide back up for the repair unit and to prevent
moisture from entering the tire fabric and steel wires. 2. (For combination repair/plug units skip this
step.) Cement the injured channel and fill the injury from the inside of the tire with the repair plug
per
repair material manufacturer's recommendations. Without stretching the plug, cut the plug off just
above the inside tire surface.
3. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair material selection.
Repair Unit Selection
Important Do not install the repair unit in this step.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1804
1. Center the repair unit over the injury as a reference and outline an area larger than the unit so
that buffing will not remove the crayon marks. 2. Remove the repair unit. 3. DO NOT overlap
previous or multiple repair units. 4. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair unit
selection.
Buffing
1. To prevent contamination and preserve the outline, buff within the marked area thoroughly and
evenly with a low speed buffing tool using a fine
wire brush or gritted rasp.
2. Buff to a smooth velvet surface (RMA #1 or #2 buffed texture). 3. Use caution not to gouge the
inner liner or expose casing fabric. 4. Remove any buffing dust with a vacuum cleaner. 5. Consult
your repair material supplier for a proper buffing tool.
Cementing
Apply chemical cement according to the repair material manufacturer's procedures.
Repair Unit Application
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1805
1. The tire must be in the relaxed position when the repair unit is installed (Do not spread the beads
excessively).
Two-Piece Plug and Repair Units
1. If applicable, install the repair unit so that the alignment is correct. 2. Center the repair unit over
the injury and stitch down thoroughly with the stitching tool, working from the center out.
3. Being careful not to stretch the plug material, cut the plug flush with the outer tread.
Combination Repair/Plug Units
1. Pull the plug through the injury until the repair just reaches the liner. Stitch down thoroughly. 2.
Follow the repair material manufacturer's recommendations for further installation instructions.
2. Consult your repair material supplier for the proper stitching tool.
Safety Cage
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1806
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
Final Inspection
1. After remounting and inflating the tire, check both beads, the repair and the valve with a water
and soap solution in order to detect leaks. 2. If the tire continues to lose air, the tire must be
demounted and reinspected. 3. Balance the tire and wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Assembly Balancing - OFF Vehicle.
For additional tire puncture repair information, contact:
Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05-03-10-020C > Apr > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in
Tires
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-020C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-03-10-020B (Section 03 - Suspension).
GM's Position on the Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
General Motors does not oppose the use of purified nitrogen as an inflation gas for tires. We expect
the theoretical benefits to be reduced in practical use due to the lack of an existing infrastructure to
continuously facilitate inflating tires with nearly pure nitrogen. Even occasional inflation with
compressed atmospheric air will negate many of the theoretical benefits. Given those theoretical
benefits, practical limitations, and the robust design of GM original equipment TPC tires, the
realized benefits to our customer of inflating their tires with purified nitrogen are expected to be
minimal.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Under Controlled Conditions
Recently, nitrogen gas (for use in inflating tires) has become available to the general consumer
through some retailers. The use of nitrogen gas to inflate tires is a technology used in automobile
racing. The following benefits under controlled conditions are attributed to nitrogen gas and its
unique properties:
- A reduction in the expected loss of Tire Pressure over time.
- A reduction in the variance of Tire Pressures with temperature changes due to reduction of water
vapor concentration.
- A reduction of long term rubber degradation due to a decrease in oxygen concentrations.
Important These are obtainable performance improvements when relatively pure nitrogen gas is
used to inflate tires under controlled conditions.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Real World Use
Nitrogen inflation can provide some benefit by reducing gas migration (pressure loss) at the
molecular level through the tire structure. NHTSA (National Highway Traffic Safety Administration)
has stated that the inflation pressure loss of tires can be up to 5% a month. Nitrogen molecules are
larger than oxygen molecules and, therefore, are less prone to "seeping" through the tire casing.
The actual obtainable benefits of nitrogen vary, based on the physical construction and the
materials used in the manufacturing of the tire being inflated.
Another potential benefit of nitrogen is the reduced oxidation of tire components. Research has
demonstrated that oxygen consumed in the oxidation process of the tire primarily comes from the
inflation media. Therefore, it is reasonable to assume that oxidation of tire components can be
reduced if the tire is inflated with pure nitrogen. However, only very small amounts of oxygen are
required to begin the normal oxidation process. Even slight contamination of the tire inflation gas
with compressed atmospheric air during normal inflation pressure maintenance, may negate the
benefits of using nitrogen.
GM Tire Quality, Technology and Focus of Importance
Since 1972, General Motors has designed tires under the TPC (Tire Performance Criteria)
specification system, which includes specific requirements that ensure robust tire performance
under normal usage. General Motors works with tire suppliers to design and manufacture original
equipment tires for GM vehicles. The GM TPC addresses required performance with respect to
both inflation pressure retention, and endurance properties for original equipment tires. The
inflation pressure retention requirements address availability of oxygen and oxidation concerns,
while endurance requirements ensure the mechanical structure of the tire has sufficient strength.
This combination has provided our customers with tires that maintain their structural integrity
throughout their useful treadlife under normal operating conditions.
Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance. Maintaining the
correct inflation pressure allows the tire to perform as intended by the vehicle manufacturer in
many areas, including comfort, fuel economy, stopping distance, cornering, traction, treadwear,
and noise. Since the load carrying capability of a tire is related to inflation pressure, proper inflation
pressure maintenance is necessary for the tire to support the load imposed by the vehicle without
excessive structural
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05-03-10-020C > Apr > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in
Tires > Page 1811
degradation.
Important Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 00-00-90-002J > Jan > 09 > Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure
Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-90-002J
Date: January 28, 2009
Subject: Information on Proper Tire Pressure
Models: 2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3, H3T 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and clarify additional information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-90-002I (Section 00 - General Information).
Important:
^ Adjustment of tire pressure for a customer with a Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) light on and
no codes in the TPM system is NOT a warrantable repair. Claims to simply adjust the tire pressure
will be rejected.
^ ALL tires (including the spare tire) MUST be set to the recommended inflation pressure stated on
the vehicle's tire placard (on driver's door) during the PRE-DELIVERY INSPECTION (PDI).
Recommended inflation pressure is not the pressure printed on tire sidewall.
^ Tires may be over-inflated from the assembly plant due to the mounting process.
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature change will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure change.
^ 2008-2009 HUMMER H2 Only - The H2 comes standard with Light Truck "D" Load Range tires
with a recommended cold inflation pressure of 289 kPa (42 psi). These tires will alert the driver to a
low pressure situation at roughly 262 kPa (38 psi) due to a requirement in FMVSS 138 which
specifies a Minimum Activation Pressure for each tire type. This creates a relatively narrow window
of "usable" pressure values and the warning will be more sensitive to outside temperature changes
during the colder months. As with other cold temperature/tire pressure issues, there is nothing
wrong with the system itself. If a vehicle is brought in with this concern, check for tire damage and
set all tires to the Recommended Cold Inflation Pressure shown on the vehicle placard.
Accurate tire pressures ensure the safe handling and appropriate ride characteristics of GM cars
and trucks. It is critical that the tire pressure be adjusted to the specifications on the vehicle¡C■s
tire placard during PDI.
Ride, handling and road noise concerns may be caused by improperly adjusted tire pressure.
The first step in the diagnosis of these concerns is to verify that the tires are inflated to the correct
pressures. The recommended tire inflation pressure is listed on the vehicle¡C■s tire placard. The
tire placard is located on the driver¡C■s side front or rear door edge, center pillar, or the rear
compartment lid.
Tip
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature increase will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure increase.
^ The definition of a "cold" tire is one that has been sitting for at least 3 hours, or driven no more
than 1.6 km (1 mi).
^ On extremely cold days, if the vehicle has been indoors, it may be necessary to compensate for
the low external temperature by adding additional air to the tire during PDI.
^ During cold weather, the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator light (a yellow horseshoe with an
exclamation point) may illuminate. If this indicator turns off after the tires warm up (reach operating
temperature), the tire pressure should be reset to placard pressure at the cold temperature.
^ The TPM system will work correctly with nitrogen in tires.
^ The TPM system is compatible with the GM Vehicle Care Tire Sealant but may not be with other
commercially available sealants.
Important:
^ Do not use the tire pressure indicated on the tire itself as a guide.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 00-00-90-002J > Jan > 09 > Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure
Information > Page 1816
^ Always inspect and adjust the pressure when the tires are cold.
^ Vehicles that have different pressures for the front and the rear need to be adjusted after tire
rotation.
Improper tire inflation may result in any or all of the following conditions:
^ Premature tire wear
^ Harsh ride
^ Excessive road noise
^ Poor handling
^ Reduced fuel economy
^ Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Light ON
^ Low Tire Pressure Message on the Drivers Information Center (DIC)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 662003 > Nov > 96 > Front Tire Tread - Contacts Inner Fender Bolts
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Tire Tread - Contacts Inner Fender Bolts
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 66-20-03
Date: November, 1996
Subject: Front Tire Tread Contacts Lower Inner Fender Bolts (Replace Lower Bolts)
Models: 1994-96 Chevrolet and GMC T Models with High Wider Option (RPO ZR2)
Condition
Some owners may comment that when turning, the front tire tread rubs against the inner fender
lower bolts and damages the tread.
Cause
The installation of non-OEM wheels and/or tires may contribute to tire to inner fender bolt contact.
Also, if the steering alignment, including suspension "Z" height is not within the specifications in
Section 3A of the S/T Truck Service Manual, tire tread to inner fender bolt contact can occur.
Correction
Replace the two lower rear inner fender Hex Head Bolts with Pan Head Bolts. These bolts provide
additional tire to bolt head clearance and reduce the possibility of tread damage.
Service Procedure
Notice:
Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use ONLY the
exact part number for that application General Motors will call out the fasteners that require thread
lockers or thread sealant. Unless otherwise specified, do not use supplemental coatings (paints,
greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint interfaces. Generally,
such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and joint clamping force, and may damage the
fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening sequence and specifications.
Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and systems.
1. Remove the two rear lower inner fender to wheel house panel bolts.
2. Install new bolts (P/N 15715627) and torque to 29 N.m (21 lb ft).
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
15715627 Pan Head Bolt 4/vehicle
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 463501 > Apr > 95 > Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering
Returnability
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
File in Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 46-35-01
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Front Tire Wear and/or Steering Returnability (Set to New Alignment Specification)
Models: 1991-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models 1991-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
CONDITION Some owners may comment on excessive front tire wear and/or steering returnability.
PERFORM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION BEFORE ALIGNMENT
CORRECTION The following procedures should be used to address customer's concerns about
front tire wear and/or steering returnability:
1. Check to be sure the tire pressure is set to GVW Certification/Tire label specifications located on
the driver's door lock pillar.
Important:
It is essential proper tire rotation schedule be followed at proper intervals to minimize tire wear.
2. 4WD ONLY, front suspension "Z" height dimension and setting must be made prior to any other
alignment changes.
3. Perform front wheel alignment to the specifications in chart (figure).
Notice:
Vehicle must be jounced three times before checking alignment to eliminate false geometry
readings.
a. For 4WD only, front suspension "Z" height dimension 122 ± 6.0 mm (4.8 ± 0.2 inch), left and
right side to be equal within 6 mm.
b. Left and right side to be equal within 0.5".
c. Left and right side to be equal within 1.0".
d. Steering wheel must be held in straight ahead position with ± 3.0". Front individual toe must be
equalized relative to rear wheel thrust angle.
e. GVW alignment is the same for all vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 433502 > Jul > 94 > Tires - Speed Rated Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Speed Rated Information
Group Ref.: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 433502
Date: July, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: SPEED RATED TIRES
MODELS: 1995 AND PRIOR YEAR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
All original equipment passenger car and light duty truck tires used by General Motors have a
speed rating symbol molded on their sidewall. This speed symbol, along with the tire's load index,
make up the service description that follows the tire's size. The original equipment tire size, speed
rating, and recommended inflation pressure are listed on the tire placard usually located on the
driver's door edge. WHEN REPLACING TIRES, NEVER INSTALL A TIRE THAT IS A SMALLER
SIZE OR LESSER SPEED RATING THAN THAT USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT. As in the
past, it is recommended that replacement tires have a TPC (Tire Performance Criteria) number on
the sidewall that is identical to that on the original tires.
Common speed rating on tires used by General Motors are as follows: (see illustration)
IMPORTANT:
Most base all season tires and touring tires used by GM are S rated. Performance tires will usually
have a higher speed rating. High performance tires are usually Z rated. Z rated tires carry the Z
symbol within the tire size, rather than after the size in the service description. These speeds apply
only at the tire's full pressure. An underinflated tire will not meet its speed rating capability.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 323501 > Dec > 93 > Tires - Manufacturers' Assistance
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Manufacturers' Assistance
Group Ref.: Steering/ Suspension Bulletin No.: 323501 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TIRE MANUFACTURERS' CONTACTS FOR ASSISTANCE
MODELS: 1991-94 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
General Tire has established a "Tire Fix" Department to assist you with anything from a tire
adjustment to the location of the nearest General Tire dealer. "Tire Fix" representatives are
available Monday through Friday from 8:00 A.M. to 6:00 P.M. Eastern Time at 1-800-847-3349.
A General Tire Brochure is provided for review with all appropriate dealer personnel. A single
contact point at General Tire can assist you with most aspects of their product to satisfy your
customers' needs.
Other tire manufacturers can be contacted for assistance at the Toll Free Numbers listed in
illustration:
Please retain this information for future reference.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair Procedures
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-001F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Puncture Repair Procedures For All Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-03-10-001E (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin covers puncture repair procedures for passenger car and light duty truck radial tires in
the tread area only. The tire manufacturer must be contacted for its individual repair policy and
whether or not the speed rating is retained after repair.
Caution
- Tire changing can be dangerous and should be done by trained professionals using proper tools
and procedures. Always read and understand any manufacturer's warnings contained in their
customers literature or molded into the tire sidewall.
- Serious eye and ear injury may result from not wearing adequate eye and ear protection while
repairing tires.
- NEVER inflate beyond 275 kPa (40 pounds) pressure to seat beads.
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
- NEVER stand, lean or reach over the assembly during inflation.
Repairable area on a radial tire.
Important
- NEVER repair tires worn to the tread indicators 1.59 mm (2/32") remaining depth).
- NEVER repair tires with a tread puncture larger than 6.35 mm (1/4").
- NEVER substitute an inner tube for a permissible or non-permissible repair.
- NEVER perform an outside-in tire repair (plug only, on the wheel).
- Every tire must be removed from the wheel for proper inspection and repair.
- Regardless of the type of repair used, the repair must seal the inner liner and fill the injury.
- Consult with repair material supplier/manufacturer for repair unit application procedures and
repair tools/repair material recommendations.
Three basic steps for tire puncture repair:
1. Remove the tire from the wheel for inspection and repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1838
2. Fill the injury (puncture) to keep moisture out. 3. Seal the inner liner with a repair unit to prevent
air loss.
External Inspection
1. Prior to demounting, inspect the tire surface, the valve and the wheel for the source of the leak
by using a water and soap solution. Mark the
injured area and totally deflate the tire by removing the valve core.
2. Demount the tire from the wheel and place the tire on a well-lighted spreader.
Internal Inspection
1. Spread the beads and mark the puncture with a tire crayon. 2. Inspect the inner tire for any signs
of internal damage. 3. Remove the puncturing object, noting the direction of the penetration. 4.
Probe the injury with a blunt awl in order to determine the extent and direction of the injury. 5.
Remove any loose foreign material from the injury. 6. Punctures exceeding 6.35 mm (1/4") should
not be repaired.
Cleaning
1. Clean the area around the puncture thoroughly with a proper liner cleaner, clean cloth and a
scraper. This step serves to remove dirt and mold
lubricants to insure proper adhesion and non-contamination of the buffing tool.
2. Refer to information on the product or manufacturer's Material Safety Data Sheet and follow
guidelines for handling and disposal.
Clean the Injury Channel
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1839
1. Use a proper hand reamer, carbide cutter or drill bit to ream the puncture channel from the inside
of the tire in order to clean the injury. 2. Remove steel wires protruding above the liner surface to
prevent damage to the repair unit. 3. Consult your repair material supplier for recommended
reaming tool(s).
Fill the Injury
1. It is necessary to fill the injury channel to provide back up for the repair unit and to prevent
moisture from entering the tire fabric and steel wires. 2. (For combination repair/plug units skip this
step.) Cement the injured channel and fill the injury from the inside of the tire with the repair plug
per
repair material manufacturer's recommendations. Without stretching the plug, cut the plug off just
above the inside tire surface.
3. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair material selection.
Repair Unit Selection
Important Do not install the repair unit in this step.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1840
1. Center the repair unit over the injury as a reference and outline an area larger than the unit so
that buffing will not remove the crayon marks. 2. Remove the repair unit. 3. DO NOT overlap
previous or multiple repair units. 4. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair unit
selection.
Buffing
1. To prevent contamination and preserve the outline, buff within the marked area thoroughly and
evenly with a low speed buffing tool using a fine
wire brush or gritted rasp.
2. Buff to a smooth velvet surface (RMA #1 or #2 buffed texture). 3. Use caution not to gouge the
inner liner or expose casing fabric. 4. Remove any buffing dust with a vacuum cleaner. 5. Consult
your repair material supplier for a proper buffing tool.
Cementing
Apply chemical cement according to the repair material manufacturer's procedures.
Repair Unit Application
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1841
1. The tire must be in the relaxed position when the repair unit is installed (Do not spread the beads
excessively).
Two-Piece Plug and Repair Units
1. If applicable, install the repair unit so that the alignment is correct. 2. Center the repair unit over
the injury and stitch down thoroughly with the stitching tool, working from the center out.
3. Being careful not to stretch the plug material, cut the plug flush with the outer tread.
Combination Repair/Plug Units
1. Pull the plug through the injury until the repair just reaches the liner. Stitch down thoroughly. 2.
Follow the repair material manufacturer's recommendations for further installation instructions.
2. Consult your repair material supplier for the proper stitching tool.
Safety Cage
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 04-03-10-001F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair
Procedures > Page 1842
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
Final Inspection
1. After remounting and inflating the tire, check both beads, the repair and the valve with a water
and soap solution in order to detect leaks. 2. If the tire continues to lose air, the tire must be
demounted and reinspected. 3. Balance the tire and wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Assembly Balancing - OFF Vehicle.
For additional tire puncture repair information, contact:
Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05-03-10-020C > Apr > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-020C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-03-10-020B (Section 03 - Suspension).
GM's Position on the Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
General Motors does not oppose the use of purified nitrogen as an inflation gas for tires. We expect
the theoretical benefits to be reduced in practical use due to the lack of an existing infrastructure to
continuously facilitate inflating tires with nearly pure nitrogen. Even occasional inflation with
compressed atmospheric air will negate many of the theoretical benefits. Given those theoretical
benefits, practical limitations, and the robust design of GM original equipment TPC tires, the
realized benefits to our customer of inflating their tires with purified nitrogen are expected to be
minimal.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Under Controlled Conditions
Recently, nitrogen gas (for use in inflating tires) has become available to the general consumer
through some retailers. The use of nitrogen gas to inflate tires is a technology used in automobile
racing. The following benefits under controlled conditions are attributed to nitrogen gas and its
unique properties:
- A reduction in the expected loss of Tire Pressure over time.
- A reduction in the variance of Tire Pressures with temperature changes due to reduction of water
vapor concentration.
- A reduction of long term rubber degradation due to a decrease in oxygen concentrations.
Important These are obtainable performance improvements when relatively pure nitrogen gas is
used to inflate tires under controlled conditions.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Real World Use
Nitrogen inflation can provide some benefit by reducing gas migration (pressure loss) at the
molecular level through the tire structure. NHTSA (National Highway Traffic Safety Administration)
has stated that the inflation pressure loss of tires can be up to 5% a month. Nitrogen molecules are
larger than oxygen molecules and, therefore, are less prone to "seeping" through the tire casing.
The actual obtainable benefits of nitrogen vary, based on the physical construction and the
materials used in the manufacturing of the tire being inflated.
Another potential benefit of nitrogen is the reduced oxidation of tire components. Research has
demonstrated that oxygen consumed in the oxidation process of the tire primarily comes from the
inflation media. Therefore, it is reasonable to assume that oxidation of tire components can be
reduced if the tire is inflated with pure nitrogen. However, only very small amounts of oxygen are
required to begin the normal oxidation process. Even slight contamination of the tire inflation gas
with compressed atmospheric air during normal inflation pressure maintenance, may negate the
benefits of using nitrogen.
GM Tire Quality, Technology and Focus of Importance
Since 1972, General Motors has designed tires under the TPC (Tire Performance Criteria)
specification system, which includes specific requirements that ensure robust tire performance
under normal usage. General Motors works with tire suppliers to design and manufacture original
equipment tires for GM vehicles. The GM TPC addresses required performance with respect to
both inflation pressure retention, and endurance properties for original equipment tires. The
inflation pressure retention requirements address availability of oxygen and oxidation concerns,
while endurance requirements ensure the mechanical structure of the tire has sufficient strength.
This combination has provided our customers with tires that maintain their structural integrity
throughout their useful treadlife under normal operating conditions.
Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance. Maintaining the
correct inflation pressure allows the tire to perform as intended by the vehicle manufacturer in
many areas, including comfort, fuel economy, stopping distance, cornering, traction, treadwear,
and noise. Since the load carrying capability of a tire is related to inflation pressure, proper inflation
pressure maintenance is necessary for the tire to support the load imposed by the vehicle without
excessive structural
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 05-03-10-020C > Apr > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires >
Page 1847
degradation.
Important Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 00-00-90-002J > Jan > 09 > Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-90-002J
Date: January 28, 2009
Subject: Information on Proper Tire Pressure
Models: 2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3, H3T 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and clarify additional information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-90-002I (Section 00 - General Information).
Important:
^ Adjustment of tire pressure for a customer with a Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) light on and
no codes in the TPM system is NOT a warrantable repair. Claims to simply adjust the tire pressure
will be rejected.
^ ALL tires (including the spare tire) MUST be set to the recommended inflation pressure stated on
the vehicle's tire placard (on driver's door) during the PRE-DELIVERY INSPECTION (PDI).
Recommended inflation pressure is not the pressure printed on tire sidewall.
^ Tires may be over-inflated from the assembly plant due to the mounting process.
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature change will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure change.
^ 2008-2009 HUMMER H2 Only - The H2 comes standard with Light Truck "D" Load Range tires
with a recommended cold inflation pressure of 289 kPa (42 psi). These tires will alert the driver to a
low pressure situation at roughly 262 kPa (38 psi) due to a requirement in FMVSS 138 which
specifies a Minimum Activation Pressure for each tire type. This creates a relatively narrow window
of "usable" pressure values and the warning will be more sensitive to outside temperature changes
during the colder months. As with other cold temperature/tire pressure issues, there is nothing
wrong with the system itself. If a vehicle is brought in with this concern, check for tire damage and
set all tires to the Recommended Cold Inflation Pressure shown on the vehicle placard.
Accurate tire pressures ensure the safe handling and appropriate ride characteristics of GM cars
and trucks. It is critical that the tire pressure be adjusted to the specifications on the vehicle¡C■s
tire placard during PDI.
Ride, handling and road noise concerns may be caused by improperly adjusted tire pressure.
The first step in the diagnosis of these concerns is to verify that the tires are inflated to the correct
pressures. The recommended tire inflation pressure is listed on the vehicle¡C■s tire placard. The
tire placard is located on the driver¡C■s side front or rear door edge, center pillar, or the rear
compartment lid.
Tip
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature increase will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure increase.
^ The definition of a "cold" tire is one that has been sitting for at least 3 hours, or driven no more
than 1.6 km (1 mi).
^ On extremely cold days, if the vehicle has been indoors, it may be necessary to compensate for
the low external temperature by adding additional air to the tire during PDI.
^ During cold weather, the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator light (a yellow horseshoe with an
exclamation point) may illuminate. If this indicator turns off after the tires warm up (reach operating
temperature), the tire pressure should be reset to placard pressure at the cold temperature.
^ The TPM system will work correctly with nitrogen in tires.
^ The TPM system is compatible with the GM Vehicle Care Tire Sealant but may not be with other
commercially available sealants.
Important:
^ Do not use the tire pressure indicated on the tire itself as a guide.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 00-00-90-002J > Jan > 09 > Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure Information
> Page 1852
^ Always inspect and adjust the pressure when the tires are cold.
^ Vehicles that have different pressures for the front and the rear need to be adjusted after tire
rotation.
Improper tire inflation may result in any or all of the following conditions:
^ Premature tire wear
^ Harsh ride
^ Excessive road noise
^ Poor handling
^ Reduced fuel economy
^ Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Light ON
^ Low Tire Pressure Message on the Drivers Information Center (DIC)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 463501 > Apr > 95 > Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Front Tire Wear/Steering Returnability
File in Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 46-35-01
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Front Tire Wear and/or Steering Returnability (Set to New Alignment Specification)
Models: 1991-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models 1991-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
CONDITION Some owners may comment on excessive front tire wear and/or steering returnability.
PERFORM PRELIMINARY INSPECTION BEFORE ALIGNMENT
CORRECTION The following procedures should be used to address customer's concerns about
front tire wear and/or steering returnability:
1. Check to be sure the tire pressure is set to GVW Certification/Tire label specifications located on
the driver's door lock pillar.
Important:
It is essential proper tire rotation schedule be followed at proper intervals to minimize tire wear.
2. 4WD ONLY, front suspension "Z" height dimension and setting must be made prior to any other
alignment changes.
3. Perform front wheel alignment to the specifications in chart (figure).
Notice:
Vehicle must be jounced three times before checking alignment to eliminate false geometry
readings.
a. For 4WD only, front suspension "Z" height dimension 122 ± 6.0 mm (4.8 ± 0.2 inch), left and
right side to be equal within 6 mm.
b. Left and right side to be equal within 0.5".
c. Left and right side to be equal within 1.0".
d. Steering wheel must be held in straight ahead position with ± 3.0". Front individual toe must be
equalized relative to rear wheel thrust angle.
e. GVW alignment is the same for all vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 433502 > Jul > 94 > Tires - Speed Rated Information
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Speed Rated Information
Group Ref.: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 433502
Date: July, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: SPEED RATED TIRES
MODELS: 1995 AND PRIOR YEAR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
All original equipment passenger car and light duty truck tires used by General Motors have a
speed rating symbol molded on their sidewall. This speed symbol, along with the tire's load index,
make up the service description that follows the tire's size. The original equipment tire size, speed
rating, and recommended inflation pressure are listed on the tire placard usually located on the
driver's door edge. WHEN REPLACING TIRES, NEVER INSTALL A TIRE THAT IS A SMALLER
SIZE OR LESSER SPEED RATING THAN THAT USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT. As in the
past, it is recommended that replacement tires have a TPC (Tire Performance Criteria) number on
the sidewall that is identical to that on the original tires.
Common speed rating on tires used by General Motors are as follows: (see illustration)
IMPORTANT:
Most base all season tires and touring tires used by GM are S rated. Performance tires will usually
have a higher speed rating. High performance tires are usually Z rated. Z rated tires carry the Z
symbol within the tire size, rather than after the size in the service description. These speeds apply
only at the tire's full pressure. An underinflated tire will not meet its speed rating capability.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Tires: > 323501 > Dec > 93 > Tires - Manufacturers' Assistance
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Manufacturers' Assistance
Group Ref.: Steering/ Suspension Bulletin No.: 323501 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TIRE MANUFACTURERS' CONTACTS FOR ASSISTANCE
MODELS: 1991-94 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
General Tire has established a "Tire Fix" Department to assist you with anything from a tire
adjustment to the location of the nearest General Tire dealer. "Tire Fix" representatives are
available Monday through Friday from 8:00 A.M. to 6:00 P.M. Eastern Time at 1-800-847-3349.
A General Tire Brochure is provided for review with all appropriate dealer personnel. A single
contact point at General Tire can assist you with most aspects of their product to satisfy your
customers' needs.
Other tire manufacturers can be contacted for assistance at the Toll Free Numbers listed in
illustration:
Please retain this information for future reference.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1873
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1874
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1875
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels >
Page 1880
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1886
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1887
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1888
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels > Page 1893
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1898
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1899
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV)
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1904
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1905
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1906
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels > Page 1911
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust
Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-03-10-102 > Jun > 99 > Warranty - OE Chrome Plated
Aluminum Wheel ID
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
File In Section: 03 - Suspension
Bulletin No.: 99-03-10-102
Date: June, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Original Equipment Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel Identification
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Chrome plated aluminum wheels have been returned to the Warranty Parts Center that are not the
original equipment (OE) components.
Original equipment chrome plated aluminum wheels can be identified by either a balance weight
clip retention groove (1) or a step (2) that is machined around both of the wheel's rim flanges. The
rim flanges (3) of painted original equipment aluminum wheels do not have a groove or a step.
Chrome plated aluminum wheels that do not have the wheel rim flange groove or step are
aftermarket chrome plated components and are NOT warrantable. Any aftermarket chrome wheels
received by the Warranty Parts Center will be charged back to the dealership.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 72-05-05 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420
Wheel Replace
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-05
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Using EO42O Wheel Replace
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide service personnel with guidelines for using the above
subject labor operation.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Aluminum Wheels (including chrome plated) with Porosity - Wheels that exhibit porosity should
be repaired as described in the vehicle service manual. Wheels should not be replaced without
wholesale approval.
^ Aluminum Wheels (except chrome plated) with a "Finish Defect" - Wheels that exhibit a defect in
the finish, (i.e., discoloration or surface degradation) should be refinished as described in the
Corporate Service Bulletin Number 53-17-03A released in May, 1996.
^ Chrome Wheels - Wheels that are chromed and found to have a finish defect can only be
replaced.
^ Aluminum and chrome wheels replaced under warranty will be subject to random part review and
inspection. Those wheels inspected and found not to be defective and/or should have been
repaired, will be subject to charge back.
Wheels damaged by normal wear, road hazards, car wash brushes, or other physical or chemical
damage are not eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
Technical Service Bulletin # 531703A Date: 960501
Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 53-17-03A
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Models: 1991-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to delete the 1990 model year and add the 1996 model year. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-17-03 (Section 10 - Body).
This bulletin supersedes and cancels all previous service bulletins concerning the refinishing of
aluminum wheels. The purpose of this service bulletin is to assist dealerships in repairing the
discoloration or surface degradation that has occurred on styled aluminum wheels.
This bulletin provides NEW PROCEDURES AND SPECIFIC MATERIALS for the refinishing of
painted aluminum wheels or aluminum wheels with discoloration or surface degradation.
Important:
THE RE-MACHINING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE RE-CLEAR
COATING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NO LONGER RECOMMENDED DUE TO CONCERNS OF
REPAIR DURABILITY
The new procedure requires the wheel surface be plastic media blasted to remove old paint or
clear coat. CHEMICAL STRIPPERS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED.
Material Required
System 1: DuPont Products
3939-S Cleaning Solvent 615/616 Etching Primer URO 5000 Primer Surfacer IMRON 6000
Basecoat 3440-S IMRON Clear
System 2: PPG Products
DX533 Aluminum Cleaner DX503 Aluminum Conditioner DP Epoxy Primer Deltron Basecoat
(DBC) Concept 2001 Clear Acrylic Urethane
System 3: Spies Hecker
Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090 Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070 Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080
Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 Permahyd H.S. Clearcoat 8060
Color Selection
If the wheels being painted were previously clearcoated aluminum, we would recommend using
Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a
very bright look. As an option to the customer, you may also use body color. For color
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page
1928
selection and verification, refer to your paint manufacturer's color book. On wheels that were
previous clearcoated aluminum it is recommended that all four wheels and their center caps be
refinished to maintain color uniformity.
Important:
THE PRODUCTS LISTED MUST BE USED AS A SYSTEM. DO NOT MIX OTHER
MANUFACTURERS' PRODUCT LINES WITH THE REQUIRED MATERIALS. PRODUCTS
LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN HAVE SHOWN THE REQUIRED REPAIR DURABILITY, AND
CURRENTLY ARE THE ONLY PAINT SYSTEMS THAT MEET GM SPECIFICATION
4350M-A336.
Procedures
1. Remove wheels from vehicle. Tires may remain mounted on wheels.
2. Remove balance weights and mark their location on tire.
3. Wipe excess grease, etc. from wheels with wax and grease remover.
4. Have wheels plastic media blasted to remove clearcoat. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON
MEDIA BLASTING IN YOUR AREA, CALL US TECHNOLOGIES INC., CONTACT DAVE
ROSENBURG AT 1-800-634-9185.
Caution:
IT IS MANDATORY THAT ADEQUATE RESPIRATORY PROTECTION BE WORN. EXAMPLES
OF SUCH PROTECTION ARE: AIR LINE RESPIRATORS WITH FULL HOOD OR HALF MASK. IF
NOT AVAILABLE, USE A VAPOR/PARTICULATE RESPIRATOR THAT RESPIRATOR
MANUFACTURER RECOMMENDS AS EFFECTIVE FOR ISOCYANATE VAPOR AND MISTS
(UNLESS LOCAL REGULATIONS PREVAIL).
5. Painting Process
a. Refer to Attachments 1-3 for each System's individual formula and process.
b. After following the specific System's individual formula and process, follow these steps:
6. Unmask wheels.
7. Clean all wheel mounting surface of any corrosion, overspray, or dirt.
8. Install new coated balance weights, at marked locations.
9. Replace wheels on vehicle.
10. USE A TORQUE STICK ON AN IMPACT WRENCH, OR A TORQUE WRENCH TO
CONSISTENTLY AND UNIFORMLY FASTEN THE WHEEL TO THE SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR
THE VEHICLE. THE STAR PATTERN MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Important:
TORQUE STICKS MUST BE USED ANY TIME AN IMPACT WRENCH IS USED TO TIGHTEN
WHEEL NUTS.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Attachment 1 - DuPont Products
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page
1929
Painting Process
System: Dupont Products
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WA EQ9283 Dupont # C9143, Sparkle Silver WA9967
Dupont # C9339
1. Wipe wheel with cleaning solvent: 3939-S, 3949-S or 3900-S.
2. Mask off tires.
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel mounting surfaces and wheel mount surfaces.
4. Apply two coats of 615/616-S etching primer to wheel allowing 10 minutes flash between coats.
Allow to dry for 30 minutes before applying primer coat.
5. Apply URO 5000 primer 1220/193-S + accelerator 389-S using two coats at 65-70 PSI at the
gun. Allow 12-15 minutes between coats. Force bake 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
6. Scuff sand using green Scotch-Brite pad.
7. Solvent wipe before top coating.
8. Apply IMRON 6000 base coat to wheel. 2-3 coats to hiding at 60-70 PSI allowing to flash
between coats. Base coat needs to dry 20-30 minutes before clearcoat is applied.
9. Apply 3440-S clearcoat to wheel using two coats at 60-70 PSI. Flash 10-15 minutes between
coats. 389-S can be used in basecoat and clearcoat to give faster set up times.
10. Allow overnight dry before reassemble. Can be baked for 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
Attachment 2 - PPG Products
Painting Process: PPG System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WAEQ9283; PPG # DBC-3531, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
PPG # 35367
1. Wash entire wheel with aluminum cleaner DX533, mix 1:3 with water. Allow to react 2-3 minutes
and rinse thoroughly.
2. Wash entire wheel with aluminum conditioner DX5O3 straight from the container. Allow to react
2-3 minutes until pale gold or tan color develops. Rinse thoroughly and dry.
3. Mask off tires.
Important:
4. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
5. Apply 1-2 coats of DP Primer and allow to flash for 15-20 minutes.
6. Apply 2-3 coats of Deltron Basecoat (DBC) and allow to flash 20 minutes after the final coat.
7. Apply two (2) wet coats of Concept 2001 Acrylic urethane.
8. Flash 20 minutes and bake 140°F (60°C) for 30 minutes.
For more information contact your PPG Jobber.
Attachment 3 - Spies Hecker
Painting Process: Spies Hecker System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver AWEQ9283; SH-72913, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
SH-71912
1. Clean with Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090.
2. Mask off tires.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page
1930
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
4. Apply 1-1/2 coats of Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070. Mix 1:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3070 as per
TDS.
5. Allow to flash for 30 minutes.
6. Apply two (2) coats of Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080. Mix 2:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3071 as
per TDS.
7. Bake for 60 minutes at 140°F (60°C) or allow to flash for 3 hours at 68°F (20°C).
8. Apply Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 as per TDS.
9. Allow to flash 10 to 15 minutes.
10. Apply 1 to 2 coats of Permacron High Solid Clear Coat 8060 as per TDS.
11. Allow to flash 10 minutes. Then bake at 140°F (60°C) for 40 minutes.
For more information, contact your SPIES HECKER Jobber.
We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1936
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1937
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1938
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels > Page 1943
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1948
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1949
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust
Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-03-10-102 > Jun > 99 > Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum
Wheel ID
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
File In Section: 03 - Suspension
Bulletin No.: 99-03-10-102
Date: June, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Original Equipment Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel Identification
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Chrome plated aluminum wheels have been returned to the Warranty Parts Center that are not the
original equipment (OE) components.
Original equipment chrome plated aluminum wheels can be identified by either a balance weight
clip retention groove (1) or a step (2) that is machined around both of the wheel's rim flanges. The
rim flanges (3) of painted original equipment aluminum wheels do not have a groove or a step.
Chrome plated aluminum wheels that do not have the wheel rim flange groove or step are
aftermarket chrome plated components and are NOT warrantable. Any aftermarket chrome wheels
received by the Warranty Parts Center will be charged back to the dealership.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 72-05-05 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel
Replace
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-05
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Using EO42O Wheel Replace
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide service personnel with guidelines for using the above
subject labor operation.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Aluminum Wheels (including chrome plated) with Porosity - Wheels that exhibit porosity should
be repaired as described in the vehicle service manual. Wheels should not be replaced without
wholesale approval.
^ Aluminum Wheels (except chrome plated) with a "Finish Defect" - Wheels that exhibit a defect in
the finish, (i.e., discoloration or surface degradation) should be refinished as described in the
Corporate Service Bulletin Number 53-17-03A released in May, 1996.
^ Chrome Wheels - Wheels that are chromed and found to have a finish defect can only be
replaced.
^ Aluminum and chrome wheels replaced under warranty will be subject to random part review and
inspection. Those wheels inspected and found not to be defective and/or should have been
repaired, will be subject to charge back.
Wheels damaged by normal wear, road hazards, car wash brushes, or other physical or chemical
damage are not eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
Technical Service Bulletin # 531703A Date: 960501
Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 53-17-03A
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Models: 1991-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to delete the 1990 model year and add the 1996 model year. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-17-03 (Section 10 - Body).
This bulletin supersedes and cancels all previous service bulletins concerning the refinishing of
aluminum wheels. The purpose of this service bulletin is to assist dealerships in repairing the
discoloration or surface degradation that has occurred on styled aluminum wheels.
This bulletin provides NEW PROCEDURES AND SPECIFIC MATERIALS for the refinishing of
painted aluminum wheels or aluminum wheels with discoloration or surface degradation.
Important:
THE RE-MACHINING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE RE-CLEAR
COATING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NO LONGER RECOMMENDED DUE TO CONCERNS OF
REPAIR DURABILITY
The new procedure requires the wheel surface be plastic media blasted to remove old paint or
clear coat. CHEMICAL STRIPPERS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED.
Material Required
System 1: DuPont Products
3939-S Cleaning Solvent 615/616 Etching Primer URO 5000 Primer Surfacer IMRON 6000
Basecoat 3440-S IMRON Clear
System 2: PPG Products
DX533 Aluminum Cleaner DX503 Aluminum Conditioner DP Epoxy Primer Deltron Basecoat
(DBC) Concept 2001 Clear Acrylic Urethane
System 3: Spies Hecker
Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090 Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070 Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080
Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 Permahyd H.S. Clearcoat 8060
Color Selection
If the wheels being painted were previously clearcoated aluminum, we would recommend using
Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a
very bright look. As an option to the customer, you may also use body color. For color
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 1966
selection and verification, refer to your paint manufacturer's color book. On wheels that were
previous clearcoated aluminum it is recommended that all four wheels and their center caps be
refinished to maintain color uniformity.
Important:
THE PRODUCTS LISTED MUST BE USED AS A SYSTEM. DO NOT MIX OTHER
MANUFACTURERS' PRODUCT LINES WITH THE REQUIRED MATERIALS. PRODUCTS
LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN HAVE SHOWN THE REQUIRED REPAIR DURABILITY, AND
CURRENTLY ARE THE ONLY PAINT SYSTEMS THAT MEET GM SPECIFICATION
4350M-A336.
Procedures
1. Remove wheels from vehicle. Tires may remain mounted on wheels.
2. Remove balance weights and mark their location on tire.
3. Wipe excess grease, etc. from wheels with wax and grease remover.
4. Have wheels plastic media blasted to remove clearcoat. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON
MEDIA BLASTING IN YOUR AREA, CALL US TECHNOLOGIES INC., CONTACT DAVE
ROSENBURG AT 1-800-634-9185.
Caution:
IT IS MANDATORY THAT ADEQUATE RESPIRATORY PROTECTION BE WORN. EXAMPLES
OF SUCH PROTECTION ARE: AIR LINE RESPIRATORS WITH FULL HOOD OR HALF MASK. IF
NOT AVAILABLE, USE A VAPOR/PARTICULATE RESPIRATOR THAT RESPIRATOR
MANUFACTURER RECOMMENDS AS EFFECTIVE FOR ISOCYANATE VAPOR AND MISTS
(UNLESS LOCAL REGULATIONS PREVAIL).
5. Painting Process
a. Refer to Attachments 1-3 for each System's individual formula and process.
b. After following the specific System's individual formula and process, follow these steps:
6. Unmask wheels.
7. Clean all wheel mounting surface of any corrosion, overspray, or dirt.
8. Install new coated balance weights, at marked locations.
9. Replace wheels on vehicle.
10. USE A TORQUE STICK ON AN IMPACT WRENCH, OR A TORQUE WRENCH TO
CONSISTENTLY AND UNIFORMLY FASTEN THE WHEEL TO THE SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR
THE VEHICLE. THE STAR PATTERN MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Important:
TORQUE STICKS MUST BE USED ANY TIME AN IMPACT WRENCH IS USED TO TIGHTEN
WHEEL NUTS.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Attachment 1 - DuPont Products
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 1967
Painting Process
System: Dupont Products
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WA EQ9283 Dupont # C9143, Sparkle Silver WA9967
Dupont # C9339
1. Wipe wheel with cleaning solvent: 3939-S, 3949-S or 3900-S.
2. Mask off tires.
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel mounting surfaces and wheel mount surfaces.
4. Apply two coats of 615/616-S etching primer to wheel allowing 10 minutes flash between coats.
Allow to dry for 30 minutes before applying primer coat.
5. Apply URO 5000 primer 1220/193-S + accelerator 389-S using two coats at 65-70 PSI at the
gun. Allow 12-15 minutes between coats. Force bake 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
6. Scuff sand using green Scotch-Brite pad.
7. Solvent wipe before top coating.
8. Apply IMRON 6000 base coat to wheel. 2-3 coats to hiding at 60-70 PSI allowing to flash
between coats. Base coat needs to dry 20-30 minutes before clearcoat is applied.
9. Apply 3440-S clearcoat to wheel using two coats at 60-70 PSI. Flash 10-15 minutes between
coats. 389-S can be used in basecoat and clearcoat to give faster set up times.
10. Allow overnight dry before reassemble. Can be baked for 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
Attachment 2 - PPG Products
Painting Process: PPG System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WAEQ9283; PPG # DBC-3531, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
PPG # 35367
1. Wash entire wheel with aluminum cleaner DX533, mix 1:3 with water. Allow to react 2-3 minutes
and rinse thoroughly.
2. Wash entire wheel with aluminum conditioner DX5O3 straight from the container. Allow to react
2-3 minutes until pale gold or tan color develops. Rinse thoroughly and dry.
3. Mask off tires.
Important:
4. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
5. Apply 1-2 coats of DP Primer and allow to flash for 15-20 minutes.
6. Apply 2-3 coats of Deltron Basecoat (DBC) and allow to flash 20 minutes after the final coat.
7. Apply two (2) wet coats of Concept 2001 Acrylic urethane.
8. Flash 20 minutes and bake 140°F (60°C) for 30 minutes.
For more information contact your PPG Jobber.
Attachment 3 - Spies Hecker
Painting Process: Spies Hecker System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver AWEQ9283; SH-72913, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
SH-71912
1. Clean with Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090.
2. Mask off tires.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 1968
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
4. Apply 1-1/2 coats of Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070. Mix 1:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3070 as per
TDS.
5. Allow to flash for 30 minutes.
6. Apply two (2) coats of Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080. Mix 2:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3071 as
per TDS.
7. Bake for 60 minutes at 140°F (60°C) or allow to flash for 3 hours at 68°F (20°C).
8. Apply Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 as per TDS.
9. Allow to flash 10 to 15 minutes.
10. Apply 1 to 2 coats of Permacron High Solid Clear Coat 8060 as per TDS.
11. Allow to flash 10 minutes. Then bake at 140°F (60°C) for 40 minutes.
For more information, contact your SPIES HECKER Jobber.
We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Adjustments
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
These vehicles use sealed front wheel bearings which require no lubrication or adjustment.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Remove or Disconnect
Tools Required:
J 28733-A Front Hub Spindle Remover J 24319-01 Universal Steering Linkage Puller J 28712 Axle
Shaft Boot Seal Protector J 36607 Ball Joint Separator
Raise the vehicle and support with safety stands. Unload the torsion bar.
1. Tire and wheel.
Note: Install J 28712 to the tripot axle joint (fig. 44).
2. Cotter pin (122). 3. Retainer (121). 4. Nut (120).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1974
Note: Insert a drift or large screwdriver through brake caliper into rotor vanes to prevent from
turning (fig. 45).
5. Washer (119). 6. Brake Caliper.
Note: Support the caliper with a piece of wire to prevent damage to the brake hose.
7. Rotor. 8. Bolts (116).
9. Hub and bearing assembly (114) from axle joint splined shaft using J 28733-A (fig. 46).
Note: Lay the hub and bearing assembly on the hub bolt (outboard) side. This will prevent damage
or contamination of the bearing seal (fig. 47).
10. Splash shield (118). 11. Cotter pin (123). 12. Nut (124).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1975
13. Tie rod end (125) from the knuckle (117) using J 24319-01 (fig. 48). 14. Cotter pins (130).
15. Ball joints (115 and 127) from the knuckle (117) using J 36607 (fig 49).
Note: Locate J 36607 on the ball joint and back off the nut (129, 131) until the ball stud is forced out
of the knuckle.
16. Nuts (129 and 131). 17. Knuckle (117) from the ball joints. 18. Spacer (128) from the knuckle
(117). 19. Seal (126) from the knuckle (117).
Install or Connect
1. New seal (126) to the knuckle (117) using J 28574 (fig. 50). 2. Spacer (128) to the knuckle (117).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1976
3. Knuckle (117) to the upper and lower ball joints (115 and 127). 4. Nuts (129 and 131). Tighten
Nuts (129) to 83 N.m (61 lbs. ft.). Tighten Nut (131) to 113 N.m (83 lbs. ft.).
Important: Tighten the nuts to align the cotter pin. Do not tighten more than 1/6 turn.
5. New cotter pins (130). Bend the pin ends against the nut flats. 6. Splash shield(118) aligned to
the knuckle (117). 7. Hub and bearing assembly (114) (fig. 43). Align the threaded holes. 8. Bolts
(116). Tighten Bolts (116) to 105 N.m (77 lbs. ft.). 9. Tie rod end (125) to the knuckle (117).
10. Nut (124). Tighten to 48 N.m (35 lbs. ft.). 11. New cotter pin. Bend the pin ends against the nut
flats. 12. Rotor (113). 13. Brake caliper. 14. Washer (119). 15. Nut (120). Tighten to 245 N.m (181
lbs. ft.).
Note: Insert a drift or large screwdriver through brake caliper into rotor vanes to prevent from
turning (fig. 45).
16. Retainer (121). 17. New cotter pin (122).
Note: Remove J 28712.
18. Tire and wheel.
A. Lower the vehicle. B. Apply the brake pedal. C. Check vehicle trim height and align the front
end.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1977
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REAR WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Fig. 3 Axle Shaft Bearing Removal
Fig. 4 Axle Shaft Bearing Installation
Fig. 5 Axle Shaft Seal Installation
1. Remove axle shaft as described under "Rear Axle Shaft, Replace." 2. Remove axle seal by
prying behind seal steel case with a pry bar. Use caution to avoid damaging axle housing. 3. Using
a puller and slide hammer, remove axle bearing, Fig. 3. 4. Lubricate new bearing with gear
lubricant, then install bearing in axle housing with axle shaft bearing installer tool No. J-23765, or
equivalent,
until bearing is seated in housing, Fig. 4.
5. Lubricate seal lips with gear lubricant, then position seal on axle shaft seal installer tool No.
J-23771, or equivalent, and install in axle housing,
tapping into place until seal is flush with axle housing, Fig. 5.
6. Install axle shaft.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 180
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: Customer Interest Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing > Page 1990
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing > Page 1996
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1997
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Lug Nuts 95 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Minimum, 698 kPa (100 psi) @ 200 rpm. The lowest cylinder reading should not be less than 80%
of the highest. Perform compression test with engine at normal operating temperature, spark plugs
removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Camshaft Lift Specs
Camshaft: Specifications Camshaft Lift Specs
Camshaft lift should measure .357 inch at intake valves and .390 inch at exhaust valves.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Camshaft Lift Specs > Page 2008
Camshaft: Specifications Camshaft
Engine Liter/CID [04] ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................ 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Camshaft Journal Diameter .................................................................................................................
............................................................ 1.8682-1.8692 Camshaft Endplay ..........................................
.................................................................................................................................................
0.0040-0.0120 Camshaft Runout (Max.) .............................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 0.001 Lifter Diameter ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... 0.8420-0.8427 Lifter To Bore Clearance ...................................................................................
............................................................................................. 0.0008-0.0025
[04] VIN Z.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2009
Camshaft: Service and Repair
Fig. 15 Timing Mark Alignment
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove air cleaner assembly and drain cooling system. 3.
Remove rocker arm covers and pushrods. 4. Remove distributor. 5. Remove intake manifold. 6.
Remove valve lifters. 7. Remove radiator, fan and pulley. 8. Remove water pump and torsional
damper. 9. Remove timing cover.
10. Remove camshaft sprocket bolts, then the sprocket and timing chain. 11. Remove thrust plate
attaching bolts, then the thrust plate. 12. Remove camshaft. 13. Reverse procedure to install.
Ensure timing marks are properly aligned after installation of sprockets and chain, Fig. 15.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair
Fig. 10 Hydraulic Lifters And Retainer
REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
1. Remove rocker arm cover and pushrods. 2. Remove intake manifold. 3. Remove
retainer-to-engine attaching bolts, retainer and restrictors, Fig. 10. 4. Remove lifters. Note lifter
location when removing. Lifters must be installed in same bore.
DISASSEMBLY
1. Depress pushrod seat with pushrod, remove seat retainer, then slowly release spring tension. 2.
Remove pushrod seat and metering valve. 3. Invert lifter and tap on flat surface to remove plunger
and plunger spring. 4. Remove check ball retainer by prying from plunger with small screwdriver. 5.
Remove check ball spring and check ball. 6. Clean lifter components in solvent, keeping
components for each lifter separate
INSPECTION
1. Inspect lifter body for internal and external wear. Also inspect bottom for wear grooves and flat
spots. 2. Inspect roller for free operation, flat spots and pitting. Replace lifter if roller is worn, pitted
or cannot be freed up. 3. Inspect pushrod seat and replace lifter and pushrod if seat is scored or
excessively worn. 4. Inspect check ball and replace lifter if ball is pitted or scored. Do not attempt to
recondition lifter assembly by interchanging components
from other lifters. If components are damaged or worn, lifter assembly should be replaced.
ASSEMBLY
Ensure lifter components are kept clean during assembly, as small particles of dirt or lint can cause
lifter to fail. 1. Install check ball to the small hole in bottom of plunger. 2. Install check ball spring
and retainer, over check ball, then press retainer into position in plunger with small screwdriver. 3.
Install plunger spring to check ball retainer. 4. Align oil feed holes in lifter body and plunger, then
install plunger into lifter body. 5. Fill lifter with SAE 10.0 oil and proceed as follows:
a. Insert a 1/8 inch punch into plunger and press down solidly, then using a 1/16 inch punch, insert
punch through oil holes to retain plunger
down against plunger spring tension.
b. Remove 1/8 inch punch and fill lifter with SAE 10.0 oil.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2013
6. Install metering valve, pushrod seat and seat retainer. 7. Depress pushrod seat with pushrod
and remove 1/16 inch punch from lifter body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Rocker Arm
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications Rocker Arm
VALVE ADJUSTMENT (VIN Z)
WITH SCREW-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS AND POSITIVE STOP SHOULDERS
Valve Rocker Arm Nuts .......................................................................................................................
.......................................... 27 Nm (20 lb. ft.).
WITH PRESSED-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS
Refer to Rocker Arm / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Rocker Arm > Page 2018
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications Rocker Arm Stud
ROCKER ARM STUD TORQUE
^ Rocker Arm Stud to Cylinder Head
................................................................................................................................................ 47 Nm
(35 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2019
Rocker Arm Assembly: Adjustments
VALVE ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 10 Valve Adjustment
The 4.3L VIN Z engine can be equipped with two different rocker arm stud configurations that
require different valve lash procedures.
TYPE 1 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has screw-in rocker arm studs with positive stop shoulders, no
valve adjustment is necessary. When the valve train requires service, you simply tighten the rocker
arm nuts to 27 Nm (20 ft lb).
TYPE 2 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has pressed-in rocker arm studs, you must follow the valve
adjustment procedure outlined below.
1. Remove rocker arm cover. 2. Rotate engine until mark on torsional damper is aligned with "0"
mark on timing tab fastened to crankcase front cover. To ensure engine is at No.
1 cylinder firing position, place fingers on No. 1 cylinder valves as the mark on damper approaches
the "0" mark on timing tab. If valves are not moving, engine is in the No. 1 cylinder firing position. If
valves are moving, engine is in the No. 4 cylinder firing position and should be rotated one
revolution.
3. With engine in No. 1 cylinder firing position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 1, 5 and 6.
^ Intake valves 1, 2 and 3.
NOTE: Even numbered cylinders are in the left bank and odd numbered cylinders are in the right
bank, when viewed from front of the engine.
4. Back off adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then tighten nut until all lash is removed. This
can be determined by rotating pushrod while
turning adjusting nut. When all lash is removed, tighten adjusting nut 1 and 3/4 turns to center lifter
plunger.
5. Crank engine one full revolution until mark on torsional damper and "0" mark on timing tab are
again in alignment. This is the No. 4 cylinder
firing position. With engine in this position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 2, 3 and 4.
^ Intake valves 4, 5 and 6.
6. Install valve covers and related components, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rocker Arm Studs Replace
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Rocker Arm Studs Replace
Fig. 12 Rocker Arm Stud Removal
Fig. 13 Rocker Arm Stud Bore Reaming
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rocker Arm Studs Replace > Page 2022
Fig. 14 Rocker Arm Stud Installation
Rocker arm studs that have damaged threads or are loose should be replaced with oversize studs.
Oversize studs are available in 0.003 and 0.013 inch and can be installed after properly reaming
the holes as follows:
1. Remove stud using stud reamer tool No. J-5802-01, or equivalent, Fig. 12, with a nut and flat
washer placed over tool.
2. Ream hole to proper size using reamer tool No. J-5715, or equivalent, Fig. 13, for 0.003 inch
oversize or reamer tool No. J-6036, or equivalent,
for 0.013 inch oversize.
Do not install oversize stud without reaming hole since cylinder head damage could occur.
3. Apply axle lubricant to press fit area of stud and install using stud installer tool No. J-6880, or
equivalent, Fig. 14.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rocker Arm Studs Replace > Page 2023
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Rocker Arms Replace
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove air cleaner assembly, then the emission relays and
bracket. 3. Remove wiring harnesses and spark plug wires from clips and position aside. 4.
Disconnect dipstick tube from cylinder head and position tube aside. 5. Remove rocker arm cover.
6. Remove rocker arm nut, then rocker arm and ball. 7. Remove pushrod. 8. Reverse procedure to
install. Adjust valves if adjustable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications
Balance Shaft: Specifications
Engine Liter/CID ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Journal Bearing Diameter
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 2.1648-2.1654 Rear ......................................................................
......................................................................................................................................
1.4994-1.5000
Rear Bearing Journal Clearance .........................................................................................................
........................................................ 0.0010-0.0036
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2028
Balance Shaft: Service and Repair
BALANCE SHAFT REMOVAL
TOOLS REQUIRED:
J 38834 Balance Shaft Bearing Service Kit J 26941 Bearing Remover
Installing Balance Shaft And Components
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (49). 2. Driven gear (42). 3. Retainer bolts (48). 4. Retainer (43). 5. Balance shaft (47) using
a soft faced hammer. 6. Balance shaft rear bearing (45) using J 38834 and J 26941.
IMPORTANT
^ The balance shaft with front bearing are serviced as an assembly.
^ Use only the correct tools for bearing and shaft installation.
^ inspect the balance shaft driven gear and the drive gear for nicks and burrs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2029
BALANCE SHAFT INSTALLATION
TOOLS REQUIRED:
J 38834 Balance Shaft Bearing Service Kit J 36998 Balance Shaft Installer J 8092 Driver Handle J
36660 Torque/Angel Meter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Balance shaft rear bearing (45) using J 38834. Dip bearing in clean engine oil before installation.
2. Balance shaft (47) into block using J 36996 and J 8092.
A. Dip the front balance shaft bearing into clean engine oil before assembly. B. Retaining ring on
balance shaft front bearing must be seated on case.
3. Install balance shaft bearing retainer (43) and bolts (48).
TIGHTEN
^ Balance shaft retainer bolts (48) to 14 Nm (124 lbs in.).
4. Balance shaft driven gear (42) and bolt (49).
TIGHTEN
^ Balance shaft driven gear bolt (49) to 20 Nm (15 lbs. ft.) plus an additional turn of 35 degrees
using J 36660.
^ Rotate balance shaft (47) by hand to make sure there is clearance between the balance shaft
(47) and retainer (43). If balance shaft does not rotate freely, check to be sure retaining ring on
front bearing is seated on case.
Balance Shaft Drive Gear To Driven Gear Timing Marks
^ Turn the camshaft so, with the balance shaft drive gear temporarily installed, the timing mark on
the drive gear is straight up.
^ With the balance shaft drive gear removed, turn the balance shaft so the timing mark on the
driven gear (42) points straight down.
5. Balance shaft drive gear (37) onto camshaft.
IMPORTANT
^ Make sure the timing marks on the balance shaft drive gear and driven gear line up.
6. Balance shaft drive gear bolts.
TIGHTEN
^ Bolt to 16 Nm (12 lbs. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod
Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Connecting rod bearings are available in standard size and 0.001 and 0.002 inch undersize for use
with new and used standard size crankshafts and 0.010 and 0.020 inch undersize for use with
reconditioned crankshafts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Torque Specifications 45 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Customer Interest Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2044
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2045
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2046
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2047
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2048
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2049
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2050
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
Crankshaft Main Bearing: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2056
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2057
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2058
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2059
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2060
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2061
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2062
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Specifications > Bearing Undersize Availability
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications Bearing Undersize Availability
Main bearings are available in standard size and undersizes of 0.001, 0.002, 0.009, 0.010 and
0.020 inch.
Connecting rod bearings are available in standard size and 0.001 and 0.002 inch undersize for use
with new and used standard size crankshafts and 0.010 and 0.020 inch undersize for use with
reconditioned crankshafts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Main Bearing Torque Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications Main Bearing Cap
Main Bearing Cap
Torque Specifications 80 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Main Bearing Torque Specifications > Page 2069
Crankshaft: Specifications Crankshaft Dimensions
Engine Liter/CID ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Crankshaft Journals
Main Bearing Journal Diameter ...........................................................................................................
..................................................................... [6] Connecting Rod Journal Diameter
..........................................................................................................................................................
2.2487-2.2497 Maximum Out Of Round All .........................................................................................
...................................................................................... 0.0010 Runout Service Limit ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... [02]
Bearing Clearance
Main Bearings ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... [07] Connecting Rod Bearings ......................................
................................................................................................................................................... [08]
Thrust Bearing .....................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 0.0020-0.0070
Connecting Rods
Pin Clearance ......................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... [03] Side Clearance .....................................................
......................................................................................................................................
0.0060-0.0140
[02] If main journals are misaligned, crankshaft is bent & must be replaced. [03] 0.0008-0.0016 inch
interference fit. [06] Front No. 1 journal, 2.4484-2.4493 inches; Nos. 2, 3, & 4 journals,
2.4481-2.4490 inches; No. 5 journal, 2.4479-2.4488 inches. [07] Production: Front, .0008-.0020
inch; intermediate, .0011-.0023 inch; rear, .0017-.0032 inch. Service: Front, .0010-.0015 inch;
intermediate,
.0010-.0025 inch; rear, .0025-.0035 inch.
[08] Production, .0013-.0035 inch; service, .0020-.0030 inch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Crankshaft Balancer - Removal/Installation Tool
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Technical Service Bulletins Crankshaft Balancer Removal/Installation Tool
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 57-61-38
Date: January, 1996
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 6A - Engine Mechanical - Crankshaft Balancer Remover/Installer Tool Incorrectly
Referenced
Models: 1990-96 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K, P, G Models 1991-94 Oldsmobile
Bravada 1996 Oldsmobile Bravada
The crankshaft balancer remover/installer tool J 39046 listed in some 1990-96 service information
sections 6A2, 6A3, 6A4, 6A5, 6A6, 6A7, 6A2B, 6A3B, 6A4B, 6A5B, and 6A6B is incorrectly
referenced.
The correct tool number for the truck models listed above is J 23523-F or equivalent.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Engine Liter/CID ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Piston Diameter (Std.) [01] ..................................................................................................................
......................................................... 3.9988-4.0008 Piston Clearance ...............................................
..................................................................................................................................... 0.0007-0.0017
[07] Piston Pin Diameter (Std.) ............................................................................................................
.............................................................. 0.9270-0.09273 Pin To Piston Bore Clearance [05] .............
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.0010 Piston Rings
End Gap [02]
Comp. ..................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. [21] Oil ..............................................................................
......................................................................................................................................... 0.015
Side Clearance
Comp. ..................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 0.0014-0.0032 Oil ..............................................................................
........................................................................................................................... 0.0014-0.0032
[01] Measured at 90 deg. angle to piston pin. [02] Minimum. [05] Maximum. [07] Service limit,
0.0027 inch. [21] Top ring, 0.010 inch; second ring, 0.018 inch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2077
Piston: Service and Repair
Piston & rod assembly
Assemble pistons to connecting rods as shown in Fig 16
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
VALVE ADJUSTMENT (VIN Z)
WITH SCREW-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS AND POSITIVE STOP SHOULDERS
Valve Rocker Arm Nuts .......................................................................................................................
.......................................... 27 Nm (20 lb. ft.).
WITH PRESSED-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS
Refer to Rocker Arm / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 2083
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
4.3L/V6-262 Left Side...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. E-I-E-I-I-E Right Side.........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2084
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 10 Valve Adjustment
The 4.3L VIN Z engine can be equipped with two different rocker arm stud configurations that
require different valve lash procedures.
TYPE 1 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has screw-in rocker arm studs with positive stop shoulders, no
valve adjustment is necessary. When the valve train requires service, you simply tighten the rocker
arm nuts to 27 Nm (20 ft lb).
TYPE 2 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has pressed-in rocker arm studs, you must follow the valve
adjustment procedure outlined below.
1. Remove rocker arm cover. 2. Rotate engine until mark on torsional damper is aligned with "0"
mark on timing tab fastened to crankcase front cover. To ensure engine is at No.
1 cylinder firing position, place fingers on No. 1 cylinder valves as the mark on damper approaches
the "0" mark on timing tab. If valves are not moving, engine is in the No. 1 cylinder firing position. If
valves are moving, engine is in the No. 4 cylinder firing position and should be rotated one
revolution.
3. With engine in No. 1 cylinder firing position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 1, 5 and 6.
^ Intake valves 1, 2 and 3.
NOTE: Even numbered cylinders are in the left bank and odd numbered cylinders are in the right
bank, when viewed from front of the engine.
4. Back off adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then tighten nut until all lash is removed. This
can be determined by rotating pushrod while
turning adjusting nut. When all lash is removed, tighten adjusting nut 1 and 3/4 turns to center lifter
plunger.
5. Crank engine one full revolution until mark on torsional damper and "0" mark on timing tab are
again in alignment. This is the No. 4 cylinder
firing position. With engine in this position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 2, 3 and 4.
^ Intake valves 4, 5 and 6.
6. Install valve covers and related components, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2085
Valve Clearance: Service and Repair
For Valve Adjustment, Refer to Valve Clearance / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Specifications > Rocker Arm
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications Rocker Arm
VALVE ADJUSTMENT (VIN Z)
WITH SCREW-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS AND POSITIVE STOP SHOULDERS
Valve Rocker Arm Nuts .......................................................................................................................
.......................................... 27 Nm (20 lb. ft.).
WITH PRESSED-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS
Refer to Rocker Arm / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Specifications > Rocker Arm > Page 2093
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications Rocker Arm Stud
ROCKER ARM STUD TORQUE
^ Rocker Arm Stud to Cylinder Head
................................................................................................................................................ 47 Nm
(35 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2094
Rocker Arm Assembly: Adjustments
VALVE ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 10 Valve Adjustment
The 4.3L VIN Z engine can be equipped with two different rocker arm stud configurations that
require different valve lash procedures.
TYPE 1 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has screw-in rocker arm studs with positive stop shoulders, no
valve adjustment is necessary. When the valve train requires service, you simply tighten the rocker
arm nuts to 27 Nm (20 ft lb).
TYPE 2 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has pressed-in rocker arm studs, you must follow the valve
adjustment procedure outlined below.
1. Remove rocker arm cover. 2. Rotate engine until mark on torsional damper is aligned with "0"
mark on timing tab fastened to crankcase front cover. To ensure engine is at No.
1 cylinder firing position, place fingers on No. 1 cylinder valves as the mark on damper approaches
the "0" mark on timing tab. If valves are not moving, engine is in the No. 1 cylinder firing position. If
valves are moving, engine is in the No. 4 cylinder firing position and should be rotated one
revolution.
3. With engine in No. 1 cylinder firing position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 1, 5 and 6.
^ Intake valves 1, 2 and 3.
NOTE: Even numbered cylinders are in the left bank and odd numbered cylinders are in the right
bank, when viewed from front of the engine.
4. Back off adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then tighten nut until all lash is removed. This
can be determined by rotating pushrod while
turning adjusting nut. When all lash is removed, tighten adjusting nut 1 and 3/4 turns to center lifter
plunger.
5. Crank engine one full revolution until mark on torsional damper and "0" mark on timing tab are
again in alignment. This is the No. 4 cylinder
firing position. With engine in this position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 2, 3 and 4.
^ Intake valves 4, 5 and 6.
6. Install valve covers and related components, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Rocker Arm Studs Replace
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Rocker Arm Studs Replace
Fig. 12 Rocker Arm Stud Removal
Fig. 13 Rocker Arm Stud Bore Reaming
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Rocker Arm Studs Replace > Page 2097
Fig. 14 Rocker Arm Stud Installation
Rocker arm studs that have damaged threads or are loose should be replaced with oversize studs.
Oversize studs are available in 0.003 and 0.013 inch and can be installed after properly reaming
the holes as follows:
1. Remove stud using stud reamer tool No. J-5802-01, or equivalent, Fig. 12, with a nut and flat
washer placed over tool.
2. Ream hole to proper size using reamer tool No. J-5715, or equivalent, Fig. 13, for 0.003 inch
oversize or reamer tool No. J-6036, or equivalent,
for 0.013 inch oversize.
Do not install oversize stud without reaming hole since cylinder head damage could occur.
3. Apply axle lubricant to press fit area of stud and install using stud installer tool No. J-6880, or
equivalent, Fig. 14.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Rocker Arm Studs Replace > Page 2098
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Rocker Arms Replace
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove air cleaner assembly, then the emission relays and
bracket. 3. Remove wiring harnesses and spark plug wires from clips and position aside. 4.
Disconnect dipstick tube from cylinder head and position tube aside. 5. Remove rocker arm cover.
6. Remove rocker arm nut, then rocker arm and ball. 7. Remove pushrod. 8. Reverse procedure to
install. Adjust valves if adjustable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Spring: Specifications
Engine Liter/CID ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Free Length .........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [04] Out Of Square Limit ..........................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.062 Installed Height ..........................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 1.687-1.750 Pressure, Lbs. @ Inches
Closed
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 76.0-84.0 @ 1.700 Exhaust .....................................................................
...................................................................................................................... 76.0-84.0 @ 1.700
Open
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 194-206 @ 1.25 Exhaust .....................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 194-206 @ 1.25
[04] Outer spring, 2.030 inches; damper spring, 1.860 inches.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Specifications > Valve Specifications
Valve: Specifications Valve Specifications
Engine Liter/CID ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Stem Diameter Std.
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 0.3410-0.3417 Exhaust ................................................................
......................................................................................................................................
0.3410-0.3417
Maximum Tip Refinish .........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ [03] Face Angle ..........................................................
....................................................................................................................................................... 45
deg. Margin [01]
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 0.0315 Exhaust .................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.0315
Valve Lash ...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [07]
[01] Minimum. [03] Grind only enough to provide true surface. After grinding valve stems, ensure
sufficient clearance remains between rocker arm & valve spring cap
or rotator.
[07] Torque rocker arm nut to 20 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Specifications > Valve Specifications > Page 2106
Valve: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
4.3L/V6-262 Left Side...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. E-I-E-I-I-E Right Side.........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of
Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine).
Background
Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be
very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges
from $160 - $200.
EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser
tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the
guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from:
- Drive Belt Noise
- Accelerated Drive Belt Wear
- Drive Belt Slippage
Instructions
The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These
instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal
instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt.
Caution
- Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser.
- Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses
help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances.
- Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to
protect eyes from direct laser exposure.
1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
2112
2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system.
3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves
of the pulley, farthest from the front of the
engine.
4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool.
5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the
tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light
beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley
alignment.
- If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly.
- If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the
position of the power steering pulley as required.
- Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures.
9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation.
10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present.
Tool Information
Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
2113
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
2114
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Serpentine Drive Belt Wear Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-013
Date: April 29, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Serpentine Belt Wear
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
All current GM vehicles designed and manufactured in North America were assembled with
serpentine belts that are made with an EPDM material and should last the life of the vehicle. It is
extremely rare to observe any cracks in EPDM belts and it is not expected that they will require
maintenance before 10 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi) of use.
Older style belts, which were manufactured with a chloroprene compound, may exhibit cracks
depending on age. However, the onset of cracking typically signals that the belt is only about
halfway through its usable life.
A good rule of thumb for chloroprene-based belts is that if cracks are observed 3 mm (1/8 in) apart,
ALL AROUND THE BELT, the belt may be reaching the end of its serviceable life and should be
considered a candidate for changing. Small cracks spaced at greater intervals should not be
considered as indicative that the belt needs changing.
Any belt that exhibits chunking should be replaced.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2115
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Serpentine Drive Belt Routing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2116
Serpentine Belt Routing
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Use a 1/2 inch breaker bar with a socket placed on the tensioner pulley axis bolt and rotate the
tensioner to the left (counterclockwise).
CAUTION: Do NOT allow the drive belt tensioner to snap into the "free" position as this may
damage the tensioner.
2. Remove belt.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Route belt over pulleys except the belt tensioner. 2. Use a 1/2 inch breaker bar with a socket
placed on the tensioner pulley axis bolt and rotate the tensioner to the left (counterclockwise). 3.
Belt over the tensioner pulley. 4. Check the belt for correct "V" groove tracking around each pulley.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Mount: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Front Engine Mount Installation
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2120
Fig. 2 Rear Engine Mount Installtion
FRONT
1. Support engine using lifting equipment. 2. Remove engine mount through bolt and nut. 3. Raise
engine and remove mount to engine attaching bolts, Fig. 1. 4. Remove engine mount. 5. Reverse
procedure to install
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2121
REAR
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Support rear of engine using equipment. 3. Remove mount to
crossmember attaching nuts and washers. 4. Remove mount to transmission attaching bolts, then
the mount. 5. Reverse procedure to install. Tighten bolts to specifications shown in Fig. 2.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Normal Oil Pressure, Psi .....................................................................................................................
................................................. 25-50 @ 1200 RPM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001
Date: March 14, 2011
Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for
Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or
Complete Oil Change
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with
Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines
GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM)
specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
1(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification
Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General
Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The
oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains
acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be
used in those older vehicles.
In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine
oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil
specification are as follows:
- To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions.
- To promote long engine life.
- To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the
industry's overall dependence on crude oil.
dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the
following benefits:
- Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE)
requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits
throughout the life of the oil.
- More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 2130
- Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life
has been depleted.
- Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil
specifications.
International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
GF-5 Standard
In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010.
- There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4
standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos
1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a
statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for
GF-4.
- It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard.
However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification.
- Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API
will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified
products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils.
Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy
Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than
doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed
CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet
these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than
ever before.
New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel
economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM).
The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when
determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy.
However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and
exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil.
Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower
viscosity oils.
dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs:
SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30.
Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the
Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being
serviced.
GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals
To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the
GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000
mile (4,830 km) recommendation.
The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the
GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle.
If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended,
GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually.
GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 2131
The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos
(TM)specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
2(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification
- dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010
vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines.
Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting
specification CJ-4.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and
replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025.
- dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on
certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction
systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum
performance longer.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
TYPE....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................................SG, SH Note: 1992-93 Syclone, and Typhoon engine
oil must be Mobile 1 synthetic or equivalent
CAPACITY, Refill: 4-cyl. 2.5L...............................................................................................................
..............................................................................2.8 Liters 3.0 Quarts Others...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...3.8 Liters 4.0 Quarts Capacity shown is without filter. When replacing filter, additional oil may be
needed
1987-88 4.3L: Above 40°F (4°C)..........................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................30‡ Above 0°F to (-18°C)................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................10W-30* Below 60°F (16°C)..............................................................................................
..........................................................................................................5W-30
1987-88 others, 1988-94 except Syclone & Typhoon: Above 40°F (4°C)............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....30‡ Above 0°F to (-18°C)................................................................................................................
...................................................................................10W-30 All temperatures...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..........5W-30*
1992-93 Syclone, Typhoon: All temperatures......................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................10W-30
*Preferred, except V6 4.3L ‡May be used when other recommended viscosities are unavailable
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
Oil Filter: Customer Interest Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2142
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2143
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2144
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2145
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2146
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2147
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2148
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 07-06-01-016B > Jul >
09 > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2158
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2159
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2160
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2161
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2162
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2163
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 376105A > Oct > 95 >
Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 2164
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 476118 > Jun > 94 >
Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
GROUP REF.: 6 - Engine
BULLETIN NO.: 476118
DATE: June, 1994
SUBJECT: ENHANCED PF52 AND PF1218 OIL FILTERS
MODELS: 1986-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K, S/T, M/L, R/V, AND G MODELS 1991-94
OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
THIS BULLETIN CANCELS AND SUPERSEDES BULLETIN 476502 TO CORRECT THE
CATEGORY IDENTIFIER/GROUP REFERENCE. PLEASE DISCARD BULLETIN 476502 (GROUP
REFERENCE 6E- ENGINE FUEL & EMISSION).
AC Rochester will be supplying a limited number of new oil filters with enhanced anti-drainback
valves to GMSPO. Oil filters with effective anti-drainback valves may reduce or eliminate short
duration cold knock. Due to limited production capacity, the new filters are only to be used on the
following special cases.
1. Trucks or vans with short duration cold knock.
2. Routine maintenance of 1994 trucks or vans. Use the existing PF52 (P/N 25012760) and
PF1218 (P/N 25013977) oil filters for applications other
than the special cases listed above.
PART INFORMATION:
For "cold knock" vehicles or 1994 vehicle maintenance:
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER REPLACES
PF52 25160560 PF51
PF1218 25160561 PF35
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 420502 > May > 94 >
Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 420502
Date: May, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: AC ROCHESTER ENGINE OIL FILTER IDENTIFICATION
MODELS: 1994 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: DEALER SERVICE MANAGER/WARRANTY ADMINISTRATOR
The purpose of this bulletin is to notify retail/wholesale service personnel of a running change to
the AC Rochester Original Equipment engine oil filters.
Due to an agreement to decrease the number of GMSPO part numbers, AC Rochester will phase
in a decision to make all Original Equipment engine oil filters blue; same color used on AC
aftermarket engine oil filters. This means that eventually the use of black Original Equipment
engine oil filters will be discontinued.
For the purpose of Warranty/Policy administration, the following will assist retail/wholesale service
personnel in identifying the difference between blue Original Equipment and aftermarket engine oil
filters:
^ AFTERMARKET FILTER: will continue to use "AC DURAGUARD OIL FILTER" label.
^ OE FILTER: will have a black bar code, Julian date code and the letters "OE" printed on the
dome of the filter. At this time, it is anticipated that all OE engine oil filters will be changed by May
1994.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 07-06-01-016B > Jul > 09
> Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 476118 > Jun > 94 > Oil
Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Filters - Enhanced Anti-Drainback Valves
GROUP REF.: 6 - Engine
BULLETIN NO.: 476118
DATE: June, 1994
SUBJECT: ENHANCED PF52 AND PF1218 OIL FILTERS
MODELS: 1986-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K, S/T, M/L, R/V, AND G MODELS 1991-94
OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
THIS BULLETIN CANCELS AND SUPERSEDES BULLETIN 476502 TO CORRECT THE
CATEGORY IDENTIFIER/GROUP REFERENCE. PLEASE DISCARD BULLETIN 476502 (GROUP
REFERENCE 6E- ENGINE FUEL & EMISSION).
AC Rochester will be supplying a limited number of new oil filters with enhanced anti-drainback
valves to GMSPO. Oil filters with effective anti-drainback valves may reduce or eliminate short
duration cold knock. Due to limited production capacity, the new filters are only to be used on the
following special cases.
1. Trucks or vans with short duration cold knock.
2. Routine maintenance of 1994 trucks or vans. Use the existing PF52 (P/N 25012760) and
PF1218 (P/N 25013977) oil filters for applications other
than the special cases listed above.
PART INFORMATION:
For "cold knock" vehicles or 1994 vehicle maintenance:
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER REPLACES
PF52 25160560 PF51
PF1218 25160561 PF35
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Filter: > 420502 > May > 94 >
Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Oil Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 420502
Date: May, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: AC ROCHESTER ENGINE OIL FILTER IDENTIFICATION
MODELS: 1994 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: DEALER SERVICE MANAGER/WARRANTY ADMINISTRATOR
The purpose of this bulletin is to notify retail/wholesale service personnel of a running change to
the AC Rochester Original Equipment engine oil filters.
Due to an agreement to decrease the number of GMSPO part numbers, AC Rochester will phase
in a decision to make all Original Equipment engine oil filters blue; same color used on AC
aftermarket engine oil filters. This means that eventually the use of black Original Equipment
engine oil filters will be discontinued.
For the purpose of Warranty/Policy administration, the following will assist retail/wholesale service
personnel in identifying the difference between blue Original Equipment and aftermarket engine oil
filters:
^ AFTERMARKET FILTER: will continue to use "AC DURAGUARD OIL FILTER" label.
^ OE FILTER: will have a black bar code, Julian date code and the letters "OE" printed on the
dome of the filter. At this time, it is anticipated that all OE engine oil filters will be changed by May
1994.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
4X2
Remove or Disconnect 1. Drain the engine oil. 2. Engine from the vehicle. 3. Oil pan bolts, nuts,
and reinforcements. 4. Oil pan. 5. Gasket. 6. Clean sealing surfaces on the oil pan and engine
block. 7. Inspect oil pan gasket. Replace if necessary.
Install or Connect 1. Apply sealant to the front cover to block joint and to the crankshaft rear seal
retainer to block joint. Apply the sealant for about 25 mm (1 inch) in
both directions from each of the four corners.
2. Oil pan gasket to the oil pan. 3. Oil pan to the engine. 4. Oil pan bolts, nuts, and reinforcements.
5. Tighten Oil pan bolts to 11 N.m (100 in. lbs.). 6. Oil pan nuts at comers to 23 N.m (17 ft. 11 lbs.).
7. Engine to the vehicle. 8. Proper quantity and grade of engine oil.
4X4
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2189
Remove or Disconnect 1. Negative battery cable. 2. Dipstick. 3. Raise the vehicle and support with
safety stands. 4. Drive belt splash shield. 5. Front axle shield. 6. Front skid plate. 7. Drain engine
oil. 8. Flywheel cover. 9. Left motor mount through bolts. 10. Right motor mount through bolts. 11.
Raise the engine. Block in position. 12. Oil cooler line. 13. Oil filter adapter. 14 Pitman arm bolt. 15.
Pitman arm. 16. Idler arm bolts. 17. Idler arm. 18. Front differential through bolts. 19. Front
propeller shaft 20. Roll differential forward. 21. Starter bolts. 22. Starter motor and lay aside. 23. Oil
pan bolts, nuts, and reinforcements. 24. Oil pan and gasket. 25. Clean sealing surfaces on the
engine and oil pan. 26. Inspect pan gasket. Replace if necessary.
Install or Connect 1. Apply sealant to the front cover to block joint and to the crankshaft rear seal to
block joint. Apply the sealant for about 25 mm (1 inch) in both
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2190
directions from each of the four corners.
2. Oil pan gasket to the oil pan. 3. Oil pan to the engine. 4. Oil pan bolts, nuts, and reinforcements.
5. Tighten pan bolts to 11 N.m (100 in. lbs.). 6. pan nuts at corners to 23 N.m (17 ft. lbs.). 7. Starter
motor. 8. Starter motor bolts. 9. Align differential into position. 10. Front propeller shaft. 11. Front
differential through bolts. 12. Idler arm. 13. Idler arm bolts. 14. Pitman arm. 15. Pitman arm bolt. 16.
Transfer case shield. 17. Flywheel cover. 18. Front skid plate. 19. Front axle shield. 20. Drive belt
splash shield. 21. Lower the vehicle. 22. Dipstick. 23. Proper quantity and grade of crankcase oil.
24. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate
Oil Pressure Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate
1. Remove lead from sensor, then connect tester J 33431-A or equivalent to sensor lead and
ground.
2. If gauge responds accurately to tester, replace sensor.
3. If gauge does not respond accurately to tester, replace cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate > Page 2195
Oil Pressure Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads High
1. Disconnect lead from sensor, then turn ignition switch to the ON position and ground lead. 2. If
gauge reads low, replace sensor. 3. If gauge reads high, locate and repair open circuit between
sensor and gauge.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate > Page 2196
Oil Pressure Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads Low
1. Check oil level, add if necessary. 2. Turn ignition switch to the On position. 3. Remove oil
pressure sensor lead at sensor, gauge should read high. 4. If gauge stays low, remove sensor lead
at gauge. Gauge should read high. If gauge reads high, locate and repair short to ground between
gauge and
sensor.
5. If gauge still reads low, replace cluster. 6. With lead removed at sensor, connect an ohmmeter to
sensor. With engine stopped resistance should be one ohm, and approximately 44 ohms with
engine running.
7. If sensor reads significantly lower than 44 ohms with engine running, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Oil Pressure Sender: > 476149 > Dec > 94 >
Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
Oil Pressure Sender: Customer Interest Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
File In Section: 6 - Engine Bulletin No. 47-61-49 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Oil Pressure Gauge Reading Concerns (Replace Oil Pressure Sending Unit)
Models: 1991-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, P Models, M/L, G Vans 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 2.2L, 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 7.4L Engines (VINs 4, Z, H, K, N - RPOs LN2, LB4, L03, L05,
L19)
CONDITION Some owners may comment on one or all of the following conditions:
^ High oil pressure when starting engine cold. ^ Low oil pressure when engine is at idle hot. ^
Erratic gauge readings.
CAUSE Oil pressure sending unit was not optimally calibrated for all operating conditions.
CORRECTION If actual oil pressures are within tolerances listed in Section 6A of the Service
Manual, and gauge circuit electrical diagnostics in Section SC of the Service Manual do not
uncover the source of the problem, an improved oil pressure sending unit should be installed.
Parts Information
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER
Oil Pressure Sending Unit 12553175
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
LABOR OPERATION LABOR TIME N222O
Use published labor operation and time.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: > 476149 >
Dec > 94 > Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
Oil Pressure Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading
Concerns
File In Section: 6 - Engine Bulletin No. 47-61-49 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Oil Pressure Gauge Reading Concerns (Replace Oil Pressure Sending Unit)
Models: 1991-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, P Models, M/L, G Vans 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 2.2L, 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 7.4L Engines (VINs 4, Z, H, K, N - RPOs LN2, LB4, L03, L05,
L19)
CONDITION Some owners may comment on one or all of the following conditions:
^ High oil pressure when starting engine cold. ^ Low oil pressure when engine is at idle hot. ^
Erratic gauge readings.
CAUSE Oil pressure sending unit was not optimally calibrated for all operating conditions.
CORRECTION If actual oil pressures are within tolerances listed in Section 6A of the Service
Manual, and gauge circuit electrical diagnostics in Section SC of the Service Manual do not
uncover the source of the problem, an improved oil pressure sending unit should be installed.
Parts Information
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER
Oil Pressure Sending Unit 12553175
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
LABOR OPERATION LABOR TIME N222O
Use published labor operation and time.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission > Page 2214
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 2215
C120 - Fuel Pump Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 2216
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable from battery.
- Sensor or switch connectors.
- Sensor or switch.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Sensor or switch.
- Sensor or switch.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
Many trucks use a warning light on the instrument panel in place of the conventional dash
indicating gauge to warn the driver when the oil pressure is dangerously low. The warning light is
wired in series with the ignition switch and the engine unit--which is an oil pressure switch. The oil
pressure switch contains a diaphragm and a set of contacts. When the ignition switch is turned on,
the warning light circuit is energized and the circuit is completed through the closed contacts in the
pressure switch. When the engine is started, build-up of oil pressure compresses the diaphragm,
opening the contacts, thereby breaking the circuit causing the light to go out.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2220
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
The oil pressure warning light should go on when the ignition is turned on. If it does not light,
disconnect the wire from the engine unit and ground the wire to the frame or cylinder block. Then if
the warning light still does not go on, replace the bulb.
If the warning light goes on when the wire is grounded, check the engine unit for a poor ground, or
improper installation. (The presence of sealing compound on the threads of the engine unit will
cause a poor ground.) If the unit is found to be properly grounded and installed, replace the unit.
If the warning light remains lit when it normally should be out, replace the engine unit before
proceeding to determine the cause for low pressure indication.
The warning light will sometimes light or flicker when the engine is idling, even if oil pressure is
adequate. However, the light should go out when the engine speed is increased.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine
Oil Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Normal Oil Pressure, Psi .....................................................................................................................
................................................. 25-50 @ 1200 RPM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement
Intake Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-06-01-026C
Date: February 03, 2010
Subject: Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement After Severe Internal Engine Damage
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-01-026B (Section 06 - Engine).
When replacing an engine due to internal damage, extreme care should be taken when transferring
the intake manifold to the new Goodwrench service engine long block. Internal damage may result
in the potential discharge of internal engine component debris in the intake manifold via broken
pistons and/or bent, broken, or missing intake valves. After removing the intake manifold from the
engine, the technician should carefully inspect all of the cylinder head intake ports to see if the
valve heads are still present and not bent. Usually when the valve heads are missing or sufficiently
bent, internal engine component debris will be present to varying degrees in the intake port of the
cylinder head. If this debris is present in any of the cylinder head intake ports, the intake manifold
should be replaced. This replacement is required due to the complex inlet runner and plenum
configuration of most of the intake manifolds, making thorough and complete component cleaning
difficult and nearly impossible to verify complete removal of debris. Re-installation of an intake
manifold removed from an engine with deposits of internal engine component debris may result in
the ingestion of any remaining debris into the new Goodwrench service engine. This may cause
damage or potential failure of the new service engine.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement > Page 2229
Intake Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Use of Wacker RTV Sealant for Intake
Manifold
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 67-61-17A
Date: August, 1996
Subject: Use of Wacker T-330 RTV Sealant (Pronounced Vaucker T)
Models: 1990-96 Buick Road master, Estate Wagon 1990-96 Cadillac Fleetwood 1990-96
Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette, Impala SS 1990-92 Oldsmobile Custom Cruiser 1990-96
Pontiac Firebird with 4.3L, 5.7L Engine (VINs W, P, 5, 8 - RPOs L99, L98, LT1, LT4) 1990-96
Chevrolet and GMC Light and Medium Duty Trucks with 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 6.0L, 7.0L, 7.4L Engines
(VINs W, Z, E H, K, M, N, P, R - RPOs L35, LB4, L03, L05, LS0, LR0, L19, L30, L31)
This bulletin is being revised to add further Chevrolet models. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 67-61-17 (Section 6 - Engine).
When installing the intake manifold, use a 5 mm (1/4 in.) thick bead of Wacker T-330 RTV, P/N
12346192, on the front and rear sealing areas between
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement > Page 2230
the engine block and intake manifold. See Figures 1 and 2. Wacker T-330 RTV has improved
adhesive abilities, is oxygen sensor safe, and is noncorrosive to ferrous metals. Wacker T-330 RW
cannot be used in coolant sealing surface areas.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2231
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair
Fig. 5 Intake Manifold Sealant Application
Fig. 6 Intake Manifold Tightening Sequence.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove air cleaner and heat stove tube.
3. Remove two braces from rear of fan belt tensioner.
4. Drain cooling system, then remove upper radiator hose.
5. Remove emission relays and bracket.
6. Remove wiring harnesses from retainers and position aside.
7. Remove power brake vacuum pipe, then ground cable from manifold stud.
8. Disconnect heater hose pipe from manifold.
9. Disconnect fuel pipes from throttle body.
10. Remove electrical connectors from sensors on manifold, then the ignition coil.
11. Remove distributor.
12. Remove electrical connectors and hoses from throttle body.
13. Remove throttle, TVS and cruise control cables, as equipped.
14. Remove EGR hose, then the manifold bolts.
15. Remove intake manifold.
16. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a.
Ensure gaskets are installed with port blocking plates facing the rear.
b. Apply a 3/16 bead of sealer to front and rear of block, Fig. 5. Extend bead 1/2 inch up each
cylinder head to seal gaskets.
c. Install manifold retaining bolts and torque to specification in proper sequence shown in Fig. 6.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate
Oil Pressure Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate
1. Remove lead from sensor, then connect tester J 33431-A or equivalent to sensor lead and
ground.
2. If gauge responds accurately to tester, replace sensor.
3. If gauge does not respond accurately to tester, replace cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate > Page 2237
Oil Pressure Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads High
1. Disconnect lead from sensor, then turn ignition switch to the ON position and ground lead. 2. If
gauge reads low, replace sensor. 3. If gauge reads high, locate and repair open circuit between
sensor and gauge.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Readings Are Inaccurate > Page 2238
Oil Pressure Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads Low
1. Check oil level, add if necessary. 2. Turn ignition switch to the On position. 3. Remove oil
pressure sensor lead at sensor, gauge should read high. 4. If gauge stays low, remove sensor lead
at gauge. Gauge should read high. If gauge reads high, locate and repair short to ground between
gauge and
sensor.
5. If gauge still reads low, replace cluster. 6. With lead removed at sensor, connect an ohmmeter to
sensor. With engine stopped resistance should be one ohm, and approximately 44 ohms with
engine running.
7. If sensor reads significantly lower than 44 ohms with engine running, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
Many trucks use a warning light on the instrument panel in place of the conventional dash
indicating gauge to warn the driver when the oil pressure is dangerously low. The warning light is
wired in series with the ignition switch and the engine unit--which is an oil pressure switch. The oil
pressure switch contains a diaphragm and a set of contacts. When the ignition switch is turned on,
the warning light circuit is energized and the circuit is completed through the closed contacts in the
pressure switch. When the engine is started, build-up of oil pressure compresses the diaphragm,
opening the contacts, thereby breaking the circuit causing the light to go out.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2242
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
The oil pressure warning light should go on when the ignition is turned on. If it does not light,
disconnect the wire from the engine unit and ground the wire to the frame or cylinder block. Then if
the warning light still does not go on, replace the bulb.
If the warning light goes on when the wire is grounded, check the engine unit for a poor ground, or
improper installation. (The presence of sealing compound on the threads of the engine unit will
cause a poor ground.) If the unit is found to be properly grounded and installed, replace the unit.
If the warning light remains lit when it normally should be out, replace the engine unit before
proceeding to determine the cause for low pressure indication.
The warning light will sometimes light or flicker when the engine is idling, even if oil pressure is
adequate. However, the light should go out when the engine speed is increased.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair
Rear oil seal installation
1. Remove transmission. Refer to Transmision and Drivetrain / Manual Transmission/Transaxle /
Service and Repair.
Refer to Transmision and Drivetrain / Automatic Transmission/Transaxle / Service and Repair.
2. Remove clutch and flywheel, if equipped. 3. Remove rear crankshaft oil seal by placing
screwdriver in notches provided and pry the seal out. 4. After cleaning groove, apply a thin even
coat of adhesive, part No. 1052621, Loctite 414 or equivalent over entire surface of seal groove. 5.
Within one minute install seal using seal installer J-35621 or equivalent, Fig. 17. 6. Reverse steps 1
and 2 to complete installation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Front Oil Seal Installation
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove fan belt, fan and pulley. 3. Remove fan shroud,
then the accessory drive pulley. 4. Remove torsional damper. 5. Remove front crankshaft seal by
prying out with large screwdriver. Use care to not distort front cover. 6. Remove crankshaft key, if
necessary. 7. Coat seal lips with engine oil and install using crankshaft seal installer tool No.
J-35468, or equivalent, Fig. 16. 8. Reverse steps 1 through 6 to complete installation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 476149 > Dec > 94 > Oil Pressure
Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
Oil Pressure Sender: Customer Interest Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
File In Section: 6 - Engine Bulletin No. 47-61-49 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Oil Pressure Gauge Reading Concerns (Replace Oil Pressure Sending Unit)
Models: 1991-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, P Models, M/L, G Vans 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 2.2L, 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 7.4L Engines (VINs 4, Z, H, K, N - RPOs LN2, LB4, L03, L05,
L19)
CONDITION Some owners may comment on one or all of the following conditions:
^ High oil pressure when starting engine cold. ^ Low oil pressure when engine is at idle hot. ^
Erratic gauge readings.
CAUSE Oil pressure sending unit was not optimally calibrated for all operating conditions.
CORRECTION If actual oil pressures are within tolerances listed in Section 6A of the Service
Manual, and gauge circuit electrical diagnostics in Section SC of the Service Manual do not
uncover the source of the problem, an improved oil pressure sending unit should be installed.
Parts Information
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER
Oil Pressure Sending Unit 12553175
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
LABOR OPERATION LABOR TIME N222O
Use published labor operation and time.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 476149 > Dec > 94 > Oil
Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading Concerns
Oil Pressure Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Oil Pressure Gauge - Erratic Reading
Concerns
File In Section: 6 - Engine Bulletin No. 47-61-49 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Oil Pressure Gauge Reading Concerns (Replace Oil Pressure Sending Unit)
Models: 1991-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T, P Models, M/L, G Vans 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 2.2L, 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 7.4L Engines (VINs 4, Z, H, K, N - RPOs LN2, LB4, L03, L05,
L19)
CONDITION Some owners may comment on one or all of the following conditions:
^ High oil pressure when starting engine cold. ^ Low oil pressure when engine is at idle hot. ^
Erratic gauge readings.
CAUSE Oil pressure sending unit was not optimally calibrated for all operating conditions.
CORRECTION If actual oil pressures are within tolerances listed in Section 6A of the Service
Manual, and gauge circuit electrical diagnostics in Section SC of the Service Manual do not
uncover the source of the problem, an improved oil pressure sending unit should be installed.
Parts Information
DESCRIPTION PART NUMBER
Oil Pressure Sending Unit 12553175
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
LABOR OPERATION LABOR TIME N222O
Use published labor operation and time.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: >
07-08-45-002 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: >
361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks
Fuse: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 361102
Date: February, 1994
SUBJECT: BLOWN FUSE, ERRATIC HVAC OPERATION, AND SELF DIAGNOSTIC FEATURE
BLINKS (INSULATE WIRES)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K TRUCKS
CONDITION:
Some owners may experience a blown fuse, erratic HVAC operation, or a blinking HVAC control
head self diagnostic indicator.
CAUSE:
Two possible hard to find causes have been discovered for the above symptoms:
- Six way I/P to HVAC connector terminals may short to the ashtray. The connector has slots to
accommodate the terminal positive attachment locks that allow metal to metal contact between the
exposed terminals and the ashtray (Figure 1).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: >
361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks > Page 2273
- The HVAC Harness from the control head to the blower and mode door motors, running across
the vehicle just under the dash panel, may chafe against the cassette deck support bracket (Figure
2).
CORRECTION:
Both conditions can be corrected by taping or otherwise shielding the wires from contact with the
respective metal edges. If the second condition has caused significant wire damage, repair
according to guidelines found in the wire repair section of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Op Description Labor Time
N6030 Wiring and/or Use Published
connector repair, A/C Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oil Pressure Sender: >
361102 > Feb > 94 > A/C - Erratic HVAC Operation & Self Diagnostic Blinks > Page 2283
- The HVAC Harness from the control head to the blower and mode door motors, running across
the vehicle just under the dash panel, may chafe against the cassette deck support bracket (Figure
2).
CORRECTION:
Both conditions can be corrected by taping or otherwise shielding the wires from contact with the
respective metal edges. If the second condition has caused significant wire damage, repair
according to guidelines found in the wire repair section of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Op Description Labor Time
N6030 Wiring and/or Use Published
connector repair, A/C Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications
Balance Shaft: Specifications
Engine Liter/CID ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L/V6-262
All specifications given in inches.
Journal Bearing Diameter
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 2.1648-2.1654 Rear ......................................................................
......................................................................................................................................
1.4994-1.5000
Rear Bearing Journal Clearance .........................................................................................................
........................................................ 0.0010-0.0036
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2288
Balance Shaft: Service and Repair
BALANCE SHAFT REMOVAL
TOOLS REQUIRED:
J 38834 Balance Shaft Bearing Service Kit J 26941 Bearing Remover
Installing Balance Shaft And Components
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (49). 2. Driven gear (42). 3. Retainer bolts (48). 4. Retainer (43). 5. Balance shaft (47) using
a soft faced hammer. 6. Balance shaft rear bearing (45) using J 38834 and J 26941.
IMPORTANT
^ The balance shaft with front bearing are serviced as an assembly.
^ Use only the correct tools for bearing and shaft installation.
^ inspect the balance shaft driven gear and the drive gear for nicks and burrs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Balance Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2289
BALANCE SHAFT INSTALLATION
TOOLS REQUIRED:
J 38834 Balance Shaft Bearing Service Kit J 36998 Balance Shaft Installer J 8092 Driver Handle J
36660 Torque/Angel Meter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Balance shaft rear bearing (45) using J 38834. Dip bearing in clean engine oil before installation.
2. Balance shaft (47) into block using J 36996 and J 8092.
A. Dip the front balance shaft bearing into clean engine oil before assembly. B. Retaining ring on
balance shaft front bearing must be seated on case.
3. Install balance shaft bearing retainer (43) and bolts (48).
TIGHTEN
^ Balance shaft retainer bolts (48) to 14 Nm (124 lbs in.).
4. Balance shaft driven gear (42) and bolt (49).
TIGHTEN
^ Balance shaft driven gear bolt (49) to 20 Nm (15 lbs. ft.) plus an additional turn of 35 degrees
using J 36660.
^ Rotate balance shaft (47) by hand to make sure there is clearance between the balance shaft
(47) and retainer (43). If balance shaft does not rotate freely, check to be sure retaining ring on
front bearing is seated on case.
Balance Shaft Drive Gear To Driven Gear Timing Marks
^ Turn the camshaft so, with the balance shaft drive gear temporarily installed, the timing mark on
the drive gear is straight up.
^ With the balance shaft drive gear removed, turn the balance shaft so the timing mark on the
driven gear (42) points straight down.
5. Balance shaft drive gear (37) onto camshaft.
IMPORTANT
^ Make sure the timing marks on the balance shaft drive gear and driven gear line up.
6. Balance shaft drive gear bolts.
TIGHTEN
^ Bolt to 16 Nm (12 lbs. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Timing Chain: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
^ Tools Required J 5825-A Crankshaft Sprocket Puller
1. Remove the timing cover.
2. Remove the crankshaft position sensor reluctor ring. 3. Remove the camshaft sprocket bolts. 4.
Remove camshaft sprocket.
5. Remove timing chain.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2293
6. Remove the crankshaft sprocket. 7. Remove crankshaft sprocket key.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the key into the crankshaft keyway.
2. Use the crankshaft balancer installer to install the crankshaft sprocket.
3. Install the camshaft sprocket and timing chain.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2294
NOTE: The gears must mesh in order to prevent damage to the camshaft retainer.
4. Install camshaft sprocket bolts.
CAUTION Be sure to align the camshaft and the crankshaft sprocket marks. Timing marks
(Number 4 Firing).
^ Tighten bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.)
5. Align the keyway on the reluctor ring with the key in the crankshaft.
6. Install the reluctor ring onto the crankshaft until the ring is completely seated against the
crankshaft sprocket. 7. Install the timing cover.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove torsional damper. 3. Remove water pump, then the
upper radiator hose. 4. Remove oil pan. 5. Remove A/C compressor and position aside. 6. Remove
right side engine accessory bracket. 7. Remove front cover attaching bolts and reinforcements. 8.
Remove front cover. 9. Reverse procedure to install, tightening cover bolts to specification.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > Diagnostic Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
Component Location - "S/T" 4.3Z Utility - Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Idle Speed - Specification Revised
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission Bulletin No.: 41-65-22 Date: September, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 4 - Revised Controlled Idle Speed Specification
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck Light Duty Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with
Gasoline Engines
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised > Page 2307
This service bulletin supersedes Service Manual information for the Controlled Idle Speed
Specification on Page 4-3 of the Driveability, Emissions, and Electrical Diagnosis Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2308
Idle Speed: Specifications
Refer to Adjustment Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 2318
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page
2324
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-6-5-4-3-2
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Timing > Ignition Timing Connector > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Set Timing
Connector - Location Correction
Ignition Timing Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location
Correction
File in Section: Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-41
Date: January, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 6A - Ignition Set Timing Connector Location
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine
(VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
The location of the Set Timing Connector is incorrectly called out in "Section 6A" (Page 6A-8) of the
"Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis", Service Manual and in the 1994 Oldsmobile
Bravada Service Manual Supplement (Page 6E3-C4-8).
The correct location of the Set Timing Connector is inside the cab where the Heater Box and the
carpet meet on the passenger side floor.
Pull carpet back to expose the single wire and connectors on the outside of the control module
harness. The wire colors are tan with a black stripe.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Timing > Ignition Timing Connector > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2338
Timing Connector-In Pass Comp Behind Carpet, Below Heater
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Timing > Timing Marks and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Timing Mark
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Cable > Component Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
RESISTANCE VALUES
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 3,000 - 10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 4,000 - 15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 6,000 - 20,000 ohms.
NOTE: Longer wires should measure about 5,000 to 10,000 ohms per foot.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Cable > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2349
Ignition Cable: Locations
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications
Distributor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2353
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2354
Distributor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The distributor reference signal provides the ECM with both engine RPM and crankshaft position
information. This enables the ECM to operate the fuel pump relay and energize the fuel injector.
OPERATION
When the engine is cranking or running the ECM receives Distributor Ignition (DI) reference pulses
from the ignition module. If the wire becomes open or grounded the engine will not run, as the ECM
will not operate the injector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2355
Distributor: Service and Repair
Distributor
Remove or Disconnect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2356
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2357
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2358
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2359
- Make sure the ignition switch is "OFF."
1. Air cleaner and hoses (4.3L VIN Z). 2. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor
cap. 3. Two screws on the sides of the distributor cap. 4. Coil wire and spark plug wires on either
the left or right side of the distributor. 5. Distributor cap and move it aside.
A. Use chalk to note the position of the rotor in relation to the engine. B. Use chalk to note the
position of the distributor housing in relation to the engine.
6. Distributor bolt and hold-down clamp. 7. Distributor and gasket, when present.
Install or Connect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2360
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2361
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2362
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2363
A. To ensure correct timing of the distributor, it must be installed with the rotor correctly positioned
as noted in step 5 of the removal procedure. Line
up the rotor to the mark on the engine, and the mark on the housing to the engine.
B. If the distributor shaft won't drop into the engine, remove the distributor, insert a screwdriver into
the hole for the distributor and rotate the oil
pump driveshaft so that it lines up with the distributor driver gear.
1. Distributor and gasket, where present. 2. Hold-down clamp and bolt.
- Bolt on the 4.3L to 27 Nm (20 lbs. ft.).
3. Distributor cap. 4. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor. 5. Spark plug wires
and coil wire. 6. Air Cleaner and hoses.
- Check the engine timing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
........................................ N/A see NOTE following.
Spark Plug Torque ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 15 N-m (11 lb.ft.)
Spark Plug Type ..................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... AC CR43TSM
NOTE Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Minimum, 698 kPa (100 psi) @ 200 rpm. The lowest cylinder reading should not be less than 80%
of the highest. Perform compression test with engine at normal operating temperature, spark plugs
removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
VALVE ADJUSTMENT (VIN Z)
WITH SCREW-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS AND POSITIVE STOP SHOULDERS
Valve Rocker Arm Nuts .......................................................................................................................
.......................................... 27 Nm (20 lb. ft.).
WITH PRESSED-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS
Refer to Rocker Arm / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 2374
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
4.3L/V6-262 Left Side...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. E-I-E-I-I-E Right Side.........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 2375
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 10 Valve Adjustment
The 4.3L VIN Z engine can be equipped with two different rocker arm stud configurations that
require different valve lash procedures.
TYPE 1 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has screw-in rocker arm studs with positive stop shoulders, no
valve adjustment is necessary. When the valve train requires service, you simply tighten the rocker
arm nuts to 27 Nm (20 ft lb).
TYPE 2 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has pressed-in rocker arm studs, you must follow the valve
adjustment procedure outlined below.
1. Remove rocker arm cover. 2. Rotate engine until mark on torsional damper is aligned with "0"
mark on timing tab fastened to crankcase front cover. To ensure engine is at No.
1 cylinder firing position, place fingers on No. 1 cylinder valves as the mark on damper approaches
the "0" mark on timing tab. If valves are not moving, engine is in the No. 1 cylinder firing position. If
valves are moving, engine is in the No. 4 cylinder firing position and should be rotated one
revolution.
3. With engine in No. 1 cylinder firing position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 1, 5 and 6.
^ Intake valves 1, 2 and 3.
NOTE: Even numbered cylinders are in the left bank and odd numbered cylinders are in the right
bank, when viewed from front of the engine.
4. Back off adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then tighten nut until all lash is removed. This
can be determined by rotating pushrod while
turning adjusting nut. When all lash is removed, tighten adjusting nut 1 and 3/4 turns to center lifter
plunger.
5. Crank engine one full revolution until mark on torsional damper and "0" mark on timing tab are
again in alignment. This is the No. 4 cylinder
firing position. With engine in this position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 2, 3 and 4.
^ Intake valves 4, 5 and 6.
6. Install valve covers and related components, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 2376
Valve Clearance: Service and Repair
For Valve Adjustment, Refer to Valve Clearance / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Water pump replacement. 4.3L/V6-262
1. Drain cooling system. 2. Remove serpentine drive belt, then the upper fan shroud. 3. Remove
fan,then fan clutch assembly and water pump pulley. 4. Remove hoses from pump. 5. Remove
water pump attaching bolts, then pump Fig. 20. 6. Reverse procedure to install. Torque bolts to
specification.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D
Date: August 15, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Coolant Reimbursement Policy
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at
the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement
is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant
concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of
pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement
for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the
appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers
Important:
USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE
FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM
ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE
COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY.
Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products
that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not
been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 2385
coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant.
Coolant Removal Services/Recycling
The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a
primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with
used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or
equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or
DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this
bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period.
DEX-COOL(R) Recycling
The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste
engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000
km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled
DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages.
This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be
expanded as demand increases.
Conventional (Green) Recycling
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 2386
Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or
conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be
accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number
in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your
facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of
these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the
operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective
(GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer.
Sealing Tablets
Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item
after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs
have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over
the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a
small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be
recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage.
Water Quality
The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water.
DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service
interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor
quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you
use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R).
"Pink" DEX-COOL(R)
DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the
mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color
shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5
yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval.
Back Service
Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 2387
Contamination
Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5
yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated
condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and
re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced
properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R).
After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant
exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems
with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same,
and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
Equipment (Coolant Exchangers)
The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant
exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be
used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They
can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling
system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature
facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over
repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows
venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available
through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program.
For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant
replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of
trapped air from the cooling system during refill.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 2388
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Coolant - Information on Back Service
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No: 53-62-02
Date: November, 1995
Subject: DEX-COOL(TM) Engine Coolant - Information on Back service
Models: 1994-95 Passenger Cars and Trucks
A new extended-life engine coolant called DEX-COOL(TM) is currently being used in all General
Motors' vehicles (excluding Chevrolet Geo and Saturn). Refer to bulletin 53-62-01 for general
service information.
Backservice
DEX-COOL(TM) may be used in General Motors vehicles originally built with conventional (green)
coolant with the following considerations:
^ Vehicles eligible for back service are 1994 and 1995 models (excluding 1994 J Body with 4
cylinder engines).
^ The service interval for DEX-COOL(TM) introduced into an older model vehicle originally built
with "green" coolant will be 2 years/30,000 miles (50,000 Km) (not 5 years/100,000 miles (160,000
Km)).
^ All the "green" coolant must be removed from the cooling system by means of a system flush.
This may be accomplished with a water flushing device or a GMDE waterless coolant changer (use
a unit dedicated to "green" coolant, not DEX-COOL TM).
Important:
When using a GMDE waterless coolant changer, conduct the procedure twice, once with water,
and once with DEX-COOL(TM)
Backservice with DEX-COOL(TM) is advocated because of enhanced water pump seal durability
experienced with this coolant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 2389
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Recycled Engine Coolant Policy
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration Bulletin No.: 310504 Date: February, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: RECYCLED ENGINE COOLANT POLICY
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: WARRANTY CLAIMS ADMINISTRATOR AND SERVICE MANAGER
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. For detailed information on GM approved
engine coolant recycling equipment guidelines refer to the following bulletins: Cadillac 93-1-18,
GMC Truck 93-6B-34, Chevrolet 93-73-6B, Pontiac 93-6-18, Oldsmobile 1-93-43, Buick 93-6B-1
(Corporate Number 236203).
Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the
appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial to
assure that only the relative amount of engine coolant concentrate be charged, not the total diluted
volume. In other words, if you are using two gallons of pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant
to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement for one gallon of Goodwrench engine coolant
concentrate at the dealer price plus the appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 2390
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Coolant - Information on Propylene Glycol Usage
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 43-62-01B
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Propylene Glycol Engine Coolant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to reflect most current information on propylene glycol engine coolant.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 4362O1A (Group Reference 6 - Engine).
General Motors has been reviewing data supplied on the performance of propylene glycol engine
coolant in GM vehicles. It is our conclusion that propylene glycol engine coolant will perform
adequately under most vehicle operating conditions. As a result, propylene glycol engine coolant
(meeting performance specification GM 1825M) may be used in GM vehicles and will not affect the
warranty coverage.
Prior to adding propylene glycol engine coolant to the cooling system, all the existing (ethylene
glycol) coolant must be removed. This can be accomplished either by utilizing water-based coolant
flushing equipment or "waterless quick change" equipment available in the GMDE program. As with
any coolant change procedure, be sure to thoroughly purge the heater core and block as well as
the radiator before attempting to convert the system to propylene glycol coolant.
Freeze/Boil point levels are different for propylene glycol than for ethylene glycol engine coolant.
To accurately determine freeze/boil protection level, it is imperative that coolants not be mixed.
Removing all the used coolant as previously discussed resolves this concern. Freeze protection of
propylene glycol cannot be determined using a standard hydrometer. Rather, a refractometer or
test strip must be used.
Propylene glycol engine coolants may be recycled in the same manner as conventional ethylene
glycol coolant. No adverse effects will be encountered if these coolants are mixed prior to recycling,
however, the ratio of propylene glycol coolant to ethylene glycol coolant should be kept low to
minimize the effects on freeze point measurements.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2391
Coolant: Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Qts.
Less A/C ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 12.1 With A/C .............................................................
........................................................................................................................................................
12.1
Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. .....................................................................................................
............................................................................... 15 Thermo. Opening Temp., deg.F .....................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 195
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
This system uses a sensor mounted on the radiator and an indicator light mounted in the
instrument panel to warn the driver if coolant level is too low. This light is wired in series with the
ignition switch, ECM and the sensor. When the ignition switch is turned to the crank position, the
circuit is energized and the indicator light will illuminate. When the ignition switch is turned to the
ON position and coolant level is sufficient, the sensor will indicate this to the ECM and the light will
turn off.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated
1. Turn ignition switch to the On position, then check coolant level and add coolant as necessary. If
lamp remains illuminated, proceed to step 2.
2. Disconnect electrical connector at the sensor. If lamp does not illuminate replace the sensor. If
lamp remains illuminated, proceed to step 3.
3. Connect electrical lead to the sensor and check for an open circuit between the sensor and the
module. Repair or replace as necessary. If circuit is satisfactory, replace the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated > Page 2397
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Lamp Will Not Illuminate
1. Turn ignition switch to the crank position, and proceed as follows: a.
If lamp illuminates, lamp is satisfactory and connector is properly installed. Proceed to step 2.
b. If lamp does not illuminate, check bulb, socket and wiring between socket and module
connector. Replace or repair as necessary.
2. Turn ignition switch to the On position and disconnect electrical lead at coolant level sensor
mounted on the radiator. If lamp fails to illuminate, check wiring between coolant level sensor
connector and ECM for a short circuit to ground. If circuit is satisfactory, replace the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Fan Blade: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: Do not operate engine until fan has first been inspected for cracks and/or separations.
If a fan blade is found to be bent or damaged in any way, do not attempt to repair or reuse
damaged part. Proper balance is essential in fan assembly operation. Balance cannot be assured
once a fan assembly has been found to be bent or damaged and failure may occur during
operation, creating an extremely dangerous condition. Always replace damaged fan assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 2403
Fan Blade: Vehicle Damage Warnings
WARNING: Do not operate engine until fan has first been inspected for cracks and/or separations.
If a fan blade is found to be bent or damaged in any way, do not attempt to repair or reuse
damaged part. Proper balance is essential in fan assembly operation. Balance cannot be assured
once a fan assembly has been found to be bent or damaged and failure may occur during
operation, creating an extremely dangerous condition. Always replace damaged fan assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis
Fan Clutch: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis
File In Section: 07 Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 99-07-30-016B
Date: October, 2002
INFORMATION
Subject: Diagnostic Information For Intermittent Transmission Downshift, Slip, Busy/cycling TCC or
Noisy Cooling Fan
Models: 1999-2000 Cadillac Escalade 2002-2003 Cadillac Escalade, Escalade EXT 1988-2003
Chevrolet Astro, Blazer, S-10, Silverado, Suburban 1989-2003 Chevrolet/Geo Tracker 1995-2003
Chevrolet Tahoe 1996-2003 Chevrolet Express 1988-1994 GMC S-15 1988-1999 GMC Suburban
1988-2003 GMC Safari, Sierra 1995-2003 GMC Sonoma, Yukon, Yukon XL 1996-2003 GMC
Savana 1999-2001 GMC Envoy 1991-2001 Oldsmobile Bravada 2003 HUMMER H2 with Air
Conditioning
This bulletin is being revised to change the Model information and text. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-07-30-016A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle)
Some customers may comment that at times the transmission seems to slip, or that there is a loud
roar from the engine with slow acceleration. This condition is most noticeable after the vehicle has
sat idle for 12 or more hours, or on hot days when the A/C is on and the vehicle moves slowly with
traffic.
Typical comments from customers may include the following conditions:
^ Intermittent slipping
^ Intermittent downshift followed by an upshift, both with no apparent reason
^ Busyness or cycling of the TCC (torque converter clutch) at steady throttle conditions and on a
level roadway
^ Noisy cooling fan
The type of concern described above requires further definition. The customer should be asked the
following questions:
^ Is the situation more pronounced with higher vehicle loads such as when pulling a trailer?
^ Do warmer ambient temperatures make the situation more pronounced?
^ When the condition occurred, did you have the A/C on, and were you driving in stop and go city
traffic?
^ Does the condition exhibit itself on the first start-up after sitting more than eight hours?
If the customer indicates that these conditions apply, and your observation confirms that the vehicle
is operating properly, provide the customer with the vehicle operating description included at the
end of this bulletin. Further action may not be necessary. A service procedure follows if further
definition is required.
Diagnostic Aids
Cooling fan operation or the resulting sound varies. The cooling fan clutch may be described as a
continuously variable clutch. If the vehicle engine is running, the fan blade is always turning unless
the fan clutch is non-functional. The speed of the fan in relation to engine speed is temperature
dependent.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis > Page 2408
Maximum fan speed (air flow and related fan noise) through the engine compartment is
experienced under two conditions.
1. When the vehicle sits in an unused condition for several hours, the viscous fluid within the
thermostatic fan clutch assembly migrates and fully engages the clutch of the fan. After a short
drive, the viscous fluid will migrate to the storage area in the fan clutch and the fan clutch will slip,
reducing the noise (roar of the fan). This is normal thermostatic fan clutch operation.
2. When the engine is running, and the air being drawn by the fan or pushed through the radiator
from the vehicle movement reaches a high enough temperature, the fan clutch will fully engage the
fan clutch, drawing additional air through the radiator to lower the engine coolant temperature and
A/C refrigerant temperature. When the cooling fan clutch fully engages, fan noise increases (for
example; this is the same as switching an electric household fan from low to high speed). Some
customers have interpreted this sound increase to be an increase in the engine RPM due to
transmission downshift, transmission slipping, or TCC cycling. As the engine coolant temperature
decreases, the fan clutch will begin to slip, lowering the actual speed of the fan blade and the
resultant sound.
Service Procedure
When diagnosing an intermittent transmission downshift, slip, or busy/cycling TCC, follow these
steps:
1. Verify the transmission fluid level and the fluid condition. Refer to the Automatic Transmission
sub-section of the appropriate Service Manual.
2. Test drive the vehicle under the conditions described by the customer (ambient temperature,
engine coolant temperature, trailering, etc.). It may be necessary to partially restrict airflow to the
radiator in order to raise the engine coolant temperature to match the customer's conditions.
3. Monitor the engine RPM and the engine coolant temperature using a scan tool.
4. Listen for an actual increase in the engine RPM. Use either the vehicle tachometer (if equipped),
the Tech 2 RPM or transmission slip speed as an indicator, rather than just the sound.
If the engine RPM display on the tachometer or the Tech 2 increases, verify the scan tool RPM and
coolant temperature readings. If the noise increase is due to the engagement of the fan, the engine
RPM will not increase and the engine coolant temperature will begin to decrease after the fan
engages. As the fan runs, the engine coolant temperature will drop and the fan will disengage,
reducing noise levels. The engine RPM will not decrease. This cycle will repeat as the engine
coolant temperature rises again.
If the above procedure shows the condition to be cooling fan-related, no further action is
necessary. The vehicle should be returned to the customer and the condition explained.
If the above procedure shows the condition to be other than cooling fan-related, refer to the
Automatic Transmission sub-section of the appropriate Service Manual for transmission diagnosis
information.
The following information regarding the operation of the engine cooling fan should be photocopied
and given to the customer.
Intermittent Transmission Downshift
All light duty trucks are equipped with a thermostatic engine cooling fan. This fan is designed to
provide greater fuel efficiency and quieter operation than a standard fan. These benefits are
possible through the addition of a thermostatic clutch to the fan drive. When the engine is cool (it
the engine has been run in the last few hours), the clutch allows the fan to "slip" or turn at a speed
slower than the engine. By turning at a slower speed, the fan uses less horsepower, which saves
fuel, and is quieter. When the engine temperature reaches a preset temperature or if the engine
has not been run for several hours, the fan "engages" and turns at the same speed as the engine.
"Engagement" of the fan provides increased airflow through the radiator to cool the engine. As the
airflow increases, fan operation becomes clearly audible.
This increase in noise can easily be mistaken for an increase in engine RPM and may be
incorrectly blamed on the automatic transmission. When operating an unloaded vehicle in cooler
ambient temperatures, the thermostatic clutch usually won't fully engage. However, if the vehicle is
pulling a trailer, is heavily loaded or is operated at high ambient temperatures, the thermostatic fan
clutch may cycle on and off as the engine coolant temperature rises and falls.
The sound of fan operation under the conditions described above is a sign that the cooling system
on your vehicle is working correctly. Replacement or modification of the cooling system or the
transmission parts will not change or reduce the noise level. Attempts to reduce this noise may
cause you, the customer, to believe that your vehicle is not reliable and will inconvenience you by
causing your vehicle to be out of service.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Intermittent Downshift/Slip/Cycling Diagnosis > Page 2409
DISCLAIMER
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2410
Fan Clutch: Description and Operation
Fan Drive Clutch Assembly
Variable Speed Fan W/Bi-Metallic Coiled Thermostatic Spring
The fan drive clutch, Fig. 1, is a fluid coupling containing silicone oil. Fan speed is regulated by the
torque-carrying capacity of the silicone oil. The more silicone oil in the coupling, the greater the fan
speed, and the less silicone oil, the slower the fan speed. The type of fan drive clutch in use is a
coiled bimetallic thermostatic spring, Fig. 2. The fan drive clutch uses a heat-sensitive, coiled
bimetallic spring connected to an opening plate which regulates the flow of silicone oil into the
coupling from a reserve chamber. The silicone oil is returned to the reserve chamber through a
bleed hole when the valve is closed. This unit causes the fan speed to increase with a rise in
temperature and to decrease as temperature decreases.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Clutch Fluid Leak
Fan Clutch: Testing and Inspection Clutch Fluid Leak
Small fluid leaks do not generally affect the operation of the unit. These leaks generally occur
around the area of the bearing assembly, but if the leaks appear to be excessive, engine
overheating may occur. Clutch and fan free-wheeling can cause overheating. To check for clutch
and fan free-wheeling, turn the motor "OFF." Spin the fan and clutch assembly by hand. If the fan
spins five or more times before it stops, replace the clutch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Clutch Fluid Leak > Page 2413
Fan Clutch: Testing and Inspection Engine Overheating
1. Start with cool engine to ensure complete fan clutch disengagement. 2. If fan and clutch
assembly free wheels with no drag (revolves more than five times when spun by hand), replace
clutch. If clutch performs properly
with slight drag, proceed to following step.
3. Position thermometer so it is located between fan blades and radiator, noting the following:
a. Insert thermometer sensor through one of existing holes in fan shroud or place between radiator
and shroud. It may be necessary to drill a 3/16
inch hole in fan shroud to insert thermometer.
b. Check for adequate clearance between fan blades and thermometer sensor before starting
engine, as damage could occur.
4. With thermometer in position, cover radiator grill sufficiently to induce high engine temperature.
5. Start engine, then turn on air conditioning and operate at 2000 RPM. 6. Observe thermometer
reading when clutch disengages, noting the following:
a. It will take approximately five to ten minutes for temperature to become high enough to allow
engagement of fan clutch. This will be indicated
by a 5-15 degrees F drop in thermometer reading.
b. If clutch did not engage between 150-195 degrees F, unit should be replaced. Ensure fan clutch
was disengaged at beginning of test. c. If no sharp increase in fan noise or temperature drop was
observed and fan noise level was constantly high from start of test to 190 degrees F,
unit should be replaced. Do not continue this test past thermometer reading of 190 degrees F to
prevent engine overheating.
7. As soon as clutch engages, remove radiator grill cover and turn A/C off to assist in engine
cooling. Run engine at approximately 1500 RPM. 8. After several minutes, fan clutch should
disengage as indicated by reduction in fan speed and roar. If fan clutch fails to function as
described,
replace it.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Clutch Fluid Leak > Page 2414
Fan Clutch: Testing and Inspection Fan Clutch Noise
Fan clutch noise can sometimes be noticed when clutch is engaged for maximum cooling. Clutch
noise is also noticeable within the first few minutes after starting engine while clutch is redistributing
the silicone fluid back to its normal, disengaged operating condition after settling for long periods of
time (overnight). However, continuous fan noise or an excessive roar indicates the clutch assembly
is locked-up due to internal failure. This condition can be checked by attempting to manually rotate
fan. If fan cannot be rotated manually or there is a rough, abrasive feel as fan is rotated, the clutch
should be replaced.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Clutch Fluid Leak > Page 2415
Fan Clutch: Testing and Inspection Fan Looseness
Lateral movement can be observed at the fan blade tip under various temperature conditions
because of the type bearing used. This movement should not exceed 1/4 inch (6.5 mm) as
measured at the fan tip. If this lateral movement does not exceed specifications, there is no cause
for replacement.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2416
Fan Clutch: Service and Repair
To prevent silicone fluid from draining into fan drive bearing, do not store or place drive unit on
bench with rear of shaft pointing downward. The coil spring type fan clutch cannot be
disassembled, serviced or repaired. If it does not function properly, it must be replaced with a new
unit. To replace the fan clutch, use the following procedure:
1. Remove the radiator fan shroud.
2. Unfasten the unit from the water pump, then remove the assembly from vehicle.
3. Separate fan from fan clutch.
4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a.
Ensure mating surfaces of water pump hub and fan clutch hub are smooth and free of any burrs.
b. Align yellow reference marks on water pump hub and fan clutch hub.
c. Torque nuts to 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2421
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2422
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2425
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2426
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2427
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2428
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2429
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2430
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2431
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2432
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2433
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2434
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2435
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2436
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2437
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2438
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2439
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2440
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2441
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2442
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2443
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2444
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2445
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2446
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2447
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2448
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2449
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2450
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2451
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2452
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2453
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2454
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2455
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2456
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2457
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2458
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Right Front Engine Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations > Page 2462
Engine Harness, Right Front
NOTE: The OEM service manual provides multiple location views for this component.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations > Page 2463
C108 - Eng Coolant Temp Sender
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2468
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2469
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2470
Heater Core: Description and Operation
In any air conditioning mode, the heater core can be used to heat the cool dehumidified air to
achieve the desired air temperature. The position of the control assembly temperature selector will
determine how much heat will be added to the incoming air.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core Replacement
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core Replacement
Figure 41: Heater Assembly Component View
HEATER CORE REPLACEMENT
Remove Or Disconnect 1. Engine coolant. 2. Heater hoses.
- Refer to "Heater Hose". See: Heater Hose Replacement
3. Instrument panel.
- Refer to "Dash Board" under Body and Frame / Interior Trim. See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dash Board / Instrument Panel
4. Rear case screws. (88) 5. Rear case. (96) 6. Screws. (94) 7. Straps. (93) 8. Heater core. (92) 9.
Seals. (89 & 90)
Install Or Connect
1. Seals. (89 & 90) 2. Heater core. (92) 3. Straps. (93) 4. Screws. (94) 5. Rear case. (96) 6. Rear
case screws. (88) 7. Instrument panel. 8. Heater hoses. 9. Engine coolant.
- Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core Replacement > Page 2473
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Hose Replacement
HEATER HOSE REPLACEMENT
Heater Hose Routing To Heater
Heater Hose Routing To The Engine
Heater Hose Routing To Heater
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core Replacement > Page 2474
Heater Hose Routing Through The Retainer
Heater Hose Routing Through The Thermostat Housing Bracket Retainer
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Engine coolant. 2. Heater inlet hose clamps. 3. Heater inlet hose from heater hose fitting. 4.
Heater inlet hose from heater core. 5. Heater outlet hose clamps. 6. Heater outlet hose from heater
hose fitting. 7. Heater outlet hose from heater core.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater outlet hose to heater core. 2. Heater outlet hose to heater hose fitting. 3. Heater outlet
hose clamps. 4. Heater inlet hose to heater core. 5. Heater inlet hose to heater hose fitting. 6.
Heater inlet hose clamps. 7. Engine coolant.
^ Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Specifications
Heater Hose: Specifications
Heater Inlet Hose Mounting Screw
....................................................................................................................................................... 1.4
Nm (12 lbs. in.)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose
With A/C
Heater Hose Routing-With A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
Tool Required:
- J 38723 Heater Line Quick Connect Separator or Equivalent
1. Air cleaner.
2. Engine coolant.
3. Inlet hose mounting screw.
4. Inlet hose clamp at heater core.
NOTE: Loosen the clamp enough to slide away from the fitting on the inlet hose (72).
5. Inlet hose (72) from heater core.
6. Push inlet hose (72) into connector and insert J 38723 or equivalent into connector to release
locking tabs.
7. Pull retainer and hose (72) from heater inlet connector.
Inspect
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose > Page 2480
- O-ring sealing surface on hose/pipe. Adjust
- If replacing heater inlet connector remove retainer from hose and discard as new connector is
equipped with retainer.
- If replacing hose, remove retainer from hose and reinsert in connector.
- If reusing hose and connector, retainer can remain in place on hose.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Push hose (72) into connector until retainer tabs lock.
NOTE: Pull back on hose to check for proper engagement.
2. Inlet hose (72) to heater core.
3. Inlet hose clamp.
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
4. Inlet hose mounting screw.
- Tighten screw to 1.4 Nm (12 lbs. in.).
5. Engine coolant.
6. Air cleaner.
- Check the system for leaks.
Without A/C
Heater Hose Routing W/out A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
Tool Required:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose > Page 2481
- J 38723 Heater Line Quick Connect Separator or Equivalent
1. Air cleaner.
2. Engine coolant.
3. Inlet hose mounting screw.
4. Inlet hose clamp at heater core.
NOTE: Loosen the clamp enough to slide away from the fitting on the inlet hose (72).
5. Inlet hose (72) from heater core.
6. Push inlet hose (72) into connector and insert J 38723 or equivalent into connector to release
locking tabs.
7. Pull retainer and hose (72) from heater inlet connector.
Inspect
- O-ring sealing surface on hose/pipe. Adjust
- If replacing heater inlet connector remove retainer from hose and discard as new connector is
equipped with retainer.
- If replacing hose, remove retainer from hose and reinsert in connector.
- If reusing hose and connector, retainer can remain in place on hose.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Push hose (72) into connector until retainer tabs lock.
NOTE: Pull back on hose to check for proper engagement.
2. Inlet hose (72) to heater core.
3. Inlet hose clamp.
NOTICE: Refer to "Fasteners" under "Vehicle Damage Warnings."
4. Inlet hose mounting screw.
- Tighten screw to 1.4 Nm (12 lbs. in.).
5. Engine coolant.
6. Air cleaner.
- Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose > Page 2482
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Outlet Hose
With A/C
Heater Hose Routing-With A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Engine coolant.
2. Hose clamps.
3. Outlet hose (70) from heater core.
4. Outlet hose (70) from radiator.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Outlet hose (70) to radiator.
2. Outlet hose (70) to heater core.
3. Hose clamps.
4. Engine coolant.
- Check the system for leaks.
Without A/C
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose > Page 2483
Heater Hose Routing W/out A/C
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Engine coolant.
2. Hose clamps.
3. Outlet hose (70) from heater core.
4. Outlet hose (70) from radiator.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Outlet hose (70) to radiator.
2. Outlet hose (70) to heater core.
3. Hose clamps.
4. Engine coolant.
- Check the system for leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2484
Special Tool
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
This system uses a sensor mounted on the radiator and an indicator light mounted in the
instrument panel to warn the driver if coolant level is too low. This light is wired in series with the
ignition switch, ECM and the sensor. When the ignition switch is turned to the crank position, the
circuit is energized and the indicator light will illuminate. When the ignition switch is turned to the
ON position and coolant level is sufficient, the sensor will indicate this to the ECM and the light will
turn off.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated
1. Turn ignition switch to the On position, then check coolant level and add coolant as necessary. If
lamp remains illuminated, proceed to step 2.
2. Disconnect electrical connector at the sensor. If lamp does not illuminate replace the sensor. If
lamp remains illuminated, proceed to step 3.
3. Connect electrical lead to the sensor and check for an open circuit between the sensor and the
module. Repair or replace as necessary. If circuit is satisfactory, replace the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Lamp Remains Illuminated >
Page 2491
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Lamp Will Not Illuminate
1. Turn ignition switch to the crank position, and proceed as follows: a.
If lamp illuminates, lamp is satisfactory and connector is properly installed. Proceed to step 2.
b. If lamp does not illuminate, check bulb, socket and wiring between socket and module
connector. Replace or repair as necessary.
2. Turn ignition switch to the On position and disconnect electrical lead at coolant level sensor
mounted on the radiator. If lamp fails to illuminate, check wiring between coolant level sensor
connector and ECM for a short circuit to ground. If circuit is satisfactory, replace the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 468306 > Dec > 94 >
Temperature Gauge - Erratic
Temperature Gauge: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Erratic
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical Bulletin No.: 46-83-06
Date: December, 1994
Subject: Erratic Temperature Gauge (Exchange Instrument Panel Cluster)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with Standard Analog Instrument Panel
Cluster
Condition
Some temperature gauges in the above vehicles may give erratic readings.
Cause
Improper nut on back of temperature gauge inside the I/P cluster, resulting in erratic voltage feed to
gauge.
Correction
Remove the instrument cluster and send it to your nearest Delco Repair Station. Repair stations
are aware of the condition and have pans available to repair the cluster. They will add a capacitor
to the power circuit to assure a consistent power flow to the temperature gauge. Be certain to
clearly describe the condition on the Delco Repair Order accompanying the cluster.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 468306 >
Dec > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Erratic
Temperature Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Erratic
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical Bulletin No.: 46-83-06
Date: December, 1994
Subject: Erratic Temperature Gauge (Exchange Instrument Panel Cluster)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with Standard Analog Instrument Panel
Cluster
Condition
Some temperature gauges in the above vehicles may give erratic readings.
Cause
Improper nut on back of temperature gauge inside the I/P cluster, resulting in erratic voltage feed to
gauge.
Correction
Remove the instrument cluster and send it to your nearest Delco Repair Station. Repair stations
are aware of the condition and have pans available to repair the cluster. They will add a capacitor
to the power circuit to assure a consistent power flow to the temperature gauge. Be certain to
clearly describe the condition on the Delco Repair Order accompanying the cluster.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Temperature
Gauge: > 449601 > Apr > 94 > Radio - Buzzing Noise in AM Band With Engine Running
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins Radio - Buzzing Noise in AM Band With
Engine Running
Group Ref.: Accessories
Bulletin No.: 449601
Date: April, 1994
SUBJECT: BUZZING NOISE IN AM BAND OF RADIO (INSTALL FILTER ON PCM/TCM)
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK C/K, S/T TRUCKS AND M/L, G VANS
1992-94 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA WITH 4L60-E AND 4L80-E TRANSMISSIONS
CONDITION:
Some owners may comment of a buzzing noise in the low end of the AM radio band with the
engine running.
CAUSE:
The switching of the force motor in the electronic transmission emits an RFI signal through the
PCM/TCM. The AM band of the radio is receiving this interference through the antenna.
CORRECTION;
To determine if this is the cause of the owner's comments. first duplicate the condition and then
disconnect the electrical connector at the transmission (this will disable the force motor). If the
condition improves. install an in-line filter (P/N 1224205) to the ignition lead (ckt 439) of the
PCM/TCM. Some applications may have two (439 ckt), in which case, a filter will be required for
each lead.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the electrical connector at the transmission will set the transmission diagnostic
codes. It will be necessary to remove these codes after the corrective action has been performed.
IMPORTANT:
Discard the instructions in the filter package. This filter Is an in-line filter with a single lead on one
end and two leads on the other end (one lead being black (ground). Install this filter as close to the
PCM/TCM connector as possible. It Is important to Install the filter with the single lead end going
toward the PCM/TCM and then take the black (ground) lead back and attach it to the case of the
PCM/TCM. If this filter is installed incorrectly, the condition will become worse.
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty use:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine
Is Hot
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine Is
Hot
This condition is generally caused by a blown fuse, open circuit or faulty sensor.
1. Check fuse, replace if necessary. 2. Turn ignition switch to On position, then remove lead at
sensor unit. 3. Connect test lamp from sensor lead to ground, lamp should glow. Short sensor lead
to ground, gauge should indicate "Hot." 4. If gauge indicated HOT, check lead on sensor. If
satisfactory, replace sensor. If gauge indicates COLD, replace cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine
Is Hot > Page 2517
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Indicates Hot When Engine Is Cold
This condition is generally caused by a shorted or grounded circuit.
1. Remove sensor lead at sensor unit. Gauge should move to COLD position, if not check unit for a
external short. If no external short is found,
replace sensor.
2. If gauge stays HOT, check for a short circuit in gauge to sensor wiring. If circuit is satisfactory,
replace cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine
Is Hot > Page 2518
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads High
1. Remove lead at sensor, measure resistance using an ohmmeter. 2. At 104 degrees F resistance
should be approximately 1200-1350 ohms, and at 125 degrees F resistance should be
approximately 53-55 ohms. 3. If resistance is not within specifications, replace sensor. 4.
Disconnect lead at sensor and gauge, check for a high resistance using an ohmmeter. Repair
wiring if necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine
Is Hot > Page 2519
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads Low
1. Ensure terminals are clean and connections are tight. 2. Remove lead at sensor, measure
resistance using an ohmmeter. 3. At 104 degrees F resistance should be approximately 1200-1350
ohms, and at 125 degrees F resistance should be approximately 53-55 ohms. 4. If resistance is not
within specifications, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator, Engine Cooling > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
A bi-metal temperature switch located in the cylinder head controls the operation of a temperature
indicator light. If the engine cooling system is not functioning properly and/or coolant temperature
exceeds a predetermined value, the warning light will illuminate.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator, Engine Cooling > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2523
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
If the light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in the
light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a ground,
defective temperature switch, or overheated cooling system.
As a test circuit to check whether the bulb is functioning properly, connect a wire from the ground
terminal of the ignition switch to the temperature indicator light circuit. When the ignition is in the
START (engine cranking) position, the ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the bulb
will be lit. When the engine is started and the ignition switch is in the ON position, the test circuit is
opened and the bulb is then controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Radiator: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2528
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2529
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2530
Radiator: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling - Radiator Repair/Replacement Guidelines
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 99-06-02-017
Date: October, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Radiator Repair/Replacement Guidelines
Models: 2000 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
If repair of an aluminum/plastic radiator is required, it is recommended that the following guidelines
be followed:
For Vehicles Under Warranty
For aluminum/plastic radiators that have damage to the face of the core including bent fins,
punctures, cuts, leaking tubes or header tubes, the aluminum radiator core section should be
replaced with a new one. In these cases, if both of the plastic tanks are not damaged, they can be
reused with the new core. If one or both of the plastic tanks are damaged along with the core, it is
recommended that a complete new radiator assembly be installed.
Warranty repairs for leaks at the tank to header (gasket leaks), broken/cracked plastic tanks, cross
threaded or leaking oil coolers should be repaired without replacing the complete radiator. This
type of repair should be handled by the radiator repair facility in your area.
Many of these radiator repair facilities are members of the National Automotive Radiator Service
Association (NARSA) who follow industry and General Motors guidelines when repairing radiators.
These facilities have the special tools, tanks and pressurizing equipment needed to properly test
the repaired radiator prior to returning it to the dealership. Many of these facilities receive the repair
components directly from General Motors.
The sublet expense for a new radiator or the repair of the radiator under warranty should be
handled following normal procedures.
For Vehicles No Longer Under Warranty
The GM released epoxy repair kit referenced in previous publications is no longer available.
Repairs to the radiator, rather than replacement, is strictly at the owner's discretion.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Replacement
Radiator: Service and Repair Radiator Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Replacement > Page 2533
Remove or Disconnect 1. Coolant from the radiator. 2. Coolant reservoir hose.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Replacement > Page 2534
3. Upper fan shroud. 4. Hoses.
5. Transmission fluid cooler pipes.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Replacement > Page 2535
6. Engine oil cooler pipes. 7. Radiator.
Install or Connect 1. Radiator. 2. Engine oil cooler line fittings.
Tighten
Fittings to 35 N.m (25 ft. lbs.).
3. Transmission fluid cooler line fittings.
Tighten
Fittings to 27 N.m (20 ft. lbs.).
4. Hoses. 5. Upper fan shroud. 6. Coolant reservoir hose. 7. Coolant to the radiator.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Radiator Replacement > Page 2536
Radiator: Service and Repair Cooling System
1. Drain coolant from radiator, then disconnect upper coolant reservoir hose. 2. Remove upper fan
shroud bolts, then the shroud. 3. Disconnect and plug transmission fluid cooler lines. 4. Disconnect
and plug engine oil cooler lines. 5. Raise and support vehicle, then disconnect lower radiator hose.
6. Disconnect heater hose and coolant overflow hose from radiator. 7. Remove radiator. 8. Reverse
procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Specifications
Radiator Cap: Specifications
Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. .....................................................................................................
............................................................................... 15 Thermo. Opening Temp., deg.F .....................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 195
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2545
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2546
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2549
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2550
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2551
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2552
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2553
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2554
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2555
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2556
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2557
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2558
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2559
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2560
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2561
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2562
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2563
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2564
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2565
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2566
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2567
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2568
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2569
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2570
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2571
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2572
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2573
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2574
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2575
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2576
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2577
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2578
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2579
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2580
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2581
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2582
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Right Front Engine Harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2586
Engine Harness, Right Front
NOTE: The OEM service manual provides multiple location views for this component.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2587
C108 - Eng Coolant Temp Sender
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 468306 > Dec > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Erratic
Temperature Gauge: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Erratic
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical Bulletin No.: 46-83-06
Date: December, 1994
Subject: Erratic Temperature Gauge (Exchange Instrument Panel Cluster)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with Standard Analog Instrument Panel
Cluster
Condition
Some temperature gauges in the above vehicles may give erratic readings.
Cause
Improper nut on back of temperature gauge inside the I/P cluster, resulting in erratic voltage feed to
gauge.
Correction
Remove the instrument cluster and send it to your nearest Delco Repair Station. Repair stations
are aware of the condition and have pans available to repair the cluster. They will add a capacitor
to the power circuit to assure a consistent power flow to the temperature gauge. Be certain to
clearly describe the condition on the Delco Repair Order accompanying the cluster.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 468306 > Dec > 94 > Temperature Gauge Erratic
Temperature Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Erratic
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical Bulletin No.: 46-83-06
Date: December, 1994
Subject: Erratic Temperature Gauge (Exchange Instrument Panel Cluster)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with Standard Analog Instrument Panel
Cluster
Condition
Some temperature gauges in the above vehicles may give erratic readings.
Cause
Improper nut on back of temperature gauge inside the I/P cluster, resulting in erratic voltage feed to
gauge.
Correction
Remove the instrument cluster and send it to your nearest Delco Repair Station. Repair stations
are aware of the condition and have pans available to repair the cluster. They will add a capacitor
to the power circuit to assure a consistent power flow to the temperature gauge. Be certain to
clearly describe the condition on the Delco Repair Order accompanying the cluster.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Temperature Gauge: > NHTSA94V114000 > Jun
> 94 > Recall 94V114000: Trailer Hitch Attaching Bolts Defect
Trailer Hitch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 94V114000: Trailer Hitch Attaching Bolts Defect
THE TRAILER HITCH ATTACHING BOLTS WERE NOT TIGHTENED TO THE SPECIFIED
TORQUE. THIS CAN LEAD TO LOOSENING AND SUBSEQUENT BREAKAGE OF THE
FASTENERS. IF THIS WERE TO OCCUR WHILE THE TRAILER WAS BEING PULLED, THE
HITCH AND TRAILER CAN SEPARATE FROM THE VEHICLE. DEALERS WILL TORQUE ALL
EIGHT TRAILER HITCH BOLTS TO THE CORRECT TORQUE.
SYSTEM: EQUIPMENT; OTHER PIECES; TRAILER HITCHES AND ATTACHMENTS.
VEHICLE DESCRIPTION: LIGHT DUTY 4 DOOR MULTI-PURPOSE VEHICLES EQUIPPED
WITH A WEIGHT DISTRIBUTION TRAILER HITCH (VR4) OPTION.
NOTE: IF YOUR VEHICLE IS PRESENTED TO AN AUTHORIZED DEALER ON AN AGREED
UPON SERVICE DATE AND THE REMEDY IS NOT PROVIDED WITHIN A REASONABLE TIME
AND FREE OF CHARGE OR THE REMEDY DOES NOT CORRECT THE DEFECT OR
NON-COMPLIANCE, PLEASE CONTACT CHEVROLET SERVICE CENTER AT 1-800-222-1020
OR GMC AT 1-313-456-4547. ALSO, CONTACT THE NATIONAL HIGHWAY TRAFFIC SAFETY
ADMINISTRATION'S AUTO SAFETY HOTLINE AT 1-800-424-9393.
1994 CHEVROLET TRUCK BLAZER 1994 GMC JIMMY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine Is Hot
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine Is
Hot
This condition is generally caused by a blown fuse, open circuit or faulty sensor.
1. Check fuse, replace if necessary. 2. Turn ignition switch to On position, then remove lead at
sensor unit. 3. Connect test lamp from sensor lead to ground, lamp should glow. Short sensor lead
to ground, gauge should indicate "Hot." 4. If gauge indicated HOT, check lead on sensor. If
satisfactory, replace sensor. If gauge indicates COLD, replace cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine Is Hot > Page 2613
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Indicates Hot When Engine Is Cold
This condition is generally caused by a shorted or grounded circuit.
1. Remove sensor lead at sensor unit. Gauge should move to COLD position, if not check unit for a
external short. If no external short is found,
replace sensor.
2. If gauge stays HOT, check for a short circuit in gauge to sensor wiring. If circuit is satisfactory,
replace cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine Is Hot > Page 2614
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads High
1. Remove lead at sensor, measure resistance using an ohmmeter. 2. At 104 degrees F resistance
should be approximately 1200-1350 ohms, and at 125 degrees F resistance should be
approximately 53-55 ohms. 3. If resistance is not within specifications, replace sensor. 4.
Disconnect lead at sensor and gauge, check for a high resistance using an ohmmeter. Repair
wiring if necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Gauge Does Not Move From Cold When Engine Is Hot > Page 2615
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection Gauge Reads Low
1. Ensure terminals are clean and connections are tight. 2. Remove lead at sensor, measure
resistance using an ohmmeter. 3. At 104 degrees F resistance should be approximately 1200-1350
ohms, and at 125 degrees F resistance should be approximately 53-55 ohms. 4. If resistance is not
within specifications, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
A bi-metal temperature switch located in the cylinder head controls the operation of a temperature
indicator light. If the engine cooling system is not functioning properly and/or coolant temperature
exceeds a predetermined value, the warning light will illuminate.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2619
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
If the light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in the
light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a ground,
defective temperature switch, or overheated cooling system.
As a test circuit to check whether the bulb is functioning properly, connect a wire from the ground
terminal of the ignition switch to the temperature indicator light circuit. When the ignition is in the
START (engine cranking) position, the ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the bulb
will be lit. When the engine is started and the ignition switch is in the ON position, the test circuit is
opened and the bulb is then controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. .....................................................................................................
............................................................................... 15 Thermo. Opening Temp., deg.F .....................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 195
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2623
Thermostat: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Drain coolant from radiator, then remove water outlet
retaining bolts. 3. Remove outlet and gasket, then the thermostat from the outlet. 4. Reverse
procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Water pump replacement. 4.3L/V6-262
1. Drain cooling system. 2. Remove serpentine drive belt, then the upper fan shroud. 3. Remove
fan,then fan clutch assembly and water pump pulley. 4. Remove hoses from pump. 5. Remove
water pump attaching bolts, then pump Fig. 20. 6. Reverse procedure to install. Torque bolts to
specification.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations
Exhaust Layout S/T 2WD PUP 4.3L
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2631
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CAUTION Prolonged operation with a misfiring or flooded engine may cause the converter to
overheat. This could cause damage either to the catalyst itself or the operating vehicle and
possible personal injury.
NOTE When jacking or lifting vehicle from frame side rails, be certain lift pads DO NOT contact
catalytic converter or damage to converter may result.
Catalytic Converters
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2632
PURPOSE
The catalytic converter is an emission control device added to the exhaust system to effectively
reduce the levels of carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, and in some cases oxides of nitrogen,
entering the atmosphere. The converter serves two purposes: it permits a faster chemical reaction
to take place and although it enters into the chemical reaction, it remains unchanged, ready to
repeat the process.
CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATION
General Motors uses four different converter designs in conjunction with two types of catalysts. The
four converter designs, are: single bed monolith, dual bed monolith, single bed pellet and dual bed
pellet. The two types of catalysts used are an oxidation catalyst and a three-way (reduction)
catalyst. The oxidation catalyst is coated with material containing platinum and palladium which
lowers levels of carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons. The three-way (reduction) catalyst is coated
with platinum and rhodium which lowers levels of oxides of nitrogen (NOx), as well as carbon
monoxide and hydrocarbons. All dual bed converters, whether monolith or pellet type, contain both
oxidation and three-way catalysts.
Due to its high operating temperatures, the catalytic converter usually requires the use of heat
shields. Heat shields are necessary to protect chassis components, passenger compartment and
other areas from heat related damage.
A fill pipe restrictor is used on catalytic converter equipped vehicles, to prevent the larger service
station pump nozzle, used for leaded fuels, being inserted into the filler tube. Since the use of
leaded fuels contaminates the catalysts, rendering them ineffective, the use of unleaded fuels is
mandatory in catalytic converter equipped vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2633
Restricted Exhaust System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Crossover Pipe > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Exhaust Crossover Pipe: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2
Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Exhaust Crossover Pipe: Customer Interest O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Crossover Pipe > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Exhaust Crossover Pipe: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2
Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 2642
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Crossover Pipe > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Exhaust Crossover Pipe: > 566501 > Jul > 95
> O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Exhaust Crossover Pipe: All Technical Service Bulletins O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In
3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Crossover Pipe > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Exhaust Crossover Pipe: > 566501 > Jul > 95
> O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 2648
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Raise and support vehicle. 3. Disconnect exhaust pipe from
manifold. 4. Lower vehicle, then remove spark plug wires from spark plugs. 5. Remove power
steering and alternator rear bracket from left manifold. 6. Remove air cleaner with heat stove pipe
and cold air intake pipe. 7. Remove exhaust manifold bolts and washers, then the manifold. 8.
Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Shift Indicator Light Application and
Operation
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 36-72-07A
Date: February, 1995
Subject: Manual Transmission Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Models: 1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K and S/T Models with Manual Transmission
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year. Please discard bulletin number 367207
(Group Reference - Transmission).
Certain trucks are not equipped with a shift indicator light. The shift light is commonly used to
achieve improved fuel economy by prompting the driver when to upshift. Depending on the
engine/transmission installed in the vehicle, the shift light can have the following characteristics:
^ Indicates proper shift point for maximum fuel economy.
^ Indicates engine over-speed.
^ Shift light is inoperative.
The following charts detail normal shift light operation:
1993 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation > Page 2659
1994 Models:
1995 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2664
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2665
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program
Adapter
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 73-65-13
Date: March, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Reprogramming Capability using the Off Board Programming Adapter
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2666
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2667
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2668
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2669
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2670
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2671
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2672
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2673
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Replacement Component Text Deletion
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-33
Date: October, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 3A - Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis - Text Deletion
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck & T Models with 2.2L Gasoline Engine (VIN 4 - RPO LN2)
or 4.3L Engine (VINs Z, W - RPOs LB4, L35)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, M/L, G, P3, PG Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO
LB4), 5.0L Engine (VIN H - RPO L03), 5.7L Engine VIN K - RPO L05) or 7.4L Engine (VIN N - RPO
L19)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, G, P3 Models with 6.5L Diesel Engine (VINs F, P, S RPOs L65, L49, L56)
This bulletin contains revisions to the "Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnostic" Service
Manuals for the following pages:
1994 S/T Truck - 3A-5
1994-1995 G Van - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 M/L Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 PG/P3 Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K, G, P Truck - 3-17 and Supplement
This Text is to be Deleted
"The replacement PCM may be faulty - After the PCM is replaced, the system should be rechecked
for proper operation. If the Diagnostic Chart again indicates that the PCM is the problem, substitute
a known good PCM".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2674
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Engine VIN Code ID [1] .......................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. Z
Engine Displacement ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L (262 cid)
Engine Configuration ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................................ V6
Fuel Control System
......................................................................................................................................................
Throttle Body Fuel Injection (TBI)
Ignition System ....................................................................................................... Distributor
Ignition W/Ignition Control and Knock Sensor(DI-IC-KS)
Control Module Systems
S/T Pickup Automatic Transmission
......................................................................................................................... Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Utility Manual Transmission
.............................................................................................................................. Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Pickup Manual Transmission
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicle
Control Module (VCM)
Remarks:
[1] The eighth digit of the VIN denotes engine code.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2675
Engine Control Module: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer And Electric Shift Transfer Case
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2676
Engine Or Powertrain Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 Red (32 Pin)
Manual Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2679
Manual Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2680
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2-Blue (32 Pin)
Automatic Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2681
Automatic Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2682
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C210
C210 - PCM
C210 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2683
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C211
C211 - PCM
C211 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2684
Engine Control Module: Diagrams With Manual Transmission
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2685
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2686
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32
Pin) > Page 2687
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2688
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Engine Control Module
Fig. 5 ECM Unit (Showing PROM & CALPAK Locations)
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
PURPOSE
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is the control center of the fuel injection system. It
constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and controls the systems (outputs)
that affect vehicle performance. The PCM also performs the diagnostic function of the system. It
can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
"Service Engine Soon" light on the instrument panel and store a Diagnostic Trouble Code(s) (DTC)
in the PCM memory. The DTC identifies the problem areas to aid the technician in performing
repairs.
OPERATION
The PCM is an electronic computer designed to process the various input information, and send
the necessary electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control
systems. The PCM can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2689
When the PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The PCM has two parts for service: Controller which is the PCM (93 PCM6), without the PROM (MEM-CAL).
- PROM (Programmable Read Only Memory) which is a separate memory calibrator unit
PCM Learning Ability
The PCM has a "learning" ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the fuel
system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected, to clear diagnostic trouble codes or for
other repairs. the "learning" process resets and begins again. A change may be noted in the
vehicle's performance. To "teach" the vehicle, ensure the engine is at operating temperature. The
vehicle should be driven at part throttle, with moderate acceleration and idle conditions until normal
performance returns.
NOTE The PCM must be maintained at a temperature below 85°C (185°F) at all times. This is most
essential if the vehicle is put through a baking process. The PCM will become inoperative if it's
temperature exceeds 85°C (185°F). It is recommended that temporary insulation be placed around
the PCM during the time the vehicle is in a paint oven or other high temperature processes.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2690
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Figure 1
CAUTION
[a] The ignition must be "OFF," when disconnecting or reconnecting the control module connector,
to prevent internal damage to the control module.
[b] To prevent possible Electrostatic Discharge to the control module, Do NOT touch the connector
pins or soldered components on the circuit
boards.
NOTE When replacing a production control module with a service controller, transfer the broadcast
code and production control module part number to the controller label. DO NOT record information
on the access cover.
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery terminal.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Mounting screw.
- Control module from mounting bracket.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease removal.
- Control module harness connectors.
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Remove new control module from its packaging and check the service number to make sure it is
the same as the defective control module.
- PROM removal. Refer to PROM (MEM-CAL) replacement.
NOTE
Replacement control module is supplied without a PROM, so care should be used when removing
it from the defective control module, because it will be reused in the new control module.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Control module harness connectors.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease installation.
- Control module into mounting bracket.
- Mounting screw.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Negative battery terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: Customer Interest Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page
2700
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page
2701
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page
2702
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking >
Page 2708
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking >
Page 2709
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking >
Page 2710
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2711
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Fuel Pump Relay
The Fuel Pump Relay is located on the driver side firewall, near brake booster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2712
C124 - Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2713
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the control module will energize the fuel
pump relay as long as the engine is cranking or running, and the control module is receiving
distributor reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the control module will shut "OFF" the
fuel pump relay within two seconds.
An inoperative fuel pump relay can result in extended crank times, particularily if the engine is cold.
The oil pressure switch will turn "ON" the fuel pump, as soon as oil pressure reaches about 28 kPa
(4 psi).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2714
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
*** UPDATED BY TSB 893206E, DATED OCTOBER 90
When the key is first turned ON, without the engine running, the ECM will turn the fuel pump relay
ON for two seconds. This builds up the fuel pressure to normal operating pressure. If the engine is
not started within two seconds, the ECM will shut the fuel pump OFF and wait until ignition
reference pulses are present. As soon as the engine is cranked, the ECM turns the relay ON,
which powers the fuel pump. The ECM continues to power the fuel pump during engine operation.
If the fuel pump relay fails, it is backed up by the oil pressure switch, which continues to operate
the fuel pump as long as oil pressure remains above 28.0 kPa (4 psi).
RESULTS OF INCORRECT FUEL PUMP SYSTEM OPERATION
- A faulty fuel pump relay can result in long cranking times, particularly if the engine is cold.
- An inoperative fuel pump would cause a no start condition.
- A fuel pump which does not provide enough pressure can result in poor performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2715
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
Relay Center 2.5L,2.8L S
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
1. Verify that ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Retainer, if installed. 3. Electrical connector.
4. Fuel pump relay by depressing bracket clip at rear of relay, or removing bolts from retaining
bracket.
INSTALL/DISCONNECT
1. Fuel pump relay. 2. Electrical connector. 3. Retainer. 4. Verify correct operation to confirm repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Ignition Module
Typical Distributor Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Ignition Module > Page 2721
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2722
C121 - Ignition Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2723
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
Typical Distributor Components
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
NOTE It is not necessary to remove ignition distributor assembly from engine.
- Distributor cap and rotor.
- Connectors from module.
- Two module attaching screws.
- Lift module from housing and remove.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
NOTE: Do not wipe silicone grease from metal face of module or distributor base (where the
module seats), when reinstalling the same module. If new module is to be installed clean distributor
module base and spread new silicone grease on base and metal face of ignition module. The
purpose of the silicone grease is to cool module.
- Module onto housing.
- Module attaching screws. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb.in.)
- Connectors to module.
- Rotor and cap.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2729
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2730
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2733
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2734
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2735
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2736
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2737
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2738
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2739
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2740
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2741
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2742
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2743
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2744
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2745
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2746
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2747
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2748
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2749
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2750
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2751
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2752
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2753
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2754
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2755
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2756
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2757
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2758
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2759
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2760
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2761
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2762
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2763
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2764
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2765
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2766
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2771
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 2776
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
2777
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View >
Page 2780
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View >
Page 2781
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2782
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2783
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2784
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2785
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark
Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2786
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
Voltage 3.6 to 5.2 V at 1000 to 2000 ft
3.5 to 5.1 V at 2000 to 3000 ft
3.3 to 5.0 V at 3000 to 4000 ft
3.2 to 4.8 V at 4000 to 5000 ft
3.0 to 4.6 V at 5000 to 6000 ft
2.9 to 4.5 V at 6000 to 7000 ft
2.8 to 4.3 V at 7000 to 8000 ft
2.6 to 4.2 V at 8000 to 9000 ft
2.5 to 4.0 V at 9000 to 10000 ft
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2790
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2791
MAP Sensor 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2794
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2795
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2796
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2797
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2798
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2799
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2800
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2801
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2802
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2803
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2804
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2805
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2806
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2807
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2808
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2809
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2810
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2811
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2812
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2813
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2814
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2815
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2816
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2817
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2818
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2819
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2820
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2821
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2822
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2823
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2824
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2825
C109 - MAP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2826
MAP Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2827
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Map Sensor Circuit (GM Generic)
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
PURPOSE
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures changes in the intake manifold pressure
resulting from engine load and speed changes. As intake manifold pressure increases, the air
density in the intake manifold also increases and additional fuel is required. Under certain
conditions, the MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure. This allows the control
module to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
The PCM uses information from the MAP sensor to calculate spark advance and fuel as follows: Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in more spark advance.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in less spark advance.
- Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in less fuel.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in more fuel.
OPERATION
The control module supplies a 5 volt reference signal to the MAP sensor and the sensor provides a
path to ground through its variable resistor. The control module by monitoring the sensor output
voltage can determine the manifold pressure. A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a
relatively low MAP output, while a wide open throttle will produce a high output. At higher pressure
or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The higher the MAP
voltage output the lower the engine vacuum, which requires more fuel. The lower the MAP voltage
output the higher the engine vacuum. At lower pressure output voltage will be about 1 to 2 volts at
idle.
A failure in the MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) 33 or 34 with
PCM/ECM systems and DTC P0107 or P0108 with VCM systems.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2828
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Output Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2829
MAP Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changes, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. At lower pressure output voltage will
be about 1 to 2 volts at idle. While at higher pressure or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output
voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The MAP sensor is also used, under certain conditions, to
measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different altitudes. The
PCM uses the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Important
^ Be sure to use the same Diagnostic Test Equipment for all measurements.
1. Checks MAP sensor output voltage to the PCM. This voltage, without engine running, represents
a barometer reading to the PCM.
^ When comparing Tech 1 scan readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number. Refer to figures on facing page.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change.
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage
value should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
NOTICE:Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
4. Disconnect sensor from bracket and twist sensor by hand (only) to check for intermittent
connection. Output changes greater than .1 volt
indicate a bad connector or connection. If OK, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 2838
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear >
Page 2844
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Closed Loop 100 - 0.999 mV
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2856
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor > Page 2859
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2862
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2863
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2864
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2865
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2866
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2867
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2868
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2869
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2870
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2871
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2872
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2873
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2874
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2875
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2876
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2877
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2878
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2879
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2880
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2881
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2882
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2883
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2884
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2885
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2886
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2887
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2888
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2889
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2890
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2891
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2892
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2893
C116 - Oxygen Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2894
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2895
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE
The Oxygen sensor (O2 Sensor) has the ability to produce a low voltage signal that feeds
information on engine exhaust content to the control module.
CONSTRUCTION
The O2 Sensor is constructed from a zirconia/platinum electrolytic element. Zirconia is an
electrolyte that conducts electricity under certain chemical conditions. The element is made of a
ceramic material and is an insulator when cold. At operating temperature, 315°C (600°F), the
element becomes a semiconductor. A platinum coating on the outer surface of the element
stimulates further combustion of the exhaust gases right at the surface and this helps deep the
element up to the desired temperature. The O2 Sensor has an inter cavity which is filled with
atmospheric (reference) air. The atmosphere has approximately 21% oxygen in it. In the electrical
circuit this inter cavity is the positive (+) terminal. The outer surface of the element is exposed to
the exhaust gas stream. It is the negative (-) terminal.
Oxygen Sensor Output Voltage vs. Air/Fuel Ratio
The difference in oxygen concentration in the narrow range of optimum air/fuel ratio causes a large
voltage change that is easily measured.
OPERATION
A rich exhaust (excessive fuel) has almost no oxygen. When there is a large difference in the
amount of oxygen touching the inside and outside surfaces, there is more conduction, and the
sensor puts out a voltage signal above 0.6 volts (600 mV). With lean exhaust (excessive oxygen)
there is about two percent oxygen in the exhaust. This is a smaller difference in oxygen from the
outside surfaces which results in less conduction and a voltage signal below 0.3 volts (300 mV).
The voltages are monitored and used by the control module to "fine tune" the air/fuel ratio to
achieve the ideal mixture desired.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2896
The control module puts out a reference signal of 0.45 volts (450 mV). The reference signal serves
two purposes. The first is to run the engine when it is in OPEN LOOP mode of operation. When the
air/fuel ratio is correct the control module senses 450 mV. When the engine is operating with a rich
air/fuel ratio there is a reduction of free oxygen in the exhaust stream and the O2 sensor voltage
rises above the reference voltage.
When the engine is running lean the voltage drops below the reference voltage due to the excess
oxygen in the exhaust stream. The O2 sensor provides the feedback information for the CLOSED
LOOP operating mode of the fuel delivery system. The O2 sensor indicates to the control module
what is happening in the exhaust. It does not cause things to happen. It is a type of gauge: Low
voltage output = lean mixture = high oxygen content in the exhaust; high voltage output = rich
mixture = low oxygen content in the exhaust.
CONDITIONS THAT CAN SET CODES
An open O2 sensor, should set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 13. A constant low voltage in the
O2 sensor circuit should set a DTC 44. A constant high voltage in the circuit should set a DTC 45.
DTC 44 and DTC 45 could be set as a result of fuel system problems. REFER TO COMPUTERS
AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSTIC CHARTS for diagnosis of these codes.
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR TYPE
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating element that is part of the sensor itself. The heater
helps the control module control the fuel injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) to detect if the heater part of the sensor is working. To check
the heater, REFER TO COMPUTERS AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
PROCEDURES/OXYGEN SENSOR TESTING.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2897
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION
- Connectors and wires
- Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
- Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
CAUTION Do NOT perform the following test for more than 2 minutes, as this may cause damage
to the catalytic converter.
PERFORMANCE TEST
Checks working range and response (speed). Warm engine
- Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt D.C. range)
- "RUN" engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm) Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
- Drive system rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow-meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
- Drive system lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an control module input or
output. Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds. NOTE After each test
the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three seconds.
- O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above. NOTE A CEC system
that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its maximum range and should
be repaired first and not diagnosed as a 02 sensor failure.
- Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
HEATING ELEMENT (H20S only)
- Turn ignition "OFF". Disconnect electrical connector.
- Connect test light between harness terminals "A" and "B".
- Turn ignition "ON". Test light should be "ON". If test light is "OFF", connect test light to harness terminal "A" to ground. Light should be "ON"
ensuring power circuit is operating correctly.
- Turn ignition "OFF".
- Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals A and B.
Resistance @ Specified Temperature
3.5 ohms @ 20°C (68°F) 14 ohms @ 350°C (662°F)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2898
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE The oxygen sensor has a permanently attached pig-tail and connector. This pig-tail should
not be removed, since removal will affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
REMOVAL
- Disconnect electrical connector from oxygen sensor.
- Using suitable wrench, carefully remove sensor from exhaust manifold or pipe.
Caution
The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when engine temperature is below 120°F. Excessive
force may damage threads in exhaust manifold or pipe.
INSTALLATION
- If new sensor is being used, install sensor into manifold or pipe.
- If old sensor is being reused, coat threads with anti-seize compound, Part No. 5613695 or
equivalent, then install into manifold or pipe.
- Torque oxygen sensor to 41 N-m (30 lb. ft.), then reconnect electrical connector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2902
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2905
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2906
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2907
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2908
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2909
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2910
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2911
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2912
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2913
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2914
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2915
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2916
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2917
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2918
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2919
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2920
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2921
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2922
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2923
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2924
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2925
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2926
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2927
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2928
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2929
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2930
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2931
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2932
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2933
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2934
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2935
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2936
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2937
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2938
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2939
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2940
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) - Service
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) Service
Group Ref.: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 448301
Date: August, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: NEW PROCEDURE FOR OBTAINING SERVICE DRACS (DIGITAL RATIO
ADAPTOR/CONTROLLER)
MODELS: 1989-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK M/L VANS, S/T MODELS 1990-94
CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK G VANS, R/V MODELS 1992-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC
TRUCK C/K MODELS 1991-94 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
If a dealer is contacted about or is in need of a service DRAC (Digital Ratio Adaptor/Controller) for
any of the following reasons:
1. Radio interference (EMI).
2. Speedometer fluctuation or flaring.
3. Erratic/surging cruise control operation.
4. Different tire size.
5. Defective part.
The dealer must contact an AC-Delco Service Center authorized to repair electronic instrument
clusters for a new service DRAC, P/N 16202915.
NOTE:
This part is a service part and has to be programmed for the vehicle. It cannot be used until this
procedure has been done by the authorized Service Center.
The dealer will need the P/N and the broadcast code (the 3 bold letters located on the printed label
of the old DRAC). The Service Center will program the DRAC according to this information.
If the customer is changing the tire size, the Service Center will need the axle ratio and tire sized in
order to program the DRAC to the new tire specifications. The AC-Delco Service Center will send
the programmed DRAC via common carrier to the dealership.
For further information, consult the AC-Delco authorized Service Center Manual WA-2 (September
1990 or later). AC-Delco centers are subject to change.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly
View
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Assembly View
LOCATION
Mounted To Transmisssion Tailshaft.
2WD Automatic Transmission
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
2WD Manual Transmission
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
4WD Automatic and Manual Transmission
VSS 4WD Or AWD
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly
View > Page 2950
Speed Sensor, Backup Lamp Switch & Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2951
C320 - Vehicle Speed Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2952
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
2 Wheel Drive (Manual Transmission)
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
2 Wheel Drive (Automatic Transmission)
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
4 Wheel Drive
VSS 4WD Or AWD
PURPOSE
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) provides information to the control module for control of: Transmission Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Speedometer
- Odometer
- Cruise control
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2953
- ANTILOCK brake system.
CONSTRUCTION
The VSS is made up of: Permanent Magnet (PM) generator (coil), which is mounted on the transmission.
- Rotor (tooth), which is mounted on the output shaft in the transmission.
- VSS Buffer, which is mounted to the control module bracket.
OPERATION
The VSS is a Permanent Magnet (PM) generator that produces a pulsing Alternating Current (AC)
voltage as each rotor tooth nears the coil. As the vehicle speed increases, the number of AC
voltage pulses increase. The VSS buffer processes inputs from the VSS and outputs signal to the
speedometer control module and cruise module. The VSS buffer takes the voltage pulses from the
VSS and uses them to open and close four solid state output switches to ground at a rate
proportional to vehicle speed. The VSS buffer is matched to the vehicle based on final drive ratio
and tire size.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2954
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Speed sensor resistance should be 900-2000 ohms. The sensor is not serviceable and should be
replaced if defective. The speed sensor is located on the transfer case.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then disconnect electrical connector from speed sensor. 2. Loosen
sensor with suitable wrench. 3. Position suitable container under sensor, then remove sensor and
O-ring. 4. Coat O-ring with transmission fluid, then install O-ring and speed sensor. 5. Torque
sensor to 32 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Automatic Transmission
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Automatic Transmission > Page 2960
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2961
C120 - Fuel Pump Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2962
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable from battery.
- Sensor or switch connectors.
- Sensor or switch.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Sensor or switch.
- Sensor or switch.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2966
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2969
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2970
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2971
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2972
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2973
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2974
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2975
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2976
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2977
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2978
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2979
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2980
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2981
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2982
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2983
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2984
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2985
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2986
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2987
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2988
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2989
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2990
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2991
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2992
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2993
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2994
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2995
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2996
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2997
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2998
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2999
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3000
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3001
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3002
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3003
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3004
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 3010
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3011
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3014
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3015
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3016
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3017
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3018
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3019
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark
Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3020
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
Diagnostic Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
Component Location - "S/T" 4.3Z Utility - Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Idle Speed - Specification Revised
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission Bulletin No.: 41-65-22 Date: September, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 4 - Revised Controlled Idle Speed Specification
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck Light Duty Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with
Gasoline Engines
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised > Page 3030
This service bulletin supersedes Service Manual information for the Controlled Idle Speed
Specification on Page 4-3 of the Driveability, Emissions, and Electrical Diagnosis Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3031
Idle Speed: Specifications
Refer to Adjustment Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter
Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter
Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3041
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3047
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-6-5-4-3-2
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Ignition Timing Connector > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Set Timing Connector Location Correction
Ignition Timing Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location
Correction
File in Section: Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-41
Date: January, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 6A - Ignition Set Timing Connector Location
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine
(VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
The location of the Set Timing Connector is incorrectly called out in "Section 6A" (Page 6A-8) of the
"Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis", Service Manual and in the 1994 Oldsmobile
Bravada Service Manual Supplement (Page 6E3-C4-8).
The correct location of the Set Timing Connector is inside the cab where the Heater Box and the
carpet meet on the passenger side floor.
Pull carpet back to expose the single wire and connectors on the outside of the control module
harness. The wire colors are tan with a black stripe.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Ignition Timing Connector > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3061
Timing Connector-In Pass Comp Behind Carpet, Below Heater
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Timing Marks and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Timing Mark
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
RESISTANCE VALUES
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 3,000 - 10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 4,000 - 15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 6,000 - 20,000 ohms.
NOTE: Longer wires should measure about 5,000 to 10,000 ohms per foot.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3072
Ignition Cable: Locations
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications
Distributor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3076
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3077
Distributor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The distributor reference signal provides the ECM with both engine RPM and crankshaft position
information. This enables the ECM to operate the fuel pump relay and energize the fuel injector.
OPERATION
When the engine is cranking or running the ECM receives Distributor Ignition (DI) reference pulses
from the ignition module. If the wire becomes open or grounded the engine will not run, as the ECM
will not operate the injector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3078
Distributor: Service and Repair
Distributor
Remove or Disconnect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3079
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3080
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3081
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3082
- Make sure the ignition switch is "OFF."
1. Air cleaner and hoses (4.3L VIN Z). 2. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor
cap. 3. Two screws on the sides of the distributor cap. 4. Coil wire and spark plug wires on either
the left or right side of the distributor. 5. Distributor cap and move it aside.
A. Use chalk to note the position of the rotor in relation to the engine. B. Use chalk to note the
position of the distributor housing in relation to the engine.
6. Distributor bolt and hold-down clamp. 7. Distributor and gasket, when present.
Install or Connect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3083
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3084
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3085
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3086
A. To ensure correct timing of the distributor, it must be installed with the rotor correctly positioned
as noted in step 5 of the removal procedure. Line
up the rotor to the mark on the engine, and the mark on the housing to the engine.
B. If the distributor shaft won't drop into the engine, remove the distributor, insert a screwdriver into
the hole for the distributor and rotate the oil
pump driveshaft so that it lines up with the distributor driver gear.
1. Distributor and gasket, where present. 2. Hold-down clamp and bolt.
- Bolt on the 4.3L to 27 Nm (20 lbs. ft.).
3. Distributor cap. 4. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor. 5. Spark plug wires
and coil wire. 6. Air Cleaner and hoses.
- Check the engine timing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
........................................ N/A see NOTE following.
Spark Plug Torque ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 15 N-m (11 lb.ft.)
Spark Plug Type ..................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... AC CR43TSM
NOTE Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression
Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Minimum, 698 kPa (100 psi) @ 200 rpm. The lowest cylinder reading should not be less than 80%
of the highest. Perform compression test with engine at normal operating temperature, spark plugs
removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
VALVE ADJUSTMENT (VIN Z)
WITH SCREW-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS AND POSITIVE STOP SHOULDERS
Valve Rocker Arm Nuts .......................................................................................................................
.......................................... 27 Nm (20 lb. ft.).
WITH PRESSED-IN ROCKER ARM STUDS
Refer to Rocker Arm / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 3097
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
4.3L/V6-262 Left Side...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. E-I-E-I-I-E Right Side.........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3098
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 10 Valve Adjustment
The 4.3L VIN Z engine can be equipped with two different rocker arm stud configurations that
require different valve lash procedures.
TYPE 1 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has screw-in rocker arm studs with positive stop shoulders, no
valve adjustment is necessary. When the valve train requires service, you simply tighten the rocker
arm nuts to 27 Nm (20 ft lb).
TYPE 2 - VIN Z
If you have a 4.3L VIN Z engine that has pressed-in rocker arm studs, you must follow the valve
adjustment procedure outlined below.
1. Remove rocker arm cover. 2. Rotate engine until mark on torsional damper is aligned with "0"
mark on timing tab fastened to crankcase front cover. To ensure engine is at No.
1 cylinder firing position, place fingers on No. 1 cylinder valves as the mark on damper approaches
the "0" mark on timing tab. If valves are not moving, engine is in the No. 1 cylinder firing position. If
valves are moving, engine is in the No. 4 cylinder firing position and should be rotated one
revolution.
3. With engine in No. 1 cylinder firing position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 1, 5 and 6.
^ Intake valves 1, 2 and 3.
NOTE: Even numbered cylinders are in the left bank and odd numbered cylinders are in the right
bank, when viewed from front of the engine.
4. Back off adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then tighten nut until all lash is removed. This
can be determined by rotating pushrod while
turning adjusting nut. When all lash is removed, tighten adjusting nut 1 and 3/4 turns to center lifter
plunger.
5. Crank engine one full revolution until mark on torsional damper and "0" mark on timing tab are
again in alignment. This is the No. 4 cylinder
firing position. With engine in this position, adjust the following valves:
^ Exhaust valves 2, 3 and 4.
^ Intake valves 4, 5 and 6.
6. Install valve covers and related components, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3099
Valve Clearance: Service and Repair
For Valve Adjustment, Refer to Valve Clearance / Adjustments.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation
A/C Signal: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
This signal indicates that the A/C control switch is turned "ON" and the pressure switch is closed.
The PCM uses this signal to adjust the idle speed.
CONSTRUCTION
A/C clutch control circuit system consists of: Heater and A/C control assembly located at the dashboard.
- Two A/C pressure switches (LOW and HIGH).
- Compressor clutch.
- PCM
OPERATION
Turning "ON" air conditioning supplies battery voltage to the the A/C compressor clutch and
terminal "E12" of the PCM connector to increase and maintain idle speed. The PCM does not
control the A/C compressor clutch, therefore, if A/C does not function refer to HVAC section for
diagnosis of the system. If A/C compressor turns "OFF", check for an open CKT 59 to the PCM. If
circuits are OK, it is a faulty PCM connector terminal "E12" or PCM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3104
A/C Signal: Testing and Inspection
A/C Clutch Control Diagnosis
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3105
A/C Signal Circuit
Circuit Description
Turning "ON" the air conditioning supplies CKT 59 battery voltage to the A/C compressor clutch
and to terminal "E12" of the PCM connector to increase and maintain idle speed.
The PCM does not control the A/C compressor clutch, therefore, if A/C does not function, refer to
the A/C section of the service manual for diagnosis of the system.
If A/C is operating properly and idle speed dips too low when the A/C compressor turns "ON" or
flares too high when the A/C compressor turns "OFF," check for an open CKT 59 to the PCM. If
circuits are OK, it is a faulty PCM connector terminal "E12" or PCM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Shift Indicator Light Application and
Operation
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 36-72-07A
Date: February, 1995
Subject: Manual Transmission Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Models: 1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K and S/T Models with Manual Transmission
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year. Please discard bulletin number 367207
(Group Reference - Transmission).
Certain trucks are not equipped with a shift indicator light. The shift light is commonly used to
achieve improved fuel economy by prompting the driver when to upshift. Depending on the
engine/transmission installed in the vehicle, the shift light can have the following characteristics:
^ Indicates proper shift point for maximum fuel economy.
^ Indicates engine over-speed.
^ Shift light is inoperative.
The following charts detail normal shift light operation:
1993 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation > Page 3110
1994 Models:
1995 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3115
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3119
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3120
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3123
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3124
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3125
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3126
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3127
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3128
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3129
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3130
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3131
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3132
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3133
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3134
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3135
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3136
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3137
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3138
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3139
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3140
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3141
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3142
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3143
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3144
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3145
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3146
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3147
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3148
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3149
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3150
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3151
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3152
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3153
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3154
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3155
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3156
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3160
C221 - Data Link Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3161
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation
ALDL Connector
PURPOSE
The Data Link Connector (DLC) provides a means of communicating with the PCM concerning
engine and transmission operating parameters and accessing Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC).
OPERATION
The PCM communicates a variety of information through the Serial Data Line (DLC terminal "M").
The data is transmitted at a high frequency which requires a Tech 1 diagnostic computer (scan)
tool for interpretation. There are several other non-OEM scan tools available for displaying the
same information.
LOCATION
The Data Link Connector is located in the passenger compartment.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3166
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3167
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program
Adapter
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 73-65-13
Date: March, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Reprogramming Capability using the Off Board Programming Adapter
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3168
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3169
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3170
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3171
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3172
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3173
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3174
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3175
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Replacement Component Text Deletion
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-33
Date: October, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 3A - Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis - Text Deletion
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck & T Models with 2.2L Gasoline Engine (VIN 4 - RPO LN2)
or 4.3L Engine (VINs Z, W - RPOs LB4, L35)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, M/L, G, P3, PG Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO
LB4), 5.0L Engine (VIN H - RPO L03), 5.7L Engine VIN K - RPO L05) or 7.4L Engine (VIN N - RPO
L19)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, G, P3 Models with 6.5L Diesel Engine (VINs F, P, S RPOs L65, L49, L56)
This bulletin contains revisions to the "Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnostic" Service
Manuals for the following pages:
1994 S/T Truck - 3A-5
1994-1995 G Van - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 M/L Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 PG/P3 Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K, G, P Truck - 3-17 and Supplement
This Text is to be Deleted
"The replacement PCM may be faulty - After the PCM is replaced, the system should be rechecked
for proper operation. If the Diagnostic Chart again indicates that the PCM is the problem, substitute
a known good PCM".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3176
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Engine VIN Code ID [1] .......................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. Z
Engine Displacement ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L (262 cid)
Engine Configuration ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................................ V6
Fuel Control System
......................................................................................................................................................
Throttle Body Fuel Injection (TBI)
Ignition System ....................................................................................................... Distributor
Ignition W/Ignition Control and Knock Sensor(DI-IC-KS)
Control Module Systems
S/T Pickup Automatic Transmission
......................................................................................................................... Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Utility Manual Transmission
.............................................................................................................................. Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Pickup Manual Transmission
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicle
Control Module (VCM)
Remarks:
[1] The eighth digit of the VIN denotes engine code.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3177
Engine Control Module: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer And Electric Shift Transfer Case
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3178
Engine Or Powertrain Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 Red (32 Pin)
Manual Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3181
Manual Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3182
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2-Blue (32 Pin)
Automatic Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3183
Automatic Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3184
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C210
C210 - PCM
C210 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3185
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C211
C211 - PCM
C211 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3186
Engine Control Module: Diagrams With Manual Transmission
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3187
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3188
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page 3189
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3190
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Engine Control Module
Fig. 5 ECM Unit (Showing PROM & CALPAK Locations)
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
PURPOSE
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is the control center of the fuel injection system. It
constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and controls the systems (outputs)
that affect vehicle performance. The PCM also performs the diagnostic function of the system. It
can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
"Service Engine Soon" light on the instrument panel and store a Diagnostic Trouble Code(s) (DTC)
in the PCM memory. The DTC identifies the problem areas to aid the technician in performing
repairs.
OPERATION
The PCM is an electronic computer designed to process the various input information, and send
the necessary electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control
systems. The PCM can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3191
When the PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The PCM has two parts for service: Controller which is the PCM (93 PCM6), without the PROM (MEM-CAL).
- PROM (Programmable Read Only Memory) which is a separate memory calibrator unit
PCM Learning Ability
The PCM has a "learning" ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the fuel
system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected, to clear diagnostic trouble codes or for
other repairs. the "learning" process resets and begins again. A change may be noted in the
vehicle's performance. To "teach" the vehicle, ensure the engine is at operating temperature. The
vehicle should be driven at part throttle, with moderate acceleration and idle conditions until normal
performance returns.
NOTE The PCM must be maintained at a temperature below 85°C (185°F) at all times. This is most
essential if the vehicle is put through a baking process. The PCM will become inoperative if it's
temperature exceeds 85°C (185°F). It is recommended that temporary insulation be placed around
the PCM during the time the vehicle is in a paint oven or other high temperature processes.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3192
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Figure 1
CAUTION
[a] The ignition must be "OFF," when disconnecting or reconnecting the control module connector,
to prevent internal damage to the control module.
[b] To prevent possible Electrostatic Discharge to the control module, Do NOT touch the connector
pins or soldered components on the circuit
boards.
NOTE When replacing a production control module with a service controller, transfer the broadcast
code and production control module part number to the controller label. DO NOT record information
on the access cover.
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery terminal.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Mounting screw.
- Control module from mounting bracket.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease removal.
- Control module harness connectors.
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Remove new control module from its packaging and check the service number to make sure it is
the same as the defective control module.
- PROM removal. Refer to PROM (MEM-CAL) replacement.
NOTE
Replacement control module is supplied without a PROM, so care should be used when removing
it from the defective control module, because it will be reused in the new control module.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Control module harness connectors.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease installation.
- Control module into mounting bracket.
- Mounting screw.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Negative battery terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications Actuator Resistance Values
Actuator Resistance Values
Terminals "A" To "B" 40 to 80 ohms
Terminals "C" to "D" 40 to 80 ohms
Terminals "B" to "C" Infinite ohms
Terminals "A" to "D" Infinite ohms
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3196
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Throttle Body Assembly (Exploded View)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 3199
C111 - IAC Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3200
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Idle Air Control (IAC) System
Idle Air Control Valve
IAC System
PURPOSE
To control engine idle speed and prevent stalling due to changes in engine load.
OPERATION
All engine idle speeds are controlled by the control module through the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve
mounted on the throttle body. The control module sends voltage pulses to the IAC motor windings
causing the IAC motor shaft and pintle to move "IN" or "OUT" a given distance (number of
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3201
steps) for each pulse (called counts). Inward movement of the pintle = Decreased RPM =Lower
Counts. Outward movement of the pintle = Increased RPM = Higher Counts.
This movement controls airflow around the throttle plate, which in turn, controls engine idle speed,
either cold or hot. IAC valve pintle position counts can be seen using a Tech 1 scan tool. Zero (0)
counts correspond to a fully closed passage, while 140 counts or more (depending on the
application) corresponds to full flow.
- Actual or "controlled" idle speed is obtained by the control module positioning the IAC valve pintle.
Resulting idle speed is generated from the total
idle air flow (IAC/passage + PCV + throttle valve + vacuum leaks).
- Controlled idle speed is always specified for normal operating conditions. Normal operating
condition is engine coolant temperature in operating
range, the A/C is "OFF," manual transmission is in neutral or automatic transmission in drive with
proper Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch adjustment. A high or low engine coolant temperature,
or A/C clutch engagement may signal the control module to change the IAC counts.
- The minimum idle speed is set at the factory with a stop screw. This setting allows enough air flow
by the throttle valves to cause the IAC valve pintle
to be positioned a calibrated number of steps (counts) from the seat during normal controlled idle
operation. The IAC counts will be higher than normal on an engine with less than 500 miles, or an
engine operating at high altitude or an engine with an accessory load such as the alternator, A/C,
power steering or hydra-boost brakes activated.
Results of Incorrect Operation
If the pintle is stuck open, the idle speed will remain high. If the pintle is stuck closed, the idle
speed will be too low, and stalling may occur. If the pintle is stuck partially open, the idle speed will
be higher than normal, and there will be no response to changes in engine load such as A/C ("ON")
or transmission in ("Drive").
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection PCM Charts
Idle Air Control (IAC) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts > Page 3204
Circuit Description
The control module controls engine idle speed with the IAC valve. To increase idle speed, the
control module retracts the IAC valve pintle away from its seat, allowing more air to pass by the
throttle bore. To decrease idle speed, it extends the IAC valve pintle towards its seat, reducing
bypass air flow. A Tech 1 scan tool will read the control module commands to the IAC valve in
counts. Higher the counts indicate more air bypass (higher idle). The lower the counts indicate less
air is allowed to bypass (lower idle).
Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The IAC tester is used to extend and retract the IAC valve. Valve movement is verified by an
engine speed change. If no change in engine
speed occurs, the valve can be retested when removed from the throttle body.
2. This step checks the quality of the IAC movement in Step 1. Between 700 RPM and about 1500
RPM the engine speed should change
smoothly with each flash of the tester light in both extend and retract. If the IAC valve is retracted
beyond the control range (about 1500 RPM), it may take many flashes in the extend position before
engine speed will begin to drop. This is normal on certain engines, fully extending IAC may cause
engine stall. This may be normal.
3. Steps 1 and 2 verified proper IAC valve operation while this step checks the IAC circuits. Each
lamp on the node light should flash red and
green while the IAC valve is cycled. While the sequence of color is not important if either light is
"OFF" or does not flash red and green, check the circuits for faults beginning with poor terminal
contacts.
IAC VALVE RESET PROCEDURE
^ Disconnect battery cable at battery for 10 seconds then reconnect cable. ^ Ignition "ON," engine
"OFF" for 5 seconds. ^ Ignition "OFF" for 10 seconds.
Diagnostic Aids
A slow, unstable, or fast idle may be caused by a non-IAC system problem that cannot be
overcome by the IAC valve. Out of control range, IAC Tech 1 scan tool counts will be above 60 if
idle is too low, and zero counts if idle is too high. The following checks should be made to repair a
non-IAC system problem.
^ Vacuum Leak (High Idle) - If idle is too high, stop the engine. Fully extend (low) IAC with tester.
Start engine. If idle speed is above 800 RPM,
locate and correct vacuum leak including crankcase ventilation system. Also, check for binding of
throttle blade or linkage.
^ System Too Rich (Low Air Fuel Ratio) The idle speed will be too low. Tech 1 scan tool IAC counts
will usually be above 80. System is obviously
rich and may exhibit black smoke in exhaust. Tech 1 scan tool O2 voltage will be fixed above 800
mV (.8 volt).
Check for high fuel pressure, leaking or sticking injector. Silicone contaminated 02S scan voltage
will be slow to respond.
^ Throttle Body - Remove IAC valve and inspect bore for foreign material. ^ IAC Valve Electrical
Connections - IAC valve connections should be carefully checked for proper contact. ^ Crankcase
Ventilation Valve - An incorrect or faulty crankcase ventilation valve may result in an incorrect idle
speed.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ A/C Compressor - Refer to A/C diagnosis if circuit is shorted to ground. If the relay is faulty, an
idle problem may exist.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ If intermittent poor driveability or idle symptoms are resolved by disconnecting the IAC, carefully
recheck connections, valve terminal resistance
or replace IAC.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts > Page 3205
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection VCM Charts
Idle Air Control (IAC) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts > Page 3206
Circuit Description
The control module controls engine idle speed with the IAC valve. To increase idle speed, the
control module retracts the IAC valve pintle away from its seat, allowing more air to pass by the
throttle bore. To decrease idle speed, it extends the IAC valve pintle towards its seat, reducing
bypass air flow. A Tech 1 scan tool will read the control module commands to the IAC valve in
counts. Higher the counts indicate more air bypass (higher idle). The lower the counts indicate less
air is allowed to bypass (lower idle).
Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The IAC tester is used to extend and retract the IAC valve. Valve movement is verified by an
engine speed change. If no change in engine
speed occurs, the valve can be retested when removed from the throttle body.
2. This step checks the quality of the IAC movement in Step 1. Between 700 RPM and about 1500
RPM the engine speed should change
smoothly with each flash of the tester light in both extend and retract. If the IAC valve is retracted
beyond the control range (about 1500 RPM), it may take many flashes in the extend position before
engine speed will begin to drop. This is normal on certain engines, fully extending IAC may cause
engine stall. This may be normal.
3. Steps 1 and 2 verified proper IAC valve operation while this step checks the IAC circuits. Each
lamp on the node light should flash red and
green while the IAC valve is cycled. While the sequence of color is not important if either light is
"OFF" or does not flash red and green, check the circuits for faults beginning with poor terminal
contacts.
IAC VALVE RESET PROCEDURE
^ Disconnect battery cable at battery for 10 seconds then reconnect cable. ^ Ignition "ON," engine
"OFF" for 5 seconds. ^ Ignition "OFF" for 10 seconds.
Diagnostic Aids
A slow, unstable, or fast idle may be caused by a non-IAC system problem that cannot be
overcome by the IAC valve. Out of control range, IAC Tech 1 scan tool counts will be above 60 if
idle is too low, and zero counts if idle is too high. The following checks should be made to repair a
non-IAC system problem.
^ Vacuum Leak (High Idle) - If idle is too high, stop the engine. Fully extend (low) IAC with tester.
Start engine. If idle speed is above 800 RPM,
locate and correct vacuum leak including crankcase ventilation system. Also, check for binding of
throttle blade or linkage.
^ System Too Rich (Low Air Fuel Ratio) The idle speed will be too low. Tech 1 scan tool IAC counts
will usually be above 80. System is obviously
rich and may exhibit black smoke in exhaust. Tech 1 scan tool O2 voltage will be fixed above 800
mV (.8 volt).
Check for high fuel pressure, leaking or sticking injector. Silicone contaminated 02S scan voltage
will be slow to respond.
^ Throttle Body - Remove IAC valve and inspect bore for foreign material. ^ IAC Valve Electrical
Connections - IAC valve connections should be carefully checked for proper contact. ^ Crankcase
Ventilation Valve - An incorrect or faulty crankcase ventilation valve may result in an incorrect idle
speed.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ A/C Compressor - Refer to A/C diagnosis if circuit is shorted to ground. If the relay is faulty, an
idle problem may exist.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ If intermittent poor driveability or idle symptoms are resolved by disconnecting the IAC, carefully
recheck connections, valve terminal resistance
or replace IAC.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3207
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
NOTES
- The Idle Air Control (IAC) valve is an electrical component and must not be soaked in any liquid
cleaner or solvent. Otherwise damage could result.
- The IAC valve for this application is thread-mounted and has a dual taper, 10 mm diameter,
pintle. Any replacement of the IAC valve must have the correct part number, with the appropriate
pintle taper and diameter for proper seating of the valve in the throttle body.
IAC Thread Mounted 10mm Pintle
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connector.
- IAC valve, use a 32 mm (1 1/4") wrench.
- IAC gasket and discard.
CLEAN
- Both original and replacement IAC valves have a special factory applied thread-locking compound
applied to the screw threads. If the valve removed from throttle body is being reinstalled, DO NOT
remove thread-locking that may remain on the threads.
- Clean IAC valve seating surfaces on throttle body to assure proper seal of new gasket and IAC
valve.
Idle Air Control Valve Pintle Retraction (Manually)
NOTES
- If the IAC valve was removed during service, its operation may be tested electrically with the
IAC/ISC Motor Tester (J-37027 or BT-8256K) or equivalent. Before installing IAC valve, measure
the distance between the tip of the valve pintle and mounting surface. If the dimension is greater
than 28.0 mm (1.10 inches), valve pintle must be retracted to prevent damage to valve. This may
be done electrically using an IAC/ISC Motor Tester or manually by exerting firm pressure, as
shown in the illustration, with a slight side to side movement on valve pintle to retract it.
- No physical adjustment of the IAC valve assembly is required after installation. The IAC valve
pintle is reset by turning the ignition "ON" for ten seconds and then OFF. The ECM then resets the
pintle to the correct position. Proper idle regulation should result.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- IAC valve into throttle body with new gasket.
NOTE New IAC valves have been reset at the factory and should be installed in throttle body in an
"as is" condition, without any adjustment.
- Tighten IAC valve assembly to 18.0 Nm (13.0 lb-ft).
- Electrical connector to IAC valve.
- Reset IAC valve pintle position as follows: - Depress accelerator pedal slightly. - "START" and run
engine for five seconds. - Turn ignition "OFF" for ten seconds.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3208
- Restart engine and check for proper idle operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 3213
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3214
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3217
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3218
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3219
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3220
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3221
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3222
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3223
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Locations
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Locations
Instrument cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3227
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL), "Service Engine Soon" light has the following purposes: Inform the driver that a problem has occurred, and that the vehicle should be taken for service as
soon as reasonably possible.
- Displays Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) stored by the ECM helping the technician diagnose
system faults.
- Indicates "Open Loop" or "Closed Loop" operation.
OPERATION
The MIL will come "ON" with the key "ON" and the engine not running. When the engine is started,
the light will turn "OFF.". This is a bulb and system check. If the light remains "ON," the
self-diagnostic system has detected a problem. If the problem goes away, the light will go out in
most cases after 10 seconds, but a DTC will remain stored in the ECM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3228
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
The CHECK ENGINE LAMP will be illuminated when the ignition switch is placed in the "ON"
position. When the engine is started, the lamp should turn "OFF". If the lamp remains "ON" for 10
seconds or constantly after the engine is started, the self diagnosis system has detected a problem
and has stored a code in the system Control Module.
After diagnosis and repair, the ECM memory can be cleared of codes by removing the Control
Module fuse or disconnecting the battery ground cable for approximately 30 seconds, with ignition
switch in the "OFF" position. NOTE If battery ground cable is disconnected to clear codes, components such as clocks, electronically
tuned radios etc., will have to be reset.
- It is a good idea to record preset radio stations before disconnecting the negative battery cable.
This will allow the stations to be reset as to not inconvenience the customer.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
Voltage 3.6 to 5.2 V at 1000 to 2000 ft
3.5 to 5.1 V at 2000 to 3000 ft
3.3 to 5.0 V at 3000 to 4000 ft
3.2 to 4.8 V at 4000 to 5000 ft
3.0 to 4.6 V at 5000 to 6000 ft
2.9 to 4.5 V at 6000 to 7000 ft
2.8 to 4.3 V at 7000 to 8000 ft
2.6 to 4.2 V at 8000 to 9000 ft
2.5 to 4.0 V at 9000 to 10000 ft
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3232
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3233
MAP Sensor 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3236
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3237
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3238
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3239
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3240
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3241
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3242
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3243
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3244
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3245
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3246
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3247
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3248
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3249
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3250
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3251
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3252
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3253
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3254
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3255
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3256
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3257
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3258
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3259
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3260
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3261
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3262
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3263
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3264
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3265
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3266
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3267
C109 - MAP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3268
MAP Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3269
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Map Sensor Circuit (GM Generic)
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
PURPOSE
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures changes in the intake manifold pressure
resulting from engine load and speed changes. As intake manifold pressure increases, the air
density in the intake manifold also increases and additional fuel is required. Under certain
conditions, the MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure. This allows the control
module to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
The PCM uses information from the MAP sensor to calculate spark advance and fuel as follows: Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in more spark advance.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in less spark advance.
- Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in less fuel.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in more fuel.
OPERATION
The control module supplies a 5 volt reference signal to the MAP sensor and the sensor provides a
path to ground through its variable resistor. The control module by monitoring the sensor output
voltage can determine the manifold pressure. A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a
relatively low MAP output, while a wide open throttle will produce a high output. At higher pressure
or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The higher the MAP
voltage output the lower the engine vacuum, which requires more fuel. The lower the MAP voltage
output the higher the engine vacuum. At lower pressure output voltage will be about 1 to 2 volts at
idle.
A failure in the MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) 33 or 34 with
PCM/ECM systems and DTC P0107 or P0108 with VCM systems.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3270
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Output Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3271
MAP Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changes, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. At lower pressure output voltage will
be about 1 to 2 volts at idle. While at higher pressure or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output
voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The MAP sensor is also used, under certain conditions, to
measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different altitudes. The
PCM uses the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Important
^ Be sure to use the same Diagnostic Test Equipment for all measurements.
1. Checks MAP sensor output voltage to the PCM. This voltage, without engine running, represents
a barometer reading to the PCM.
^ When comparing Tech 1 scan readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number. Refer to figures on facing page.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change.
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage
value should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
NOTICE:Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
4. Disconnect sensor from bracket and twist sensor by hand (only) to check for intermittent
connection. Output changes greater than .1 volt
indicate a bad connector or connection. If OK, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Memory Calibration Unit >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM/MEMCAL - Identification Marks
Memory Calibration Unit: Technical Service Bulletins PROM/MEMCAL - Identification Marks
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 44-65-01
Date: October, 1994
Subject: New PROM/MEMCAL Identification Markings
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Note:
For the purposes of this document, the terms PROM and MEMCAL will be used interchangeably.
To simplify identification of service PROMs. a new external marking format will be implemented.
Parts manufactured after Sept. 1994 will feature these new markings. This change will place the full
8-digit service part number on the PROM, in place of the old 4-digit "EXTERNAL ID" number. In the
past, parts and service personnel could not identify a PROM without using a cross-reference table
that matched external IDs and service numbers. In the future, the cross-reference table will not be
required for PROMs; parts will be ordered directly from the number appearing on the PROM.
However, the label will retain the broadcast code alpha characters to allow continued use of
cross-reference charts, if so desired.
Old Marking Format:
New Marking Format:
^ Ordering the above PROM from the old marking format would require using a cross-reference
chart to determine a service part number, based on the BROAD CAST CODE and EXTERNAL ID
NUMBERS.
^ To order from the new format, simply combine the 2nd and 3rd lines to form an 8-digit part
number that can be directly ordered from SPO (number 16134624 in the above example).
As these changes are phased into the parts inventory, it should be noted that dealers will continue
to see parts with both formats for some time in the future. This is because:
^ Millions of vehicles have already been built with the old format.
^ SPO has existing stock of MEMCALs and PROMs with the old format.
^ PROMS with 7-digit part numbers (representing less than 10% of current part numbers) will
continue to use the old format. The 7-digit part numbers are easily identified because they always
begin with "122xxxx".
Due to manufacturing processes, more than one 8-digit part number may appear on a MEMCAL. In
this event, service personnel should use the label on the exterior cover of the MEMCAL assembly.
To avoid confusion, only the service label will include the BROAD CAST CODE, consisting of letter
characters (I.E., ARCL).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Memory Calibration Unit >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM/MEMCAL - Identification Marks > Page 3276
CHANGES TO MEMCAL/PROM LABELING FORMATS
^ MEMCALs may use either INK-JET or ADHESIVE labels, as shown.
^ PROMs will always use ADHESIVE labels with the same format as shown for MEMCALs. These
changes will become effective on parts manufactured after 10/94.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations
Quad Driver: Locations
Quad/Output drivers are hard wired onto the ECM/PCM/VCM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3280
Quad Driver: Description and Operation
Quad/Output Driver Module
The Control Module in this vehicle controls most components with electronic switches which
complete a ground circuit when turned on. When the switches are arranged in groups of 4, they
can independently control up to 4 outputs and are called Quad Drivers. When the switches are
arranged in groups of 7, they can independently control up to 7 outputs and are called Output
Drivers. Not all outputs are always used.
Shorted solenoid. relay coil. or harness- Solenoids and relays are turned "ON" and "OFF" by the
PCM or VCM using internal electronic switches called "drivers." Each driver is part of a group of
four called "quad-drivers." Failure of one driver can damage any other driver in the set.
A shorted solenoid, relay coil. or harness will not damage the "quad-drivers" in this VCM/PCM, but
will cause the circuit and controlled component to be inoperative. When the circuit fault is not
present or has been repaired, the "quad-driver" will again operate in a normal manner due to its
fault protected design. If a fault has been repaired in a circuit, controlled by a "quad-driver," the
original VCM/PCM should be reinstalled and the circuit checked for proper operation. PCM
replacement will not be necessary if the repaired circuit or component operates correctly.
The J 39200 DVM testers, or equivalent, provide a fast, accurate means of checking for a shorted
coil, or a short to battery voltage.
The replacement VCM/PCM may be faulty - After the VCM/PCM is replaced, the system should be
rechecked for proper operation. If the diagnostic chart again indicates that the VCM/PCM is the
problem, substitute a known good VCM/PCM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3281
Quad Driver: Testing and Inspection
Little or no quad driver testing was supplied by the manufacturer. The engine module decides when
to turn each switch of the driver "ON".
Even though some models will set codes, in the end, if you want to check the driver itself, you'll
need:
1. To use a scantool to command the suspected driver switch to energize (ground) the circuit, while
checking with a test light, 2. To operate the vehicle in a way that should cause the suspected
portion of the driver to switch "ON".
On the up side, since the early 90's, most driver load circuits utilized circuit breakers. This
protected most drivers and engine models from burning up when the circuit was overloaded.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3282
Quad Driver: Service and Repair
Quad/Output drivers are hard wired onto the ECM/PCM/VCM, and can't be serviced separately.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling
Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling
Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 3291
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul >
95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul >
95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 3297
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb >
81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 >
Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Closed Loop 100 - 0.999 mV
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3309
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor > Page 3312
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3315
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3316
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3317
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3318
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3319
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3320
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3321
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3322
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3323
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3324
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3325
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3326
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3327
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3328
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3329
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3330
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3331
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3332
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3333
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3334
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3335
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3336
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3337
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3338
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3339
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3340
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3341
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3342
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3343
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3344
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3345
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3346
C116 - Oxygen Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3347
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3348
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE
The Oxygen sensor (O2 Sensor) has the ability to produce a low voltage signal that feeds
information on engine exhaust content to the control module.
CONSTRUCTION
The O2 Sensor is constructed from a zirconia/platinum electrolytic element. Zirconia is an
electrolyte that conducts electricity under certain chemical conditions. The element is made of a
ceramic material and is an insulator when cold. At operating temperature, 315°C (600°F), the
element becomes a semiconductor. A platinum coating on the outer surface of the element
stimulates further combustion of the exhaust gases right at the surface and this helps deep the
element up to the desired temperature. The O2 Sensor has an inter cavity which is filled with
atmospheric (reference) air. The atmosphere has approximately 21% oxygen in it. In the electrical
circuit this inter cavity is the positive (+) terminal. The outer surface of the element is exposed to
the exhaust gas stream. It is the negative (-) terminal.
Oxygen Sensor Output Voltage vs. Air/Fuel Ratio
The difference in oxygen concentration in the narrow range of optimum air/fuel ratio causes a large
voltage change that is easily measured.
OPERATION
A rich exhaust (excessive fuel) has almost no oxygen. When there is a large difference in the
amount of oxygen touching the inside and outside surfaces, there is more conduction, and the
sensor puts out a voltage signal above 0.6 volts (600 mV). With lean exhaust (excessive oxygen)
there is about two percent oxygen in the exhaust. This is a smaller difference in oxygen from the
outside surfaces which results in less conduction and a voltage signal below 0.3 volts (300 mV).
The voltages are monitored and used by the control module to "fine tune" the air/fuel ratio to
achieve the ideal mixture desired.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3349
The control module puts out a reference signal of 0.45 volts (450 mV). The reference signal serves
two purposes. The first is to run the engine when it is in OPEN LOOP mode of operation. When the
air/fuel ratio is correct the control module senses 450 mV. When the engine is operating with a rich
air/fuel ratio there is a reduction of free oxygen in the exhaust stream and the O2 sensor voltage
rises above the reference voltage.
When the engine is running lean the voltage drops below the reference voltage due to the excess
oxygen in the exhaust stream. The O2 sensor provides the feedback information for the CLOSED
LOOP operating mode of the fuel delivery system. The O2 sensor indicates to the control module
what is happening in the exhaust. It does not cause things to happen. It is a type of gauge: Low
voltage output = lean mixture = high oxygen content in the exhaust; high voltage output = rich
mixture = low oxygen content in the exhaust.
CONDITIONS THAT CAN SET CODES
An open O2 sensor, should set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 13. A constant low voltage in the
O2 sensor circuit should set a DTC 44. A constant high voltage in the circuit should set a DTC 45.
DTC 44 and DTC 45 could be set as a result of fuel system problems. REFER TO COMPUTERS
AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSTIC CHARTS for diagnosis of these codes.
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR TYPE
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating element that is part of the sensor itself. The heater
helps the control module control the fuel injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) to detect if the heater part of the sensor is working. To check
the heater, REFER TO COMPUTERS AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
PROCEDURES/OXYGEN SENSOR TESTING.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3350
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION
- Connectors and wires
- Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
- Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
CAUTION Do NOT perform the following test for more than 2 minutes, as this may cause damage
to the catalytic converter.
PERFORMANCE TEST
Checks working range and response (speed). Warm engine
- Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt D.C. range)
- "RUN" engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm) Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
- Drive system rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow-meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
- Drive system lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an control module input or
output. Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds. NOTE After each test
the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three seconds.
- O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above. NOTE A CEC system
that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its maximum range and should
be repaired first and not diagnosed as a 02 sensor failure.
- Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
HEATING ELEMENT (H20S only)
- Turn ignition "OFF". Disconnect electrical connector.
- Connect test light between harness terminals "A" and "B".
- Turn ignition "ON". Test light should be "ON". If test light is "OFF", connect test light to harness terminal "A" to ground. Light should be "ON"
ensuring power circuit is operating correctly.
- Turn ignition "OFF".
- Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals A and B.
Resistance @ Specified Temperature
3.5 ohms @ 20°C (68°F) 14 ohms @ 350°C (662°F)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3351
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE The oxygen sensor has a permanently attached pig-tail and connector. This pig-tail should
not be removed, since removal will affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
REMOVAL
- Disconnect electrical connector from oxygen sensor.
- Using suitable wrench, carefully remove sensor from exhaust manifold or pipe.
Caution
The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when engine temperature is below 120°F. Excessive
force may damage threads in exhaust manifold or pipe.
INSTALLATION
- If new sensor is being used, install sensor into manifold or pipe.
- If old sensor is being reused, coat threads with anti-seize compound, Part No. 5613695 or
equivalent, then install into manifold or pipe.
- Torque oxygen sensor to 41 N-m (30 lb. ft.), then reconnect electrical connector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay: Technical Service Bulletins Shift Indicator Light Application and
Operation
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 36-72-07A
Date: February, 1995
Subject: Manual Transmission Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Models: 1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K and S/T Models with Manual Transmission
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year. Please discard bulletin number 367207
(Group Reference - Transmission).
Certain trucks are not equipped with a shift indicator light. The shift light is commonly used to
achieve improved fuel economy by prompting the driver when to upshift. Depending on the
engine/transmission installed in the vehicle, the shift light can have the following characteristics:
^ Indicates proper shift point for maximum fuel economy.
^ Indicates engine over-speed.
^ Shift light is inoperative.
The following charts detail normal shift light operation:
1993 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation > Page 3357
1994 Models:
1995 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3362
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3363
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program
Adapter
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 73-65-13
Date: March, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Reprogramming Capability using the Off Board Programming Adapter
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3364
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3365
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3366
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3367
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3368
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3369
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3370
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 3371
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Replacement Component Text Deletion
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-33
Date: October, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 3A - Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis - Text Deletion
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck & T Models with 2.2L Gasoline Engine (VIN 4 - RPO LN2)
or 4.3L Engine (VINs Z, W - RPOs LB4, L35)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, M/L, G, P3, PG Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO
LB4), 5.0L Engine (VIN H - RPO L03), 5.7L Engine VIN K - RPO L05) or 7.4L Engine (VIN N - RPO
L19)
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, G, P3 Models with 6.5L Diesel Engine (VINs F, P, S RPOs L65, L49, L56)
This bulletin contains revisions to the "Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnostic" Service
Manuals for the following pages:
1994 S/T Truck - 3A-5
1994-1995 G Van - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 M/L Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 PG/P3 Truck - 3A-4
1994-1995 C/K, G, P Truck - 3-17 and Supplement
This Text is to be Deleted
"The replacement PCM may be faulty - After the PCM is replaced, the system should be rechecked
for proper operation. If the Diagnostic Chart again indicates that the PCM is the problem, substitute
a known good PCM".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
3372
Engine Control Module: Specifications
Engine VIN Code ID [1] .......................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. Z
Engine Displacement ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................... 4.3L (262 cid)
Engine Configuration ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................................ V6
Fuel Control System
......................................................................................................................................................
Throttle Body Fuel Injection (TBI)
Ignition System ....................................................................................................... Distributor
Ignition W/Ignition Control and Knock Sensor(DI-IC-KS)
Control Module Systems
S/T Pickup Automatic Transmission
......................................................................................................................... Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Utility Manual Transmission
.............................................................................................................................. Powertrain Control
Module (93PCM6)
S/T Pickup Manual Transmission
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicle
Control Module (VCM)
Remarks:
[1] The eighth digit of the VIN denotes engine code.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
3373
Engine Control Module: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer And Electric Shift Transfer Case
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
3374
Engine Or Powertrain Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 Red (32 Pin)
Manual Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3377
Manual Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3378
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2-Blue (32 Pin)
Automatic Transmission (1 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3379
Automatic Transmission (2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3380
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C210
C210 - PCM
C210 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3381
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C211
C211 - PCM
C211 - ECM
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3382
Engine Control Module: Diagrams With Manual Transmission
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3383
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3384
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 Red (32 Pin) > Page
3385
Pinout Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3386
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Engine Control Module
Fig. 5 ECM Unit (Showing PROM & CALPAK Locations)
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
PURPOSE
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is the control center of the fuel injection system. It
constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and controls the systems (outputs)
that affect vehicle performance. The PCM also performs the diagnostic function of the system. It
can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
"Service Engine Soon" light on the instrument panel and store a Diagnostic Trouble Code(s) (DTC)
in the PCM memory. The DTC identifies the problem areas to aid the technician in performing
repairs.
OPERATION
The PCM is an electronic computer designed to process the various input information, and send
the necessary electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control
systems. The PCM can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3387
When the PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The PCM has two parts for service: Controller which is the PCM (93 PCM6), without the PROM (MEM-CAL).
- PROM (Programmable Read Only Memory) which is a separate memory calibrator unit
PCM Learning Ability
The PCM has a "learning" ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the fuel
system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected, to clear diagnostic trouble codes or for
other repairs. the "learning" process resets and begins again. A change may be noted in the
vehicle's performance. To "teach" the vehicle, ensure the engine is at operating temperature. The
vehicle should be driven at part throttle, with moderate acceleration and idle conditions until normal
performance returns.
NOTE The PCM must be maintained at a temperature below 85°C (185°F) at all times. This is most
essential if the vehicle is put through a baking process. The PCM will become inoperative if it's
temperature exceeds 85°C (185°F). It is recommended that temporary insulation be placed around
the PCM during the time the vehicle is in a paint oven or other high temperature processes.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3388
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Figure 1
CAUTION
[a] The ignition must be "OFF," when disconnecting or reconnecting the control module connector,
to prevent internal damage to the control module.
[b] To prevent possible Electrostatic Discharge to the control module, Do NOT touch the connector
pins or soldered components on the circuit
boards.
NOTE When replacing a production control module with a service controller, transfer the broadcast
code and production control module part number to the controller label. DO NOT record information
on the access cover.
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery terminal.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Mounting screw.
- Control module from mounting bracket.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease removal.
- Control module harness connectors.
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Remove new control module from its packaging and check the service number to make sure it is
the same as the defective control module.
- PROM removal. Refer to PROM (MEM-CAL) replacement.
NOTE
Replacement control module is supplied without a PROM, so care should be used when removing
it from the defective control module, because it will be reused in the new control module.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Mounting brackets and modules if equipped.
- Control module harness connectors.
- VSS buffer connector and rotate control module to ease installation.
- Control module into mounting bracket.
- Mounting screw.
- Hush panel if equipped.
- Passenger side kick panel.
- Negative battery terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3393
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3394
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3397
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3398
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3399
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3400
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3401
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3402
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3403
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3404
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3405
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3406
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3407
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3408
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3409
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3410
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3411
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3412
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3413
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3414
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3415
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3416
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3417
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3418
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3419
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3420
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3421
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3422
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3423
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3424
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3425
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3426
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3427
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3428
C105 - Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3429
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3430
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor information is used by the control module to
control: Fuel delivery
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Engine Spark Timing (EST)
- Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
- Idle Air Control (IAC)
- Cooling Fan
OPERATION
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow mounted to the intake manifold.
When the coolant temperature is low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant
temperature is high, the sensor produces a low resistance.
The PCM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the PCM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 185 ohms at 210 deg F
450 ohms at 160 deg F
1800 ohms at 100 deg F
3400 ohms at 70 deg F
7500 ohms at 40 deg F
13500 ohms at 20 deg F
25000 ohms at 0 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 3435
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor
Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor
Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 3440
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3441
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3444
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3445
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3446
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3447
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3448
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3449
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3450
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
Voltage 3.6 to 5.2 V at 1000 to 2000 ft
3.5 to 5.1 V at 2000 to 3000 ft
3.3 to 5.0 V at 3000 to 4000 ft
3.2 to 4.8 V at 4000 to 5000 ft
3.0 to 4.6 V at 5000 to 6000 ft
2.9 to 4.5 V at 6000 to 7000 ft
2.8 to 4.3 V at 7000 to 8000 ft
2.6 to 4.2 V at 8000 to 9000 ft
2.5 to 4.0 V at 9000 to 10000 ft
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
3454
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
3455
MAP Sensor 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3458
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3459
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3460
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3461
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3462
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3463
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3464
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3465
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3466
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3467
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3468
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3469
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3470
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3471
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3472
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3473
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3474
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3475
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3476
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3477
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3478
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3479
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3480
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3481
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3482
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3483
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3484
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3485
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3486
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3487
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3488
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3489
C109 - MAP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3490
MAP Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3491
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Map Sensor Circuit (GM Generic)
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
PURPOSE
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures changes in the intake manifold pressure
resulting from engine load and speed changes. As intake manifold pressure increases, the air
density in the intake manifold also increases and additional fuel is required. Under certain
conditions, the MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure. This allows the control
module to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
The PCM uses information from the MAP sensor to calculate spark advance and fuel as follows: Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in more spark advance.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in less spark advance.
- Low MAP output voltage (low pressure) results in less fuel.
- High MAP output voltage (high pressure) results in more fuel.
OPERATION
The control module supplies a 5 volt reference signal to the MAP sensor and the sensor provides a
path to ground through its variable resistor. The control module by monitoring the sensor output
voltage can determine the manifold pressure. A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a
relatively low MAP output, while a wide open throttle will produce a high output. At higher pressure
or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The higher the MAP
voltage output the lower the engine vacuum, which requires more fuel. The lower the MAP voltage
output the higher the engine vacuum. At lower pressure output voltage will be about 1 to 2 volts at
idle.
A failure in the MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) 33 or 34 with
PCM/ECM systems and DTC P0107 or P0108 with VCM systems.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3492
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Output Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3493
MAP Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changes, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. At lower pressure output voltage will
be about 1 to 2 volts at idle. While at higher pressure or at Wide Open Throttle (WOT) output
voltage will be about 4 to 4.8 volts. The MAP sensor is also used, under certain conditions, to
measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different altitudes. The
PCM uses the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Important
^ Be sure to use the same Diagnostic Test Equipment for all measurements.
1. Checks MAP sensor output voltage to the PCM. This voltage, without engine running, represents
a barometer reading to the PCM.
^ When comparing Tech 1 scan readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number. Refer to figures on facing page.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change.
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage
value should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
NOTICE:Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
4. Disconnect sensor from bracket and twist sensor by hand (only) to check for intermittent
connection. Output changes greater than .1 volt
indicate a bad connector or connection. If OK, replace sensor.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 3502
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 56-65-01
DATE: July, 1995
SUBJECT: Rattling Noise on Acceleration/Transmission Starting Out in 3rd Gear (Provide
Clearance or Replace Exhaust Crossover)
MODELS: 1993-94
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L Engines (VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
CONDITION
Customers may comment on one or more of the following conditions: A rattling noise on
acceleration, transmission starting out in 3rd gear (possible DTC 66, 67, 81, 82) and/or diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44.
CAUSE
M/L Vans
Oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to improper routing of the
harness. Sharp edges of the heat shield cuts through the wire insulation.
T Trucks
The rattle noise may be the oxygen sensor and/or harness pigtail contacting the heat shield due to
the mispositioning of the oxygen sensor mounting boss. Starting out in 3rd gear may be due to the
pink wire (CKT 39) shorting out against the heat shield causing power to be interrupted to the
transmission control circuit putting the transmission into backup mode (3rd Gear Starts). Diagnostic
trouble codes 13 or 44 may be set due to the oxygen sensor signal wire shorting to or cut through
by the heat shield.
CORRECTION
M/L Vans
Refer to the "1993 M/L Van Electrical Diagrams and Diagnosis" manual or the "1994 Driveability,
Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis" manual for circuit 39 schematics. Normal circuit diagnostics
should be performed first if the problem is constant. If the problem is intermittent, an inspection of
circuit 39 (pink/black) in the area of the exhaust heat shields may lead to the problem. Inspect the
oxygen sensor wiring and replace the sensor it the insulation has been damaged. Re-route wiring
harness as needed to protect harness. Clear any codes and test drive.
T Trucks
If the oxygen sensor is contacting the heat shield, this condition can be corrected by replacing the
exhaust crossover pipe. If the oxygen sensor wire is damaged, the oxygen sensor must also be
replaced.
Follow regular Service Manual Procedures in Section 3 of the 1993 or 1994 "S/T Truck Driveability,
Emission and Electrical Diagnosis" manual to make above repairs. Clear any diagnostic trouble
codes and test drive.
PARTS INFORMATION
P/N Description Qty
10096129 Sensor, Oxygen (1993) 1
25133503 Sensor, Oxygen (1994) 1
15661132 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/ZR2) 1
15672887 Pipe, Exhaust Crossover (w/o ZR2) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 566501 > Jul > 95 > O2 Sensor - Rattling Noise/A/T Starts In 3rd Gear > Page 3508
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
J6372 Sensor, Oxygen Replace Use Published
L2080 Pipe, Crossover Exhaust Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 81I37 > Feb > 81 > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Closed Loop 100 - 0.999 mV
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications >
Page 3520
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor > Page
3523
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3526
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3527
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3528
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3529
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3530
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3531
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3532
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3533
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3534
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3535
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3536
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3537
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3538
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3539
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3540
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3541
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3542
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3543
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3544
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3545
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3546
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3547
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3548
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3549
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3550
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3551
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3552
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3553
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3554
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3555
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3556
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3557
C116 - Oxygen Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3558
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3559
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE
The Oxygen sensor (O2 Sensor) has the ability to produce a low voltage signal that feeds
information on engine exhaust content to the control module.
CONSTRUCTION
The O2 Sensor is constructed from a zirconia/platinum electrolytic element. Zirconia is an
electrolyte that conducts electricity under certain chemical conditions. The element is made of a
ceramic material and is an insulator when cold. At operating temperature, 315°C (600°F), the
element becomes a semiconductor. A platinum coating on the outer surface of the element
stimulates further combustion of the exhaust gases right at the surface and this helps deep the
element up to the desired temperature. The O2 Sensor has an inter cavity which is filled with
atmospheric (reference) air. The atmosphere has approximately 21% oxygen in it. In the electrical
circuit this inter cavity is the positive (+) terminal. The outer surface of the element is exposed to
the exhaust gas stream. It is the negative (-) terminal.
Oxygen Sensor Output Voltage vs. Air/Fuel Ratio
The difference in oxygen concentration in the narrow range of optimum air/fuel ratio causes a large
voltage change that is easily measured.
OPERATION
A rich exhaust (excessive fuel) has almost no oxygen. When there is a large difference in the
amount of oxygen touching the inside and outside surfaces, there is more conduction, and the
sensor puts out a voltage signal above 0.6 volts (600 mV). With lean exhaust (excessive oxygen)
there is about two percent oxygen in the exhaust. This is a smaller difference in oxygen from the
outside surfaces which results in less conduction and a voltage signal below 0.3 volts (300 mV).
The voltages are monitored and used by the control module to "fine tune" the air/fuel ratio to
achieve the ideal mixture desired.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3560
The control module puts out a reference signal of 0.45 volts (450 mV). The reference signal serves
two purposes. The first is to run the engine when it is in OPEN LOOP mode of operation. When the
air/fuel ratio is correct the control module senses 450 mV. When the engine is operating with a rich
air/fuel ratio there is a reduction of free oxygen in the exhaust stream and the O2 sensor voltage
rises above the reference voltage.
When the engine is running lean the voltage drops below the reference voltage due to the excess
oxygen in the exhaust stream. The O2 sensor provides the feedback information for the CLOSED
LOOP operating mode of the fuel delivery system. The O2 sensor indicates to the control module
what is happening in the exhaust. It does not cause things to happen. It is a type of gauge: Low
voltage output = lean mixture = high oxygen content in the exhaust; high voltage output = rich
mixture = low oxygen content in the exhaust.
CONDITIONS THAT CAN SET CODES
An open O2 sensor, should set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 13. A constant low voltage in the
O2 sensor circuit should set a DTC 44. A constant high voltage in the circuit should set a DTC 45.
DTC 44 and DTC 45 could be set as a result of fuel system problems. REFER TO COMPUTERS
AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSTIC CHARTS for diagnosis of these codes.
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR TYPE
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating element that is part of the sensor itself. The heater
helps the control module control the fuel injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no
Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) to detect if the heater part of the sensor is working. To check
the heater, REFER TO COMPUTERS AND CONTROL SYSTEMS/DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
PROCEDURES/OXYGEN SENSOR TESTING.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3561
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION
- Connectors and wires
- Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
- Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
CAUTION Do NOT perform the following test for more than 2 minutes, as this may cause damage
to the catalytic converter.
PERFORMANCE TEST
Checks working range and response (speed). Warm engine
- Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt D.C. range)
- "RUN" engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm) Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
- Drive system rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow-meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
- Drive system lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an control module input or
output. Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds. NOTE After each test
the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three seconds.
- O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above. NOTE A CEC system
that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its maximum range and should
be repaired first and not diagnosed as a 02 sensor failure.
- Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
HEATING ELEMENT (H20S only)
- Turn ignition "OFF". Disconnect electrical connector.
- Connect test light between harness terminals "A" and "B".
- Turn ignition "ON". Test light should be "ON". If test light is "OFF", connect test light to harness terminal "A" to ground. Light should be "ON"
ensuring power circuit is operating correctly.
- Turn ignition "OFF".
- Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between terminals A and B.
Resistance @ Specified Temperature
3.5 ohms @ 20°C (68°F) 14 ohms @ 350°C (662°F)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3562
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE The oxygen sensor has a permanently attached pig-tail and connector. This pig-tail should
not be removed, since removal will affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
REMOVAL
- Disconnect electrical connector from oxygen sensor.
- Using suitable wrench, carefully remove sensor from exhaust manifold or pipe.
Caution
The oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove when engine temperature is below 120°F. Excessive
force may damage threads in exhaust manifold or pipe.
INSTALLATION
- If new sensor is being used, install sensor into manifold or pipe.
- If old sensor is being reused, coat threads with anti-seize compound, Part No. 5613695 or
equivalent, then install into manifold or pipe.
- Torque oxygen sensor to 41 N-m (30 lb. ft.), then reconnect electrical connector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3566
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3569
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3570
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3571
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3572
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3573
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3574
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3575
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3576
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3577
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3578
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3579
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3580
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3581
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3582
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3583
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3584
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3585
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3586
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3587
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3588
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3589
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3590
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3591
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3592
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3593
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3594
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3595
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3596
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3597
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3598
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3599
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3600
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3601
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3602
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3603
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3604
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Digital
Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) - Service
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) Service
Group Ref.: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 448301
Date: August, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: NEW PROCEDURE FOR OBTAINING SERVICE DRACS (DIGITAL RATIO
ADAPTOR/CONTROLLER)
MODELS: 1989-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK M/L VANS, S/T MODELS 1990-94
CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK G VANS, R/V MODELS 1992-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC
TRUCK C/K MODELS 1991-94 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
If a dealer is contacted about or is in need of a service DRAC (Digital Ratio Adaptor/Controller) for
any of the following reasons:
1. Radio interference (EMI).
2. Speedometer fluctuation or flaring.
3. Erratic/surging cruise control operation.
4. Different tire size.
5. Defective part.
The dealer must contact an AC-Delco Service Center authorized to repair electronic instrument
clusters for a new service DRAC, P/N 16202915.
NOTE:
This part is a service part and has to be programmed for the vehicle. It cannot be used until this
procedure has been done by the authorized Service Center.
The dealer will need the P/N and the broadcast code (the 3 bold letters located on the printed label
of the old DRAC). The Service Center will program the DRAC according to this information.
If the customer is changing the tire size, the Service Center will need the axle ratio and tire sized in
order to program the DRAC to the new tire specifications. The AC-Delco Service Center will send
the programmed DRAC via common carrier to the dealership.
For further information, consult the AC-Delco authorized Service Center Manual WA-2 (September
1990 or later). AC-Delco centers are subject to change.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Assembly View
LOCATION
Mounted To Transmisssion Tailshaft.
2WD Automatic Transmission
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
2WD Manual Transmission
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
4WD Automatic and Manual Transmission
VSS 4WD Or AWD
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page
3614
Speed Sensor, Backup Lamp Switch & Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3615
C320 - Vehicle Speed Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3616
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
2 Wheel Drive (Manual Transmission)
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
2 Wheel Drive (Automatic Transmission)
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
4 Wheel Drive
VSS 4WD Or AWD
PURPOSE
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) provides information to the control module for control of: Transmission Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Speedometer
- Odometer
- Cruise control
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3617
- ANTILOCK brake system.
CONSTRUCTION
The VSS is made up of: Permanent Magnet (PM) generator (coil), which is mounted on the transmission.
- Rotor (tooth), which is mounted on the output shaft in the transmission.
- VSS Buffer, which is mounted to the control module bracket.
OPERATION
The VSS is a Permanent Magnet (PM) generator that produces a pulsing Alternating Current (AC)
voltage as each rotor tooth nears the coil. As the vehicle speed increases, the number of AC
voltage pulses increase. The VSS buffer processes inputs from the VSS and outputs signal to the
speedometer control module and cruise module. The VSS buffer takes the voltage pulses from the
VSS and uses them to open and close four solid state output switches to ground at a rate
proportional to vehicle speed. The VSS buffer is matched to the vehicle based on final drive ratio
and tire size.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3618
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Speed sensor resistance should be 900-2000 ohms. The sensor is not serviceable and should be
replaced if defective. The speed sensor is located on the transfer case.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then disconnect electrical connector from speed sensor. 2. Loosen
sensor with suitable wrench. 3. Position suitable container under sensor, then remove sensor and
O-ring. 4. Coat O-ring with transmission fluid, then install O-ring and speed sensor. 5. Torque
sensor to 32 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Shift Light > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Shift Light: Technical Service Bulletins Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 36-72-07A
Date: February, 1995
Subject: Manual Transmission Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation
Models: 1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K and S/T Models with Manual Transmission
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year. Please discard bulletin number 367207
(Group Reference - Transmission).
Certain trucks are not equipped with a shift indicator light. The shift light is commonly used to
achieve improved fuel economy by prompting the driver when to upshift. Depending on the
engine/transmission installed in the vehicle, the shift light can have the following characteristics:
^ Indicates proper shift point for maximum fuel economy.
^ Indicates engine over-speed.
^ Shift light is inoperative.
The following charts detail normal shift light operation:
1993 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Shift Light > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Shift Indicator Light Application and Operation > Page 3623
1994 Models:
1995 Models:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Shift Light > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3624
Shift Light: Description and Operation
Manual Transmission Shift Light Circuit
PURPOSE
The Manual Transmission Shift Light provides a display which indicates to the driver the optimum
fuel economy point for upshifting the manual transmission based on engine speed and load.
OPERATION
Activation of the control module driver turns the lamp "ON". The Shift Light will stay "ON" for up to 5
seconds, so as to urge the driver to shift-up. The control module uses information from the
following inputs to control the shift light: Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor.
- Throttle Position (TP) sensor.
- Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS).
- Engine RPM.
The Shift Light will dim slightly when the headlights and/or parking lights are turned "ON". This is to
give better driver visibility through the windshield.
LOCATION
The display lamp is on instrument panel.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3628
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3631
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3632
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3633
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3634
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3635
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3636
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3637
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3638
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3639
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3640
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3641
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3642
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3643
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3644
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3645
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3646
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3647
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3648
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3649
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3650
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3651
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3652
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3653
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3654
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3655
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3656
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3657
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3658
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3659
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3660
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3661
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3662
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3663
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3664
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3665
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3666
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) - Service
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Digital Ratio Adapter/Controller (DRAC) Service
Group Ref.: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 448301
Date: August, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: NEW PROCEDURE FOR OBTAINING SERVICE DRACS (DIGITAL RATIO
ADAPTOR/CONTROLLER)
MODELS: 1989-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK M/L VANS, S/T MODELS 1990-94
CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK G VANS, R/V MODELS 1992-94 CHEVROLET AND GMC
TRUCK C/K MODELS 1991-94 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
If a dealer is contacted about or is in need of a service DRAC (Digital Ratio Adaptor/Controller) for
any of the following reasons:
1. Radio interference (EMI).
2. Speedometer fluctuation or flaring.
3. Erratic/surging cruise control operation.
4. Different tire size.
5. Defective part.
The dealer must contact an AC-Delco Service Center authorized to repair electronic instrument
clusters for a new service DRAC, P/N 16202915.
NOTE:
This part is a service part and has to be programmed for the vehicle. It cannot be used until this
procedure has been done by the authorized Service Center.
The dealer will need the P/N and the broadcast code (the 3 bold letters located on the printed label
of the old DRAC). The Service Center will program the DRAC according to this information.
If the customer is changing the tire size, the Service Center will need the axle ratio and tire sized in
order to program the DRAC to the new tire specifications. The AC-Delco Service Center will send
the programmed DRAC via common carrier to the dealership.
For further information, consult the AC-Delco authorized Service Center Manual WA-2 (September
1990 or later). AC-Delco centers are subject to change.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Assembly View
LOCATION
Mounted To Transmisssion Tailshaft.
2WD Automatic Transmission
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
2WD Manual Transmission
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
4WD Automatic and Manual Transmission
VSS 4WD Or AWD
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 3676
Speed Sensor, Backup Lamp Switch & Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3677
C320 - Vehicle Speed Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3678
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
2 Wheel Drive (Manual Transmission)
VSS 2WD Manual Transmission
2 Wheel Drive (Automatic Transmission)
VSS 2WD (A/TRANS.) VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
4 Wheel Drive
VSS 4WD Or AWD
PURPOSE
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) provides information to the control module for control of: Transmission Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
- Speedometer
- Odometer
- Cruise control
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3679
- ANTILOCK brake system.
CONSTRUCTION
The VSS is made up of: Permanent Magnet (PM) generator (coil), which is mounted on the transmission.
- Rotor (tooth), which is mounted on the output shaft in the transmission.
- VSS Buffer, which is mounted to the control module bracket.
OPERATION
The VSS is a Permanent Magnet (PM) generator that produces a pulsing Alternating Current (AC)
voltage as each rotor tooth nears the coil. As the vehicle speed increases, the number of AC
voltage pulses increase. The VSS buffer processes inputs from the VSS and outputs signal to the
speedometer control module and cruise module. The VSS buffer takes the voltage pulses from the
VSS and uses them to open and close four solid state output switches to ground at a rate
proportional to vehicle speed. The VSS buffer is matched to the vehicle based on final drive ratio
and tire size.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3680
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Speed sensor resistance should be 900-2000 ohms. The sensor is not serviceable and should be
replaced if defective. The speed sensor is located on the transfer case.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then disconnect electrical connector from speed sensor. 2. Loosen
sensor with suitable wrench. 3. Position suitable container under sensor, then remove sensor and
O-ring. 4. Coat O-ring with transmission fluid, then install O-ring and speed sensor. 5. Torque
sensor to 32 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal Buffer: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer And Electric Shift Transfer Case
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Locations > Page 3684
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Locations > Page 3685
Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal Buffer: Diagrams
C255 - Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer
C249 - Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Locations > Page 3686
Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal Buffer: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer processes inputs from the Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) and
outputs signals to the Speedometer, Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Cruise Control Module and
the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake (4WAL) Module. The VSS is made up of a 4O-tooth rotor and a coil
mounted on the transmission. As each rotor tooth nears the coil, the coil produces an AC voltage
pulse. Each revolution of the rotor produces 40 AC voltage pulses. As the vehicle speed increases,
the number of AC voltage pulses per second increases.
The Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer takes the voltage pulses from the VSS and uses them to open
and close four Solid-State output switches to ground at a rate proportional to vehicle speed.
The Speedometer switch opens and closes at the same rate as the VSS pulses. The PCM and
Cruise Control switches open and close at half the rate of the VSS pulses. The 4WAL switch opens
and closes at a rate seven times the VSS pulses.
The Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer is matched to the vehicle based on transmission, final drive ratio
and tire size. It is important to ensure that the correct Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer is installed in
the vehicle if replacement is necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal Buffer: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Cruise Control Does Not Operate Properly (Part 1 Of 2)
Cruise Control Does Not Operate Properly (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 3689
Speed Sensor Components Do Not Operate Properly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal
Buffer > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 3690
Vehicle Speed Sensor Signal Buffer: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
The Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer processes inputs from the Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) and
outputs signals to the Speedometer, Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Cruise Control Module and
the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake (4WAL) Module. The VSS is made up of a 4O-tooth rotor and a coil
mounted on the transmission. As each rotor tooth nears the coil, the coil produces an AC voltage
pulse. Each revolution of the rotor produces 40 AC voltage pulses. As the vehicle speed increases,
the number of AC voltage pulses per second increases.
The Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer takes the voltage pulses from the VSS and uses them to open
and close four Solid-State output switches to ground at a rate proportional to vehicle speed.
The Speedometer switch opens and closes at the same rate as the VSS pulses. The PCM and
Cruise Control switches open and close at half the rate of the VSS pulses. The 4WAL switch opens
and closes at a rate seven times the VSS pulses.
The Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer is matched to the vehicle based on transmission, final drive ratio
and tire size. It is important to ensure that the correct Vehicle Speed Sensor Buffer is installed in
the vehicle if replacement is necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Voltage Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Voltage Signal: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
Inform the control module that there is a basic generator over voltage problem.
OPERATION
PCM/ECM
If voltage is greater than 19.5 volts for 2 seconds at PCM terminal "E16" (ECM is "C16"), the
control module sets Diagnostic Trouble Code 53, the automatic transmission pressure control
solenoid is turned "OFF", the automatic transmission shifts immediately to third gear, and TCC
operation is inhibited. (the setting of additional DTC's may result.)
VCM
If voltage is greater than 17.1 volts at VCM terminal "GR2" sets Diagnostic Fault Code P1632. For
2 seconds after the fault is detected, the VCM will disengage its outputs. This may result in
additional DTC's being set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Vacuum
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
C180 - Air Switching Solenoid
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations
Exhaust Layout S/T 2WD PUP 4.3L
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3702
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CAUTION Prolonged operation with a misfiring or flooded engine may cause the converter to
overheat. This could cause damage either to the catalyst itself or the operating vehicle and
possible personal injury.
NOTE When jacking or lifting vehicle from frame side rails, be certain lift pads DO NOT contact
catalytic converter or damage to converter may result.
Catalytic Converters
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3703
PURPOSE
The catalytic converter is an emission control device added to the exhaust system to effectively
reduce the levels of carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, and in some cases oxides of nitrogen,
entering the atmosphere. The converter serves two purposes: it permits a faster chemical reaction
to take place and although it enters into the chemical reaction, it remains unchanged, ready to
repeat the process.
CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATION
General Motors uses four different converter designs in conjunction with two types of catalysts. The
four converter designs, are: single bed monolith, dual bed monolith, single bed pellet and dual bed
pellet. The two types of catalysts used are an oxidation catalyst and a three-way (reduction)
catalyst. The oxidation catalyst is coated with material containing platinum and palladium which
lowers levels of carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons. The three-way (reduction) catalyst is coated
with platinum and rhodium which lowers levels of oxides of nitrogen (NOx), as well as carbon
monoxide and hydrocarbons. All dual bed converters, whether monolith or pellet type, contain both
oxidation and three-way catalysts.
Due to its high operating temperatures, the catalytic converter usually requires the use of heat
shields. Heat shields are necessary to protect chassis components, passenger compartment and
other areas from heat related damage.
A fill pipe restrictor is used on catalytic converter equipped vehicles, to prevent the larger service
station pump nozzle, used for leaded fuels, being inserted into the filler tube. Since the use of
leaded fuels contaminates the catalysts, rendering them ineffective, the use of unleaded fuels is
mandatory in catalytic converter equipped vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3704
Restricted Exhaust System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Locations
Vapor Canister 2.5;2.8;4.3;5.0;5.7;7.4L
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Evaporative Canister Filter Replacement
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair Fuel Evaporative Canister Filter Replacement
PROCEDURE
At intervals recommended, usually every 24 months or 30,000 miles, the filter on an open bottom
canister should be replaced,
- Remove all hoses from the top of the canister and mark. Remove the canister.
- Remove the filter element by squeezing it out from under the lip surface at bottom of canister and
from under retainer bar, where used.
- Squeeze the new element under retainer bar, where used, and position it evenly around the entire
bottom of the canister. Tuck the edges under the lip of canister.
- Reinstall the canister to its original position on the vehicle, following normal service procedures.
- Reconnect the hoses to the top of the canister, according to the labeling on top of canister.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Evaporative Canister Filter Replacement
> Page 3711
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair EVRV Filter Replacement
EVRV Filter Replacment
Removal and Installation
- Grasp and pull the filter OFF with a rocking motion.
- Push the new filter on making sure that the cut-out for the wires is properly aligned.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Specifications
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Specifications Canister Torque Values
Canister Torque Values
Vapor Canister Bracket Bolt 19 ft.lb
Vapor Canister Clamp Bolt 7 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Canister Replacement
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair Vapor Canister Replacement
Removal
- Remove hoses from canister. Mark hoses for installation of new canister.
- Remove screw from bracket and canister.
Installation
- Install new canister and secure to bracket with screw.
- Connect hoses to canister making sure hoses are connected to the correct ports.
- Check operation of new canister.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Canister Replacement >
Page 3717
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair Vapor Canister Hose Replacement
Refer to "Vehicle Emission Control Information" underhood label for proper routing of the canister
hoses. When replacing hoses, only use hose that is identified with the word "Flouroelastomer".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications
EGR Control Solenoid: Specifications Solenoid To Bracket Torque
Solenoid To Bracket Torque
EVRV Solenoid to Bracket 18 in.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > EGR Solenoid
EGR Solenoid 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > EGR Solenoid > Page 3724
EGR Solenoid 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3725
EGR Control Solenoid: Service and Repair
Top Of Engine
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Air cleaner, if necessary.
- Electrical connector at solenoid.
- Vacuum hoses.
- Bolts and solenoid.
- Filter, if required.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Filter, if required.
- Solenoid. Tighten bolts to 24 N-m (17 lb.ft.).
- Vacuum hoses.
- Electrical connector to solenoid.
- Air cleaner, if removed.
- Negative battery cable.
- Check system to ensure proper operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
EGR Filter: Service and Repair
EVRV Filter Replacment
REMOVE AND INSTALL
- Grasp and pull the filter OFF with a rocking motion.
- Push the new filter on making sure that the cut-out for the wires is properly aligned.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Linear EGR - Installation Procedure Revision
EGR Valve: Technical Service Bulletins Linear EGR - Installation Procedure Revision
FILE IN SECTION: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
BULLETIN NO.: 51-65-32
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Section 6E3, 9, 9C, 9A - Driveability and Emissions - Revised Linear EGR installation
Procedure
MODELS: 1992-95
Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans
1992-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck P3, P/G Chassis
1992-93 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4.3L, 7.4L Engines (VINs W, N - RPOs L35, L19) and (VIN Z - RPO LB4 - with California
Emissions)
This service bulletin revises the Linear EGR installation Procedure, in the following service
manuals:
1992-93 Oldsmobile Bravada Service Manual, page 6E3-C7-6.
1992-93 Light Duty Truck, Fuel and Emissions Service Manual, pages 9-19 and 90-6.
1994-95 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Service Manual and the 1994 S/T
Truck Supplement with RPO CTF, page 9A-8.
1994-95 C/K, M/L, G Van and P/G and P3 Chassis Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis
Service Manuals, page 9A-6.
The revised procedure is as follows: Install or Connect
1. EGR valve and new gasket.
2. Valve to flange bolts.
Tighten
Tighten bolts in two steps.
a. The first step to 10 Nm (89 lb.in.).
b. The second step to 25 Nm (18 lb.ft.).
3. Electrical connector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3736
EGR Valve: Specifications Valve To Intake Manifold Torque
Valve To Intake Manifold Torque
EGR Valve to Intake Manifold 17 ft.lb
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3737
EGR Valve
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3738
EGR Valve: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system is designed to lower NOx (oxides of nitrogen)
emission levels created by high combustion temperatures.
EGR System
OPERATION
The EGR system routes exhaust gases from the exhaust manifold to the intake manifold at
specified engine operating conditions. The EGR valve is opened by ECM/PCM controlled vacuum
and engine exhaust backpressure which allows exhaust gas to flow into the intake manifold. The
exhaust gas then moves with the air/fuel mixture into the combustion chamber. Since there is less
air/fuel mixture to burn in the combustion chamber during EGR operation, the temperature is
reduced enough to limit NOx formation. If too much exhaust gas enters, combustion will NOT
occur. Because of this, very little exhaust gas is allowed to pass through the valve, especially at
idle. The valve should only open when the engine is at operating temperature and above idle
speed. Variations in vacuum and exhaust backpressure, control the amount of exhaust gas
recirculation.
EGR Valve
The port EGR valve is controlled by a flexible diaphragm which is spring loaded to hold the valve
closed. Vacuum applied to the top side of the diaphragm overcomes the spring pressure and opens
the valve in the exhaust gas port. This allows the exhaust gas to be pulled into the intake manifold
and enter the engine cylinders.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3739
IDENTIFICATION
EGR Valve Identification
The ported EGR valve is identified by having NO identification number or letter stamped after the
part number.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Intake Manifold Cleaning
EGR Valve: Service and Repair EGR Intake Manifold Cleaning
PROCEDURE
WARNING Appropriate eye protection should be worn when cleaning the EGR system to prevent
injury to eyes.
CAUTION When cleaning intake manifold EGR passages, care should be taken to ensure that all
loose particles are completely removed to prevent them from clogging the EGR valve or from being
ingested into the engine, as damage to system or engine may occur.
- Remove throttle body.
- Disconnect vacuum hose or electrical connector from EGR valve, then remove EGR valve to
manifold retaining bolts and valve.
- Remove deposits from EGR ports by hand using a suitable drill bit and screwdriver.
- Brush small deposits down EGR port into passages, then using compressed air, blow ports clean.
Solvents should not be used to clean EGR valve or passages, since damage to system may result.
- Install EGR valve, using new gasket.
- Install throttle body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Intake Manifold Cleaning > Page 3742
EGR Valve: Service and Repair EGR Valve Cleaning
PROCEDURE
WARNING Appropriate eye protection should be worn when cleaning the EGR system to prevent
injury to eyes.
CAUTION DO NOT wash the EGR valve in solvents or degreaser as permanent damage to the
valve diaphragm or electrical connection may result. Also, sand blasting of the valve is not
recommended since this can affect the operation of the valve.
- With a wire wheel, buff the exhaust deposits from the mounting surface and around the valve.
- Look for exhaust deposits in the valve outlet. Remove deposit build up with a screwdriver.
- Clean the mounting surfaces of the intake manifold and valve assembly.
- Install valve assembly using new gasket.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Intake Manifold Cleaning > Page 3743
EGR Valve: Service and Repair Port EGR Valve Replacement
EGR Valve
REMOVE
- Air cleaner.
- EGR valve vacuum tube at valve.
- Bolts or nuts.
- EGR valve and gasket from manifold. Discard gasket.
INSPECT
If the EGR passage indicates excessive build up of deposits, the passage should be cleaned Care
should be taken to ensure that all loose particles are completely removed to prevent them from
clogging the EGR valve of from being ingested into the engine.
CLEAN
CAUTION Do NOT wash the EGR valve in solvents or degreaser as permanent damage to the
valve diaphragm may result.
Sand blasting of the valve is not recommended since this can affect the operation of the valve.
- With a wire wheel, buff exhaust deposits from mounting surface around valve
- Look for exhaust deposits in the valve outlet Remove deposit build up with a screwdriver
- Clean mounting surfaces of intake manifold and valve assembly
INSTALL
- New EGR gasket.
- EGR valve onto manifold.
- Bolts or nuts. Torque to 24 Nm (17 ft.lb).
- Vacuum tube to EGR valve.
- Air cleaner assembly.
- Check operation of EGR system to ensure correct operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Neck
Fuel Door And Restrictor (Typical)
Purpose
To prevent refueling with leaded fuel, the fuel filter neck has a built-in restrictor and deflector. The
opening in the restrictor will accept only the smaller unleaded gasoline fuel nozzle which must be
fully inserted to bypass the deflector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3747
Fillpipe Restrictor: Testing and Inspection
Fuel Door And Restrictor (Typical)
Fuel Filler Neck
The fillpipe restrictor should prevent insertion of special dowel with a diameter same as that of
leaded fuel pump nozzles (0.950").
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair
Inspection
The crankcase ventilation system should be checked every 30,000 miles and also during regular
engine tune-ups. If the crankcase ventilation system includes a breather filter, located in the air
cleaner housing, this filter should be replaced whenever the crankcase ventilation valve or air
cleaner is replaced. When a periodic inspection indicates the crankcase ventilation is not
functioning properly, it should be serviced by replacement only.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Ventilation 4.3Z
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3755
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Service and Repair
Inspection
The crankcase ventilation system should be checked every 30,000 miles and also during regular
engine tune-ups. If the crankcase ventilation system includes a breather filter, located in the air
cleaner housing, this filter should be replaced whenever the crankcase ventilation valve or air
cleaner is replaced. When a periodic inspection indicates the crankcase ventilation is not
functioning properly, it should be serviced by replacement only.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Thermostatic Air Cleaner >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Thermostatic Air Cleaner: Description and Operation
Air Cleaner With Heated Air Intake System
Thermac Operation
DESCRIPTION
A heated intake air system is used for good driveability under varying climatic conditions. Having a
uniform inlet air temperature improves fuel vaporization.
OPERATION
The THERMAC system regulates in incoming air temperature without the use of vacuum. The air
regulating damper is controlled by means of a self contained, wax pellet actuated assembly
mounted in the air cleaner. When incoming air is cold, the wax material sealed in the actuator is in
a solid phase and the damper closes off the cold air inlet. This causes all incoming air to be heated
by the exhaust manifold. As the incoming air warms, the wax material expands changing to a liquid
phase which forces out a piston to reposition the damper allowing a cold and hot air mix or all cold
air to enter the engine.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Thermostatic Air Cleaner >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3759
Thermostatic Air Cleaner: Testing and Inspection
Results of Incorrect Operation
Hesitation during warm up can be caused by: Heat stove tube disconnected.
- Missing or damaged air cleaner to TBI gasket.
- Loose air cleaner cover and air cleaner.
- Missing air cleaner cover seal.
- Stuck open damper door.
Lack of power, sluggish, pinging or spongy, on a hot engine check for: Stuck closed damper door.
Air Cleaner Functional Check
- Remove air cleaner assembly and cool to below 4°C (40°F). The damper should be closed to
outside air (cold air).
- Check condition of air cleaner to throttle body gasket.
- Reinstall air cleaner and connect heat stove tube at air cleaner snorkel and exhaust manifold.
- Start engine. Watch damper door in air cleaner snorkel. As air cleaner warms up, damper door
should open slowly to outside air (cold air).
- If air cleaner fails to operate as described, be sure calibrated spring is properly installed and
damper door is not binding.
- If still inoperative after last step, replace wax pellet actuator assembly and recheck
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > Diagnostic
Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
Component Location - "S/T" 4.3Z Utility - Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Idle Speed - Specification Revised
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission Bulletin No.: 41-65-22 Date: September, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 4 - Revised Controlled Idle Speed Specification
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck Light Duty Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with
Gasoline Engines
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Idle Speed - Specification Revised > Page 3772
This service bulletin supersedes Service Manual information for the Controlled Idle Speed
Specification on Page 4-3 of the Driveability, Emissions, and Electrical Diagnosis Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3773
Idle Speed: Specifications
Refer to Adjustment Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal >
Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal: Locations
Control Cable And Linkage
Accelerator Pedal Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3777
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair
Accelerator Pedal Assembly
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
When performing service on the accelerator pedal, observe the following: The mounting surface between the support and dash panel must be free of insulation. The carpet
and padding in the pedal and tunnel area must be positioned to lay flat and be free of wrinkles and
bunches.
- Slip the accelerator control cable through the slot in the rod and then install the retainer in the rod,
makeing sure it is seated. Use care when pressing the retainer into the hole in the rod to ensure
that the cable is not kinked or damaged in any way.
- After securing all components of the accelerator linkage, the linkage must operate freely without
binding between full closed throttle and full wide open throttle.
- Wires, hoses, cables or other obstructions must not be placed within 13 mm (1/2 inch) of the
cable or the rod at any point in their travel.
Control Cable And Linkage
ACCELERATOR CONTROL CABLE
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3778
When performing service on the accelerator control cable, observe the following: The retainer must be installed with the tangs secured overhead of the stud.
- The conduit fitting at both ends of the cable must have the locking tangs expanded and locked in
the attaching holes.
- The braided portion of the accelerator cable assembly must not come in contact with the front of
the dash sealer during assembly, repair, or replacement of the assembly.
- The flexible components (hoses, wires, conduits, etc.) must not be routed within 50 mm (2 inches)
of the moving parts of the accelerator linkage outboard of the support unless the routing is
positively controlled.
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Retainer from throttle lever stud
- Retainer locking tangs from support bracket
- Retainer from accelerator pedal rod or release cable from rod.
- Retainer locking tangs from dash panel
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Retainer to dash panel.
- Retainer to accelerator pedal rod or connect cable in rod slot.
- Retainer to support bracket.
- Retainer to throttle lever stud or connect cable to pulley.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 >
Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 >
Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3788
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb >
07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb >
07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3794
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 99-01-39-004C
Date: June 12, 2009
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor (Install Evaporator Core Dryer Kit and Apply Cooling Coil Coating)
Models:
1993-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 All
Equipped with Air Conditioning
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 and 2010 model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-39-004B (Section 01 - HVAC).
Condition
Some customers may comment about musty odors emitted from the Heating, Ventilation and Air
Conditioning (HVAC) system at vehicle start-up in hot, humid conditions.
Cause
This condition may be caused by condensate build-up on the evaporator core, which does not
evaporate by itself in high humidity conditions. The odor may be the result of microbial growth on
the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan is turned on, the microbial growth may release an
unpleasant musty odor into the passenger compartment.
There are several other possible sources of a musty odor in a vehicle. A common source is a water
leak into the interior of the vehicle or foreign material in the HVAC air distribution system. Follow
the procedures in SI for identifying and correcting water leaks and air inlet inspection.
The procedure contained in this bulletin is only applicable if the odor source has been determined
to be microbial growth on the evaporator core inside the HVAC module.
Correction
Many vehicles currently incorporate an afterblow function within the HVAC control module
software. The afterblow feature, when enabled, employs the HVAC blower fan to dry the
evaporator after vehicle shut down and this function will inhibit microbial growth. Technicians are to
confirm that the customer concern is evaporator core odor and that the vehicle has the imbedded
afterblow feature, as defined in the SI document for that specific vehicle model, model year and
specific HVAC option. Refer to SI for enabling the afterblow function. Vehicles being delivered in
areas prone to high humidity conditions may benefit from having the afterblow enabled calibration
installed prior to any customer comment.
Important If the vehicle is not factory equipped with the imbedded afterblow enable feature, it may
be added with the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module Kit (P/N 12497910 or AC Delco 15-5876).
Important When installing the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module, you MUST use the included
electrical splice connectors to ensure a proper splice. Complete detailed installation instructions
and self testing procedures are supplied with the kit. If necessary, the Electronic Evaporator Dryer
Module may be installed underhood if it is protected from extreme heat and water splash areas.
To immediately remove the evaporator core odor on all suspect vehicles, it is necessary to
eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its re-occurrence. To accomplish this, perform the
following procedure:
Vehicle and Applicator Tool Preparation
1. The evaporator core must be dry. This may be accomplished by disabling the compressor and
running the blower fan on the recirc heat setting for
an extended period of time.
Note Compressor engagement will cause the evaporator core to remain wet and will prevent full
adherence of the Coiling Coil Coating to the evaporator core surfaces.
2. Verify that the air conditioning drain hose is not clogged and place a drain pan beneath the
vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 3800
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet below the evaporator core. 4. Remove the cabin air
filter, if equipped, and cover the opening prior to applying the Cooling Coil Coating, as the product
may clog the filter. If the
cabin air filter appears to have little or no remaining life, suggest a replacement to your customer.
5. If the HVAC module has a blower motor cooling tube, be careful NOT TO SPRAY THE
COOLING COIL COATING INTO THE
BLOWER MOTOR COOLING TUBE.
6. Attach the Flexible Applicator Pressure Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) to a compressed air line
operating at 586 kPa (85 psi) to 793 kPa (115 psi). 7. Shake the bottle of Cooling Coil Coating well.
Screw the bottle onto the cap on the applicator tool's pick-up tube.
Note The pick-up tube is designed for 120 ml (4 oz) and 240 ml (8 oz) bottles and should coil
slightly in the bottom of a 120 ml (4 oz) bottle.
8. Use one of the following three methods to apply the Cooling Coil Coating.
Important If the Pressure Applicator Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) is not available, the Cooling Coil
Coating is also available in an aerosol can (P/N 12377951 (in Canada, 10953503)).
Application Through Blower Motor Control Module Opening
- Remove the blower motor control module (blower motor resistor). Refer to the applicable
procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor blower
motor control module (blower motor resistor) opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor blower motor control module (blower
motor control module).
Application Through Blower Motor Opening
- Remove the blower motor. Refer to the applicable blower motor removal procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor.
Application Through a Hole in the HVAC Module
- If neither of the two previous application methods are available, it may be necessary to drill a hole
in the HVAC module.
- Locate an area of the HVAC module between the blower motor and the evaporator core. Drill a 10
mm (3/8 in) hole in the HVAC module. Use caution to keep the drill clear of the evaporator core and
the blower motor fan.
- With the air distribution vents closed and the blower motor fan speed on HIGH, insert the
applicator tool into the hole and spray the Cooling Coil Coating into the airstream toward the
evaporator core.
- Use a GM approved RTV sealant to plug the hole in the HVAC module.
9. After the Cooling Coil Coating application is complete, start and run the vehicle for approximately
10 minutes, with the compressor disabled,
HVAC mode set to Recirculate/Max, heat set to full warm, blower motor fan speed on high, and
one window open approximately 12 mm (1/2 in). This cures the Cooling Coil Coating onto the
evaporator core surface.
10. While the engine is running, rinse the applicator tool with warm water to prolong the life of the
tool. Be sure to spray warm water through the
nozzle to rinse out any residual Cooling Coil Coating still in the capillary pick up tube, otherwise it
will dry and clog the applicator tool. Also remove the small green valve from the bottle cap and
rinse it thoroughly while rolling it between two fingers and then reinstall it. If this valve is clogged ,
the Cooling Coil Coating will not flow through the applicator tool.
11. Shut off the engine and enable the compressor again. 12. Verify proper HVAC system
operation. 13. Remove the protective cover from inside the vehicle. 14. Remove the drain pan from
underneath the vehicle. 15. Reinstall the cabin air filter if necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 3801
Parts Information
Important The Cooling Coil Coating listed below is the only GM approved product for use under
warranty as an evaporator core disinfectant and for the long term control of evaporator core
microbial growth.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 53-12-12A
Date: December, 1996
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor at Start Up in Humid Climates (Disinfect Evaporator Core, Install
Delayed Blower Control Package)
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars (Except GEO) 1993-96 Light Duty Models (Except Tracker)
This bulletin is being revised to update the wiring diagrams, add the Corvette (with RPO C60) and
delete medium/heavy duty trucks. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-12-12 (Section 1 HVAC).
Condition
Some owners may comment on odors emitted from the air conditioning system, primarily at start up
in hot, humid climates.
Cause
This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan
is turned on, the microbial growth may release an unpleasant musty odor into the passenger
compartment.
Correction
To remove odors of this type, it is necessary to eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its
recurrence. To accomplish this, these two procedures must be completed.
^ Deodorize the evaporator core using Deodorizing Aerosol Kit, P/N 12377951 (AC Delco 15-102).
^ Install the new A/C Delayed Blower Control Package, P/N 12370470, (AC Delco 15-8632).
The blower control package will enable the blower to run at high speed for five (5) minutes. It will
do so approximately fifty (50) minutes after the ignition has been turned off if the compressor had
been engaged for four (4) or more minutes prior to shutting off engine. By doing so, the evaporator
case and core are dried out, reducing the chances of a recurring A/C odor.
Procedure
1. Visually inspect the air conditioning evaporator drain hose for obstructions or working condition.
2. Apply deodorizing aerosol as described in the instructions supplied with the kit. Once the
deodorizer has been applied, some of the mixture may overflow from the drain hose.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3806
3. The chart identifies specific instructions for each vehicle. This chart will identify the proper
deodorizing procedure, template and wiring diagram. Deodorizing the evaporator case can easily
be done by removing the blower motor resistor and tape off opening. The nozzle can now be
inserted through a pierced hole in the tape to deodorize the evaporator case. For some of the
vehicles specified below, a drilling procedure is identified in the deodorizing instructions. This type
of alternative procedure and others can be done by using the referenced templates in the chart.
4. Complete detailed installation instructions are supplied with the blower control package.
Important:
A. 1996 ONLY (Use blower resistor location for drilling procedure)
B. 1994-1996 ONLY
Refer to appropriate Service Manual for enabling afterblow feature through on-board diagnostics.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3807
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Figure 1
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3808
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3809
Figure 5
Figure 6
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3810
Figure 7
Figure 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3811
Figure 9
Figure 10
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3812
Figure 11
Figure 12
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3813
Figure 13
Figure 14
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3814
Figure 15
Figure 16
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3815
Figure 17
Figure 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3816
Figure 19
Figure 20
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3817
Figure 21
Figure 22
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3818
Figure 23
Figure 24
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3819
Figure 25
Figure 26
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3820
Figure 27
Figure 28
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 3826
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet below the evaporator core. 4. Remove the cabin air
filter, if equipped, and cover the opening prior to applying the Cooling Coil Coating, as the product
may clog the filter. If the
cabin air filter appears to have little or no remaining life, suggest a replacement to your customer.
5. If the HVAC module has a blower motor cooling tube, be careful NOT TO SPRAY THE
COOLING COIL COATING INTO THE
BLOWER MOTOR COOLING TUBE.
6. Attach the Flexible Applicator Pressure Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) to a compressed air line
operating at 586 kPa (85 psi) to 793 kPa (115 psi). 7. Shake the bottle of Cooling Coil Coating well.
Screw the bottle onto the cap on the applicator tool's pick-up tube.
Note The pick-up tube is designed for 120 ml (4 oz) and 240 ml (8 oz) bottles and should coil
slightly in the bottom of a 120 ml (4 oz) bottle.
8. Use one of the following three methods to apply the Cooling Coil Coating.
Important If the Pressure Applicator Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) is not available, the Cooling Coil
Coating is also available in an aerosol can (P/N 12377951 (in Canada, 10953503)).
Application Through Blower Motor Control Module Opening
- Remove the blower motor control module (blower motor resistor). Refer to the applicable
procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor blower
motor control module (blower motor resistor) opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor blower motor control module (blower
motor control module).
Application Through Blower Motor Opening
- Remove the blower motor. Refer to the applicable blower motor removal procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor.
Application Through a Hole in the HVAC Module
- If neither of the two previous application methods are available, it may be necessary to drill a hole
in the HVAC module.
- Locate an area of the HVAC module between the blower motor and the evaporator core. Drill a 10
mm (3/8 in) hole in the HVAC module. Use caution to keep the drill clear of the evaporator core and
the blower motor fan.
- With the air distribution vents closed and the blower motor fan speed on HIGH, insert the
applicator tool into the hole and spray the Cooling Coil Coating into the airstream toward the
evaporator core.
- Use a GM approved RTV sealant to plug the hole in the HVAC module.
9. After the Cooling Coil Coating application is complete, start and run the vehicle for approximately
10 minutes, with the compressor disabled,
HVAC mode set to Recirculate/Max, heat set to full warm, blower motor fan speed on high, and
one window open approximately 12 mm (1/2 in). This cures the Cooling Coil Coating onto the
evaporator core surface.
10. While the engine is running, rinse the applicator tool with warm water to prolong the life of the
tool. Be sure to spray warm water through the
nozzle to rinse out any residual Cooling Coil Coating still in the capillary pick up tube, otherwise it
will dry and clog the applicator tool. Also remove the small green valve from the bottle cap and
rinse it thoroughly while rolling it between two fingers and then reinstall it. If this valve is clogged ,
the Cooling Coil Coating will not flow through the applicator tool.
11. Shut off the engine and enable the compressor again. 12. Verify proper HVAC system
operation. 13. Remove the protective cover from inside the vehicle. 14. Remove the drain pan from
underneath the vehicle. 15. Reinstall the cabin air filter if necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 3827
Parts Information
Important The Cooling Coil Coating listed below is the only GM approved product for use under
warranty as an evaporator core disinfectant and for the long term control of evaporator core
microbial growth.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3832
3. The chart identifies specific instructions for each vehicle. This chart will identify the proper
deodorizing procedure, template and wiring diagram. Deodorizing the evaporator case can easily
be done by removing the blower motor resistor and tape off opening. The nozzle can now be
inserted through a pierced hole in the tape to deodorize the evaporator case. For some of the
vehicles specified below, a drilling procedure is identified in the deodorizing instructions. This type
of alternative procedure and others can be done by using the referenced templates in the chart.
4. Complete detailed installation instructions are supplied with the blower control package.
Important:
A. 1996 ONLY (Use blower resistor location for drilling procedure)
B. 1994-1996 ONLY
Refer to appropriate Service Manual for enabling afterblow feature through on-board diagnostics.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3833
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Figure 1
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3834
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3835
Figure 5
Figure 6
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3836
Figure 7
Figure 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3837
Figure 9
Figure 10
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3838
Figure 11
Figure 12
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3839
Figure 13
Figure 14
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3840
Figure 15
Figure 16
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3841
Figure 17
Figure 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3842
Figure 19
Figure 20
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3843
Figure 21
Figure 22
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3844
Figure 23
Figure 24
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3845
Figure 25
Figure 26
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page 3846
Figure 27
Figure 28
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diagnostic Connector - Fuel
Pump > Component Information > Locations
Component Location - "S/T" 4.3Z Utility - Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fillpipe Restrictor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Neck
Fuel Door And Restrictor (Typical)
Purpose
To prevent refueling with leaded fuel, the fuel filter neck has a built-in restrictor and deflector. The
opening in the restrictor will accept only the smaller unleaded gasoline fuel nozzle which must be
fully inserted to bypass the deflector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fillpipe Restrictor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3853
Fillpipe Restrictor: Testing and Inspection
Fuel Door And Restrictor (Typical)
Fuel Filler Neck
The fillpipe restrictor should prevent insertion of special dowel with a diameter same as that of
leaded fuel pump nozzles (0.950").
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That Affect
Economy/Mileage
Fuel: Customer Interest Fuel System - Factors That Affect Economy/Mileage
Number: 93-96-6C
Section: 6C
Date: FEB. 1993
Corporate Bulletin No.: 306502
ASE No.: A1, A8
Subject: FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY
Model and Year: ALL YEARS ALL MODELS
BACKGROUND INFORMATION:
EPA fuel economy estimates are posted on the fuel economy label of all new vehicles. The only
intended use of these values is for comparison among the different vehicles. Fuel economy
estimates are generated from data taken during a laboratory test using pre-production prototype
vehicles under extremely controlled conditions using a professional driver, with the vehicle
operating on an instrument similar to a treadmill. The comparisons of current vehicle fuel economy
to the EPA fuel economy estimates is a misuse of the information and should be discouraged.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE, available at each dealership, points out that the actual mileage
when driving a vehicle may differ considerably from the estimated mileage. The guide also
describes how vehicles are tested under identical conditions to insure the results can be compared
with confidence.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE also points out that city fuel economy estimate simulates a 7.5
mile, stop-and-go trip with an average speed of 20 mph. The trip takes 23 minutes and has 18
stops. About 18 percent of the time is spent idling, as in waiting at traffic lights or in rush hour
traffic. Two kinds of engine starts are used - the cold start, which is similar to starting a car in the
morning after it has been parked all night - and the hot start, similar to restarting a vehicle after it
has been warmed up, driven and stopped for a short time.
The test to determine the highway fuel economy estimate represents a mixture of "non-city" driving.
Segments corresponding to different kinds of rural roads and interstate highways are included. The
test simulates a 10 mile trip and averages 48 mph. The test is run from a hot start and has little
idling time and no stops.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE explains that the actual test results are adjusted downward to
arrive at the estimates used in the booklet and on the labels. City estimates are lowered by 10
percent and the highway estimate by 22 percent from the laboratory test results. The guide also
points out that traveling at higher speeds lowers fuel economy and traveling at 65 mph instead of
55 mph lowers fuel economy over 15 percent.
FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY:
Axle Ratio
Numerically lower axle ratios generally produce better highway fuel economy. The exception to this
is if the engine is "working" exceptionally hard, (heavy vehicle loads pulling a trailer, small engine in
a large vehicle ... ). In these cases a numerically higher axle may provide better fuel economy.
Numerically higher axle ratios will also tend to provide more fuel economy in congested city traffic
and stop and go conditions.
Brakes
Brake drag (even a minimal amount undetectable by coasting), can have a significant negative
impact on fuel economy. Pull upward on the brake pedal to assure that the stoplight switch and
cruise switch at the brake pedal are full and properly adjusted. A "click" sound when the pedal is
pulled upward indicates that the switch was improperly adjusted. This causes the front brake pads
to lightly rub the rotors, causing a fuel economy loss, without generating excessive heat or brake
pad wear.
Driving Habits
Frequent short trips (less than 5 miles), especially in cooler ambient temperatures (less than 65
degrees), will necessitate fuel enrichment on start-ups, especially after "soaks" with the engine off
for approximately a half hour or more.
Frequent accelerator pedal movement while driving will reduce fuel economy because of fuel
enrichment during the periods of acceleration. Under such driving conditions the torque converter
clutch (TCC) also disengages, contributing to fuel economy losses. Prolonged idle periods reduce
fuel economy especially in cold ambients when vehicle is allowed to "Warm up".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That Affect
Economy/Mileage > Page 3862
Fuels
Oxygenated fuels, with methanol and/or ethanol blended into the gasoline have lower energy and
thus reduce fuel economy. Typically there is about a 1 MPG penalty for a vehicle which gets 25 to
30 MPG on 100 percent gasoline.
Using fuels of a lower octane than the vehicle was calibrated to will cause increased "KS" Knock
Sensor system activity. This will result in a net decrease in spark advance and thus poorer fuel
economy. Using fuel of a higher octane than the vehicle was calibrated for WILL NOT increase fuel
economy.
Variations in how much fuel is added to the fuel tank during re-fueling can greatly affect calculated
fuel economy. These effects decrease as the distance traveled and the number of tank fillups
increase.
Green Engine
New vehicles have not yet had an opportunity for the engine to break in, (rings to seat ... ). A typical
engine will take 3 to 5 thousand miles to break in and during this time period a gradual increase in
fuel economy can be expected.
Parasitic Loads
Air conditioning and/or electrical loads, (headlights, heated backglass ... ) also result in lower fuel
economy, (typically less than 1 MPG difference, each 10 AMPs takes approximately .4 MPG).
Road Conditions
Road surface condition impacts fuel economy. Gravel and/or pot holed roads decrease fuel
economy. Hills (vs. level terrain) also negatively impact fuel economy. Even gradual unperceptible
increases in elevation result in real measurable decreases in fuel economy. Similarly, driving in the
rain or snow decreases fuel economy.
Suspension
Vehicle suspension misalignment can cause poor fuel economy. Check all four tires for abnormal
and/or premature tire wear.
New tires, tire rotation, and/or front end alignment may be required to correct fuel economy.
Tires
Performance tires and/or tires with larger "contact areas," (like 60 series aspect ratio), can cause
as much as 3 MPG lower fuel economy when compared to hard "thin" tires. Find out if the tire size
currently on the car is the same as original equipment. Replacement tires tailor than original
equipment tires cause the odometer to read LESS THAN actual distance traveled. This will result in
lower calculated fuel economy than actual fuel economy.
Tire Pressure
Harder tires, (more air pressure, or different tire compositions) result in better fuel economy. Do not
exceed maximum pressure as labeled on the tire, typically 30-35 psi. The disadvantage of this is
that the greater the tire pressure, the harsher the vehicle ride.
Transmission
On 4-Speed automatics, it is possible to drive the vehicle in 3rd gear rather than "overdrive" and
not perceive it. Typically this condition occurs when the shift indicator, or the shift linkage/detent is
misadjusted. Misadjusted shift linkage can also result in improper signals to the ECM, which can
result in less spark advance, and results in a drop in fuel economy.
Driving a vehicle in 3rd gear rather than overdrive at highway speeds typically results in a 3 to 5
MPG penalty.
Torque Converter Clutch operation is essential for good fuel economy. A non-locking torque
converter typically results in a 1 to 2 MPG penalty at highway speeds.
Vehicle Weight
Each 125 lbs. of additional weight results in a .3 MPG loss of fuel economy. Thus, additional
passengers, luggage ... will decrease fuel economy.
Vehicle Wind Resistance
More wind "DRAG" means less fuel economy. Thus, hang-on luggage carders, cat toppers, open
windows and/or open trunk... mean less fuel economy. (See "Driving Habits").
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-04-022G
Date: October 27, 2010
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Information and Available Brands (Deposits, Fuel
Economy, No Start, Power, Performance, Stall Concerns) - Canada ONLY
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Canada Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and include an additional
gasoline brand as a TOP TIER source. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). In the U.S., refer to the latest version of Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047I.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by the Canadian General Standards Board (CGSB). Those
vehicles that have experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with Minimum Additive recommended by the CGSB
Top Tier Fuel Availability
Chevron was the first to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in Canada. Shell became the first
national gasoline retailer to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline across Canada. Petro-Canada
began offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline nationally as of October 1, 2006. Sunoco began
offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in March of 2007. Esso began offering TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline in May of 2010.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3868
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
The following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards in all octane
grades :
Chevron Canada (markets in British Columbia and western Alberta)
- Shell Canada (nationally)
- Petro-Canada (nationally)
- Sunoco-Canada (Ontario)
- Esso-Canada (nationally)
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency and no
metallic additives. It meets new, voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive
companies that exceed the detergent recommendations of Canadian standards and does not
contain metallic additives, which can damage vehicle emission control components.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began in the U.S. and Canada on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have
already joined and introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not
all fuel marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will
appear on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda, Toyota, Volkswagen and Audi.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. In the U.S., government regulations require that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a
detergent additive. However, the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to
keep engines clean. In Canada, gasoline standards recommend adherence to U.S. detergency
requirements but do not require it. In fact, many brands of gasoline in Canada do not contain any
detergent additive. In order to meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of
detergent is needed than what is required or recommended, and no metallic additives are allowed.
Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency and the intentional addition of metallic additives is an
issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Clean engines help provide optimal
fuel economy and engine performance, and also provide reduced emissions. Also, the use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce deposit related concerns.
Who should use TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Those vehicles that have
experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline. More information on TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found at this website,
http://www.toptiergas.com/.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3869
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP
TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - 'TOP TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-047I
Date: August 17, 2009
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns) - U.S. Only
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) (U.S. Only) 2003-2010
HUMMER H2 (U.S. Only) 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 (U.S. Only) 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X (U.S. Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and additional sources to the Top Tier
Fuel Retailers list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047H (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). In Canada, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit related
concerns may especially benefit from the use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with Legal Minimum additive
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
As of August 1, 2009, all grades of the following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline Standards:
- Chevron
- Chevron-Canada
- QuikTrip
- Conoco
Phillips 66
- 76
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP
TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information > Page 3874
- Shell
- Shell-Canada
- Entec Stations located in the greater Montgomery, Alabama area.
- MFA Oil Company located throughout Missouri.
- Kwik Trip, Inc. in Minnesota and Wisconsin and Kwik Star convenience stores in Iowa.
The Somerset Refinery, Inc. at Somerset Oil stations in Kentucky.
Aloha Petroleum
- Tri-Par Oil Company
- Turkey Hill Minit Markets
- Texaco
- Petro-Canada
- Sunoco-Canada
- Road Ranger located in Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Missouri, Ohio and Wisconsin
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began on May 3, 2004 and many fuel marketers have joined the program
and have introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will appear
on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Where Can I find the Latest Information on TOP TIER Fuel and Retailers?
On the web, please visit www.toptiergas.com for additional information and updated retailer lists.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: Audi,
BMW, General Motors, Honda, Toyota and Volkswagen.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However,
the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to
meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is
required by the EPA. Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to
differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-00-047 > Jun > 04 > Fuel - Top Tier
Detergent Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Top Tier Detergent Gasoline Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-00-047
Date: June 24, 2004
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tier Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns)
Models: 2005 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks (U.S. Only)
A new class of gasoline, called Top Tier Detergent Gasoline, will be appearing at retail stations of
some fuel marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by four automotive
companies. A description of the concept and benefits of Top Tier is provided in the following
question and answer section.
What is Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by four automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Who developed Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by four automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda and Toyota.
Why was Top Tier Detergent Gasoline developed?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in gasoline.
The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However, the
requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to meet
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is required
by the EPA. Also, Top Tier was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate
their product.
Why did the four automotive companies join together to develop Top Tier?
All four corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Who should use Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using Top Tier Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit
related concerns may especially benefit from use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline.
Where can Top Tier Detergent Gasoline be purchased?
The Top Tier program began on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have already joined and are
making plans to introduce Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, a list of all fuel
marketers meeting Top Tier standards will be made available. For now, look for the "Top Tier"
designation at the gas pump.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 570102 > Jun > 95 > Fuel Reformulated/Oxygenated Gasolines
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Reformulated/Oxygenated Gasolines
FILE IN SECTION: 0 - General Information
BULLETIN NO.: 57-01-02
DATE: June, 1995
SUBJECT: Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), Oxygenated Gasoline and California Phase 2 RFG
MODELS: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors customers will be potentially exposed to a variety of different fuel types. Besides
the conventional gasoline available, new types such as Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), oxygenated
gasoline, and starting in 1996, California Phase 2 RFG. Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) is blended
to burn more cleanly and not to evaporate as readily. RFG must contain a minimum of 2 percent
oxygen, which is usually achieved with ethanol or EPA-approved ethers such as methyl
tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE). This type of fuel is required by the Clean Air Act in the nine worst
ozone non-attainment areas of the country, and may also be required in other areas designated
ozone non-attainment, at the option of the states. RFG is intended to produce approximately 15
percent less pollution than conventional gasoline. Using RFG should reduce the total health risk to
the public by reducing exposure to ozone and air toxins. General Motors supports the use of RFG
as a cost effective means of providing air quality benefits.
Oxygenated gasolines are prevalent in the wintertime for Carbon Monoxide (CO) non-attainment
areas. These fuels contain oxygen components similar to RFG. Approximately 50 percent of the
fuel sold in the U.S. in the wintertime contains an oxygenate component.
Vehicle fuel economy may be slightly reduced, if at all, by the use of gasoline containing
oxygenates. Fuel economy is most affected by engine and vehicle type, driving habits, weather
conditions, and vehicle maintenance.
Properly blended RFG, oxygenated gasoline, and California Phase 2 RFG will have no adverse
effect on vehicle performance or to the durability of engine and fuel system components. In fact,
the General Motors Owner's Manual fuel statements have consistently permitted the use of
properly blended fuels containing up to 10 percent ethanol (since 1980) and up to 15 percent
methyl tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE) for current and all past model year vehicles. These statements
continue to be valid. The use of oxygenate-containing fuels will not invalidate the GM vehicle
warranty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That
Affect Economy/Mileage
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Factors That Affect Economy/Mileage
Number: 93-96-6C
Section: 6C
Date: FEB. 1993
Corporate Bulletin No.: 306502
ASE No.: A1, A8
Subject: FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY
Model and Year: ALL YEARS ALL MODELS
BACKGROUND INFORMATION:
EPA fuel economy estimates are posted on the fuel economy label of all new vehicles. The only
intended use of these values is for comparison among the different vehicles. Fuel economy
estimates are generated from data taken during a laboratory test using pre-production prototype
vehicles under extremely controlled conditions using a professional driver, with the vehicle
operating on an instrument similar to a treadmill. The comparisons of current vehicle fuel economy
to the EPA fuel economy estimates is a misuse of the information and should be discouraged.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE, available at each dealership, points out that the actual mileage
when driving a vehicle may differ considerably from the estimated mileage. The guide also
describes how vehicles are tested under identical conditions to insure the results can be compared
with confidence.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE also points out that city fuel economy estimate simulates a 7.5
mile, stop-and-go trip with an average speed of 20 mph. The trip takes 23 minutes and has 18
stops. About 18 percent of the time is spent idling, as in waiting at traffic lights or in rush hour
traffic. Two kinds of engine starts are used - the cold start, which is similar to starting a car in the
morning after it has been parked all night - and the hot start, similar to restarting a vehicle after it
has been warmed up, driven and stopped for a short time.
The test to determine the highway fuel economy estimate represents a mixture of "non-city" driving.
Segments corresponding to different kinds of rural roads and interstate highways are included. The
test simulates a 10 mile trip and averages 48 mph. The test is run from a hot start and has little
idling time and no stops.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE explains that the actual test results are adjusted downward to
arrive at the estimates used in the booklet and on the labels. City estimates are lowered by 10
percent and the highway estimate by 22 percent from the laboratory test results. The guide also
points out that traveling at higher speeds lowers fuel economy and traveling at 65 mph instead of
55 mph lowers fuel economy over 15 percent.
FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY:
Axle Ratio
Numerically lower axle ratios generally produce better highway fuel economy. The exception to this
is if the engine is "working" exceptionally hard, (heavy vehicle loads pulling a trailer, small engine in
a large vehicle ... ). In these cases a numerically higher axle may provide better fuel economy.
Numerically higher axle ratios will also tend to provide more fuel economy in congested city traffic
and stop and go conditions.
Brakes
Brake drag (even a minimal amount undetectable by coasting), can have a significant negative
impact on fuel economy. Pull upward on the brake pedal to assure that the stoplight switch and
cruise switch at the brake pedal are full and properly adjusted. A "click" sound when the pedal is
pulled upward indicates that the switch was improperly adjusted. This causes the front brake pads
to lightly rub the rotors, causing a fuel economy loss, without generating excessive heat or brake
pad wear.
Driving Habits
Frequent short trips (less than 5 miles), especially in cooler ambient temperatures (less than 65
degrees), will necessitate fuel enrichment on start-ups, especially after "soaks" with the engine off
for approximately a half hour or more.
Frequent accelerator pedal movement while driving will reduce fuel economy because of fuel
enrichment during the periods of acceleration. Under such driving conditions the torque converter
clutch (TCC) also disengages, contributing to fuel economy losses. Prolonged idle periods reduce
fuel economy especially in cold ambients when vehicle is allowed to "Warm up".
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That
Affect Economy/Mileage > Page 3887
Fuels
Oxygenated fuels, with methanol and/or ethanol blended into the gasoline have lower energy and
thus reduce fuel economy. Typically there is about a 1 MPG penalty for a vehicle which gets 25 to
30 MPG on 100 percent gasoline.
Using fuels of a lower octane than the vehicle was calibrated to will cause increased "KS" Knock
Sensor system activity. This will result in a net decrease in spark advance and thus poorer fuel
economy. Using fuel of a higher octane than the vehicle was calibrated for WILL NOT increase fuel
economy.
Variations in how much fuel is added to the fuel tank during re-fueling can greatly affect calculated
fuel economy. These effects decrease as the distance traveled and the number of tank fillups
increase.
Green Engine
New vehicles have not yet had an opportunity for the engine to break in, (rings to seat ... ). A typical
engine will take 3 to 5 thousand miles to break in and during this time period a gradual increase in
fuel economy can be expected.
Parasitic Loads
Air conditioning and/or electrical loads, (headlights, heated backglass ... ) also result in lower fuel
economy, (typically less than 1 MPG difference, each 10 AMPs takes approximately .4 MPG).
Road Conditions
Road surface condition impacts fuel economy. Gravel and/or pot holed roads decrease fuel
economy. Hills (vs. level terrain) also negatively impact fuel economy. Even gradual unperceptible
increases in elevation result in real measurable decreases in fuel economy. Similarly, driving in the
rain or snow decreases fuel economy.
Suspension
Vehicle suspension misalignment can cause poor fuel economy. Check all four tires for abnormal
and/or premature tire wear.
New tires, tire rotation, and/or front end alignment may be required to correct fuel economy.
Tires
Performance tires and/or tires with larger "contact areas," (like 60 series aspect ratio), can cause
as much as 3 MPG lower fuel economy when compared to hard "thin" tires. Find out if the tire size
currently on the car is the same as original equipment. Replacement tires tailor than original
equipment tires cause the odometer to read LESS THAN actual distance traveled. This will result in
lower calculated fuel economy than actual fuel economy.
Tire Pressure
Harder tires, (more air pressure, or different tire compositions) result in better fuel economy. Do not
exceed maximum pressure as labeled on the tire, typically 30-35 psi. The disadvantage of this is
that the greater the tire pressure, the harsher the vehicle ride.
Transmission
On 4-Speed automatics, it is possible to drive the vehicle in 3rd gear rather than "overdrive" and
not perceive it. Typically this condition occurs when the shift indicator, or the shift linkage/detent is
misadjusted. Misadjusted shift linkage can also result in improper signals to the ECM, which can
result in less spark advance, and results in a drop in fuel economy.
Driving a vehicle in 3rd gear rather than overdrive at highway speeds typically results in a 3 to 5
MPG penalty.
Torque Converter Clutch operation is essential for good fuel economy. A non-locking torque
converter typically results in a 1 to 2 MPG penalty at highway speeds.
Vehicle Weight
Each 125 lbs. of additional weight results in a .3 MPG loss of fuel economy. Thus, additional
passengers, luggage ... will decrease fuel economy.
Vehicle Wind Resistance
More wind "DRAG" means less fuel economy. Thus, hang-on luggage carders, cat toppers, open
windows and/or open trunk... mean less fuel economy. (See "Driving Habits").
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-04-022G
Date: October 27, 2010
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Information and Available Brands (Deposits, Fuel
Economy, No Start, Power, Performance, Stall Concerns) - Canada ONLY
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Canada Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and include an additional
gasoline brand as a TOP TIER source. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). In the U.S., refer to the latest version of Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047I.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by the Canadian General Standards Board (CGSB). Those
vehicles that have experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with Minimum Additive recommended by the CGSB
Top Tier Fuel Availability
Chevron was the first to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in Canada. Shell became the first
national gasoline retailer to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline across Canada. Petro-Canada
began offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline nationally as of October 1, 2006. Sunoco began
offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in March of 2007. Esso began offering TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline in May of 2010.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3893
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
The following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards in all octane
grades :
Chevron Canada (markets in British Columbia and western Alberta)
- Shell Canada (nationally)
- Petro-Canada (nationally)
- Sunoco-Canada (Ontario)
- Esso-Canada (nationally)
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency and no
metallic additives. It meets new, voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive
companies that exceed the detergent recommendations of Canadian standards and does not
contain metallic additives, which can damage vehicle emission control components.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began in the U.S. and Canada on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have
already joined and introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not
all fuel marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will
appear on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda, Toyota, Volkswagen and Audi.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. In the U.S., government regulations require that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a
detergent additive. However, the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to
keep engines clean. In Canada, gasoline standards recommend adherence to U.S. detergency
requirements but do not require it. In fact, many brands of gasoline in Canada do not contain any
detergent additive. In order to meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of
detergent is needed than what is required or recommended, and no metallic additives are allowed.
Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency and the intentional addition of metallic additives is an
issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Clean engines help provide optimal
fuel economy and engine performance, and also provide reduced emissions. Also, the use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce deposit related concerns.
Who should use TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Those vehicles that have
experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline. More information on TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found at this website,
http://www.toptiergas.com/.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3894
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP TIER'
Detergent Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - 'TOP TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-047I
Date: August 17, 2009
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns) - U.S. Only
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) (U.S. Only) 2003-2010
HUMMER H2 (U.S. Only) 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 (U.S. Only) 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X (U.S. Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and additional sources to the Top Tier
Fuel Retailers list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047H (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). In Canada, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit related
concerns may especially benefit from the use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with Legal Minimum additive
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
As of August 1, 2009, all grades of the following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline Standards:
- Chevron
- Chevron-Canada
- QuikTrip
- Conoco
Phillips 66
- 76
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP TIER'
Detergent Gasoline Information > Page 3899
- Shell
- Shell-Canada
- Entec Stations located in the greater Montgomery, Alabama area.
- MFA Oil Company located throughout Missouri.
- Kwik Trip, Inc. in Minnesota and Wisconsin and Kwik Star convenience stores in Iowa.
The Somerset Refinery, Inc. at Somerset Oil stations in Kentucky.
Aloha Petroleum
- Tri-Par Oil Company
- Turkey Hill Minit Markets
- Texaco
- Petro-Canada
- Sunoco-Canada
- Road Ranger located in Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Missouri, Ohio and Wisconsin
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began on May 3, 2004 and many fuel marketers have joined the program
and have introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will appear
on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Where Can I find the Latest Information on TOP TIER Fuel and Retailers?
On the web, please visit www.toptiergas.com for additional information and updated retailer lists.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: Audi,
BMW, General Motors, Honda, Toyota and Volkswagen.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However,
the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to
meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is
required by the EPA. Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to
differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-00-047 > Jun > 04 > Fuel - Top Tier Detergent
Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Top Tier Detergent Gasoline Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-00-047
Date: June 24, 2004
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tier Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns)
Models: 2005 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks (U.S. Only)
A new class of gasoline, called Top Tier Detergent Gasoline, will be appearing at retail stations of
some fuel marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by four automotive
companies. A description of the concept and benefits of Top Tier is provided in the following
question and answer section.
What is Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by four automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Who developed Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by four automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda and Toyota.
Why was Top Tier Detergent Gasoline developed?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in gasoline.
The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However, the
requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to meet
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is required
by the EPA. Also, Top Tier was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate
their product.
Why did the four automotive companies join together to develop Top Tier?
All four corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Who should use Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using Top Tier Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit
related concerns may especially benefit from use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline.
Where can Top Tier Detergent Gasoline be purchased?
The Top Tier program began on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have already joined and are
making plans to introduce Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, a list of all fuel
marketers meeting Top Tier standards will be made available. For now, look for the "Top Tier"
designation at the gas pump.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 570102 > Jun > 95 > Fuel - Reformulated/Oxygenated
Gasolines
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Reformulated/Oxygenated Gasolines
FILE IN SECTION: 0 - General Information
BULLETIN NO.: 57-01-02
DATE: June, 1995
SUBJECT: Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), Oxygenated Gasoline and California Phase 2 RFG
MODELS: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors customers will be potentially exposed to a variety of different fuel types. Besides
the conventional gasoline available, new types such as Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), oxygenated
gasoline, and starting in 1996, California Phase 2 RFG. Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) is blended
to burn more cleanly and not to evaporate as readily. RFG must contain a minimum of 2 percent
oxygen, which is usually achieved with ethanol or EPA-approved ethers such as methyl
tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE). This type of fuel is required by the Clean Air Act in the nine worst
ozone non-attainment areas of the country, and may also be required in other areas designated
ozone non-attainment, at the option of the states. RFG is intended to produce approximately 15
percent less pollution than conventional gasoline. Using RFG should reduce the total health risk to
the public by reducing exposure to ozone and air toxins. General Motors supports the use of RFG
as a cost effective means of providing air quality benefits.
Oxygenated gasolines are prevalent in the wintertime for Carbon Monoxide (CO) non-attainment
areas. These fuels contain oxygen components similar to RFG. Approximately 50 percent of the
fuel sold in the U.S. in the wintertime contains an oxygenate component.
Vehicle fuel economy may be slightly reduced, if at all, by the use of gasoline containing
oxygenates. Fuel economy is most affected by engine and vehicle type, driving habits, weather
conditions, and vehicle maintenance.
Properly blended RFG, oxygenated gasoline, and California Phase 2 RFG will have no adverse
effect on vehicle performance or to the durability of engine and fuel system components. In fact,
the General Motors Owner's Manual fuel statements have consistently permitted the use of
properly blended fuels containing up to 10 percent ethanol (since 1980) and up to 15 percent
methyl tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE) for current and all past model year vehicles. These statements
continue to be valid. The use of oxygenate-containing fuels will not invalidate the GM vehicle
warranty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Locations
Fuel Filler Neck
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3911
Fuel Filler Cap: Service and Repair
If a fuel tank filler cap requires replacement, use only a cap with the same features. Failure to use
the correct cap can result in a malfunctioning of the evaporative system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING
To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve fuel system pressure before
servicing fuel system components. A small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel
lines or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a
shop towel before disconnecting to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an
approved container when disconnect is complete.
PROCEDURE
- Disconnect negative battery terminal to avoid possible fuel discharge if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
- Loosen fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure. (Do not tighten until service has been
completed.)
- The TBI model 220 contains a constant bleed feature in the pressure regulator that relieves
pressure. Therefore, no further action is required.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-051B
Date: January 04, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Maintenance Cleaning of Fuel Injectors
Models: 2006 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2
2006 HUMMER H3
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years and update the name and part
number of GM Fuel System Treatment. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-051A
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools, equipment and programs to
support fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance procedure. General Motors does not
endorse, support or acknowledge the need for fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance
procedure. Fuel injector cleaning is approved only when performed as directed by a published GM
driveability or DTC diagnostic service procedure.
Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, the only preventative maintenance
currently endorsed by GM regarding its gasoline engine fuel systems is the addition of GM Fuel
System Treatment PLUS, P/N 88861011 (for U.S. ACDelco(R), use P/N 88861013) (in Canada,
P/N 88861012), added to a tank of fuel at each oil change. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
03-06-04-030A for proper cleaning instructions.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning > Page 3920
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Introduction Of The Fuel Injector Tester
NO.: 93-I-39 DATE: June, 1993 GROUP: 6 CORP. NO.: 316501R
SUBJECT: INFORMATION ON THE INTRODUCTION OF THE FUEL INJECTOR TESTER TOOL
J - 39021
This bulletin is being revised to add information about the coil test and a list of driveability
problems.
In February, 1993, Kent-Moore shipped a new Fuel Injector Tester, tool J-39021, as part of the
Essential Tool Program. This tool has the capability of performing injector balance and coil tests on
all GM and many non-GM fuel injection systems. The injector balance test is one familiar to most
technicians where fuel pressure drop is measured as an injector is energized for a set period of
time. This fuel pressure drop is compared to that of the other injectors in the vehicle or a published
standard.
The injector coil test is a new test whereby the injector's resistance is measured during normal
gperation by feeding a fixed current through the injector and measuring the voltage across the
injector. Injector coil failures are more accurately detected using this method than by simply
measuring the injectors resistance with an ohmmeter. Refer to the instructions included with the
tool for testing procedures.
This tool, and the injector coil test specifically, were developed to detect deterioration of injector
coils due to the introduction of injector cleaners and fuel blends containing high levels of alcohol.
Alcohol and water carried by the alcohol may attack and corrode injector coils resulting in a change
in coil resistance and one or more of the following driveability symptoms:
^ rough idle
^ engine miss/surge
^ stall after start/hard start
^ fails emission test
^ poor fuel economy
^ exhaust odor
The injector coil test procedure also requires the use of the Digital Voltmeter, J-39200, to measure
the voltage across the injector during the test. The Fuel Injector Tester, J-39021, supplies one of
three fixed current values throughout the duration of the test. Selection of the supply current value
(0.5, 2.5, or 4.0 amps) is based on the injector's specified resistance. When the push-to-start-test
button is pressed, the tool energizes the injector coil for five seconds. The condition of the injector
coil (pass/fail) is determined by the voltage reading displayed on the voltmeter while the injector is
energized. Instructions and specifications for most GM fuel injectors are included with the tool.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3921
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Throttle Body Assembly (Exploded View)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 3924
Fuel Injector: Connector Views
C104 - Injector B
C103 - Injector A
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3925
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection
PROCEDURE
- Connect fuel pressure gauge.
- Block off (pinch) return line.
- Power up fuel pump (engine "OFF") by applying 12 volts to fuel pump "test" terminal.
- Verify fuel pressure is stabile and remains constant.
- Visually inspect injectors for evidence of fuel dribbling.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure
PROCEDURE:
1. Relieve the system pressure, refer to FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF.
2. Disconnect the fuel supply line from the inlet of the fuel rail.
3. Attach the fuel supply line to the return line.
4. Plug the fuel return fitting at the fuel rail or connect to tester/cleaner depending on configuration.
5. Connect the fuel supply hose from the tester/cleaner to the fuel supply manifold.
6. Turn the tester/cleaner "ON." Tester/cleaner should run 10 minutes.
7. START the engine and check the fuel lines for leakage. If there is any sign of leakage, turn the
vehicle and the tester/cleaner "OFF" and repair the location where fuel is leaking. Then return to
Step 6.
8. When the engine speed has stabilized, set the idle speed at 2000 rpm. Run the remainder of the
10 minute cycle to eliminate all the air in the fuel supply hose and fuel rail.
9. Turn power switch "OFF" and disconnect power lines.
10. Disconnect cleaner supply hose from the fuel supply manifold.
11. Connect vehicle fuel lines. START engine and check for leaks. Lubricate O-rings prior to
installation and ensure fuel lines are securely connected.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure > Page 3928
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Injector(S) Replacement
CAUTION
- Each fuel injector is serviced as a complete assembly only.
- Use care in removing the fuel injectors to prevent damage to the electrical connector terminals,
the injector filter, and the fuel nozzle. The fuel injector is serviced as a complete assembly only.
Also, since the injectors are electrical components, they should not be immersed in any type of
liquid solvent or cleaner as damage could occur.
Fuel Injector Removal
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors to fuel injectors. (Squeeze plastic tabs and pull straight up.)
- Fuel meter cover assembly. See: Throttle Body/Service and Repair/Fuel Meter Cover Assembly
- With fuel meter cover gasket in place to prevent damage to casting, use a screwdriver and
fulcrum to carefully lift out each injector.
- Lower (small) O-rings from nozzle of injectors and discard.
- Fuel meter cover gasket and discard.
- Upper (large) O-rings and steel backup washers from top of fuel injector cavity and discard.
INSPECT
Fuel injector filter for evidence of dirt and contamination. If present, check for presence of dirt in
fuel lines and fuel tank. If dirt is present refer to FUEL SYSTEM CLEANING.
Fuel Injector Part Number Location
NOTE
Be sure to replace the injector with an identical part. Different injectors with different flow rates will
fit this unit, but are calibrated for different flow rates.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure > Page 3929
Fuel Injector Installation
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Lubricate new lower (small) O-rings with clean engine oil and push on nozzle end of injector until
it presses against injector fuel filter.
- Steel injector back up washer in counterbore of fuel meter body.
- Lubricate new upper (large) O-rings with clean engine oil and install directly over the back up
washer. Be sure the O-ring is seated properly and is flush with top of fuel meter body surface.
NOTE Backup washers and O-rings must be installed before injectors or improper seating of large
O-rings could cause fuel to leak.
- Injector, aligning raised lug on each injector base with notch in fuel meter body cavity. Push down
on injector until it is fully seated in the fuel meter body. (Electrical terminals of the injector should be
parallel with throttle shaft).
- Fuel meter cover gasket.
- Fuel meter cover.
- Electrical connectors to fuel injectors.
INSPECT
Turn ignition switch to "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to "OFF" position for ten seconds.
Again turn ignition switch to "ON" position and check for leaks around gaskets and fuel line
couplings.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Locations
Fuel Pressure Regulator
Throttle Body Assembly (Exploded View)
The fuel pressure regulator assembly is located on the top of the engine, inside the throttle body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3933
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Regulator
The fuel pressure regulator assembly is located on the top of the engine, inside the throttle body.
Please refer to Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Throttle Body/Service and
Repair/Procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation
Damper > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 66-63-09 > Apr > 97 > Engine Hard Start or No Start
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: Customer Interest Engine - Hard Start or No Start
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 66-63-09
Date: April, 1997
Subject: Engine Hard Start or No Start (Replace Fuel Pump Pulsator)
Models:
1992-96 Chevrolet and GMC Trucks 1992-96 Oldsmobile Bravada with Gasoline Engines
Condition
Some owners may report their engine is hard to start or will not start.
Cause
The fuel delivery system may have low or no pressure due to a ruptured fuel pump pulsator The
pulsator is the flexible connector between the fuel pump and the metal fuel line in the tank. This
rupture appears as a tear in the pulsator openings and is the result of exposure to gasoline
containing a high percentage of ethanol.
Correction
Follow the Strategy Based Diagnostic Steps for the reported symptoms. If diagnosis reveals low or
no fuel system pressure, and the fuel pump is identified as a possible cause, follow the service
procedure for, On-Vehicle Service, Fuel Pump, in the appropriate Truck Service Manual. Before
replacing the fuel pump, inspect the pulsator for signs of tears or leaks It the pulsator is damaged,
replace it with P/N 25175836 and re-test the fuel system for normal pressure. This pulsator is made
of Viton which is resistant to Ethanol content fuels. P/N 25175836 replaces P/N 25094266 for
trucks. This change will appear in GMSPO parts catalogs as they are revised.
Part Information
P/N Description QTY
25175836
Damper Asm - Fuel Pulsator 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Labor Op Description Labor Time
J 5590 Pump, Fuel R&R; Use Published Labor Time
Important:
Labor operation is coded to base vehicle coverage in the warranty system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation
Damper > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pressure
Pulsation Damper: > 66-63-09 > Apr > 97 > Engine - Hard Start or No Start
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Hard Start or No Start
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 66-63-09
Date: April, 1997
Subject: Engine Hard Start or No Start (Replace Fuel Pump Pulsator)
Models:
1992-96 Chevrolet and GMC Trucks 1992-96 Oldsmobile Bravada with Gasoline Engines
Condition
Some owners may report their engine is hard to start or will not start.
Cause
The fuel delivery system may have low or no pressure due to a ruptured fuel pump pulsator The
pulsator is the flexible connector between the fuel pump and the metal fuel line in the tank. This
rupture appears as a tear in the pulsator openings and is the result of exposure to gasoline
containing a high percentage of ethanol.
Correction
Follow the Strategy Based Diagnostic Steps for the reported symptoms. If diagnosis reveals low or
no fuel system pressure, and the fuel pump is identified as a possible cause, follow the service
procedure for, On-Vehicle Service, Fuel Pump, in the appropriate Truck Service Manual. Before
replacing the fuel pump, inspect the pulsator for signs of tears or leaks It the pulsator is damaged,
replace it with P/N 25175836 and re-test the fuel system for normal pressure. This pulsator is made
of Viton which is resistant to Ethanol content fuels. P/N 25175836 replaces P/N 25094266 for
trucks. This change will appear in GMSPO parts catalogs as they are revised.
Part Information
P/N Description QTY
25175836
Damper Asm - Fuel Pulsator 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Labor Op Description Labor Time
J 5590 Pump, Fuel R&R; Use Published Labor Time
Important:
Labor operation is coded to base vehicle coverage in the warranty system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation
Damper > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pressure
Pulsation Damper: > 666309 > Apr > 97 > Engine - Hard Start Or No Start
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Hard Start Or No Start
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 66-63-09
Date: April, 1997
Subject: Engine Hard Start or No Start (Replace Fuel Pump Pulsator)
Models: 1992-96 Chevrolet and GMC Trucks 1992-96 Oldsmobile Bravada with Gasoline Engines
Condition
Some owners may report their engine is hard to start or will not start.
Cause
The fuel delivery system may have low or no pressure due to a ruptured fuel pump pulsator. The
pulsator is the flexible connector between the fuel pump and the metal fuel line in the tank. This
rupture appears as a tear in the pulsator openings and is the result of exposure to gasoline
containing a high percentage of ethanol.
Correction
Follow the Strategy Based Diagnostic Steps for the reported symptoms. If diagnosis reveals low or
no fuel system pressure, and the fuel pump is identified as a possible cause, follow the service
procedure for, On-Vehicle Service, Fuel Pump, in the appropriate Truck Service Manual. Before
replacing the fuel pump, inspect the pulsator for signs of tears or leaks. If the pulsator is damaged,
replace it with P/N 25175836 and re-test the fuel system for normal pressure. This pulsator is made
of Viton which is resistant to Ethanol content fuels. P/N 25175836 replaces P/N 25094266 for
trucks. This change will appear in GMSPO parts catalogs as they are revised.
Part Information
P/N Description Qty
25175836 Damper Asm - Fuel Pulsator 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty. use:
Labor Op Description Labor Time
Use Published Labor
J 5590 Pump, Fuel R&R; Operation Time
Important:
Labor operation is coded to base vehicle coverage in the warranty system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation
Damper > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Pressure Pulsation
Damper: > 666309 > Apr > 97 > Engine - Hard Start Or No Start
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Hard Start Or No Start
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 66-63-09
Date: April, 1997
Subject: Engine Hard Start or No Start (Replace Fuel Pump Pulsator)
Models: 1992-96 Chevrolet and GMC Trucks 1992-96 Oldsmobile Bravada with Gasoline Engines
Condition
Some owners may report their engine is hard to start or will not start.
Cause
The fuel delivery system may have low or no pressure due to a ruptured fuel pump pulsator. The
pulsator is the flexible connector between the fuel pump and the metal fuel line in the tank. This
rupture appears as a tear in the pulsator openings and is the result of exposure to gasoline
containing a high percentage of ethanol.
Correction
Follow the Strategy Based Diagnostic Steps for the reported symptoms. If diagnosis reveals low or
no fuel system pressure, and the fuel pump is identified as a possible cause, follow the service
procedure for, On-Vehicle Service, Fuel Pump, in the appropriate Truck Service Manual. Before
replacing the fuel pump, inspect the pulsator for signs of tears or leaks. If the pulsator is damaged,
replace it with P/N 25175836 and re-test the fuel system for normal pressure. This pulsator is made
of Viton which is resistant to Ethanol content fuels. P/N 25175836 replaces P/N 25094266 for
trucks. This change will appear in GMSPO parts catalogs as they are revised.
Part Information
P/N Description Qty
25175836 Damper Asm - Fuel Pulsator 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty. use:
Labor Op Description Labor Time
Use Published Labor
J 5590 Pump, Fuel R&R; Operation Time
Important:
Labor operation is coded to base vehicle coverage in the warranty system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
Diagnostic Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
Component Location - "S/T" 4.3Z Utility - Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: Customer Interest Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 3969
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 3970
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 3971
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A >
Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A >
Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 3977
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A >
Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 3978
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A >
Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 3979
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3980
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Fuel Pump Relay
The Fuel Pump Relay is located on the driver side firewall, near brake booster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3981
C124 - Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3982
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the control module will energize the fuel
pump relay as long as the engine is cranking or running, and the control module is receiving
distributor reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the control module will shut "OFF" the
fuel pump relay within two seconds.
An inoperative fuel pump relay can result in extended crank times, particularily if the engine is cold.
The oil pressure switch will turn "ON" the fuel pump, as soon as oil pressure reaches about 28 kPa
(4 psi).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3983
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
*** UPDATED BY TSB 893206E, DATED OCTOBER 90
When the key is first turned ON, without the engine running, the ECM will turn the fuel pump relay
ON for two seconds. This builds up the fuel pressure to normal operating pressure. If the engine is
not started within two seconds, the ECM will shut the fuel pump OFF and wait until ignition
reference pulses are present. As soon as the engine is cranked, the ECM turns the relay ON,
which powers the fuel pump. The ECM continues to power the fuel pump during engine operation.
If the fuel pump relay fails, it is backed up by the oil pressure switch, which continues to operate
the fuel pump as long as oil pressure remains above 28.0 kPa (4 psi).
RESULTS OF INCORRECT FUEL PUMP SYSTEM OPERATION
- A faulty fuel pump relay can result in long cranking times, particularly if the engine is cold.
- An inoperative fuel pump would cause a no start condition.
- A fuel pump which does not provide enough pressure can result in poor performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3984
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
Relay Center 2.5L,2.8L S
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
1. Verify that ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Retainer, if installed. 3. Electrical connector.
4. Fuel pump relay by depressing bracket clip at rear of relay, or removing bolts from retaining
bracket.
INSTALL/DISCONNECT
1. Fuel pump relay. 2. Electrical connector. 3. Retainer. 4. Verify correct operation to confirm repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Return Line: Service and Repair
NOTES
When replacing fuel feed and return pipes, always replace them with original equipment or parts
that meet GM specifications for those parts. The replacement pipe must have the same type fittings
as the original pipes to ensure the integrity of the connection.
Do NOT use copper or aluminum tubing to replace steel tubing. Only tubing meeting the 124M
specification or its equivalent is capable of meeting all pressure and vibration characteristics
necessary to ensure the durability standard required.
Many of the feed and return pipes use screw couplings with O-rings. Any time these fittings are
loosened to service or to replace components, ensure that: A back-up wrench is used to loosen and tighten fittings.
- Check all O-rings at these locations (if applicable) for cuts or any damage and replace as
necessary.
- Use correct torque when tightening these fittings.
- Inspect all pipes for kinks, leaks or dents.
- Pipes must be properly secured to the frame to prevent chafing. A minimum of 6 mm (1/4 inch)
clearance must be maintained around a pipe to prevent contact or chafing.
- Fuel feed and return pipes are secured to the underbody with clamps and screw assemblies.
- Follow the same routing as the original pipe.
- Fuel pipes must not contact the fuel tank or underbody at any point.
FUEL AND VAPOR PIPE REPAIR
When it is impractical to replace an entire fuel line to repair localized damage, use the following
procedure: When rubber hose is used to replace pipe, use only reinforced fuel-resistant hose which is
identified with the word "Fluoroelastomer" on the hose. The inside diameter of the hose must match
the outside pipe diameter.
- Do NOT use rubber hose within 100 mm (4 inches) of any part of the exhaust system, or within
254 mm (10 inches) of the catalytic converter.
- In repairable areas, cut a piece of hose 100 mm (4 inches) longer than the portion of line
removed. If more than a 6 inch length of pipe is removed, use a combination of steel pipe and hose
so that hose lengths will not be more than 254 mm (10 inches).
- Follow the same routing as the original pipe.
- Cut the ends of the pipe, remaining on the car, square with a tubing cutter. Using the first step of
a double flaring tool, form a bead on the end of each pipe section. If the pipe is too corroded to
withstand the beading operation without damage, the pipe should be replaced. If a new section of
pipe is used, form a bead on both ends of it also.
- Use a screw type hose clamp NO. #2494772, or equivalent. Slide the clamps onto the pipe and
push hoses 51 mm (2 inches) onto each portion of the fuel pipe. Tighten the clamps on each side
of the repair.
- Pipes must be properly secured to the frame to prevent chafing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair
NOTES
When replacing fuel feed and return pipes, always replace them with original equipment or parts
that meet GM specifications for those parts. The replacement pipe must have the same type fittings
as the original pipes to ensure the integrity of the connection.
Do NOT use copper or aluminum tubing to replace steel tubing. Only tubing meeting the 124M
specification or its equivalent is capable of meeting all pressure and vibration characteristics
necessary to ensure the durability standard required.
Many of the feed and return pipes use screw couplings with O-rings. Any time these fittings are
loosened to service or to replace components, ensure that: A back-up wrench is used to loosen and tighten fittings.
- Check all O-rings at these locations (if applicable) for cuts or any damage and replace as
necessary.
- Use correct torque when tightening these fittings.
- Inspect all pipes for kinks, leaks or dents.
- Pipes must be properly secured to the frame to prevent chafing. A minimum of 6 mm (1/4 inch)
clearance must be maintained around a pipe to prevent contact or chafing.
- Fuel feed and return pipes are secured to the underbody with clamps and screw assemblies.
- Follow the same routing as the original pipe.
- Fuel pipes must not contact the fuel tank or underbody at any point.
FUEL AND VAPOR PIPE REPAIR
When it is impractical to replace an entire fuel line to repair localized damage, use the following
procedure: When rubber hose is used to replace pipe, use only reinforced fuel-resistant hose which is
identified with the word "Fluoroelastomer" on the hose. The inside diameter of the hose must match
the outside pipe diameter.
- Do NOT use rubber hose within 100 mm (4 inches) of any part of the exhaust system, or within
254 mm (10 inches) of the catalytic converter.
- In repairable areas, cut a piece of hose 100 mm (4 inches) longer than the portion of line
removed. If more than a 6 inch length of pipe is removed, use a combination of steel pipe and hose
so that hose lengths will not be more than 254 mm (10 inches).
- Follow the same routing as the original pipe.
- Cut the ends of the pipe, remaining on the car, square with a tubing cutter. Using the first step of
a double flaring tool, form a bead on the end of each pipe section. If the pipe is too corroded to
withstand the beading operation without damage, the pipe should be replaced. If a new section of
pipe is used, form a bead on both ends of it also.
- Use a screw type hose clamp NO. #2494772, or equivalent. Slide the clamps onto the pipe and
push hoses 51 mm (2 inches) onto each portion of the fuel pipe. Tighten the clamps on each side
of the repair.
- Pipes must be properly secured to the frame to prevent chafing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Filler Neck
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Sending Unit
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Sending Unit
Rear Lamps Crossbody Harness W/O Trailer Tow
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Sending Unit > Page 3999
Rear Lamps Harness W/Trailer Tow
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Sending Unit > Page 4000
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly (Typical)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 4001
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly (Typical)
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle.
- Fuel tank.
- Pump and sending unit assembly by turning cam lock counterclockwise using tool J-36608 or
J-24187 or equivalent.
Pull fuel pump up into attaching hose while pulling outward from the bottom support. Do not
damage rubber insulator or strainer.
INSPECT
- Inspect fuel pump attaching hose for signs of deterioration.
- Inspect rubber sound insulation at bottom of pump for deterioration.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Pump assembly into attaching hose.
NOTE: Care should be taken not to fold over or twist strainer when installing sending unit as this
will restrict fuel flow. Sending unit and fuel pump assembly into fuel tank. (Always use a new O-ring seal).
- Cam lock assembly. Turn cam lock clockwise to lock it.
- Fuel tank assembly.
- Negative battery cable.
- START vehicle and check for fuel leaks.
- Lower vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Tank Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump And Sender Assembly (Typical)
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle.
- Fuel tank.
- Pump and sending unit assembly by turning cam lock counterclockwise using tool J-36608 or
J-24187 or equivalent.
Pull fuel pump up into attaching hose while pulling outward from the bottom support. Do not
damage rubber insulator or strainer.
INSPECT
- Inspect fuel pump attaching hose for signs of deterioration.
- Inspect rubber sound insulation at bottom of pump for deterioration.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Pump assembly into attaching hose.
NOTE: Care should be taken not to fold over or twist strainer when installing sending unit as this
will restrict fuel flow. Sending unit and fuel pump assembly into fuel tank. (Always use a new O-ring seal).
- Cam lock assembly. Turn cam lock clockwise to lock it.
- Fuel tank assembly.
- Negative battery cable.
- START vehicle and check for fuel leaks.
- Lower vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications Actuator Resistance Values
Actuator Resistance Values
Terminals "A" To "B" 40 to 80 ohms
Terminals "C" to "D" 40 to 80 ohms
Terminals "B" to "C" Infinite ohms
Terminals "A" to "D" Infinite ohms
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4008
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Throttle Body Assembly (Exploded View)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 4011
C111 - IAC Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4012
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Idle Air Control (IAC) System
Idle Air Control Valve
IAC System
PURPOSE
To control engine idle speed and prevent stalling due to changes in engine load.
OPERATION
All engine idle speeds are controlled by the control module through the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve
mounted on the throttle body. The control module sends voltage pulses to the IAC motor windings
causing the IAC motor shaft and pintle to move "IN" or "OUT" a given distance (number of
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4013
steps) for each pulse (called counts). Inward movement of the pintle = Decreased RPM =Lower
Counts. Outward movement of the pintle = Increased RPM = Higher Counts.
This movement controls airflow around the throttle plate, which in turn, controls engine idle speed,
either cold or hot. IAC valve pintle position counts can be seen using a Tech 1 scan tool. Zero (0)
counts correspond to a fully closed passage, while 140 counts or more (depending on the
application) corresponds to full flow.
- Actual or "controlled" idle speed is obtained by the control module positioning the IAC valve pintle.
Resulting idle speed is generated from the total
idle air flow (IAC/passage + PCV + throttle valve + vacuum leaks).
- Controlled idle speed is always specified for normal operating conditions. Normal operating
condition is engine coolant temperature in operating
range, the A/C is "OFF," manual transmission is in neutral or automatic transmission in drive with
proper Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch adjustment. A high or low engine coolant temperature,
or A/C clutch engagement may signal the control module to change the IAC counts.
- The minimum idle speed is set at the factory with a stop screw. This setting allows enough air flow
by the throttle valves to cause the IAC valve pintle
to be positioned a calibrated number of steps (counts) from the seat during normal controlled idle
operation. The IAC counts will be higher than normal on an engine with less than 500 miles, or an
engine operating at high altitude or an engine with an accessory load such as the alternator, A/C,
power steering or hydra-boost brakes activated.
Results of Incorrect Operation
If the pintle is stuck open, the idle speed will remain high. If the pintle is stuck closed, the idle
speed will be too low, and stalling may occur. If the pintle is stuck partially open, the idle speed will
be higher than normal, and there will be no response to changes in engine load such as A/C ("ON")
or transmission in ("Drive").
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection PCM Charts
Idle Air Control (IAC) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts > Page 4016
Circuit Description
The control module controls engine idle speed with the IAC valve. To increase idle speed, the
control module retracts the IAC valve pintle away from its seat, allowing more air to pass by the
throttle bore. To decrease idle speed, it extends the IAC valve pintle towards its seat, reducing
bypass air flow. A Tech 1 scan tool will read the control module commands to the IAC valve in
counts. Higher the counts indicate more air bypass (higher idle). The lower the counts indicate less
air is allowed to bypass (lower idle).
Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The IAC tester is used to extend and retract the IAC valve. Valve movement is verified by an
engine speed change. If no change in engine
speed occurs, the valve can be retested when removed from the throttle body.
2. This step checks the quality of the IAC movement in Step 1. Between 700 RPM and about 1500
RPM the engine speed should change
smoothly with each flash of the tester light in both extend and retract. If the IAC valve is retracted
beyond the control range (about 1500 RPM), it may take many flashes in the extend position before
engine speed will begin to drop. This is normal on certain engines, fully extending IAC may cause
engine stall. This may be normal.
3. Steps 1 and 2 verified proper IAC valve operation while this step checks the IAC circuits. Each
lamp on the node light should flash red and
green while the IAC valve is cycled. While the sequence of color is not important if either light is
"OFF" or does not flash red and green, check the circuits for faults beginning with poor terminal
contacts.
IAC VALVE RESET PROCEDURE
^ Disconnect battery cable at battery for 10 seconds then reconnect cable. ^ Ignition "ON," engine
"OFF" for 5 seconds. ^ Ignition "OFF" for 10 seconds.
Diagnostic Aids
A slow, unstable, or fast idle may be caused by a non-IAC system problem that cannot be
overcome by the IAC valve. Out of control range, IAC Tech 1 scan tool counts will be above 60 if
idle is too low, and zero counts if idle is too high. The following checks should be made to repair a
non-IAC system problem.
^ Vacuum Leak (High Idle) - If idle is too high, stop the engine. Fully extend (low) IAC with tester.
Start engine. If idle speed is above 800 RPM,
locate and correct vacuum leak including crankcase ventilation system. Also, check for binding of
throttle blade or linkage.
^ System Too Rich (Low Air Fuel Ratio) The idle speed will be too low. Tech 1 scan tool IAC counts
will usually be above 80. System is obviously
rich and may exhibit black smoke in exhaust. Tech 1 scan tool O2 voltage will be fixed above 800
mV (.8 volt).
Check for high fuel pressure, leaking or sticking injector. Silicone contaminated 02S scan voltage
will be slow to respond.
^ Throttle Body - Remove IAC valve and inspect bore for foreign material. ^ IAC Valve Electrical
Connections - IAC valve connections should be carefully checked for proper contact. ^ Crankcase
Ventilation Valve - An incorrect or faulty crankcase ventilation valve may result in an incorrect idle
speed.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ A/C Compressor - Refer to A/C diagnosis if circuit is shorted to ground. If the relay is faulty, an
idle problem may exist.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ If intermittent poor driveability or idle symptoms are resolved by disconnecting the IAC, carefully
recheck connections, valve terminal resistance
or replace IAC.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts > Page 4017
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection VCM Charts
Idle Air Control (IAC) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM Charts > Page 4018
Circuit Description
The control module controls engine idle speed with the IAC valve. To increase idle speed, the
control module retracts the IAC valve pintle away from its seat, allowing more air to pass by the
throttle bore. To decrease idle speed, it extends the IAC valve pintle towards its seat, reducing
bypass air flow. A Tech 1 scan tool will read the control module commands to the IAC valve in
counts. Higher the counts indicate more air bypass (higher idle). The lower the counts indicate less
air is allowed to bypass (lower idle).
Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The IAC tester is used to extend and retract the IAC valve. Valve movement is verified by an
engine speed change. If no change in engine
speed occurs, the valve can be retested when removed from the throttle body.
2. This step checks the quality of the IAC movement in Step 1. Between 700 RPM and about 1500
RPM the engine speed should change
smoothly with each flash of the tester light in both extend and retract. If the IAC valve is retracted
beyond the control range (about 1500 RPM), it may take many flashes in the extend position before
engine speed will begin to drop. This is normal on certain engines, fully extending IAC may cause
engine stall. This may be normal.
3. Steps 1 and 2 verified proper IAC valve operation while this step checks the IAC circuits. Each
lamp on the node light should flash red and
green while the IAC valve is cycled. While the sequence of color is not important if either light is
"OFF" or does not flash red and green, check the circuits for faults beginning with poor terminal
contacts.
IAC VALVE RESET PROCEDURE
^ Disconnect battery cable at battery for 10 seconds then reconnect cable. ^ Ignition "ON," engine
"OFF" for 5 seconds. ^ Ignition "OFF" for 10 seconds.
Diagnostic Aids
A slow, unstable, or fast idle may be caused by a non-IAC system problem that cannot be
overcome by the IAC valve. Out of control range, IAC Tech 1 scan tool counts will be above 60 if
idle is too low, and zero counts if idle is too high. The following checks should be made to repair a
non-IAC system problem.
^ Vacuum Leak (High Idle) - If idle is too high, stop the engine. Fully extend (low) IAC with tester.
Start engine. If idle speed is above 800 RPM,
locate and correct vacuum leak including crankcase ventilation system. Also, check for binding of
throttle blade or linkage.
^ System Too Rich (Low Air Fuel Ratio) The idle speed will be too low. Tech 1 scan tool IAC counts
will usually be above 80. System is obviously
rich and may exhibit black smoke in exhaust. Tech 1 scan tool O2 voltage will be fixed above 800
mV (.8 volt).
Check for high fuel pressure, leaking or sticking injector. Silicone contaminated 02S scan voltage
will be slow to respond.
^ Throttle Body - Remove IAC valve and inspect bore for foreign material. ^ IAC Valve Electrical
Connections - IAC valve connections should be carefully checked for proper contact. ^ Crankcase
Ventilation Valve - An incorrect or faulty crankcase ventilation valve may result in an incorrect idle
speed.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ A/C Compressor - Refer to A/C diagnosis if circuit is shorted to ground. If the relay is faulty, an
idle problem may exist.
Refer to "Rough, Unstable, Incorrect Idle or Stalling".
^ If intermittent poor driveability or idle symptoms are resolved by disconnecting the IAC, carefully
recheck connections, valve terminal resistance
or replace IAC.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4019
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
NOTES
- The Idle Air Control (IAC) valve is an electrical component and must not be soaked in any liquid
cleaner or solvent. Otherwise damage could result.
- The IAC valve for this application is thread-mounted and has a dual taper, 10 mm diameter,
pintle. Any replacement of the IAC valve must have the correct part number, with the appropriate
pintle taper and diameter for proper seating of the valve in the throttle body.
IAC Thread Mounted 10mm Pintle
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connector.
- IAC valve, use a 32 mm (1 1/4") wrench.
- IAC gasket and discard.
CLEAN
- Both original and replacement IAC valves have a special factory applied thread-locking compound
applied to the screw threads. If the valve removed from throttle body is being reinstalled, DO NOT
remove thread-locking that may remain on the threads.
- Clean IAC valve seating surfaces on throttle body to assure proper seal of new gasket and IAC
valve.
Idle Air Control Valve Pintle Retraction (Manually)
NOTES
- If the IAC valve was removed during service, its operation may be tested electrically with the
IAC/ISC Motor Tester (J-37027 or BT-8256K) or equivalent. Before installing IAC valve, measure
the distance between the tip of the valve pintle and mounting surface. If the dimension is greater
than 28.0 mm (1.10 inches), valve pintle must be retracted to prevent damage to valve. This may
be done electrically using an IAC/ISC Motor Tester or manually by exerting firm pressure, as
shown in the illustration, with a slight side to side movement on valve pintle to retract it.
- No physical adjustment of the IAC valve assembly is required after installation. The IAC valve
pintle is reset by turning the ignition "ON" for ten seconds and then OFF. The ECM then resets the
pintle to the correct position. Proper idle regulation should result.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- IAC valve into throttle body with new gasket.
NOTE New IAC valves have been reset at the factory and should be installed in throttle body in an
"as is" condition, without any adjustment.
- Tighten IAC valve assembly to 18.0 Nm (13.0 lb-ft).
- Electrical connector to IAC valve.
- Reset IAC valve pintle position as follows: - Depress accelerator pedal slightly. - "START" and run
engine for five seconds. - Turn ignition "OFF" for ten seconds.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4020
- Restart engine and check for proper idle operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Locations
Air Intake Ducts S/T PUP TBI
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic Transmission > Page 4028
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4029
C120 - Fuel Pump Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4030
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable from battery.
- Sensor or switch connectors.
- Sensor or switch.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Sensor or switch.
- Sensor or switch.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: Customer Interest Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 4040
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 4041
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 4042
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 4048
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 4049
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Fuel Pump Relay: > 566305A > Jan > 96 > Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 4050
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4051
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Fuel Pump Relay
The Fuel Pump Relay is located on the driver side firewall, near brake booster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4052
C124 - Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4053
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the control module will energize the fuel
pump relay as long as the engine is cranking or running, and the control module is receiving
distributor reference pulses. If there are no reference pulses, the control module will shut "OFF" the
fuel pump relay within two seconds.
An inoperative fuel pump relay can result in extended crank times, particularily if the engine is cold.
The oil pressure switch will turn "ON" the fuel pump, as soon as oil pressure reaches about 28 kPa
(4 psi).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4054
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
*** UPDATED BY TSB 893206E, DATED OCTOBER 90
When the key is first turned ON, without the engine running, the ECM will turn the fuel pump relay
ON for two seconds. This builds up the fuel pressure to normal operating pressure. If the engine is
not started within two seconds, the ECM will shut the fuel pump OFF and wait until ignition
reference pulses are present. As soon as the engine is cranked, the ECM turns the relay ON,
which powers the fuel pump. The ECM continues to power the fuel pump during engine operation.
If the fuel pump relay fails, it is backed up by the oil pressure switch, which continues to operate
the fuel pump as long as oil pressure remains above 28.0 kPa (4 psi).
RESULTS OF INCORRECT FUEL PUMP SYSTEM OPERATION
- A faulty fuel pump relay can result in long cranking times, particularly if the engine is cold.
- An inoperative fuel pump would cause a no start condition.
- A fuel pump which does not provide enough pressure can result in poor performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4055
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
Relay Center 2.5L,2.8L S
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
1. Verify that ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Retainer, if installed. 3. Electrical connector.
4. Fuel pump relay by depressing bracket clip at rear of relay, or removing bolts from retaining
bracket.
INSTALL/DISCONNECT
1. Fuel pump relay. 2. Electrical connector. 3. Retainer. 4. Verify correct operation to confirm repair.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic
Transmission
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Automatic
Transmission > Page 4061
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4062
C120 - Fuel Pump Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4063
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Service and Repair
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable from battery.
- Sensor or switch connectors.
- Sensor or switch.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Sensor or switch.
- Sensor or switch.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4067
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4070
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4071
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4072
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4073
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4074
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4075
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4076
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4077
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4078
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4079
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4080
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4081
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4082
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4083
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4084
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4085
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4086
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4087
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4088
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4089
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4090
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4091
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4092
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4093
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4094
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4095
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4096
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4097
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4098
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4099
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4100
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4101
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4102
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4103
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4104
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4105
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement
Throttle Body Assembly (Exploded View)
REMOVAL/DISCONNECT
- TBI assembly from vehicle. See: Throttle Body Unit
- Fuel meter body attaching screw assemblies.
- Fuel meter body assembly.
- Fuel meter body to throttle body attaching screws.
- Fuel meter body assembly and gasket. Discard gasket.
- Throttle body to fuel meter body gasket and discard gasket.
DISASSEMBLE
Remove TPS from old throttle body, for use on new throttle body. (IAC valve does not have to be
removed, since a new one comes with replacement throttle body.)
ASSEMBLE
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement > Page 4110
Install TPS onto replacement throttle body assembly.See: Sensors and Switches - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction/Throttle Position Sensor/Service and Repair
INSTALL/CONNECT
- New throttle body to fuel meter body gasket.
- Fuel meter body assembly on throttle body assembly.
- Fuel meter body to throttle body attaching screws that have been coated with locking compound.
Tighten the attaching screw assemblies to 4.0 Nm (3.50 lb-in).
- TBI unit onto intake manifold. Tighten mounting bolts to 25.0 Nm (18.0 lb-ft).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement > Page 4111
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Fuel Meter Body Assembly
Fuel Meter Body Assembly
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connections to fuel injectors. (Squeeze plastic tabs and pull straight up.)
- Fuel meter cover assembly. See: Fuel Meter Cover Assembly
- Fuel injectors. See: Fuel Injector/Service and Repair/Fuel Injector(S) Replacement
- Fuel inlet and outlet lines. Discard O-rings.
- Fuel inlet and outlet nuts and gaskets from fuel meter body assembly. Discard gaskets.
NOTE Note locations of nuts, for proper reassembly later. Inlet nut has a larger passage than outlet
nut.
- Fuel meter body to throttle body attaching screw assemblies.
- Fuel meter body assembly from throttle body assembly.
- Throttle body to fuel meter body gasket and discard.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- New throttle body to fuel meter gasket. Match cut-out portions in gasket with openings in throttle
body.
- Fuel meter body assembly on throttle body assembly.
- Fuel meter body-to-throttle body attaching screw assemblies, precoated with appropriate locking
compound. Tighten screw assemblies to 4.0 Nm (35.0 lb-in).
- Fuel inlet and outlet nuts with new gaskets to fuel body assembly. Tighten inlet nut to 40.0 Nm
(30.0 lb-ft) and outlet nut to 29.0 Nm (21.0 lb-ft).
- Fuel inlet and return lines and new O-rings. (Use back-up wrench to keep TBI nuts from turning.
Tighten fuel lines to 27.0 Nm (20.0 lb-ft).
- Injectors with new upper and lower O-rings in fuel meter body assembly.
- Fuel meter cover gasket, fuel meter outlet gasket, and pressure regulator seal.
- Fuel meter cover assembly.
- Long and short fuel meter cover attaching screw assemblies, coated with appropriate compound.
Tighten screw assemblies to 3.0 Nm (27.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connectors to fuel injectors.
INSPECT
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement > Page 4112
Turn ignition switch to "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to "OFF" position for ten seconds.
Again turn ignition switch to "ON" position and check for leaks around gaskets and fuel line
couplings.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement > Page 4113
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Fuel Meter Cover Assembly
Fuel Meter Cover Assembly
The fuel meter cover assembly contains the fuel pressure regulator assembly. The regulator has
been adjusted at the factory and should only be serviced as a complete preset assembly.
CAUTION: DO NOT remove the four screws securing the pressure regulator to the fuel meter
cover. The fuel pressure regulator includes a large spring under heavy compression which, if
accidentally released, could cause personal injury. Disassembly might also result in a fuel leak
between the diaphragm and the regulator container.
Fuel Meter Cover Replacement (TBI 220)
Remove or Disconnect
1. Electrical connectors to fuel injectors. (Squeeze plastic tabs and pull straight up.) 2. Long and
short fuel meter cover screw assemblies. 3. Fuel meter cover assembly.
NOTICE: DO NOT immerse the fuel meter cover (with pressure regulator) in cleaner, as damage to
the regulator diaphragm and gasket could occur.
4. Fuel meter outlet gasket and pressure regulator seal. Discard gaskets and seal.
INSPECT: ^
For dirt, foreign material and casting warpage.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement > Page 4114
Fuel Meter Cover Replacement (TBI 220)
Install or Connect
1. New pressure regulator seal, fuel meter outlet passage gasket, and cover gasket. 2. Fuel meter
cover assembly. 3. Attaching screw assemblies, precoated with appropriate locking compound to
threads. (Short screws are next to injectors.)
TIGHTEN: ^
Screw assemblies to 3.0 Nm (28.0 lb. in.).
4. Electrical connectors to fuel injectors. 5. With engine "OFF," and ignition "ON," check for leaks
around gasket and fuel line couplings.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement > Page 4115
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body Unit
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Air cleaner assembly and discard gasket.
- Electrical connectors from idle air control valve (IAC), throttle position sensor (TPS), and fuel
injectors (squeeze plastic tabs on injector connector and pull straight up).
- Grommet with injector wires and lay aside.
- Throttle linkage, return spring(s), transmission control cable, and cruise control (wherever
applicable).
- Cable support bracket attaching screws and bracket.
- Vacuum hoses, noting position of hoses.
- Inlet and outlet fuel lines.
NOTE Relieve fuel pressure before disconnecting fuel lines and use a back-up wrench on inlet and
outlet nuts.
- Fuel line O-rings from fuel nuts and discard.
- TBI unit mounting hardware.
- TBI unit.
NOTE To prevent damage to the throttle valve, it is essential that the unit be placed on a holding
fixture, before performing service.
- TBI flange (manifold mounting) gasket.
NOTE Before removing old gasket from surface of intake manifold, stuff the manifold opening with
a clean rag to prevent material from entering the engine.
INSPECT
- Manifold bore for loose parts and foreign material.
- Intake manifold sealing surface for cleanliness.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- New TBI flange (manifold mounting) gasket.
- TBI unit with mounting hardware. Tighten to 25.0 Nm (18.0 lb.ft.)
- New O-rings on fuel line nuts and coat with new engine oil. Use a back-up wrench and tighten to
27.0 Nm (20 lb.ft.).
- Vacuum hoses.
- Cable support bracket attaching screws and bracket. Tighten to 10.0 Nm (88 lb.in.)
- Throttle linkage, return spring(s), transmission control cable, and cruise control (wherever
applicable).
- Grommet, with injector harness, to throttle body.
- Electrical connectors. Ensure connectors are fully seated and latched.
- Check to see if accelerator pedal is free, by depressing pedal to the floor and releasing, while
engine is "OFF".
- Check for fuel leaks around fuel line nuts. Apply fuel pressure by turning ignition "ON" with engine
"OFF".
- Air cleaner assembly with new gasket.
NOTE: Ensure injectors wires are not pinched between TBI and air cleaner assembly.
- Start engine check again for fuel leaks.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Locations
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Locations
Control Cable And Linkage
Accelerator Pedal Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4119
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair
Accelerator Pedal Assembly
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
When performing service on the accelerator pedal, observe the following: The mounting surface between the support and dash panel must be free of insulation. The carpet
and padding in the pedal and tunnel area must be positioned to lay flat and be free of wrinkles and
bunches.
- Slip the accelerator control cable through the slot in the rod and then install the retainer in the rod,
makeing sure it is seated. Use care when pressing the retainer into the hole in the rod to ensure
that the cable is not kinked or damaged in any way.
- After securing all components of the accelerator linkage, the linkage must operate freely without
binding between full closed throttle and full wide open throttle.
- Wires, hoses, cables or other obstructions must not be placed within 13 mm (1/2 inch) of the
cable or the rod at any point in their travel.
Control Cable And Linkage
ACCELERATOR CONTROL CABLE
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4120
When performing service on the accelerator control cable, observe the following: The retainer must be installed with the tangs secured overhead of the stud.
- The conduit fitting at both ends of the cable must have the locking tangs expanded and locked in
the attaching holes.
- The braided portion of the accelerator cable assembly must not come in contact with the front of
the dash sealer during assembly, repair, or replacement of the assembly.
- The flexible components (hoses, wires, conduits, etc.) must not be routed within 50 mm (2 inches)
of the moving parts of the accelerator linkage outboard of the support unless the routing is
positively controlled.
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Retainer from throttle lever stud
- Retainer locking tangs from support bracket
- Retainer from accelerator pedal rod or release cable from rod.
- Retainer locking tangs from dash panel
INSTALL/CONNECT
- Retainer to dash panel.
- Retainer to accelerator pedal rod or connect cable in rod slot.
- Retainer to support bracket.
- Retainer to throttle lever stud or connect cable to pulley.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Idle Normal 0.45 to 0.95 V
Maximum 1.25 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.0 to 4.5 V
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4124
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4127
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4128
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4129
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4130
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4131
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4132
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4133
Output
Outputs The Solid-State Switches are used to turn on a circuit outside the module. When the
switch closes, the voltage or ground shown will be applied to the connected circuit. Additional
information about what makes the switch close is often provided. The voltage controlled by the
switch may be measured just as if it were a mechanical switch.
Pulsed Output
These symbols are similar to the Solid-State Switch. The pulses represent the rate at which the
switch is turned on and off.
Data Output
These two symbols are special versions of the Solid-State Switch. They represent serial data
inputs and outputs. Serial data consists of coded groups of voltage pulses transmitted at high
speed. These pulses cannot usually be measured with a Digital Voltmeter. There are cases,
however, where procedures in System Diagnosis may describe such measurements. The Scan tool
can often read and display this data.
Input
Inputs These symbols represent the equivalent circuit at the input terminals of electronic modules.
You should not attempt to measure the resistance of these terminals unless instructed to do so by
a service procedure. These inputs can be used to check wiring to electronic modules.
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4134
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green:
GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4135
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Basic Electricity
Electrical power flows from the power source to a load device and then back to the source of
power. The electrical circuit should contain a device to open or close the circuit, such as a switch or
relay, and a protective device (in case of an overload), such as a circuit breaker or a fusible link.
Electrical circuits can be set up as series circuits, parallel circuits, or series/parallel circuits. The
circuits in this vehicle are normally parallel circuits.
CIRCUITS
Series Circuit
Series Circuits In a series circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form one current path to
and from the power source. In a series circuit the voltage is shared equally by all the devices in the
circuit.
Parallel Circuit
Parallel Circuits In a parallel circuit, the electrical devices are connected to form more than one
current path to and from the power source. In a parallel circuit the voltage is constant and equal for
each current path.
Series/Parallel Circuit
Series/Parallel Circuits A series/parallel circuit consists of a single current path and a circuit with
more than one current path to and from the power source.
Circuit Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4136
Circuit Components
Circuit components include power sources, circuit protection devices, circuit controllers, and circuit
loads. Power sources are the battery or generator which provide the power for the circuit. Circuit
protection devices are components such as fuses, circuit breakers and fusible links and provide
overload protection for the circuit. Circuit controllers are used to control the power flow within a
circuit and are usually switches and relays. Circuit loads are the actual component that provides a
specific function. Circuit loads can be lights, motors, and solenoids.
Relayless Circuit
Relay Circuit
Relays Battery and load location may require that a switch be placed some distance from either
component. This means a longer wire and a higher voltage drop. The installation of a relay
between the battery and the load reduces the voltage drop, because the switch controls the relay,
the switch can be compact. Refer to Fuse, Circuit Breaker, Lamp Bulb, and Relay Data for a listing
of relays used in this vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4137
Diode Specifications And Configurations
Diode Markings
Diodes Many of the electrical systems in this vehicle use diodes to isolate certain circuits and
protect them from voltage surges. Diode specifications and replacement part numbers are listed.
To identify the Peak Inverse Voltage (PIV) rating of the diode that will be replaced. Replacement
procedures are as follows: 1. If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape. 2. Paying
attention to the direction of current flow, remove the faulty diode from the harness with a suitable
soldering tool. If the diode is located
next to a connector terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from
the soldering tool.
3. Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered portion of the wire(s). Do not
remove any more than is necessary to attach
the new diode.
4. Check the current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the diode with the correct
bias. Attach the new diode to the wire(s)
using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a heat sink (aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode
leads to protect it from excessive heat. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering
equipment you are using.
5. Install terminal(s) into the connector body, if removed in step 2. 6. Tape the diode to the harness
or connector using electrical tape. To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely
cover all exposed
wire and diode attachment points.
Circuit Malfunctions
There are three electrical conditions that can cause a non-working circuit: an "Open Circuit," a
"Short Circuit" or a "Grounded Circuit." These conditions can also be caused by intermittent or poor
connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4138
Open Circuit
Open Circuit An open circuit occurs whenever there is a break in the circuit. The break can be
corrosion at the connector, a wire broken off in a component, a wire that burned open from too
much current or a component not operating as it should.
Short Circuit
Short Circuit A short circuit happens when the current bypasses part of the normal circuit. This
bypassing is usually caused by wires touching, salt water in or on a component such as a switch or
a connector, or solder melting and bridging conductors in a component.
Grounded Circuit
Grounded Circuit A grounded circuit is like a short circuit but the current flows directly into a ground
circuit that is not part of the original circuit. This may be caused by a wire rubbing against the frame
or body. Sometimes a wire will break and fall against metal that is connected electrically to the
ground side of the voltage supply. A grounded circuit may also be caused by deposits of oil, dirt, or
moisture around connections or terminals, which provide a good path to ground.
Intermittents And Poor Connections Most intermittents are usually caused by faulty electrical
connections or wiring, although occasionally a sticking relay, solenoid, or loose ground point can be
a problem.
General
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it
is important to check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line
connectors, before replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: "Check for poor connection." Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4139
contact. A poor connection between the male and female terminal at a connector may be the result
of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact.
1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, instruction manual, J
38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination. Contamination will result in a white or
green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing high terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female terminal
in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and then
joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention force is
significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in question,
refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A.
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a (DVM) Digital Voltmeter connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement
Twin Lock Connector Terminal
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Twin Lock-Type)
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 22727 Terminal Remover 1. Connector lock tangs. 2.
Terminal locks using J 22727 (3). 3. Wire terminal (1).
Install or Connect 1. Pry out the tangs. 2. Terminal (1) into the connector (2).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4140
Removing The Terminals From The Connector
Wiring Connector Terminal Replacement (Blade-Type)
Remove or Disconnect 1. Terminal lock tang. 2. Terminal (1).
Resetting The Terminal Lock Tang
Install or Connect 1. Pry up on the terminal lock tang (1). 2. Terminal into the connector.
General
The following test equipment comes in a variety of styles and are adequate for simple tests.
However, when accuracy becomes important, the value of a reading obtained using a meter is
critical to the diagnosis procedure. Make sure any electrical test meter used is of sufficient quality
and accuracy to make the measurements required in the electrical testing.
Jumper Wires
Jumper wires allow "jumping" across a suspected open or break in a circuit.
^ If the circuit works properly with the jumper wire in place, but does not work when the jumper wire
is removed, the circuit has an open spot.
^ A circuit without any opens or breaks has continuity and needs no further testing.
The jumper is usually a long wire with alligator clips. A version of the jumper has a fuse holder in it
with a 10-amp fuse. This will prevent damaging the circuit if the jumper is connected in the wrong
way.
The jumper is used to locate opens in a circuit. One end of the jumper is attached to a voltage
source and the other end is attached to the load in the circuit, i.e. lamps or motors. If the load
works, try "jumping" to circuit points that are progressively closer to the voltage supply. When the
circuit load stops working, the open has been located.
The jumper is also used to test components in the circuit such as connectors, switches and
suspected high resistance points.
Unpowered Test Lamp
This tool consists of a 12-volt lamp with leads. The ends of the leads usually have alligator clips,
but various kinds of probes, terminal spades and special connectors also are used.
The 12-volt test lamp continuity tester uses the vehicle's battery to provide voltage to the circuit
being tested. 12-volt testers are manufactured with a
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4141
variety of tips to permit touching them to connectors, bare wires, insulated wires, or even wires
within wiring harnesses. To check the tester before use, briefly touch the clip to one side of the
battery and the probe to the other. 12-volt testers are NOT sensitive to polarity in a circuit and can
be connected either way.
The 12-volt test lamp generally has a sharp probe tip so it can be inserted into connector terminals
or through the wire insulation for testing. It is important to keep the probe tip sharp to minimize
damage to wire insulation. When the test is complete at a particular point, be sure to tape any
holes made in wire insulation.
The unpowered test lamp is used on an open circuit. One lead of the test lamp is grounded and the
other lead is moved around the circuit to find the open. Depending on the physical layout of the
circuit, sometimes it is easier to start at the voltage supply, and other times it is easier to start at the
circuit load or ground circuit.
Once one becomes familiar with the test lamp and the brilliance of the bulb in a normal circuit,
high-resistance circuits can be recognized by the effect they have on the bulb. As the current drops
in a high-resistance circuit, the bulb in the test lamp glows less brightly. Although the 12-volt test
lamp cannot be used as a foolproof test for high resistance, a less than normal brilliance of the
lamp is an indication of circuit high resistance. Further testing will verify the condition and locate the
cause.
NOTE: Test lamps are to be used only on circuits that do not contain solid-state devices. If a test
lamp is used in a circuit containing a solid-state device, the current that the test lamp would draw
would be above the current that the solid-state device would be able to handle. Using a test lamp
on a solid-state device may damage the device.
Self-Powered Test Lamp
This lamp is a pencil-shaped unit with a self-contained battery, a 1.5-volt lamp bulb, a sharp probe,
and a ground lead fitted with an alligator clip.
This test is used mainly for testing components that are disconnected from the vehicle voltage
supply. The powered test lamp is also useful for testing suspected high resistance points in a circuit
such as connectors and ground circuits that are corroded or loose.
General
The following three types of meters are generally used for diagnosis: ammeter, ohmmeter, and
voltmeter.
These meters are available in two designs: analog (needle-type) and digital (electronic
display-type).
NOTE: The correct type of meter must be used when diagnosing circuits containing solid-state
devices. Incorrect use of the meters will result in damage to the solid-state device.
Analog meters may be used for any circuit not containing a solid-state device, while a digital meter
MUST be used to diagnose any circuit with a solid-state device. Circuits which contain a solid-state
device, such as the engine control module, should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher
impedance digital multimeter (J 39200 or equivalent).
Ammeter
Ammeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4142
Meter Scales
An ammeter is used to measure current flow (amperage) in a circuit. Amperes are units of electron
flow which indicate how many electrons are passing through the circuit. Current flow in a circuit is
equal to the circuit voltage divided by total circuit resistance.
At normal operating voltage, most circuits have a characteristic amount of current flow, referred to
as normal current draw. Current draw is measured in amperes (amps) with an ammeter.
Comparing measured current draw with the specified current draw rating provides useful diagnostic
information.
Disconnect the circuit from the voltage source before connecting the ammeter. The ammeter must
be placed in series with the circuit being tested. Be sure that the ammeter's positive terminal is
connected to the positive (battery) side of the circuit and its negative terminal to the negative
(ground) side of the circuit.
NOTE: Never connect an ammeter across a circuit like a voltmeter. The ammeter could be
damaged by the vehicle electrical system.
Excessive current draw is responsible for blowing fuses and, in some cases, draining the battery.
An ammeter helps diagnose these conditions by locating the cause of the excessive current draw.
On the other hand, there are times when a reduced current draw at a component (a power window
motor for example) causes unsatisfactory performance of an electrical system.
Ohmmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4143
Ohmmeter
Meter Scales
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4144
The ohmmeter is used to read resistance (ohms) or to check for opens or shorts in a circuit or
component. There are both analog-type and digital-type ohmmeters.
^ An analog ohmmeter shows the actual resistance on a scale by the movement of a needle.
^ On a digital ohmmeter, the resistance measured is converted inside the meter to a numerical
output which is shown on a display panel.
Ohmmeters use a small battery to supply the voltage and current which flow through the circuit
being tested. The current flows through the circuit, positions the needle on analog-type ohmmeters
or converts to a digital readout on digital-type ohmmeters.
Although there are several different styles of analog ohmmeters, all usually have the following
features in addition to the meter movement:
^ A range selector switch which permits the selection of different ranges of resistance.
^ A set adjust control which allows the meter to be set at zero for accurate measurements.
^ Some model ohmmeters also have a built-in feature that allows the ohmmeter to be used as a
self-powered test lamp.
Digital meters do not have to be zeroed. They have various ranges just like the analog meters.
NOTE: Like a self-powered test lamp, the ohmmeter can only be used on circuits where voltage
has been removed. It is designed to be operated on its own voltage and current levels for the meter
to make resistance measurements. The 12-volt electrical system voltage in the vehicles circuits
could damage the meter.
Electrical circuits can be checked for opens using basically the same procedure as previously
described for the self-powered test lamp. The circuit must be separated from all voltage sources.
The ohmmeter is connected across the two open ends of the circuit to be checked. A high reading
(infinity) is an indication of an open circuit. A low reading (near zero) is an indication of a
continuous circuit.
Checks for short circuits are made in a similar manner to that used for open circuits, except that the
circuit being checked must be isolated from both voltage and normal ground.
Connecting the ohmmeter between an isolated circuit and a good ground point allows checking the
circuit for shorts to ground.
A short to ground in the circuit is indicated on the meter by a near zero reading. A good circuit (no
short to ground) shows up as infinity (very high resistance) indicated on the meter.
To measure the resistance of a component or a circuit, the component or circuit must be isolated
from all other components (or circuits). The ohmmeter leads are then placed across the component
or circuit and the resistance is read on the ohmmeter.
Voltmeter
Voltmeter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4145
Meter Scales
The voltmeter (properly observed) will give the technician more information than the ammeter,
ohmmeter, and test lamp combined. Its application for diagnosis here is to measure the electrical
pressure (voltage) drop in a resistance circuit. Voltage drop is a reduction or "using up" of the
voltage to push electricity through a resistance. It can be compared to the pressure of water flowing
through a metering valve.
Low voltage to a lamp makes the lamp glow dimly. This can be caused by low source voltage
(battery discharge or low alternator output) or by high resistance in the circuit due to a poor
connection. Before making any meter measurements, it is important to review the relationship
between current, voltage and resistance.
Determining voltage drop is important because it provides the following information:
^ Too high of a voltage drop indicates excessive resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs
too slowly or a lamp glows too dimly, one can be sure there is excessive resistance in the circuit.
By taking voltage drop readings in various parts of the circuit, the problem (corroded terminals, for
example) can be isolated.
^ Too low of a voltage drop indicates low resistance. If, for instance, a blower motor runs too fast,
the problem could be isolated to a low resistance in a resistor pack by taking voltage drop readings.
^ Maximum allowable voltage drop under a load is critical, especially if there is more than one high
resistance problem in a circuit. It is important because, like all resistances, all voltage drops are
cumulative. Corroded terminals, loose connections, and similar problems reduce the voltage
available across the key circuit components. The current flow is reduced in the circuit, and all of the
affected components operate at less than peak efficiency. A small drop across wires (conductors),
switches, connectors, etc., is normal. This is due to the resistance of the conductors but should
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4146
be less than 10 percent of the total drop.
When using a voltmeter:
^ Be sure to connect the positive lead to the battery side and the negative lead to the ground side
of the component being checked.
^ Voltage drop occurs when electricity (current) flows through a resistance. Make sure the voltage
drop being measured is only through the component being checked, not through the component
and a poor connection.
^ The circuit must be operating (lamp ON or motor running, for example) to measure voltage drop.
The instrument panel voltmeter in the vehicle should also be observed for monitoring proper
operation of the generator, battery, cranking motor, and cranking circuit. In this application, battery
voltage drop can be monitored while the engine is cranking; after the engine is running, generator
output voltage can be monitored. This can be a valuable first step before diagnosing other electrical
problems.
General
SIX STEP PROCESS OF ELECTRICAL DIAGNOSIS:
To correctly isolate and repair electrical problems, view the video Electrical Diagnosis (T-9067-1)
and follow these six electrical diagnosis steps:
Step 1: Verify the Problem Review the work order, operate the system, and list symptoms in order
to: ^
Check the accuracy and completeness of the complaint.
^ Re-create the problem.
Step 2: Narrow the Choice of Possible Causes of Failure Refer to the circuit diagram for clues to
the problem. Location and identification of circuit components may give some idea of where the
problem is.
The circuit diagrams are designed to make it easy to identify common points in circuits. This
knowledge can help narrow the problem to a specific area. For example, if several circuits fail at
the same time, check for a common power or ground connection. If part of a circuit fails, check the
connections between the part that works and the part that does not work.
For example, if the low beam headlamps work, but the high beams and the indicator lamps do not,
then voltage and ground paths are good. Since the headlamp dimmer switch is the component
which switches this voltage, it is most likely the cause of the failure.
Step 3: Identify the Failed Circuit Read the circuit operation for the problem circuit identified in the
previous step. By studying the circuit diagram and circuit operation, enough information should be
learned to narrow the cause to one component or one portion of the circuit.
Step 4: Locate the Failed Component or Element The diagnosis charts are a step-by-step
approach to diagnose a symptom. Each chart covers one symptom. For example, "HORN(S) WILL
NOT OPERATE."
The charts are divided into three columns: Test, Result, and Action. The test procedures are listed
in numerical sequence and must be followed in that order. Each test step describes what must be
done to the circuit, what test equipment to use and where to connect the test equipment.
After the test procedure has been performed, refer to the result column. This lists possible results
of the test. Once the result has been found, follow it directly over to the action column.
The action column instructs what must be done to correct the problem or lists the next test step to
be performed.
It is important to remember that a problem in one system could result in a symptom in another
system.
Step 5: Make the Repair Repair the problem circuit as directed in the diagnosis charts.
Step 6: Verify that the Repair is Complete Operate the system, and check that the repair has
removed all symptoms and has not caused any new symptoms.
Finding A Short Circuit or Ground
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4147
Short And Grounded Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes on.
Example: A - Ignition SW ON B - Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C - Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay on
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light. The short lies between
the connector where the test light stays light and the
connector where the light goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating or connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, Refer to "Checking Terminal Contact" for specifics. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Wiring Problems
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand-type wire are intact, resistance could be far too
high.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined in the following procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4148
Special Tools
General
All electrical connections must be kept clean and tight. Loose or corroded connections may cause
a discharged battery, difficult starting, dim lamps and possible damage to the generator and
regulator. Wires must be replaced it insulation becomes burned, cracked, or deteriorated.
Always use rosin flux solder to splice a wire or repair one that is frayed or broken, and use
insulating tape to cover all splices or bare wires.
When replacing wire, it is important that the correct size wire be used as shown on applicable
wiring diagrams or in parts books. Each harness or wire must be held securely in place to prevent
chafing or damage to the insulation due to vibration. Wire size in a circuit is determined by the
amount of current, the length of the circuit, and the voltage drop allowed. Wire size is specified
using the metric gage. The metric gage describes the wire size directly in a cross section area
measured in square millimeters.
Wire Repair
The wire is very important for the continued reliable operation of the vehicle. This repair must be
done as described in the following procedures.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4149
Twisted Wire Repair
Twisted Wires
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Twisted wires (2). 3. Insulation from the wire.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clip (3). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (4). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(5) on the splices. 4. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (6).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4150
Twisted/Shielded Wire Repair
Twisted Wires Shielded Cable
Remove or Disconnect 1. Jacket (1). 2. Unwrap aluminum/Mylar tape (2). 3. Drain wire (3). 4.
Leads. 5. Insulation on the leads.
Install or Connect 1. Splice clips (4). 2. Crimp and solder the splice clips (5). 3. Electrical tape wrap
(6) on the splices. 4. Aluminum/Mylar tape by wrapping and taping. 5. Drain wire with a splice clip
(7). Crimp and solder the splice clip. 6. Outer jacket electrical tape wrap (8).
Solderless Wiring Repair
Solderless wiring repair can be accomplished by the use of crimp and seal splice sleeves. Crimp
and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial to form a
one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as moisture
sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit. Use the
following procedure for solderless wiring repair:
1. Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation damage,
use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply stores). The
crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except tefzel and coaxial and
may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
2. Cut the Wire Begin cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the extra
length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of the splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is 40 mm (1.5 in) away from other
splices, harness
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4151
branches, or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging adjacent splices and causing
damage.
3. Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add length of wire to the existing harness, be certain to
use the same size as the original wire.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in your wire stripper and work down until you get a clean strip of the insulation.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in) of insulation from each wire to be splices. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
4. Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire size. The
splice sleeves and tool nests are color coded. Refer above to determine the correct splice sleeve.
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The splice sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further.
Close the handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4152
Seal Splice Sequence
5. Insert the Wires into the Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the crimp tool tightly until the crimper handles open when
released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure has been applied
to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the opposite end of the splice. Figure shows the
condition of the splice sleeve after crimping.
Seal Splice Sequence
6. Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using a heat torch, apply heat to the center of the splice
sleeve. Gradually move the heat to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing as the heat is
moved along the insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when
sufficient shrinking has been achieved. Figure shows the condition of the splice when the tubing is
completely shrunk.
General
Special connectors known as Weather-Pack connectors require special tool J 28742 for servicing.
This special tool is required to remove the pin and sleeve terminals. If removal is attempted with an
ordinary pick, there is a good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed. Unlike standard
blade-type terminals, these terminals cannot be straightened once they are bent.
Make sure that the connectors are properly seated and all of the sealing rings (1) are in place when
connecting the leads. The hinge-type flap (4) provides a back-up, or secondary locking feature for
terminals. They are used to improve the connector reliability by retaining the terminals if the small
terminal lock tangs are not positioned properly.
Molded-on connectors require complete replacement of the connection. This means splicing a new
connector assembly into the harness. Environmental connections cannot be replaced with standard
connections. Instructions are provided with the Weather-Pack connector and terminal packages.
With the low current and voltage levels found in some circuits, it is important that the best possible
bond at all wire splices be made by soldering the splices.
Use care when probing the connections or replacing terminals in them. It is possible to short
between two terminals. If this happens, damage may be done to certain components. Always use
jumper wires between connectors for circuit checking. Never probe through the Weather-Pack
seals.
When diagnosing for possible open circuits, it is often difficult to locate them by sight because
oxidation or terminal misalignment is hidden by the connectors. Merely wiggling a connector on a
sensor or in the wiring harness may pinpoint the open circuit condition. This should always be
considered when an open circuit is indicated while diagnosing.Intermittent problems may also be
caused by oxidized or loose connections.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4153
Weather-Pack Connector Replacement
Weather Pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 28742 Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector section. 3. Secondary lock (6) by spreading the sides of
the hasp, thus clearing the staples and rotating the hasp (8). 4. Terminal (12) by using J 28742 (9).
^ Snip off the old terminal assembly.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation (11).
Clean
^ Terminal barrel (5).
Install or Connect
1. Terminal insulator (15) on the wire. Slide the insulator back on the wire about 8 cm (3 inches). 2.
Terminal (12) on the wire.
^ Roll crimp (13) and solder the terminal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4154
3. Terminal insulator (15) and the roll crimp (14). 4. Terminal into the connector. 5. Secondary lock
(6). 6. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
General
Metri-pack Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4155
Contact Tang And Amount Of Deformation
The Metri-Pack connectors use a pull-to-seat type terminal. The special tool required to remove the
terminal is J 35689-A terminal remover. If removal is attempted with an ordinary pick, there is a
good chance that the terminal will be bent or deformed.
Metri-Pack Connector Replacement
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4156
Metri-pack Connector
Remove or Disconnect Tool Required: J 35689-A Terminal Remover
1. Primary lock (2) by lifting. 2. Connector body (17). 3. Connector seal (1) by pulling the seal back
onto the wires away from the connector body (17). 4. Terminal (16) by inserting J 35689-A (19) into
the connector body (17) to depress the locking tang (18), then push the wire and terminal through
the connector body. ^
Snip off the old terminal unless the terminal is to be reused; reshape the locking tang.
5. 5mm (0.2 inch) of the wire insulation.
Clean
^ Terminal cavity of the connector body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4157
Metri-pack Connector
Install or Connect
1. Terminal (16) on the wire.
^ Crimp and solder the terminal.
2. Terminal (16) into the connector cavity by pulling the wire on the seal side of the connector until
the locking tang (18) is fully seated. 3. Seal (1) by pressing the seal into the connector body(17)
until it is fully seated. 4. Connector sections until the primary lock (2) engages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4158
C110 - TP Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4159
Throttle Position (TP) Circuit
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4160
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Wiring Diagram For Code 21 - Throttle Position Sensor (Signal Voltage High)
NOTE Because different models and engine applications vary in wire colors, circuit numbers, and
pin numbers, the above image is a typical example. Refer to COMPUTERS AND CONTROL
SYSTEMS/SCHEMATIC AND ROUTING DIAGRAMS for specific schematic applications.
PURPOSE
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the PCM. The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the control module for fuel
control and for most of the control module control outputs.
OPERATION
The TPS has three internal circuits provided by the control module. One to ground, a second from
the control module as a 5.0 volt reference source and a third circuit is used by the control module
to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal)
the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle
(WOT). Each time the voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module assumes this
value is 0 throttle from this point on.
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4161
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS is not adjustable. Each time voltage drops below 1.25 volts and stops, the control module
assumes that this value is zero throttle angle and measures percent throttle from this point on.
Therefore adjustment is not necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4162
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE
Since Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) configurations can be mounted interchangeably, be sure to
order the correct one for your engine with identical part number of the one being replaced.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
- Electrical connectors.
- TPS attaching screw assemblies and retainer, (if applicable).
- TPS from throttle body assembly.
NOTE Do NOT immerse in any type of liquid solvent or cleaner, as damage may occur.
INSTALL/CONNECT
- With throttle valve in normally closed position, install TPS on throttle shaft with seal and rotate
counter clockwise to align mounting hole.
- Two attaching screw assemblies. Tighten screw assemblies to 2.0 Nm (18.0 lb-in).
- Electrical connector to TPS.
- Check for TPS output as follows: Connect an ALDL scanner to read TPS output voltage.
- With ignition "ON" and engine stopped, TPS voltage should be less than 1.25 volts. If more than
1.25 volts, replace TPS.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-6-5-4-3-2
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Ignition Timing Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location Correction
Ignition Timing Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location
Correction
File in Section: Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-41
Date: January, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 6A - Ignition Set Timing Connector Location
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine
(VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
The location of the Set Timing Connector is incorrectly called out in "Section 6A" (Page 6A-8) of the
"Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis", Service Manual and in the 1994 Oldsmobile
Bravada Service Manual Supplement (Page 6E3-C4-8).
The correct location of the Set Timing Connector is inside the cab where the Heater Box and the
carpet meet on the passenger side floor.
Pull carpet back to expose the single wire and connectors on the outside of the control module
harness. The wire colors are tan with a black stripe.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Ignition Timing Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4173
Timing Connector-In Pass Comp Behind Carpet, Below Heater
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Timing Marks and Indicators
> System Information > Locations
Timing Mark
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications
Distributor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4184
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4185
Distributor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The distributor reference signal provides the ECM with both engine RPM and crankshaft position
information. This enables the ECM to operate the fuel pump relay and energize the fuel injector.
OPERATION
When the engine is cranking or running the ECM receives Distributor Ignition (DI) reference pulses
from the ignition module. If the wire becomes open or grounded the engine will not run, as the ECM
will not operate the injector.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4186
Distributor: Service and Repair
Distributor
Remove or Disconnect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4187
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4188
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4189
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4190
- Make sure the ignition switch is "OFF."
1. Air cleaner and hoses (4.3L VIN Z). 2. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor
cap. 3. Two screws on the sides of the distributor cap. 4. Coil wire and spark plug wires on either
the left or right side of the distributor. 5. Distributor cap and move it aside.
A. Use chalk to note the position of the rotor in relation to the engine. B. Use chalk to note the
position of the distributor housing in relation to the engine.
6. Distributor bolt and hold-down clamp. 7. Distributor and gasket, when present.
Install or Connect
Figure 8 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (2.2L)
Figure 9 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side (2.2L)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4191
Figure 10 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 11 - Distributor And Coil (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4192
Figure 12 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Left Side (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 13 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Pickup Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4193
Figure 14 - Spark Plug Wire Routing - Right Side - Utility Models (4.3L VIN Z)
Figure 15 - Spark Plug Wire Routing (4.3L VIN W)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4194
A. To ensure correct timing of the distributor, it must be installed with the rotor correctly positioned
as noted in step 5 of the removal procedure. Line
up the rotor to the mark on the engine, and the mark on the housing to the engine.
B. If the distributor shaft won't drop into the engine, remove the distributor, insert a screwdriver into
the hole for the distributor and rotate the oil
pump driveshaft so that it lines up with the distributor driver gear.
1. Distributor and gasket, where present. 2. Hold-down clamp and bolt.
- Bolt on the 4.3L to 27 Nm (20 lbs. ft.).
3. Distributor cap. 4. Wiring harness connectors at the side of the distributor. 5. Spark plug wires
and coil wire. 6. Air Cleaner and hoses.
- Check the engine timing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
RESISTANCE VALUES
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 3,000 - 10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 4,000 - 15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
................................................. 6,000 - 20,000 ohms.
NOTE: Longer wires should measure about 5,000 to 10,000 ohms per foot.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4198
Ignition Cable: Locations
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications
Ignition Coil: Specifications
COIL PACK RESISTANCE SPECIFICATIONS:
^ The OEM service manual does not give a specification for coil resistance and recommends to
test all other ignition components first and then switch affected coil with a good known coil and
retest.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4202
Engine Harness, Right Front
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4203
C112 - Ignition Coil
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4204
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection
Ignition Coil Testing
TOOL REQUIRED
J 39200 Digital Multimeter.
Make sure the ignition switch is "OFF."
1. Disconnect the connector and coil wire from the ignition coil.
NOTE: Do not insert the J 39200 probe into the ignition coil connectors. The female terminals could
be spread and deformed, resulting in intermittent operation of the coil. Be sure to make contact with
only the front edge of the terminals.
2. Connect J 39200 as shown in image, (1). Measure resistance using the high scale. The reading
should be OL (infinite). If not, replace the coil. 3. Connect J 39200 as shown in (2). Measure
resistance using the low scale. The reading should be 0.2 - 1.5 ohms. If not, replace the coil. 4.
Connect J 39200 as shown in (3). Measure resistance using the high scale. The meter should read
5k - 25k ohms. If it does, replace the coil. 5. Reconnect the distributor lead and wiring to the coil.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4205
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
Distributor And Coil 4.3L Engine
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Coil to distributor lead at coil.
NOTE Make sure ignition switch is "OFF".
- Wiring connectors at side of the coil.
- Nuts or screws holding coil bracket and coil to engine.
- Coil bracket and coil. ^
Drill and punch out rivets holding coil to coil bracket.
- Coil from coil bracket.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Coil to coil bracket with screws.
- Coil and coil bracket to engine. Tighten screws to 10 N-m (89 lb. in.).
- Wiring connectors to the coil. Assure connectors are fully seated and latched.
- Distributor lead to coil. Assure lead is fully seated on coil tower.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Ignition Module
Typical Distributor Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Ignition Module > Page 4210
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4211
C121 - Ignition Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4212
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
Typical Distributor Components
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
NOTE It is not necessary to remove ignition distributor assembly from engine.
- Distributor cap and rotor.
- Connectors from module.
- Two module attaching screws.
- Lift module from housing and remove.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
NOTE: Do not wipe silicone grease from metal face of module or distributor base (where the
module seats), when reinstalling the same module. If new module is to be installed clean distributor
module base and spread new silicone grease on base and metal face of ignition module. The
purpose of the silicone grease is to cool module.
- Module onto housing.
- Module attaching screws. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb.in.)
- Connectors to module.
- Rotor and cap.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing Connector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location Correction
Ignition Timing Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Set Timing Connector - Location
Correction
File in Section: Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 41-65-41
Date: January, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 6A - Ignition Set Timing Connector Location
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models 1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine
(VINs W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
The location of the Set Timing Connector is incorrectly called out in "Section 6A" (Page 6A-8) of the
"Driveability, Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis", Service Manual and in the 1994 Oldsmobile
Bravada Service Manual Supplement (Page 6E3-C4-8).
The correct location of the Set Timing Connector is inside the cab where the Heater Box and the
carpet meet on the passenger side floor.
Pull carpet back to expose the single wire and connectors on the outside of the control module
harness. The wire colors are tan with a black stripe.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing Connector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4217
Timing Connector-In Pass Comp Behind Carpet, Below Heater
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision > Page 4222
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4223
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Assembly View > Page 4226
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Assembly View > Page 4227
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4228
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4229
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4230
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4231
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark
Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4232
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Pick-Up Coil, Ignition > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Pick-Up Coil: Service and Repair
Typical Distributor Components
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
1. With distributor removed, disconnect wires at module terminals 2. Roll pin from drive gear by
driving out with 1/8 inch diameter drift punch. Mark shaft and driven gear so they can be aligned for
assembly. 3. Gear, shim and tanged washer from distributor shaft. Remove any burrs that may
have been caused by removal of pin. 4. Distributor shaft from housing. Bushings in housing are not
serviceable. 5. Remove retainer from inside pickup coil assembly. 6. Remove pickup coil assembly
from housing.
INSTALL/CONNECT
1. Install pickup coil.
^ Fit tab on the bottom of coil into anchor hole in housing.
2. Connect pickup coil wiring connector to module.
^ Make sure locking tab is in place.
3. Install shield onto coil.
4. Install retainer onto shield.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Pick-Up Coil, Ignition > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4236
Installing Pick-up Coil Retainer
NOTE: Use a new round retainer if center bushing in distributor base has no groove around the
outside. Use a new square retainer when there is a groove in center bushing. a.
Place retainer over center bushing with teeth pointing upward.
b. Place a 15 mm (5/8 in.) socket head onto edge of retainer. Keep socket centered on retainer so
the teeth are not damaged. Use a small hammer to tap retainer evenly down on center bushing.
When installing square retainer, make sure both teeth are seated in groove on bushing. NOTE: The
retainer should hold shield, pickup coil, and pole piece firmly.
5. Install shaft assembly into housing.
6. Install tanged washer, shim and drive gear (teeth up) to bottom of shaft. Align drive gear and
shaft assembly.
7. Install new roll pin and spin shaft to make sure teeth on shaft assembly do not touch pole piece.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Pole Piece / Reluctor Wheel, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Pole Piece / Reluctor Wheel: Service and Repair
Typical Distributor Components
REMOVE/DISCONNECT
1. With distributor removed, disconnect wires at module terminals 2. Roll pin from drive gear by
driving out with 1/8 inch diameter drift punch. Mark shaft and driven gear so they can be aligned for
assembly. 3. Gear, shim and tanged washer from distributor shaft. Remove any burrs that may
have been caused by removal of pin. 4. Distributor shaft from housing. Bushings in housing are not
serviceable. 5. Remove retainer from inside pickup coil assembly. 6. Remove pickup coil assembly
from housing.
INSTALL/CONNECT
1. Install pickup coil.
^ Fit tab on the bottom of coil into anchor hole in housing.
2. Connect pickup coil wiring connector to module.
^ Make sure locking tab is in place.
3. Install shield onto coil.
4. Install retainer onto shield.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Pole Piece / Reluctor Wheel, Ignition >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4240
Installing Pick-up Coil Retainer
NOTE: Use a new round retainer if center bushing in distributor base has no groove around the
outside. Use a new square retainer when there is a groove in center bushing. a.
Place retainer over center bushing with teeth pointing upward.
b. Place a 15 mm (5/8 in.) socket head onto edge of retainer. Keep socket centered on retainer so
the teeth are not damaged. Use a small hammer to tap retainer evenly down on center bushing.
When installing square retainer, make sure both teeth are seated in groove on bushing. NOTE: The
retainer should hold shield, pickup coil, and pole piece firmly.
5. Install shaft assembly into housing.
6. Install tanged washer, shim and drive gear (teeth up) to bottom of shaft. Align drive gear and
shaft assembly.
7. Install new roll pin and spin shaft to make sure teeth on shaft assembly do not touch pole piece.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Ignition Module
Typical Distributor Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Ignition Module > Page 4246
Rear Engine Wiring W/Man Trans
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4247
C121 - Ignition Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4248
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
Typical Distributor Components
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
NOTE It is not necessary to remove ignition distributor assembly from engine.
- Distributor cap and rotor.
- Connectors from module.
- Two module attaching screws.
- Lift module from housing and remove.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
NOTE: Do not wipe silicone grease from metal face of module or distributor base (where the
module seats), when reinstalling the same module. If new module is to be installed clean distributor
module base and spread new silicone grease on base and metal face of ignition module. The
purpose of the silicone grease is to cool module.
- Module onto housing.
- Module attaching screws. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb.in.)
- Connectors to module.
- Rotor and cap.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
Knock Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision
File In Section: 6E Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 51-65-19
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Section 3A - Control Module System (PCM) Driveability and Emissions - Revised DTC 43
Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensors)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T; M/L, C/K Models with 4.3L Engine (VINs W, Z RPOs L35, LB4)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Knock Sensor Circuit - DTC 43 Chart Revision >
Page 4254
This bulletin advises of a revision to the DTC 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit (Dual Knock Sensor
System) chart in the following service manuals:
1994 S/T Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-119
1994 M/L Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-75
1994 C/K Driveability Emissions and Electrical Diagnosis Manual, page 3A-69
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4255
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Coil bracket bolt/nut .............................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Distributor clamp bolt ...........................................................................................................................
................................................ 27 N-m (20 lbs ft)
Knock Sensor ......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 19 N-m (14 lbs ft)
Spark Plugs .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 15 N-M (11 lbs ft)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View
Knock Sensors
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 4258
Knock Sensor: Locations Harness View
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Assembly View > Page 4259
LH Rear
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4260
Knock Sensor: Diagrams
C119 - Knock Sensor
C135 - Knock Sensor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4261
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The control module will retard
the electronic spark timing up to 8° based on the signal received.
CONSTRUCTION
The KS system has two major components: Control Module.
- Knock Sensor(s). The two knock sensors are spliced together and go directly to the control
module.
OPERATION
The knock sensor internal circuit causes the control modules 5 volts to be pulled down to about 2.5
volts. The knock sensor produces an A/C signal which rides on the 2.5 volts DC signal. The AC
voltage monitor in the control module will detect this AC voltage and provide a signal to begin
retarding spark until the knock diminishes. The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the
knock level.
LOCATION
Engine block.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4262
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Knock Sensor (KS) System Check
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4263
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description
The Knock Sensor (KS) circuit consists of two knock sensors with one wire that goes directly to the
control modules. There are two Knock Sensor (KS) checks performed by the ECM. One check
consists of monitoring CKT 496 for a voltage that is more than .63 volt and less than 3.1 volts.
If voltage is either too high or too low for 10 or more seconds, DTC 43 will set. The PCM uses this
self check only. The next test is used only by the ECM along with the previous test. Once engine
temperature reaches 85°C, MAP is over 83 kPa, and engine speed is less than 3200 RPM, the
ECM will perform a self check. This self check will advance the timing until it receives a knock
signal. If no knock signal is received, DTC 43 will set.
Chart Test Description
Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first test is to determine if the system is functioning at the present time.
2. Test two determines the state of the 5 volt reference voltage applied to the knock sensor circuit.
3. Test 3 determines the state of the knock sensors and connections themselves.
Diagnostic Aids
The control module applies 5 volts to CKT 496. A 8200 ohm resistor in the knock sensors reduces
the voltage to about 2.5 volts. When knock occurs, the knock sensor produces a small AC voltage
that rides on top of the 2.5 volts already applied. An AC voltage monitor, in the control module, is
able to read this signal as knock and incrementally retard spark. If the KS system checks OK, but
detonation is the complaint, refer to "Detonation/Spark Knock". See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Detonation/ Spark
Knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4264
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Negative battery cable.
- Drain cooling system.
NOTE On knock sensors which are mounted in the end of the cylinder head draining the cooling
system will not be necessary.
- Wiring harness connector from knock sensor.
- Knock sensor.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Knock sensor. If reinstalling original sensor, apply water base caulk to sensor threads. Do NOT
use silicone tape as this will insulate sensor from engine. ^
Tighten to 19 Nm (14 lb. ft.).
- Wiring harness connector to knock sensor.
- Refill cooling system and pressure test for leaks.
- Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
........................................ N/A see NOTE following.
Spark Plug Torque ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 15 N-m (11 lb.ft.)
Spark Plug Type ..................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... AC CR43TSM
NOTE Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid line pressure.
OPERATION
The solenoid controls line pressure by controlling actuator feed limit fluid flow acting on internal
spool valve and spring pressure. The solenoid is a normally closed solenoid valve that controls fluid
pressure when operating on a duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Component Resistance Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4278
Shift Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body ..........................................................................................
................................................................................ 8 Solenoid Assembly To Pump ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 8 Solenoid Assembly To Case ....................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Electronic Component Location Views
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4281
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 1-2 and 3-4
shift valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 2-3 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page 4284
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 2-3 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 2-3 shift
valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 1-2 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page 4285
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 3-2 Control Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 3-2 shift
valve, which then controls the 2-4 band apply rate and 3-4 clutch release rate. The solenoid also
controls the 3-2 downshift feel.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a pulse width modulated solenoid that operates on a negative duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Valve Body and Wiring Harness
VALVE BODY AND WIRING HARNESS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4288
Valve Body Bolt Location
Control Valve And Pressure Switch Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4289
Manual Valve Link
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4290
Valve Body Checkballs
Case Checkballs And Filters
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Electrical connections from components. 2. TCC PWM Solenoid Retainer Clip (379) and
Solenoid (396). 3. TCC Solenoid bolts (68) and solenoid assembly (66) with O-ring seal (65) and
wiring harness. 4. Pressure switch assembly bolts (70) and pressure switch assembly (69). 5.
Accumulator cover bolts (58 and 59) and 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57). 6. 1-2
accumulator piston (56) and seal (55). 7. Spring (54). 8. Dipstick stop bracket (93).
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (64) and manual detent spring assembly (63).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4291
2. Wiring harness retaining bolts.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Remaining valve body bolts (62). 2. Manual valve link (89). 3. Control valve assembly (60). 4.
Bolts (58 and 59), accumulator cover (57), piston (56, spring (54) and spring (54A). 5. Bolts (77)
and plate (53). 6. Spacer plate (48) and spacer plate gaskets (47 and 52). 7. Spring (46), piston
(44), and pin (43).
- Seven checkballs are located under the valve body and one is located in the case. The large
copper flash colored ball is # 1A checkball (91).
Valve Body and Associated Parts
VALVE BODY AND ASSOCIATED PARTS
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate And Gaskets
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4292
Case Checkballs And Filters
TOOL REQUIRED:
- J 25025-5 Guide Pins
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined corners that are necessary for
"cleaning" the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, "micro fine" lapping
compound 900 grit or finer should be used. Too much "lapping" of a valve will cause excessive
clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. The wiring harness pass-thru connector into the case. 2. The 3-4 accumulator pin (43) into the
case. 3. The 3-4 accumulator piston seal (45) onto the 3-4 accumulator piston. 4. The 3-4
accumulator piston (44) onto the pin.
- The end with three legs must face the valve body.
5. The 3-4 accumulator piston spring (46).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkball (91) into case as shown.
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. J 25025-5 into the case. 3. Screens onto spacer plate as shown. 4. Spacer plate to case gasket
(47) and spacer plate to valve body gasket (52) onto the spacer plate (48).
- Gasket (47) identified by a "C". Gasket (52) identified by a "V".
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
5. Spacer plate and gaskets onto the case.
IMPORTANT
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the spacer plate and gaskets.
6. Spacer plate support (53) and bolts (77).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.)
Control Valve Body
CONTROL VALVE BODY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4293
Case Checkballs And Filters
Filter Screen - Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4294
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4295
Control Valve Assembly - Legend
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4296
Valve Body Checkball Locations
Valve Body Bolt Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4297
Manual Valve Link
Outside Electrical Connector
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly thoroughly in clean solvent. A. Move the valves with a pick or small
screwdriver to dislodge any dirt or debris that may have accumulated. B. Air dry.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
IMPORTANT
- Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing roll pins and retainer clips.
- Valves, springs and bushings must be laid out on a clean surface in the exact sequence they are
removed.
1. Pressure control solenoid retainer bolt (364) retainer (378) and solenoid. 2. Bore plug retainer
clip (395), bore plug (376) and valve train (374 and 375). 3. 2-3 shift solenoid retainer (379),
solenoid (367) and valve train (368 and 369). 4. 1-2 shift solenoid retainer (379), solenoid (367)
and valve train (365 and 366). 5. Accumulator valve train retainer pin (360), bore plug (373) and
valve train (370 and 371). 6. Forward accumulator cover bolts (364) and cover (363). 7. Forward
accumulator spring (356), piston (354) and pin (355). 8. Lo overrun valve spring (362) and valve
(361). 9. Retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and forward abuse valve train (357 and 358).
10. Manual valve (340). 11. 3-2 control solenoid retainer clip (379) and solenoid (394).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4298
12. Bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and 3-2 control valve train (391 - 393). 13. 3-2
downshift bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (389 - 390). 14. Reverse abuse
bore plug retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and valve train (387 - 388). 15. 3-4 shift valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (385 - 386). 16. 3-4 relay bore plug retainer
(395), bore plug (381) and valve train (382 - 384). 17. Torque converter clutch signal valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve (380).
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings and control valve body in clean solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
- All valves and bushings for: Porosity
- Scoring
- Nicks
- Scratches
- Springs for damaged or distorted coils.
- Valve body casting for: Porosity
- Cracks
- Inter connected oil passages
- Damaged machined surfaces
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly (350) exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and bushing passages.
- Position the pressure control solenoid so the connector tabs face outward.
NOTICE: TCC PWM solenoid (396) cannot be installed until TCC solenoid has been installed and
torqued to proper specifications.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkballs into the valve body assembly (350).
- Retain with Transjell TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. Valve body assembly (350).
- Connect the manual valve link (89) to the inside detent lever (88).
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the valve body assembly.
3. Wiring harness (66), manual spring assembly (63), pressure switch assembly(69), dipstick, stop
bracket (93) and all remaining valve body bolts.
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
4. TCC solenoid (66) and bolts (68).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
5. TCC PWM solenoid (396), and retainer clip (379).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Wiring harness connections to electrical components.
- To correctly hook up the wires, see the wiring diagrams.
- The pressure control solenoid (377) has two different colored connectors. The black connector
should be installed on the tab farthest from the valve body.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Parking bracket (86).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 31 Nm (23 lb. ft.).
2. The 1-2 accumulator piston seal (55) onto the 1-2 accumulator piston (56). 3. The 1-2
accumulator spring (54) and 1-2 accumulator inner spring (54A) onto the piston (56). 4. The 1-2
accumulator piston (56) into the 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57).
- The three legs on the piston must face away from the case when installed.
5. The 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57) onto the case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4299
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4300
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L80-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Wire Harness Assembly
WIRE HARNESS ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4301
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Wire harness connectors from electrical components.
NOTICE: Excessive force on the case pass through connector may damage the connector.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
2. Wire harness assembly (34) from case using a 1-5/16" 12 point socket to release the connector
retaining clips.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4302
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Rotate transmission bottom pan surface up and lock in place. 2. Wire harness assembly (34)
connectors from components.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
- Use a cap to cover electrical pin at case connection.
3. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket, and transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40).
NOTICE: Be sure five O-rings are attached to transmission fluid pressure switch assembly.
4. Twenty-one bolts (35) using 10 mm socket, from valve body assembly, manual detent spring and
roller assembly (41). 5. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid level indicator stop (43), one bolt (36) using
10 mm socket, lube pipe (39), lube pipe retainer (37) and clamp (38). 6. Control valve assembly
(44) including the accumulator housing assembly (51), valve body gaskets (45 and 48), spacer
plate (46) and accumulator
gasket (47).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4303
7. Manual valve (319) from control valve assembly (44) to prevent any damage. 8. Checkballs (54)
from case passages.
NOTICE: Do not use a magnet. It could cause checkball(s) to be magnetized causing metal
particles to stick to the ball.
9. Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid screen (75).
INSPECT
- Screen PWM solenoid (75), replace if necessary.
DISASSEMBLE
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4304
- Control valve assembly. A. Position as shown on a clean surface. B. Remove blind hole retainer
pins with a drill bit.
CAUTION: Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing the retaining pins or
personal injury could result.
C. Remove valve trains, shift solenoids (311 and 313), PCS (320), PWM solenoid (323), PCS
screen (302) and shift solenoid filter (317). D. Valves, springs, bushings and pistons must be laid
out on a clean surface.
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings, pistons, control valve body and accumulator housing in clean
solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
1. All valves, pistons and bushings for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
2. Pistons for:
- Seal damage.
3. Springs for:
- Damaged or distorted coils.
4. Valve body casting and accumulator housing for:
- Porosity.
- Cracks.
- Interconnected passages.
- Damaged machined surfaces.
5. Solenoid connectors and filter (317). 6. PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid) screen (302).
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY/ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4305
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4306
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4307
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4308
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4309
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined comers that are necessary for
cleaning the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and the bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, micro fine lapping
compound 900 grit (J 38459) or finer should be used. Too much lapping of the valve will cause
excessive clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly and accumulator housing (51) thoroughly in clean solvent.
- Air dry.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4310
Accumulator Housing Assembly
ACCUMULATOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4311
Accumulator Housing Assembly
DISASSEMBLE
1. Six bolts (53), using 8 mm socket. 2. Accumulator housing assembly. 3. Gasket accumulator
housing (47). 4. Spacer plate (46). 5. Gasket (45) valve body spacer. 6. Snap ring (402) from
outside housing, pin (408), snap ring (402), piston (407) and spring (49). 7. 3rd clutch piston (405)
and spring (50). 8. Seals (404 and 406).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4312
CLEAN
- All components.
INSPECT
- All valves, pistons, springs and seals for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4313
ASSEMBLE
- Accumulator housing assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the positions of the pistons.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and
bushing passages.
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4314
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY AND ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
TOOL REQUIRED:
- Guide Pin J 25025-5
ASSEMBLE
1. Guide pin J 25025-5 into valve body. Located at back bolt hole of detent spring and roller
assembly bolt bole. 2. Gasket (45) valve body to spacer plate. 3. Spacer plate (46). 4. Gasket (47)
accumulator housing to spacer plate. 5. Accumulator housing assembly (51) onto valve body
assembly (44).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4315
6. Six bolts (53) using (8 mm) socket through accumulator housing into valve body assembly.
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
NOTE: Start accumulator housing bolts finger tight and work towards opposite end.
TIGHTEN
- Bolt (53) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
7. Remove guide pin J 25025-5.
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4316
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4317
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Install checkballs (54) in proper location into case fluid passages. Use TRANSJEL TM J 36850
or equivalent to hold in place.
NOTICE: Do not use any type of grease to retain parts during assembly of this unit. Greases other
than the recommended assembly lube will change transmission fluid characteristics and cause
undesirable shift conditions and/or filter clogging.
- # 2 checkball is used only on RCP RDP, ZJP and ZLP models.
2. PWM solenoid screen (75).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4318
3. Gasket (48) spacer plate to case. 4. Manual valve (319) into valve body. 5. Complete valve body
assembly (44) onto case (7). Use 1 25025-5 guide pin set.
IMPORTANT
- Attach manual valve to detent lever.
6. Transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40) onto valve body assembly (44). 7. Spring and
roller assembly (41) into place. 8. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid indicator stop (43) and lube pipe
clamp (38). 9. Twenty-one bolts (35). Using 10 mm socket.
10. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket into transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40). 11.
Lube pipe (39) long end into case, short end into valve body. 12. Lube pipe retainer (37) with short
bolt (36).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (35, 36 and 76) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4319
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
13. Attach wiring harness (34) to 5 connectors.
- Put large end into case first, pressure switch hook up, 1-2 shift solenoid (purple) and 2-3 shift
solenoid (tan), PWM (Pulse Width Modulated) solenoid and PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid).
Pan and Filter Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4320
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4
Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4325
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4326
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4327
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
Inside automatic transmission attached to valve body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4328
C216 - TCC
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4329
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transmission through the torque converter. This reduces
the slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy.
For the converter clutch to apply, two hydraulic conditions must be met: Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
- The control module completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Control module control is based on the input of these sensors: Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS): Vehicle equipped with A/C will allow TCC engagement at about 35
mph when the A/C is selected "ON". Engagement will occur at a vehicle speed of about 30 mph (25
mph for 92) when A/C is selected "OFF".
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Engine at normal operating temperature (above
65°C/149°F).
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS): Output not changing, indicating a steady road speed.
- Transmission Fluid (TFT) sensor.
Control module is also controlled by these switches: Brake switch closed: 12 volts supplied when brake is depressed.
- Transmission Range (TR) pressure switch assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
The Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch (Encoder Switch) is located in the in the shift
motor on the transfer case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch > Page 4335
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 4336
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 4337
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair
ELECTRIC SHIFT MOTOR REPLACEMENT
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle and support with safety stands.
2. Transfer case shield. 3. Motor electrical connection. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Front output shaft
yoke. 6. Motor to transfer case bolts. 7. Motor from the transfer case.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Motor to the transfer case. 2. Bolts.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 18 Nm (13 lbs. ft.).
3. Front output shaft yoke. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Motor electrical connection. 6. Transfer case
shield. 7. Negative battery cable.
- Lower Vehicle
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
Instrument cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp Wiring I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4347
C274 - 4WD Indicator
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4348
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Preliminary Checks - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
1. Check condition of IGN/GAU Fuse. If fuse is Blown, locate and repair overload. Replace fuse. 2.
If fuse is not blown, proceed with the Diagnostics. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 4351
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Indicator Assembly Illumination Lamp Does Not Light
One Or More Indicator Assembly Lamps Do Not Light
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Mounted on the back of the Electronic Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4357
C202A - Transfer Case Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting
Control Module: Description and Operation Electric 4WD Shifting
Transfer Case 4WD Selector Switch
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
On vehicles equipped with the Model 233 transfer case, there is no transfer case selector lever in
the cab. The operator selects 4HI or 4LO by pushing a three-position (4HI, 4LO, 2HI) rocker-type
selector switch mounted on the instrument panel. During normal driving the transfer case is in the
2HI mode. The switch is spring-loaded to the center position. When the transfer case is in 2HI both
the 4HI and 4L0 switch circuits are open, and both lights are off. When shifting to 4HI or 4LO the
rocker switch will still return to the center position and the 4HI or 4LO light will be on. The above
image shows the wiring schematic of the transfer case selector switch.
Mode Shifts Mode shifts are shifts from:
- 2HI to 4HI
- 4HI to 2HI
A mode shift can be accomplished in any gear position and at any vehicle speed. If the system is in
2HI, the operator can shift into 4HI merely by pressing and releasing the 4HI area of the selector
rocker switch. The green 4HI status lamp flashes whenever a 2HI or 4HI shift is initiated and
continues to flash until the TCCM completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). After the shift
into 4HI is accomplished, the 4HI status lamp remains lit to indicate that the system is in 4HI. The
operator can shift from 4HI back to 2HI by again pressing 4HI on the selector switch. Again, the
green 4HI status lamp flashes until the shift to 2HI is complete, and then extinguishes once the shift
is complete. Both the 4HI and 4LO lamps remain oft when the vehicle is in 2HI.
Range Shifts Range shifts are shifts between the HI and LO ranges, from:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4360
- 2HI to 4LO
- 4HI to 4LO
- 4LO to 4HI
A range shift from 4L0 directly to 2HI cannot be made. The operator must first make range shift
from 4LO to 4HI, then a mode shift from 4HI to 2HI. A range shift can only be made with the
automatic transmission in neutral or with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed. The
vehicle speed must also be below three miles per hour before the shift can occur. Whenever a shift
into 4LO is initiated, the amber 4LO status lamp flashes and continues to flash until the TCCM
completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). The 4LO status lamp must glow steadily before
the vehicle transmission is shifted into gear or before the clutch pedal is released. If a range shift is
initiated when the transmission is engaged or when the vehicle speed is above 3 mph, the 4LO
status lamp flashes for 30 seconds and no range shift actually occurs; the system returns to the
position before the shift was initiated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4361
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Power and Ground
Fig. 1, Memory Power, System Power, And Ground Circuit
Fig. 2, Fuse Block And Cavity Location
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4362
POWER, CIRCUIT PROTECTION, AND GROUND
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) memory power, system power, and the ground circuit
are shown in Figure 1. The vehicle fuse block and cavity location for memory power, system power,
and motor power are shown in Figure 2.
Memory Power Trouble code memory power is protected by a 5-amp TCCM fuse. Memory power
is supplied to TCCM connector pin C6 through circuit 140.
System Power Operating power is controlled by the ignition switch and is protected by a 15-amp
radio fuse. System power is supplied to TCCM connector pin C8 through circuit 141. This fuse also
supplies, voltage to pin B of the transfer case switch. The system power will shut down if either the
5-amp TCCM fuse or the 15-amp radio fuse are removed or blown.
System Ground System ground is supplied to TCCM connector pin C10 through circuit 150. Circuit
150 is connected to the bus bar ground located on the left side of the steering column support.
Refer to Figure 1.
Turn/BU Fuse A 15-amp TURN/BU fuse supplies ignition voltage to the park/neutral position
switch. This voltage enables the park switch to send a park signal to TCCM connector pin D2.
Power Accessory Circuit Breaker The 30-amp power accessory circuit breaker supplies ignition
voltage to TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This voltage is used to control the electric-shift
motor circuit.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4363
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Inputs and Outputs
General Description
INPUTS
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) receives input signals from the following sources:
- Transfer case selector switch on the instrument panel.
- Park/neutral position switch on vehicles with automatic transmissions.
- Clutch safety switch on vehicles with manual transmissions.
- Vehicle speed sensor buffer which supplies vehicle speed signals.
- Encoder switch within the electric-shift motor which provides actual mode and range information
signals.
- Data link connector (DLC) pin J which provides diagnostic enable.
OUTPUTS
After processing the input information, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) outputs signals
to the following:
- Electric shift motor to effect mode and range shifts.
- Selector switch status lamps to provide transfer case status information.
- Diagnostic trouble codes (DTC) which are output via the selector switch status lamps.
2HI to 4HI Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the transfer case is in 2HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the
4HI contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564, and furnishing 12-volts
to pin C5 of the TCCM connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5 commands the Transfer Case
Control Module (TCCM) to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. The contacts return to the
open position as soon as the switch is released.
4HI to 2HI Selector Switch Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4364
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
If the transfer case is in 4HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the 4HI
contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564 and furnishing 12-volts to
pin C5 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5
commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. Again, the contacts return to
the open position as soon as the switch is released.
2HI to 4HI to 4LO Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the operator presses the 4LO area of the rocker switch while the transfer case is in either
2HI or 4HI, the 4LO contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1559, and
furnishing 12-volts to pin C3 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt
signal at pin C3 commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift the transfer case into
4LO. Once more, the contacts return to the open position as soon as the switch is released.
Park/Neutral Position Switch Inputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4365
Automatic Transmission Neutral Start Switch
Neutral Start Switch Voltages
OPERATION
Because range shift should only be made with the automatic transmission in neutral, the
park/neutral position switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle
automatic transmission is in either:
- Park
- Neutral
- One of the drive positions
The park/neutral position switch consists of three switches together in one unit, and it provides
three signals:
- Park - When the automatic transmission is in park, the contacts of both the park switch and the
park neutral switch are closed. When these contacts are closed, a battery voltage signal is sent to
TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 voltage). The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in park.
- Neutral - When the automatic transmission is in neutral, the contacts of the park switch are open
and the contacts of the park neutral position switch are closed. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal
is sent to TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 volts). The
TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in neutral.
- In gear - When the automatic transmission is in any other gear position, the contacts of both the
park switch and park neutral switch are open. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal is sent to TCCM
connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is neither
park or neutral.
Important
- If the backup switch connector were to be plugged in upside down, the park switch would receive
no power. Such a condition would cause a 0-voltage signal at both pin D2 and pin D16 in neutral
and in park. The transfer case, accordingly, would perform a range shift in park as well as in
neutral.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4366
- An open in circuit 75, or an open in the Turn/BU fuse would also cause this condition.
- Additionally, a park/neutral position switch that is out of adjustment may prevent a range shift in
park.
Clutch Safety Switch Inputs
Clutch Safety Switch Schematic
Clutch Safety Switch Voltage Signals
OPERATION
Because range shifts should only be made with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed, the
clutch safety switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle clutch
pedal is fully depressed or released. The clutch safety switch is connected to TCCM connector pin
D16. When the clutch pedal is released, the contacts of the clutch safety switch are open. When
these contacts are open, a battery voltage signal is seen at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the clutch is released. When the clutch is fully depressed, the
contacts of the clutch safety switch are closed. When the contacts are closed, voltage is pulled low
to 0 at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the clutch pedal is fully
depressed. Because TCCM connector pin D2 is not connected when the vehicle is equipped with a
manual transmission, the TCCM reads a 0-volt signal at pin D2 at all times. All readings are taken
while back-probing the TCCM pins with the ignition in the "Run" position. A reading of less than 0.5
volt is considered to be zero.
Vehicle Speed Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4367
Vehicle Sensor Buffer And TCCM Schematic
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor buffer informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) about the
speed of the vehicle in miles per hour. Such information is essential to inform the TCCM to prohibit
range shifts at speeds above 3 mph. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) is a variable-reluctance
magnetic sensing device that converts tone wheel rotation into a frequency and voltage output
proportional to the vehicle speed. The frequency and voltage signal is sent to the vehicle speed
sensor buffer which converts the speed sensor output into a useful pulse signal. The vehicle speed
sensor buffer then, pulses circuit 1567 to ground at a rate of 4000 pulses per mile. Whenever the
vehicle speed sensor buffer grounds circuit 1567, the voltage at TCCM connector pin D8 returns to
5 volts. The TCCM reads the 4000 pulses-per-mile (1.11 Hz per mph) signal to determine vehicle
speed.
Encoder Switch Inputs
Fig 1, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Layout
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4368
Fig 2, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Schematic
Fig 3, Encoder Switch Channel Signals And Positions
OPERATION
The four-channel encoder switch indicates the current transfer case mode and range to the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM). The encoder switch is located inside the encoder itself and
is not serviceable. The TCCM reads the status of the four channels to determine the range and
mode in which the transfer case is operating or whether the transfer case is shifting between
modes and/or ranges. The encoder assembly is composed of an inner ground ring in contact with a
three-leg wiper arm. The three legs of the wiper, spaced 120 degrees apart, make contact with the
conductive areas of the four channels. When any leg of the wiper arm is in contact with the
conductive area of any channel, a path to ground is provided to the inner ground ring. A schematic
of the encoder switch is shown in Figure 2. The channel signals in various transfer case operating
modes and ranges are shown in Figure 3. Any combination of signals not listed in Figure 3 are
considered invalid by the TCCM.
Encoder Switch Channel Positions These voltage readings can be obtained by back-probing either
the TCCM connector pins or the transfer case connector pins. For TCCM pin numbers and encoder
channels, refer to Figure 2.
Diagnostic Enable Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4369
Wiring Schematic For Enabling The Status Lamps
OPERATION
When pin J of the Data Link Connector (DLC) is connected either to pin A of the DLC or to a good
ground while the ignition is on, the diagnostics routine of the Transfer Case Control Module
(TCCM) is activated. When the diagnostics routine is activated, the transfer case selector switch
4HI and 4LO status lamps flash the diagnostic codes.
Electric Shift Motor Outputs
Electric Shift Motor Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) provides the output for the electric shift motor as the
schematic shows.
- Motor control is achieved by energizing one of the two motor control relays located in the TCCM,
by way of the transfer case selector switch.
The TCCM operates the motor in one direction by energizing one relay while the second relay is
de-energized. The TCCM operates the motor in the reverse direction by energizing the second
relay while the first relay is de-energized.
- Motor power to actuate the motor drive relays is input at TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This
power is supplied by the ignition through the 30-amp power circuit breaker.
- Motor ground is input at TCCM connector pins D12 and D13 to provide the return line for the
motor drive relays.
4HI and 4LO Status Lamps Outputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 4370
Selector Switch Status Lamp Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) controls the operation of the 4HI and 4LO status lamps
in the transfer case selector switch. The status lamps also show the transfer case mode and range
of operation. The status lamps also provide a self-test when the ignition is first turned on.
Additionally, the status lamps are used to alert the driver that there is a problem somewhere in the
four-wheel drive system, and also to flash diagnostic trouble codes (DTC's).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4371
Control Module: Service and Repair
TRANSFER CASE MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. ECM (utility only). 3. Cowl side panel (pickup only). 4. Electrical
connection. 5. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 6. Module.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Module. 2. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 3. Electrical connection. 4. ECM (utility
only). 5. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch > Page 4378
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4379
C217 - Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Plugs (1/8 - 27) .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Pressure Plugs (1/4 - 18) ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 18 Pressure Switches ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs. Vehicle Speed Sensor Retainer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
The Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor is used by the control module to control: Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) apply and release schedule.
- Hot mode determination.
- Shift quality.
OPERATION
The TFT is a thermistor used to indicate transmission fluid temperature. The control module sends
a 5.0 volt signal to the TFT through a resistor in the computer and measures the voltage. High
sensor resistance produces high signal input voltage which corresponds to low fluid temperature.
Low sensor resistance produces low signal input voltage which corresponds to high fluid
temperature. With the TFT varying its resistance, the control module can sense transmission fluid
temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION
The sensor is part of the transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly and is attached to the
control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Pickup
Transfer Case Select Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Pickup > Page 4397
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4398
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 4 Selector Switch Installation. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove console, then disconnect console wiring harness.
3. Remove shifter boot retaining screws and slide boot up shift lever.
4. Remove switch attaching screw, then the switch and harness, Fig. 2.
5. Position new switch on mounting bracket and install attaching screw.Ensure shift lever assembly
pawl is on the switch contact carrier.
6. Route wiring as shown in Fig. 4.
7. Place shifter boot in proper position, then install retaining screws.
8. Connect console wiring harness, then install console.
9. Connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 4403
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 4404
4WD Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn.
Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor
Conn.
Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001
Date: May 17, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed
Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab
9-7X
with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive
Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is
removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer
case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the
plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past,
the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair
procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This
connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time.
A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This
new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly
Technical Service Bulletin # 99046 Date: 991201
Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly
File in Section: Special Prices
Bulletin No.: 99046
Date: December, 1999
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99046 - SPECIAL POLICY - HIGH/LOW/HIGH ABS BRAKE ANOMALY
MODELS: 1993-1996 CHEVROLET, GMC, AND OLDSMOBILE S/T UTILITY 1994-1996
CHEVROLET AND GMC S/T PICKUP EQUIPPED WITH A V6 ENGINE 1993-1995 CHEVROLET
AND GMC M/L VAN 1993-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC G VAN
THIS SPECIAL POLICY IS IN EFFECT UNTIL DECEMBER 1, 2002
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS SPECIAL POLICY WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. THIS FIRST PHASE WILL BE THE REPROGRAMMING OF THE VCM IN 2WD AND
4WD 1994-1996 S/T PICKUPS AND 1995-1996 S/T UTILITIES EQUIPPED WITH A VCM.
VEHICLES INVOLVED IN PHASE 1 ARE SHADED IN THE TABLE.
YOU WILL BE NOTIFIED OF THE NEXT PHASE VIA DCS MESSAGE.
Condition
The federal government's highway safety agency, the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) has identified, and General Motors Corporation has confirmed, the
existence of a condition in the antilock braking system of some Chevrolet, GMC, and Oldsmobile
S/T utilities. 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC S/T pickups equipped with a V6 engine, 1993-1995
Chevrolet and GMC M/L vans, and 1993-1996 Chevrolet and GMC G vans, all equipped with the
Lucas Varity three-sensor ABS system. On rare occasions, this condition can result in longer
stopping distances during certain antilock brake applications, as explained below.
If the customer is driving on a road surface that supports good traction and they begin to stop by
applying the brake pedal firmly, and both front wheels of their vehicle then pass onto a slippery
surface (such as an ice-covered or wet patched asphalt part of the road), the antilock brake system
will adjust the brakes at each of the wheels to take advantage of the available traction. This will
allow the customer to steer and maintain stability, which is normal ABS operation1 as their owner's
manual explains in more detail.
However, if the customer is still braking while the vehicle leaves the slippery surface and both front
wheels get back on a higher-traction surface, the ABS may perform as if the vehicle were still on
the slippery surface and the vehicle may not stop as quickly. However, this will not happen every
time these conditions are encountered. It depends on several additional factors, such as vehicle
speed and the length of the slippery surface.
The ABS system was designed with increased sensitivity to wheel slip in order to improve vehicle
steerability while braking on very slippery surfaces. This improvement for steerability, however,
made it possible for reduced front braking effectiveness to occur as described above.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT (Phase I)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly >
Page 4417
This special policy adjustment covers the condition described above- until December 1, 2002,
regardless of vehicle mileage or ownership. Dealers are to reprogram the VCM. Use the following
Service Procedure. This will be performed at no charge to the customer during this time. Other
conditions that may cause similar or different brake complaints that are not a result of the condition
listed above are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be informed that any
further service that is not covered by this special policy would be their responsibility, if they elect to
have the service performed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly >
Page 4418
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are 1993-1998 S/T utilities, 1994-1996 S/T pickups equipped with a V6 engine, 1993-1995
M/L van, and 1993-1996 G vans built within the VIN breakpoints.
PARTS INFORMATION
This phase requires no parts. Calibrations are available in October, 1999 on TIS 2000 CD, # 21 or
Techline CD # 20/21 or later versions.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles, in phases, by General Motors (see
copy of typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
VCM Programming
Important:
For 1995 S/T utilities with L35, check the Service Parts Identification (SPID) label on the inside of
the glovebox to determine if the vehicle has a VCM. If there is an RPO of "K29", the vehicle has a
PCM and is programmable.
The new calibration,will be available in October, 1999 on TIS 2000 CD # 21 or Techline CD # 20/21
and later versions. The calibration is programmed into the vehicle's VCM via a Techline TOOL. Use
a Techline Terminal or scan tool to perform the learn procedure and program the VCM.
Important:
Use the calibration file "Special Policy 99046" on TIS 2000 CD # 21 or Techline CD # 20/21 or later
versions.
1. To ensure VCM programming/RPO configuration, confirm that the following conditions exist in
order to prepare for VCM programming:
^ The battery is fully charged
^ The ignition switch is in the "RUN" position
^ The Data Link Connector (DLC) is accessible
2. Refer to the latest Techline Terminal and equipment user's instructions.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after the programming is complete.
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty submit a claim with the information indicated.
Owner Letter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly >
Page 4419
December, 1999
Dear Chevrolet/GMC Customer:
As the owner of a General Motors truck equipped with the Lucas Varity three-sensor antilock brake
system (ABS), your satisfaction with our product is of utmost concern to us.
Condition: The federal government's highway safety agency. the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) has identifled1 and General Motors Corporation has confirmed the
existence of a condition in the antilock braking system of some Chevrolet and GMC 1994-1996 S/T
pickups equipped with a V6 engine and 1995-1996 S/T utility vehicles. On rare occasions, this
condition can result in longer stopping distances during certain antilock brake applications, as
explained below.
If you're driving on a road surface that supports good traction and you begin to stop by applying
your brake pedal firmly, and both front wheels of your vehicle then pass, onto a slippery surface
(such as an ice-covered or wet patched asphalt part of the road), your antilock brake system will
adjust the brakes at each of the wheels to take advantage of the available traction. This will allow
you to steer and maintain stability, which is normal ABS operation, as your owner's manual
explains in more detail.
However, if you are still braking while the vehicle leaves the slippery surface and both front wheels
get back on a higher-traction surface, the ABS may perform as if the vehicle were still on the
slippery surface and the vehicle may not stop as quickly. However, this will not happen every time
these conditions are encountered. It depends on several additional factors, such as vehicle speed
and the length of the slippery surface.
Your ABS system was designed with increased sensitivity to wheel slip in order to improve vehicle
steerability while braking on very slippery surfaces. This improvement for steerability, however,
made it possible for reduced front braking effectiveness to occur as described above. Therefore,
GM has developed a software change that will make your vehicle less Sensitive to wheel slip under
the circumstances described above.
What Will Be Done: Upon your request, your Chevrolet/GMC dealer will make a change to your
antilock braking system software to prevent this phenomenon from occurring. This software change
will have only a slight effect on vehicle steerablity during braking on very slippery surfaces and is
designed to have no effect on normal ABS or other braking operations. This change should not
affect how your brakes feel or create any perceptible difference in the steerability or stability of your
vehicle while braking. This modification will be performed for you at no charge at anytime until
December 1, 2002.
How Long Will The Repair Take: Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer will modify your vehicle's ABS
software. We estimate that it will take your dealer 45 minutes to perform this modification.
Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If your dealer has a large
number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant. Please ask your dealer
if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed.
Contacting Your Dealer: Repairs and adjustments qualifying under this special coverage must be
performed by a Chevrolet/GMC dealer. You may want to call the service department to arrange a
convenient appointment. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service date within a
reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number
listed below:
Deaf, Hearing Impaired
Division Number or Speech Impaired*
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583
* Utilizes Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf/Text Telephones (TDD/TTY)
1-800-462-8782. The deaf, hearing impaired, or speech impaired should call 1-800-462-8583
(utilizes Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf/Text Telephones, TDD/TTY).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4425
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4426
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4427
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4428
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4429
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4430
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil
Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4431
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 476522 > Jan > 95 > Engine - Backfire Upon Acceleration
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine - Backfire Upon
Acceleration
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 47-65-22
Date: January, 1995
Subject: Backfire on Acceleration (Correct Calibration)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO LB4) and
Manual Transmission (RPO MY2)
Condition
Some owners may experience a backfire condition upon acceleration.
Cause
Insufficient ignition timing advance in the spark calibration under some driving conditions.
Correction
More robust calibrations have been released to address this concern. THIS CALIBRATION WILL
NOT CORRECT ANY OTHER DRIVEABILITY CONCERN.
Important:
These service calibrations should ONLY be used if a backfire concern still exists in a vehicle
WHICH HAS HAD THE BASE TIMING CHECKED AND SET TO SPECIFICATION.
LAUNCH DETONATION MAY OCCUR IN VEHICLES SERVICED WITH THESE CALIBRATIONS;
particularly in vehicles which are heavily loaded or towing trailers.
Parts Information
Service "FLASH" calibrations are available starting with the December, 1994 CD ROM.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly
Technical Service Bulletin # 99046 Date: 991201
Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly
File in Section: Special Prices
Bulletin No.: 99046
Date: December, 1999
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99046 - SPECIAL POLICY - HIGH/LOW/HIGH ABS BRAKE ANOMALY
MODELS: 1993-1996 CHEVROLET, GMC, AND OLDSMOBILE S/T UTILITY 1994-1996
CHEVROLET AND GMC S/T PICKUP EQUIPPED WITH A V6 ENGINE 1993-1995 CHEVROLET
AND GMC M/L VAN 1993-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC G VAN
THIS SPECIAL POLICY IS IN EFFECT UNTIL DECEMBER 1, 2002
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS SPECIAL POLICY WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. THIS FIRST PHASE WILL BE THE REPROGRAMMING OF THE VCM IN 2WD AND
4WD 1994-1996 S/T PICKUPS AND 1995-1996 S/T UTILITIES EQUIPPED WITH A VCM.
VEHICLES INVOLVED IN PHASE 1 ARE SHADED IN THE TABLE.
YOU WILL BE NOTIFIED OF THE NEXT PHASE VIA DCS MESSAGE.
Condition
The federal government's highway safety agency, the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) has identified, and General Motors Corporation has confirmed, the
existence of a condition in the antilock braking system of some Chevrolet, GMC, and Oldsmobile
S/T utilities. 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC S/T pickups equipped with a V6 engine, 1993-1995
Chevrolet and GMC M/L vans, and 1993-1996 Chevrolet and GMC G vans, all equipped with the
Lucas Varity three-sensor ABS system. On rare occasions, this condition can result in longer
stopping distances during certain antilock brake applications, as explained below.
If the customer is driving on a road surface that supports good traction and they begin to stop by
applying the brake pedal firmly, and both front wheels of their vehicle then pass onto a slippery
surface (such as an ice-covered or wet patched asphalt part of the road), the antilock brake system
will adjust the brakes at each of the wheels to take advantage of the available traction. This will
allow the customer to steer and maintain stability, which is normal ABS operation1 as their owner's
manual explains in more detail.
However, if the customer is still braking while the vehicle leaves the slippery surface and both front
wheels get back on a higher-traction surface, the ABS may perform as if the vehicle were still on
the slippery surface and the vehicle may not stop as quickly. However, this will not happen every
time these conditions are encountered. It depends on several additional factors, such as vehicle
speed and the length of the slippery surface.
The ABS system was designed with increased sensitivity to wheel slip in order to improve vehicle
steerability while braking on very slippery surfaces. This improvement for steerability, however,
made it possible for reduced front braking effectiveness to occur as described above.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT (Phase I)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly > Page 4441
This special policy adjustment covers the condition described above- until December 1, 2002,
regardless of vehicle mileage or ownership. Dealers are to reprogram the VCM. Use the following
Service Procedure. This will be performed at no charge to the customer during this time. Other
conditions that may cause similar or different brake complaints that are not a result of the condition
listed above are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be informed that any
further service that is not covered by this special policy would be their responsibility, if they elect to
have the service performed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly > Page 4442
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are 1993-1998 S/T utilities, 1994-1996 S/T pickups equipped with a V6 engine, 1993-1995
M/L van, and 1993-1996 G vans built within the VIN breakpoints.
PARTS INFORMATION
This phase requires no parts. Calibrations are available in October, 1999 on TIS 2000 CD, # 21 or
Techline CD # 20/21 or later versions.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles, in phases, by General Motors (see
copy of typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
VCM Programming
Important:
For 1995 S/T utilities with L35, check the Service Parts Identification (SPID) label on the inside of
the glovebox to determine if the vehicle has a VCM. If there is an RPO of "K29", the vehicle has a
PCM and is programmable.
The new calibration,will be available in October, 1999 on TIS 2000 CD # 21 or Techline CD # 20/21
and later versions. The calibration is programmed into the vehicle's VCM via a Techline TOOL. Use
a Techline Terminal or scan tool to perform the learn procedure and program the VCM.
Important:
Use the calibration file "Special Policy 99046" on TIS 2000 CD # 21 or Techline CD # 20/21 or later
versions.
1. To ensure VCM programming/RPO configuration, confirm that the following conditions exist in
order to prepare for VCM programming:
^ The battery is fully charged
^ The ignition switch is in the "RUN" position
^ The Data Link Connector (DLC) is accessible
2. Refer to the latest Techline Terminal and equipment user's instructions.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after the programming is complete.
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty submit a claim with the information indicated.
Owner Letter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly > Page 4443
December, 1999
Dear Chevrolet/GMC Customer:
As the owner of a General Motors truck equipped with the Lucas Varity three-sensor antilock brake
system (ABS), your satisfaction with our product is of utmost concern to us.
Condition: The federal government's highway safety agency. the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) has identifled1 and General Motors Corporation has confirmed the
existence of a condition in the antilock braking system of some Chevrolet and GMC 1994-1996 S/T
pickups equipped with a V6 engine and 1995-1996 S/T utility vehicles. On rare occasions, this
condition can result in longer stopping distances during certain antilock brake applications, as
explained below.
If you're driving on a road surface that supports good traction and you begin to stop by applying
your brake pedal firmly, and both front wheels of your vehicle then pass, onto a slippery surface
(such as an ice-covered or wet patched asphalt part of the road), your antilock brake system will
adjust the brakes at each of the wheels to take advantage of the available traction. This will allow
you to steer and maintain stability, which is normal ABS operation, as your owner's manual
explains in more detail.
However, if you are still braking while the vehicle leaves the slippery surface and both front wheels
get back on a higher-traction surface, the ABS may perform as if the vehicle were still on the
slippery surface and the vehicle may not stop as quickly. However, this will not happen every time
these conditions are encountered. It depends on several additional factors, such as vehicle speed
and the length of the slippery surface.
Your ABS system was designed with increased sensitivity to wheel slip in order to improve vehicle
steerability while braking on very slippery surfaces. This improvement for steerability, however,
made it possible for reduced front braking effectiveness to occur as described above. Therefore,
GM has developed a software change that will make your vehicle less Sensitive to wheel slip under
the circumstances described above.
What Will Be Done: Upon your request, your Chevrolet/GMC dealer will make a change to your
antilock braking system software to prevent this phenomenon from occurring. This software change
will have only a slight effect on vehicle steerablity during braking on very slippery surfaces and is
designed to have no effect on normal ABS or other braking operations. This change should not
affect how your brakes feel or create any perceptible difference in the steerability or stability of your
vehicle while braking. This modification will be performed for you at no charge at anytime until
December 1, 2002.
How Long Will The Repair Take: Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer will modify your vehicle's ABS
software. We estimate that it will take your dealer 45 minutes to perform this modification.
Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If your dealer has a large
number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant. Please ask your dealer
if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed.
Contacting Your Dealer: Repairs and adjustments qualifying under this special coverage must be
performed by a Chevrolet/GMC dealer. You may want to call the service department to arrange a
convenient appointment. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service date within a
reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number
listed below:
Deaf, Hearing Impaired
Division Number or Speech Impaired*
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583
* Utilizes Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf/Text Telephones (TDD/TTY)
1-800-462-8782. The deaf, hearing impaired, or speech impaired should call 1-800-462-8583
(utilizes Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf/Text Telephones, TDD/TTY).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99-06-04-053 > Nov > 99 > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Powertrain
Control Module Reprogramming
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 99-06-04-053
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reprogramming (Do Not Reprogram Using the Same
Download Files as Those Already Present in The Control Module)
Models: 1990-2000 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Reprogrammable PCM
It is strongly recommended to NOT reinstall the same software and/or calibration download file(s)
into the powertrain control module as those that are already present in the PCM. There is no
technical reason that the download files inside the PCM would ever become corrupted after the
control module had previously been successfully programmed. A P0601 (Control Module Read
Only Memory) Diagnostic Trouble Code would set in memory and the MIL would be illuminated if
the controller memory became corrupted.
The Techline Information System 2000 (TIS 2000) PC, combined with vehicle information gained
through the Tech 2, can determine when an attempt to reprogram a PCM using the same download
files (as those already in the control module) is being requested. If this is attempted, the TIS 2000
PC currently displays the following message:
Notice:
THE CALIBRATION SELECTED IS THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IN THE CONTROL MODULE.
PROGRAMMING WITH THE SAME DOWNLOAD FILES IS NOT AN EFFECTIVE REPAIR.
SELECT ( YES ) TO CONTINUE PROGRAMMING THE CONTROL MODULE,OR ( NO ) TO
CANCEL.
Effective in the first quarter of 2000, the TIS 2000 PC will indicate:
Important:
THE CALIBRATION SELECTED IS ALREADY THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IN THE CONTROL
MODULE. REPROGRAMMING WITH THE SAME DOWNLOAD FILE IS NOT ALLOWED.
Certain learned values, such as: (but not limited to)
^ fuel trim (previously known as block learn memory),
^ IAC learned position in various park/neutral and air conditioning on/off combinations,
^ certain OBDII diagnostic thresholds,
^ automatic transmission shift adapts
will revert back to their unlearned starting point values after a reprogramming event occurs.
It is feasible that the engine or transmission might temporarily operate differently after a
reprogramming event, until these values are re-learned. Relearning occurs while operating the
vehicle through normal driving routines. If the same download files are simply reinstalled, any
changes noticed in engine operation will likely disappear in a short amount of time and/or driving
distance.
Reprogramming the control module with the same download files that already exist in the module
will only accomplish a warranty claim for a non-effective repair, and a likely comeback.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Reprogram
Using Off Board Program Adapter
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 73-65-13
Date: March, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Reprogramming Capability using the Off Board Programming Adapter
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4452
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4453
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4454
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4455
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4456
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4457
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4458
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins SPS/FLASH EPROM Programming
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 53-65-08
Date: January, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: SPS/FLASH EPROM Programming
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles
This bulletin is being issued to assist technicians in reprogramming vehicles and should be used in
conjunction with instructions provided on your Techline Terminal and in your Techline Terminal
User's Manual.
THE TECHLINE TERMINAL (T-20, T-50, T-60) HAS BEEN ABLE TO DO 1996 VEHICLE
PROGRAMMING THROUGH THE DIRECT METHOD SINCE 1996 VEHICLES HAVE BEEN
AVAILABLE IN THE DEALERSHIPS/RETAIL FACILITIES. THE TECHLINE CD-ROM TITLED
DISC 13 CONTAINS THE SOFTWARE NEEDED TO PROGRAM ALL 1996 VEHICLES WITH A
TECH 1 (REMOTE PROGRAMMING METHOD).
SPS Tips
1. BATTERY VOLTAGE SHOULD BE CHECKED. A FULLY CHARGED BATTERY IS
NECESSARY BEFORE REPROGRAMMING TAKES PLACE. THE VEHICLE BATTERY SHOULD
NOT BE CONNECTED TO A BATTERY CHARGER DURING A PROGRAMMING EVENT
INCORRECT VOLTAGE COULD CAUSE PROGRAMMING AND/OR CONTROL MODULE
FAILURE. During programming, the control module depends on the battery as its sole source of
power. Also during programming, the vehicle's components (i.e. blower motor) are set to a default
mode which may be turned on, placing additional draw on the vehicle's battery. If the voltage goes
outside the specified range (11 to 14 volts) the controllers and the Techline equipment will stop
communicating. If this happens, it could cause the control module to become inoperable and
require replacement.
2. CHECK THE INTEGRITY OF THE TECH 1 CABLES, MAKE SURE THEY ARE NOT FRAYED,
BROKEN OR TWISTED. Loss of communication for any reason will require additional time in
completing the reprogramming event.
3. IF USING A TECH 1, YOUR MASS STORAGE CARTRIDGE (MSC) MUST BE UPDATED TO
REFLECT THE MOST CURRENT UPDATE OFFERED ON THE TECHLINE CD-ROM. DISC 13,
1995 WAS THE FIRST CD-ROM THAT HAD REMOTE PROGRAMMING SUPPORT If your MSC
is not updated to reflect the current software version on the Techline Terminal, in some situations
the software will not be capable of interpreting the information that is requested from the vehicle.
4. T-100 TERMINALS (CAMS) ARE NOT CAPABLE OF PROGRAMMING OBD II VEHICLES
THROUGH THE DIRECT METHOD. A TECH 1 MUST BE USED (REMOTE METHOD) WHEN
REPROGRAMMING WITH A T-100. The T-100 terminals communicate with vehicles through a
DLC (ALDL) card and cable found within the T-100's computer. The DLC (ALDL) card is not
capable of communicating at the new baud rate used with OBD II.
5. PROGRAMMING IS NOT NEEDED IF THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IS THE SAME AS THE
SELECTED CALIBRATION.
6. IF PROGRAMMING A NEW CONTROL MODULE, YOU MUST REQUEST INFORMATION
FROM THE NEW CONTROL MODULE. The security information that is needed for a control
module to be programmed is stored in the new control module. The security information must be
requested from the control module to be programmed. At that point, the control module can be
successfully programmed. This requesting of security information takes place in both the direct and
remote methods. The request is automatic when using the direct method. Looking at the calibration
stored in the old controller may be helpful in selecting the calibration from the CD-ROM for the new
controller.
7. WHEN PROGRAMMING OBD II VEHICLES WITH A TECH 1 (REMOTE PROGRAMMING
METHOD), A VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE (VIM) IS REQUIRED. The VIM allows the Tech 1
to communicate with the OBD II vehicles. The VIM is necessary for all other Tech 1 diagnostics on
OBD II vehicles. VIMs are no longer on backorder. If you are interested in obtaining additional
VIMs, call 1-800-GM-TOOLS and ask for VIM kit part number 7000041.
8. DISCONNECT THE TECH I AND VIM FROM THE VEHICLE BETWEEN RETRIEVING DATA
AND PROGRAMMING THE VEHICLE. If the VIM remains powered up after data is requested, a
communication problem may result when the reprogramming function is performed.
9. WHEN CONNECTING THE TECH 1 TO A TECHLINE TERMINAL (EXCEPT T-100 CAMS),
ALWAYS CONNECT THE FLAT GRAY R5232 CABLE FIRST AND THEN THE POWER
ADAPTER. FAILURE TO DO SO COULD RESULT IN A LOSS OF INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4463
STORED ON THE TECH 1. When power is turned on to the Tech 1, it looks for the RS232
connection. If it does not see the connection, the Tech 1 in some cases, will erase the information
stored for download.
10. DO NOT DISCONTINUE OR INTERRUPT THE PROGRAM LOADING PROCESS TO THE
VEHICLE. This will result in a programming error and could prevent the Electronic Control Module
(ECM) from functioning properly.
11. AFTER PROGRAMMING IS COMPLETE, PRESS "EXIT". MAKE SURE THE KEY IS CYCLED
OFF FOR APPROXIMATELY 10 SECONDS THEN BACK ON. Some vehicles will lose component
settings (PMC/IAC Valve). Cycling the key off two times (Off for 30 seconds, On for 10 then repeat
a second time) will allow for resetting of the components. Start the vehicle to ensure programming
was successful.
FOR CADILLAC VEHICLES ONLY a. DUE TO OTHER MODULES ON THE DATA LINE TRYING TO COMMUNICATE WITH THE
ECM DURING PROGRAMMING, SOME COMMUNICATION CODES MAY BE SET After
programming is complete, clear any codes and verify they do not reset.
b. TO HELP MINIMIZE BATTERY DRAW DURING ECM PROGRAMMING, DISCONNECT THE
BLOWER MOTOR (AT THE CONNECTOR, NOT THE FUSE) PRIOR TO PROGRAMMING. When
programming is complete, reconnect the blower motor.
12. 1997 VEHICLES REQUIRE REPROGRAMMING BE DONE USING A TECH 2. OBD II vehicle
calibration size and complexity will require more memory than the Tech 1 has available. Tech 2 will
be an essential tool in the first quarter of 1996 containing limited 1996 applications and updates.
13. STG HAS ISSUED BULLETINS (# 53-65-04 and # 53-65-05 - (SEE CHART EXCERPTED
FROM 53-65-05 FOR USE AS A QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE), DEVELOPED QUICK
REFERENCE GUIDES (P/N SPSCARD-1 AVAILABLE THROUGH YOUR LOCAL GM TRAINING
CENTER), PRODUCED CPT VIDEOS (CPT # 56010.00-B), HAD PULSAT BROADCASTS, AND
OFFERS GM TRAINING CENTER CLASSROOM COURSES. As you work through
reprogramming, keep the above-mentioned material in mind as resources to assist you if difficulty
is encountered. As always, the Techline Customer Support Center (1-800-828-6860 English,
1-800-503-3222 French) is always available to assist the technician with any situation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4464
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4465
SPS/EEPROM Programming
1993 to current Reprogrammable Vehicles
Note: If programming a new control module you must request info from the new control module
first. Battery voltage should be checked and at full charge before reprogramming takes place.
System to be programmed should NOT be connected to a battery charger. Incorrect voltage could
cause programming and/or control module failure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4470
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4471
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4472
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4473
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4474
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4475
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4476
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
476522 > Jan > 95 > Engine - Backfire Upon Acceleration
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Backfire Upon
Acceleration
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 47-65-22
Date: January, 1995
Subject: Backfire on Acceleration (Correct Calibration)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO LB4) and
Manual Transmission (RPO MY2)
Condition
Some owners may experience a backfire condition upon acceleration.
Cause
Insufficient ignition timing advance in the spark calibration under some driving conditions.
Correction
More robust calibrations have been released to address this concern. THIS CALIBRATION WILL
NOT CORRECT ANY OTHER DRIVEABILITY CONCERN.
Important:
These service calibrations should ONLY be used if a backfire concern still exists in a vehicle
WHICH HAS HAD THE BASE TIMING CHECKED AND SET TO SPECIFICATION.
LAUNCH DETONATION MAY OCCUR IN VEHICLES SERVICED WITH THESE CALIBRATIONS;
particularly in vehicles which are heavily loaded or towing trailers.
Parts Information
Service "FLASH" calibrations are available starting with the December, 1994 CD ROM.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99-06-04-053 > Nov > 99 > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Powertrain
Control Module Reprogramming
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 99-06-04-053
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reprogramming (Do Not Reprogram Using the Same
Download Files as Those Already Present in The Control Module)
Models: 1990-2000 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Reprogrammable PCM
It is strongly recommended to NOT reinstall the same software and/or calibration download file(s)
into the powertrain control module as those that are already present in the PCM. There is no
technical reason that the download files inside the PCM would ever become corrupted after the
control module had previously been successfully programmed. A P0601 (Control Module Read
Only Memory) Diagnostic Trouble Code would set in memory and the MIL would be illuminated if
the controller memory became corrupted.
The Techline Information System 2000 (TIS 2000) PC, combined with vehicle information gained
through the Tech 2, can determine when an attempt to reprogram a PCM using the same download
files (as those already in the control module) is being requested. If this is attempted, the TIS 2000
PC currently displays the following message:
Notice:
THE CALIBRATION SELECTED IS THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IN THE CONTROL MODULE.
PROGRAMMING WITH THE SAME DOWNLOAD FILES IS NOT AN EFFECTIVE REPAIR.
SELECT ( YES ) TO CONTINUE PROGRAMMING THE CONTROL MODULE,OR ( NO ) TO
CANCEL.
Effective in the first quarter of 2000, the TIS 2000 PC will indicate:
Important:
THE CALIBRATION SELECTED IS ALREADY THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IN THE CONTROL
MODULE. REPROGRAMMING WITH THE SAME DOWNLOAD FILE IS NOT ALLOWED.
Certain learned values, such as: (but not limited to)
^ fuel trim (previously known as block learn memory),
^ IAC learned position in various park/neutral and air conditioning on/off combinations,
^ certain OBDII diagnostic thresholds,
^ automatic transmission shift adapts
will revert back to their unlearned starting point values after a reprogramming event occurs.
It is feasible that the engine or transmission might temporarily operate differently after a
reprogramming event, until these values are re-learned. Relearning occurs while operating the
vehicle through normal driving routines. If the same download files are simply reinstalled, any
changes noticed in engine operation will likely disappear in a short amount of time and/or driving
distance.
Reprogramming the control module with the same download files that already exist in the module
will only accomplish a warranty claim for a non-effective repair, and a likely comeback.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Reprogram
Using Off Board Program Adapter
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 73-65-13
Date: March, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Reprogramming Capability using the Off Board Programming Adapter
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks (Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4490
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4491
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4492
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4493
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4494
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4495
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4496
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins SPS/FLASH EPROM Programming
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 53-65-08
Date: January, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: SPS/FLASH EPROM Programming
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles
This bulletin is being issued to assist technicians in reprogramming vehicles and should be used in
conjunction with instructions provided on your Techline Terminal and in your Techline Terminal
User's Manual.
THE TECHLINE TERMINAL (T-20, T-50, T-60) HAS BEEN ABLE TO DO 1996 VEHICLE
PROGRAMMING THROUGH THE DIRECT METHOD SINCE 1996 VEHICLES HAVE BEEN
AVAILABLE IN THE DEALERSHIPS/RETAIL FACILITIES. THE TECHLINE CD-ROM TITLED
DISC 13 CONTAINS THE SOFTWARE NEEDED TO PROGRAM ALL 1996 VEHICLES WITH A
TECH 1 (REMOTE PROGRAMMING METHOD).
SPS Tips
1. BATTERY VOLTAGE SHOULD BE CHECKED. A FULLY CHARGED BATTERY IS
NECESSARY BEFORE REPROGRAMMING TAKES PLACE. THE VEHICLE BATTERY SHOULD
NOT BE CONNECTED TO A BATTERY CHARGER DURING A PROGRAMMING EVENT
INCORRECT VOLTAGE COULD CAUSE PROGRAMMING AND/OR CONTROL MODULE
FAILURE. During programming, the control module depends on the battery as its sole source of
power. Also during programming, the vehicle's components (i.e. blower motor) are set to a default
mode which may be turned on, placing additional draw on the vehicle's battery. If the voltage goes
outside the specified range (11 to 14 volts) the controllers and the Techline equipment will stop
communicating. If this happens, it could cause the control module to become inoperable and
require replacement.
2. CHECK THE INTEGRITY OF THE TECH 1 CABLES, MAKE SURE THEY ARE NOT FRAYED,
BROKEN OR TWISTED. Loss of communication for any reason will require additional time in
completing the reprogramming event.
3. IF USING A TECH 1, YOUR MASS STORAGE CARTRIDGE (MSC) MUST BE UPDATED TO
REFLECT THE MOST CURRENT UPDATE OFFERED ON THE TECHLINE CD-ROM. DISC 13,
1995 WAS THE FIRST CD-ROM THAT HAD REMOTE PROGRAMMING SUPPORT If your MSC
is not updated to reflect the current software version on the Techline Terminal, in some situations
the software will not be capable of interpreting the information that is requested from the vehicle.
4. T-100 TERMINALS (CAMS) ARE NOT CAPABLE OF PROGRAMMING OBD II VEHICLES
THROUGH THE DIRECT METHOD. A TECH 1 MUST BE USED (REMOTE METHOD) WHEN
REPROGRAMMING WITH A T-100. The T-100 terminals communicate with vehicles through a
DLC (ALDL) card and cable found within the T-100's computer. The DLC (ALDL) card is not
capable of communicating at the new baud rate used with OBD II.
5. PROGRAMMING IS NOT NEEDED IF THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IS THE SAME AS THE
SELECTED CALIBRATION.
6. IF PROGRAMMING A NEW CONTROL MODULE, YOU MUST REQUEST INFORMATION
FROM THE NEW CONTROL MODULE. The security information that is needed for a control
module to be programmed is stored in the new control module. The security information must be
requested from the control module to be programmed. At that point, the control module can be
successfully programmed. This requesting of security information takes place in both the direct and
remote methods. The request is automatic when using the direct method. Looking at the calibration
stored in the old controller may be helpful in selecting the calibration from the CD-ROM for the new
controller.
7. WHEN PROGRAMMING OBD II VEHICLES WITH A TECH 1 (REMOTE PROGRAMMING
METHOD), A VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE (VIM) IS REQUIRED. The VIM allows the Tech 1
to communicate with the OBD II vehicles. The VIM is necessary for all other Tech 1 diagnostics on
OBD II vehicles. VIMs are no longer on backorder. If you are interested in obtaining additional
VIMs, call 1-800-GM-TOOLS and ask for VIM kit part number 7000041.
8. DISCONNECT THE TECH I AND VIM FROM THE VEHICLE BETWEEN RETRIEVING DATA
AND PROGRAMMING THE VEHICLE. If the VIM remains powered up after data is requested, a
communication problem may result when the reprogramming function is performed.
9. WHEN CONNECTING THE TECH 1 TO A TECHLINE TERMINAL (EXCEPT T-100 CAMS),
ALWAYS CONNECT THE FLAT GRAY R5232 CABLE FIRST AND THEN THE POWER
ADAPTER. FAILURE TO DO SO COULD RESULT IN A LOSS OF INFORMATION
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4501
STORED ON THE TECH 1. When power is turned on to the Tech 1, it looks for the RS232
connection. If it does not see the connection, the Tech 1 in some cases, will erase the information
stored for download.
10. DO NOT DISCONTINUE OR INTERRUPT THE PROGRAM LOADING PROCESS TO THE
VEHICLE. This will result in a programming error and could prevent the Electronic Control Module
(ECM) from functioning properly.
11. AFTER PROGRAMMING IS COMPLETE, PRESS "EXIT". MAKE SURE THE KEY IS CYCLED
OFF FOR APPROXIMATELY 10 SECONDS THEN BACK ON. Some vehicles will lose component
settings (PMC/IAC Valve). Cycling the key off two times (Off for 30 seconds, On for 10 then repeat
a second time) will allow for resetting of the components. Start the vehicle to ensure programming
was successful.
FOR CADILLAC VEHICLES ONLY a. DUE TO OTHER MODULES ON THE DATA LINE TRYING TO COMMUNICATE WITH THE
ECM DURING PROGRAMMING, SOME COMMUNICATION CODES MAY BE SET After
programming is complete, clear any codes and verify they do not reset.
b. TO HELP MINIMIZE BATTERY DRAW DURING ECM PROGRAMMING, DISCONNECT THE
BLOWER MOTOR (AT THE CONNECTOR, NOT THE FUSE) PRIOR TO PROGRAMMING. When
programming is complete, reconnect the blower motor.
12. 1997 VEHICLES REQUIRE REPROGRAMMING BE DONE USING A TECH 2. OBD II vehicle
calibration size and complexity will require more memory than the Tech 1 has available. Tech 2 will
be an essential tool in the first quarter of 1996 containing limited 1996 applications and updates.
13. STG HAS ISSUED BULLETINS (# 53-65-04 and # 53-65-05 - (SEE CHART EXCERPTED
FROM 53-65-05 FOR USE AS A QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE), DEVELOPED QUICK
REFERENCE GUIDES (P/N SPSCARD-1 AVAILABLE THROUGH YOUR LOCAL GM TRAINING
CENTER), PRODUCED CPT VIDEOS (CPT # 56010.00-B), HAD PULSAT BROADCASTS, AND
OFFERS GM TRAINING CENTER CLASSROOM COURSES. As you work through
reprogramming, keep the above-mentioned material in mind as resources to assist you if difficulty
is encountered. As always, the Techline Customer Support Center (1-800-828-6860 English,
1-800-503-3222 French) is always available to assist the technician with any situation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4502
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4503
SPS/EEPROM Programming
1993 to current Reprogrammable Vehicles
Note: If programming a new control module you must request info from the new control module
first. Battery voltage should be checked and at full charge before reprogramming takes place.
System to be programmed should NOT be connected to a battery charger. Incorrect voltage could
cause programming and/or control module failure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Cold Knock,
Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 37-61-05A
Date: October, 1995
Subject: Cold Engine Knock (Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM)
Models: 1990-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, R/V, S/T, M/L, G, P Models 1991-92 Oldsmobile
Bravada with 4.3L (VIN Z - RPO LB4), 5.7L (VIN K - RPO L05), 7.4 (VIN N - RPO L19) Engine
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1995 model year information. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 37-61-05 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some late model truck engines have been reported to exhibit "cold knock" on start up. "Cold
Knock" usually occurs after the vehicle has been completely warmed up, then parked for 8 or more
hours in ambient temperatures of 35° F or less. "Cold knock" can be separated into three distinct
categories.
1. Short Duration - Harsh, deep metallic knock that usually lasts from 1 to 10 seconds. Generally
classified as a bearing or rod knock.
2. Valve Train - Light clatter, tick or click that may last up to 1 minute.
3. Piston Slap - Metallic knock that occurs only under load. Piston slap may last as long as 5
minutes.
Correction
Category A: Short Duration Knock
This matrix describes the repair for each affected model year and engine.
Specific information for each affected model year and engine is supplied.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4508
1992 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" only
1992-93 LB4 VIN Z with "cold knock" and installed field fix PROM OR with "cold knock" and
detonation
1990-95 LB4 VIN Z Install check valve oil filter P/N 12555891 (FRAM PH3980). If the filter does not
cure the condition, install the appropriate calibration from the tables (calibrations are available for
all 1992 and some 1993 LB4 applications). If a calibration is not offered or does not cure the short
duration cold knock
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4509
condition, install the appropriate main bearings as determined by the following procedure.
Calibration Information - 1992-93 LB4 VIN Z The revised PROMs reduce spark advance after the
engine is started. The reduction in spark lowers the cylinder pressure and eliminates the knock.
The revised PROMs will NOT eliminate a piston slap (Category C) or valve train noise (Category B)
concern. The base cold knock PROM contains the previously released calibration updates. For
1992 LB4, the previous field release is included for torque converter clutch (TCC) lock up (see
Bulletin 137107 - Chevrolet 92-75-7A; GMC Truck 92-7A-40; Oldsmobile 92-T-34; Canada
9274L60100) for automatic transmissions, or neutral gear rattle for manual transmissions (see
Bulletin 267201R - Chevrolet 92-187B-7B; GMC Truck 92-7B-149A; Canada 93-7B-105). If a
vehicle has had a detonation fix PROM installed previously, select the combined detonation and
cold knock fix PROM for the application. See Bulletin 376508 for more information on field fix
PROM for the application and detonation.
Important:
Use of a detonation fix PROM in a non-detonating vehicle may result in degraded driveability.
GMSPO currently stocks three (3) PROMs for each light duty 1992 model year LB4 application.
Base
Cold Knock Fix
Combination Cold Knock and Detonation Fix
GMSPO Service Parts Assistance Center (SPAC 1-800-433-6961) will have information available
on each PROM part number. Select the PROM from the table. Old Broadcast Code (Old B/C Code)
and Scan I.D. information has been supplied to help installed previously. Use a TECH-1 to
determine the Scan I.D. of the PROM in the vehicle or remove the PROM and read the Broadcast
Code (B/C Code). If the B/C Code/Scan I.D. can be found in the first table, a detonation fix has not
been installed.
PROMs are currently available GMSPO.
1990-95 L05 VIN K
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4510
1993 to 1995 L05 VIN K
Install the appropriate check valve oil filter P/N 25160561 (PF1218 for two-wheel C-series and P/N
12555891 (FRAM PH3980) for four-wheel drive K-series). If the oil filter does not cure the
condition, install the appropriate calibration from the table (calibrations are available for some 1993
and 1994 L05 applications). All calibrations are for light duty vehicles equipped with 4L60-E (M30)
transmissions (no heavy duty emission/4L80-E calibrations are available). If a calibration is not
offered or does not cure the short duration cold knock condition, install the appropriate main
bearings as determined by the procedure.
1990-94 L19 VIN N
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4511
Install a check valve oil filter; no other recommended actions at this time.
Important:
The previous actions are only applicable to short duration cold knock. These actions will not
eliminate a knock occurring under load or a knock lasting for more than 10 seconds.
Two main bearing procedures are recommended:
1. For main bearing replacement with the engine IN the vehicle: C, G, P, M and L vehicles
2. For main bearing replacement with the engine OUT OF the vehicle: K, S and T
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE IN THE VEHICLE
Recommended for C, G, P, M and L vehicles.
Important:
A OEM training video has been produced for in-vehicle main bearing replacement procedure. One
copy of the video will be sent to each dealer. If the video has not been received, contact XPRESS 1
Distribution Center at 1-800-783-3034.
Main Bearing Clearance Determination and Installation Procedure
1. REMOVE THE SERPENTINE BELT, dipstick, dipstick tube and disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Raise the vehicle and remove (or set aside) any parts restricting access to the oil pan bolts (i.e.,
starter motor, oil cooler lines, oil filter adapter, flywheel inspection cover).
3. Remove the oil pan, oil pump, and shield.
4. Remove # 5 (flange) bearing cap. Wipe the oil from the crankshaft journal and the lower main
bearing insert.
5. Place a screw jack under an accessible part of the crankshaft, carefully apply pressure to the
crankshaft to force it solidly against the top bearing insert. The reason for this is to remove any
clearance between the top bearing insert and the crankshaft. If this step is not performed, a smaller
than actual clearance will be measured.
Important:
This should be done as close as possible to the bearing being measured. This step is only required
for on-vehicle service where the engine cannot be turned upside down as on an engine stand.
6. Place a piece of plastigage across the width of the lower bearing insert (parallel to the centerline
of the crankshaft).
7. Reinstall # 5 main bearing cap. Torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft). Do not allow crankshaft to turn.
8. Carefully remove the # 5 main bearing cap and bearing insert. The flattened plastigage will
adhere to either the bearing insert or the crank journal. Do not remove the plastigage from the
insert or journal.
9. On the edge of the plastigage envelope, there is a graduated scale. Without removing the
flattened plastigage, measure its width at the widest point using the graduated scale on the
plastigage envelope.
10. The desired main bearing clearance is 0.0008" - 0.0028". If the clearance measured with the
plastigage is greater than 0.0028", write down the clearance. Next, read the back of the bearing
insert to determine what size bearing was originally installed (usual STD, 0.0006", 0.0010" or
0.0012"). The size stamped on the bearing is the effective undersize when both inserts are
installed. For example, a 0.0006" undersize bearing set consists of two (2) 0.0003" thicker bearing
inserts, both stamped 0.0006".
11. Remove the top bearing insert using tool J 8080 and read the back to determine what size
upper bearing insert was originally installed. The top insert may be different size than the bottom.
12. Calculate the original bearing undersize by dividing the size on each insert by 2, then add the
values together.
EXAMPLE 1:
The lower insert is stamped 0.0006" and the upper is stamped 0.0010". Divide 0.0006" by two to
get 0.0003". Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0.0003" and 0.0005" together to calculate the
bearing undersize, which is 0.0008" in this case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4512
EXAMPLE 2:
The lower insert is stamped STD (standard) and the upper is stamped 0.0010". The undersize for a
STD bearing is 0. Divide 0 by 2 to get 0. Divide 0.0010" by 2 to get 0.0005". Add 0 and 0.0005"
together to calculate the bearing undersize, which is 0.0005" in this case.
13. Add the original bearing undersize calculated in step 12 to the clearance measured and written
down in step 9. For example, if a clearance of 0.0030" was measured with plastigage in step 9 and
the calculated bearing undersize from step 12 was 0.0005", the bearing clearance for that
particular main journal is equal to 0.0030" plus 0.0005". The bearing clearance would be 0.0035" in
this case.
14. Determine which of the combinations of two sizes of replacement bearings will produce the
desired clearance. The two sizes available are 0.001" and 0.002". One insert of each size may be
combined to produce an intermediate undersize of 0.0015". Subtract the replacement bearing size
from the actual clearance to determine which bearing should be used. The bearing that should be
used is the one which gives a clearance closer to 0.0008" than to 0.0028". The clearance must not
be less than 0.0008". Using the example from step 11, the actual clearance is 0.0035". Subtracting
0.001" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0025", just barely within the required range.
Subtracting 0.002" from 0.0035" will give a clearance of 0.0015". The 0.002" undersize bearing set
would be the one to use in this case since it gives a clearance closer to 0.0008", but not less.
15. Install the replacement upper main bearing insert using tool J 8080.
16. Install the replacement lower main bearing insert in the main bearing cap. Lay a piece of
plastigage across the width of the lower main bearing insert (same as step 5).
17. Repeat steps 7, 8 and 9.
18. Measuring the plastigage with the scale on the envelope, verify the clearance of the
replacement bearings is within the range of 0.001" to 0.003".
19. Repeat steps 4 through 16 for each main bearing.
20. Thrust the crankshaft forward and backward several times to seat the thrust bearing.
21. Reinstall oil pump; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
22. Reinstall the oil pan and other hardware.
23. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
24. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
25. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS TO BE USED FOR VEHICLES REQUIRING MAIN BEARING
REPLACEMENT WITH THE ENGINE OUT OF THE VEHICLE
Recommended for K, S and T vehicles.
1. Remove the engine from the vehicle using the appropriate service manual procedure.
2. Mount the engine on an engine stand, flip the engine so the oil pan is facing up.
3. Remove the oil pan.
4. Remove the oil pump and shield.
5. Remove the dipstick tube.
6. Remove one (1) main bearing cap (must do one at a time).
7. Plasti-gage bearing.
8. If the bearing clearance is out of specification (clearance greater than 0.003 inches), remove
upper main bearing from the block.
9. Check the size of the original bearing.
10. Determine what combination of new bearings are required to get the clearance in the
acceptable range of 0.0008 inches to 0.0028 inches. See steps
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4513
12 through 14 in the "in-vehicle" service outlined above.
11. Reinstall the upper main bearing.
12. Reinstall the main cap and lower bearing; torque to 110 N.m (80 lb ft).
13. Repeat for each main bearing.
14. Reinstall oil pump and shield; torque to 88 N.m (65 lb ft).
15. Reinstall dipstick tube.
16. Reinstall oil pan.
17. Reinstall engine in vehicle.
18. Before starting the engine, remove the fuel pump fuse and crank the engine until oil pressure
registers on the gauge. Stop cranking, let the starter cool down, then crank for another 15 seconds.
19. Install fuel pump fuse, start engine, check for leaks or unusual noises.
20. Road test vehicle, check for leaks or unusual noises.
Correction
Category B: Valve Train Clatter, Tick or Click
For 1992-94 vehicles equipped with a 4.3L V6 (LB4 VIN Z or L35 VIN W) engine see Corporate
Bulletin 376006 for information on converting from net lash to adjustable lash and/or re-lashing the
valves on an adjustable lash system.
Investigation of "cold knock" is continuing. Updates will continue to be provided when available.
Parts Information
Check-Valve Filters Description Part Number
V6, V8 (Four-Wheel Drive) FRAM PH3980 12555891
V8 (Two-Wheel Drive), Mark V8 PF1218 25160561
The FRAM PH3980 is to be used in place of the PF52. The PH3980 provides superior
anti-drainback performance, a key factor in reducing cold knock. FRAM filters are to be procured
locally until 08-15-95. After this date the filters may be ordered from GMSPO using the supplied
part number. Orders placed to GMSPO prior to this date will not be placed on backorder.
Bearings Description Part Number
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 10120992
0.001" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 10120994
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Positions 1-4 on V8, 1-3 on V6 12329758
0.002" Main Bearing Kit, Flange # 5 on V8, # 4 on V6 12329792
Main bearing kits are currently available from GMSPO.
All calibrations are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
376105A > Oct > 95 > Engine - Cold Knock, Replace Oil Filter/Bearings/PROM > Page 4514
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
476522 > Jan > 95 > Engine - Backfire Upon Acceleration
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Backfire Upon
Acceleration
File in Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 47-65-22
Date: January, 1995
Subject: Backfire on Acceleration (Correct Calibration)
Models: 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models with 4.3L Engine (VIN Z - RPO LB4) and
Manual Transmission (RPO MY2)
Condition
Some owners may experience a backfire condition upon acceleration.
Cause
Insufficient ignition timing advance in the spark calibration under some driving conditions.
Correction
More robust calibrations have been released to address this concern. THIS CALIBRATION WILL
NOT CORRECT ANY OTHER DRIVEABILITY CONCERN.
Important:
These service calibrations should ONLY be used if a backfire concern still exists in a vehicle
WHICH HAS HAD THE BASE TIMING CHECKED AND SET TO SPECIFICATION.
LAUNCH DETONATION MAY OCCUR IN VEHICLES SERVICED WITH THESE CALIBRATIONS;
particularly in vehicles which are heavily loaded or towing trailers.
Parts Information
Service "FLASH" calibrations are available starting with the December, 1994 CD ROM.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly
Technical Service Bulletin # 99046 Date: 991201
Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly
File in Section: Special Prices
Bulletin No.: 99046
Date: December, 1999
SPECIAL POLICY
SUBJECT: 99046 - SPECIAL POLICY - HIGH/LOW/HIGH ABS BRAKE ANOMALY
MODELS: 1993-1996 CHEVROLET, GMC, AND OLDSMOBILE S/T UTILITY 1994-1996
CHEVROLET AND GMC S/T PICKUP EQUIPPED WITH A V6 ENGINE 1993-1995 CHEVROLET
AND GMC M/L VAN 1993-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC G VAN
THIS SPECIAL POLICY IS IN EFFECT UNTIL DECEMBER 1, 2002
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS SPECIAL POLICY WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. THIS FIRST PHASE WILL BE THE REPROGRAMMING OF THE VCM IN 2WD AND
4WD 1994-1996 S/T PICKUPS AND 1995-1996 S/T UTILITIES EQUIPPED WITH A VCM.
VEHICLES INVOLVED IN PHASE 1 ARE SHADED IN THE TABLE.
YOU WILL BE NOTIFIED OF THE NEXT PHASE VIA DCS MESSAGE.
Condition
The federal government's highway safety agency, the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) has identified, and General Motors Corporation has confirmed, the
existence of a condition in the antilock braking system of some Chevrolet, GMC, and Oldsmobile
S/T utilities. 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC S/T pickups equipped with a V6 engine, 1993-1995
Chevrolet and GMC M/L vans, and 1993-1996 Chevrolet and GMC G vans, all equipped with the
Lucas Varity three-sensor ABS system. On rare occasions, this condition can result in longer
stopping distances during certain antilock brake applications, as explained below.
If the customer is driving on a road surface that supports good traction and they begin to stop by
applying the brake pedal firmly, and both front wheels of their vehicle then pass onto a slippery
surface (such as an ice-covered or wet patched asphalt part of the road), the antilock brake system
will adjust the brakes at each of the wheels to take advantage of the available traction. This will
allow the customer to steer and maintain stability, which is normal ABS operation1 as their owner's
manual explains in more detail.
However, if the customer is still braking while the vehicle leaves the slippery surface and both front
wheels get back on a higher-traction surface, the ABS may perform as if the vehicle were still on
the slippery surface and the vehicle may not stop as quickly. However, this will not happen every
time these conditions are encountered. It depends on several additional factors, such as vehicle
speed and the length of the slippery surface.
The ABS system was designed with increased sensitivity to wheel slip in order to improve vehicle
steerability while braking on very slippery surfaces. This improvement for steerability, however,
made it possible for reduced front braking effectiveness to occur as described above.
SPECIAL POLICY ADJUSTMENT (Phase I)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly > Page 4524
This special policy adjustment covers the condition described above- until December 1, 2002,
regardless of vehicle mileage or ownership. Dealers are to reprogram the VCM. Use the following
Service Procedure. This will be performed at no charge to the customer during this time. Other
conditions that may cause similar or different brake complaints that are not a result of the condition
listed above are not covered by this special policy. The customer should be informed that any
further service that is not covered by this special policy would be their responsibility, if they elect to
have the service performed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly > Page 4525
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Involved are 1993-1998 S/T utilities, 1994-1996 S/T pickups equipped with a V6 engine, 1993-1995
M/L van, and 1993-1996 G vans built within the VIN breakpoints.
PARTS INFORMATION
This phase requires no parts. Calibrations are available in October, 1999 on TIS 2000 CD, # 21 or
Techline CD # 20/21 or later versions.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Customers will be notified of this special policy on their vehicles, in phases, by General Motors (see
copy of typical customer letter included with this bulletin - actual divisional letter may vary slightly).
SERVICE PROCEDURE
VCM Programming
Important:
For 1995 S/T utilities with L35, check the Service Parts Identification (SPID) label on the inside of
the glovebox to determine if the vehicle has a VCM. If there is an RPO of "K29", the vehicle has a
PCM and is programmable.
The new calibration,will be available in October, 1999 on TIS 2000 CD # 21 or Techline CD # 20/21
and later versions. The calibration is programmed into the vehicle's VCM via a Techline TOOL. Use
a Techline Terminal or scan tool to perform the learn procedure and program the VCM.
Important:
Use the calibration file "Special Policy 99046" on TIS 2000 CD # 21 or Techline CD # 20/21 or later
versions.
1. To ensure VCM programming/RPO configuration, confirm that the following conditions exist in
order to prepare for VCM programming:
^ The battery is fully charged
^ The ignition switch is in the "RUN" position
^ The Data Link Connector (DLC) is accessible
2. Refer to the latest Techline Terminal and equipment user's instructions.
3. Clear the diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after the programming is complete.
CLAIM INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty submit a claim with the information indicated.
Owner Letter
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
99046 > Dec > 99 > Recall - High/Low/High ABS Brake Anomaly > Page 4526
December, 1999
Dear Chevrolet/GMC Customer:
As the owner of a General Motors truck equipped with the Lucas Varity three-sensor antilock brake
system (ABS), your satisfaction with our product is of utmost concern to us.
Condition: The federal government's highway safety agency. the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) has identifled1 and General Motors Corporation has confirmed the
existence of a condition in the antilock braking system of some Chevrolet and GMC 1994-1996 S/T
pickups equipped with a V6 engine and 1995-1996 S/T utility vehicles. On rare occasions, this
condition can result in longer stopping distances during certain antilock brake applications, as
explained below.
If you're driving on a road surface that supports good traction and you begin to stop by applying
your brake pedal firmly, and both front wheels of your vehicle then pass, onto a slippery surface
(such as an ice-covered or wet patched asphalt part of the road), your antilock brake system will
adjust the brakes at each of the wheels to take advantage of the available traction. This will allow
you to steer and maintain stability, which is normal ABS operation, as your owner's manual
explains in more detail.
However, if you are still braking while the vehicle leaves the slippery surface and both front wheels
get back on a higher-traction surface, the ABS may perform as if the vehicle were still on the
slippery surface and the vehicle may not stop as quickly. However, this will not happen every time
these conditions are encountered. It depends on several additional factors, such as vehicle speed
and the length of the slippery surface.
Your ABS system was designed with increased sensitivity to wheel slip in order to improve vehicle
steerability while braking on very slippery surfaces. This improvement for steerability, however,
made it possible for reduced front braking effectiveness to occur as described above. Therefore,
GM has developed a software change that will make your vehicle less Sensitive to wheel slip under
the circumstances described above.
What Will Be Done: Upon your request, your Chevrolet/GMC dealer will make a change to your
antilock braking system software to prevent this phenomenon from occurring. This software change
will have only a slight effect on vehicle steerablity during braking on very slippery surfaces and is
designed to have no effect on normal ABS or other braking operations. This change should not
affect how your brakes feel or create any perceptible difference in the steerability or stability of your
vehicle while braking. This modification will be performed for you at no charge at anytime until
December 1, 2002.
How Long Will The Repair Take: Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer will modify your vehicle's ABS
software. We estimate that it will take your dealer 45 minutes to perform this modification.
Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If your dealer has a large
number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant. Please ask your dealer
if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed.
Contacting Your Dealer: Repairs and adjustments qualifying under this special coverage must be
performed by a Chevrolet/GMC dealer. You may want to call the service department to arrange a
convenient appointment. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service date within a
reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at the number
listed below:
Deaf, Hearing Impaired
Division Number or Speech Impaired*
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583
* Utilizes Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf/Text Telephones (TDD/TTY)
1-800-462-8782. The deaf, hearing impaired, or speech impaired should call 1-800-462-8583
(utilizes Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf/Text Telephones, TDD/TTY).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4535
The General Motors vehicles contain Electronically Reprogrammable Devices (i.e. PCM, VCM,
ECM). These vehicles cannot be programmed through PROM replacement, however service
programming capability is available through the Tech 1/1A, Tech 2 and Techline terminals via
direct or remote programming.
The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has requested that all new vehicle manufacturers
ensure their dealers/retailers are aware that they are responsible for providing customers access to
reprogramming services at a reasonable cost and in a timely manner.
Although programming of controllers has become a common service practice at GM
dealers/retailers, the EPA has received reports from consumers and the aftermarket repair industry
that they were unable to purchase a new (programmed) Electronically Reprogrammable Device
(ERD) over-the-counter. As a result, on August 1, 1995, the Federal Government issued a
regulation requiring all manufacturers to make available reprogramming to the independent
aftermarket by December 1, 1997.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4536
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4537
Today, the Off Board Programming Adapter (OBPA) is used to reprogram ERD's sold
over-the-counter. For all practical purposes, the OBPA takes the place of the vehicle when the
vehicle is not available.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4538
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4539
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4540
The list of dealerships/retailers currently own the OBPA (see Attachments 1 - 3). These locations
are equipped to provide over-the-counter preprogrammed ERD's. The hardware required to
perform reprogramming in addition to the OBPA is a Techline terminal, Tech 1/1A and associated
cables and adapters. THE TECH 2 SHOULD NOT BE USED WITH THE OBPA AT THIS TIME
BECAUSE OF INADEQUATE OBPA GROUNDING.
The current OBPA can support reprogramming on all late model General Motor's vehicles except:
^ Premium V-8's
^ 1996 Diesel Truck
^ Cadillac Catera
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
736513 > Mar > 97 > PROM - Reprogram Using Off Board Program Adapter > Page 4541
^ All 1997 programmable vehicles (requires use of the Tech 2)
A modification to the OBPA is being offered by Kent-Moore to support these additional vehicles and
to allow reprogramming using the Tech 2. The revisions to the OBPA for the Tech 2 is very
important as the Tech 2 is the only tool used for service programming for 1997 and future vehicles.
To have the modifications performed, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The revisions (part
number J 41207 REV-C) are free of charge for GM dealerships/retailers.
A dealership/retailer can purchase the OBPA by contacting Kent-Moore (part number J 41207-C).
Support on how to use the OBPA is provided by the Techline Customer Support Center (TCSC) at
(800) 828-6860 (English) or (800) 503-3222 (French).
If you need to purchase an OBPA and/or cable, contact Kent-Moore at (800) 345-2233. The OBPA
retails for $695.00 (includes all revisions 1-4) under part number J 41207-C.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4546
STORED ON THE TECH 1. When power is turned on to the Tech 1, it looks for the RS232
connection. If it does not see the connection, the Tech 1 in some cases, will erase the information
stored for download.
10. DO NOT DISCONTINUE OR INTERRUPT THE PROGRAM LOADING PROCESS TO THE
VEHICLE. This will result in a programming error and could prevent the Electronic Control Module
(ECM) from functioning properly.
11. AFTER PROGRAMMING IS COMPLETE, PRESS "EXIT". MAKE SURE THE KEY IS CYCLED
OFF FOR APPROXIMATELY 10 SECONDS THEN BACK ON. Some vehicles will lose component
settings (PMC/IAC Valve). Cycling the key off two times (Off for 30 seconds, On for 10 then repeat
a second time) will allow for resetting of the components. Start the vehicle to ensure programming
was successful.
FOR CADILLAC VEHICLES ONLY a. DUE TO OTHER MODULES ON THE DATA LINE TRYING TO COMMUNICATE WITH THE
ECM DURING PROGRAMMING, SOME COMMUNICATION CODES MAY BE SET After
programming is complete, clear any codes and verify they do not reset.
b. TO HELP MINIMIZE BATTERY DRAW DURING ECM PROGRAMMING, DISCONNECT THE
BLOWER MOTOR (AT THE CONNECTOR, NOT THE FUSE) PRIOR TO PROGRAMMING. When
programming is complete, reconnect the blower motor.
12. 1997 VEHICLES REQUIRE REPROGRAMMING BE DONE USING A TECH 2. OBD II vehicle
calibration size and complexity will require more memory than the Tech 1 has available. Tech 2 will
be an essential tool in the first quarter of 1996 containing limited 1996 applications and updates.
13. STG HAS ISSUED BULLETINS (# 53-65-04 and # 53-65-05 - (SEE CHART EXCERPTED
FROM 53-65-05 FOR USE AS A QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE), DEVELOPED QUICK
REFERENCE GUIDES (P/N SPSCARD-1 AVAILABLE THROUGH YOUR LOCAL GM TRAINING
CENTER), PRODUCED CPT VIDEOS (CPT # 56010.00-B), HAD PULSAT BROADCASTS, AND
OFFERS GM TRAINING CENTER CLASSROOM COURSES. As you work through
reprogramming, keep the above-mentioned material in mind as resources to assist you if difficulty
is encountered. As always, the Techline Customer Support Center (1-800-828-6860 English,
1-800-503-3222 French) is always available to assist the technician with any situation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4547
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
536508 > Jan > 96 > SPS/FLASH EPROM - Programming > Page 4548
SPS/EEPROM Programming
1993 to current Reprogrammable Vehicles
Note: If programming a new control module you must request info from the new control module
first. Battery voltage should be checked and at full charge before reprogramming takes place.
System to be programmed should NOT be connected to a battery charger. Incorrect voltage could
cause programming and/or control module failure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4549
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service Precautions
A PROM is a sensitive electronic part and must be handled with care. If the connector terminals
(pins) on the bottom of the PROM are exposed, avoid touching them. Pins can be broken easily,
and the PROM can be damaged by static electric discharge. Follow these guidelines when
replacing a PROM:
^ Disconnect the battery ground cable before removing a PROM. Reconnect the cable after the
new PROM is installed.
^ DO NOT try to remove a PROM from its plastic PROM carrier.
^ Note the direction in which the original PROM and its carrier were installed in the ECM, and
install the replacement PROM in the same direction. Most PROM's are marked with a notch at one
end for orientation. Many PROM's can be installed in a reversed direction, which will destroy the
PROM when power is applied.
CAUTION: A PROM can be damaged by static electric discharge. Avoid damage as follows:
^ DO NOT remove a PROM from its packing material until you are ready to install it. DO NOT hold
a PROM by its pins.
^ Before entering a vehicle to remove or replace a PROM, touch an exposed metal part of the
vehicle to discharge any static charge from your body or use anti-static wrist straps.
^ Avoid sliding across upholstery or carpeting when removing or installing a PROM. If this is not
possible, touch an exposed metal part of the vehicle with your free hand before removing a PROM
or installing a new one in its socket in the ECM.
^ When available, use an antistatic grounding strap attached to your wrist and clipped to a metal
part of the vehicle body to prevent static charges from accumulating. Antistatic, conductive
floormats are also available.
^ For some vehicles, it may be desirable to remove the ECM when replacing the PROM.
^ NOTE: See POWERTRAIN MANAGEMENT / SERVICE PRECAUTIONS / VEHICLE DAMAGE
WARNINGS / ELECTRICAL PRECAUTIONS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Introducing the GM PROM Cross
Reference Index
This PROM cross reference index provides tables that let you use a PROM identification (ID) code
to identify the PROM installed in the engine control module (ECM) on most GM vehicles. The code
can be either - or both - the internal "scan ID" code or the external PROM code. From the PROM
identification, you can find the part number of the PROM and trace the PROM history to determine
if any revised PROM's have been issued to supersede the one in the vehicle.
The PROM history for a specific vehicle lists a succession of superseding PROM's ending with the
most recent PROM released as a service part for the vehicle. PROM's that were released as
service parts and explained in a technical service bulletin (TSB) are listed with a description of why
the PROM was issued. In most cases, the applicable TSB also is referenced.
This index lists ECM PROM's for the 1980-95 vehicles. It does not contain ID codes and part
numbers for all PROM's used in all GM vehicles. NOTE: GM flash PROM's (EEPROM's) can only
be updated at GM Dealerships with factory-supplied equipment. These cars will not display a
PROM ID.
By following the steps outlined below, you can use the PROM index to determine if the problem
you are diagnosing can possibly be corrected by installing a revised PROM. The PROM index
tables are organized by model year, engine displacement, and engine code (the eighth digit of the
Vehicle Identification Number). The table columns are arranged as shown below:
Example of Table Column Arrangement
SCAN PROM PROM PART SUPERSEDING TSB REFERENCE
ID CODE (BCC) NUMBER ID PART NUMBER NUMBER
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................
9461 8958 AMU 16058955R 8290 01228290 86194
Column 1, SCAN ID:
The scan ID is the internal PROM identification number transmitted on the ECM data stream and
displayed by the scanner as PROM ID. The PROM records for each year and engine are listed
numerically by this scan ID.
Column 2, PROM CODE:
These are the numbers and letters marked on the top of the PROM itself. The numbers are often
referred to as the "external PROM ID." The letters are often called the "broadcast code." Together
they are the external PROM code.
Column 3, PROM P/N:
This is the GM part number for the PROM identified by the codes in columns 1 and 2.
Column 4, SUPERSEDING ID PROM PART NUMBER:
Use the superseding scan ID to locate the newer PROM in the table. If the scan ID for the
superseding PROM is not known, the PROM broadcast code is listed here. If the PROM is
superseded by a newer PROM, that part number is listed here.
Column 5, TSB REFERENCE NUMBER
The TSB NUMBER column identifies the original TSB that released this PROM for service.
Whenever possible you should refer to the TSB for additional information before changing a
PROM. The bulletin may list other parts that must be installed when the PROM is changed, or it
may provide additional troubleshooting information. To find a TSB, see Reading Technical Service
Bulletins. See: Reading Technical Service Bulletins This will display all the TSB's for that particular
vehicle.
EXPANDED FOOTNOTES Here you will find SUPERSEDING SCAN ID, PROM PART NUMBERS,
symptoms and additional parts that need to be replaced when servicing the PROM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4552
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Introducing the GM PROM Cross
Reference Index
This PROM cross reference index provides tables that let you use a PROM identification (ID) code
to identify the PROM installed in the engine control module (ECM) on most GM vehicles. The code
can be either - or both - the internal "scan ID" code or the external PROM code. From the PROM
identification, you can find the part number of the PROM and trace the PROM history to determine
if any revised PROM's have been issued to supersede the one in the vehicle.
The PROM history for a specific vehicle lists a succession of superseding PROM's ending with the
most recent PROM released as a service part for the vehicle. PROM's that were released as
service parts and explained in a technical service bulletin (TSB) are listed with a description of why
the PROM was issued. In most cases, the applicable TSB also is referenced.
This index lists ECM PROM's for the 1980-95 vehicles. It does not contain ID codes and part
numbers for all PROM's used in all GM vehicles. NOTE: GM flash PROM's (EEPROM's) can only
be updated at GM Dealerships with factory-supplied equipment. These cars will not display a
PROM ID.
By following the steps outlined below, you can use the PROM index to determine if the problem
you are diagnosing can possibly be corrected by installing a revised PROM. The PROM index
tables are organized by model year, engine displacement, and engine code (the eighth digit of the
Vehicle Identification Number). The table columns are arranged as shown below:
Example of Table Column Arrangement
SCAN PROM PROM PART SUPERSEDING TSB REFERENCE
ID CODE (BCC) NUMBER ID PART NUMBER NUMBER
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................
9461 8958 AMU 16058955R 8290 01228290 86194
Column 1, SCAN ID:
The scan ID is the internal PROM identification number transmitted on the ECM data stream and
displayed by the scanner as PROM ID. The PROM records for each year and engine are listed
numerically by this scan ID.
Column 2, PROM CODE:
These are the numbers and letters marked on the top of the PROM itself. The numbers are often
referred to as the "external PROM ID." The letters are often called the "broadcast code." Together
they are the external PROM code.
Column 3, PROM P/N:
This is the GM part number for the PROM identified by the codes in columns 1 and 2.
Column 4, SUPERSEDING ID PROM PART NUMBER:
Use the superseding scan ID to locate the newer PROM in the table. If the scan ID for the
superseding PROM is not known, the PROM broadcast code is listed here. If the PROM is
superseded by a newer PROM, that part number is listed here.
Column 5, TSB REFERENCE NUMBER
The TSB NUMBER column identifies the original TSB that released this PROM for service.
Whenever possible you should refer to the TSB for additional information before changing a
PROM. The bulletin may list other parts that must be installed when the PROM is changed, or it
may provide additional troubleshooting information. To find a TSB, see Reading Technical Service
Bulletins. See: Reading Technical Service Bulletins This will display all the TSB's for that particular
vehicle.
EXPANDED FOOTNOTES Here you will find SUPERSEDING SCAN ID, PROM PART NUMBERS,
symptoms and additional parts that need to be replaced when servicing the PROM.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4553
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Additional PROM Information
New ECM PROMs for GM vehicles may be released for service at any time. The information in this
system is accurate to the best of the publisher's knowledge and the publication date of the disk.
Before ordering a PROM, consult with a GM parts and service dealer to verify the latest part
number information. Scanner PROM ID information for earlier-model vehicles (1980-83) is less
complete than for later models. To accurately identify PROM's in earlier vehicles, it may be
necessary to check the external PROM code marked on the PROM.
General Motors has often recommended that dealership technicians check the PROM history of a
vehicle and install the most recent PROM revision before performing other diagnostic operations.
Each succeeding PROM revision for a specific vehicle includes all previous revisions. Therefore,
whenever you consider changing a PROM, review the entire PROM history to see if any revision
covered the current driveability problem. Installing the most recent PROM revision may be
impractical however for an independent service facility, particularly if the latest PROM revision does
not address the specific driveability problem of the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4554
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Additional PROM Information
New ECM PROMs for GM vehicles may be released for service at any time. The information in this
system is accurate to the best of the publisher's knowledge and the publication date of the disk.
Before ordering a PROM, consult with a GM parts and service dealer to verify the latest part
number information. Scanner PROM ID information for earlier-model vehicles (1980-83) is less
complete than for later models. To accurately identify PROM's in earlier vehicles, it may be
necessary to check the external PROM code marked on the PROM.
General Motors has often recommended that dealership technicians check the PROM history of a
vehicle and install the most recent PROM revision before performing other diagnostic operations.
Each succeeding PROM revision for a specific vehicle includes all previous revisions. Therefore,
whenever you consider changing a PROM, review the entire PROM history to see if any revision
covered the current driveability problem. Installing the most recent PROM revision may be
impractical however for an independent service facility, particularly if the latest PROM revision does
not address the specific driveability problem of the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4555
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID PROM/MEMCAL Identification
Marks
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 44-65-01
Date: October, 1994
Subject: New PROM/MEMCAL Identification Markings
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Note:
For the purposes of this document, the terms PROM and MEMCAL will be used interchangeably.
To simplify identification of service PROMs. a new external marking format will be implemented.
Parts manufactured after Sept. 1994 will feature these new markings. This change will place the full
8-digit service part number on the PROM, in place of the old 4-digit "EXTERNAL ID" number. In the
past, parts and service personnel could not identify a PROM without using a cross-reference table
that matched external IDs and service numbers. In the future, the cross-reference table will not be
required for PROMs; parts will be ordered directly from the number appearing on the PROM.
However, the label will retain the broadcast code alpha characters to allow continued use of
cross-reference charts, if so desired.
Old Marking Format:
New Marking Format:
^ Ordering the above PROM from the old marking format would require using a cross-reference
chart to determine a service part number, based on the BROAD CAST CODE and EXTERNAL ID
NUMBERS.
^ To order from the new format, simply combine the 2nd and 3rd lines to form an 8-digit part
number that can be directly ordered from SPO (number 16134624 in the above example).
As these changes are phased into the parts inventory, it should be noted that dealers will continue
to see parts with both formats for some time in the future. This is because:
^ Millions of vehicles have already been built with the old format.
^ SPO has existing stock of MEMCALs and PROMs with the old format.
^ PROMS with 7-digit part numbers (representing less than 10% of current part numbers) will
continue to use the old format. The 7-digit part numbers are easily identified because they always
begin with "122xxxx".
Due to manufacturing processes, more than one 8-digit part number may appear on a MEMCAL. In
this event, service personnel should use the label on the exterior cover of the MEMCAL assembly.
To avoid confusion, only the service label will include the BROAD CAST CODE, consisting of letter
characters (I.E., ARCL).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4556
CHANGES TO MEMCAL/PROM LABELING FORMATS
^ MEMCALs may use either INK-JET or ADHESIVE labels, as shown.
^ PROMs will always use ADHESIVE labels with the same format as shown for MEMCALs. These
changes will become effective on parts manufactured after 10/94.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4557
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID PROM/MEMCAL Identification
Marks
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 44-65-01
Date: October, 1994
Subject: New PROM/MEMCAL Identification Markings
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Note:
For the purposes of this document, the terms PROM and MEMCAL will be used interchangeably.
To simplify identification of service PROMs. a new external marking format will be implemented.
Parts manufactured after Sept. 1994 will feature these new markings. This change will place the full
8-digit service part number on the PROM, in place of the old 4-digit "EXTERNAL ID" number. In the
past, parts and service personnel could not identify a PROM without using a cross-reference table
that matched external IDs and service numbers. In the future, the cross-reference table will not be
required for PROMs; parts will be ordered directly from the number appearing on the PROM.
However, the label will retain the broadcast code alpha characters to allow continued use of
cross-reference charts, if so desired.
Old Marking Format:
New Marking Format:
^ Ordering the above PROM from the old marking format would require using a cross-reference
chart to determine a service part number, based on the BROAD CAST CODE and EXTERNAL ID
NUMBERS.
^ To order from the new format, simply combine the 2nd and 3rd lines to form an 8-digit part
number that can be directly ordered from SPO (number 16134624 in the above example).
As these changes are phased into the parts inventory, it should be noted that dealers will continue
to see parts with both formats for some time in the future. This is because:
^ Millions of vehicles have already been built with the old format.
^ SPO has existing stock of MEMCALs and PROMs with the old format.
^ PROMS with 7-digit part numbers (representing less than 10% of current part numbers) will
continue to use the old format. The 7-digit part numbers are easily identified because they always
begin with "122xxxx".
Due to manufacturing processes, more than one 8-digit part number may appear on a MEMCAL. In
this event, service personnel should use the label on the exterior cover of the MEMCAL assembly.
To avoid confusion, only the service label will include the BROAD CAST CODE, consisting of letter
characters (I.E., ARCL).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4558
CHANGES TO MEMCAL/PROM LABELING FORMATS
^ MEMCALs may use either INK-JET or ADHESIVE labels, as shown.
^ PROMs will always use ADHESIVE labels with the same format as shown for MEMCALs. These
changes will become effective on parts manufactured after 10/94.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4559
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Reading Technical Service
Bulletins
Always read any Technical Service Bulletins (TSB's) referenced before replacing a PROM.
Service bulletins list parts that must be installed when a PROM is changed, and provide information
on trouble codes, troubleshooting and driveability problems for which the PROM was released.
To find applicable TSB's:
Complete TSB Listing
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Vehicle" in the "Pull Right Menu". 2. Select the TSB
ICON. 3. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins by Number, Date, and Title". 4. Select "Sort by
Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 5. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
PROM TSB Listing Only
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Technical Service Bulletins" in the "Pull Right Menu".
2. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory". 3. Select
"Sort by Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 4. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 4560
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Reading Technical Service
Bulletins
Always read any Technical Service Bulletins (TSB's) referenced before replacing a PROM.
Service bulletins list parts that must be installed when a PROM is changed, and provide information
on trouble codes, troubleshooting and driveability problems for which the PROM was released.
To find applicable TSB's:
Complete TSB Listing
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Vehicle" in the "Pull Right Menu". 2. Select the TSB
ICON. 3. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins by Number, Date, and Title". 4. Select "Sort by
Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 5. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
PROM TSB Listing Only
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Technical Service Bulletins" in the "Pull Right Menu".
2. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory". 3. Select
"Sort by Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 4. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 1 Thru 50
[1] Also needs EGR P/N 1706739.
[2] Also requires EGR P/N 17111295.
[3] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067111, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[4] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067107, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[5] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17067144, EGR valve service P/N 17067110, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[6] PROM I.D. 7080 KJ is also acceptable for PROM I.D. 5853 KJ only. Requires Throttle Body
service P/N 17067144, EGR valve service P/N 17067108 (FED), 17067144 (CAL), Injector service
kit P/N 17067976.
[7] Required Throttle Body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067107 (FED),
17068210 (CAL), Injector service kit P/N 17067976.
[8] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17068019, EGR valve service P/N 17067109, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[9] For Federal - Use 01226047 (PROM CODE 7654 BKW). For California - Use 01226049 (PROM
CODE 7665 BKY).
[10] For Federal - Use 01226054. For California - Use 01226056
[11] For Federal - Use 01226055. For California - Use 01226057.
[12] For Federal - Use 01226046 (PROM CODE 7648 BKU). For California - Use 01226049
(PROM CODE 7665 BKY).
[13] For federal - Use 01226046 (PROM CODE 7648 BKU). For California - Use 01226048 (PROM
CODE 7659 BKX).
[14] ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16019710 (1225500).
[15] ECM may also be 16018161. ECM may also have been replaced by service ECM P/N
16018000 (1225330).
[16] ECM may also be 16018201. ECM may also have been replaced by service ECM P/N
16018000 (1225330).
[17] ECM may also be 16018211. ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16018000
(1225330).
[18] ECM may also be 16023761. ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16018000
(1225330).
[19] ECM may also be 16018101. ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16018000
(1225330).
[20] For 2-board ECM only.
[21] May need EGR valve P/N 17079563. Original equipment P/N 16029014.
[22] Original equipment PROM P/N 16017094, now 16025254
[23] Original equipment PROM P/N 16017224, now 16025264.
[24] Also needs EGR valve P/N 17079013. Original equipment PROM P/N 16030034 (PROM ID:
BOH).
[25] Requires kit P/N 25522748 containing: Wiring harness jumper P/N 12043500, Relay P/N
25522747, Foam P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[26] Needs EGR valve P/N 17079818.
[27] For (MY7) - Use 01226473 (SCAN I.D. = 3941). For (M19) - Use 01226474 (SCAN I.D. =
3951).
[28] For (MY7) or (M19, C60) - Use 01226473 (SCAN I.D. = 3941). For (M19) - Use 01226474
(SCAN I.D. = 3951).
[29] ECM may also be 16023561(M5), or 16033061(M4 with A/C).
[30] For F62 axle - Use 01226441 (SCAN I.D. = 3622). For F17 axle - Use 01226439 (SCAN I.D. =
3332).
[31] For one_board ECM only.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4563
[32] Requires Thermac Sensor P/N 8997916.
[33] For Federal - Use 01227729 (SCAN I.D. = 7729). For California - Use 01227728 (SCAN I.D. =
7728).
[34] Use 01227629 (SCAN I.D. = 7629) only to resolve surge or chuggle.
[35] Use 01227381 (SCAN I.D. = 7381) only to resolve chuggle.
[36] Use 01227386 (SCAN I.D. = 7386) only to resolve chuggle.
[37] Retrofit PROM - Does not supersede the regular replacement service PROM. To be used only
as required to resolve cases of chuggle.
[38] Retrofit PROM - Supersedes all previous service PROM part numbers. To be used as both the
regular service replacement (PROM-damaged or
defective), and to resolve cases of chuggle.
[39] Retrofit PROM - Supersedes all previous service PROM part numbers. To be used as both the
regular service replacement (PROM-damaged or
defective), and to resolve cases of chuggle, detonation, or flatness.
[40] Retrofit PROM - Does not supersede the regular replacement service PROMS. To be used
only as required to resolve cases of chuggle, detonation,
or flatness.
[41] Need EGR valve P/N 17111577 (Federal only).
[42] For use with P215/65 tires - use 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). For use with P235/60,
P245/50 tires - use 01228291 (SCAN I.D. = 8291).
[43] For use with P215/65 tires - use 01228292 (SCAN I.D. - 8292). For use with P235/60, P245/50
tires - use 01228293 (SCAN I.D. = 8293).
[44] Use 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764,
Fuel Sender P/N 25093526). Use 16143459 (SCAN
I.D. = 3571) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[45] Use 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764,
Fuel Sender P/N 25093526). Use 16143453 (SCAN
I.D. = 3501) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[46] Use 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764).
Use 16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) for Code 42,
Spark Knock, High Idle.
[47] Use 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764).
Use 16143462 (SCAN I.D. = 3591) for Code 42,
Spark Knock, High Idle.
[48] Use 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115925,
Fuel Sender P/N 25092778). Use 16143466 (SCAN
I.D. = 3481) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[49] Use 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115925,
Fuel Sender P/N 25092778). Use 16143463 (SCAN
I.D. = 3451) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[50] Needs air injection service kit (P/N 10115773) and new vehicle emission control label.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4564
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 51 Thru 100
[51] Must be ordered with service kit P/N 10115773.
[52] With this PROM installed, use 1987-88 2.8L speed density engine driveability and emissions
manual.
[53] PROM update eliminates MAF sensor, replacing it with a speed density system. With a 1990
or earlier primary cartridge, I.D. vehicle on scanner
as a 1989 model (VIN = K-1-W).
[54] For 2WD use 16120099 (SCAN I.D. = 9941). For 4WD use 16120109 (SCAN I.D. = 9901).
[55] For 2.73 (GU2) Axle use 16120077 (SCAN I.D. = 9891). For 3.08 (GU4) Axle use 16120082
(SCAN I.D. = 9901). For 3.42 (GU6) and 3.73
(GT4) Axles use 16120086 (SCAN I.D. = 9911).
[56] For 2WD use 16120042 (SCAN I.D. = 9991). For 4WD use 16120129 (SCAN I.D. = 0011).
[57] Needs accelerator pump check ball spring P/N 17069583.
[58] For false Code 44 on long coast down, use retrofit service PROM 01228486 AAND 1050. For
regular service replacement, use PROM 16062797
AAND 2798.
[59] For false Code 44 on long coast down, use retrofit service PROM 01228487 AANF 1052. For
regular service replacement, use PROM 16062801
AANF 2802.
[60] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) For hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764,
Fuel Sender P/N 25093744). Use 16143465 (SCAN
I.D. = 3471) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[61] With this PROM installed, use 1987-88 2.8L speed density engine driveability and emissions
manual.
[62] For use with model C1 Trucks - Use 16121162 (SCAN I.D. = 3511). For use with model C2, K,
K2, AND K1000 Trucks - use 16121166 (SCAN
I.D. = 3521).
[63] Also requires installation of new EGR valve package P/N 17112238 (Contains EGR valve P/N
17090078 and a gasket).
[64] Use 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) for cold start stall. Use 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[65] Use 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) for cold start stall. Use 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[66] Use 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) for cold start stall. Use 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[67] Do not rely on the scanner ID to determine which PROM is in a vehicle. Look at the BCC on
the PROM to be sure. Do not confuse with some
1991 models with a 2.84 axle ratio and a Federal emissions pkg which used scanner ID 5644 but
had a BCC of AWJD.
[68] This PROM may have a negative impact on fuel economy.
[69] Cannot be used on vehicles that do not have digital EGR valves.
[70] Use 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) for cold start stall. Use 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[71] Use 16181883 (SCAN I.D. = 0894) for cold start stall. Use 16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[72] Use 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) for cold start stall. Use 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[73] This PROM may have a negative impact on fuel economy.
[74] PROM can only be used with ECM P/N 16144288.
[75] Make certain the vehicle has been updated with previously attempted service fixes as follows:
EGR valve P/N 17090156 (stamped on valve)
17112373 (GMSPO kit), PCV valve P/N 25098542, ESC module P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4565
[76] For vehicles with sleeve bearing engines.
[77] Combination detonation and neutral gear rattle PROM available.
[78] Needs ESC P/N 16175099.
[79] Model 2DDM Transmissions - Check dealer records to see if the torque converter has already
been replaced with P/N 8650935 (Tagged BCC:
DGAF). Trans. with torque converters with P/N 8656959 (Tagged BCC: DG5F) need to replace it
with P/N 8650935.
[80] For dedicated natural gas vehicles. Order with kit P/N 12545589 unless the only problem is
idle fluctuation.
[81] For chuggle at 40-45 condition, use PROM only. For tip-in hesitation only, use EGR valve only
- P/N 17078431. For cold driveability hesitation,
use both PROM and EGR.
[82] Requires supplementary tune-up label, spark bypass relay kit P/N 14086983, spark plugs P/N
5614009, sun visor starting label P/N 14085150.
Also, remove and discard fuse labeled "crank" from fuse BLK #2 position (3 Amp. Fuse).
[83] Manual transmission cars should also be updated with the clutch anticipate switch per dealer
service bulletin number. 91-472-7C.
[84] Cold driveability, use with PROM 0051 AAF (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[85] Cold driveability, use with PROM 0050 AAF (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[86] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5884 BH (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17068019, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067109, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[87] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5869 BH (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17068019, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067109, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[88] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5779 KB (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067110, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[89] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5778 KB (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067110, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[90] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5854 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7080 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5853 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[91] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5853 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7080 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5853 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[92] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5861 KK (G057). REQUIRED THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[93] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5860 KK (G057). REQUIRED THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[94] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5786 LW
(G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067107, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[95] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5785 LW
(G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067107, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[96] Cold driveability, use with PROM 7088 LY (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[97] Cold driveability, use with PROM 7087 LY (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[98] Chuggle at 40-45 mph, cold driveability hesitation. FOR CHUGGLE AT 40-45 CONDITION,
USE PROM ONLY. FOR TIP-IN HESITATION
ONLY, USE EGR VALVE ONLY - P/N 17078431. FOR COLD DRIVEABILITY HESITATION, USE
BOTH PROM AND EGR.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4566
[99] Driveability correction for heavy chuggle. REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748 CONTAINING:
WIRING HARNESS JUMPER P/N 12043500,
RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[100] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4567
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 101 Thru 150
[101] Driveability correction for heavy chuggle. REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748 CONTAINING:
WIRING HARNESS JUMPER P/N 12043500,
RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[102] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[103] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[104] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[105] Surge. RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE REGULAR REPLACEMENT
SERVICE PROM. TO BE USED ONLY AS
REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[106] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[107] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[108] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[109] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[110] Surge. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM PART
NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH THE
REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE
CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[111] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[112] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[113] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[114] Surge, flatness or tip-in hesitation. RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE
REGULAR REPLACEMENT SERVICE PROMS.
TO BE USED ONLY AS REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR
FLATNESS.
[115] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228291 (SCAN
I.D. = 8291).
[116] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228291 (SCAN
I.D. = 8291).
[117] Spark knock only. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[118] Spark knock only. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[119] Spark knock. USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143460
(SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[120] Detonation. USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143462
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4568
(SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[121] Stall, sags, hesitation. USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[122] USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764). USE 16143460 (SCAN I.D. =
3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[123] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[124] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[125] USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[126] USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[127] USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[128] USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[129] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[130] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[131] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[132] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[133] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[134] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on clutch operation, with manual transmission equipped vehicle. WITH THIS
PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND
EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[135] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle. WITH
THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND
EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[136] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[137] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[138] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[139] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4569
[140] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[141] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[142] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[143] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[144] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[145] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[146] PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER
PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[147] PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER
PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[148] PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER
PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[149] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle. PROM
UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[150] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle. PROM
UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4570
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 151 Thru 200
[151] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[152] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[153] Driveability improvement and eliminate FALSE "Service Engine Soon" lights. FOR 2WD USE
16120099 (SCAN I.D. = 9941). FOR 4WD
USE 16120109 (SCAN I.D. = 9901).
[154] Driveability improvement and eliminate FALSE "Service Engine Soon" lights. FOR 2.73
(GU2) AXLE USE 16120077 (SCAN I.D. = 9891).
FOR 3.08 (GU4) AXLE USE 16120082 (SCAN I.D. = 9901). FOR 3.42 (GU6) AND 3.73 (GT4)
AXLES USE 16120086 (SCAN I.D. = 9911).
[155] Driveability improvement and eliminate FALSE "Service Engine Soon" lights. FOR 2WD USE
16120042 (SCAN I.D. = 9991). FOR 4WD
USE 16120129 (SCAN I.D. = 0011).
[156] Prom calibration. FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT
SERVICE PROM 01228486 AAND 1050. FOR
REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062797 AAND 2798.
[157] FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT SERVICE PROM
01228487 AANF 1052. FOR REGULAR SERVICE
REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062801 AANF 2802.
[158] Spark knock only. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[159] Spark knock only. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[160] Detonation. USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143462
(SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[161] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093744).
USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[162] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[163] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093744).
USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[164] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[165] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[166] Hard start when hot and detonation. USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD
RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N
25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778). USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42,
SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[167] Hard start when hot and detonation. USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD
RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N
25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778). USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42,
SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[168] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[169] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[170] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4571
[171] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. MUST BE ORDERED WITH SERVICE KIT P/N
10115773.
[172] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[173] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[174] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[175] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[176] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[177] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[178] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[179] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[180] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[181] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[182] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[183] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[184] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[185] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[186] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[187] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[188] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4572
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[189] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[190] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[191] Information on PROM calibrations. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[192] Information on PROM calibrations. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[193] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[194] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[195] FOR USE WITH MODEL C1 TRUCKS - USE 16121162 (SCAN I.D. = 3511). FOR USE
WITH MODEL C2, K, K2, AND K1000 TRUCKS USE 16121166 (SCAN I.D. = 3521).
[196] Engine surge. ALSO REQUIRES INSTALLATION OF NEW EGR VALVE PACKAGE P/N
17112238 (CONTAINS EGR VALVE P/N
17090078 AND A GASKET).
[197] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[198] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[199] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[200] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4573
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 201 Thru 250
[201] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[202] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[203] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[204] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[205] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[206] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[207] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[208] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[209] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[210] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[211] Engine stall, long cranks/idle/decel/surge. CANNOT BE USED ON VEHICLES THAT DO
NOT HAVE DIGITAL EGR VALVES.
[212] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[213] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[214] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[215] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[216] Cold start extended crank. Engine starts with ignition key cycled. USE 16181883 (SCAN I.D.
= 0894) FOR COLD START STALL. USE
16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND
CHUGGLE.
[217] Cold start extended crank, engine starts with ignition key cycled. USE 16181883 (SCAN I.D.
= 0894) FOR COLD START STALL. USE
16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND
CHUGGLE.
[218] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[219] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[220] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[221] Surge or chuggle on decel and/or rough idle. PROM CAN ONLY BE USED WITH ECM P/N
16144288.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4574
[222] Surge or chuggle on decel and/or rough idle. PROM CAN ONLY BE USED WITH ECM P/N
16144288.
[223] Engine stall. MANUAL TRANSMISSION CARS SHOULD ALSO BE UPDATED WITH THE
CLUTCH ANTICIPATE SWITCH PER
DEALER SERVICE BULLETIN NO. 91-472-7C.
[224] USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D.
= 5624) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[225] USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D.
= 5644) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[226] USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D.
= 5644) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[227] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[228] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[229] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[230] Surge or chuggle on decel and/or rough idle. PROM CAN ONLY BE USED WITH ECM P/N
16144288.
[231] MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR
VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N
25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[232] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[233] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[234] Driveablity improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[235] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[236] Center Port Fuel Injection noise. FOR VEHICLES WITH SLEEVE BEARING ENGINES.
[237] Neutral gear rattle only. COMBINATION DETONATION AND NEUTRAL GEAR RATTLE
PROM AVAILABLE.
[238] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[239] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANSMISSIONS - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF
THE TORQUE CONVERTER HAS
ALREADY BEEN REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935 (TAGGED BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH
TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959 (TAGGED BCC: DG5F) NEED TO REPLACE IT
WITH P/N 8650935.
[240] Unstable idle in park or neutral/poor driveability. FOR DEDICATED NATURAL GAS
VEHICLES. ORDER WITH KIT P/N 12545589
UNLESS THE ONLY PROBLEM IS IDLE FLUCTUATION.
[241] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[242] Information on PROM calibrations. CANNOT BE USED ON VEHICLES THAT DO NOT
HAVE DIGITAL EGR VALVES.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4575
[243] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANSMISSIONS - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF
THE TORQUE CONVERTER HAS
ALREADY BEEN REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935 (TAGGED BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH
TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959 (TAGGED BCC: DG5F) NEED TO REPLACE IT
WITH P/N 8650935.
[244] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANSMISSIONS - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF
THE TORQUE CONVERTER HAS
ALREADY BEEN REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935 (TAGGED BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH
TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959 (TAGGED BCC: DG5F) NEED TO REPLACE IT
WITH P/N 8650935.
[245] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle.
[246] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle.
[247] Check engine light comes on while idling on vehicles equipped with Computer Controlled
Emission System (C.C.E.S.), driven in altitudes above
3000 feet.
[248] Engine may stop running during parking maneuver or during coast down at low speeds during
ambient temperature above 85°F.
[249] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle.
[250] Surge on acceleration and/or at road load speeds, false "Service Engine Soon" light (CODE
32), poor driveability during warm up, Detonation
under load.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4576
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 251 Thru 300
[251] Hesitation or sag during the first two minutes of cold operation while vehicle is under
moderate to heavy throttle drive away, or TCC chuggle.
[252] Cold start-stall, hesitation, or sag when the engine coolant is between 36°F to 111°F (2°C to
44°C); or Inadequate AC performance when driving
at a steady speed and throttle position, between 24 to 64 MPH, when the cruise control is not being
used.
[253] Lack of throttle response on trucks equipped with governors; or hot restart driveaway sag,
both governor and non-governor trucks.
[254] Intermittent stall after cold start; engine stalling on coast down; hesitation cold; or ECM
CODES E22,E26,E32,E55,E70, and/or E85
[255] PROM I.D. 7080 KJ is also acceptable for PROM I.D. 5853 KJ only. Requires Throttle body
service P/N 17067144, EGR valve] service P/N
17067108 (FED), 17067144 (CAL), Injector service kit P/N 17067976.
[256] Requires Throttle body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067107 (FED),
17068210 (CAL), Injector service kit P/N 17067976.
[257] FOR CHUGGLE AT 40-45 CONDITION, USE PROM ONLY. FOR TIP-IN HESITATION
ONLY, USE EGR VALVE ONLY - P/N
17078431. FOR COLD DRIVEABILITY HESITATION, USE BOTH PROM AND EGR.
[258] REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 015
14086983, SPARK PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN
VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 015 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND DISCARD FUSE LABELED
"CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[259] DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE.
LOOK AT THE BCC ON THE PROM TO
BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A
FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT HAD A
[260] DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE.
LOOK AT THE BCC ON THE PROM TO
BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A
FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT HAD A
[261] DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE.
LOOK AT THE BCC ON THE PROM TO
BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A
FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT HAD A
[262] MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY AT TEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR
VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N
25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[263] MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR
VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N
25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[264] MODEL 2DDM TRANS. CARS - CHECK DLR. RECORDS TO SEE IF THE TORQUE
CONVERTER HAS ALREADY BEEN REPLACED
WITH PN 8650935 (BCC: DGAF). TRANSMISSIONS WITH TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH PN
8656959 (BCC: DG5F) NEED TO HAVE THE TORQUE CONVERTER REPLACED W
[265] MODEL 2DDM TRANS. CARS - CHECK DLR. RECORDS TO SEE IF THE TORQUE
CONVERTER HAS ALREADY BEEN REPLACED
WITH PN 8650935 (BCC: DGAF). TRANSMISSIONS WITH TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH PN
8656959 (BCC: DG5F) NEED TO HAVE THE TORQUE CONVERTER REPLACED W
[266] Vehicles equipped with Computer Controlled Emission System (C.C.E.S) experience a Check
Engine Light coming on while idling, usually when
idling time exceeds 2 minutes with transmission in gear in altitudes above 3000 feet.
[267] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5854 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7080 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5853 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[268] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5853 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7079 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5854 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[269] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5861 KK (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4577
[270] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5860 KK (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[271] Tip-in hesitation, lack low speed performance. Used with Manual transaxle vehicles with A/C
only. Requires EGR TVS P/N 373510, and A.I.R.
valve P/N 17082701.
[272] Weak drive-away after cold start, requires EGR TVS P/N 373510. Also, for CALIFORNIA
emissions, manual transaxle, replace A.I.R.
management valve with PN 17082701.
[273] Level road surge, tip-in hesitation, lack of low speed performance - for automatic transaxles
only. (Requires EGR valve P/N 17068212). FOR
FEDERAL - USE 01226055. FOR CALIFORNIA - USE 01226057.
[274] Stall in coast down with clutch disengaged and A/C on, weak drive away after cold start ,
requires EGR TVS P/N 373510. Also, for
CALIFORNIA emissions, manual transaxle, replace A.I.R. management valve with PN 17082701.
[275] Idle shake, detonation (G043). FOR 2.5L EFI, AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE, AND FIRST
DESIGN (3-BOARD) ECM. THE SECOND
DESIGN (2-BOARD) ECM HAS THE SPARK REVISION ALREADY INCORPORATED IN ITS
PROM.
[276] Chuggle/surge at 40-45 MPH, tip-in hesitation/sag, spark knock, requires EGR valve (G032).
FOR CHUGGLE AT 40-45 CONDITION, USE
PROM ONLY. FOR TIP-IN HESITATION ONLY, USE EGR VALVE ONLY - P/N 17078431. FOR
COLD DRIVEABILITY HESITATION, USE BOTH PROM AND EGR.
[277] Chuggle and surge at 35-55 MPH, requires EGR kit. REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748
CONTAINING: WIRING HARNESS JUMPER P/N
12043500, RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[278] CODE 42, spark knock, cold startability, plug fouling (G040). REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY
TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK BYPASS RELAY
KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150.
ALSO, REMOVE AND DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3
AMP. FUSE).
[279] Chuggle and surge at 35-55 MPH, requires EGR kit (G040). REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748
CONTAINING: WIRING HARNESS JUMPER
P/N 12043500, RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[280] Cold hesitation/sag, warm surge (G082). RETROFIT PROM SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS
SERVICE PROM PART NUMBERS. TO BE
USED AS BOTH THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OF
DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[281] TCC chuggle or surge (G043). WHEN INSTALLING PROM IN A CANADIAN 1985 NB, A
CODE 13 WILL OCCUR AS THE VEHICLE
WAS NOT EQUIPPED WITH AN O2 SENSOR. TO ELIMINATE THE CODE 13, NEED TO
INSTALL O2 SENSOR # 8990741 AND CONNECT TO THE EXISTING PURPLE WIRE AND
CONNECTOR IN THE
[282] Surge or chuggle at 52-60 MPH (G071). RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE
REGULAR REPLACEMENT SERVICE
PROM. TO BE USED ONLY AS REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[283] Surge or chuggle at 52-60 MPH (G071). RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL
PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM PART NUMBERS. TO BE
USED AS BOTH THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR
DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[284] Chuggle, hesitation, tip-in spark knock. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS
SERVICE PROM PART NUMBERS. TO BE
USED AS BOTH THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR
DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[285] Chuggle, hesitation, tip-in spark knock. RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE
REGULAR REPLACEMENT SERVICE
PROMS. TO BE USED ONLY AS REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE,
DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[286] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228291 (SCAN
I.D. = 8291).
[287] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228292 (SCAN I.D. = 8292). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228293 (SCAN
I.D. = 8293).
[288] FALSE CODES 33, 34, 43, rough idle, chuggle, hesitation (G006,G007). USED WITH VIN
#119016 OR LATER ALUMINUM HEAD
CORVETTES AND ALL CONVERTIBLE MODELS WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION, 2.59
(GM1) AXLE ONLY.
[289] FALSE CODES 33, 34, 43, rough idle, chuggle, hesitation (G006,G007). USED FOR VIN
#119016 OR LATER ALUMINUM HAED
CORVETTES AND ALL CONVERTIBLE MODELS WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION, 2.73
(GU2)/3.07 (G44) AXLE ONLY.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4578
[290] Spark knock. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[291] Spark knock. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[292] Spark knock (G055). USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[293] Spark knock (G043). USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143462 (SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[294] Stalling, tip-in hesitation/sag, rough idle, cold driveability. USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541)
FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK
KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[295] Hard hot restart (requires rubber bumper pkg PN 25004553, and a pulsator package PN
25094266), or CODE 42, intermittent high idle, spark
knock (G055).
[296] USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764). USE 16143460 (SCAN I.D. =
3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[297] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[298] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[299] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[300] Spark knock. USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4579
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 301 Thru 350
[301] Spark knock. USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[302] Hard start hot (requires installation of a rubber bumper pkg PN 25004553, and a pulsator pkg
PN 25094266) or CODE 42, high idle, spark knock
(G055).
[303] USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[304] Hard hot restart (requires rubber bumper pkg PN 25004553, and a pulsator package PN
25094266), or CODE 42, intermittent high idle, spark
knock (G055).
[305] USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[306] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY
ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[307] CODES 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[308] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[309] Code 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS
A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[310] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A
SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE
ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[311] High emissions, exhaust odor, starting and driveability problems (G046). Requires Connector
Bleed Assembly P/N 10105820
[312] FALSE CODES 43, 54, unstable idle. FOR 2.73 (GU2) AXLE USE 16120077 (SCAN I.D. =
9891). FOR 3.08 (GU4) AXLE USE 16120082
(SCAN I.D. = 9901). FOR 3.42 (GU6) AND 3.73 (GT4) AXLES USE 16120086 (SCAN I.D. = 9911).
[313] Running change. FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT
SERVICE PROM 01228486 SCAN I.D. 8486, AAND
1050. FOR REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062797 SCAN I.D. 2223, AAND
2798.
[314] Running change. FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT
SERVICE PROM 01228487 SCAN I.D. 8487, AANF
1052. FOR REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062801 SCAN I.D. 2233, AANF
2802.
[315] Surge on acceleration and/or at road load speeds, false "Service Engine Soon" light (CODE
32), poor driveability during warm up, Detonation
under load (G052).
[316] Spark knock. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[317] Spark knock. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[318] Spark knock (G043). USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143462 (SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[319] Spark knock (G055). USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093744). USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[320] CODE 42, spark knock, intermittent high idle. IF MAJOR CONDITION IS HARD HOT
ENGINE RESTART, PROM ALSO REQUIRES
INSTALLATION OF A RUBBER BUMPER PKG PN 25004553, AND PULSATOR PKG PN
25094266.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4580
[321] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093744).
USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[322] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[323] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[324] Spark knock. USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[325] Spark knock. USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[326] Tip-in hesitation, stall, CODES 23, 25, 33, or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY
ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[327] CODES 23, 25, 33, 34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH
A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A
1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL
(VIN = K-1-W).
[328] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/ man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[329] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/ man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A
SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE
ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[330] CODES 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[331] Code 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS
A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[332] FOR USE WITH MODEL C1 TRUCKS - USE 16121162 (SCAN I.D. = 3511). FOR USE
WITH MODEL C2, K, K2, AND K1000 TRUCKS USE 16121166 (SCAN I.D. = 3521).
[333] Surge on acceleration and/or at road load speeds, false "Service Engine Soon" light (CODE
32), poor driveability during warm up, Detonation
under load (G052).
[334] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[335] [Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) FOR COLD START
STALL. USE 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[336] Engine does not stay running on initial cold start and chuggle at 35-45 MPH with TCC
engaged. New MEM-CAL may affect fuel economy. DO
NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT
THE BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH
A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH SCANNER ID 5644 BUT A
BCC OF A]
[337] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[338] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[339] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[340] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4581
[341] Hesitation or sag during the first two minutes of cold operation while vehicle is under
moderate to heavy throttle driveaway, or TCC chuggle.
[342] Cold start-stall, hesitation, or sag when the engine coolant is between 36°F - 111°F (2°C 44°C); or Inadequate A/C performance when driving at
steady speed and throttle position, between 24 - 64 MPH, when the cruise control is not being
used.
[343] Engine does not stay running on initial cold start and chuggle at 35-45 MPH with TCC
engaged. New MEM-CAL may affect fuel economy. DO
NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT
THE BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH
A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH SCANNER ID 5644 BUT A
BCC OF A
[344] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[345] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[346] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181883 (SCAN I.D. = 0894) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[347] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[348] Service Engine Soon light (SES) with a code 43 or tip-in sag, tip-in hesitation, surge at WOT,
or spark detonation when cold.
[349] Engine stall. MANUAL TRANSMISSION CARS SHOULD ALSO BE UPDATED WITH THE
CLUTCH ANTICIPATE SWITCH PER
DEALER SERVICE BULLETIN NO. 91-472-7C.
[350] Engine does not stay running on initial cold start and chuggle at 35-45 MPH with TCC
engaged. New MEM-CAL may affect fuel economy. DO
NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT
THE BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH
A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH SCANNER ID 5644 BUT A
BCC OF A.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 4582
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 351 Thru 400
[351] USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D.
= 5624) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[352] USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D.
= 5644) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[353] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[354] Lack of throttle response on trucks equipped with governors; or hot restart driveaway sag,
both governor and non-governor trucks.
[355] Low speed driveability or detonation. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED
WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373
(GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[356] Tip-in hesitation, sag, backfire, spark knock. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN
UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373
(GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[357] Hesitation or sag during the first two minutes of cold operation while vehicle is under
moderate to heavy throttle driveaway, or TCC chuggle.
[358] Sustained detonation/knock. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONS REQUIRE TORQUE
CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) CALIBRATION. USE
OF THIS PROM IN A NON-DETONATING ENGINE MAY RESULT IN DEGRADED
DRIVEABILITY.
[359] High emissions, exhaust odor, starting and driveability problems (G046). Requires Connector
Bleed Assembly P/N 10105820
[360] Neutral gear rattle. MAY ALSO REQUIRE CLUTCH DRIVEN PLATE P/N 15961141, AND
CLUTCH PILOT BEARING P/N 14061685.
COMBINATION DETONATION AND NEUTRAL GEAR RATTLE PROM AVAILABLE.
[361] Malfunction Indicator Lamp (check engine light) illuminates and may set a DTC 24 (VSS
Circuit Fault) during a California State Emissions Test.
[362] Higher than normal hydrocarbon emissions during the idle portion of the inspection and
maintenance test. Also, may exhibit a slight detonation
during a light throttle acceleration
[363] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANS. - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF THE
TORQUE CONVERTER HAS BEEN REPLACED
WITH P/N 8650935 (BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959
(BCC: DG5F) NEED TO HAVE THE TORQUE CONVERTER REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935.
[364] Cold start stall, cold tip in hesitation and/or a cold rough idle after extended idling.
Additionally, in 40-50°F ambient temp., fogging on the
inside of the front windshield which does not clear with the defroster on occurs.
[365] Poor throttle response, stall, misfire, poor cold or hot start, extended crank of the starter with
a hot engine, and/or vehicle will start and then stall
when the engine is hot. MT vehicles may also experience decel. stall and poor accel. performance.
[366] Poor throttle response, stalling, misfire, poor cold or hot starting, extended cranking of the
starter with a hot engine, and/or vehicle will start and
then stall when the engine is hot. USED WITH MANUAL TRANSMISSION ONLY.
[367] MIL illuminates and/or store a DTC 32 (EGR error) with no noticeable driveability concern,
usually occurring while climbing a grade.
[368] MIL illuminates and/or store a DTC 32 (EGR error) with no noticeable driveability concern,
usually occurring while climbing a grade, towing a
trailer or driving into a strong head wind.
[369] High emissions, exhaust odor, starting and driveability problems (G046). Requires Connector
Bleed Assembly P/N 10105820
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Page 4583
Prom Information
Scan Prom Prom Prom Superseding
ID Code Bcc Part # ID Part # TSB Reference #
0375 0369 BMTA 16210369
0825 0820 BKFK 16200819
Running change.
4005 4008 BKZM 16204004 Chevrolet 476501
DTC 32. GMC Truck 476501
4565 4570 BHCN 16194569
4575 4573 BHCP 16194572
6605 6533 BHYZ 16196532
Running change.
6905 6856 BJAY 16196854
6985 6887 BJBB 16196884
6995 6892 BJBC 16196890
7465 7466 BJFC 16197464
Running change.
7475 7469 BJFD 16197468
7735 7737 BJHW 16197736
8085 8053 BJLA 16198052
8095 8057 BJLB 16198056
8105 8060 BJLC 16198059 0825 16200819
8371 9367 AYXY 16169366
8465 8494 BDSD 16188493
8475 8511 BDSF 16188510
8535 8642 BDSN 16188640 6605 16196532
8561 9452 AYYX 16169450
8581 9460 AYYZ 16169459
9295 9308 BDWZ 16189307
9305 9312 BDXA 16189310
9335 9324 BDXD 16189323
9365 9336 BDXJ 16189334
9375 9339 BDXK 16189338
9425 9358 BDXR 16189357
9435 9362 BDXS 16189360 7465 16197464
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Page 4584
9525 9527 BDYT 16189526
9545 9537 BDYW 16189536
9555 9540 BDYX 16189539
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation CALPAK
CAUTION:
If the computer is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old CALPAK and
PROM, then place both into the replacement computer. When replacing the COMPUTER always
transfer the BROADCAST CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on
the replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
The resistor network calibration called a CALPAK is located inside the computer. Its appearance
and service is similar to the PROM. The CALPAK allows fuel to be delivered if other parts of the
computer fail. The CALPAK provides the computer with calibrations for:
^ Cold Start Cranking.
^ Limp home fuel (fuel backup mode).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 4587
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation EEPROM
CAUTION:
The EEPROM is soldered to the COMPUTER and cannot be serviced separately. Reprogramming
of EEPROM information is necessary when replacing a COMPUTER, or when changing the engine
and/or transaxle calibrations. Failure to do this will cause the vehicle to have a no start or poor
running condition.
It is essential that a replacement COMPUTER be reprogrammed with the correct VIN, option
content, tire size, and calibration information. Reprogramming of the EEPROM is only possible with
the Service Stall System (SSS) hardware available at authorized dealer locations. Check with a
dealer before performing COMPUTER replacement or EEPROM reprogramming.
DESCRIPTION:
The term EEPROM is defined as Electronically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM) in the COMPUTER. The EEPROM stores vehicle information such as engine and
transaxle calibrations, vehicle identification number, programmable vehicle option content and
MALF history. Vehicle information stored on the EEPROM has a major effect on how the vehicle
will operate.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 4588
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation EPROM
CAUTION:
The EPROM is serviceable in some applications and can be removed for replacement. If the
COMPUTER is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old EPROM if applicable
and place into the new computer. When replacing the COMPUTER always transfer the
BROADCAST CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on the
replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
The term EPROM means Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM). The EPROM
functions in the same manner as a regular PROM and is programmed with data pertaining to the
vehicles weight, engine, transmission, axle ratio etc. Automotive technicians do not ERASE or
PROGRAM the EPROM in the field. Instead, the EPROM is serviced in one of two manners. Some
applications are soldered to the circuit board and require both the computer and EPROM to be
replaced as a complete unit. Other applications allow for the EPROM only to replaced.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 4589
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation MEMCAL
CAUTION:
If the COMPUTER is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old MEMCAL and
place it into the replacement computer. When replacing the COMPUTER always transfer the
BROADCAST CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on the
replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
The MEMCAL assembly contains both the functions of the PROM and the CALPAK. Like the
PROM, it contains the calibrations needed for a specific vehicle. It also is the fuel back up control
for the computer should it become damaged or faulty.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 4590
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation PROM
CAUTION:
If the computer is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old PROM and place it
into the replacement computer. Some ECM's are equipped with another chip called a CALPAK. If
the computer is equipped with a CALPAK chip, it will be located next to the PROM and must be
transferred along with the PROM. When replacing the computer always transfer the BROADCAST
CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on the replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
To allow one type of computer to be used for many different vehicles, a device called a
Programable Read Only Memory (PROM) unit is used. The PROM is located inside the computer
and has system calibration information based upon the vehicle's axle ratio, engine, transmission,
weight, and other specific configurations of the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4591
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Testing and Inspection
Some control modules may have problems due to cracked solder joints on the circuit board. These
internal control module problems can cause the following symptoms:
^ Failure to start or vehicle is stalling.
^ The "CHECK ENGINE" "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or "MALFUNCTION INDICATOR" light will
flash or light up, but no trouble codes will be present.
^ Vehicle instrument panel displays may be inoperative.
^ The control module may or may not communicate with the scanner.
^ Other intermittent driveability problems.
Incorrect PROM or MEMCAL removal and replacement can create solder joint problems or
aggravate an existing condition. See PROM or MEMCAL INSTALLATION for proper procedures.
If a solder joint problem results in a "hard" failure, normal test procedures will usually pinpoint a
faulty control module. Many symptoms caused by poor solder joints in the control module result in
intermittent problems, but they may be hard to duplicate during troubleshooting. Control modules
with solder joint problems are sensitive to heat and vibration. You can check for these internal
control module problems in either, or both, of the following ways:
^ Remove the control module from its mounting bracket and extend it on the harness so that you
can expose it to the vehicle heater ducts. Alternatively, use the flexible duct to route air from the
heater to the control module location. Then run the engine and operate the heater at the "MAX
HEAT" position. This exposes the control module to approximately 140°F.
^ With the engine running, tap on the control module several times with your hand or finger tips to
simulate vehicle vibration.
If the engine stumbles or stalls, the "CHECK ENGINE" "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or
"MALFUNCTION INDICATOR" light flashes, or any of the previous symptoms occur, the control
module may have bad solder joints on the circuit board.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair CALPAK
1. Remove ECM from vehicle.
2. Remove ECM access cover.
3. Remove Calibration Pack (CALPAK) using removal tool shown. Grasp the CALPAK carrier on
the narrow ends only. Gently rock the carrier from
end to end while applying a firm upward force.
4. Inspect the reference end of the CALPAK carrier and carefully set aside. Do not remove the
CALPAK from the carrier to confirm CALPAK
correctness. The notch in the CALPAK is referenced to the small notch in the carrier. The small
notch of the carrier must be aligned with the small notch in the socket.
CAUTION: ANY TIME THE CALPAK IS INSTALLED BACKWARDS AND THE IGNITION SWITCH
IS TURNED ON, THE CALPAK IS DESTROYED.
5. Install the CALPACK by pressing on the CALPAK carrier until it is firmly seated in the socket. Do
not press on the CALPAK, only the carrier.
6. Install ECM access cover.
7. Install ECM and perform a DIAGNOSTIC CIRCUIT CHECK to confirm proper installation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 4594
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair EEPROM
CAUTION:
The Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) is a permanent memory that is
physically soldered to the circuit boards within the computer. It is not serviceable and should not be
removed for replacement. If COMPUTER replacement is performed, reprogramming of the
EEPROM will be necessary. Failure to do this will cause the vehicle to have a no start or poor
running condition. Reprogramming of the EEPROM is only possible with the Service Stall System
(SSS) hardware available at authorized dealer locations. Check with a dealer before performing
COMPUTER replacement or EEPROM reprogramming.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 4595
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair EPROM
REMOVAL:
^ DO NOT remove an EPROM from its packing material until you are ready to install it. DO NOT
hold an EPROM by its pins.
^ Before entering a vehicle to remove or replace an EPROM, touch an exposed metal part of the
vehicle to discharge any static charge from your body or use anti-static wrist straps. Avoid sliding
across upholstery or carpeting when removing or installing an EPROM. If this is not possible, touch
an exposed metal part of the vehicle with your free hand before removing or replacing an EPROM.
^ When available, use an antistatic grounding strap attached to your wrist and clipped to a metal
part of the vehicle body to prevent static charges from accumulating. Antistatic conductive
floormats are also available.
^ It may be desirable to remove the computer for EPROM replacement.
^ Remove computer access cover.
^ Unlock the locking levers by pressing outward toward the sides of the EPROM.
^ Remove EPROM from its socket
INSTALLATION:
EPROM/MEM-CAL Unit Installation
^ Install the replacement EPROM in the same direction.
^ VERY GENTLY PRESS down on the ends of the EPROM until the locking levers are rotated
toward the sides of the EPROM.
^ NOTE: To avoid Computer damage, do not press on the ends of the EPROM until the levers
snap into place. Do not use any vertical force beyond the minimum required to engage the EPROM
into its socket.
^ While continuing light pressure on the ends of the EPROM, use your index fingers to press the
locking levers inward until they are snapped into place. Listen for the click.
^ Install the access cover on the computer.
^ Perform FUNCTIONAL CHECK
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 4596
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair MEMCAL
CONDITION:
When installing a service replacement computer, the use of incorrect MEMCAL installation
procedures may cause the computer to fail before it can be installed in the vehicle. This condition
may appear as if the computer were defective when shipped to the dealership, when in fact it was
damaged while being installed. In addition this condition may also occur when installing an updated
MEMCAL into the vehicles original equipment computer.
CAUSE:
Excessive vertical force may be applied to the MEMCAL resulting in flexing of the circuit board and
damage to the connections between the circuit board and attached components. Excessive vertical
force may be generated in two ways.
^ Incorrect MEMCAL installation procedures.
^ Interference between MEMCAL and cover.
IMPORTANT CORRECTION:
This procedure supersedes any instructions regarding MEMCAL installation dated prior to
September 1990.
1. Inspect the MEMCAL to determine if a cork spacer is glued to the top side of the MEMCAL
assembly. If so, remove it prior to installation.
2. Align small notches with matching notches in Computer MEMCAL socket.
3. VERY GENTLY PRESS down on the ends of the MEMCAL until the locking levers are rotated
toward the sides of the MEMCAL.
NOTE: To avoid computer damage, do not press on the ends of the MEMCAL until the levers snap
into place. Do not use any vertical force beyond the minimum required to engage the MEMCAL into
its socket.
4. While continuing light pressure on the ends of the MEMCAL, use your index fingers to press the
locking levers inward until they are snapped into
place. Listen for the click.
5. Install MEMCAL cover and install computer cover.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 4597
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair PROM
1. Remove ECM from vehicle.
2. Remove ECM access cover.
PROM Removal
3. Remove PROM using the rocker-type PROM removal tool shown. Engage one end of the PROM
carrier with the hook end of the tool. Press on
the vertical bar end of the tool and rock the engaged end of the PROM carrier up as far as
possible. Engage the opposite end of the PROM carrier in the same manner and rock this end up
as far as possible. Repeat this process until the PROM carrier and PROM are free of the PROM
socket. The PROM carrier with the PROM in it should lift off of the PROM socket easily.
4. Inspect the reference end of the PROM carrier and carefully set aside. Do not remove the PROM
from the carrier to confirm PROM correctness.
The notch in the PROM is referenced to the small notch in the carrier. The small notch of the
carrier must be aligned with the small notch in the socket.
CAUTION: ANY TIME THE PROM IS INSTALLED BACKWARDS AND THE IGNITION SWITCH IS
TURNED ON, THE PROM IS DESTROYED.
5. Install PROM by pressing on the PROM carrier until it is firmly seated in the socket. Do not press
on the PROM, only the carrier.
6. Install ECM access cover.
7. Install ECM and perform a DIAGNOSTIC CIRCUIT CHECK to confirm proper installation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid line pressure.
OPERATION
The solenoid controls line pressure by controlling actuator feed limit fluid flow acting on internal
spool valve and spring pressure. The solenoid is a normally closed solenoid valve that controls fluid
pressure when operating on a duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Component Resistance Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications >
Page 4608
Shift Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body ..........................................................................................
................................................................................ 8 Solenoid Assembly To Pump ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 8 Solenoid Assembly To Case ....................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission
Electronic Component Location Views
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4611
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift
Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 1-2 and 3-4
shift valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 2-3 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift
Solenoid > Page 4614
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 2-3 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 2-3 shift
valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 1-2 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift
Solenoid > Page 4615
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 3-2 Control Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 3-2 shift
valve, which then controls the 2-4 band apply rate and 3-4 clutch release rate. The solenoid also
controls the 3-2 downshift feel.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a pulse width modulated solenoid that operates on a negative duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Valve Body and Wiring Harness
VALVE BODY AND WIRING HARNESS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4618
Valve Body Bolt Location
Control Valve And Pressure Switch Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4619
Manual Valve Link
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4620
Valve Body Checkballs
Case Checkballs And Filters
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Electrical connections from components. 2. TCC PWM Solenoid Retainer Clip (379) and
Solenoid (396). 3. TCC Solenoid bolts (68) and solenoid assembly (66) with O-ring seal (65) and
wiring harness. 4. Pressure switch assembly bolts (70) and pressure switch assembly (69). 5.
Accumulator cover bolts (58 and 59) and 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57). 6. 1-2
accumulator piston (56) and seal (55). 7. Spring (54). 8. Dipstick stop bracket (93).
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (64) and manual detent spring assembly (63).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4621
2. Wiring harness retaining bolts.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Remaining valve body bolts (62). 2. Manual valve link (89). 3. Control valve assembly (60). 4.
Bolts (58 and 59), accumulator cover (57), piston (56, spring (54) and spring (54A). 5. Bolts (77)
and plate (53). 6. Spacer plate (48) and spacer plate gaskets (47 and 52). 7. Spring (46), piston
(44), and pin (43).
- Seven checkballs are located under the valve body and one is located in the case. The large
copper flash colored ball is # 1A checkball (91).
Valve Body and Associated Parts
VALVE BODY AND ASSOCIATED PARTS
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate And Gaskets
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4622
Case Checkballs And Filters
TOOL REQUIRED:
- J 25025-5 Guide Pins
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined corners that are necessary for
"cleaning" the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, "micro fine" lapping
compound 900 grit or finer should be used. Too much "lapping" of a valve will cause excessive
clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. The wiring harness pass-thru connector into the case. 2. The 3-4 accumulator pin (43) into the
case. 3. The 3-4 accumulator piston seal (45) onto the 3-4 accumulator piston. 4. The 3-4
accumulator piston (44) onto the pin.
- The end with three legs must face the valve body.
5. The 3-4 accumulator piston spring (46).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkball (91) into case as shown.
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. J 25025-5 into the case. 3. Screens onto spacer plate as shown. 4. Spacer plate to case gasket
(47) and spacer plate to valve body gasket (52) onto the spacer plate (48).
- Gasket (47) identified by a "C". Gasket (52) identified by a "V".
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
5. Spacer plate and gaskets onto the case.
IMPORTANT
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the spacer plate and gaskets.
6. Spacer plate support (53) and bolts (77).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.)
Control Valve Body
CONTROL VALVE BODY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4623
Case Checkballs And Filters
Filter Screen - Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4624
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4625
Control Valve Assembly - Legend
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4626
Valve Body Checkball Locations
Valve Body Bolt Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4627
Manual Valve Link
Outside Electrical Connector
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly thoroughly in clean solvent. A. Move the valves with a pick or small
screwdriver to dislodge any dirt or debris that may have accumulated. B. Air dry.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
IMPORTANT
- Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing roll pins and retainer clips.
- Valves, springs and bushings must be laid out on a clean surface in the exact sequence they are
removed.
1. Pressure control solenoid retainer bolt (364) retainer (378) and solenoid. 2. Bore plug retainer
clip (395), bore plug (376) and valve train (374 and 375). 3. 2-3 shift solenoid retainer (379),
solenoid (367) and valve train (368 and 369). 4. 1-2 shift solenoid retainer (379), solenoid (367)
and valve train (365 and 366). 5. Accumulator valve train retainer pin (360), bore plug (373) and
valve train (370 and 371). 6. Forward accumulator cover bolts (364) and cover (363). 7. Forward
accumulator spring (356), piston (354) and pin (355). 8. Lo overrun valve spring (362) and valve
(361). 9. Retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and forward abuse valve train (357 and 358).
10. Manual valve (340). 11. 3-2 control solenoid retainer clip (379) and solenoid (394).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4628
12. Bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and 3-2 control valve train (391 - 393). 13. 3-2
downshift bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (389 - 390). 14. Reverse abuse
bore plug retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and valve train (387 - 388). 15. 3-4 shift valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (385 - 386). 16. 3-4 relay bore plug retainer
(395), bore plug (381) and valve train (382 - 384). 17. Torque converter clutch signal valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve (380).
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings and control valve body in clean solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
- All valves and bushings for: Porosity
- Scoring
- Nicks
- Scratches
- Springs for damaged or distorted coils.
- Valve body casting for: Porosity
- Cracks
- Inter connected oil passages
- Damaged machined surfaces
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly (350) exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and bushing passages.
- Position the pressure control solenoid so the connector tabs face outward.
NOTICE: TCC PWM solenoid (396) cannot be installed until TCC solenoid has been installed and
torqued to proper specifications.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkballs into the valve body assembly (350).
- Retain with Transjell TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. Valve body assembly (350).
- Connect the manual valve link (89) to the inside detent lever (88).
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the valve body assembly.
3. Wiring harness (66), manual spring assembly (63), pressure switch assembly(69), dipstick, stop
bracket (93) and all remaining valve body bolts.
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
4. TCC solenoid (66) and bolts (68).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
5. TCC PWM solenoid (396), and retainer clip (379).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Wiring harness connections to electrical components.
- To correctly hook up the wires, see the wiring diagrams.
- The pressure control solenoid (377) has two different colored connectors. The black connector
should be installed on the tab farthest from the valve body.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Parking bracket (86).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 31 Nm (23 lb. ft.).
2. The 1-2 accumulator piston seal (55) onto the 1-2 accumulator piston (56). 3. The 1-2
accumulator spring (54) and 1-2 accumulator inner spring (54A) onto the piston (56). 4. The 1-2
accumulator piston (56) into the 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57).
- The three legs on the piston must face away from the case when installed.
5. The 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57) onto the case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4629
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4630
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L80-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Wire Harness Assembly
WIRE HARNESS ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4631
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Wire harness connectors from electrical components.
NOTICE: Excessive force on the case pass through connector may damage the connector.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
2. Wire harness assembly (34) from case using a 1-5/16" 12 point socket to release the connector
retaining clips.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4632
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Rotate transmission bottom pan surface up and lock in place. 2. Wire harness assembly (34)
connectors from components.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
- Use a cap to cover electrical pin at case connection.
3. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket, and transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40).
NOTICE: Be sure five O-rings are attached to transmission fluid pressure switch assembly.
4. Twenty-one bolts (35) using 10 mm socket, from valve body assembly, manual detent spring and
roller assembly (41). 5. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid level indicator stop (43), one bolt (36) using
10 mm socket, lube pipe (39), lube pipe retainer (37) and clamp (38). 6. Control valve assembly
(44) including the accumulator housing assembly (51), valve body gaskets (45 and 48), spacer
plate (46) and accumulator
gasket (47).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4633
7. Manual valve (319) from control valve assembly (44) to prevent any damage. 8. Checkballs (54)
from case passages.
NOTICE: Do not use a magnet. It could cause checkball(s) to be magnetized causing metal
particles to stick to the ball.
9. Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid screen (75).
INSPECT
- Screen PWM solenoid (75), replace if necessary.
DISASSEMBLE
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4634
- Control valve assembly. A. Position as shown on a clean surface. B. Remove blind hole retainer
pins with a drill bit.
CAUTION: Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing the retaining pins or
personal injury could result.
C. Remove valve trains, shift solenoids (311 and 313), PCS (320), PWM solenoid (323), PCS
screen (302) and shift solenoid filter (317). D. Valves, springs, bushings and pistons must be laid
out on a clean surface.
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings, pistons, control valve body and accumulator housing in clean
solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
1. All valves, pistons and bushings for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
2. Pistons for:
- Seal damage.
3. Springs for:
- Damaged or distorted coils.
4. Valve body casting and accumulator housing for:
- Porosity.
- Cracks.
- Interconnected passages.
- Damaged machined surfaces.
5. Solenoid connectors and filter (317). 6. PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid) screen (302).
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY/ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4635
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4636
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4637
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4638
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4639
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined comers that are necessary for
cleaning the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and the bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, micro fine lapping
compound 900 grit (J 38459) or finer should be used. Too much lapping of the valve will cause
excessive clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly and accumulator housing (51) thoroughly in clean solvent.
- Air dry.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4640
Accumulator Housing Assembly
ACCUMULATOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4641
Accumulator Housing Assembly
DISASSEMBLE
1. Six bolts (53), using 8 mm socket. 2. Accumulator housing assembly. 3. Gasket accumulator
housing (47). 4. Spacer plate (46). 5. Gasket (45) valve body spacer. 6. Snap ring (402) from
outside housing, pin (408), snap ring (402), piston (407) and spring (49). 7. 3rd clutch piston (405)
and spring (50). 8. Seals (404 and 406).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4642
CLEAN
- All components.
INSPECT
- All valves, pistons, springs and seals for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4643
ASSEMBLE
- Accumulator housing assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the positions of the pistons.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and
bushing passages.
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4644
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY AND ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
TOOL REQUIRED:
- Guide Pin J 25025-5
ASSEMBLE
1. Guide pin J 25025-5 into valve body. Located at back bolt hole of detent spring and roller
assembly bolt bole. 2. Gasket (45) valve body to spacer plate. 3. Spacer plate (46). 4. Gasket (47)
accumulator housing to spacer plate. 5. Accumulator housing assembly (51) onto valve body
assembly (44).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4645
6. Six bolts (53) using (8 mm) socket through accumulator housing into valve body assembly.
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
NOTE: Start accumulator housing bolts finger tight and work towards opposite end.
TIGHTEN
- Bolt (53) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
7. Remove guide pin J 25025-5.
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4646
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4647
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Install checkballs (54) in proper location into case fluid passages. Use TRANSJEL TM J 36850
or equivalent to hold in place.
NOTICE: Do not use any type of grease to retain parts during assembly of this unit. Greases other
than the recommended assembly lube will change transmission fluid characteristics and cause
undesirable shift conditions and/or filter clogging.
- # 2 checkball is used only on RCP RDP, ZJP and ZLP models.
2. PWM solenoid screen (75).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4648
3. Gasket (48) spacer plate to case. 4. Manual valve (319) into valve body. 5. Complete valve body
assembly (44) onto case (7). Use 1 25025-5 guide pin set.
IMPORTANT
- Attach manual valve to detent lever.
6. Transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40) onto valve body assembly (44). 7. Spring and
roller assembly (41) into place. 8. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid indicator stop (43) and lube pipe
clamp (38). 9. Twenty-one bolts (35). Using 10 mm socket.
10. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket into transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40). 11.
Lube pipe (39) long end into case, short end into valve body. 12. Lube pipe retainer (37) with short
bolt (36).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (35, 36 and 76) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4649
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
13. Attach wiring harness (34) to 5 connectors.
- Put large end into case first, pressure switch hook up, 1-2 shift solenoid (purple) and 2-3 shift
solenoid (tan), PWM (Pulse Width Modulated) solenoid and PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid).
Pan and Filter Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic
Transmission > Page 4650
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4
Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4655
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4656
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 4657
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
Inside automatic transmission attached to valve body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 4658
C216 - TCC
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 4659
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transmission through the torque converter. This reduces
the slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy.
For the converter clutch to apply, two hydraulic conditions must be met: Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
- The control module completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Control module control is based on the input of these sensors: Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS): Vehicle equipped with A/C will allow TCC engagement at about 35
mph when the A/C is selected "ON". Engagement will occur at a vehicle speed of about 30 mph (25
mph for 92) when A/C is selected "OFF".
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Engine at normal operating temperature (above
65°C/149°F).
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS): Output not changing, indicating a steady road speed.
- Transmission Fluid (TFT) sensor.
Control module is also controlled by these switches: Brake switch closed: 12 volts supplied when brake is depressed.
- Transmission Range (TR) pressure switch assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Electronic Shift
Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
The Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch (Encoder Switch) is located in the in the shift
motor on the transfer case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Electronic Shift
Transfer Case Position Switch > Page 4665
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 4666
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 4667
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair
ELECTRIC SHIFT MOTOR REPLACEMENT
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle and support with safety stands.
2. Transfer case shield. 3. Motor electrical connection. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Front output shaft
yoke. 6. Motor to transfer case bolts. 7. Motor from the transfer case.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Motor to the transfer case. 2. Bolts.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 18 Nm (13 lbs. ft.).
3. Front output shaft yoke. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Motor electrical connection. 6. Transfer case
shield. 7. Negative battery cable.
- Lower Vehicle
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid line pressure.
OPERATION
The solenoid controls line pressure by controlling actuator feed limit fluid flow acting on internal
spool valve and spring pressure. The solenoid is a normally closed solenoid valve that controls fluid
pressure when operating on a duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Component Resistance Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4677
Shift Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body ..........................................................................................
................................................................................ 8 Solenoid Assembly To Pump ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 8 Solenoid Assembly To Case ....................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Electronic Component Location Views
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4680
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 1-2 and 3-4
shift valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 2-3 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page
4683
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 2-3 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 2-3 shift
valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 1-2 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page
4684
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 3-2 Control Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 3-2 shift
valve, which then controls the 2-4 band apply rate and 3-4 clutch release rate. The solenoid also
controls the 3-2 downshift feel.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a pulse width modulated solenoid that operates on a negative duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Valve Body and Wiring Harness
VALVE BODY AND WIRING HARNESS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4687
Valve Body Bolt Location
Control Valve And Pressure Switch Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4688
Manual Valve Link
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4689
Valve Body Checkballs
Case Checkballs And Filters
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Electrical connections from components. 2. TCC PWM Solenoid Retainer Clip (379) and
Solenoid (396). 3. TCC Solenoid bolts (68) and solenoid assembly (66) with O-ring seal (65) and
wiring harness. 4. Pressure switch assembly bolts (70) and pressure switch assembly (69). 5.
Accumulator cover bolts (58 and 59) and 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57). 6. 1-2
accumulator piston (56) and seal (55). 7. Spring (54). 8. Dipstick stop bracket (93).
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (64) and manual detent spring assembly (63).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4690
2. Wiring harness retaining bolts.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Remaining valve body bolts (62). 2. Manual valve link (89). 3. Control valve assembly (60). 4.
Bolts (58 and 59), accumulator cover (57), piston (56, spring (54) and spring (54A). 5. Bolts (77)
and plate (53). 6. Spacer plate (48) and spacer plate gaskets (47 and 52). 7. Spring (46), piston
(44), and pin (43).
- Seven checkballs are located under the valve body and one is located in the case. The large
copper flash colored ball is # 1A checkball (91).
Valve Body and Associated Parts
VALVE BODY AND ASSOCIATED PARTS
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate And Gaskets
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4691
Case Checkballs And Filters
TOOL REQUIRED:
- J 25025-5 Guide Pins
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined corners that are necessary for
"cleaning" the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, "micro fine" lapping
compound 900 grit or finer should be used. Too much "lapping" of a valve will cause excessive
clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. The wiring harness pass-thru connector into the case. 2. The 3-4 accumulator pin (43) into the
case. 3. The 3-4 accumulator piston seal (45) onto the 3-4 accumulator piston. 4. The 3-4
accumulator piston (44) onto the pin.
- The end with three legs must face the valve body.
5. The 3-4 accumulator piston spring (46).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkball (91) into case as shown.
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. J 25025-5 into the case. 3. Screens onto spacer plate as shown. 4. Spacer plate to case gasket
(47) and spacer plate to valve body gasket (52) onto the spacer plate (48).
- Gasket (47) identified by a "C". Gasket (52) identified by a "V".
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
5. Spacer plate and gaskets onto the case.
IMPORTANT
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the spacer plate and gaskets.
6. Spacer plate support (53) and bolts (77).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.)
Control Valve Body
CONTROL VALVE BODY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4692
Case Checkballs And Filters
Filter Screen - Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4693
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4694
Control Valve Assembly - Legend
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4695
Valve Body Checkball Locations
Valve Body Bolt Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4696
Manual Valve Link
Outside Electrical Connector
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly thoroughly in clean solvent. A. Move the valves with a pick or small
screwdriver to dislodge any dirt or debris that may have accumulated. B. Air dry.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
IMPORTANT
- Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing roll pins and retainer clips.
- Valves, springs and bushings must be laid out on a clean surface in the exact sequence they are
removed.
1. Pressure control solenoid retainer bolt (364) retainer (378) and solenoid. 2. Bore plug retainer
clip (395), bore plug (376) and valve train (374 and 375). 3. 2-3 shift solenoid retainer (379),
solenoid (367) and valve train (368 and 369). 4. 1-2 shift solenoid retainer (379), solenoid (367)
and valve train (365 and 366). 5. Accumulator valve train retainer pin (360), bore plug (373) and
valve train (370 and 371). 6. Forward accumulator cover bolts (364) and cover (363). 7. Forward
accumulator spring (356), piston (354) and pin (355). 8. Lo overrun valve spring (362) and valve
(361). 9. Retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and forward abuse valve train (357 and 358).
10. Manual valve (340). 11. 3-2 control solenoid retainer clip (379) and solenoid (394).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4697
12. Bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and 3-2 control valve train (391 - 393). 13. 3-2
downshift bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (389 - 390). 14. Reverse abuse
bore plug retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and valve train (387 - 388). 15. 3-4 shift valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (385 - 386). 16. 3-4 relay bore plug retainer
(395), bore plug (381) and valve train (382 - 384). 17. Torque converter clutch signal valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve (380).
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings and control valve body in clean solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
- All valves and bushings for: Porosity
- Scoring
- Nicks
- Scratches
- Springs for damaged or distorted coils.
- Valve body casting for: Porosity
- Cracks
- Inter connected oil passages
- Damaged machined surfaces
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly (350) exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and bushing passages.
- Position the pressure control solenoid so the connector tabs face outward.
NOTICE: TCC PWM solenoid (396) cannot be installed until TCC solenoid has been installed and
torqued to proper specifications.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkballs into the valve body assembly (350).
- Retain with Transjell TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. Valve body assembly (350).
- Connect the manual valve link (89) to the inside detent lever (88).
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the valve body assembly.
3. Wiring harness (66), manual spring assembly (63), pressure switch assembly(69), dipstick, stop
bracket (93) and all remaining valve body bolts.
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
4. TCC solenoid (66) and bolts (68).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
5. TCC PWM solenoid (396), and retainer clip (379).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Wiring harness connections to electrical components.
- To correctly hook up the wires, see the wiring diagrams.
- The pressure control solenoid (377) has two different colored connectors. The black connector
should be installed on the tab farthest from the valve body.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Parking bracket (86).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 31 Nm (23 lb. ft.).
2. The 1-2 accumulator piston seal (55) onto the 1-2 accumulator piston (56). 3. The 1-2
accumulator spring (54) and 1-2 accumulator inner spring (54A) onto the piston (56). 4. The 1-2
accumulator piston (56) into the 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57).
- The three legs on the piston must face away from the case when installed.
5. The 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57) onto the case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4698
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4699
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L80-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Wire Harness Assembly
WIRE HARNESS ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4700
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Wire harness connectors from electrical components.
NOTICE: Excessive force on the case pass through connector may damage the connector.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
2. Wire harness assembly (34) from case using a 1-5/16" 12 point socket to release the connector
retaining clips.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4701
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Rotate transmission bottom pan surface up and lock in place. 2. Wire harness assembly (34)
connectors from components.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
- Use a cap to cover electrical pin at case connection.
3. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket, and transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40).
NOTICE: Be sure five O-rings are attached to transmission fluid pressure switch assembly.
4. Twenty-one bolts (35) using 10 mm socket, from valve body assembly, manual detent spring and
roller assembly (41). 5. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid level indicator stop (43), one bolt (36) using
10 mm socket, lube pipe (39), lube pipe retainer (37) and clamp (38). 6. Control valve assembly
(44) including the accumulator housing assembly (51), valve body gaskets (45 and 48), spacer
plate (46) and accumulator
gasket (47).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4702
7. Manual valve (319) from control valve assembly (44) to prevent any damage. 8. Checkballs (54)
from case passages.
NOTICE: Do not use a magnet. It could cause checkball(s) to be magnetized causing metal
particles to stick to the ball.
9. Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid screen (75).
INSPECT
- Screen PWM solenoid (75), replace if necessary.
DISASSEMBLE
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4703
- Control valve assembly. A. Position as shown on a clean surface. B. Remove blind hole retainer
pins with a drill bit.
CAUTION: Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing the retaining pins or
personal injury could result.
C. Remove valve trains, shift solenoids (311 and 313), PCS (320), PWM solenoid (323), PCS
screen (302) and shift solenoid filter (317). D. Valves, springs, bushings and pistons must be laid
out on a clean surface.
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings, pistons, control valve body and accumulator housing in clean
solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
1. All valves, pistons and bushings for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
2. Pistons for:
- Seal damage.
3. Springs for:
- Damaged or distorted coils.
4. Valve body casting and accumulator housing for:
- Porosity.
- Cracks.
- Interconnected passages.
- Damaged machined surfaces.
5. Solenoid connectors and filter (317). 6. PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid) screen (302).
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY/ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4704
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4705
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4706
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4707
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4708
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined comers that are necessary for
cleaning the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and the bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, micro fine lapping
compound 900 grit (J 38459) or finer should be used. Too much lapping of the valve will cause
excessive clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly and accumulator housing (51) thoroughly in clean solvent.
- Air dry.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4709
Accumulator Housing Assembly
ACCUMULATOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4710
Accumulator Housing Assembly
DISASSEMBLE
1. Six bolts (53), using 8 mm socket. 2. Accumulator housing assembly. 3. Gasket accumulator
housing (47). 4. Spacer plate (46). 5. Gasket (45) valve body spacer. 6. Snap ring (402) from
outside housing, pin (408), snap ring (402), piston (407) and spring (49). 7. 3rd clutch piston (405)
and spring (50). 8. Seals (404 and 406).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4711
CLEAN
- All components.
INSPECT
- All valves, pistons, springs and seals for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4712
ASSEMBLE
- Accumulator housing assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the positions of the pistons.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and
bushing passages.
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4713
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY AND ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
TOOL REQUIRED:
- Guide Pin J 25025-5
ASSEMBLE
1. Guide pin J 25025-5 into valve body. Located at back bolt hole of detent spring and roller
assembly bolt bole. 2. Gasket (45) valve body to spacer plate. 3. Spacer plate (46). 4. Gasket (47)
accumulator housing to spacer plate. 5. Accumulator housing assembly (51) onto valve body
assembly (44).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4714
6. Six bolts (53) using (8 mm) socket through accumulator housing into valve body assembly.
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
NOTE: Start accumulator housing bolts finger tight and work towards opposite end.
TIGHTEN
- Bolt (53) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
7. Remove guide pin J 25025-5.
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4715
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4716
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Install checkballs (54) in proper location into case fluid passages. Use TRANSJEL TM J 36850
or equivalent to hold in place.
NOTICE: Do not use any type of grease to retain parts during assembly of this unit. Greases other
than the recommended assembly lube will change transmission fluid characteristics and cause
undesirable shift conditions and/or filter clogging.
- # 2 checkball is used only on RCP RDP, ZJP and ZLP models.
2. PWM solenoid screen (75).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4717
3. Gasket (48) spacer plate to case. 4. Manual valve (319) into valve body. 5. Complete valve body
assembly (44) onto case (7). Use 1 25025-5 guide pin set.
IMPORTANT
- Attach manual valve to detent lever.
6. Transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40) onto valve body assembly (44). 7. Spring and
roller assembly (41) into place. 8. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid indicator stop (43) and lube pipe
clamp (38). 9. Twenty-one bolts (35). Using 10 mm socket.
10. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket into transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40). 11.
Lube pipe (39) long end into case, short end into valve body. 12. Lube pipe retainer (37) with short
bolt (36).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (35, 36 and 76) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4718
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
13. Attach wiring harness (34) to 5 connectors.
- Put large end into case first, pressure switch hook up, 1-2 shift solenoid (purple) and 2-3 shift
solenoid (tan), PWM (Pulse Width Modulated) solenoid and PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid).
Pan and Filter Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission >
Page 4719
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4
Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4724
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4725
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
4726
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
Inside automatic transmission attached to valve body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
4727
C216 - TCC
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
4728
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transmission through the torque converter. This reduces
the slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy.
For the converter clutch to apply, two hydraulic conditions must be met: Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
- The control module completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Control module control is based on the input of these sensors: Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS): Vehicle equipped with A/C will allow TCC engagement at about 35
mph when the A/C is selected "ON". Engagement will occur at a vehicle speed of about 30 mph (25
mph for 92) when A/C is selected "OFF".
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Engine at normal operating temperature (above
65°C/149°F).
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS): Output not changing, indicating a steady road speed.
- Transmission Fluid (TFT) sensor.
Control module is also controlled by these switches: Brake switch closed: 12 volts supplied when brake is depressed.
- Transmission Range (TR) pressure switch assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement
Accumulator: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 87-71-74
Date: November, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: 1-2 Accumulator Piston and Outer Spring Replacement
Models: 1982-96 Buick Roadmaster 1982-96 Cadillac Brougham, Fleetwood, DeVille 1982-86
Chevrolet Caprice 1982-99 Chevrolet Camaro, Corvette 1982-99 Pontiac Firebird with
HYDRA-MATIC 4L60, 4L60-E Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30)
1982-99 Chevrolet and GMC C/K, M/L, S/T, G Models 1991-99 Oldsmobile Bravada with
HYDRA-MATIC 4L60, 4L60-E Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30)
Transmissions built from 1982 through 1999 were built with one of two styles of 1-2 accumulator
pistons and outer springs.
Important:
The 1-2 accumulator pistons and outer springs are not interchangeable.
For replacement of the 1-2 accumulator piston and outer spring, remove the 1-2 accumulator
assembly and inspect the interior for the presence of either an aluminum or composite (plastic) 1-2
accumulator piston.
Design 1
1-2 accumulator assemblies with an aluminum piston and a round wire outer spring, use service
package P/N 24204495 (1982-1993) or P/N 24204496
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4733
(1994-1997).
Design 2
1-2 accumulator assemblies with a composite (plastic) piston and an ovate wire outer spring,
started May 11, 1998 (Julian Date 131), use service package P/N 24214343 (1998-1999).
Notice:
Failure to follow the above instructions may result in transmission distress.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4734
Accumulator: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Accumulator Assembly Service Manual Update
Group Ref.: Transmission
Bulletin No.: 377143
Date: November, 1993
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
SUBJECT: SECTION 7A - AUTOMATIC - TRANSMISSION UNIT REPAIR - ACCUMULATOR
ASSEMBLY
MODELS: 1994 BUICK ROADMASTER 1994 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD 1994 CHEVROLET
CAPRICE, CAMARO, CORVETTE 1994 PONTIAC FIREBIRD
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K, S/T TRUCKS AND L/M, G VANS 1994 OLDSMOBILE
BRAVADA
TRANSAXLE
APPLICATIONS:
1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E (RPO M30)
BULLETIN COVERS:
New product information for 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions. This information has
been updated since publication of the 1994 Service Manual and should be noted accordingly. Be
certain to familiarize yourself with these updates to properly repair the 1994 HYDRA-MATIC
4L60-E transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4735
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4736
DATE OF PRODUCTION CHANGE: (Figures 1, 2 & 3)
Beginning with start of production 1994, HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions were built with a
new calibration that has two (2) springs in the 1-2 accumulator. The 3-4 accumulator has also
changed. Some models do not use a 3-4 accumulator spring.
SERVICE MANUAL REFERENCE:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4737
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4738
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4739
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4740
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 1-2 Accumulator Piston/Outer Spring Replacement > Page
4741
Update your 1994 Service Manual with the five (5) pages.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4742
Accumulator: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Accumulator Cover To Case ...............................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 FWD Accumulator Cover To Valve Body .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Band: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page
4747
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page
4748
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Band Apply Servo: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove two oil pan bolts from below servo cover. 3. Install servo
cover compressor tool No. J-29714 or equivalent on oil pan flange and depress servo cover. 4.
Remove servo cover retaining ring. 5. Remove servo cover and seal ring. 6. Remove servo piston
and bore-apply pin assembly. 7. Reverse procedure to install. Whenever any servo parts are
replaced, apply-pin length must be checked.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Bell Housing: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Bellhousing To Case ...........................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 55
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch > Page 4759
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4760
C217 - Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis
Case: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis
Bulletin No.: 02-07-30-024B
Date: August 18, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Diagnosis of Cracked or Broken Transmission Case
Models: 2006 and Prior Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 and Prior HUMMER H2 2006 HUMMER
H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60/4L60-E/4L65-E or 4L80-E/4L85-E or Allison(R) Series 1000 Automatic Transmission
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 02-07-30-024A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Diagnosing the cause of a cracked or broken transmission case requires additional diagnosis and
repair or a repeat failure will occur.
A cracked or broken transmission case is most often the result of abnormal external torsional
forces acting on the transmission case. If none of the conditions listed below are apparent, an
internal transmission component inspection may be required. Repairs of this type may be the result
of external damage or abuse for which General Motors is not responsible. They are not the result of
defects in materials or workmanship. If in doubt, contact your General Motors Service
Representative.
The following items should be considered:
^ It is important to inspect the vehicle for signs of an out of line condition, impact damage or foreign
material to the following components:
- The transmission
- The engine mounts
- The transmission rear mount and crossmember
- Vehicle frame damage that alters the front to rear alignment of the driveshaft
- The driveshafts (both front and rear)
- The wheels (caked with mud, concrete, etc.)
- The tires (roundness, lack of cupping, excessive balance weights)
- The transfer case (if the vehicle is 4WD)
^ A worn or damaged driveshaft U-Joint has shown to be a frequent cause of transmission case
cracking, especially on vehicles that see extended periods of highway driving. Always inspect the
U-joint condition when diagnosing this condition.
^ For driveshaft damage or imbalance, Inspect the driveshafts (both front and rear) for dents,
straightness/runout or signs of missing balance weights. Also, inspect for foreign material such as
undercoat sprayed on the driveshaft.
^ The driveshaft working angles may be excessive or non-canceling, especially if the vehicle
carrying height has been altered (lifted or lowered) or if the frame has been extended or modified.
^ Damaged or worn upper or lower rear control arms or bushings.
^ A rear axle that is not seated in the rear spring properly (leaf spring vehicles).
^ Broken rear springs and or worn leaf spring bushings.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 4765
In some cases, the customer may not comment about a vibration but it is important to test drive the
vehicle while using the electronic vibration analysis tool in an attempt to locate the cause of the
torsional vibration. Refer to the Vibration Diagnosis and Correction sub-section of the appropriate
Service Manual for more details on diagnosing and correcting vibrations.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 4766
Case: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - New Low and Reverse Support to Case Retainer Ring
GROUP REF.: Transmission
BULLETIN NO.: 477104
DATE: March, 1994
SUBJECT: NEW LOW AND REVERSE SUPPORT TO CASE RETAINER RING
MODELS: 1994 BUICK ROADMASTER 1994 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD 1994 CHEVROLET
CAPRICE, CAMARO, CORVETTE 1994 PONTIAC FIREBIRD 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K,
S/T TRUCKS AND M/L, G VANS 1994 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E (RPO M30)
BULLETIN COVERS: (Figure 1)
New product information for 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions. An enhanced low and
reverse support to case retainer ring (ill. 676) has been released. The new low and reverse support
to case retainer ring has been enhanced to contact the case ring groove around the entire ring.
This will ultimately improve the retention of the ring. Also, the low and reverse support to case
retainer ring must be located with the opening in the five o'clock position as shown in Figure 1.
NOTE:
The GMC Bulletin No. 367106 Automatic Transmission Service Procedure, will remain in effect for
GMC trucks only.
DATE OF PRODUCTION CHANGE:
On August 08, 1993 the HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions were built with the new low and
reverse support to case retainer ring.
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
Parts are expected to be available on February 28, 1994.
PART NUMBER PART NAME
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Cracked Case Diagnosis > Page 4767
24200278 Low and Reverse Support to Case Retainer Ring
The new low and reverse support to case retainer ring can also be used for 1982-1993
HYDRA-MATIC 4L60 and 4L60-E transmissions.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4768
Case: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Accumulator Cover To Case ...............................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Case Extension To Case ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 26 Auxiliary Valve Body To Case ................................................................................................
............................................................................................ 8 Bellhousing To Case ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 55 Pump Assembly To Case .............................................................................................
...................................................................................................... 18 Solenoid Assembly To Case ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 18 Spacer Plate Support To Case ........................................................................
...................................................................................................................... 8 Transmission Oil Pan
To Case ...............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Channel Plate: Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No Movement
in Drive or 3rd Gear
Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-027
Date: June 04, 2008
Subject: No Movement When Transmission is Shifted to Drive or Third - Normal Operation When
Shifted to Second, First or Reverse (Replace Forward Sprag Assembly)
Models: 1982 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 - 2007 Buick Rainier 2006
Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2006 Chevrolet SSR 2006 - 2008 Chevrolet
Avalanche, Colorado, Express, Silverado Classic, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006
GMC Yukon Denali, Yukon Denali XL 2006 - 2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Savana, Sierra Classic,
Sierra, Yukon, Yukon XL 2006 Pontiac GTO 2006 - 2007 HUMMER H2 2006 - 2008 HUMMER H3
2006 - 2008 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60, 4L60E, 4L65E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30, M32, M33 or M70)
Condition
Some customers may comment that the vehicle has no movement when the transmission is shifted
to DRIVE or THIRD position, but there is normal operation when it is shifted to SECOND, FIRST or
REVERSE position.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a damaged forward sprag assembly (642).
Correction
When inspecting the sprag, it is important to test the sprag for proper operation by holding the outer
race (644) with one hand while rotating the input sun gear (640) with the other hand. The sun gear
should rotate only in the counterclockwise direction with the input sun gear facing upward. If the
sprag rotates in both directions or will not rotate in either direction, the sprag elements should be
inspected by removing one of the sprag assembly retaining rings (643). Refer to SI Unit Repair
section for forward clutch sprag disassembly procedures.
If the sprag is found to be damaged, make repairs to the transmission as necessary. A new forward
roller clutch sprag assembly is now available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No Movement
in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 4781
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the Pressure Control (PC) solenoid
valve (377) fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid (377) as necessary. It is also important
to flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J45096. Refer to SI Automatic
Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test for the procedure.
The notches above each sprag must point up as shown when assembled into the outer race.
Bearing Assembly, Input Sun Gear
Snap Ring, Overrun Clutch Hub Retaining
Hub, Overrun Clutch
Wear Plate, Sprag Assembly
Retainer and Race Assembly, Sprag
Forward Sprag Assembly
Retainer Rings, Sprag Assembly
Outer Race, Forward Clutch
Washer, Thrust (Input Carrier to Race)
The following information applies when this sprag is used in 1982-86 transmissions.
The new design sprag can be used on models 1982 through 1986, by replacing the entire
assembly (637 - 644). Individual components are NOT
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No Movement
in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 4782
interchangeable.
Important:
The wear plate (640) and input thrust washer (660) are not required with the new sprag. Use of the
thrust washer and wear plate with the new sprag assembly will cause a misbuild (correct end play
cannot be obtained).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-027
Date: June 04, 2008
Subject: No Movement When Transmission is Shifted to Drive or Third - Normal Operation When
Shifted to Second, First or Reverse (Replace Forward Sprag Assembly)
Models: 1982 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 - 2007 Buick Rainier 2006
Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2006 Chevrolet SSR 2006 - 2008 Chevrolet
Avalanche, Colorado, Express, Silverado Classic, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006
GMC Yukon Denali, Yukon Denali XL 2006 - 2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Savana, Sierra Classic,
Sierra, Yukon, Yukon XL 2006 Pontiac GTO 2006 - 2007 HUMMER H2 2006 - 2008 HUMMER H3
2006 - 2008 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60, 4L60E, 4L65E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30, M32, M33 or M70)
Condition
Some customers may comment that the vehicle has no movement when the transmission is shifted
to DRIVE or THIRD position, but there is normal operation when it is shifted to SECOND, FIRST or
REVERSE position.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a damaged forward sprag assembly (642).
Correction
When inspecting the sprag, it is important to test the sprag for proper operation by holding the outer
race (644) with one hand while rotating the input sun gear (640) with the other hand. The sun gear
should rotate only in the counterclockwise direction with the input sun gear facing upward. If the
sprag rotates in both directions or will not rotate in either direction, the sprag elements should be
inspected by removing one of the sprag assembly retaining rings (643). Refer to SI Unit Repair
section for forward clutch sprag disassembly procedures.
If the sprag is found to be damaged, make repairs to the transmission as necessary. A new forward
roller clutch sprag assembly is now available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 4788
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the Pressure Control (PC) solenoid
valve (377) fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid (377) as necessary. It is also important
to flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J45096. Refer to SI Automatic
Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test for the procedure.
The notches above each sprag must point up as shown when assembled into the outer race.
Bearing Assembly, Input Sun Gear
Snap Ring, Overrun Clutch Hub Retaining
Hub, Overrun Clutch
Wear Plate, Sprag Assembly
Retainer and Race Assembly, Sprag
Forward Sprag Assembly
Retainer Rings, Sprag Assembly
Outer Race, Forward Clutch
Washer, Thrust (Input Carrier to Race)
The following information applies when this sprag is used in 1982-86 transmissions.
The new design sprag can be used on models 1982 through 1986, by replacing the entire
assembly (637 - 644). Individual components are NOT
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 4789
interchangeable.
Important:
The wear plate (640) and input thrust washer (660) are not required with the new sprag. Use of the
thrust washer and wear plate with the new sprag assembly will cause a misbuild (correct end play
cannot be obtained).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 577112A > Sep > 95 >
A/T - Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 57-71-12A
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Section 7 - Lo and Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection
Models: 1993-95
Buick Roadmaster
1993-95 Cadillac Fleetwood
1993-95 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1993-95 Pontiac Firebird
1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T; M/L, G Models
1993-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4L60/4L60-E Transmission (RPOs M30, MD8)
This bulletin is being revised to Include the 4L60 Transmission. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 57-71-12 (Section 7 - Transmission).
The dimension "D" for the overall height for the lo reverse clutch plates is in error. The correct
measurement should be 29.22 to 29.90 mm (1.15 to 1.18 inches).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 577112A > Sep > 95 >
A/T - Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection > Page 4794
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 577112A > Sep > 95 >
A/T - Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection > Page 4795
Included are the updated pages for your Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477141 > Jan > 95 >
A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477141 > Jan > 95 >
A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4800
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477141 > Jan > 95 >
A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4801
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477105 > Mar > 94 >
A/T - New Long Lip Seal Design 3-4 and Forward Clutches
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - New Long Lip Seal Design 3-4 and Forward Clutches
GROUP REF.: Transmission
BULLETIN NO.: 477105
DATE: March, 1994
SUBJECT: NEW LONG LIP SEAL DESIGN 3A AND FORWARD CLUTCHES
MODELS: 1994 BUICK ROADMASTER 1994 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD 1994 CHEVROLET
CAPRICE, CAMARO, CORVETTE 1994 PONTIAC FIREBIRD 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K,
S/T TRUCKS AND M/L, G VANS 1994 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E (RPO M30)
BULLETIN COVERS: (Figure 1)
New product information for 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions. New clutch piston seal
design. The 3-4 clutch piston outer seal and the forward clutch piston outer seals have been
redesigned to include a long lip profile for enhanced sealing. Be certain to familiarize yourself with
these updates to properly repair the 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477105 > Mar > 94 >
A/T - New Long Lip Seal Design 3-4 and Forward Clutches > Page 4806
DATE OF PRODUCTION CHANGE: (Figure 2)
Beginning with August 09, 1993, the HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions were built with a new
3-4 clutch outer seal (long lip). On September 20,1993 the HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions
were built with a new forward clutch outer seal (long lip).
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
The new 3-4 clutch outer seal and forward clutch outer seal should be used when rebuilding
transmissions that operate under -25°F or if the 3-4 clutch plates or forward clutch plates exhibit a
burnt condition.
The long lip seals are interchangeable with the current seals. The new design will replace the
current seal in service packages as stock is depleted. To order the long lip seals individually use
the following part numbers:
PART NUMBER PART NAME
8642138 3-4 Clutch Outer Seal
8686146 Forward Clutch Outer Seal
These seals can also be used for 1982-1993 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60 and 4L60-E transmissions.
NOTE:
The GMC Bulletin No. 367106 Automatic Transmission Service Procedure, will remain in effect for
GMC trucks only.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 577112A > Sep > 95 > A/T Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 57-71-12A
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Section 7 - Lo and Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection
Models: 1993-95
Buick Roadmaster
1993-95 Cadillac Fleetwood
1993-95 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1993-95 Pontiac Firebird
1993-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T; M/L, G Models
1993-94 Oldsmobile Bravada
with 4L60/4L60-E Transmission (RPOs M30, MD8)
This bulletin is being revised to Include the 4L60 Transmission. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 57-71-12 (Section 7 - Transmission).
The dimension "D" for the overall height for the lo reverse clutch plates is in error. The correct
measurement should be 29.22 to 29.90 mm (1.15 to 1.18 inches).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 577112A > Sep > 95 > A/T Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection > Page 4812
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 577112A > Sep > 95 > A/T Low/Reverse Clutch Spacer Plate Selection > Page 4813
Included are the updated pages for your Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477141 > Jan > 95 > A/T 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477141 > Jan > 95 > A/T 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4818
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477141 > Jan > 95 > A/T 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 4819
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477105 > Mar > 94 > A/T New Long Lip Seal Design 3-4 and Forward Clutches
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - New Long Lip Seal Design 3-4 and Forward Clutches
GROUP REF.: Transmission
BULLETIN NO.: 477105
DATE: March, 1994
SUBJECT: NEW LONG LIP SEAL DESIGN 3A AND FORWARD CLUTCHES
MODELS: 1994 BUICK ROADMASTER 1994 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD 1994 CHEVROLET
CAPRICE, CAMARO, CORVETTE 1994 PONTIAC FIREBIRD 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K,
S/T TRUCKS AND M/L, G VANS 1994 OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E (RPO M30)
BULLETIN COVERS: (Figure 1)
New product information for 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions. New clutch piston seal
design. The 3-4 clutch piston outer seal and the forward clutch piston outer seals have been
redesigned to include a long lip profile for enhanced sealing. Be certain to familiarize yourself with
these updates to properly repair the 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 477105 > Mar > 94 > A/T New Long Lip Seal Design 3-4 and Forward Clutches > Page 4824
DATE OF PRODUCTION CHANGE: (Figure 2)
Beginning with August 09, 1993, the HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions were built with a new
3-4 clutch outer seal (long lip). On September 20,1993 the HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions
were built with a new forward clutch outer seal (long lip).
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
The new 3-4 clutch outer seal and forward clutch outer seal should be used when rebuilding
transmissions that operate under -25°F or if the 3-4 clutch plates or forward clutch plates exhibit a
burnt condition.
The long lip seals are interchangeable with the current seals. The new design will replace the
current seal in service packages as stock is depleted. To order the long lip seals individually use
the following part numbers:
PART NUMBER PART NAME
8642138 3-4 Clutch Outer Seal
8686146 Forward Clutch Outer Seal
These seals can also be used for 1982-1993 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60 and 4L60-E transmissions.
NOTE:
The GMC Bulletin No. 367106 Automatic Transmission Service Procedure, will remain in effect for
GMC trucks only.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Extension Housing, A/T
> Component Information > Specifications
Extension Housing: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Case Extension To Case .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................ 26
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E
Date: April 07, 2011
Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Models:
2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008
HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION
2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo,
Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except
2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only
Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT
(MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra
Attention:
DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs
for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING
The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle
that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use
P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual
transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be
checked when servicing any of these components.
Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid.
Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations.
Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some
concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and
transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for
General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the
J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with
DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as
noted above).
DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair
or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use
in automatic transmissions/transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-VI ATF
General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle
production.
Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use
DEXRON(R)-VI.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 4832
All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with
DEXRON(R)-VI fluid.
DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas:
* These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being.
2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing
Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the
machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 4833
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 4834
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 4835
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Dexron IIE Preferred Fluid for All Hydra-matic
BULLETIN No.: 9274T60-E-02
CORP. REF. NO.: 177125
DATE: October 1991
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: All
TRANSMISSION MODELS: All
SUBJECT: Dexron(R)-IIE Automatic Transmission/Transaxle Fluid
VEHICLE APPLICATIONS: All Hydra-matic Automatic Transmissions/Transaxles
BULLETIN COVERS:
General Motors has developed a new service fill automatic transmission/transaxle fluid which is
designated DEXRON(R)-IIE. This fluid is the preferred fluid for all HYDRA-MATIC automatic
transmissions/transaxles and will eventually replace DEXRON(R)-II. DEXRON(R)-IIE is acceptable
for use whenever DEXRON(R)-II was previously specified. DEXRON(R)-II is acceptable for use
when DEXRON(R)-IIE is not available. DEXRON(R)-II and DEXRON(R)-IIE can be used in both
electronically and hydraulically controlled transmissions/ transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-IIE Advantages Over DEXRON(R)-II:
^ Has better anti-foaming characteristic.
^ Improved high temperature oxidation stability and improved low temperature flow characteristics
(low temperature viscosity).
^ DEXRON(R)-IIE and DEXRON(R)-II can be mixed in any ratio. No draining or flushing of system
is required.
^ DEXRON(R)-IIE is back serviceable to 1949 for all General Motors automatic
transmissions/transaxles.
^ No change in transmission/transaxle calibration or reduction in transmission/transaxle durability
will occur as a result of using DEXRON(R)-IIE.
SERVICE PART INFORMATION:
PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION
12345881 1 quart container
12345882 1 gallon container
12345883 55 gallon drum
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 4836
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON III Fluid Introduction
File In Section: 0 - General Information
Bulletin No.: 57-02-01
Date: March, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 0 - General Information - DEXRON(R)-III Transmission Fluid Introduction
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors has phased in a new automatic transmission fluid, DEXRON(R)-III, that does not
need replacing under normal service. DEXRON(R)-III is designed to help the transmission deliver
the best possible performance under all conditions. Refer to Figure 1.
The improvements in DEXRON(R)-III include better friction stability, more high temperature
oxidation stability and better material compatibility. DEXRON(R)-III has the same low temperature
fluidity as DEXRON(R)-IIE, for better transmission performance in cold weather.
DEXRON(R)-IIE and DEXRON(R)-III are fully compatible.
DEXRON(R)-III is fully compatible with any General Motors passenger vehicle or light truck with
automatic transmission and built since 1949.
Dealers should require their supplier to include the DEXRON(R)-III license number on all automatic
transmission fluid invoices.
Starting February 1, 1994 DEXRON(R)-III was phased into all North American assembly plants.
DEXRON(R)-III fluid is available from GMSPO (see fluid numbers below):
U.S.
1 Quart 12346143
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 4837
1 Gallon 12346144
55 Gallon 12346145
In Canada
1 Liter 10952622
4 Liter 10952623
200 Liter 10952624
The 1995 Automatic Transmission/Transaxle fluid change intervals are the following:
(1994 and prior should use the schedules as written in the Owner's Manual.)
If the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions:
In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90°F (32°C) or higher.
In hilly or mountainous terrain.
When doing frequent trailer towing.
Uses such as found in taxi, police car or delivery service.
Change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (63,000 km).
If the vehicle is not used mainly under any of these conditions, the fluid and filter do not require
periodic changing for vehicles under 8,600 GVWR.
Vehicles over 8,600 GVWR change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (83,000 km) regardless
of driving conditions.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
CAPACITIES .......................................................................................................................................
................................................................ QUARTS
Pan Capacity .......................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 5.0 Total (Overhaul) Capacity ...............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 11.2
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4840
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... Dexron IIE
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4841
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Fluid level should be checked at every engine oil change. Frequency of change for transmission
fluid is dependent on the type of driving conditions in which the vehicle is used. If the transmission
is subjected to severe service such as: use in heavy city traffic when the outside temperature
regularly reaches 90°F, use in very hilly or mountainous areas, commercial use such as taxi or
delivery service, the fluid should be changed every 15,000 miles when using Dexron II and 50,000
miles when using Dexron III or equivalent. Otherwise, change the fluid every 100,000 miles, using
Dexron II, III or equivalent automatic transmission fluid. When checking fluid, ensure vehicle is at
operating temperature (190°-200°F), which can be obtained by 15 miles of highway-type driving.
After transmission fluid is at operating temperature, use the following procedure to check fluid level:
1. Ensure vehicle is on a level surface, then move gear selector to the Park position. 2. Apply
parking brake and block wheels, then allow engine to run at idle speed for three minutes with
accessories off. 3. Check fluid level, color and condition.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Changing Fluid
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Changing Fluid
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Loosen two bolts attaching right side of transmission support to
frame rail. 3. Remove two bolts attaching left side transmission support to frame rail. 4. Using
suitable transmission jack, support and slightly raise transmission. 5. Slide transmission support
rearward enough to access rear oil pan attaching bolts. 6. Place drain pan under transmission oil
pan, loosen pan bolts on front of pan, pry carefully with screwdriver to loosen oil pan, and allow
fluid to
drain.
7. Remove remaining oil pan bolts, oil pan, and gasket. 8. Drain fluid from pan, then clean pan and
dry thoroughly with compressed air. 9. Remove oil filter to valve body bolt, then remove filter and
gasket, replace with new filter and gasket.
10. Install new gasket on oil pan, then oil pan and attaching bolts. Tighten attaching bolts to
specification. 11. Lower vehicle and add five quarts of automatic transmission fluid through filler
tube. 12. With selector lever in Park and parking brake applied, start engine and let idle. Do not
race engine. 13. Move selector lever through each gear range, then return lever to park. 14. Check
fluid, then add additional fluid to bring level between dimples on dipstick.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Changing Fluid > Page 4844
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Adding Fluid to A DRY Transmission
1. Add transmission fluid through filler tube until oil level is between the "ADD" and "HOT" marks on
dipstick. 2. Place selector lever in park, depress accelerator to place carburetor on fast idle cam,
and move selector lever through each range. Do not race
engine.
3. With selector lever in park, engine running at idle (1-3 minutes), and vehicle on level surface,
check fluid level and add additional fluid to bring
level between dimples on dipstick.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Updated Design Oil Filter Assembly & Seal
Fluid Filter - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Updated Design Oil Filter Assembly & Seal
Group Ref.: Transmission
Bulletin No.: 377142A
Date: February, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: NEW TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER ASSEMBLY
MODELS: 1994 BUICK ROADMASTER 1994 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD 1994 CHEVROLET
CAPRICE, CAMARO, CORVETTE 1994 PONTIAC FIREBIRD 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC C/K
AND S/T TRUCKS 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC M/L AND G VANS 1994 OLDSMOBILE
BRAVADA
TRANSMISSION APPLICATIONS: 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E (M30)
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING REVISED TO CLARIFY TRANSMISSION USAGE. PLEASE DISCARD
BULLETIN 377142.
BULLETIN COVERS:
New product information for 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions. Be certain to familiarize
yourself with these updates to properly repair the 1994 HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Updated Design Oil Filter Assembly & Seal > Page 4849
DATE OF PRODUCTION CHANGE: (Figure 1 and 2)
On August 10, 1993 (Julian Date 222), HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E transmissions were built with a new
filter seal (ill. 71) and transmission oil filter assembly (ill. 72).
The previous transmission oil filter assembly and filter seal had an assembly method of installing
the seal on the filter neck and then installing the filter in the transmission.
When using the new filter seal and transmission oil filter assembly, the filter seal must be installed
in the transmission first and then install the transmission oil filter assembly into the transmission.
NOTE:
The new filter seal and transmission oil filter assembly can be used on all HYDRA-MATIC 4L60-E
transmissions 1993-1994. The new filter seal and transmission oil filter assembly cannot be used
on any HYDRA-MATIC 4L60 transmission.
The new filter seal cannot be used with the old transmission oil filter assembly and the new
transmission oil filter assembly cannot be used with the old filter seal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Line/Hose: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Connector Cooler Pipe ........................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 28
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Transmission Oil Pan To Case ............................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Fluid Pan: Service and Repair 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Removal
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Installation
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4858
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4859
Fluid Pan: Service and Repair 4L80-E Automatic Transmission
Removal
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Installation
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4860
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Plugs (1/8 - 27) .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Pressure Plugs (1/4 - 18) ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 18 Pressure Switches ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pump: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pump Assembly To Case ....................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 18 Pump Cover To Body .....................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 18 Solenoid Assembly To Pump ...................................................................................................
............................................................................................ 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Governor: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle 2. Remove governor cover from case using extreme care not to
damage cover. If cover is damaged, it should be replaced. 3. Remove governor. 4. Reverse
procedure to install and check fluid level.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
Instrument cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
Output Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-042F
Date: February 05, 2010
Subject: Information on 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32,
M70)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and 4L70E transmission.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-042E (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Important For 2005 model year fullsize utilities and pickups, refer to Corporate Bulletin
05-07-30-012.
Some vehicles may exhibit a clunk noise that can be heard on a 2-3 upshift or a 3-2 downshift.
During a 2-3 upshift, the 2-4 band is released and the 3-4 clutch is applied. The timing of this shift
can cause a momentary torque reversal of the output shaft that results in a clunk noise. This same
torque reversal can also occur on a 3-2 downshift when the 3-4 clutch is released and the 2-4 band
applied. This condition may be worse on a 4-wheel drive vehicle due to the additional tolerances in
the transfer case.
This is a normal condition. No repairs should be attempted.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid line pressure.
OPERATION
The solenoid controls line pressure by controlling actuator feed limit fluid flow acting on internal
spool valve and spring pressure. The solenoid is a normally closed solenoid valve that controls fluid
pressure when operating on a duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 467108 > Dec > 94 > A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
File In Section: 7 - Transmission Bulletin No. 46-71-08 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Transmission Extension Seal Leaks (Install Revised Seal)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C1-2, G, S, M Models with 4L60 (MD8) or 4L60-E
(M3O) and One-Piece Propeller Shaft
CONDITION Some vehicles may experience a leak from the transmission extension seal.
CAUSE This leak may occur if the seal lips are damaged by a corroded slip yoke barrel. As the
rear suspension moves, the slip yoke slides past the seal lips. If the slip yoke barrel is corroded,
seal damage can occur resulting in a leak.
CORRECTION Install a revised seal P/N 24201470. The seal features a flexible boot which covers
the slip yoke barrel to prevent corrosion. This seal is used in production starting with the 1995
model year.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Refer to the appropriate year and model Light Truck Service Manual,
Section 7A - Automatic Transmission On Vehicle Service for correct seal replacement procedure.
Tailshaft Seal
Important:
This seal has a small vent hole in the flexible boot. This hole must be installed facing down or the
boot could collect and hold water. Use sandpaper or crocus cloth to clean any rust or corrosion off
the slip yoke barrel before installation. If the slip yoke barrel is not clean, the seal could be
damaged.
Parts Information
P/N DESCRIPTION QTY
24201470 Seal, trans extension oil 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Labor
OPERATION DESCRIPTION LABOR TIME
K6360 Seal, Extension Use Published
Housing Rear - Labor Operation
Replace Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 467108 > Dec
> 94 > A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
File In Section: 7 - Transmission Bulletin No. 46-71-08 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Transmission Extension Seal Leaks (Install Revised Seal)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C1-2, G, S, M Models with 4L60 (MD8) or 4L60-E
(M3O) and One-Piece Propeller Shaft
CONDITION Some vehicles may experience a leak from the transmission extension seal.
CAUSE This leak may occur if the seal lips are damaged by a corroded slip yoke barrel. As the
rear suspension moves, the slip yoke slides past the seal lips. If the slip yoke barrel is corroded,
seal damage can occur resulting in a leak.
CORRECTION Install a revised seal P/N 24201470. The seal features a flexible boot which covers
the slip yoke barrel to prevent corrosion. This seal is used in production starting with the 1995
model year.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Refer to the appropriate year and model Light Truck Service Manual,
Section 7A - Automatic Transmission On Vehicle Service for correct seal replacement procedure.
Tailshaft Seal
Important:
This seal has a small vent hole in the flexible boot. This hole must be installed facing down or the
boot could collect and hold water. Use sandpaper or crocus cloth to clean any rust or corrosion off
the slip yoke barrel before installation. If the slip yoke barrel is not clean, the seal could be
damaged.
Parts Information
P/N DESCRIPTION QTY
24201470 Seal, trans extension oil 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Labor
OPERATION DESCRIPTION LABOR TIME
K6360 Seal, Extension Use Published
Housing Rear - Labor Operation
Replace Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-013B >
Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 04-07-30-013B >
Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 4899
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 4900
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 467108 Date: 941201
A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
File In Section: 7 - Transmission Bulletin No. 46-71-08 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Transmission Extension Seal Leaks (Install Revised Seal)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C1-2, G, S, M Models with 4L60 (MD8) or 4L60-E
(M3O) and One-Piece Propeller Shaft
CONDITION Some vehicles may experience a leak from the transmission extension seal.
CAUSE This leak may occur if the seal lips are damaged by a corroded slip yoke barrel. As the
rear suspension moves, the slip yoke slides past the seal lips. If the slip yoke barrel is corroded,
seal damage can occur resulting in a leak.
CORRECTION Install a revised seal P/N 24201470. The seal features a flexible boot which covers
the slip yoke barrel to prevent corrosion. This seal is used in production starting with the 1995
model year.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Refer to the appropriate year and model Light Truck Service Manual,
Section 7A - Automatic Transmission On Vehicle Service for correct seal replacement procedure.
Tailshaft Seal
Important:
This seal has a small vent hole in the flexible boot. This hole must be installed facing down or the
boot could collect and hold water. Use sandpaper or crocus cloth to clean any rust or corrosion off
the slip yoke barrel before installation. If the slip yoke barrel is not clean, the seal could be
damaged.
Parts Information
P/N DESCRIPTION QTY
24201470 Seal, trans extension oil 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Labor
OPERATION DESCRIPTION LABOR TIME
K6360 Seal, Extension Use Published
Housing Rear - Labor Operation
Replace Time
Technical Service Bulletin # 467108 Date: 941201
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 4901
A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
File In Section: 7 - Transmission Bulletin No. 46-71-08 Date: December, 1994
Subject: Transmission Extension Seal Leaks (Install Revised Seal)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C1-2, G, S, M Models with 4L60 (MD8) or 4L60-E
(M3O) and One-Piece Propeller Shaft
CONDITION Some vehicles may experience a leak from the transmission extension seal.
CAUSE This leak may occur if the seal lips are damaged by a corroded slip yoke barrel. As the
rear suspension moves, the slip yoke slides past the seal lips. If the slip yoke barrel is corroded,
seal damage can occur resulting in a leak.
CORRECTION Install a revised seal P/N 24201470. The seal features a flexible boot which covers
the slip yoke barrel to prevent corrosion. This seal is used in production starting with the 1995
model year.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Refer to the appropriate year and model Light Truck Service Manual,
Section 7A - Automatic Transmission On Vehicle Service for correct seal replacement procedure.
Tailshaft Seal
Important:
This seal has a small vent hole in the flexible boot. This hole must be installed facing down or the
boot could collect and hold water. Use sandpaper or crocus cloth to clean any rust or corrosion off
the slip yoke barrel before installation. If the slip yoke barrel is not clean, the seal could be
damaged.
Parts Information
P/N DESCRIPTION QTY
24201470 Seal, trans extension oil 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Labor
OPERATION DESCRIPTION LABOR TIME
K6360 Seal, Extension Use Published
Housing Rear - Labor Operation
Replace Time
Technical Service Bulletin # 467108 Date: 941201
A/T - Extension Seal Leaks
File In Section: 7 - Transmission Bulletin No. 46-71-08
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 4902
Date: December, 1994
Subject: Transmission Extension Seal Leaks (Install Revised Seal)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C1-2, G, S, M Models with 4L60 (MD8) or 4L60-E
(M3O) and One-Piece Propeller Shaft
CONDITION Some vehicles may experience a leak from the transmission extension seal.
CAUSE This leak may occur if the seal lips are damaged by a corroded slip yoke barrel. As the
rear suspension moves, the slip yoke slides past the seal lips. If the slip yoke barrel is corroded,
seal damage can occur resulting in a leak.
CORRECTION Install a revised seal P/N 24201470. The seal features a flexible boot which covers
the slip yoke barrel to prevent corrosion. This seal is used in production starting with the 1995
model year.
SERVICE PROCEDURE Refer to the appropriate year and model Light Truck Service Manual,
Section 7A - Automatic Transmission On Vehicle Service for correct seal replacement procedure.
Tailshaft Seal
Important:
This seal has a small vent hole in the flexible boot. This hole must be installed facing down or the
boot could collect and hold water. Use sandpaper or crocus cloth to clean any rust or corrosion off
the slip yoke barrel before installation. If the slip yoke barrel is not clean, the seal could be
damaged.
Parts Information
P/N DESCRIPTION QTY
24201470 Seal, trans extension oil 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Labor
OPERATION DESCRIPTION LABOR TIME
K6360 Seal, Extension Use Published
Housing Rear - Labor Operation
Replace Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T
> System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4903
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
1. Remove driveshaft, and tunnel strap, if equipped. 2. Using suitable tool, pry out lip oil seal. 3.
Coat outer casting of new oil seal with suitable sealer and drive into place with seal installer tool
No. J-21426 or equivalent. 4. Install tunnel strap if used, then install driveshaft.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch > Page 4909
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Page 4910
C217 - Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Plugs (1/8 - 27) .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Pressure Plugs (1/4 - 18) ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 18 Pressure Switches ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs. Vehicle Speed Sensor Retainer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
The Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor is used by the control module to control: Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) apply and release schedule.
- Hot mode determination.
- Shift quality.
OPERATION
The TFT is a thermistor used to indicate transmission fluid temperature. The control module sends
a 5.0 volt signal to the TFT through a resistor in the computer and measures the voltage. High
sensor resistance produces high signal input voltage which corresponds to low fluid temperature.
Low sensor resistance produces low signal input voltage which corresponds to high fluid
temperature. With the TFT varying its resistance, the control module can sense transmission fluid
temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION
The sensor is part of the transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly and is attached to the
control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Component Resistance Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4927
Shift Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body ..........................................................................................
................................................................................ 8 Solenoid Assembly To Pump ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 8 Solenoid Assembly To Case ....................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Electronic Component Location Views
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4930
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 1-2 and 3-4
shift valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 2-3 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page 4933
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 2-3 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 2-3 shift
valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 1-2 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page 4934
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 3-2 Control Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 3-2 shift
valve, which then controls the 2-4 band apply rate and 3-4 clutch release rate. The solenoid also
controls the 3-2 downshift feel.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a pulse width modulated solenoid that operates on a negative duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Valve Body and Wiring Harness
VALVE BODY AND WIRING HARNESS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4937
Valve Body Bolt Location
Control Valve And Pressure Switch Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4938
Manual Valve Link
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4939
Valve Body Checkballs
Case Checkballs And Filters
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Electrical connections from components. 2. TCC PWM Solenoid Retainer Clip (379) and
Solenoid (396). 3. TCC Solenoid bolts (68) and solenoid assembly (66) with O-ring seal (65) and
wiring harness. 4. Pressure switch assembly bolts (70) and pressure switch assembly (69). 5.
Accumulator cover bolts (58 and 59) and 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57). 6. 1-2
accumulator piston (56) and seal (55). 7. Spring (54). 8. Dipstick stop bracket (93).
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (64) and manual detent spring assembly (63).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4940
2. Wiring harness retaining bolts.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Remaining valve body bolts (62). 2. Manual valve link (89). 3. Control valve assembly (60). 4.
Bolts (58 and 59), accumulator cover (57), piston (56, spring (54) and spring (54A). 5. Bolts (77)
and plate (53). 6. Spacer plate (48) and spacer plate gaskets (47 and 52). 7. Spring (46), piston
(44), and pin (43).
- Seven checkballs are located under the valve body and one is located in the case. The large
copper flash colored ball is # 1A checkball (91).
Valve Body and Associated Parts
VALVE BODY AND ASSOCIATED PARTS
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate And Gaskets
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4941
Case Checkballs And Filters
TOOL REQUIRED:
- J 25025-5 Guide Pins
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined corners that are necessary for
"cleaning" the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, "micro fine" lapping
compound 900 grit or finer should be used. Too much "lapping" of a valve will cause excessive
clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. The wiring harness pass-thru connector into the case. 2. The 3-4 accumulator pin (43) into the
case. 3. The 3-4 accumulator piston seal (45) onto the 3-4 accumulator piston. 4. The 3-4
accumulator piston (44) onto the pin.
- The end with three legs must face the valve body.
5. The 3-4 accumulator piston spring (46).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkball (91) into case as shown.
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. J 25025-5 into the case. 3. Screens onto spacer plate as shown. 4. Spacer plate to case gasket
(47) and spacer plate to valve body gasket (52) onto the spacer plate (48).
- Gasket (47) identified by a "C". Gasket (52) identified by a "V".
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
5. Spacer plate and gaskets onto the case.
IMPORTANT
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the spacer plate and gaskets.
6. Spacer plate support (53) and bolts (77).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.)
Control Valve Body
CONTROL VALVE BODY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4942
Case Checkballs And Filters
Filter Screen - Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4943
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4944
Control Valve Assembly - Legend
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4945
Valve Body Checkball Locations
Valve Body Bolt Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4946
Manual Valve Link
Outside Electrical Connector
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly thoroughly in clean solvent. A. Move the valves with a pick or small
screwdriver to dislodge any dirt or debris that may have accumulated. B. Air dry.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
IMPORTANT
- Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing roll pins and retainer clips.
- Valves, springs and bushings must be laid out on a clean surface in the exact sequence they are
removed.
1. Pressure control solenoid retainer bolt (364) retainer (378) and solenoid. 2. Bore plug retainer
clip (395), bore plug (376) and valve train (374 and 375). 3. 2-3 shift solenoid retainer (379),
solenoid (367) and valve train (368 and 369). 4. 1-2 shift solenoid retainer (379), solenoid (367)
and valve train (365 and 366). 5. Accumulator valve train retainer pin (360), bore plug (373) and
valve train (370 and 371). 6. Forward accumulator cover bolts (364) and cover (363). 7. Forward
accumulator spring (356), piston (354) and pin (355). 8. Lo overrun valve spring (362) and valve
(361). 9. Retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and forward abuse valve train (357 and 358).
10. Manual valve (340). 11. 3-2 control solenoid retainer clip (379) and solenoid (394).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4947
12. Bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and 3-2 control valve train (391 - 393). 13. 3-2
downshift bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (389 - 390). 14. Reverse abuse
bore plug retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and valve train (387 - 388). 15. 3-4 shift valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (385 - 386). 16. 3-4 relay bore plug retainer
(395), bore plug (381) and valve train (382 - 384). 17. Torque converter clutch signal valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve (380).
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings and control valve body in clean solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
- All valves and bushings for: Porosity
- Scoring
- Nicks
- Scratches
- Springs for damaged or distorted coils.
- Valve body casting for: Porosity
- Cracks
- Inter connected oil passages
- Damaged machined surfaces
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly (350) exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and bushing passages.
- Position the pressure control solenoid so the connector tabs face outward.
NOTICE: TCC PWM solenoid (396) cannot be installed until TCC solenoid has been installed and
torqued to proper specifications.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkballs into the valve body assembly (350).
- Retain with Transjell TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. Valve body assembly (350).
- Connect the manual valve link (89) to the inside detent lever (88).
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the valve body assembly.
3. Wiring harness (66), manual spring assembly (63), pressure switch assembly(69), dipstick, stop
bracket (93) and all remaining valve body bolts.
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
4. TCC solenoid (66) and bolts (68).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
5. TCC PWM solenoid (396), and retainer clip (379).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Wiring harness connections to electrical components.
- To correctly hook up the wires, see the wiring diagrams.
- The pressure control solenoid (377) has two different colored connectors. The black connector
should be installed on the tab farthest from the valve body.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Parking bracket (86).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 31 Nm (23 lb. ft.).
2. The 1-2 accumulator piston seal (55) onto the 1-2 accumulator piston (56). 3. The 1-2
accumulator spring (54) and 1-2 accumulator inner spring (54A) onto the piston (56). 4. The 1-2
accumulator piston (56) into the 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57).
- The three legs on the piston must face away from the case when installed.
5. The 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57) onto the case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4948
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4949
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L80-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Wire Harness Assembly
WIRE HARNESS ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4950
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Wire harness connectors from electrical components.
NOTICE: Excessive force on the case pass through connector may damage the connector.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
2. Wire harness assembly (34) from case using a 1-5/16" 12 point socket to release the connector
retaining clips.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4951
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Rotate transmission bottom pan surface up and lock in place. 2. Wire harness assembly (34)
connectors from components.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
- Use a cap to cover electrical pin at case connection.
3. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket, and transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40).
NOTICE: Be sure five O-rings are attached to transmission fluid pressure switch assembly.
4. Twenty-one bolts (35) using 10 mm socket, from valve body assembly, manual detent spring and
roller assembly (41). 5. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid level indicator stop (43), one bolt (36) using
10 mm socket, lube pipe (39), lube pipe retainer (37) and clamp (38). 6. Control valve assembly
(44) including the accumulator housing assembly (51), valve body gaskets (45 and 48), spacer
plate (46) and accumulator
gasket (47).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4952
7. Manual valve (319) from control valve assembly (44) to prevent any damage. 8. Checkballs (54)
from case passages.
NOTICE: Do not use a magnet. It could cause checkball(s) to be magnetized causing metal
particles to stick to the ball.
9. Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid screen (75).
INSPECT
- Screen PWM solenoid (75), replace if necessary.
DISASSEMBLE
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4953
- Control valve assembly. A. Position as shown on a clean surface. B. Remove blind hole retainer
pins with a drill bit.
CAUTION: Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing the retaining pins or
personal injury could result.
C. Remove valve trains, shift solenoids (311 and 313), PCS (320), PWM solenoid (323), PCS
screen (302) and shift solenoid filter (317). D. Valves, springs, bushings and pistons must be laid
out on a clean surface.
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings, pistons, control valve body and accumulator housing in clean
solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
1. All valves, pistons and bushings for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
2. Pistons for:
- Seal damage.
3. Springs for:
- Damaged or distorted coils.
4. Valve body casting and accumulator housing for:
- Porosity.
- Cracks.
- Interconnected passages.
- Damaged machined surfaces.
5. Solenoid connectors and filter (317). 6. PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid) screen (302).
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY/ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4954
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4955
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4956
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4957
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4958
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined comers that are necessary for
cleaning the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and the bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, micro fine lapping
compound 900 grit (J 38459) or finer should be used. Too much lapping of the valve will cause
excessive clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly and accumulator housing (51) thoroughly in clean solvent.
- Air dry.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4959
Accumulator Housing Assembly
ACCUMULATOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4960
Accumulator Housing Assembly
DISASSEMBLE
1. Six bolts (53), using 8 mm socket. 2. Accumulator housing assembly. 3. Gasket accumulator
housing (47). 4. Spacer plate (46). 5. Gasket (45) valve body spacer. 6. Snap ring (402) from
outside housing, pin (408), snap ring (402), piston (407) and spring (49). 7. 3rd clutch piston (405)
and spring (50). 8. Seals (404 and 406).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4961
CLEAN
- All components.
INSPECT
- All valves, pistons, springs and seals for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4962
ASSEMBLE
- Accumulator housing assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the positions of the pistons.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and
bushing passages.
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4963
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY AND ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
TOOL REQUIRED:
- Guide Pin J 25025-5
ASSEMBLE
1. Guide pin J 25025-5 into valve body. Located at back bolt hole of detent spring and roller
assembly bolt bole. 2. Gasket (45) valve body to spacer plate. 3. Spacer plate (46). 4. Gasket (47)
accumulator housing to spacer plate. 5. Accumulator housing assembly (51) onto valve body
assembly (44).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4964
6. Six bolts (53) using (8 mm) socket through accumulator housing into valve body assembly.
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
NOTE: Start accumulator housing bolts finger tight and work towards opposite end.
TIGHTEN
- Bolt (53) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
7. Remove guide pin J 25025-5.
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4965
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4966
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Install checkballs (54) in proper location into case fluid passages. Use TRANSJEL TM J 36850
or equivalent to hold in place.
NOTICE: Do not use any type of grease to retain parts during assembly of this unit. Greases other
than the recommended assembly lube will change transmission fluid characteristics and cause
undesirable shift conditions and/or filter clogging.
- # 2 checkball is used only on RCP RDP, ZJP and ZLP models.
2. PWM solenoid screen (75).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4967
3. Gasket (48) spacer plate to case. 4. Manual valve (319) into valve body. 5. Complete valve body
assembly (44) onto case (7). Use 1 25025-5 guide pin set.
IMPORTANT
- Attach manual valve to detent lever.
6. Transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40) onto valve body assembly (44). 7. Spring and
roller assembly (41) into place. 8. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid indicator stop (43) and lube pipe
clamp (38). 9. Twenty-one bolts (35). Using 10 mm socket.
10. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket into transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40). 11.
Lube pipe (39) long end into case, short end into valve body. 12. Lube pipe retainer (37) with short
bolt (36).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (35, 36 and 76) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4968
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
13. Attach wiring harness (34) to 5 connectors.
- Put large end into case first, pressure switch hook up, 1-2 shift solenoid (purple) and 2-3 shift
solenoid (tan), PWM (Pulse Width Modulated) solenoid and PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid).
Pan and Filter Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 4969
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May > 94 > A/T No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power
Technical Service Bulletin # 467102 Date: 940501
A/T - No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power
Group Ref.: Transmission
Bulletin No.: 467102
Date: May 1994
SUBJECT: NO REVERSE, OR PERCEIVED LACK OF POWER (TIE UP) IN 2ND GEAR (SHIFT
LINKAGE ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S/T, M/L, C/K 1, 2 MODELS 1994
OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA WITH 4L60E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (RPO M30) AND ROD
STYLE SHIFT LINKAGE
Condition
Some owners may experience a loss of reverse or a tie-up (perceived lack of power) in 2nd gear.
Inspection of these transmissions often indicates heavy wear and evidence of high heat on the
low-reverse clutch and 2-4 band.
CAUSE: The transmission shift linkage may be improperly adjusted (the manual valve is not
properly positioned in relationship to the "PRNDL" position). This may prevent the low-reverse
clutch apply circuit from exhausting after a shift from park or reverse to a forward range. If the
low-reverse clutch remains partially applied, a tie-up may occur when the transmission shifts from
first to second gear. This could result in low-reverse clutch and 2-4 band failure.
Correction
The transmission shift linkage must be properly adjusted following repair or replacement of the
transmission or if the "PRNDL" indicator does not match the actual transmission range. The
following procedure must be followed when adjusting the rod style linkage on a 4L60E equipped
vehicle:
- S/T models use adjustment procedure # 1
- M/L models use adjustment procedure # 2
- C/K models use adjustment procedure # 3
Adjustment procedure # 1 applies to 1994 S/T vehicles with 4L60E transmission: (Figure 1)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May > 94 > A/T No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power > Page 4978
1. Linkage adjustment must be performed at the transmission prior to any "PRNDL" indicator
adjustment at the steering column.
2. Full weight of vehicle must be on wheels (curb height). Do not use a frame hoist to raise the
vehicle for this procedure. Mandatory that vehicle be raised on a twin post hoist or utilize an
alignment rack.
3. Position the steering column shift lever in the neutral gate notch. (Do not use the indicator to find
neutral.)
4. Loosen the bolt (2) in the swivel (4) that clamps the shift rod (1) to the transmission equalizer
lever (3). Make sure that the shift rod moves freely in the swivel.
5. Set trans lever (5) in neutral detent. Obtain neutral detent by indexing trans lever all the way
clockwise to "PARK", then counter-clockwise two detents to "NEUTRAL". (Alternate procedure is to
rotate trans lever counter-clockwise all the way to "L1", then rotate it clockwise four detents.)
6. Make sure that trans control lever (3) is fully seated in trans lever (5). Hold the rod (1) tightly in
the swivel (4). Tighten clamp screw (2) against rod (1) to 25 N-m (18 lbs.ft.). Make sure the rod
does not move in the swivel while tightening the screw.
7. Verify proper adjustment:
- When moving the transmission shift lever in either direction, all detent positions will be attainable
without a binding condition present.
- With the key on and the shift lever in "Reverse", the key will not be removable and the steering
column will not be locked.
- With the key in the lock position and the shift lever in the "Park" position, the key will be
removable, the steering wheel will be locked, and the shift lever will not disengage from "Park". In
addition, verify that the vehicle is held stationary in "Park".
- The engine must start in the "Neutral" or "Park" positions only. Adjust neutral safety *switch as
required.
- Verify that shift indicator position matches actual transmission range. Adjust "PRNDL" switch as
required.
Adjustment procedure # 2 applies to 1994 M/L vehicles with 4L60E transmission: (Figure 2)
1. Linkage adjustment must be performed at the transmission prior to any "PRNDL" indicator
adjustment at the steering column.
2. Full weight of vehicle must be on wheels (curb height). Do not use a frame hoist to raise the
vehicle for this procedure. Mandatory that vehicle be raised on a twin post hoist or utilize an
alignment rack.
3. Position the steering column shift lever in the neutral gate notch. (Do not use the indicator to find
neutral).
4. Loosen the bolt (2) from the swivel (4) that clamps the shift rod (1) to the transmission equalizer
lever (3), Make sure the rod slides freely in the swivel.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May > 94 > A/T No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power > Page 4979
5. Set trans lever (5) in neutral detent. Obtain neutral detent by indexing trans lever all the way
clockwise to "PARK", then counter-clockwise two detents to "NEUTRAL". (Alternate procedure is to
rotate trans lever counter-clockwise all the way to "L1", then rotate it clockwise four detents.)
6. Make sure that transmission equalizer lever (3) is fully seated in trans lever (5). Hold the shift rod
(1) tightly in the swivel (4) and tighten the bolt (2) to 25 N-m (18 lbs.ft.). Do not allow the rod to slide
in the swivel while tightening.
7. Verify proper adjustment:
- When moving the transmission shift lever in either direction, all detent positions will be attainable
without a binding condition present.
- With the key on and the shift lever in "Reverse", the key will not be removable and the steering
column will not be locked.
- With the key in the lock position and the shift lever in the "Park" position, the key will be
removable, the steering wheel will be locked, and the shift lever will not disengage from "Park". In
addition, verify that the vehicle is held stationary in "Park".
- The engine must start in the "Neutral" or "Park" positions only. Adjust neutral safety switch as
required.
- Verify that shift indicator position matches actual transmission range. Adjust "PRNDL" switch as
required.
Adjustment procedure # 3 applies to 1994 C/K vehicles with 4L60E transmission: (Figure 3)
1. Linkage adjustment must be performed at the lower end of the steering column prior to any
"PRNDL" indicator adjustment.
2. Full weight of vehicle must be on wheels (curb height). Do not use a frame hoist to raise the
vehicle for this procedure. Mandatory that vehicle be raised on a twin post hoist or utilize an
alignment rack.
3. Position the steering column shift lever in the neutral gate notch. (Do not use the indicator to find
neutral).
4. Loosen the bolt (2) from the swivel (4) that clamps the shift rod (1) to the transmission equalizer
lever (3). Make sure the rod slides freely in the swivel.
5. Set trans lever (3) in neutral detent. Obtain neutral detent by indexing trans lever all the way
clockwise to "PARK", then counter-clockwise two detents to "NEUTRAL". (Alternate procedure is to
rotate trans lever counter-clockwise all the way to "L1", then rotate it clockwise four detents.)
6. Hold the rod (1) tightly in the swivel (4) and tighten screw (2) to 25 N-m (18 lbs.ft.). Do not allow
the rod to move in the swivel while tightening.
7. Verify proper adjustment:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May > 94 > A/T No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power > Page 4980
- When moving the transmission shift lever in either direction, all detent positions will be attainable
without a binding condition present.
- With the key on and the shift lever in "Reverse", the key will not be removable and the steering
column will not be locked.
- With the key in the lock position and the shift lever in the "Park" position, the key will be
removable, the steering wheel will be locked, and the shift lever will not disengage from "Park". In
addition, verify that the vehicle is held stationary in "Park".
- The engine must start in the "Neutral" or "Park" positions only. Adjust neutral safety switch as
required.
- Verify that shift indicator position matches actual transmission range. Adjust "PRNDL" switch as
required.
Please note these new procedures in the appropriate Service Manual, Section 7A.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor 0p Description Labor Time
K5244 Linkage, Shift Use Published
Adjust Labor Operation
Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May >
94 > A/T - No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power
Technical Service Bulletin # 467102 Date: 940501
A/T - No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power
Group Ref.: Transmission
Bulletin No.: 467102
Date: May 1994
SUBJECT: NO REVERSE, OR PERCEIVED LACK OF POWER (TIE UP) IN 2ND GEAR (SHIFT
LINKAGE ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S/T, M/L, C/K 1, 2 MODELS 1994
OLDSMOBILE BRAVADA WITH 4L60E AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (RPO M30) AND ROD
STYLE SHIFT LINKAGE
Condition
Some owners may experience a loss of reverse or a tie-up (perceived lack of power) in 2nd gear.
Inspection of these transmissions often indicates heavy wear and evidence of high heat on the
low-reverse clutch and 2-4 band.
CAUSE: The transmission shift linkage may be improperly adjusted (the manual valve is not
properly positioned in relationship to the "PRNDL" position). This may prevent the low-reverse
clutch apply circuit from exhausting after a shift from park or reverse to a forward range. If the
low-reverse clutch remains partially applied, a tie-up may occur when the transmission shifts from
first to second gear. This could result in low-reverse clutch and 2-4 band failure.
Correction
The transmission shift linkage must be properly adjusted following repair or replacement of the
transmission or if the "PRNDL" indicator does not match the actual transmission range. The
following procedure must be followed when adjusting the rod style linkage on a 4L60E equipped
vehicle:
- S/T models use adjustment procedure # 1
- M/L models use adjustment procedure # 2
- C/K models use adjustment procedure # 3
Adjustment procedure # 1 applies to 1994 S/T vehicles with 4L60E transmission: (Figure 1)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May >
94 > A/T - No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power > Page 4986
1. Linkage adjustment must be performed at the transmission prior to any "PRNDL" indicator
adjustment at the steering column.
2. Full weight of vehicle must be on wheels (curb height). Do not use a frame hoist to raise the
vehicle for this procedure. Mandatory that vehicle be raised on a twin post hoist or utilize an
alignment rack.
3. Position the steering column shift lever in the neutral gate notch. (Do not use the indicator to find
neutral.)
4. Loosen the bolt (2) in the swivel (4) that clamps the shift rod (1) to the transmission equalizer
lever (3). Make sure that the shift rod moves freely in the swivel.
5. Set trans lever (5) in neutral detent. Obtain neutral detent by indexing trans lever all the way
clockwise to "PARK", then counter-clockwise two detents to "NEUTRAL". (Alternate procedure is to
rotate trans lever counter-clockwise all the way to "L1", then rotate it clockwise four detents.)
6. Make sure that trans control lever (3) is fully seated in trans lever (5). Hold the rod (1) tightly in
the swivel (4). Tighten clamp screw (2) against rod (1) to 25 N-m (18 lbs.ft.). Make sure the rod
does not move in the swivel while tightening the screw.
7. Verify proper adjustment:
- When moving the transmission shift lever in either direction, all detent positions will be attainable
without a binding condition present.
- With the key on and the shift lever in "Reverse", the key will not be removable and the steering
column will not be locked.
- With the key in the lock position and the shift lever in the "Park" position, the key will be
removable, the steering wheel will be locked, and the shift lever will not disengage from "Park". In
addition, verify that the vehicle is held stationary in "Park".
- The engine must start in the "Neutral" or "Park" positions only. Adjust neutral safety *switch as
required.
- Verify that shift indicator position matches actual transmission range. Adjust "PRNDL" switch as
required.
Adjustment procedure # 2 applies to 1994 M/L vehicles with 4L60E transmission: (Figure 2)
1. Linkage adjustment must be performed at the transmission prior to any "PRNDL" indicator
adjustment at the steering column.
2. Full weight of vehicle must be on wheels (curb height). Do not use a frame hoist to raise the
vehicle for this procedure. Mandatory that vehicle be raised on a twin post hoist or utilize an
alignment rack.
3. Position the steering column shift lever in the neutral gate notch. (Do not use the indicator to find
neutral).
4. Loosen the bolt (2) from the swivel (4) that clamps the shift rod (1) to the transmission equalizer
lever (3), Make sure the rod slides freely in the swivel.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May >
94 > A/T - No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power > Page 4987
5. Set trans lever (5) in neutral detent. Obtain neutral detent by indexing trans lever all the way
clockwise to "PARK", then counter-clockwise two detents to "NEUTRAL". (Alternate procedure is to
rotate trans lever counter-clockwise all the way to "L1", then rotate it clockwise four detents.)
6. Make sure that transmission equalizer lever (3) is fully seated in trans lever (5). Hold the shift rod
(1) tightly in the swivel (4) and tighten the bolt (2) to 25 N-m (18 lbs.ft.). Do not allow the rod to slide
in the swivel while tightening.
7. Verify proper adjustment:
- When moving the transmission shift lever in either direction, all detent positions will be attainable
without a binding condition present.
- With the key on and the shift lever in "Reverse", the key will not be removable and the steering
column will not be locked.
- With the key in the lock position and the shift lever in the "Park" position, the key will be
removable, the steering wheel will be locked, and the shift lever will not disengage from "Park". In
addition, verify that the vehicle is held stationary in "Park".
- The engine must start in the "Neutral" or "Park" positions only. Adjust neutral safety switch as
required.
- Verify that shift indicator position matches actual transmission range. Adjust "PRNDL" switch as
required.
Adjustment procedure # 3 applies to 1994 C/K vehicles with 4L60E transmission: (Figure 3)
1. Linkage adjustment must be performed at the lower end of the steering column prior to any
"PRNDL" indicator adjustment.
2. Full weight of vehicle must be on wheels (curb height). Do not use a frame hoist to raise the
vehicle for this procedure. Mandatory that vehicle be raised on a twin post hoist or utilize an
alignment rack.
3. Position the steering column shift lever in the neutral gate notch. (Do not use the indicator to find
neutral).
4. Loosen the bolt (2) from the swivel (4) that clamps the shift rod (1) to the transmission equalizer
lever (3). Make sure the rod slides freely in the swivel.
5. Set trans lever (3) in neutral detent. Obtain neutral detent by indexing trans lever all the way
clockwise to "PARK", then counter-clockwise two detents to "NEUTRAL". (Alternate procedure is to
rotate trans lever counter-clockwise all the way to "L1", then rotate it clockwise four detents.)
6. Hold the rod (1) tightly in the swivel (4) and tighten screw (2) to 25 N-m (18 lbs.ft.). Do not allow
the rod to move in the swivel while tightening.
7. Verify proper adjustment:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Linkage: > 467102 > May >
94 > A/T - No Reverse, Perceived Second Gear Lack of Power > Page 4988
- When moving the transmission shift lever in either direction, all detent positions will be attainable
without a binding condition present.
- With the key on and the shift lever in "Reverse", the key will not be removable and the steering
column will not be locked.
- With the key in the lock position and the shift lever in the "Park" position, the key will be
removable, the steering wheel will be locked, and the shift lever will not disengage from "Park". In
addition, verify that the vehicle is held stationary in "Park".
- The engine must start in the "Neutral" or "Park" positions only. Adjust neutral safety switch as
required.
- Verify that shift indicator position matches actual transmission range. Adjust "PRNDL" switch as
required.
Please note these new procedures in the appropriate Service Manual, Section 7A.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor 0p Description Labor Time
K5244 Linkage, Shift Use Published
Adjust Labor Operation
Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Shift Rod Swivel Attaching Nuts
Shift Linkage: Specifications Shift Rod Swivel Attaching Nuts
Shift Rod Swivel Attaching Nut ............................................................................................................
................................................................. 18 Ft.Lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Shift Rod Swivel Attaching Nuts > Page 4991
Shift Linkage: Specifications 4L60 & 4L60-E Transmission
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Manual Shaft To Inside Detent Lever ..................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 23
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4992
Shift Linkage: Adjustments
Fig.8 Shift Linkage Adjustment
1. Apply parking brake, then loosen swivel nut, Fig. 8. 2. Place column selector lever in neutral. 3.
Place transmission in Neutral by moving shift lever to its forward position, then back to the second
detent position. 4. Holding shift rod tightly in the swivel, tighten swivel nut to specifications. 5. Place
column selector lever into park position and check adjustment. The column selector lever must
move through all the detents. The engine
must start in the park or Neutral positions. With the selector lever in the park position, the parking
pawl should freely engage within the rear (reaction) internal gear lugs or the output ring gear lugs
and prevent the vehicle from rolling, which could result in personal injury.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Speedometer Gear,
A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Speedometer Gear, A/T: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect speedometer cable or P.M. generator electrical connector at transmission. 2.
Remove retainer bolt, retainer, P.M. generator if equipped, speedometer driven gear and O-ring
seal. 3. Reverse procedure to install, using new O-ring and adding fluid as necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
Sun Gear: Customer Interest A/T - 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 00-07-30-022D
Date: June 10, 2008
Subject: No Reverse, Second Gear or Fourth Gear (Replace Reaction Sun Shell with More Robust
Heat Treated Parts)
Models: 1993 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003 - 2005 HUMMER H2
with 4L60/65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30 or M32)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add 2005 model year to the parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-07-30-022C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a no reverse, no second or no fourth gear condition. First and
third gears will operate properly.
Cause
The reaction sun gear (673) may not hold inside the reaction sun shell (670).
Correction
Important:
There are FOUR distinct groups of vehicles and repair procedures involved. Vehicles built in the
2001 model year and prior that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust washer:
^ The sun shell can be identified by four square holes used to retain the thrust washer. Use
reaction sun shell P/N 24228345, reaction carrier to shell thrust washer (699B) P/N 8642202 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674) P/N 8642331er (674) P/N 8642331along with the
appropriate seals and washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and prior that have had previous service to the reaction sun
shell: It is possible that some 2001 and prior model year vehicles have had previous service to the
reaction sun shell. At the time of service, these vehicles may have been updated with a Reaction
Sun Shell Kit (Refer to Service Bulletin 020730003) without four square holes to retain the thrust
washer. If it is found in a 2001 model year and prior vehicles that the reaction sun shell DOES NOT
have four square holes to retain the thrust washer, these vehicles must be serviced with P/Ns
24229825 (674), 24217328 and 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and washers listed
below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and later that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust
bearing: The sun shell can be identified by no holes to retain the thrust washer. Use reaction sun
shell, P/N 24229825, reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A), P/N 24217328 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674), P/N 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and
washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built from November, 2001 through June, 2002: These vehicles should have the reaction
carrier shaft replaced when the sun shell is replaced. Use shell kit P/N 24229853, which contains a
sun shell (670), a reaction carrier shaft (666), a reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A)
and a reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674). The appropriate seals and washers listed below
should also be used.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Follow the service procedure below for diagnosis and correction of the no reverse, no second, no
forth condition.
Important:
If metallic debris is found on the transmission magnet, the transmission must be completely
disassembled and cleaned. Metallic debris is defined as broken parts and pieces of internal
transmission components. This should not be confused with typical "normal" fine particles found on
all transmission magnets. Failure to properly clean the transmission case and internal components
may lead to additional repeat repairs.
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and inspect the magnet in the bottom of the pan for metal
debris. Refer to SI Document ID # 825141.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5004
2. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate SI document.
Important:
^ Inspect all the transmission components for damage or wear. Replace all damaged or worn
components. The parts shown above should be sufficient to correct this concern.
^ This condition does not normally require replacement of the transmission completely.
Components such as clutches, valve body, pump and torque converters will NOT require
replacement to correct this condition.
Disassemble the transmission and replace the appropriate parts listed below. Refer to the Unit
Repair Manual - Repair Instructions.
3. Reinstall the transmission in the vehicle. Refer to appropriate service information.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5005
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
Sun Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 00-07-30-022D
Date: June 10, 2008
Subject: No Reverse, Second Gear or Fourth Gear (Replace Reaction Sun Shell with More Robust
Heat Treated Parts)
Models: 1993 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003 - 2005 HUMMER H2
with 4L60/65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30 or M32)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add 2005 model year to the parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-07-30-022C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a no reverse, no second or no fourth gear condition. First and
third gears will operate properly.
Cause
The reaction sun gear (673) may not hold inside the reaction sun shell (670).
Correction
Important:
There are FOUR distinct groups of vehicles and repair procedures involved. Vehicles built in the
2001 model year and prior that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust washer:
^ The sun shell can be identified by four square holes used to retain the thrust washer. Use
reaction sun shell P/N 24228345, reaction carrier to shell thrust washer (699B) P/N 8642202 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674) P/N 8642331er (674) P/N 8642331along with the
appropriate seals and washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and prior that have had previous service to the reaction sun
shell: It is possible that some 2001 and prior model year vehicles have had previous service to the
reaction sun shell. At the time of service, these vehicles may have been updated with a Reaction
Sun Shell Kit (Refer to Service Bulletin 020730003) without four square holes to retain the thrust
washer. If it is found in a 2001 model year and prior vehicles that the reaction sun shell DOES NOT
have four square holes to retain the thrust washer, these vehicles must be serviced with P/Ns
24229825 (674), 24217328 and 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and washers listed
below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and later that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust
bearing: The sun shell can be identified by no holes to retain the thrust washer. Use reaction sun
shell, P/N 24229825, reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A), P/N 24217328 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674), P/N 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and
washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built from November, 2001 through June, 2002: These vehicles should have the reaction
carrier shaft replaced when the sun shell is replaced. Use shell kit P/N 24229853, which contains a
sun shell (670), a reaction carrier shaft (666), a reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A)
and a reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674). The appropriate seals and washers listed below
should also be used.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Follow the service procedure below for diagnosis and correction of the no reverse, no second, no
forth condition.
Important:
If metallic debris is found on the transmission magnet, the transmission must be completely
disassembled and cleaned. Metallic debris is defined as broken parts and pieces of internal
transmission components. This should not be confused with typical "normal" fine particles found on
all transmission magnets. Failure to properly clean the transmission case and internal components
may lead to additional repeat repairs.
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and inspect the magnet in the bottom of the pan for metal
debris. Refer to SI Document ID # 825141.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5011
2. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate SI document.
Important:
^ Inspect all the transmission components for damage or wear. Replace all damaged or worn
components. The parts shown above should be sufficient to correct this concern.
^ This condition does not normally require replacement of the transmission completely.
Components such as clutches, valve body, pump and torque converters will NOT require
replacement to correct this condition.
Disassemble the transmission and replace the appropriate parts listed below. Refer to the Unit
Repair Manual - Repair Instructions.
3. Reinstall the transmission in the vehicle. Refer to appropriate service information.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 5012
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information
Torque Converter: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-010C
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle Torque Converter Replacement
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saturn Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Except VTi Equipped Vehicles (RPO M16 and M75)
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with ALL Automatic Transmissions and Transaxles
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2007-2009 model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-010B (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The purpose of this bulletin is to help technicians determine when a torque converter should be
replaced. Below is a list of general guidelines to follow.
The converter should NOT be replaced if the following apply:
^ DTC P0742 - TCC stuck on is set. This code is almost always the result of a controls condition
(i.e. stuck TCC solenoid/valve). Experience has shown that this code rarely indicates a mechanical
concern within the torque converter.
^ The fluid has an odor or is discolored but no evidence of metal contamination.
^ Fine metal particles (traces of metal flakes/gray color to fluid ) are found in the converter. This is
not harmful to the torque converter.
^ The vehicle has been exposed to high mileage.
^ A small amount of wear appears on the hub where the oil pump drive gear mates to the converter
(RWD only). A certain amount of such wear is normal for both the hub and oil pump gear. Neither
the converter nor the front pump assembly should be replaced.
The torque converter should be replaced under any of the following conditions:
^ The vehicle has TCC shudder and/or no TCC apply. First complete all electrical and hydraulic
diagnosis and check for proper engine operation. The converter clutch may be damaged. Also the
converter bushing and/or internal 0-ring may be damaged.
^ Evidence of damage to the oil pump assembly pump shaft turbine shaft drive sprocket support
and bearing or metal chips/debris in the converter.
^ Metal chips/debris are found in the converter or when flushing the cooler and the cooler lines.
^ External leaks in the hub weld area lug weld or closure weld.
^ Converter pilot is broken damaged or fits poorly into the crankshaft.
^ The converter hub is scored or damaged.
^ The transmission oil is contaminated with engine coolant engine oil or water.
^ If excessive end play is found after measuring the converter for proper end play (refer to Service
Manual).
^ If metal chips/debris are found in the fluid filter or on the magnet and no internal parts in the unit
are worn or damaged. This indicates that the material came from the converter.
^ The converter has an unbalanced condition that results in a vibration that cannot be corrected by
following Converter Vibration Procedures.
^ Blue converter or dark circular ring between lugs. This condition will also require a complete
cleaning of the cooler and a check for adequate flow
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information > Page 5017
through the cooler.
^ Converter bearing noise determined by noise from the bell housing area in Drive or Reverse at
idle. The noise is gone in Neutral and Park.
^ If silicon from the viscous clutch is found in the lower pan (4T80-E ONLY).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch
Friction/Plates
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4
Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch
Friction/Plates > Page 5022
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch
Friction/Plates > Page 5023
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5024
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
Inside automatic transmission attached to valve body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5025
C216 - TCC
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5026
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transmission through the torque converter. This reduces
the slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy.
For the converter clutch to apply, two hydraulic conditions must be met: Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
- The control module completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Control module control is based on the input of these sensors: Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS): Vehicle equipped with A/C will allow TCC engagement at about 35
mph when the A/C is selected "ON". Engagement will occur at a vehicle speed of about 30 mph (25
mph for 92) when A/C is selected "OFF".
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Engine at normal operating temperature (above
65°C/149°F).
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS): Output not changing, indicating a steady road speed.
- Transmission Fluid (TFT) sensor.
Control module is also controlled by these switches: Brake switch closed: 12 volts supplied when brake is depressed.
- Transmission Range (TR) pressure switch assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-07-30-052G
Date: March 02, 2011
Subject: Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow(R)
Models:
2011 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2010 HUMMER H2 2006-2010
HUMMER H3 with Automatic Transmission/Transaxle including Allison(R) Transmissions
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052F (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle include
labor time to flush the transmission oil cooler system.
The J 45096 transmission oil cooling system flush and flow test tool replaces current tool J
35944-A. J 45096 is a self-contained unit utilizing a 12-volt flow meter, shop air supply and
DEXRON(R) VI automatic transmission fluid (ATF). In the flush mode, transmission fluid is cycled
through the transmission oil cooling system. High-pressure air is automatically injected into the fluid
stream adding agitation to the ATF oil to enhance the removal of contaminated ATF oil and debris.
In the flow mode, an electronic flow meter is used to measure the flow capability of the ATF oil
cooling system. A digital display indicates the ATF oil flow rate in gallons per minute (GPM) along
with the amount of ATF oil in the supply vessel, supply vessel ATF oil temperature, machine cycles
and the operating mode. The supply oil vessel has 30 L (32 qt) capacity and the waste oil vessel
has 32 L (34 qt) capacity. The waste oil vessel is constructed of a translucent composite material
that allows the user to easily identify the oil level. The waste oil vessel can accommodate vacuum
evacuation and gravity draining. In the code mode, a random, encrypted code is generated that can
be used for verification of flow test results.
Current essential cooler line adapters are used to connect the J 45096 to the automatic
transmission oil cooler lines that allows J 45096 to adapt to General Motors passenger cars and
light duty trucks, current and past models (except the Pontiac Vibe, Wave and Chevrolet Aveo).
The tool may be adapted for use on the Pontiac Vibe, Wave and Chevrolet Aveo by dealership
personnel with a barbed hose connector and rubber hose obtained locally. The
Vibe's/Wave's/Aveo's transmission has a transmission oil requirement which is slightly different
than DEXRON(R) VI ATF. However, flushing the cooler with DEXRON(R) VI automatic
transmission fluid is an acceptable service procedure. Very little fluid remains in the cooler after the
flush procedure and the residual DEXRON(R) VI ATF in the cooler is compatible with the
Vibe's/Wave's/Aveo's transmission fluid.
Notice
Insufficient oil flow through the ATF oil cooling system will cause premature transmission failure.
The required minimum ATF oil flow rate reading is directly related to the supply oil temperature.
Refer to the flow rate reference chart for the oil flow rate specification based on the temperature of
the ATF in the supply vessel.
Helpful Hints for Maintaining the Temperature at or above 18°C (65°F)
Important
- The temperature of the supply vessel oil must be 18°C (65°F) or greater for J 45096 to operate. It
is recommended to store the J 45096 in an area of the dealership where the room temperature
remains at or above 18°C (65°F) when not in use.
- Do not attempt to increase the fluid temperature in the Transflow(R) machine with an engine oil
dipstick, or any other immersion type heater. The Transflow(R) machine has a check valve in the
supply reservoir. Inserting a heater will damage the check valve and the subsequent repair
expense would be the dealer's responsibility.
- A heater blanket, P/N J-45096-10, is available for the Transflow(R) transmission cooling system
flushing tool. This heater fastens around the Transflow(R) internal supply vessel and runs on 110
volts AC. The heater will warm the ATF in the supply vessel to at least 18°C (65° F) and has a
thermostat to hold a constant temperature.
Store the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J 45096, Transflow(R) machine in a room
where the temperature is maintained at or above 18°C (65°F).
Keep the ATF level in the reservoir low when the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J
45096, Transflow(R), is not in use. Store several gallons of oil in an area where the temperature is
maintained at or above 18°C (65°F). Fill the reservoir of the J 45096 as needed before using the
machine on
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5031
each repair.
With the ATF in a tightly sealed container, place the container in a tub of hot water for a period of
time. Then pour the ATF into the reservoir. This method works best with a low fluid level in the
reservoir.
Place the Transflow(R) machine in the direct sunlight with the cabinet door open to expose the
reservoir to the rays of the warm sun.
Flush / Flow Test Procedure
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle and require
the transmission oil pan or transmission side cover to be removed include labor time to flush the
transmission oil cooler system.
Refer to SI for Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test J 45096 for the
appropriate procedure.
Important The J 45096 can be used to flush the transmission oil cooler system on an Allison
equipped vehicle, but the flow meter should not be utilized. Refer to SI for Automatic Transmission
Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test J 45096 for the appropriate flow check procedure.
Machine Displays
After completion of the flush and flow test, the following information is to be recorded on the repair
order. This information is displayed on the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J 45096,
Transflow(R) machine when the dial is in the code position.
- Tested flow rate (displayed in Gallons Per Minute (GPM)
- Temperature (displayed is degrees Fahrenheit)
- Cycle number (a number)
- Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code (i.e. A10DFB2)
Warranty Information
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle include
labor time to flush the transmission oil cooler system.
Performing a transmission oil cooling system flush and flow test will use between 4.7-7.5 L (5-8 qts)
of DEXRON(R)VI transmission fluid. The amount
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5032
of transmission fluid (ATF), (DEXRON(R)VI) (fluid) that is to be charged for the flush portion of the
repair should not exceed the allowable charge for 7.5 L (2 gal) of fluid. This expense should be
shown in the Parts Section of the warranty claim document.
The Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code, i.e. A10DFB2, "MUST" be written on the job card and
placed in the comments section of the warranty claim. Any repair that requires the technician to
contact the Product Quality Center (PQC) must also include the seven digit flow code. The agent
will request the seven digit flow code and add the information to the PQC case prior to providing
authorization for the warranty claim.
The Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code, i.e. A10DFB2, "MUST" be written on the job card,
entered in the warranty claim labor operation Flush Code additional field (when available) and
placed in the comments section of the warranty claim. Any repair that requires the technician to
contact the Product Quality Center (PQC) must also include the seven digit flow code. The agent
will request the seven digit flow code and add the information to the PQC case prior to providing
authorization for the warranty claim.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5033
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5034
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5035
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Oil Cooler Flushing Frequently Asked
Questions
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 03-07-30-027
Date: June, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: Most Frequently Asked Questions and Answers for J 45096 TransFlow Transmission Oil
Cooling System Flushing Machine
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle
2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
This bulletin is issued to help answer the most frequently asked questions and concerns about
essential tool J 45096.
Q: Why doesn't the machine work below 18°C (65°F)?
A: The flow characteristics of ATF at temperatures below 18°C (65°F) does not provide accurate
flow test results with the electronics used in the J
45096.
Q: Why didn't the unit come with a tank heater?
A: The vast majority of dealerships do not require a heater to keep the ATF above 18°C (65°F). As
a result, the heater was deleted as a cost-savings
measure. A tank heater, J 45096-10, is currently available from Kent-Moore if your dealership
requires it. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-07-30-002A for suggestions on warming the ATF
without using a heater blanket.
Q: Why does the machine fail new oil coolers?
A: Several reasons have been found. The most likely reason is the air pressure at the air hose
connected to the J 45096 is less than 586 kPa (85 psi).
Other reasons include a twisted hose inside the J 45096 at the bulkhead as a result of the nut
turning when the waste or supply hose was installed, the internal pressure regulator was
improperly set at the factory or a problem with the cooler lines on the vehicle. Perform the J 45096
self-test as described on pages 9 and 10 of the Operation Manual. If a problem is still detected,
refer to Troubleshooting on page 19 of the Operation Manual. If a problem still persists, contact
Kent-Moore Customer Service at 1-800-345-2233.
Q: What is the difference between steel and aluminum oil coolers?
A: The aluminum oil cooler tube is slightly thinner in construction than the steel oil cooler tube,
which affects the oil flow rate. The fitting that is
protruding out of the radiator tank easily identifies the aluminum oil cooler. Refer to the Quick
Reference card provided with the J 45096 in order to identify the proper flow rate for the aluminum
oil cooler.
Q: Why can't I use TransFlow for Allison transmission cooling Systems?
A: Validation of TransFlow is currently under development for light duty trucks equipped with the
Allison automatic transmission. TransFlow is based
on the existing MINIMUM flow rate specification through the transmission oil cooling system. The
Allison transmission oil cooling system only has MAXIMUM oil flow rates specified and J 45096
does not have the capability to test the transmission oil cooling system at the maximum oil flow rate
specification.
Q: Why doesn't GM publish a specification for auxiliary transmission oil coolers?
A: The auxiliary oil cooler used with GM vehicles does not contain an internal turbulator plate like
the radiator tank oil cooler does. Therefore, there is
no internal restriction that would affect the flow rate through the oil cooling system so a
specification for auxiliary oil cooler is not required. Keep in mind, kinks and damage to the auxiliary
cooler and lines can affect the flow rate through the system.
Q: Why did GM drop the labor time for transmission repairs?
A: The labor for flushing and flow testing the transmission oil cooling system is included with the
R&R; labor of the "K" labor operations that require
transmission removal. The time required to use the J 45096 to perform the flush and flow test is
much less than that of the J 35944-A. The warranty labor savings allowed GM to provide the J
45096 at no cost to dealerships.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 5036
Q: Why didn't the machine come with the adapters to hook up to the car?
A: The J 45096 was designed to use the previously released essential cooler line adapters for the J
35944-A. All adapters are listed on page 17 of the
Operation Manual and can be ordered from Kent-Moore at 1-800-345-2233.
Q: How do I connect the J 45096 to a Catera, Prizm or a Vibe?
A: These vehicles, along with many other models, only require barbed fittings to connect to the
rubber cooler hose. These fittings are commercially
available and already found in many shops.
Q: Why didn't I receive an Operation Manual with the machine?
A: The Operation Manual was packaged in the upper portion of the shipping carton. If the shipping
carton was lifted off the base without opening the
top of the carton, the Operation Manual could have been discarded with the carton. Replacement
Operation Manual packages can be obtained from Kent-Moore Customer Service at
1-800-345-2233.
Q: Why can't I re-use the transmission fluid I use for flushing?
A: The very fine metal and clutch material debris from the transmission failure in the ATF causes
failures with the hall effect speed sensors that are used
to measure the flow rate. To avoid costly repairs, expensive filters, regular maintenance and
problems caused by a partially restricted filter, the filter was not included.
Q: What do I do if I need service on my machine?
A: Call Kent-Moore Customer Service at 1-800-345-2233. The J 45096 has a one-year warranty.
Q: Can I flush and flow engine oil coolers?
A: The engine oil cooler flow rates, the appropriate adapters and an acceptable procedure are
currently under development.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure
Test Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs. Vehicle Speed Sensor Retainer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission
Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
The Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor is used by the control module to control: Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) apply and release schedule.
- Hot mode determination.
- Shift quality.
OPERATION
The TFT is a thermistor used to indicate transmission fluid temperature. The control module sends
a 5.0 volt signal to the TFT through a resistor in the computer and measures the voltage. High
sensor resistance produces high signal input voltage which corresponds to low fluid temperature.
Low sensor resistance produces low signal input voltage which corresponds to high fluid
temperature. With the TFT varying its resistance, the control module can sense transmission fluid
temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION
The sensor is part of the transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly and is attached to the
control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Valve Body: Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Valve Body: Electrical Specifications
Component Resistance Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5055
Valve Body: Mechanical Specifications
4L60 Automatic Transmission
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
FWD Accumulator Cover To Valve Body ............................................................................................
............................................................................... 8 Valve Body To Case .........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 8 Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body .................................................................................
......................................................................................... 8 Detent Spring To Valve Body .................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............. 18 Auxiliary Valve Body To Case ..........................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 8
4L60-E Automatic Transmission
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
FWD Accumulator Cover To Valve Body ............................................................................................
............................................................................... 8 Valve Body To Case .........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 8 Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body .................................................................................
......................................................................................... 8 Detent Spring To Valve Body .................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............. 18 Auxiliary Valve Body To Case ..........................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Checkball Locations
Valve Body: Locations Checkball Locations
Case Checkballs and Filters Locations
Control Valve Body Checkball Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Checkball Locations > Page 5058
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Checkball Locations > Page 5059
Valve Body: Locations Shift Solenoids
Electronic Component Location Views
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Checkball Locations > Page 5060
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service
Valve Body: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Service
Control Valve Assembly
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect TV cable at throttle lever, then raise and support
vehicle. 3. Drain transmission fluid, then remove transmission oil pan, filter and gasket.
Fig.12 Auxiliary Valve Body Replacement
4. Remove two bolts that attach auxiliary accumulator valve tube to control valve assembly and
accumulator valve body assembly, Fig. 12. 5. Remove two tube clamps, gently pry tube loose from
oil pump assembly, then the auxiliary accumulator valve body assembly. 6. Disconnect electrical
connectors at valve body. 7. Remove detent spring and roller assembly from valve body and
remove valve body to case bolts. 8. Remove valve body assembly while disconnecting manual
control valve link from range selector inner lever and removing throttle lever bracket
from TV link.
9. Reverse procedure to install.
Auxiliary Valve Body
1. Raise and support vehicle, then drain transmission fluid. 2. Remove transmission oil pan and
filter.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5063
Fig.12 Auxiliary Valve Body Replacement
3. Remove two bolts that attach auxiliary accumulator valve tube to control valve assembly and
accumulator valve body assembly, Fig. 12. 4. Remove two tube clamps, gently pry tube loose from
oil pump assembly and auxiliary accumulator valve body assembly. 5. Remove three auxiliary
accumulator valve body to transmission case attaching bolts. 6. Remove auxiliary valve body and
check ball. 7. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5064
Valve Body: Service and Repair Unit Repair
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Valve Body and Wiring Harness
VALVE BODY AND WIRING HARNESS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5065
Valve Body Bolt Location
Control Valve And Pressure Switch Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5066
Manual Valve Link
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5067
Valve Body Checkballs
Case Checkballs And Filters
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Electrical connections from components. 2. TCC PWM Solenoid Retainer Clip (379) and
Solenoid (396). 3. TCC Solenoid bolts (68) and solenoid assembly (66) with O-ring seal (65) and
wiring harness. 4. Pressure switch assembly bolts (70) and pressure switch assembly (69). 5.
Accumulator cover bolts (58 and 59) and 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57). 6. 1-2
accumulator piston (56) and seal (55). 7. Spring (54). 8. Dipstick stop bracket (93).
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (64) and manual detent spring assembly (63).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5068
2. Wiring harness retaining bolts.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Remaining valve body bolts (62). 2. Manual valve link (89). 3. Control valve assembly (60). 4.
Bolts (58 and 59), accumulator cover (57), piston (56, spring (54) and spring (54A). 5. Bolts (77)
and plate (53). 6. Spacer plate (48) and spacer plate gaskets (47 and 52). 7. Spring (46), piston
(44), and pin (43).
- Seven checkballs are located under the valve body and one is located in the case. The large
copper flash colored ball is # 1A checkball (91).
Valve Body and Associated Parts
VALVE BODY AND ASSOCIATED PARTS
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate And Gaskets
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5069
Case Checkballs And Filters
TOOL REQUIRED:
- J 25025-5 Guide Pins
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined corners that are necessary for
"cleaning" the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, "micro fine" lapping
compound 900 grit or finer should be used. Too much "lapping" of a valve will cause excessive
clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. The wiring harness pass-thru connector into the case. 2. The 3-4 accumulator pin (43) into the
case. 3. The 3-4 accumulator piston seal (45) onto the 3-4 accumulator piston. 4. The 3-4
accumulator piston (44) onto the pin.
- The end with three legs must face the valve body.
5. The 3-4 accumulator piston spring (46).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkball (91) into case as shown.
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. J 25025-5 into the case. 3. Screens onto spacer plate as shown. 4. Spacer plate to case gasket
(47) and spacer plate to valve body gasket (52) onto the spacer plate (48).
- Gasket (47) identified by a "C". Gasket (52) identified by a "V".
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
5. Spacer plate and gaskets onto the case.
IMPORTANT
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the spacer plate and gaskets.
6. Spacer plate support (53) and bolts (77).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.)
Control Valve Body
CONTROL VALVE BODY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5070
Case Checkballs And Filters
Filter Screen - Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5071
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5072
Control Valve Assembly - Legend
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5073
Valve Body Checkball Locations
Valve Body Bolt Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5074
Manual Valve Link
Outside Electrical Connector
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly thoroughly in clean solvent. A. Move the valves with a pick or small
screwdriver to dislodge any dirt or debris that may have accumulated. B. Air dry.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
IMPORTANT
- Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing roll pins and retainer clips.
- Valves, springs and bushings must be laid out on a clean surface in the exact sequence they are
removed.
1. Pressure control solenoid retainer bolt (364) retainer (378) and solenoid. 2. Bore plug retainer
clip (395), bore plug (376) and valve train (374 and 375). 3. 2-3 shift solenoid retainer (379),
solenoid (367) and valve train (368 and 369). 4. 1-2 shift solenoid retainer (379), solenoid (367)
and valve train (365 and 366). 5. Accumulator valve train retainer pin (360), bore plug (373) and
valve train (370 and 371). 6. Forward accumulator cover bolts (364) and cover (363). 7. Forward
accumulator spring (356), piston (354) and pin (355). 8. Lo overrun valve spring (362) and valve
(361). 9. Retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and forward abuse valve train (357 and 358).
10. Manual valve (340). 11. 3-2 control solenoid retainer clip (379) and solenoid (394).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5075
12. Bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and 3-2 control valve train (391 - 393). 13. 3-2
downshift bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (389 - 390). 14. Reverse abuse
bore plug retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and valve train (387 - 388). 15. 3-4 shift valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (385 - 386). 16. 3-4 relay bore plug retainer
(395), bore plug (381) and valve train (382 - 384). 17. Torque converter clutch signal valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve (380).
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings and control valve body in clean solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
- All valves and bushings for: Porosity
- Scoring
- Nicks
- Scratches
- Springs for damaged or distorted coils.
- Valve body casting for: Porosity
- Cracks
- Inter connected oil passages
- Damaged machined surfaces
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly (350) exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and bushing passages.
- Position the pressure control solenoid so the connector tabs face outward.
NOTICE: TCC PWM solenoid (396) cannot be installed until TCC solenoid has been installed and
torqued to proper specifications.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkballs into the valve body assembly (350).
- Retain with Transjell TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. Valve body assembly (350).
- Connect the manual valve link (89) to the inside detent lever (88).
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the valve body assembly.
3. Wiring harness (66), manual spring assembly (63), pressure switch assembly(69), dipstick, stop
bracket (93) and all remaining valve body bolts.
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
4. TCC solenoid (66) and bolts (68).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
5. TCC PWM solenoid (396), and retainer clip (379).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Wiring harness connections to electrical components.
- To correctly hook up the wires, see the wiring diagrams.
- The pressure control solenoid (377) has two different colored connectors. The black connector
should be installed on the tab farthest from the valve body.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Parking bracket (86).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 31 Nm (23 lb. ft.).
2. The 1-2 accumulator piston seal (55) onto the 1-2 accumulator piston (56). 3. The 1-2
accumulator spring (54) and 1-2 accumulator inner spring (54A) onto the piston (56). 4. The 1-2
accumulator piston (56) into the 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57).
- The three legs on the piston must face away from the case when installed.
5. The 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57) onto the case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5076
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5077
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Wire Harness Assembly
WIRE HARNESS ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5078
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Wire harness connectors from electrical components.
NOTICE: Excessive force on the case pass through connector may damage the connector.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
2. Wire harness assembly (34) from case using a 1-5/16" 12 point socket to release the connector
retaining clips.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5079
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Rotate transmission bottom pan surface up and lock in place. 2. Wire harness assembly (34)
connectors from components.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
- Use a cap to cover electrical pin at case connection.
3. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket, and transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40).
NOTICE: Be sure five O-rings are attached to transmission fluid pressure switch assembly.
4. Twenty-one bolts (35) using 10 mm socket, from valve body assembly, manual detent spring and
roller assembly (41). 5. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid level indicator stop (43), one bolt (36) using
10 mm socket, lube pipe (39), lube pipe retainer (37) and clamp (38). 6. Control valve assembly
(44) including the accumulator housing assembly (51), valve body gaskets (45 and 48), spacer
plate (46) and accumulator
gasket (47).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5080
7. Manual valve (319) from control valve assembly (44) to prevent any damage. 8. Checkballs (54)
from case passages.
NOTICE: Do not use a magnet. It could cause checkball(s) to be magnetized causing metal
particles to stick to the ball.
9. Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid screen (75).
INSPECT
- Screen PWM solenoid (75), replace if necessary.
DISASSEMBLE
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5081
- Control valve assembly. A. Position as shown on a clean surface. B. Remove blind hole retainer
pins with a drill bit.
CAUTION: Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing the retaining pins or
personal injury could result.
C. Remove valve trains, shift solenoids (311 and 313), PCS (320), PWM solenoid (323), PCS
screen (302) and shift solenoid filter (317). D. Valves, springs, bushings and pistons must be laid
out on a clean surface.
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings, pistons, control valve body and accumulator housing in clean
solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
1. All valves, pistons and bushings for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
2. Pistons for:
- Seal damage.
3. Springs for:
- Damaged or distorted coils.
4. Valve body casting and accumulator housing for:
- Porosity.
- Cracks.
- Interconnected passages.
- Damaged machined surfaces.
5. Solenoid connectors and filter (317). 6. PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid) screen (302).
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY/ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5082
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5083
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5084
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5085
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5086
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined comers that are necessary for
cleaning the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and the bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, micro fine lapping
compound 900 grit (J 38459) or finer should be used. Too much lapping of the valve will cause
excessive clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly and accumulator housing (51) thoroughly in clean solvent.
- Air dry.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5087
Accumulator Housing Assembly
ACCUMULATOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5088
Accumulator Housing Assembly
DISASSEMBLE
1. Six bolts (53), using 8 mm socket. 2. Accumulator housing assembly. 3. Gasket accumulator
housing (47). 4. Spacer plate (46). 5. Gasket (45) valve body spacer. 6. Snap ring (402) from
outside housing, pin (408), snap ring (402), piston (407) and spring (49). 7. 3rd clutch piston (405)
and spring (50). 8. Seals (404 and 406).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5089
CLEAN
- All components.
INSPECT
- All valves, pistons, springs and seals for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5090
ASSEMBLE
- Accumulator housing assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the positions of the pistons.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and
bushing passages.
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5091
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY AND ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
TOOL REQUIRED:
- Guide Pin J 25025-5
ASSEMBLE
1. Guide pin J 25025-5 into valve body. Located at back bolt hole of detent spring and roller
assembly bolt bole. 2. Gasket (45) valve body to spacer plate. 3. Spacer plate (46). 4. Gasket (47)
accumulator housing to spacer plate. 5. Accumulator housing assembly (51) onto valve body
assembly (44).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5092
6. Six bolts (53) using (8 mm) socket through accumulator housing into valve body assembly.
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
NOTE: Start accumulator housing bolts finger tight and work towards opposite end.
TIGHTEN
- Bolt (53) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
7. Remove guide pin J 25025-5.
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5093
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5094
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Install checkballs (54) in proper location into case fluid passages. Use TRANSJEL TM J 36850
or equivalent to hold in place.
NOTICE: Do not use any type of grease to retain parts during assembly of this unit. Greases other
than the recommended assembly lube will change transmission fluid characteristics and cause
undesirable shift conditions and/or filter clogging.
- # 2 checkball is used only on RCP RDP, ZJP and ZLP models.
2. PWM solenoid screen (75).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5095
3. Gasket (48) spacer plate to case. 4. Manual valve (319) into valve body. 5. Complete valve body
assembly (44) onto case (7). Use 1 25025-5 guide pin set.
IMPORTANT
- Attach manual valve to detent lever.
6. Transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40) onto valve body assembly (44). 7. Spring and
roller assembly (41) into place. 8. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid indicator stop (43) and lube pipe
clamp (38). 9. Twenty-one bolts (35). Using 10 mm socket.
10. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket into transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40). 11.
Lube pipe (39) long end into case, short end into valve body. 12. Lube pipe retainer (37) with short
bolt (36).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (35, 36 and 76) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5096
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
13. Attach wiring harness (34) to 5 connectors.
- Put large end into case first, pressure switch hook up, 1-2 shift solenoid (purple) and 2-3 shift
solenoid (tan), PWM (Pulse Width Modulated) solenoid and PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid).
Pan and Filter Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Service > Page 5097
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Fill the clutch master cylinder to the "Full" or "MAX" mark on the reservoir. Do not overfill.
Caution: Should accidental spillage occur, rinse the area thoroughly with water. Pay special
attention to any electrical wires, parts, harnesses, rubber or painted surfaces.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5104
Clutch Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
Hydraulic Clutch Fluid
...........................................................................................................................................................
DOT 3 or DOT 4 Brake Fluid
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Master Cylinder: Specifications
Master Cylinder Retaining Nuts ...........................................................................................................
............................................................... 10-15ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Fig. 1 Clutch Master Cylinder.
REMOVAL
1. Remove sound absorbing panel from upper left side foot well. Remove lower air conditioning
duct, if necessary.
2. Disconnect master cylinder push rod from clutch pedal.
3. Remove master cylinder retaining nuts.
4. Disconnect reservoir hose and slave cylinder hydraulic line from master cylinder.
5. Remove clutch master cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Position master cylinder at front of dash, then install retaining nuts and torque to 10-15ft. lbs.
2. Connect master cylinder push rod to clutch pedal and install retaining clip.
3. Install sound absorbing panel.
4. Install lower air conditioning duct, if removed.
5. Connect reservoir hose and slave cylinder hydraulic line to master cylinder.
6. Bleed system as described under "Hydraulic Clutch System Bleed." Refer to Hydraulic Clutch
System Bleed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 5110
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Clutch Master Cylinder Replace
Fig. 1 Clutch Master Cylinder.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove sound absorbing panel from upper left side foot
well. 3. Remove lower left side air conditioning duct if needed. 4. Disconnect master cylinder
pushrod from clutch pedal. 5. Remove master cylinder retaining nuts, Fig. 1. 6. Disconnect
reservoir hose and slave cylinder hydraulic line from master cylinder. 7. Remove clutch master
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Position master cylinder at front of dash, then install retaining nuts and torque to 10-15 ft. lbs.,
Fig. 1. 2. Connect master cylinder pushrod to clutch pedal and install retaining clip. 3. Install sound
absorbing panel. 4. Install lower left air conditioning duct if removed. 5. Connect reservoir hose and
slave cylinder hydraulic line to master cylinder. 6. Connect battery ground cable. 7. Bleed system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Specifications
Clutch Actuator Cylinder Nuts .............................................................................................................
................................................................... 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
When servicing the clutch actuator with hydraulic line intact, disconnect the clutch master cylinder
pushrod from the clutch pedal in order to prevent damage to the actuator should the pedal be
depressed.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove actuator cylinder to clutch housing nuts and actuator
assembly.
2. Drive out hydraulic line to actuator retaining pin using a 7/64 inch punch.
3. Use hydraulic clutch line separator tool No. J-36221 or equivalent to disconnect actuator cylinder
hydraulic line coupling, then remove line from clips if necessary.
4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Torque actuator cylinder nuts to 18 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 5116
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Secondary (Slave) Cylinder
Fig. 3 Clutch Slave Cylinder.
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect hydraulic line from slave cylinder, Fig. 3. 3. Remove
slave cylinder retaining nuts, then the slave cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect hydraulic line to slave cylinder, Fig. 3. 2. Bleed system. 3. Position slave cylinder on
bellhousing, then install retaining nuts and tighten to specifications.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Linkage > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Clutch Linkage: Service and Repair
Never use fluid which has been bled from a system to fill the reservoir. It may be aerated, have too
high of a moisture content and possibly be contaminated.
1. Fill reservoir with new DOT 3 brake fluid, then press and hold down clutch pedal. 2. Open bleed
screw on actuator cylinder to expel air, then close bleed screw and release clutch pedal. 3. Repeat
procedure until all air is out of system, noting the following:
a. Check and refill reservoir as needed during bleeding so air is not drawn into system. b. After
bleeding, pump clutch pedal several times. If clutch engagement is not satisfactory, repeat bleeding
procedure.
4. If this procedure is unsuccessful, perform the following:
a. Remove reservoir cap, then pump pedal very fast for 30.0 seconds. b. Stop to let air escape. c.
Repeat as necessary.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 467303 > Oct > 94 > Clutch Pedal - Pop or Scrape Noise
When Depressed
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Customer Interest Clutch Pedal - Pop or Scrape Noise When Depressed
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 46-73-03
Date: October, 1994
Subject: Clutch Pedal Return Spring Fractured (Remove Spring)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T Models with Manual Transmission
Condition
Some owners may comment that they hear a pop or scrape noise, or feel a catch as they depress
the clutch pedal. They may also comment that the clutch pedal return spring is fractured. This
spring is located at the clutch pedal pivot.
Cause
Spring fatigue resulting in short service life.
Correction
Remove the clutch pedal return spring and DO NOT replace it. Refer to the appropriate Service
Manual Section 7C - Clutch, Clutch Pedal Replacement for the correct procedure.
Testing has shown that this spring is not needed for proper clutch pedal return or clutch pedal feel.
This spring was eliminated in production as follows:
^ C/K all models, mid-1994 model year
^ S/T pickups, mid-1994 model year
^ S/T utilities, start of production 1995 model year
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation
Description Labor Time
K0100 Spring, Clutch Use Published Labor
Pedal Return Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 467303 > Oct > 94 > Clutch Pedal - Pop or
Scrape Noise When Depressed
Clutch Pedal Assembly: All Technical Service Bulletins Clutch Pedal - Pop or Scrape Noise When
Depressed
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 46-73-03
Date: October, 1994
Subject: Clutch Pedal Return Spring Fractured (Remove Spring)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K, S/T Models with Manual Transmission
Condition
Some owners may comment that they hear a pop or scrape noise, or feel a catch as they depress
the clutch pedal. They may also comment that the clutch pedal return spring is fractured. This
spring is located at the clutch pedal pivot.
Cause
Spring fatigue resulting in short service life.
Correction
Remove the clutch pedal return spring and DO NOT replace it. Refer to the appropriate Service
Manual Section 7C - Clutch, Clutch Pedal Replacement for the correct procedure.
Testing has shown that this spring is not needed for proper clutch pedal return or clutch pedal feel.
This spring was eliminated in production as follows:
^ C/K all models, mid-1994 model year
^ S/T pickups, mid-1994 model year
^ S/T utilities, start of production 1995 model year
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation
Description Labor Time
K0100 Spring, Clutch Use Published Labor
Pedal Return Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 04-08-50-006D > Sep >
10 > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info
Seat Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-08-50-006D
Date: September 09, 2010
Subject: Minor Wrinkles/Creases, Discoloration, Cigarette Burns and Customer Induced Cuts and
Stains on Front and Rear Driver and Passenger Seats with Leather, Vinyl or Cloth Seat Covers
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and
Prior HUMMER H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-08-50-006C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
If a customer comes in to your dealership due to certain conditions of the seat covers (splits,
wrinkles, loose stitching, etc.), you must examine the seat cover in order to determine the validity of
the customer claim. Some components from the above listed vehicles have been returned to the
Warranty Parts Center (WPC) and analysis of these parts showed "customer induced damage" or
No Trouble Found (NTF).
The dealer should pay particular attention to the following conditions:
- Cigarette burns
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 04-08-50-006D > Sep >
10 > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 5138
- Customer induced cuts (knife cuts, cut by customer tools, etc.)
- Paint stains (customer should have cleaned paint stains while paint was still wet)
- Coffee stains and other removable dirt These should be cleaned as described in the Owner's
Manual under Appearance Care. Also, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-00-89-029A or later.
- Evidence of chemicals used for cleaning, other than those specified in the Owner's Manual
- Other chemical spills
- Minor and normal leather wrinkles as a result of use
- Other defects to the seat cover not detected during the pre-delivery inspection (PDI).
Inform the customer that the above issues were not present when the vehicle was purchased and
cannot be replaced under warranty. The covers, however, may be repaired or replaced at the
customer's expense.
The following conditions are not caused by the customer and should be covered by warranty:
- Split seams
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 04-08-50-006D > Sep >
10 > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 5139
- Wear/cracking/peeling
- Discoloration/dye transfer from customer clothing (if discoloration/dye transfer is not removed
after using GM Leather and Vinyl Plastic Cleaner, P/N 88861401 (in Canada, P/N 88861409),
replace the covers.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 00-00-89-027E > Sep >
08 > Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors
Seat Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-89-027E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Eliminating Unwanted Odors in Vehicles
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and refine the instructions. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-89-027D (Section 00 - General Information).
Vehicle Odor Elimination
General Motors offers a product that may control or eliminate odors in the interior and luggage
compartment areas of GM vehicles. GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator is a non-toxic,
biodegradable odor remover. This odorless product has been shown to greatly reduce or remove
objectionable smells of mold and mildew resulting from vehicle water leaks (as well as customer
created odors, i.e. smoke). You may use GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator on fabrics, vinyl,
leather, carpet and sound deadening materials. It may also be induced into HVAC modules and
instrument panel ducts (for the control of non-bacterial related odors).
Important:
This product leaves no residual scent and should not be sold as or considered an air freshener.
Product action may result in the permanent elimination of an odor and may be preferable to
customers with allergies who are sensitive to perfumes.
How to Use This Product
GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator may be sprayed on in a ready-to-use formula or used in steam
cleaners as an additive with carpet shampoo. This water-based, odorless product is safe for all
vehicle interiors. Do not wet or soak any interior surface that plain water would cause to
deteriorate, as this product will have the same effect. Also avoid letting this product come into
contact with vinegar or any acidic substance. Acid-based products will hamper the effectiveness of,
or render GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator inert.
Note:
Complete eight page treatment sheets are enclosed within each case of GM Vehicle Care Odor
Eliminator. These treatment instructions range from simple vehicle odor elimination to full step by
step procedures for odor removal from water leaks. If lost, contact 800-977-4145 to get a
replacement set faxed or e-mailed to your dealership.
Instructions and cautions are printed on the bottle, but additional help is available. If you encounter
a difficult to eliminate or reoccurring odor, you may call 1-800-955-8591 (in Canada,
1-800-977-4145) to obtain additional information and usage suggestions.
Important:
This product may effectively remove odors when directly contacting the odor source. It should be
used in conjunction with diagnostic procedures (in cases such as a water leak) to first eliminate the
root cause of the odor, and then the residual odor to permanently correct the vehicle condition.
Vehicle Waterleak Odor Elimination
STEP ONE:
Confirm that all water leaks have been repaired. Determine what areas of the vehicle were water
soaked or wet. Components with visible mold/mildew staining should be replaced. Isolate the odor
source inside the vehicle. Often an odor can be isolated to an area or component of the vehicle
interior by careful evaluation. Odor evaluation may need to be performed by multiple persons.
Another method of isolating an odor source is to remove and segregate interior trim and
components. Plastic sheeting or drop cloths can be used to confine seats, headliners, etc. to assist
in evaluation and diagnoses. If appropriate the vehicle and interior trim should be evaluated
separately to determine if the odor stays with the vehicle or the interior components. Odors that
stay with the vehicle may be isolated to insulating and sound deadening materials (i.e. water leak
at the windshield or standing water in the front foot well area caused mold/mildew to form on the
bulkhead or kick panel sound deadening pads. If the interior is removed the floor pan and
primed/painted surfaces should be treated with bleach/soap solution, rinsed with clean water and
dried. Interior surfaces should then be treated with GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product
before reinstalling carpet or reassembling.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 00-00-89-027E > Sep >
08 > Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors > Page 5144
The GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product is an effective odor elimination product when used
properly. It must come into direct contact with the odor source. It should be used in conjunction with
diagnostic procedures to first eliminate the root cause of the odor. Some procedures for use after
odor root cause correction are:
STEP TWO:
^ Use the trigger spray head.
^ Put a drop of dish soap the size of a quarter in the bottom of a bottle.
^ Add 8 oz. of GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator (1 cup) to the dish soap and top off the bottle with
tap water.
^ This formula should be used on hard surfaces (dash, interior plastic molding, and floor pan)
STEP THREE:
The third step to neutralizing the vehicle is a light to medium treatment of all carpeting and
upholstered seats with the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula and a wide fan spray setting
(at full strength) (i.e.: carpeting on the driver's side requires 4-5 triggers pulls for coverage). The
headliner and trunk should be sprayed next. Lightly brushing the formula into the carpeting and
upholstery is a recommended step for deep odor problems. The dash and all hard surfaces should
be sprayed with dish soap/water mixture. Let stand for 1-2 minutes then wipe off the surface.
STEP FOUR: (vehicle ventilation system treatment)
The ventilation system is generally the last step in the treatment of the vehicle.
a. Spray the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula into all dash vents. (1-2 trigger pulls per
vent).
b. Start the vehicle and turn the vehicle fan on high cool (not A/C setting).
c. Spray the formula (10 trigger pulls) into the outside fresh air intake vent (cowl at base of
windshield)
d. Enter the vehicle after 1 minute and wipe off the excess formula spurting out of the dash vents.
e. Smell the air coming from the dash vents. If odors are still present, spray another 5 triggers into
the cowl, wait another minute and smell the results. Once you have obtained a fresh, clean smell
coming from the vents, turn the system to the A/C re-circulation setting. Roll up the windows, spray
3-5 pumps into the right lower IP area and let the vehicle run with the fan set on high for 5-7
minutes.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Additional Suggestions to Increase Customer Satisfaction
Here are some additional ideas to benefit your dealership and to generate greater customer
enthusiasm for this product.
^ Keep this product on-hand for both the Service Department and the Used Car lot. Add value to
your used car trades; treat loaner and demo cars during service and at final sale to eliminate
smoke, pet, and other common odors offensive to customers. Make deodorizing a vehicle part of
your normal vehicle detailing service.
^ Consider including GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator as a give-away item with new vehicle
purchases. Many dealers give away as "gifts" various cleaning supplies at time of delivery. GM
Odor Eliminator is one of a few products GM offers that has as many uses in the home as in the
vehicle. Customers may find this product can be used for a host of recreational activities
associated with their new vehicle, such as deodorizing a boat they tow, or a camper.
^ GM Odor Eliminator and many of the GM Vehicle Care products offer you the chance to increase
dealership traffic as these superior quality products cannot be purchased in stores. Many
Dealerships have product displays at the parts counter. Consider additional displays in the
Customer Service Lounge, the Showroom and at the Service Desk or Cashier Window. Many
customers who purchase vehicles and receive regular maintenance at your dealership may never
visit the parts counter, and subsequently are not exposed to the variety and value that these
products offer.
Parts Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 00-00-89-027E > Sep >
08 > Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors > Page 5145
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 00-08-50-002 > Apr >
00 > Driver/Passenger Seat - Wear on Outboard Recliner Hinge
Seat Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Driver/Passenger Seat - Wear on Outboard Recliner
Hinge
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 00-08-50-002
Date: April, 2000
TECHNICAL
Subject: Driver/Passenger Seat Wear at Outboard Recliner Hinge Area (Add Protector
Cover/Replace Seat Cushion Trim Cover)
Models: 1994-97 Chevrolet and GMC S/T Pickups and 2 Door Utility Models With Front Reclining
Bucket Seats or 60/40 Bench Seats (RPOs AV5 or AM6)
Condition: Some customers may comment that there appears to be premature wear of the cover
material on the driver's or passenger seat cushion in the outboard recliner hinge area.
Correction: Add a protector cover to the outboard recliner hinge and replace the seat cushion trim
cover with a new cover. The new cover has an added plastic patch sewn in to improve durability.
Please be advised that all seat cushion trim covers currently at GMSPO have this change. Refer to
group number 16.717 of the parts catalog for part description and usage.
Determine if a protector cover has already been installed per Campaign Bulletin 97033(A)-Seat
Belt Separation. Look for a campaign label under the hood.
1. If a cover has already been installed, replace the worn seat cushion trim cover. Refer to the
Seats subsection of the appropriate Service Manual for information on replacing the seat cushion
trim cover material.
2. If a cover has not been installed, perform Campaign Bulletin 97033(A)-Seat Belt Separation and
replace the worn seat cushion trim cover. Refer to the Seats subsection of the appropriate Service
Manual for information on replacing the seat cushion trim cover material.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 431606 > Oct > 94 >
Leather Seat Covers - Cleaning Procedure
Seat Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Leather Seat Covers - Cleaning Procedure
File In Section: 10 - Body Bulletin No.: 43-16-06 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Cleaning Procedure for Leather Seat Covers
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and "C/K" and "S/T" Trucks
If leather seat covers are being returned only because they are dirty, a more aggressive cleaning
procedure is recommended by General Motors prior to replacing covers.
Procedure
Dirty or soiled leather seat covers should be cleaned with a mild soap and water solution, using
clean soft cloths. When this procedure proves inadequate, a commercially available leather
cleaner, "Tanner's Preserve Leather Cleaner"* should be used with a 3M "Type T"* scrubbing pad.
Important:
The type of scrubbing pad is very critical because the common 3M Scotch-Brite green pad is too
aggressive and will damage the leather finish.
The cleaner is available from "First Brands" by calling 1-800-726-1001, identifying yourself as a GM
dealership, requesting "Tanner's Preserve Leather Cleaner" product, number AS-330, quantity and
shipping address. This product is also available at stores.
The 3M "Type T" scrubbing pad is available from a 3M distributor. Call 1-800-742-9546 for the
nearest distributor and then request the Scotch-Brite Clean and Finish Sheet, "Type T", in 6 x 9
inch sheets, UPC code number 048011-01276.
* We believe these sources and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional
manufacturers of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items
which may be available from other sources.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 04-08-50-006D > Sep >
10 > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 5159
- Customer induced cuts (knife cuts, cut by customer tools, etc.)
- Paint stains (customer should have cleaned paint stains while paint was still wet)
- Coffee stains and other removable dirt These should be cleaned as described in the Owner's
Manual under Appearance Care. Also, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-00-89-029A or later.
- Evidence of chemicals used for cleaning, other than those specified in the Owner's Manual
- Other chemical spills
- Minor and normal leather wrinkles as a result of use
- Other defects to the seat cover not detected during the pre-delivery inspection (PDI).
Inform the customer that the above issues were not present when the vehicle was purchased and
cannot be replaced under warranty. The covers, however, may be repaired or replaced at the
customer's expense.
The following conditions are not caused by the customer and should be covered by warranty:
- Split seams
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 04-08-50-006D > Sep >
10 > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 5160
- Wear/cracking/peeling
- Discoloration/dye transfer from customer clothing (if discoloration/dye transfer is not removed
after using GM Leather and Vinyl Plastic Cleaner, P/N 88861401 (in Canada, P/N 88861409),
replace the covers.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 00-00-89-027E > Sep >
08 > Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors > Page 5165
The GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product is an effective odor elimination product when used
properly. It must come into direct contact with the odor source. It should be used in conjunction with
diagnostic procedures to first eliminate the root cause of the odor. Some procedures for use after
odor root cause correction are:
STEP TWO:
^ Use the trigger spray head.
^ Put a drop of dish soap the size of a quarter in the bottom of a bottle.
^ Add 8 oz. of GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator (1 cup) to the dish soap and top off the bottle with
tap water.
^ This formula should be used on hard surfaces (dash, interior plastic molding, and floor pan)
STEP THREE:
The third step to neutralizing the vehicle is a light to medium treatment of all carpeting and
upholstered seats with the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula and a wide fan spray setting
(at full strength) (i.e.: carpeting on the driver's side requires 4-5 triggers pulls for coverage). The
headliner and trunk should be sprayed next. Lightly brushing the formula into the carpeting and
upholstery is a recommended step for deep odor problems. The dash and all hard surfaces should
be sprayed with dish soap/water mixture. Let stand for 1-2 minutes then wipe off the surface.
STEP FOUR: (vehicle ventilation system treatment)
The ventilation system is generally the last step in the treatment of the vehicle.
a. Spray the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula into all dash vents. (1-2 trigger pulls per
vent).
b. Start the vehicle and turn the vehicle fan on high cool (not A/C setting).
c. Spray the formula (10 trigger pulls) into the outside fresh air intake vent (cowl at base of
windshield)
d. Enter the vehicle after 1 minute and wipe off the excess formula spurting out of the dash vents.
e. Smell the air coming from the dash vents. If odors are still present, spray another 5 triggers into
the cowl, wait another minute and smell the results. Once you have obtained a fresh, clean smell
coming from the vents, turn the system to the A/C re-circulation setting. Roll up the windows, spray
3-5 pumps into the right lower IP area and let the vehicle run with the fan set on high for 5-7
minutes.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Additional Suggestions to Increase Customer Satisfaction
Here are some additional ideas to benefit your dealership and to generate greater customer
enthusiasm for this product.
^ Keep this product on-hand for both the Service Department and the Used Car lot. Add value to
your used car trades; treat loaner and demo cars during service and at final sale to eliminate
smoke, pet, and other common odors offensive to customers. Make deodorizing a vehicle part of
your normal vehicle detailing service.
^ Consider including GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator as a give-away item with new vehicle
purchases. Many dealers give away as "gifts" various cleaning supplies at time of delivery. GM
Odor Eliminator is one of a few products GM offers that has as many uses in the home as in the
vehicle. Customers may find this product can be used for a host of recreational activities
associated with their new vehicle, such as deodorizing a boat they tow, or a camper.
^ GM Odor Eliminator and many of the GM Vehicle Care products offer you the chance to increase
dealership traffic as these superior quality products cannot be purchased in stores. Many
Dealerships have product displays at the parts counter. Consider additional displays in the
Customer Service Lounge, the Showroom and at the Service Desk or Cashier Window. Many
customers who purchase vehicles and receive regular maintenance at your dealership may never
visit the parts counter, and subsequently are not exposed to the variety and value that these
products offer.
Parts Information
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Pedal Assembly: > 00-00-89-027E > Sep >
08 > Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors > Page 5166
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Clutch System
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Service and Repair Hydraulic Clutch System
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove lower filler panel(s) or steering column covers.
Remove lower left side of air conditioning duct if necessary to gain clearance.
2. Remove clutch start switch, noting position for installation reference, then remove clutch master
cylinder push rod from pedal.
3. Remove clutch pedal nut, bolt and braces, noting positions for installation reference, then the
pedal and spring. When removing bolt, slide a similar long rod or screw into bracket to keep parts
together and in order.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Torque clutch pedal nut to 26 ft. lbs.
5. Remove bushings and spacer, then the bumper, if worn or damaged.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Clutch System > Page 5177
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Service and Repair Less Hydraulic Clutch System
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove coffer pin and washers from clutch pedal rod.
2. Remove clutch start switch, noting position for installation reference, then the nut, bolt and
washers from clutch pivot arm.
3. Remove clutch pivot arm, pedal rod and bushing. Release retracting spring by depressing pedal,
moving pedal laterally and releasing.
4. Remove pedal and bushings, then the bumper, if worn or damaged.
5. Reverse procedure to install. Adjust clutch linkage as described under "Clutch, Adjust." Refer to
Clutch/Adjust
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations
I/P Wiring, Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5181
C253 - Clutch Release Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5182
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove lower instrument panel trim. 2. Remove clutch start switch electrical connector, Fig. 3.
3. Remove clutch start switch from clutch pedal. 4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 567301 > Feb > 95 > Clutch Pedal - Squeak Noise
Clutch Release Fork: Customer Interest Clutch Pedal - Squeak Noise
File in Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 56-73-01
Date: February, 1995
SUBJECT: Clutch Pedal Squeak Noise (Install Greaseable Ball Stud)
MODELS: 1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K 1, 2 and S/T Models with NV3500 5-Speed
Manual Transmission (RPOs MG5, MY2, M50)
CONDITION
A squeak noise may come from the clutch area when the clutch pedal is fully released (foot off the
clutch pedal) and the engine is running. This squeak will stop when slight pressure is placed on the
clutch pedal. This noise may be confused with a squeaking or noisy clutch release bearing.
CAUSE
This noise is usually caused by a dry clutch fork ball stud which causes metal to metal contact with
the clutch fork. The grease fitting was removed in production for the 1994 and 1995 model years so
the joint is no longer greaseable.
CORRECTION
Install a greaseable ball stud.
Service Procedure
1. Remove the transmission following directions in the appropriate Service Manual, Section 7B,
Manual Transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 567301 > Feb > 95 > Clutch Pedal - Squeak Noise > Page
5191
2. Remove the clutch fork and ball stud from the front transmission housing using J 36510, clutch
fork pivot remover/installer (Figure 1).
3. Inspect the front transmission housing to locate the raised boss where the grease zerk is to be
installed (Figure 2).
^ The boss is on the right side of the transmission between the fill plug and the clutch fork pocket.
4. Drill a hole of required size (determined by diameter/thread pitch of zerk used) in the center of
the raised boss located in step 3.
^ The grease zerk used should have no more than 1/4" of threaded length to avoid entering the ball
stud cavity.
Important:
Wall thickness in this area is approximately 1/4". Use caution to prevent passing through the ball
stud cavity and drilling through the inner wall of the housing.
5. Tap the hole as required and install the grease zerk.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 567301 > Feb > 95 > Clutch Pedal - Squeak Noise > Page
5192
Important:
Thoroughly clean out all metal chips before installing the zerk and ball stud to prevent plugging the
greaseable ball stud.
6. Install greaseable ball stud P/N 23049797 using J 36510, clutch fork pivot remover/installer.
7. Grease the fitting until a small amount of grease flows from the end of the ball stud.
8. Install new clutch fork P/N 15588262. Place grease in the clutch fork pocket that contacts the
clutch fork push rod.
9. Reinstall the transmission following directions in the appropriate Service Manual, Section 7B,
Manual Transmission.
10. Grease the assembled ball stud lightly through the fining. Grease every 30,000 miles thereafter.
Important:
Grease should be added "sparingly" to the fitting. Excessive grease can contaminate the clutch
disc friction surfaces resulting in slip or chatter and the need to replace the disc.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts are currently available from GMPSO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
K0720 Fork and/or Ball Use published labor
Stud, Clutch operation time
Release - Replace
The document shown should be reproduced locally and provided to the owners of the vehicles
modified by this procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 567301 > Feb > 95 > Clutch Pedal - Squeak
Noise
Clutch Release Fork: All Technical Service Bulletins Clutch Pedal - Squeak Noise
File in Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 56-73-01
Date: February, 1995
SUBJECT: Clutch Pedal Squeak Noise (Install Greaseable Ball Stud)
MODELS: 1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K 1, 2 and S/T Models with NV3500 5-Speed
Manual Transmission (RPOs MG5, MY2, M50)
CONDITION
A squeak noise may come from the clutch area when the clutch pedal is fully released (foot off the
clutch pedal) and the engine is running. This squeak will stop when slight pressure is placed on the
clutch pedal. This noise may be confused with a squeaking or noisy clutch release bearing.
CAUSE
This noise is usually caused by a dry clutch fork ball stud which causes metal to metal contact with
the clutch fork. The grease fitting was removed in production for the 1994 and 1995 model years so
the joint is no longer greaseable.
CORRECTION
Install a greaseable ball stud.
Service Procedure
1. Remove the transmission following directions in the appropriate Service Manual, Section 7B,
Manual Transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 567301 > Feb > 95 > Clutch Pedal - Squeak
Noise > Page 5198
2. Remove the clutch fork and ball stud from the front transmission housing using J 36510, clutch
fork pivot remover/installer (Figure 1).
3. Inspect the front transmission housing to locate the raised boss where the grease zerk is to be
installed (Figure 2).
^ The boss is on the right side of the transmission between the fill plug and the clutch fork pocket.
4. Drill a hole of required size (determined by diameter/thread pitch of zerk used) in the center of
the raised boss located in step 3.
^ The grease zerk used should have no more than 1/4" of threaded length to avoid entering the ball
stud cavity.
Important:
Wall thickness in this area is approximately 1/4". Use caution to prevent passing through the ball
stud cavity and drilling through the inner wall of the housing.
5. Tap the hole as required and install the grease zerk.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 567301 > Feb > 95 > Clutch Pedal - Squeak
Noise > Page 5199
Important:
Thoroughly clean out all metal chips before installing the zerk and ball stud to prevent plugging the
greaseable ball stud.
6. Install greaseable ball stud P/N 23049797 using J 36510, clutch fork pivot remover/installer.
7. Grease the fitting until a small amount of grease flows from the end of the ball stud.
8. Install new clutch fork P/N 15588262. Place grease in the clutch fork pocket that contacts the
clutch fork push rod.
9. Reinstall the transmission following directions in the appropriate Service Manual, Section 7B,
Manual Transmission.
10. Grease the assembled ball stud lightly through the fining. Grease every 30,000 miles thereafter.
Important:
Grease should be added "sparingly" to the fitting. Excessive grease can contaminate the clutch
disc friction surfaces resulting in slip or chatter and the need to replace the disc.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts are currently available from GMPSO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Description Labor Time
K0720 Fork and/or Ball Use published labor
Stud, Clutch operation time
Release - Replace
The document shown should be reproduced locally and provided to the owners of the vehicles
modified by this procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
Fuel Pump Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 56-63-05A
Date: January, 1996
Subject: Vehicle Does Not Start Readily Upon Cranking (Replace Fuel Pump Relay)
Models: 1993-94 Chevrolet and GMC Truck M/L Vans 1994 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Utility
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada with 4.3L Engine (VIN W, Z - RPOs L35, LB4)
This bulletin is being revised to change the correction procedure and parts information and to add
the L Van and artwork. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 56-63-05 (Section 6E - Engine
Fuel & Emission).
Condition
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 5205
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 5206
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 5207
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 5213
Some owners may experience extended engine crank times on cold start and may set diagnostic
trouble code 54 and activate the M/L (Check Engine light).
Cause
This condition may be due to failure of the fuel pump relay.
Correction
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 5214
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Clutch Release Fork: > 566305A > Jan > 96 >
Engine - Will Not Start Readily Upon Cranking > Page 5215
Verify condition using the normal diagnostic procedure in the service manual. Replace the Fuel
Pump Relay (P/N 12077867) following the service manual procedure. Replace the connector (Kit
P/N 12166225) following the instructions in Figures 3 and 4. Note that each of the four cavities of
the old connector are lettered. The new connector is numbered and it should be wired according to
Figure 3 and not the instructions contained within the connector kit.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
12077867 Fuel Pump Relay 1
12166225 Connector 1
12129073 Bracket (S/T Only) 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J5460 Relay, Fuel Pump- Use Published
Replace Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pilot Bearing > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > M/T - Clutch Pilot Bushing and Bearings
Pilot Bearing: Technical Service Bulletins M/T - Clutch Pilot Bushing and Bearings
File In Section: 7 - Transmission Bulletin No.: 46-73-02 Date: October, 1994
INFORMATION
Subject: Clutch Pilot Bushings and Bearings
Models: 1988-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck Light Duty Trucks with 4.3L, 5.0L, 5.7L, 6.2L, 6.5L,
7.4L Engines and Manual Transmission
A worn or damaged clutch pilot bushing or bearing, located in the end of the crankshaft, can be the
cause of various clutch and transmission concerns including:
^ Noise when the clutch pedal is depressed
^ Transmission noise
^ Clutch shudder on launch
^ Difficult shifting or excessive clash into reverse
A worn clutch pilot bushing will not properly support the transmission input shaft. Without sufficient
support, the front of the input shaft can move out of location resulting in transmission noise or
clutch shudder on engagement.
A damaged clutch pilot bushing or bearing may continue to turn the transmission input shaft when
the clutch is released. This rotation can then cause difficult shifting or gear clash.
Anytime a transmission or clutch is removed for repair, a new clutch pilot roller bearing should be
installed. The end of the transmission input shaft that contacts the pilot roller bearing should also
be inspected for damage.
When installing the pilot roller bearing, the chamfer or lead-in to the I.D. should be installed facing
the rear of the vehicle. This chamfer will help guide the input shaft into the roller bearing. This
bearing is pre-lubed with a high temperature grease and does not require additional lubrication.
The bearing listed below will fit all 1988-95 4.3L, 5.OL, 5.7L, 6.2L, 6.5L, and 7.4L light duty
engines. Do not use a bronze clutch pilot bushing.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
14061685 Bearing, clutch Pilot 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pressure Plate > Component Information >
Specifications
Pressure Plate: Specifications
Clutch Cover to Flywheel Bolts ............................................................................................................
.................................................................. 30 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability
Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 5231
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: All Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Engine
Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-029E
Date: April 29, 2010
Subject: Unnecessary Flushing Services, Additive Recommendations and Proper Utilization of GM
Simplified Maintenance Schedule to Enhance Customer Service Experience
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and add information about the
proper transmission flush procedure. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-01-029D
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
An Overview of Proper Vehicle Service
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools and equipment to support a
subsystem flushing procedures. These dedicated machines are in addition to many engine oil,
cooling system, fuel system, A/C, transmission flush and steering system additives available to the
consumer. GM Vehicles under normal usage do not require any additional procedures or additives
beyond what is advised under the former Vehicle Maintenance Schedules or the current Simplified
Maintenance Schedules. Do not confuse machines available from Kent-Moore/SPX that are
designed to aid and accelerate the process of fluid changing with these flushing machines.
Engine Crankcase Flushing
General Motors Corporation does not endorse or recommend engine crankcase flushing for any of
its gasoline engines. Analysis of some of the aftermarket materials used for crankcase flushing
indicate incompatibility with GM engine components and the potential for damage to some engine
seals and bearings. Damage to engine components resulting from crankcase flushing IS NOT
COVERED under the terms of the New Vehicle Warranty.
GM Authorized Service Information: Detailed, Descriptive, and Complete
If a specific model vehicle or powertrain need is identified, GM will issue an Authorized Service
Document containing a procedure and, if required, provide, make available, or require the specific
use of a machine, tool or chemical to accomplish proper vehicle servicing. An example of this is
fuel injector cleaning. Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, GM has
recognized the need for fuel injector cleaning methods on some engines, though under normal
circumstances, this service is not part of the maintenance requirements.
GM has published several gasoline fuel injector cleaning bulletins that fully outline the methods to
be used in conjunction with GM Part Numbered solutions to accomplish proper and safe cleaning
of the fuel injectors with preventative maintenance suggestions to maintain optimum performance.
You may refer to Corporate Bulletin Numbers 03-06-04-030 and 04-06-04-051 for additional
information on this subject.
Subsystem Flushing
Flushing of A/C lines, radiators, transmission coolers, and power steering systems are recognized
practices to be performed after catastrophic failures or extreme corrosion when encountered in
radiators. For acceptable A/C flushing concerns, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 01-01-38-006.
This practice is NOT required or recommended for normal service operations.
The use of external transmission fluid exchange or flush machines is NOT recommended for the
automatic or manual transmission. Use of external machines to replace the fluid may affect the
operation or durability of the transmission. Transmission fluid should only be replaced by draining
and refilling following directions in SI. Refer to Automatic/Manual Transmission Fluid and Filter
Replacement.
Approved Transmission Flushing Tool (Transmission Cooler Only)
The Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Tool is recommended for GM
vehicles. Refer to Transmission Fluid Cooler Flushing and Flow Test in SI using the J 45096.
Service Is Important to You and Your Customer
General Motors takes great pride in offering our dealerships and customers high quality vehicles
that require extremely low maintenance over the life of the vehicle. This low cost of ownership
builds repeat sales and offers our customers measurable economy of operation against competing
vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info. > Page
5237
Providing responsible services at the proper intervals will greatly aid your dealership with repeat
business, and additional services when required. Most customers appreciate and gain trust in the
dealership that informs and offers them just what they need for continued trouble-free operation.
Examine your service department's practices and verify that all Service Consultants and
Technicians focus on customer satisfaction, vehicle inspections, and other products at time of
service. Use this opportunity to upgrade the services you provide to your customers. Here are a
few suggestions:
- Take the time required to align your dealership service practices with the new GM Simplified
Maintenance Schedule. Use the new vehicle Owner's Manual Maintenance I and II schedules to
create a "mirror image" in your advertising and dealer service pricing that is easily understandable
to your customer. Taking advantage of this new service strategy may greatly increase your
dealership service sales and customer retention while decreasing the frequency of visits and
inconvenience to your customer.
- Review your program to ensure that all vehicles coming in are evaluated for safety and wear
items. Examine all vehicles for tire condition, signs of misalignment, brake wear, exterior lamp
functionality, exhaust condition, A/C cooling performance, SRS or Air Bag MIL, along with Service
Engine Soon or Check Engine indicators. If the Service Engine Soon or Check Engine MIL is
illuminated, it is vital that you inform the customer of the concerns with ignoring the indicator and
what the required repair would cost. In addition to the possibility of increased emissions and
driveability concerns, many customers are unaware that lower gas mileage may also result, with
additional cost to the customer.
- Be complete in your service recommendations. Some sales opportunities are not being fully
pursued nationally. Focus on overlooked but required maintenance that has real benefits to the
customer. Many vehicles are equipped with cabin air filters. If these filters are used beyond
replacement time, they may impede airflow decreasing A/C and heating performance. Make sure
these filters are part of your recommended service. Note that some of our vehicles may not have
been factory equipped but will accept the filters as an accessory.
- Express the value in maintaining the finish quality of the customer's vehicle at the Maintenance I
and II visits. More fully utilize the vehicle prep personnel you already have in place. In today's
world, many people simply ignore the finish of their vehicle, at best infrequently using an automatic
car wash for exterior cleaning. Offer vehicle detailing services in stages from just a wash and wax
to a complete interior cleaning. When paired with the Simplified Maintenance visit, this will increase
customer satisfaction. On return, the customer gets a visibly improved vehicle that will be a source
of pride of ownership along with a vehicle that is now fully maintained. Also, reinforce the improved
resale value of a completely maintained vehicle.
- For customers who clean and maintain the appearance of their vehicles themselves encourage
the use of GM Vehicle Care products. Many customers may have never used GM Car Wash/Wax
Concentrate, GM Cleaner Wax or a longtime product, GM Glass Cleaner, which is a favorite of
many customers who try it just once. If your dealership give samples of these products with new
car purchases, customers may already be sold on the product but not willing to make a special trip
to the dealership. Capitalize on sales at this time. Stock shelves right at the Service counter with
these products and consider instituting compensation programs for Service Consultants who
suggest these products. Many consumers faced with an intimidating wall full of car care products
sold at local auto parts stores may find it comforting to purchase a fully tested product sold by GM
that they know will not harm the finish of their vehicle. We suggest these competitively priced basic
vehicle care products to emphasize:
In USA:
- #12378401 GM Vehicle Care Wash/Wax Concentrate 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #89021822 GM Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner Aerosol 18 oz. (510 g)
- #12377966 GM Vehicle Care Cleaner Wax 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #1052929 GM Vehicle Care Chrome and Wire Wheel Cleaner 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #88861431 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 24 fl. oz. (0.710L)
In Canada:
- #10953203 GM Vehicle Care Wash & Wax Concentrate 473 mL
- #992727 GM Glass Cleaner Aerosol 500 g
- #10952905 GM Vehicle Care Liquid Cleaner/Wax 473 mL
- #10953013 GM Vehicle Care Chrome Cleaner and Polish 454 mL
- #10953202 GM Vehicle Care Wheel Brite 473 mL
- #88901678 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 473 mL
- Display signboards with the installed price for popular GM Accessories such as running boards
and Tonneau Covers. Customers may not think to ask about these desirable items at the time of a
service visit.
- Finally, take advantage of the GM Goodwrench initiatives (Tire Program, Goodwrench Credit
Card, etc. / Dealer Marketing Association (DMA) Promotions in Canada) to provide the customer
with more reasons to identify your dealership as the best place to go for parts and service.
Remember to utilize ALL of the service aspects you possess in your dealership to satisfy and
provide value to your customer. Many businesses exist profitably as an oil change location, a
vehicle repair facility, or a detailing shop alone. You already have the capabilities of all three and
provide these services with the inherent trust of your customer, under the GM Mark of Excellence.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 5242
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: All Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Engine
Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-029E
Date: April 29, 2010
Subject: Unnecessary Flushing Services, Additive Recommendations and Proper Utilization of GM
Simplified Maintenance Schedule to Enhance Customer Service Experience
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and add information about the
proper transmission flush procedure. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-01-029D
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
An Overview of Proper Vehicle Service
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools and equipment to support a
subsystem flushing procedures. These dedicated machines are in addition to many engine oil,
cooling system, fuel system, A/C, transmission flush and steering system additives available to the
consumer. GM Vehicles under normal usage do not require any additional procedures or additives
beyond what is advised under the former Vehicle Maintenance Schedules or the current Simplified
Maintenance Schedules. Do not confuse machines available from Kent-Moore/SPX that are
designed to aid and accelerate the process of fluid changing with these flushing machines.
Engine Crankcase Flushing
General Motors Corporation does not endorse or recommend engine crankcase flushing for any of
its gasoline engines. Analysis of some of the aftermarket materials used for crankcase flushing
indicate incompatibility with GM engine components and the potential for damage to some engine
seals and bearings. Damage to engine components resulting from crankcase flushing IS NOT
COVERED under the terms of the New Vehicle Warranty.
GM Authorized Service Information: Detailed, Descriptive, and Complete
If a specific model vehicle or powertrain need is identified, GM will issue an Authorized Service
Document containing a procedure and, if required, provide, make available, or require the specific
use of a machine, tool or chemical to accomplish proper vehicle servicing. An example of this is
fuel injector cleaning. Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, GM has
recognized the need for fuel injector cleaning methods on some engines, though under normal
circumstances, this service is not part of the maintenance requirements.
GM has published several gasoline fuel injector cleaning bulletins that fully outline the methods to
be used in conjunction with GM Part Numbered solutions to accomplish proper and safe cleaning
of the fuel injectors with preventative maintenance suggestions to maintain optimum performance.
You may refer to Corporate Bulletin Numbers 03-06-04-030 and 04-06-04-051 for additional
information on this subject.
Subsystem Flushing
Flushing of A/C lines, radiators, transmission coolers, and power steering systems are recognized
practices to be performed after catastrophic failures or extreme corrosion when encountered in
radiators. For acceptable A/C flushing concerns, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 01-01-38-006.
This practice is NOT required or recommended for normal service operations.
The use of external transmission fluid exchange or flush machines is NOT recommended for the
automatic or manual transmission. Use of external machines to replace the fluid may affect the
operation or durability of the transmission. Transmission fluid should only be replaced by draining
and refilling following directions in SI. Refer to Automatic/Manual Transmission Fluid and Filter
Replacement.
Approved Transmission Flushing Tool (Transmission Cooler Only)
The Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Tool is recommended for GM
vehicles. Refer to Transmission Fluid Cooler Flushing and Flow Test in SI using the J 45096.
Service Is Important to You and Your Customer
General Motors takes great pride in offering our dealerships and customers high quality vehicles
that require extremely low maintenance over the life of the vehicle. This low cost of ownership
builds repeat sales and offers our customers measurable economy of operation against competing
vehicles.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info. > Page
5248
Providing responsible services at the proper intervals will greatly aid your dealership with repeat
business, and additional services when required. Most customers appreciate and gain trust in the
dealership that informs and offers them just what they need for continued trouble-free operation.
Examine your service department's practices and verify that all Service Consultants and
Technicians focus on customer satisfaction, vehicle inspections, and other products at time of
service. Use this opportunity to upgrade the services you provide to your customers. Here are a
few suggestions:
- Take the time required to align your dealership service practices with the new GM Simplified
Maintenance Schedule. Use the new vehicle Owner's Manual Maintenance I and II schedules to
create a "mirror image" in your advertising and dealer service pricing that is easily understandable
to your customer. Taking advantage of this new service strategy may greatly increase your
dealership service sales and customer retention while decreasing the frequency of visits and
inconvenience to your customer.
- Review your program to ensure that all vehicles coming in are evaluated for safety and wear
items. Examine all vehicles for tire condition, signs of misalignment, brake wear, exterior lamp
functionality, exhaust condition, A/C cooling performance, SRS or Air Bag MIL, along with Service
Engine Soon or Check Engine indicators. If the Service Engine Soon or Check Engine MIL is
illuminated, it is vital that you inform the customer of the concerns with ignoring the indicator and
what the required repair would cost. In addition to the possibility of increased emissions and
driveability concerns, many customers are unaware that lower gas mileage may also result, with
additional cost to the customer.
- Be complete in your service recommendations. Some sales opportunities are not being fully
pursued nationally. Focus on overlooked but required maintenance that has real benefits to the
customer. Many vehicles are equipped with cabin air filters. If these filters are used beyond
replacement time, they may impede airflow decreasing A/C and heating performance. Make sure
these filters are part of your recommended service. Note that some of our vehicles may not have
been factory equipped but will accept the filters as an accessory.
- Express the value in maintaining the finish quality of the customer's vehicle at the Maintenance I
and II visits. More fully utilize the vehicle prep personnel you already have in place. In today's
world, many people simply ignore the finish of their vehicle, at best infrequently using an automatic
car wash for exterior cleaning. Offer vehicle detailing services in stages from just a wash and wax
to a complete interior cleaning. When paired with the Simplified Maintenance visit, this will increase
customer satisfaction. On return, the customer gets a visibly improved vehicle that will be a source
of pride of ownership along with a vehicle that is now fully maintained. Also, reinforce the improved
resale value of a completely maintained vehicle.
- For customers who clean and maintain the appearance of their vehicles themselves encourage
the use of GM Vehicle Care products. Many customers may have never used GM Car Wash/Wax
Concentrate, GM Cleaner Wax or a longtime product, GM Glass Cleaner, which is a favorite of
many customers who try it just once. If your dealership give samples of these products with new
car purchases, customers may already be sold on the product but not willing to make a special trip
to the dealership. Capitalize on sales at this time. Stock shelves right at the Service counter with
these products and consider instituting compensation programs for Service Consultants who
suggest these products. Many consumers faced with an intimidating wall full of car care products
sold at local auto parts stores may find it comforting to purchase a fully tested product sold by GM
that they know will not harm the finish of their vehicle. We suggest these competitively priced basic
vehicle care products to emphasize:
In USA:
- #12378401 GM Vehicle Care Wash/Wax Concentrate 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #89021822 GM Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner Aerosol 18 oz. (510 g)
- #12377966 GM Vehicle Care Cleaner Wax 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #1052929 GM Vehicle Care Chrome and Wire Wheel Cleaner 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #88861431 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 24 fl. oz. (0.710L)
In Canada:
- #10953203 GM Vehicle Care Wash & Wax Concentrate 473 mL
- #992727 GM Glass Cleaner Aerosol 500 g
- #10952905 GM Vehicle Care Liquid Cleaner/Wax 473 mL
- #10953013 GM Vehicle Care Chrome Cleaner and Polish 454 mL
- #10953202 GM Vehicle Care Wheel Brite 473 mL
- #88901678 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 473 mL
- Display signboards with the installed price for popular GM Accessories such as running boards
and Tonneau Covers. Customers may not think to ask about these desirable items at the time of a
service visit.
- Finally, take advantage of the GM Goodwrench initiatives (Tire Program, Goodwrench Credit
Card, etc. / Dealer Marketing Association (DMA) Promotions in Canada) to provide the customer
with more reasons to identify your dealership as the best place to go for parts and service.
Remember to utilize ALL of the service aspects you possess in your dealership to satisfy and
provide value to your customer. Many businesses exist profitably as an oil change location, a
vehicle repair facility, or a detailing shop alone. You already have the capabilities of all three and
provide these services with the inherent trust of your customer, under the GM Mark of Excellence.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Carrier > Carrier Bearings
> Component Information > Adjustments > 2 - Pinion
Carrier Bearings: Adjustments 2 - Pinion
Fig. 3 Installing shims
To adjust differential side bearing preload, change thickness of right and left shims equally so
original backlash is not disturbed.
1. Ensure side bearing surfaces are clean and free of burrs.
2. Apply suitable lubricant to side bearings. If original bearings are to be reused, original outer
races should also be used.
3. Install differential case in carrier, with bearing outer races in position.
4. Install left bearing cap and cap attaching bolts loosely so case may be moved during adjustment.
5. Measure original spacers and subtract .004 inch from each reading. Use caution not to
interchange right and left spacers.
6. Select a service spacer for each side equal to thickness of original shim minus .004 inch, then
install shim as shown in Fig. 3. Ensure flat edge of spacer faces against housing.
7. At this point, bearings should have no play and no drag (zero preload). If zero preload is not
present, shims should be added or removed equally from both sides as necessary.
8. Check case for zero endplay using a suitable dial indicator. If shim installation causes excessive
pinion to ring gear clearance, select thinner left shim and add difference to right side. Keep total
shim thickness at a value equal to that obtained in step 6.
9. Install both bearing caps and cap attaching bolts. Torque bolts 40 ft. lbs.
Fig. 4 Gear tooth contact pattern check
10. If pinion was not removed, check backlash and tooth pattern as follows:
a. Apply suitable marking compound on ring gear teeth.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Carrier > Carrier Bearings
> Component Information > Adjustments > 2 - Pinion > Page 5255
b. Rotate drive pinion one revolution and check gear tooth contact pattern as shown on Fig. 4. Add
or remove shims as required. c. After backlash and tooth pattern operation has been completed,
remove shim packs using caution not to mix them. d. Select new shims for each side .004 inch
thicker than those removed, then install each shim on its proper side. This additional thickness will
ensure proper bearing preload.
e. Check total rotational torque. Total torque with differential case preloaded and pinion installed
should be 16---29 inch lbs. if new bearings
are installed or 10---16 inch lbs. if original bearings are installed.
f. If total rotational torque is not as specified, repeat steps 4 through 10.
11. If drive pinion was removed, remove differential case and shims, then proceed to ``Drive Pinion
& Bearing Shim Adjustment'' procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Carrier > Carrier Bearings
> Component Information > Adjustments > 2 - Pinion > Page 5256
Carrier Bearings: Adjustments 4 - Pinion
Fig. 3 Installing shims
To adjust differential side bearing preload, change thickness of right and left shims equally so
original backlash is not disturbed.
1. Ensure side bearing surfaces are clean and free of burrs.
2. Apply suitable lubricant to side bearings. If original bearings are to be reused, original outer
races should also be used.
3. Install differential case in carrier, with bearing outer races in position.
4. Install left bearing cap and cap attaching bolts loosely so case may be moved during adjustment.
5. Measure original spacers and subtract .004 inch from each reading. Use caution not to
interchange right and left spacers.
6. Select a service spacer for each side equal to thickness of original shim minus .004 inch, then
install shim as shown in Fig. 3. Ensure flat edge of spacer faces against housing.
7. At this point, bearings should have no play and no drag (zero preload). If zero preload is not
present, shims should be added or removed equally from both sides as necessary.
8. Check case for zero endplay using a dial indicator. If shim installation causes excessive pinion to
ring gear clearance, select thinner left shim and add difference to right side. Keep total shim
thickness at a value equal to that obtained in step 6.
9. Install both bearing caps and cap attaching bolts. Torque bolts 40 ft. lbs.
Fig. 4 Gear tooth contact pattern check
10. If pinion was not removed, check backlash and tooth pattern as follows:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Carrier > Carrier Bearings
> Component Information > Adjustments > 2 - Pinion > Page 5257
a. Apply marking compound on ring gear teeth. b. Rotate drive pinion one revolution and check
gear tooth contact pattern as shown on Fig. 4. Add or remove shims as required. c. After backlash
and tooth pattern operation has been completed, remove shim packs using caution not to mix
them. d. Select new shims for each side .004 inch thicker than those removed, then install each
shim on its proper side. This additional thickness will
ensure proper bearing preload.
e. Check total rotational torque. Total torque with differential case preloaded and pinion installed
should be 16-29 inch lbs. if new bearings are
installed or 10-16 inch lbs. if original bearings are installed.
f. If total rotational torque is not as specified, repeat steps 4 through 10.
11. If drive pinion was removed, remove differential case and shims, then proceed to DRIVE
PINION & BEARING SHIM ADJUSTMENT procedure.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
Differential Clutch: Service and Repair 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
Cam Gear Clutch
Fig. 8 Exploded View Of Eaton Locking Differential. Models With 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
1. Remove retaining ring from end of cam gear, Fig. 8.
2. Remove discs and cam plate from gear, keeping all components in order.
3. Clean and inspect components, and replace any that are damaged, distorted or excessively
worn. If cam gear must be replaced, refer to CAM GEAR SHIM SELECTION for shim selection
procedures prior to case reassembly.
4. Position gear on flat surface with hub end up, and assemble cam plate onto gear with cam form
down to mate with cam form on gear.
5. Assemble two eared discs, one splined disc and one wave washer on cam gear, starting with
eared disc as shown in Fig. 8.
6. Alternately assemble three eared discs and two splined discs on cam gear hub, starting with
eared discs.
7. Install retaining ring, ensuring that retainer is fully seated.
Side Gear (RH) Clutch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear > Page 5262
Fig. 8 Exploded View Of Eaton Locking Differential. Models With 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
1. Remove disc pack and shim from side gear, keeping components in order.
2. Clean and inspect components, and replace any that are damaged, deformed or excessively
worn. If side gear must be replaced, refer to SIDE GEAR SHIM SELECTION for shim selection
prior to case assembly. If side gear hub is scored or worn, inspect bore in case and replace
assembly if bore is damaged or worn.
3. Alternately assemble eared discs and splined discs on side gear hub, starting with eared disc as
shown in Fig. 8.
4. Install original shim or replacement shim of same thickness if original side gear is being used.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear > Page 5263
Differential Clutch: Service and Repair 8 7/8 Inch Ring Gear
Cam Gear Clutch
If cam plate or clutch discs must be replaced, the cam gear subassembly must be serviced as
follows:
1. Measure and record overall length of gear assembly (front face of gear to back side of thrust
ring, including shim). This dimension will be needed to reassemble unit if thrust ring is replaced. Do
not replace thrust ring unless necessary. If ring is excessively worn or scored, check bore in case
for scoring. If bore is scored, replace entire differential.
2. With gear hub end up, compress disc pack and install jaws of split ring bearing remover between
the thrust ring and the top eared disc. Bevel side of bearing remover should face up toward thrust
ring.
3. Place cam gear assembly with bearing remover attached in an arbor press supporting the
bearing remover on both sides.
4. Install a 1-1/2 inch to 1-3/4 inch diameter plug on gear hub. Press against plug with ram of press
to remove thrust ring. Keep components in proper order.
5. Place gear on bench with hub end up.
6. Assemble cam plate with cam form down to mate with cam form on gear.
Fig. 8 Exploded View Of Eaton Locking Differential. Models With 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
7. Assemble onto cam plate: 2 eared discs, 1 splined disc, and 1 wave spring alternately, Fig. 8.
8. Assemble onto gear hub: 2 splined discs and 3 eared discs alternately, Fig. 8.
9. Locate cam gear assembly in arbor press with hub end up. Place thrust ring on gear hub and
press to shoulder making sure that ring is square with hub. Compress disc pack by pushing down
on the discs to keep the splined discs from becoming wedged between the thrust ring and gear
shoulder while pressing the subassembly together.
Side Gear (RH) Clutch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear > Page 5264
Fig. 8 Exploded View Of Eaton Locking Differential. Models With 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
1. Remove shim and disc pack from side gear, keeping components in order.
2. Inspect discs and guide clips and replace as needed.
3. Inspect side gear and shim. If either component is damaged or excessively worn, differential
assembly must be replaced. If gear hub is scored or abnormally worn, inspect corresponding bore
in case. If case bore is damaged or oversize, differential assembly must be replaced.
4. Assemble eared and splined discs onto side gear hub, starting with eared disc as shown in Fig.
8. If original disc pack is used, ensure that discs are installed in original position.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear > Page 5265
Differential Clutch: Service and Repair 9 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
Cam Gear Clutch
Fig. 6 Cam Gear Thrust Ring Removal. Eaton Locking Differential
1. Measure and record overall length of cam gear assembly from front face of gear to back side of
thrust ring, including shim.
2. With gear hub facing up, compress disc pack and insert jaws of suitable split ring bearing puller
between thrust ring and top eared disc with bevel side of puller facing thrust ring, Fig. 6.
3. Support bearing remover in press and press cam gear from thrust ring using 1-3/4 inch diameter
spacer. Keep all component in order as cam gear is removed.
4. Remove disc pack and cam plate from gear, clean and inspect components, and replace any
that are damaged or excessively worn. Do not replace thrust ring and/or cam gear unless
necessary. If ring or gear is excessively worn or scored, inspect bore in case. If case bore is
scored, entire assembly must be replaced. If cam gear or thrust ring are replaced, shim thickness
must be selected to provide original assembly dimension and proper differential pinion backlash.
5. Position cam gear on flat surface with hub end up and install cam plate with cam form down to
mate with form on gear.
Fig. 5 Exploded View Of Eaton Locking Differential
6. Assemble two eared discs, one splined disc and wave spring onto cam plate as shown in Fig. 5.
If components are reused, they must be installed in original position.
7. Alternately assemble three splined and four eared discs on cam gear hub, as shown in Fig. 5.
8. Mount cam gear assembly in press and position thrust ring over gear hub.
9. Compress disc pack to prevent splined disc from being trapped, then press thrust ring onto gear
until seated against shoulder of gear.
10. Inspect assembly to ensure that discs are properly assembled and that first splined disc (large
spline) is properly located on cam plate.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 7 1/2 - 8 1/2 Inch Ring Gear > Page 5266
Side Gear (RH) Clutch
Fig. 5 Exploded View Of Eaton Locking Differential
1. Remove shim and disc pack from gear keeping components in order.
2. Inspect discs and guide clips and replace as needed.
3. Inspect side gear and shim. If either component is scored or excessively worn, inspect case and
replace entire assembly if case is defective. If either side gear or shim must be replaced, shim
thickness must be determined. Refer to Shim Selection. See: Differential Carrier/Service and
Repair
4. Alternately assemble splined and eared discs on side gear hub as shown in Fig. 5. If
components are reused, they must be installed in original position.
5. Install original shim or new shim of equal thickness.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Front Axle Vacuum Actuator
Differential Lock: Locations Front Axle Vacuum Actuator
Shift Cable
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Vacuum hose from the vacuum actuator (130). 2. Shift cable (10) from the vacuum actuator
(130). 3. Bolts (131). 4. Vacuum actuator (130).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Vacuum actuator (130). 2. Bolts (131). Tighten to 1.4 Nm (13 lbs. in.). 3. Shift cable (10).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Front Axle Vacuum Actuator > Page 5271
4. Vacuum hose.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Front Axle Vacuum Actuator > Page 5272
Differential Lock: Locations Shift Cable
Shift Cable
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Front Axle Vacuum Actuator > Page 5273
Disconnecting The Shift Cable From The Vacuum Actuator
Shift Cable And Housing
Disconnecting The Shift Cable From The Carrier
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Shift cable (10) from the vacuum actuator (130).
A. Bend the tang on the lock spring (133).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Front Axle Vacuum Actuator > Page 5274
B. Push the diaphragm in to release the cable end. C. Squeeze the two locking fingers of the cable
ferrule with pliers. Then pull the cable from the bracket.
2. Raise the vehicle and support with safety stands. 3. Bolts (6).
- DO NOT unscrew the coupling nut (132) at this time.
4. Shift cable housing (11) from the carrier assembly. Pull out about 20 mm (3/4 inch). 5. Cable end
from the shift fork shaft (17). Bend the tang of the locking spring (137), then pull the cable end from
the shift fork shaft. 6. Shift cable (10) from the shift cable housing (11) by unscrewing the coupling
nut (132). 7. Shift cable from the vehicle.
Shift Cable
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Front Axle Vacuum Actuator > Page 5275
Connecting The Shift Cable To The Carrier
Connecting The Shift Cable To The Vacuum Actuator
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Shift cable housing (11) to the carrier assembly. 2. Bolts (6). Tighten bolts (6) to 48 Nm (36 lbs.
ft.). 3. Shift cable (10) to the shift cable housing.
A. The shift cable must be attached to the housing before it is routed. B. Guide the cable end (136)
through the hole in the shift cable housing. C. Push the cable end into the shift fork shaft (17). It
should snap into place. D. Thread the coupling nut (132) into the housing by hand to avoid cross
threading. Tighten coupling nut to 10.0 Nm (90 lbs. in.).
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Shift cable to the vehicle.
A. Route as shown.
6. Shift cable to the vacuum actuator (130).
A. Push the cable into the hole in the bracket. The cable end and ferrule should snap together.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Differential Axle Housing: Service and Repair Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Removal and Installation
1. Unlock steering column so linkage is free to move, then disconnect shift cable from vacuum
actuator. 2. Raise and support vehicle, then remove battery and battery tray. 3. Remove front
wheels, then the front axle skid plate. 4. Remove drain plug and flat washer, then drain lubricant
from carrier. 5. Remove righthand side lower shock bolt. 6. Disconnect wire from indicator switch.
7. Remove shift cable housing and shift cable from carrier housing. 8. Disconnect vent hose. 9.
Disconnect steering relay rod from idler arm and pitman arm.
10. Hold left drive axle by inserting drift in top of brake caliper and into vanes in brake rotor, noting
the following:
a. It is essential positions of all driveline components relative to propeller shaft and axles be
observed and accurately reference marked before
disassembling. Relative components include propeller shafts, drive axles, pinion flanges, output
shafts, etc.
b. All components must be assembled in exact relationship to each other as they were before
removal. c. Published specifications as well as any measurements made prior to disassembly must
be followed.
11. Remove bolts, then the drift from brake rotor. 12. Remove bolts and nuts, then the front prop
shaft, as follows:
a. Support both lower control arms with suitable stands at edge of stabilizer shaft. b. Lower vehicle
until front end weight is resting on stands.
13. Hold carrier upper nut with 18mm wrench inserted through frame, then remove carrier bolts and
nuts. 14. Remove carrier assembly by rolling carrier counterclockwise while lifting up to gain
clearance from mounting ears. 15. Remove tube bolts from carrier. 16. Reverse procedure to
install.
Tube & Shaft Assembly
Fig. 3 Vacuum Actuator
Fig. 4 Drive Axle & Tube Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect shift cable from vacuum actuator. Disengage
locking spring, then push actuator diaphragm into release cable, Fig. 3. 3. Unlock steering wheel so
linkage is free to move. 4. Raise vehicle and place jack stands under frame side rails. 5. Remove
front wheels, drive belt shield and the axle skid plate as equipped.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5280
6. Support righthand lower control arm with a jack, then disconnect right upper ball joint and
remove support so that control arm hangs free. 7. Disconnect righthand drive axle shaft from tube
assembly, Fig. 4. Insert a drift through opening in top of brake caliper and into corresponding
vane of brake rotor to prevent axle from turning.
8. Disconnect four-wheel drive indicator light electrical connector from switch. 9. Remove three shift
cable and switch housing to carrier bolts and pull housing out to gain access to cable locking
spring. Do not remove cable
coupling nut unless cable is being replaced.
10. Disconnect shift cable from fork shaft by lifting spring over slot in shift fork. 11. Remove tube
bracket bolts from frame and tube assembly bolts from carrier. 12. Remove tube assembly from
axle. Use care not to allow sleeve, thrust washers, connector and output shaft to fall from carrier or
be damaged when
removing tube.
Fig. 5 Thrust Washer Installation
Fig. 6 Checking Operation Of Four Wheel Drive Mechanism
INSTALLATION
1. Install sleeve, thrust washers, connector and output shaft in carrier. The thrust washer notch
must align with tab on washer, Fig. 5. 2. Coat tube to carrier mating surface with Loctite 514
sealant or equivalent. 3. Install tube and shaft assembly to carrier using only one bolt installed
finger tight at one o'clock position. 4. Pull assembly down, then install cable and switch housing
and four remaining bolts. Tighten bolts to specifications. 5. Install two tube to frame bolts. Tighten
to specifications. 6. Check four wheel drive mechanism for proper operation by inserting shift cable
housing installation tool No. J-33799, or equivalent, into shift fork
and checking for rotation of axle shaft, Fig. 6.
7. Remove tool and install shift cable switch housing, then guide cable through housing into fork
shaft hole and push cable in by sliding cable
through into fork shaft hole.
8. Connect four wheel drive indicator light electrical connector to switch. 9. Support and raise
righthand lower control arm using a jack and connect upper ball joint.
10. Install righthand drive axle to axle tube. Install one bolt first, then rotate axle to install five
remaining bolts. Tighten bolts to specifications. 11. Install front axle skid plate, if equipped, drive
belt shield and front wheels. Tighten skid plate bolts to specifications. 12. Connect shift cable to
vacuum actuator by pushing cable end into actuator shaft hole.
Output Shaft Pilot Bearing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5281
Exploded View Of Front Drive Axle.
1. Remove tube and shaft assembly. Refer to TUBE & SHAFT ASSEMBLY. See: Tube & Shaft
Assembly 2. Remove bearing using pilot bearing remover tool No. J-34011, or equivalent, Fig. 1. 3.
Lubricate new bearing with suitable axle lubricant, then install bearing using pilot bearing installer
tool No. J-33482, or equivalent. 4. Reverse procedure to complete installation.
Righthand Output Shaft & Tube
Disassembly
1. Remove output shaft from tube by tapping inside of flange with a rubber mallet.
2. Pry tube seal from tube, then remove bearing from tube.
3. Drive differential shift cable housing seal out of tube using a punch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5282
Assembly
1. Install output shaft tube bearing.
2. Install tube seal. Flange of seal must be flush with tube outer surface.
3. Install output shaft into tube by tapping flange with a rubber mallet.
4. Install differential shift cable housing seal.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Axle Housing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5283
Differential Axle Housing: Service and Repair Semi-Floating Rear Axle
Fig. 1 Rear Suspension. L H Side Down, R H Side Similar
Construction of the axle assembly is such that service operations may be performed with the
housing installed in the vehicle or with the housing removed and installed in a holding fixture. The
following procedure is necessary only when the housing requires replacement.
1. Raise vehicle and place jack stands under frame side rails. Position a jack under the rear axle
housing and raise slightly to support axle assembly. 2. Remove rear wheels. 3. Disconnect shock
absorbers from anchor plates. 4. Scribe reference marks between driveshaft and pinion flange for
use during reassembly, then disconnect driveshaft and position aside. 5. Disconnect brake lines
from junction block and backing plates, then remove junction block attaching bolt and position
aside. 6. Remove backing plates. 7. Remove U-bolts and anchor plates, Fig. 1. 8. Disconnect vent
hose from axle housing. 9. Lower rear axle assembly, then remove lower spring shackle bolts.
10. Remove rear axle assembly. 11. Reverse procedure to install. Tighten shock absorber nut,
U-bolt nuts and lower spring shackle bolts to specification.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Drain Plug, Differential > Component
Information > Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Recommended Axle Lubricant
Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Recommended Axle Lubricant
File In Section: 0 - General Information
Bulletin No.: 76-02-02A
Date: October, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: Recommended Axle Lubricant
Models: 1999 and Prior Rear Wheel Drive Passenger Cars, Light and Medium Duty Trucks, and
Four Wheel Drive Vehicles
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1998 and 1999 Model Years and add Vehicle Line and
Recommended Axle Lubricant Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 76-02-02
(Section 0 - General Information).
The following tables provide the latest information on recommended axle lubricant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Recommended Axle Lubricant > Page 5291
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Rear Axle Oil, Pints [05] ......................................................................................................................
............................................................................. 3.9
[05] Front drive axle, 2.6 pts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5294
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Front Axle
SAE 80W-90 GL5 Gear Lubricant. GM P/N 1052271
Locking Differential (G80)
This Article has been updated by TSB # 76-02-02A.
SAE 80W-90 GL5 Gear Lubricant, GM P/N 1052271. Do not use limited slip additive.
Non-Locking Differential
Rear Axle with Non Limited Slip or Non Locking Differentials
HD-3500 Trucks (Dana 11.0 axles)
Recommended Lubricant - GM P/N 12346140, SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Gear Lubricant.
1999 GMT 800 Trucks
Recommended Lubricant - GM P/N 12378261, SAE 75W-90 Synthetic Axle Lubricant.
All other non limited-slip or non locking differentials including B and D cars, S/T, M/L, G, P, and C/K
trucks except GMT 800 trucks, and as noted above.
Recommended Lubricant - GM P/N 1052271 or an SAE 80W90 GL-5 Gear Lubricant.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Pinion Bearing: Adjustments Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Fig. 22 Setting Pinion Depth
The drive pinions used are ``nominal'' or ``zero'' pinions and are not marked. The thickness of the
shim used will be equal to the dial
indicator gauge reading.
1. Lubricate inner and outer pinion bearings with axle lubricant, then install pinion shim setting
gauge tool No. J-33838 or equivalent while holding bearings in place,
Fig. 22.
2. Set preload of pinion bearings to 15-25 inch lbs. by tightening mounting bolt on tool while holding
end of tool shaft with a wrench.
3. Zero the dial indicator, then install it on pinion shim setting gauge tool No. J-33838 or equivalent.
Push dial indicator down until needle rotates approximately three turns clockwise and tighten the
dial indicator in this position.
4. Position button of pinion shim setting gauge tool No. J-33838 or equivalent in differential bearing
bore, then rotate tool back and forth until lowest point of bore is indicated on dial indicator.
5. Zero the dial indicator, then repeat rocking action of tool to verify zero setting.
6. When zero setting has been obtained and verified, move tool button out of bearing bore and
record the dial indicator reading. Select shim equal to this reading.
7. Install shim on drive pinion, then install pinion in carrier. Refer to Differential Carrier / Service
and Repair. See: Differential Carrier/Service
and Repair
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5299
Pinion Bearing: Adjustments Borg Warner
2 - Pinion
Fig. 8 Pinion gauge plate installation
Fig. 9 Checking pinion depth
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5300
Fig. 10 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Corvette
Adjustment
1. Install pinion bearing races in housing using a suitable driver.
2. Lubricate pinion bearings and install bearings in races.
3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing, Fig. 8, noting the following:
a. Assemble gauge plate onto preload stud.
b. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through rear bearing and pilot and front bearing and
pilot, then install retaining nut and tighten nut until snug.
c. Rotate tool to ensure bearings are properly seated.
d. Hold preload stud and tighten nut until 20 inch lbs. of torque, which is required to rotate stud. To
prevent damage to bearing, tighten nut in
small increments, checking rotating torque after each adjustment.
e. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step for disc that corresponds to base of housing.
f. Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing, ensuring side bearing discs are properly seated,
install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to prevent bearing discs from moving,
Fig. 9.
4. Mount dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of arbor
plunger.
5. Preload indicator 3/4 revolution and secure to arbor mounting stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotating plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size.
7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button while observing dial indicator.
8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection, zero dial indicator.
Perform steps 7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero reading is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading.
Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for a ``nominal'' pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows: a.
If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension obtained
in step 9.
b. If pinion is stamped with a minus ( - ) number, subtract that many thousandths from dimension
obtained in step 9.
c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number, dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim
thickness.
12. Remove gauging tools and pinion bearings from housing, noting installation position of
bearings.
Installation
1. Install selected shim onto pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable spacers.
2. Install new collapsible spacer onto pinion shaft, then insert pinion assembly into housing.
3. Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing into housing and tap bearing over pinion shaft with
a drift while assistant holds pinion in place. Old
pinion nut and a large washer can be used to seat front bearing on pinion, but care must be taken
not to collapse spacer if this method is used.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5301
4. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft yoke on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping yoke until several pinion shaft threads protrude from yoke.
5. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut.
6. Hold driveshaft yoke with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until
endplay is reduced to zero.
7. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload using a torque wrench.
8. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until 35-40 inch lbs. of bearing preload is
obtained with new bearings or 20-25 inch lbs. of bearing preload is obtained with used bearings,
rotating pinion and checking preload after each adjustment.
Exceeding preload specification will
compress collapsible spacer too far, requiring replacement of spacer. If preload specification is
exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated. Do not loosen
pinion nut to reduce preload.
4 - Pinion
Fig. 5 Drive pinion & bearing shim adjustment
1. Install front pinion bearing cup in carrier using tool J-7817 or equivalent.
2. Install spacer (E) into carrier bore, Fig. 5.
3. Slide rear pinion bearing and cap (F) onto thru bolt (D) and rear bearing into axle housing.
4. Install thru bolt (D), rear bearing and cap (F) into axle housing.
5. Assemble front bearing cone (A) and spacer (B) onto thru bolt.
6. Rotate nut and shaft while increasing torque on nut until a rotational torque of 15-22 inch lbs. is
obtained. Rotate thru bolt back and forth when
tightening nut to properly seat bearing.
7. Install discs on thru bolt assembly as shown in Fig. 5. Position carrier so dial indicator contact
rod is directly over gauging area of gauge plate
J-35118-2. Discs must be fully seated in side bearing bores.
8. Install bearing caps over gauge shaft discs, then the cap attaching bolts.
torque attaching bolts to 40 ft. lbs.
9. With dial indicator rod contacting gauging area of J-35118-2, rock gauge shaft back and forth
until dial indicator measures the greatest deflection, then zero dial indicator.
10. Rotate gauge shaft until shaft does not contact gauge plate, then note measurement.
11. Select correct pinion shim as follows: a. If reusing production pinion, and pinion is marked with
a ``+,'' correct shim will have a thickness equal to gauge reading minus amount
specified on pinion.
b. If reusing production pinion, and pinion is marked with a `` - ,'' correct shim will have a thickness
equal to gauge reading plus amount specified
on pinion.
c. If using a production or service pinion which has no marking, correct shim will have a thickness
equal to gauge reading.
12. Install selected pinion shim into carrier, then press rear pinion bearing cup into carrier using tool
J-5590 or equivalent.
13. Press rear pinion bearing onto pinion using a bearing installation tool, then install pinion in
carrier.
14. Install collapsible spacer and front bearing onto pinion while supporting pinion under head.
15. Install oil seal, companion flange and new nut on pinion, then tighten pinion nut until a rotating
torque of 10-25 inch lbs. with new bearings or
5-12 inch lbs. with original bearings is obtained while rotating pinion forwards to seat bearings.
16. If preload is excessive after tightening pinion nut, replace collapsible spacer and repeat steps
14 and 15.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5302
Pinion Bearing: Adjustments Corporate and Eaton
7 1/2 - 8 5/8 Inch Ring Gear
PINION DEPTH ADJUSTMENT
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing are replaced,
pinion depth must be adjusted using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver. 2. Lubricate pinion
bearings and install bearings in races. 3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing, noting the following:
Fig. 16 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/7-1/2 inch ring gear
a. On models with 7 1/2 & 7 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-23597-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 16. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5303
Fig. 17 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/8-1/2 & 8-7/8 inch ring gear
b. On models with 8 1/2 and 8 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-21777-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 17. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
c. Assemble gauge plate onto preload stud. d. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through
rear bearing and pilot and front bearing and pilot, then install retaining nut and tighten nut
until snug.
e. Rotate tool to ensure bearings are properly seated. f.
Hold preload stud and torque nut until 20 inch lbs. is required to rotate stud. Tighten nut in small
increments, checking rotating
torque after
each adjustment, to prevent damaging bearings.
g. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step for disc that corresponds to base of housing. h.
Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing, ensuring that side bearing discs are properly
seated, install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to
prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger. 5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution and secure to arbor mounting stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotating plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size. 7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button
while observing dial indicator. 8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection,
zero dial indicator.
Perform steps 7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero reading is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for a "nominal" pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification
of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows:
a. If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension
obtained in step 9. b. If pinion is stamped with a minus (-) number, subtract that many thousandths
from dimension obtained in step 9. c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number,
dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim thickness.
12. Remove gauging tools and pinion bearings from housing, noting installation position of
bearings.
PINION INSTALLATION
1. Install selected shim onto pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable
spacers.
2. Install new collapsible spacer onto pinion shaft, then insert pinion assembly into housing. 3.
Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing into housing and tap bearing over pinion shaft with
suitable drift while assistant holds pinion in
place.
Old pinion nut and suitable large washer can be used to seat front bearing on pinion, but care must
be taken not to collapse spacer
if this method is used.
4. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft yoke on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping yoke until several pinion
shaft threads protrude from yoke.
5. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut. 6. Hold
driveshaft yoke with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until endplay
is reduced to zero. 7. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload using
suitable torque wrench.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5304
8. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified pinion bearing preload is
obtained, rotating pinion and checking preload after
each adjustment. Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far,
requiring replacement of spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
9 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
Fig. 9 Pinion depth gauge installation
PINION DEPTH, ADJUST
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing requires
replacement, pinion depth must be adjusted using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver.
2. Lubricate pinion bearings and install bearings in races.
3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing noting the following.
Use gauge assembly J-21777-01, Fig. 9, or suitable equivalent. Follow all tool
manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge assembly.
a. Assemble gauge plate on preload stud. b. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through
rear bearing and pilot, then front bearing and pilot, install retaining nut and tighten nut
hand tight.
c. Rotate tool to ensure that bearings are properly seated. d. Hold preload stud and tighten nut until
20 inch lbs. torque is required to rotate stud.
Tighten nut in small increments, checking rotating
torque after each adjustment using suitable torque wrench.
e. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step that corresponds to base of housing. f.
Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing ensuring that side bearing discs are properly seated,
install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger.
5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution, then secure to arbor stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotate plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size.
7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button while observing dial indicator.
8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection, zero dial indicator. Perform steps
7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero setting is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for ``nominal'' pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows:
a. If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension
obtained in step 9. b. If pinion is stamped with a minus ( - ) number, subtract that many
thousandths from dimension obtained in step 9. c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus
number, dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim thickness.
12. Remove gauging tool and pinion bearings from housing.
DRIVE PINION, INSTALL
1. Install pinion bearing races in housing, if not previously installed, using suitable drivers to ensure
that races are squarely seated.
2. Install selected shim on pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable spacers.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5305
3. Install new collapsible spacer on pinion and insert pinion assembly into housing.
4. Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing in housing and tap bearing onto pinion shaft while
assistant holds pinion in place. Old pinion nut
and large washer can be used to draw front bearing onto pinion, but care must be taken not to
collapse spacer if this method is used.
5. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft flange on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping flange until several pinion shaft threads protrude.
6. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut and
adjust preload to specifications.
PINION BEARING PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT
1. Ensure pinion and bearings are properly installed, as outlined. 2. Hold driveshaft companion
flange with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until endplay is
reduced to zero. 3. Using and inch lb. torque wrench, check pinion preload by rotating pinion with
wrench. Preload should be at 20-25 inch lbs. or less on new
bearings or 10-15 inch lbs. on used bearings.
4. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified bearing preload is obtained,
rotating pinion and checking preload after each
adjustment. Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far, requiring
replacement of spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion
Pinion Bearing: Service and Repair Borg Warner - 2 Pinion
1. Scribe reference mark between drive pinion and driveshaft yoke, then hold yoke with suitable
tool and remove pinion nut and yoke. If yoke shows wear in the seal-to-flange contacting surface,
the yoke should be replaced.
2. Install original pinion nut a few turns on pinion shaft, then using hammer and drift, tap pinion
shaft out of pinion housing. Hold gear end of pinion shaft when removing to prevent it from falling
from axle housing. On Corvette models, the pinion preload shims may stick to the pinion housing or
the rear bearing during removal. These shims must be collected and kept together for use during
reassembly.
3. Remove and discard pinion nut and collapsible spacer.
4. If being replaced, remove front and rear bearing races from pinion housing using drift positioned
in race slots and hammer.
5. If rear pinion bearing is being replaced, remove using arbor press and adapters. Measure and
record thickness of shim which is found under rear bearing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5308
Pinion Bearing: Service and Repair Corporate and Eaton
7 1/2 - 8 5/8 Inch Ring Gear
PINION DEPTH ADJUSTMENT
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing are replaced,
pinion depth must be adjusted using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver. 2. Lubricate pinion
bearings and install bearings in races. 3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing, noting the following:
Fig. 16 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/7-1/2 inch ring gear
a. On models with 7 1/2 & 7 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-23597-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 16. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5309
Fig. 17 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/8-1/2 & 8-7/8 inch ring gear
b. On models with 8 1/2 and 8 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-21777-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 17. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
c. Assemble gauge plate onto preload stud. d. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through
rear bearing and pilot and front bearing and pilot, then install retaining nut and tighten nut
until snug.
e. Rotate tool to ensure bearings are properly seated. f.
Hold preload stud and torque nut until 20 inch lbs. is required to rotate stud. Tighten nut in small
increments, checking rotating
torque after
each adjustment, to prevent damaging bearings.
g. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step for disc that corresponds to base of housing. h.
Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing, ensuring that side bearing discs are properly
seated, install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to
prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger. 5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution and secure to arbor mounting stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotating plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size. 7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button
while observing dial indicator. 8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection,
zero dial indicator.
Perform steps 7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero reading is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for a "nominal" pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification
of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows:
a. If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension
obtained in step 9. b. If pinion is stamped with a minus (-) number, subtract that many thousandths
from dimension obtained in step 9. c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number,
dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim thickness.
12. Remove gauging tools and pinion bearings from housing, noting installation position of
bearings.
PINION INSTALLATION
1. Install selected shim onto pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable
spacers.
2. Install new collapsible spacer onto pinion shaft, then insert pinion assembly into housing. 3.
Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing into housing and tap bearing over pinion shaft with
suitable drift while assistant holds pinion in
place.
Old pinion nut and suitable large washer can be used to seat front bearing on pinion, but care must
be taken not to collapse spacer
if this method is used.
4. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft yoke on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping yoke until several pinion
shaft threads protrude from yoke.
5. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut. 6. Hold
driveshaft yoke with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until endplay
is reduced to zero. 7. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload using
suitable torque wrench.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5310
8. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified pinion bearing preload is
obtained, rotating pinion and checking preload after
each adjustment. Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far,
requiring replacement of spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
9 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
PINION DEPTH ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 9 Pinion Depth Gauge Installation
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if
ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing requires replacement, pinion depth must be adjusted
using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver.
2. Lubricate pinion bearings and install bearings in races.
3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing noting the following.
Use gauge assembly tool No. J-21777-01, Fig. 9, or suitable equivalent. Follow all
tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge assembly. a.
Assemble gauge plate on preload stud.
b. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through rear bearing and pilot, then front bearing and
pilot, install retaining nut and tighten nut hand tight.
c. Rotate tool to ensure that bearings are properly seated.
d. Hold preload stud and tighten nut until 20 inch lbs. torque is required to rotate stud. Tighten nut
in small increments, checking rotating
torque after each adjustment using suitable torque wrench.
e. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step that corresponds to base of housing.
f. Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing ensuring that side bearing discs are properly
seated, install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger.
5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution, then secure to arbor stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotate plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size.
7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button while observing dial indicator.
8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection, zero dial indicator. Perform steps
7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero setting is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for ``nominal'' pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows: a.
If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension obtained
in step 9.
b. If pinion is stamped with a minus (-) number, subtract that many thousandths from dimension
obtained in step 9.
c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number, dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim
thickness.
12. Remove gauging tool and pinion bearings from housing.
DRIVE PINION INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion bearing races in housing, if not previously installed, using suitable drivers to ensure
that races are squarely seated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Bearing, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5311
2. Install selected shim on pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable spacers.
3. Install new collapsible spacer on pinion and insert pinion assembly into housing.
4. Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing in housing and tap bearing onto pinion shaft while
assistant holds pinion in place.
Old pinion nut
and large washer can be used to draw front bearing onto pinion, but care must be taken not to
collapse spacer if this method is used.
5. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft flange on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping flange until several pinion shaft threads protrude.
6. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut and
adjust preload to specifications.
PINION BEARING PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT
1. Ensure that pinion and bearings are properly installed, as outlined.
2. Hold driveshaft companion flange with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate
pinion until endplay is reduced to zero.
3. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload by rotating pinion with suitable
torque wrench.
4. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified bearing preload is obtained,
rotating pinion and checking preload after each adjustment.
Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far, requiring replacement of
spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Pinion Gear: Adjustments Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Fig. 22 Setting Pinion Depth
The drive pinions used are ``nominal'' or ``zero'' pinions and are not marked. The thickness of the
shim used will be equal to the dial
indicator gauge reading.
1. Lubricate inner and outer pinion bearings with axle lubricant, then install pinion shim setting
gauge tool No. J-33838 or equivalent while holding bearings in place,
Fig. 22.
2. Set preload of pinion bearings to 15-25 inch lbs. by tightening mounting bolt on tool while holding
end of tool shaft with a wrench.
3. Zero the dial indicator, then install it on pinion shim setting gauge tool No. J-33838 or equivalent.
Push dial indicator down until needle rotates approximately three turns clockwise and tighten the
dial indicator in this position.
4. Position button of pinion shim setting gauge tool No. J-33838 or equivalent in differential bearing
bore, then rotate tool back and forth until lowest point of bore is indicated on dial indicator.
5. Zero the dial indicator, then repeat rocking action of tool to verify zero setting.
6. When zero setting has been obtained and verified, move tool button out of bearing bore and
record the dial indicator reading. Select shim equal to this reading.
7. Install shim on drive pinion, then install pinion in carrier. Refer to Differential Carrier / Service
and Repair. See: Differential Carrier/Service
and Repair
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5316
Pinion Gear: Adjustments Borg Warner
2 - Pinion
Fig. 8 Pinion gauge plate installation
Fig. 9 Checking pinion depth
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5317
Fig. 10 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Corvette
Adjustment
1. Install pinion bearing races in housing using a suitable driver.
2. Lubricate pinion bearings and install bearings in races.
3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing, Fig. 8, noting the following:
a. Assemble gauge plate onto preload stud.
b. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through rear bearing and pilot and front bearing and
pilot, then install retaining nut and tighten nut until snug.
c. Rotate tool to ensure bearings are properly seated.
d. Hold preload stud and tighten nut until 20 inch lbs. of torque, which is required to rotate stud. To
prevent damage to bearing, tighten nut in
small increments, checking rotating torque after each adjustment.
e. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step for disc that corresponds to base of housing.
f. Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing, ensuring side bearing discs are properly seated,
install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to prevent bearing discs from moving,
Fig. 9.
4. Mount dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of arbor
plunger.
5. Preload indicator 3/4 revolution and secure to arbor mounting stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotating plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size.
7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button while observing dial indicator.
8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection, zero dial indicator.
Perform steps 7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero reading is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading.
Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for a ``nominal'' pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows: a.
If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension obtained
in step 9.
b. If pinion is stamped with a minus ( - ) number, subtract that many thousandths from dimension
obtained in step 9.
c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number, dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim
thickness.
12. Remove gauging tools and pinion bearings from housing, noting installation position of
bearings.
Installation
1. Install selected shim onto pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable spacers.
2. Install new collapsible spacer onto pinion shaft, then insert pinion assembly into housing.
3. Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing into housing and tap bearing over pinion shaft with
a drift while assistant holds pinion in place. Old
pinion nut and a large washer can be used to seat front bearing on pinion, but care must be taken
not to collapse spacer if this method is used.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5318
4. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft yoke on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping yoke until several pinion shaft threads protrude from yoke.
5. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut.
6. Hold driveshaft yoke with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until
endplay is reduced to zero.
7. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload using a torque wrench.
8. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until 35-40 inch lbs. of bearing preload is
obtained with new bearings or 20-25 inch lbs. of bearing preload is obtained with used bearings,
rotating pinion and checking preload after each adjustment.
Exceeding preload specification will
compress collapsible spacer too far, requiring replacement of spacer. If preload specification is
exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated. Do not loosen
pinion nut to reduce preload.
4 - Pinion
Fig. 5 Drive pinion & bearing shim adjustment
1. Install front pinion bearing cup in carrier using tool J-7817 or equivalent.
2. Install spacer (E) into carrier bore, Fig. 5.
3. Slide rear pinion bearing and cap (F) onto thru bolt (D) and rear bearing into axle housing.
4. Install thru bolt (D), rear bearing and cap (F) into axle housing.
5. Assemble front bearing cone (A) and spacer (B) onto thru bolt.
6. Rotate nut and shaft while increasing torque on nut until a rotational torque of 15-22 inch lbs. is
obtained. Rotate thru bolt back and forth when
tightening nut to properly seat bearing.
7. Install discs on thru bolt assembly as shown in Fig. 5. Position carrier so dial indicator contact
rod is directly over gauging area of gauge plate
J-35118-2. Discs must be fully seated in side bearing bores.
8. Install bearing caps over gauge shaft discs, then the cap attaching bolts.
torque attaching bolts to 40 ft. lbs.
9. With dial indicator rod contacting gauging area of J-35118-2, rock gauge shaft back and forth
until dial indicator measures the greatest deflection, then zero dial indicator.
10. Rotate gauge shaft until shaft does not contact gauge plate, then note measurement.
11. Select correct pinion shim as follows: a. If reusing production pinion, and pinion is marked with
a ``+,'' correct shim will have a thickness equal to gauge reading minus amount
specified on pinion.
b. If reusing production pinion, and pinion is marked with a `` - ,'' correct shim will have a thickness
equal to gauge reading plus amount specified
on pinion.
c. If using a production or service pinion which has no marking, correct shim will have a thickness
equal to gauge reading.
12. Install selected pinion shim into carrier, then press rear pinion bearing cup into carrier using tool
J-5590 or equivalent.
13. Press rear pinion bearing onto pinion using a bearing installation tool, then install pinion in
carrier.
14. Install collapsible spacer and front bearing onto pinion while supporting pinion under head.
15. Install oil seal, companion flange and new nut on pinion, then tighten pinion nut until a rotating
torque of 10-25 inch lbs. with new bearings or
5-12 inch lbs. with original bearings is obtained while rotating pinion forwards to seat bearings.
16. If preload is excessive after tightening pinion nut, replace collapsible spacer and repeat steps
14 and 15.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5319
Pinion Gear: Adjustments Corporate and Eaton
7 1/2 - 8 5/8 Inch Ring Gear
PINION DEPTH ADJUSTMENT
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing are replaced,
pinion depth must be adjusted using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver. 2. Lubricate pinion
bearings and install bearings in races. 3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing, noting the following:
Fig. 16 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/7-1/2 inch ring gear
a. On models with 7 1/2 & 7 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-23597-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 16. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5320
Fig. 17 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/8-1/2 & 8-7/8 inch ring gear
b. On models with 8 1/2 and 8 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-21777-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 17. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
c. Assemble gauge plate onto preload stud. d. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through
rear bearing and pilot and front bearing and pilot, then install retaining nut and tighten nut
until snug.
e. Rotate tool to ensure bearings are properly seated. f.
Hold preload stud and torque nut until 20 inch lbs. is required to rotate stud. Tighten nut in small
increments, checking rotating
torque after
each adjustment, to prevent damaging bearings.
g. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step for disc that corresponds to base of housing. h.
Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing, ensuring that side bearing discs are properly
seated, install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to
prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger. 5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution and secure to arbor mounting stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotating plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size. 7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button
while observing dial indicator. 8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection,
zero dial indicator.
Perform steps 7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero reading is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for a "nominal" pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification
of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows:
a. If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension
obtained in step 9. b. If pinion is stamped with a minus (-) number, subtract that many thousandths
from dimension obtained in step 9. c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number,
dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim thickness.
12. Remove gauging tools and pinion bearings from housing, noting installation position of
bearings.
PINION INSTALLATION
1. Install selected shim onto pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable
spacers.
2. Install new collapsible spacer onto pinion shaft, then insert pinion assembly into housing. 3.
Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing into housing and tap bearing over pinion shaft with
suitable drift while assistant holds pinion in
place.
Old pinion nut and suitable large washer can be used to seat front bearing on pinion, but care must
be taken not to collapse spacer
if this method is used.
4. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft yoke on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping yoke until several pinion
shaft threads protrude from yoke.
5. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut. 6. Hold
driveshaft yoke with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until endplay
is reduced to zero. 7. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload using
suitable torque wrench.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5321
8. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified pinion bearing preload is
obtained, rotating pinion and checking preload after
each adjustment. Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far,
requiring replacement of spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
9 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
Fig. 9 Pinion depth gauge installation
PINION DEPTH, ADJUST
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing requires
replacement, pinion depth must be adjusted using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver.
2. Lubricate pinion bearings and install bearings in races.
3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing noting the following.
Use gauge assembly J-21777-01, Fig. 9, or suitable equivalent. Follow all tool
manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge assembly.
a. Assemble gauge plate on preload stud. b. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through
rear bearing and pilot, then front bearing and pilot, install retaining nut and tighten nut
hand tight.
c. Rotate tool to ensure that bearings are properly seated. d. Hold preload stud and tighten nut until
20 inch lbs. torque is required to rotate stud.
Tighten nut in small increments, checking rotating
torque after each adjustment using suitable torque wrench.
e. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step that corresponds to base of housing. f.
Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing ensuring that side bearing discs are properly seated,
install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger.
5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution, then secure to arbor stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotate plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size.
7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button while observing dial indicator.
8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection, zero dial indicator. Perform steps
7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero setting is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for ``nominal'' pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows:
a. If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension
obtained in step 9. b. If pinion is stamped with a minus ( - ) number, subtract that many
thousandths from dimension obtained in step 9. c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus
number, dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim thickness.
12. Remove gauging tool and pinion bearings from housing.
DRIVE PINION, INSTALL
1. Install pinion bearing races in housing, if not previously installed, using suitable drivers to ensure
that races are squarely seated.
2. Install selected shim on pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable spacers.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Adjustments > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5322
3. Install new collapsible spacer on pinion and insert pinion assembly into housing.
4. Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing in housing and tap bearing onto pinion shaft while
assistant holds pinion in place. Old pinion nut
and large washer can be used to draw front bearing onto pinion, but care must be taken not to
collapse spacer if this method is used.
5. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft flange on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping flange until several pinion shaft threads protrude.
6. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut and
adjust preload to specifications.
PINION BEARING PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT
1. Ensure pinion and bearings are properly installed, as outlined. 2. Hold driveshaft companion
flange with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until endplay is
reduced to zero. 3. Using and inch lb. torque wrench, check pinion preload by rotating pinion with
wrench. Preload should be at 20-25 inch lbs. or less on new
bearings or 10-15 inch lbs. on used bearings.
4. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified bearing preload is obtained,
rotating pinion and checking preload after each
adjustment. Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far, requiring
replacement of spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion
Pinion Gear: Service and Repair Borg Warner - 2 Pinion
1. Scribe reference mark between drive pinion and driveshaft yoke, then hold yoke with suitable
tool and remove pinion nut and yoke. If yoke shows wear in the seal-to-flange contacting surface,
the yoke should be replaced.
2. Install original pinion nut a few turns on pinion shaft, then using hammer and drift, tap pinion
shaft out of pinion housing. Hold gear end of pinion shaft when removing to prevent it from falling
from axle housing. On Corvette models, the pinion preload shims may stick to the pinion housing or
the rear bearing during removal. These shims must be collected and kept together for use during
reassembly.
3. Remove and discard pinion nut and collapsible spacer.
4. If being replaced, remove front and rear bearing races from pinion housing using drift positioned
in race slots and hammer.
5. If rear pinion bearing is being replaced, remove using arbor press and adapters. Measure and
record thickness of shim which is found under rear bearing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5325
Pinion Gear: Service and Repair Corporate and Eaton
7 1/2 - 8 5/8 Inch Ring Gear
PINION DEPTH ADJUSTMENT
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing are replaced,
pinion depth must be adjusted using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver. 2. Lubricate pinion
bearings and install bearings in races. 3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing, noting the following:
Fig. 16 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/7-1/2 inch ring gear
a. On models with 7 1/2 & 7 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-23597-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 16. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5326
Fig. 17 Pinion depth gauge tool installation. Models w/8-1/2 & 8-7/8 inch ring gear
b. On models with 8 1/2 and 8 5/8 inch ring gear, use gauge assembly tool No. J-21777-01 or
equivalent, Fig. 17. Follow all tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge
assembly.
c. Assemble gauge plate onto preload stud. d. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through
rear bearing and pilot and front bearing and pilot, then install retaining nut and tighten nut
until snug.
e. Rotate tool to ensure bearings are properly seated. f.
Hold preload stud and torque nut until 20 inch lbs. is required to rotate stud. Tighten nut in small
increments, checking rotating
torque after
each adjustment, to prevent damaging bearings.
g. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step for disc that corresponds to base of housing. h.
Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing, ensuring that side bearing discs are properly
seated, install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to
prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger. 5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution and secure to arbor mounting stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotating plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size. 7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button
while observing dial indicator. 8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection,
zero dial indicator.
Perform steps 7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero reading is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for a "nominal" pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification
of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows:
a. If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension
obtained in step 9. b. If pinion is stamped with a minus (-) number, subtract that many thousandths
from dimension obtained in step 9. c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number,
dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim thickness.
12. Remove gauging tools and pinion bearings from housing, noting installation position of
bearings.
PINION INSTALLATION
1. Install selected shim onto pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable
spacers.
2. Install new collapsible spacer onto pinion shaft, then insert pinion assembly into housing. 3.
Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing into housing and tap bearing over pinion shaft with
suitable drift while assistant holds pinion in
place.
Old pinion nut and suitable large washer can be used to seat front bearing on pinion, but care must
be taken not to collapse spacer
if this method is used.
4. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft yoke on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping yoke until several pinion
shaft threads protrude from yoke.
5. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut. 6. Hold
driveshaft yoke with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate pinion until endplay
is reduced to zero. 7. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload using
suitable torque wrench.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5327
8. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified pinion bearing preload is
obtained, rotating pinion and checking preload after
each adjustment. Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far,
requiring replacement of spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
9 1/2 Inch Ring Gear
PINION DEPTH ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 9 Pinion Depth Gauge Installation
If original ring gear and pinion assembly and rear pinion bearing are to be reused, original depth
adjusting shim can be used. However, if
ring gear and pinion or rear pinion bearing requires replacement, pinion depth must be adjusted
using following procedures.
1. Install pinion bearing races to be used in housing using suitable driver.
2. Lubricate pinion bearings and install bearings in races.
3. Mount depth gauging jig in housing noting the following.
Use gauge assembly tool No. J-21777-01, Fig. 9, or suitable equivalent. Follow all
tool manufacturer's recommendations when installing gauge assembly. a.
Assemble gauge plate on preload stud.
b. Hold pinion bearings in position, insert stud through rear bearing and pilot, then front bearing and
pilot, install retaining nut and tighten nut hand tight.
c. Rotate tool to ensure that bearings are properly seated.
d. Hold preload stud and tighten nut until 20 inch lbs. torque is required to rotate stud. Tighten nut
in small increments, checking rotating
torque after each adjustment using suitable torque wrench.
e. Mount side bearing discs on arbor, using step that corresponds to base of housing.
f. Mount arbor and plunger assembly in housing ensuring that side bearing discs are properly
seated, install bearing caps and tighten cap bolts to prevent bearing discs from moving.
4. Mount suitable dial indicator on arbor stud with indicator contact button bearing against top of
arbor plunger.
5. Preload indicator 1/2 revolution, then secure to arbor stud in this position.
6. Place arbor plunger on gauge plate, rotate plate as needed so that plunger rests directly on
button corresponding to ring gear size.
7. Slowly rock plunger rod back and forth across button while observing dial indicator.
8. At point on button where indicator registers greatest deflection, zero dial indicator. Perform steps
7 and 8 several times to ensure correct
setting.
9. Once verified zero setting is obtained, swing plunger aside until it is clear of gauge plate button
and record dial indicator reading. Indicator will
now read required pinion depth shim thickness for ``nominal'' pinion.
10. Inspect rear face of drive pinion to be installed for a pinion code number. This number indicates
in thousandths of an inch necessary modification of pinion shim thickness obtained in step 9.
11. Select pinion depth adjusting shim as follows: a.
If pinion is stamped with a plus (+) number, add that number of thousandths to dimension obtained
in step 9.
b. If pinion is stamped with a minus (-) number, subtract that many thousandths from dimension
obtained in step 9.
c. If pinion is not stamped with plus or minus number, dimension obtained in step 9 is correct shim
thickness.
12. Remove gauging tool and pinion bearings from housing.
DRIVE PINION INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion bearing races in housing, if not previously installed, using suitable drivers to ensure
that races are squarely seated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Gear, Differential >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Borg Warner - 2 Pinion > Page 5328
2. Install selected shim on pinion shaft, lubricate rear pinion bearing with specified axle lubricant,
then press rear bearing onto pinion using suitable spacers.
3. Install new collapsible spacer on pinion and insert pinion assembly into housing.
4. Lubricate front pinion bearing, install bearing in housing and tap bearing onto pinion shaft while
assistant holds pinion in place.
Old pinion nut
and large washer can be used to draw front bearing onto pinion, but care must be taken not to
collapse spacer if this method is used.
5. Install new pinion seal in housing, coat seal lips with grease, then mount driveshaft flange on
pinion shaft, lightly tapping flange until several pinion shaft threads protrude.
6. Coat rear of pinion washer with suitable sealer, then install washer and new pinion nut and
adjust preload to specifications.
PINION BEARING PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT
1. Ensure that pinion and bearings are properly installed, as outlined.
2. Hold driveshaft companion flange with suitable tool, then alternately tighten pinion nut and rotate
pinion until endplay is reduced to zero.
3. When endplay is reduced to zero, check pinion bearing preload by rotating pinion with suitable
torque wrench.
4. Continue tightening pinion nut in small increments until specified bearing preload is obtained,
rotating pinion and checking preload after each adjustment.
Exceeding preload specification will compress collapsible spacer too far, requiring replacement of
spacer. If preload
specification is exceeded, spacer must be replaced and adjustment procedure must be repeated.
Do not loosen pinion nut to reduce preload.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Axle
Fig. 15 Pinion Flange Retaining Bolts
Fig. 16 Pinion Flange Removal
Fig. 17 Pinion Seal Installation
1. Remove crossmember if necessary.
2. Remove pinion flange bolts and retainers, Fig. 15.
3. Remove propeller shaft from pinion shaft and tape bearing caps to hold in place.
4. Remove pinion shaft retaining nut and washer. Mark pinion flange, pinion shaft, and pinion
retaining nut to ensure proper bearing preload.
5. Using companion flange holding tool No. J-8614-01, remove pinion flange, Fig. 16.
6. Remove pinion seal using a seal puller.
7. Reverse procedure to install, using seal installer tool No. J-33782 to install pinion oil seal, Fig.
17.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle > Page 5333
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Axle
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
- Tools Required: -
J 8614-01 Companion Flange Holder
1. Bolts and retainers.
Important: It is essential that the positions of all driveling components relative to the propeller shaft
and axles be observed and accurately reference marked prior to disassembly. These components
include the propeller shafts, drive axles, pinion flanges, output shafts, etc. All components must be
reassembled in the exact relationship to each other as they were when removed. Specifications
and torque values, as well as any measurements made prior to disassembly, must be followed.
- Accurately mark the installed position of the propeller shaft and pinion flange so they can be
reassembled in the same position.
2. Propeller shaft from the pinion flange.
A. Use a piece of tape to hold the bearing caps. B. Secure the propeller shaft up and out of the way
so as not to put unnecessary stress on the universal joints. C. Make an accurate alignment mark
on the pinion stem, pinion flange, and pinion flange nut. Also record the number of exposed
threads on the
pinion stem for reference.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle > Page 5334
D. Measure, using an inch-pound torque wrench, the amount of torque required to turn the pinion.
Record this measurement for reassemble. This
will give combined pinion bearing, seal, carrier bearing, axle bearing, and seal preload.
3. Pinion flange nut and washer.
- Use J 8614-01 to hold the pinion flange.
4. Pinion flange.
- Have a suitable container in place to catch lubricant.
5. Oil seal using a seal removal tool.
- Do not damage the carrier.
Inspect
1. Seal surface of the pinion flange for tool marks, nicks, or damage such as a groove worn by the
seal. Replace the flange if necessary. 2. Carrier bore for burrs that might cause leaks around the
outside of the seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Tools Required: J 8614-01 Companion Flange Holder
- J 23911 Pinion Oil Seal Installer
1. New seal using J 23911. 2. Seal lubricant to the outside of the pinion flange and the sealing lip of
the new seal. 3. Pinion flange.
Important: Do not attempt to hammer the pinion flange onto the pinion stem.
4. Washer and nut.
- Tighten: A. The nut on the pinion stem as close to the original marks as possible without going
past the mark. Use the reference mark and the thread
count as reference.
B. The nut a little at a time and turn the pinion flange several times after each tightening to set the
rollers.
Measure
- Using an inch-pound torque wrench, the torque required to rotate the pinion. Compare this with
the required rotating torque recorded earlier. Continue tightening and measuring a little at a time
until the same preload is achieved.
Important: If the original preload torque value was less than 3 inch lbs. then reset the torque specification to
3-5 inch lbs.
- Align the propeller shaft with the alignment marks made previously.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle > Page 5335
- Use J 8614-01 to hold the pinion flange.
5. Propeller shaft to the pinion flange. 6. Bolts and retainers.
- Tighten bolts to 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle
Differential Pilot Bearing
Fig. 1 Exploded View Of Front Axle
Refer to Fig. 1, when performing this procedure.
1. Remove shaft and tube assembly as outlined under TUBE & SHAFT ASSEMBLY.
2. Remove shim (20).
3. Using pilot bearing remover No. J34011 or equivalent, remove pilot bearing.
4. Reverse procedure to install, using bearing install No. J33842 or equivalent to install pilot
bearing.
Differential Output Shaft Pilot Bearing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5341
Fig. 1 Exploded View Of Front Drive Axle. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Remove tube and shaft assembly. Refer to Tube & Shaft Assembly. See: Differential
Assembly/Differential Axle Housing/Service and Repair
2. Remove bearing. Refer to Fig. 1 for bearing location.
3. Install new bearing.
4. Reverse procedure to complete installation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5342
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Dana/Spicer Full Floating Axle
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove axle shaft.
3. Remove hub and drum.
4. Remove oil seal, inner bearing and retaining ring.
5. Remove outer bearing.
6. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5343
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Saginaw Full Floating Axle
Bearing & Cup
Fig. 7 Removing Outer Bearing & Cup
1. Using a hammer and suitable drift, drive inner bearing, cup and seal from hub assembly.
2. Remove outer bearing snap ring using suitable pliers.
3. Using tools J-24426 and J-8092, Fig. 7, drive outer bearing and cup from hub assembly.
4. Install new outer bearing into hub assembly.
5. Install outer bearing cup using tools mentioned in Step 3. Drive cup beyond snap ring groove.
Install outer bearing cup with tool J-8092 positioned upside down to prevent chamfer on tool from
damaging cup.
6. Install snap ring into groove using suitable pliers.
7. Using tool J-24426, drive cup against snap ring.
8. Install inner bearing cup using tools J-24427 and J-8092. Drive cup into position until it seats
against shoulder of hub bore.
9. Install new oil seal.
Hub & Drum
Fig. 6 Removing Or Installing Wheel Bearing Adjusting Nut
1. Remove wheel and axle shaft.
2. Disengage tang of locknut from slot or flat of locknut, then remove locknut from housing tube,
using appropriate tool, Fig. 6.
3. Disengage tang of locknut from slot or flat of adjusting nut and remove locknut from housing
tube.
4. Use appropriate tool, Fig. 6, to remove adjusting nut from housing tube. Remove thrust washer
from housing tube.
5. Pull hub and drum straight off axle housing.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Aluminum Case Front Drive Axle > Page 5344
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Axle
Fig. 3 Axle Shaft Bearing Removal
Fig. 4 Axle Shaft Bearing Installation
Fig. 5 Axle Shaft Seal Installation
1. Remove axle shaft as described under "Rear Axle Shaft, Replace." 2. Remove axle seal by
prying behind seal steel case with a pry bar. Use caution to avoid damaging axle housing. 3. Using
a puller and slide hammer, remove axle bearing, Fig. 3. 4. Lubricate new bearing with gear
lubricant, then install bearing in axle housing with axle shaft bearing installer tool No. J-23765, or
equivalent,
until bearing is seated in housing, Fig. 4.
5. Lubricate seal lips with gear lubricant, then position seal on axle shaft seal installer tool No.
J-23771, or equivalent, and install in axle housing,
tapping into place until seal is flush with axle housing, Fig. 5.
6. Install axle shaft.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Constant Velocity Joint: Testing and Inspection
CLICKING NOISE IN TURNS
1. Worn or damaged outboard joints.
2. Cut or damaged seals.
NOISE DURING ACCELERATION FROM COAST TO DRIVE
1. Worn or damaged joint.
SHUDDER OR VIBRATION DURING ACCELERATION
1. Excessive joint angle.
2. Excessive toe.
3. Incorrect trim height.
4. Worn or damaged joints.
5. Sticking spider assembly.
VIBRATION AT HIGHWAY SPEEDS
1. Out of balance tires or wheels.
2. Out of round front tires.
3. Worn joint.
4. Binding or tight joint.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5349
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair
Exploded View Of Front Axle.
Outer Constant Velocity Joint Seal Removal & Installation
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5350
Outer Constant Velocity Joint Disassembly & Assembly
Refer to Figs. 13, 15, 16 for CV joint replacement.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Front Wheel Driveshaft Boot Damage Prevention
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Technical Service Bulletins Front Wheel Driveshaft Boot - Damage
Prevention
File In Section: 4 - Drive Axle Bulletin No. 56-43-01 Date: March, 1995
Subject: Preventing Front Wheel Driveshaft Boot Damage
Models: 1995 and Prior Light Duty Trucks with Four Wheel Drive (4WD) or All Wheel Drive (AWD)
When diagnosing a vehicle for customer concerns such as noise and/or vibrations, it is often
necessary to run the vehicle while it is supported in the air by hoists or jack stands. On light duty
truck models with four wheel drive (4WD) or All Wheel Drive (AWD) the front suspension should
not be allowed to hang free while performing on-hoist testing. It the front suspension is allowed to
hang free, the CV joint will be at a very high angle. This will likely result in damage to the front
wheel driveshaft boots. In addition, extra vibrations may occur and may damage the front wheel
driveshaft joints.
When on-hoist testing an AWD or 4WD light duty truck, support the outer end of the lower control
arm using jack stands. This will reduce the CV joint angle and prevent damage to the front wheel
driveshaft assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5355
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair
Fig. 13 Inner Tri-pot Seal Removal & Installation
Fig. 14 Righthand Output Shaft & Tube
For removal and installation procedures, refer to Figs. 13 and 14.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
Fig. 3 Axle Shaft Bearing Removal
Fig. 4 Axle Shaft Bearing Installation
Fig. 5 Axle Shaft Seal Installation
1. Remove axle shaft as described under AXLE SHAFT.
2. Remove axle seal by prying behind seal steel case with a suitable pry bar. Use care to avoid
damaging axle housing.
3. Remove axle bearing using slide hammer J-2619, adapter J-2619-4, or axle bearing puller
J-22813-01. The tangs of the axle bearing puller should engage the bearing outer race, Fig. 3.
4. Lubricate new bearing with gear lubricant, then install bearing in axle housing with axle shaft
bearing installer J-23765 or equivalent until bearing is seated in housing, Fig. 4.
5. Apply suitable gear lubricant to seal lips, then position seal on axle shaft seal installer J-23771 or
equivalent. Install in axle housing, tapping into place until seal is flush with housing, Fig. 5.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Adjustments
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
These vehicles use sealed front wheel bearings which require no lubrication or adjustment.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Remove or Disconnect
Tools Required:
J 28733-A Front Hub Spindle Remover J 24319-01 Universal Steering Linkage Puller J 28712 Axle
Shaft Boot Seal Protector J 36607 Ball Joint Separator
Raise the vehicle and support with safety stands. Unload the torsion bar.
1. Tire and wheel.
Note: Install J 28712 to the tripot axle joint (fig. 44).
2. Cotter pin (122). 3. Retainer (121). 4. Nut (120).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5364
Note: Insert a drift or large screwdriver through brake caliper into rotor vanes to prevent from
turning (fig. 45).
5. Washer (119). 6. Brake Caliper.
Note: Support the caliper with a piece of wire to prevent damage to the brake hose.
7. Rotor. 8. Bolts (116).
9. Hub and bearing assembly (114) from axle joint splined shaft using J 28733-A (fig. 46).
Note: Lay the hub and bearing assembly on the hub bolt (outboard) side. This will prevent damage
or contamination of the bearing seal (fig. 47).
10. Splash shield (118). 11. Cotter pin (123). 12. Nut (124).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5365
13. Tie rod end (125) from the knuckle (117) using J 24319-01 (fig. 48). 14. Cotter pins (130).
15. Ball joints (115 and 127) from the knuckle (117) using J 36607 (fig 49).
Note: Locate J 36607 on the ball joint and back off the nut (129, 131) until the ball stud is forced out
of the knuckle.
16. Nuts (129 and 131). 17. Knuckle (117) from the ball joints. 18. Spacer (128) from the knuckle
(117). 19. Seal (126) from the knuckle (117).
Install or Connect
1. New seal (126) to the knuckle (117) using J 28574 (fig. 50). 2. Spacer (128) to the knuckle (117).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5366
3. Knuckle (117) to the upper and lower ball joints (115 and 127). 4. Nuts (129 and 131). Tighten
Nuts (129) to 83 N.m (61 lbs. ft.). Tighten Nut (131) to 113 N.m (83 lbs. ft.).
Important: Tighten the nuts to align the cotter pin. Do not tighten more than 1/6 turn.
5. New cotter pins (130). Bend the pin ends against the nut flats. 6. Splash shield(118) aligned to
the knuckle (117). 7. Hub and bearing assembly (114) (fig. 43). Align the threaded holes. 8. Bolts
(116). Tighten Bolts (116) to 105 N.m (77 lbs. ft.). 9. Tie rod end (125) to the knuckle (117).
10. Nut (124). Tighten to 48 N.m (35 lbs. ft.). 11. New cotter pin. Bend the pin ends against the nut
flats. 12. Rotor (113). 13. Brake caliper. 14. Washer (119). 15. Nut (120). Tighten to 245 N.m (181
lbs. ft.).
Note: Insert a drift or large screwdriver through brake caliper into rotor vanes to prevent from
turning (fig. 45).
16. Retainer (121). 17. New cotter pin (122).
Note: Remove J 28712.
18. Tire and wheel.
A. Lower the vehicle. B. Apply the brake pedal. C. Check vehicle trim height and align the front
end.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5367
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REAR WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Fig. 3 Axle Shaft Bearing Removal
Fig. 4 Axle Shaft Bearing Installation
Fig. 5 Axle Shaft Seal Installation
1. Remove axle shaft as described under "Rear Axle Shaft, Replace." 2. Remove axle seal by
prying behind seal steel case with a pry bar. Use caution to avoid damaging axle housing. 3. Using
a puller and slide hammer, remove axle bearing, Fig. 3. 4. Lubricate new bearing with gear
lubricant, then install bearing in axle housing with axle shaft bearing installer tool No. J-23765, or
equivalent,
until bearing is seated in housing, Fig. 4.
5. Lubricate seal lips with gear lubricant, then position seal on axle shaft seal installer tool No.
J-23771, or equivalent, and install in axle housing,
tapping into place until seal is flush with axle housing, Fig. 5.
6. Install axle shaft.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 180
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Slip Yoke >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Slip Yoke/U-Joint - Replacement and Servicing
Slip Yoke: Technical Service Bulletins Slip Yoke/U-Joint - Replacement and Servicing
File In Section: 4 - Drive Axle
Bulletin No.: 46-41-01
Date: September, 1994
INFORMATION
Subject: Slip Yoke Replacement and U-Joint Servicing
Models: 1995 and Prior Light Duty Trucks
U-joints that are pressed out of the propeller shaft or slip yoke must not be re-used. When it is
necessary to press out the u-joint to replace a slip yoke, a new u-joint must be installed. A new
u-joint is necessary as the bearing cup seals and slingers are easily damaged. If these components
are damaged, dirt and water can contaminate the bearing causing early bearing wear-out.
Replacement of the rear u-joint is not required if the retaining straps holding the u-joint to the rear
axle pinion flange are removed.
Light duty trucks make use of three types of yokes:
1. Vented slip yoke. This yoke can be identified by a small hole in the center of the slip yoke welch
plug. This yoke uses grease for internal lubrication. The internal splines of the yoke should be
coated with a light covering of grease before installation to the output shaft. A small amount of
grease may be forced from the vent hole during operation. No attempts should be made to plug the
vent hole.
2. Non-vented slip yoke. This yoke has no vent hole and relies on transmission or transfer case
fluid for internal lubrication. Grease should not be used on the yoke internal splines as it may
contaminate the transmission or transfer case fluid.
3. Bolted or fixed yoke. This yoke does not slide so it needs no internal lubrication.
The transmission/transfer case output shaft seal should be inspected for damage before installing
the yoke. The seal lips should also be greased before yoke installation for longer seal life and
better performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Slip Yoke/U-Joint - Replacement and
Servicing
Universal Joint: Technical Service Bulletins Slip Yoke/U-Joint - Replacement and Servicing
File In Section: 4 - Drive Axle
Bulletin No.: 46-41-01
Date: September, 1994
INFORMATION
Subject: Slip Yoke Replacement and U-Joint Servicing
Models: 1995 and Prior Light Duty Trucks
U-joints that are pressed out of the propeller shaft or slip yoke must not be re-used. When it is
necessary to press out the u-joint to replace a slip yoke, a new u-joint must be installed. A new
u-joint is necessary as the bearing cup seals and slingers are easily damaged. If these components
are damaged, dirt and water can contaminate the bearing causing early bearing wear-out.
Replacement of the rear u-joint is not required if the retaining straps holding the u-joint to the rear
axle pinion flange are removed.
Light duty trucks make use of three types of yokes:
1. Vented slip yoke. This yoke can be identified by a small hole in the center of the slip yoke welch
plug. This yoke uses grease for internal lubrication. The internal splines of the yoke should be
coated with a light covering of grease before installation to the output shaft. A small amount of
grease may be forced from the vent hole during operation. No attempts should be made to plug the
vent hole.
2. Non-vented slip yoke. This yoke has no vent hole and relies on transmission or transfer case
fluid for internal lubrication. Grease should not be used on the yoke internal splines as it may
contaminate the transmission or transfer case fluid.
3. Bolted or fixed yoke. This yoke does not slide so it needs no internal lubrication.
The transmission/transfer case output shaft seal should be inspected for damage before installing
the yoke. The seal lips should also be greased before yoke installation for longer seal life and
better performance.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5381
Universal Joint: Description and Operation
The cross and roller type universal joint is a cross-shaped spider joint connecting two Y-shaped
yokes. When design angles of more than 3-4° are exceeded, joints wear faster than normal.
Original equipment joints are lubricated for life and cannot be lubricated on the vehicle. Never
clamp propeller shaft tubing in a vice. Always clamp one of the yokes and support shaft
horizontally.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Notes
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Service Notes
Before disassembling any universal joint, examine the assembly carefully and note the position of
the grease fitting (if used). Also, be sure to mark the yokes in relation to the propeller shaft for
assembly reference. Failure to observe these precautions may produce rough vehicle operation
resulting in rapid wear and parts failure, as well as placing an unbalanced load on transmission,
engine and rear axle.
When universal joints are disassembled for lubrication or inspection, and the old parts are to be
reinstalled, special care must be exercised to avoid damage to universal joint spider or cross and
bearing cups.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Notes > Page 5384
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Cross & Roller Type
Fig. 1 Production Type Universal Joints Which Use Nylon Injection Rings In Place Of Snap Rings
Fig. 2 Service Type Universal Joints (Internal Snap Ring Type)
Production universal joints cannot be reassembled because there are no bearing retainer grooves
in the production bearing caps, Figs. 2 and 3.
DISASSEMBLY
1. Mark shaft for assembly reference. 2. Support shaft in a horizontal line with universal joint
bearing separator tool No. J 9522-3, equivalent or suitable vice.
Fig. 4 External Snap Ring Universal Joint.
3. On models with external snap rings, remove snap rings, Fig. 4. If ring does not snap out of
groove, relieve pressure on ring by tapping lightly on
bearing cap.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Notes > Page 5385
4. On all models, place joint in tool No. J 9522-3 or equivalent with lower yoke ear supported by 1
1/8 inch socket, Fig. 5, then press out cap. If cap
is not completely removed, insert spacer tool No. J 9522-5 or equivalent and continue to press, Fig.
6. If using a vice in place of special tool, use 1 1/8 inch socket to receive one cap and 5/8 inch
socket to push opposite cap.
5. Rotate joint in tool or vice and press opposite cap out, then remove cross from yoke. 6. Inspect
and clean retaining ring grooves. 7. Check cap bores for burrs and imperfections.
ASSEMBLY
1. Use finger to coat needle bearings with thin layer of grease. Do not fill cups completely or use
excessive amounts. Over lubrication may damage
seals.
2. Put one bearing cap part way into one side of yoke, then insert cross into cap, Fig. 7. 3. Press
cross and cap into yoke until cap is flush with yoke ear.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Notes > Page 5386
4. Press opposite cap into yoke, ensuring trunnion alignment, Fig. 8. 5. Continue to press cap into
yoke ear while working cross to ensure free, unbinding movement until retainer groove clears
inside of yoke. If binding
occurs, stop pressing and check for misaligned bearings.
6. Snap retainers into place, Fig. 9. Yoke can be sprung slightly with firm hammer blow if retainer is
difficult to seat, Fig. 10.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
Instrument cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp Wiring I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 5396
C274 - 4WD Indicator
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 5397
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Preliminary Checks - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
1. Check condition of IGN/GAU Fuse. If fuse is Blown, locate and repair overload. Replace fuse. 2.
If fuse is not blown, proceed with the Diagnostics. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5400
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Indicator Assembly Illumination Lamp Does Not Light
One Or More Indicator Assembly Lamps Do Not Light
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Bell Housing: Specifications
Clutch Housing to Engine Bolts ...........................................................................................................
................................................................... 66 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Case: Specifications
Transmission to Engine Bolts ..............................................................................................................
.................................................................... 35 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Fluid Capacity ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 6.0 Pts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5412
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission
Manual .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ [01]
[01] New Venture Gear 3500; synchromesh transmission fluid, G.M. P/N 12345349 or equivalent.
Borg Warner T5; DEXRON IIE automatic transmission fluid, G.M. P/N 12345881 or equivalent.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T >
Component Information > Adjustments > 4-Speed Transmissions
Shift Linkage: Adjustments 4-Speed Transmissions
The shift mechanism does not require adjustment and may be serviced independently of the
transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T >
Component Information > Adjustments > 4-Speed Transmissions > Page 5417
Shift Linkage: Adjustments 5-Speed Transmissions
The shift mechanism does not require adjustment and may be serviced independently of the
transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Mounted on the back of the Electronic Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 5423
C202A - Transfer Case Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting
Control Module: Description and Operation Electric 4WD Shifting
Transfer Case 4WD Selector Switch
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
On vehicles equipped with the Model 233 transfer case, there is no transfer case selector lever in
the cab. The operator selects 4HI or 4LO by pushing a three-position (4HI, 4LO, 2HI) rocker-type
selector switch mounted on the instrument panel. During normal driving the transfer case is in the
2HI mode. The switch is spring-loaded to the center position. When the transfer case is in 2HI both
the 4HI and 4L0 switch circuits are open, and both lights are off. When shifting to 4HI or 4LO the
rocker switch will still return to the center position and the 4HI or 4LO light will be on. The above
image shows the wiring schematic of the transfer case selector switch.
Mode Shifts Mode shifts are shifts from:
- 2HI to 4HI
- 4HI to 2HI
A mode shift can be accomplished in any gear position and at any vehicle speed. If the system is in
2HI, the operator can shift into 4HI merely by pressing and releasing the 4HI area of the selector
rocker switch. The green 4HI status lamp flashes whenever a 2HI or 4HI shift is initiated and
continues to flash until the TCCM completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). After the shift
into 4HI is accomplished, the 4HI status lamp remains lit to indicate that the system is in 4HI. The
operator can shift from 4HI back to 2HI by again pressing 4HI on the selector switch. Again, the
green 4HI status lamp flashes until the shift to 2HI is complete, and then extinguishes once the shift
is complete. Both the 4HI and 4LO lamps remain oft when the vehicle is in 2HI.
Range Shifts Range shifts are shifts between the HI and LO ranges, from:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5426
- 2HI to 4LO
- 4HI to 4LO
- 4LO to 4HI
A range shift from 4L0 directly to 2HI cannot be made. The operator must first make range shift
from 4LO to 4HI, then a mode shift from 4HI to 2HI. A range shift can only be made with the
automatic transmission in neutral or with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed. The
vehicle speed must also be below three miles per hour before the shift can occur. Whenever a shift
into 4LO is initiated, the amber 4LO status lamp flashes and continues to flash until the TCCM
completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). The 4LO status lamp must glow steadily before
the vehicle transmission is shifted into gear or before the clutch pedal is released. If a range shift is
initiated when the transmission is engaged or when the vehicle speed is above 3 mph, the 4LO
status lamp flashes for 30 seconds and no range shift actually occurs; the system returns to the
position before the shift was initiated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5427
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Power and Ground
Fig. 1, Memory Power, System Power, And Ground Circuit
Fig. 2, Fuse Block And Cavity Location
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5428
POWER, CIRCUIT PROTECTION, AND GROUND
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) memory power, system power, and the ground circuit
are shown in Figure 1. The vehicle fuse block and cavity location for memory power, system power,
and motor power are shown in Figure 2.
Memory Power Trouble code memory power is protected by a 5-amp TCCM fuse. Memory power
is supplied to TCCM connector pin C6 through circuit 140.
System Power Operating power is controlled by the ignition switch and is protected by a 15-amp
radio fuse. System power is supplied to TCCM connector pin C8 through circuit 141. This fuse also
supplies, voltage to pin B of the transfer case switch. The system power will shut down if either the
5-amp TCCM fuse or the 15-amp radio fuse are removed or blown.
System Ground System ground is supplied to TCCM connector pin C10 through circuit 150. Circuit
150 is connected to the bus bar ground located on the left side of the steering column support.
Refer to Figure 1.
Turn/BU Fuse A 15-amp TURN/BU fuse supplies ignition voltage to the park/neutral position
switch. This voltage enables the park switch to send a park signal to TCCM connector pin D2.
Power Accessory Circuit Breaker The 30-amp power accessory circuit breaker supplies ignition
voltage to TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This voltage is used to control the electric-shift
motor circuit.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5429
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Inputs and Outputs
General Description
INPUTS
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) receives input signals from the following sources:
- Transfer case selector switch on the instrument panel.
- Park/neutral position switch on vehicles with automatic transmissions.
- Clutch safety switch on vehicles with manual transmissions.
- Vehicle speed sensor buffer which supplies vehicle speed signals.
- Encoder switch within the electric-shift motor which provides actual mode and range information
signals.
- Data link connector (DLC) pin J which provides diagnostic enable.
OUTPUTS
After processing the input information, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) outputs signals
to the following:
- Electric shift motor to effect mode and range shifts.
- Selector switch status lamps to provide transfer case status information.
- Diagnostic trouble codes (DTC) which are output via the selector switch status lamps.
2HI to 4HI Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the transfer case is in 2HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the
4HI contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564, and furnishing 12-volts
to pin C5 of the TCCM connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5 commands the Transfer Case
Control Module (TCCM) to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. The contacts return to the
open position as soon as the switch is released.
4HI to 2HI Selector Switch Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5430
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
If the transfer case is in 4HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the 4HI
contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564 and furnishing 12-volts to
pin C5 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5
commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. Again, the contacts return to
the open position as soon as the switch is released.
2HI to 4HI to 4LO Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the operator presses the 4LO area of the rocker switch while the transfer case is in either
2HI or 4HI, the 4LO contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1559, and
furnishing 12-volts to pin C3 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt
signal at pin C3 commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift the transfer case into
4LO. Once more, the contacts return to the open position as soon as the switch is released.
Park/Neutral Position Switch Inputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5431
Automatic Transmission Neutral Start Switch
Neutral Start Switch Voltages
OPERATION
Because range shift should only be made with the automatic transmission in neutral, the
park/neutral position switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle
automatic transmission is in either:
- Park
- Neutral
- One of the drive positions
The park/neutral position switch consists of three switches together in one unit, and it provides
three signals:
- Park - When the automatic transmission is in park, the contacts of both the park switch and the
park neutral switch are closed. When these contacts are closed, a battery voltage signal is sent to
TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 voltage). The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in park.
- Neutral - When the automatic transmission is in neutral, the contacts of the park switch are open
and the contacts of the park neutral position switch are closed. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal
is sent to TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 volts). The
TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in neutral.
- In gear - When the automatic transmission is in any other gear position, the contacts of both the
park switch and park neutral switch are open. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal is sent to TCCM
connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is neither
park or neutral.
Important
- If the backup switch connector were to be plugged in upside down, the park switch would receive
no power. Such a condition would cause a 0-voltage signal at both pin D2 and pin D16 in neutral
and in park. The transfer case, accordingly, would perform a range shift in park as well as in
neutral.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5432
- An open in circuit 75, or an open in the Turn/BU fuse would also cause this condition.
- Additionally, a park/neutral position switch that is out of adjustment may prevent a range shift in
park.
Clutch Safety Switch Inputs
Clutch Safety Switch Schematic
Clutch Safety Switch Voltage Signals
OPERATION
Because range shifts should only be made with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed, the
clutch safety switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle clutch
pedal is fully depressed or released. The clutch safety switch is connected to TCCM connector pin
D16. When the clutch pedal is released, the contacts of the clutch safety switch are open. When
these contacts are open, a battery voltage signal is seen at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the clutch is released. When the clutch is fully depressed, the
contacts of the clutch safety switch are closed. When the contacts are closed, voltage is pulled low
to 0 at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the clutch pedal is fully
depressed. Because TCCM connector pin D2 is not connected when the vehicle is equipped with a
manual transmission, the TCCM reads a 0-volt signal at pin D2 at all times. All readings are taken
while back-probing the TCCM pins with the ignition in the "Run" position. A reading of less than 0.5
volt is considered to be zero.
Vehicle Speed Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5433
Vehicle Sensor Buffer And TCCM Schematic
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor buffer informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) about the
speed of the vehicle in miles per hour. Such information is essential to inform the TCCM to prohibit
range shifts at speeds above 3 mph. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) is a variable-reluctance
magnetic sensing device that converts tone wheel rotation into a frequency and voltage output
proportional to the vehicle speed. The frequency and voltage signal is sent to the vehicle speed
sensor buffer which converts the speed sensor output into a useful pulse signal. The vehicle speed
sensor buffer then, pulses circuit 1567 to ground at a rate of 4000 pulses per mile. Whenever the
vehicle speed sensor buffer grounds circuit 1567, the voltage at TCCM connector pin D8 returns to
5 volts. The TCCM reads the 4000 pulses-per-mile (1.11 Hz per mph) signal to determine vehicle
speed.
Encoder Switch Inputs
Fig 1, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Layout
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5434
Fig 2, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Schematic
Fig 3, Encoder Switch Channel Signals And Positions
OPERATION
The four-channel encoder switch indicates the current transfer case mode and range to the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM). The encoder switch is located inside the encoder itself and
is not serviceable. The TCCM reads the status of the four channels to determine the range and
mode in which the transfer case is operating or whether the transfer case is shifting between
modes and/or ranges. The encoder assembly is composed of an inner ground ring in contact with a
three-leg wiper arm. The three legs of the wiper, spaced 120 degrees apart, make contact with the
conductive areas of the four channels. When any leg of the wiper arm is in contact with the
conductive area of any channel, a path to ground is provided to the inner ground ring. A schematic
of the encoder switch is shown in Figure 2. The channel signals in various transfer case operating
modes and ranges are shown in Figure 3. Any combination of signals not listed in Figure 3 are
considered invalid by the TCCM.
Encoder Switch Channel Positions These voltage readings can be obtained by back-probing either
the TCCM connector pins or the transfer case connector pins. For TCCM pin numbers and encoder
channels, refer to Figure 2.
Diagnostic Enable Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5435
Wiring Schematic For Enabling The Status Lamps
OPERATION
When pin J of the Data Link Connector (DLC) is connected either to pin A of the DLC or to a good
ground while the ignition is on, the diagnostics routine of the Transfer Case Control Module
(TCCM) is activated. When the diagnostics routine is activated, the transfer case selector switch
4HI and 4LO status lamps flash the diagnostic codes.
Electric Shift Motor Outputs
Electric Shift Motor Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) provides the output for the electric shift motor as the
schematic shows.
- Motor control is achieved by energizing one of the two motor control relays located in the TCCM,
by way of the transfer case selector switch.
The TCCM operates the motor in one direction by energizing one relay while the second relay is
de-energized. The TCCM operates the motor in the reverse direction by energizing the second
relay while the first relay is de-energized.
- Motor power to actuate the motor drive relays is input at TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This
power is supplied by the ignition through the 30-amp power circuit breaker.
- Motor ground is input at TCCM connector pins D12 and D13 to provide the return line for the
motor drive relays.
4HI and 4LO Status Lamps Outputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5436
Selector Switch Status Lamp Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) controls the operation of the 4HI and 4LO status lamps
in the transfer case selector switch. The status lamps also show the transfer case mode and range
of operation. The status lamps also provide a self-test when the ignition is first turned on.
Additionally, the status lamps are used to alert the driver that there is a problem somewhere in the
four-wheel drive system, and also to flash diagnostic trouble codes (DTC's).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 5437
Control Module: Service and Repair
TRANSFER CASE MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. ECM (utility only). 3. Cowl side panel (pickup only). 4. Electrical
connection. 5. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 6. Module.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Module. 2. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 3. Electrical connection. 4. ECM (utility
only). 5. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch >
Page 5444
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5445
C217 - Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Plugs (1/8 - 27) .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Pressure Plugs (1/4 - 18) ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 18 Pressure Switches ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs. Vehicle Speed Sensor Retainer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
The Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor is used by the control module to control: Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) apply and release schedule.
- Hot mode determination.
- Shift quality.
OPERATION
The TFT is a thermistor used to indicate transmission fluid temperature. The control module sends
a 5.0 volt signal to the TFT through a resistor in the computer and measures the voltage. High
sensor resistance produces high signal input voltage which corresponds to low fluid temperature.
Low sensor resistance produces low signal input voltage which corresponds to high fluid
temperature. With the TFT varying its resistance, the control module can sense transmission fluid
temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION
The sensor is part of the transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly and is attached to the
control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Pickup
Transfer Case Select Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Pickup
> Page 5463
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
5464
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 4 Selector Switch Installation. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove console, then disconnect console wiring harness.
3. Remove shifter boot retaining screws and slide boot up shift lever.
4. Remove switch attaching screw, then the switch and harness, Fig. 2.
5. Position new switch on mounting bracket and install attaching screw.Ensure shift lever assembly
pawl is on the switch contact carrier.
6. Route wiring as shown in Fig. 4.
7. Place shifter boot in proper position, then install retaining screws.
8. Connect console wiring harness, then install console.
9. Connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 5469
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 5470
4WD Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn.
Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor
Conn.
Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001
Date: May 17, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed
Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab
9-7X
with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive
Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is
removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer
case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the
plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past,
the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair
procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This
connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time.
A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This
new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
The Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch (Encoder Switch) is located in the in the shift
motor on the transfer case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch > Page 5481
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 5482
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 5483
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair
ELECTRIC SHIFT MOTOR REPLACEMENT
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle and support with safety stands.
2. Transfer case shield. 3. Motor electrical connection. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Front output shaft
yoke. 6. Motor to transfer case bolts. 7. Motor from the transfer case.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Motor to the transfer case. 2. Bolts.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 18 Nm (13 lbs. ft.).
3. Front output shaft yoke. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Motor electrical connection. 6. Transfer case
shield. 7. Negative battery cable.
- Lower Vehicle
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Mounted on the back of the Electronic Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5487
C202A - Transfer Case Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting
Control Module: Description and Operation Electric 4WD Shifting
Transfer Case 4WD Selector Switch
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
On vehicles equipped with the Model 233 transfer case, there is no transfer case selector lever in
the cab. The operator selects 4HI or 4LO by pushing a three-position (4HI, 4LO, 2HI) rocker-type
selector switch mounted on the instrument panel. During normal driving the transfer case is in the
2HI mode. The switch is spring-loaded to the center position. When the transfer case is in 2HI both
the 4HI and 4L0 switch circuits are open, and both lights are off. When shifting to 4HI or 4LO the
rocker switch will still return to the center position and the 4HI or 4LO light will be on. The above
image shows the wiring schematic of the transfer case selector switch.
Mode Shifts Mode shifts are shifts from:
- 2HI to 4HI
- 4HI to 2HI
A mode shift can be accomplished in any gear position and at any vehicle speed. If the system is in
2HI, the operator can shift into 4HI merely by pressing and releasing the 4HI area of the selector
rocker switch. The green 4HI status lamp flashes whenever a 2HI or 4HI shift is initiated and
continues to flash until the TCCM completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). After the shift
into 4HI is accomplished, the 4HI status lamp remains lit to indicate that the system is in 4HI. The
operator can shift from 4HI back to 2HI by again pressing 4HI on the selector switch. Again, the
green 4HI status lamp flashes until the shift to 2HI is complete, and then extinguishes once the shift
is complete. Both the 4HI and 4LO lamps remain oft when the vehicle is in 2HI.
Range Shifts Range shifts are shifts between the HI and LO ranges, from:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5490
- 2HI to 4LO
- 4HI to 4LO
- 4LO to 4HI
A range shift from 4L0 directly to 2HI cannot be made. The operator must first make range shift
from 4LO to 4HI, then a mode shift from 4HI to 2HI. A range shift can only be made with the
automatic transmission in neutral or with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed. The
vehicle speed must also be below three miles per hour before the shift can occur. Whenever a shift
into 4LO is initiated, the amber 4LO status lamp flashes and continues to flash until the TCCM
completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). The 4LO status lamp must glow steadily before
the vehicle transmission is shifted into gear or before the clutch pedal is released. If a range shift is
initiated when the transmission is engaged or when the vehicle speed is above 3 mph, the 4LO
status lamp flashes for 30 seconds and no range shift actually occurs; the system returns to the
position before the shift was initiated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5491
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Power and Ground
Fig. 1, Memory Power, System Power, And Ground Circuit
Fig. 2, Fuse Block And Cavity Location
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5492
POWER, CIRCUIT PROTECTION, AND GROUND
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) memory power, system power, and the ground circuit
are shown in Figure 1. The vehicle fuse block and cavity location for memory power, system power,
and motor power are shown in Figure 2.
Memory Power Trouble code memory power is protected by a 5-amp TCCM fuse. Memory power
is supplied to TCCM connector pin C6 through circuit 140.
System Power Operating power is controlled by the ignition switch and is protected by a 15-amp
radio fuse. System power is supplied to TCCM connector pin C8 through circuit 141. This fuse also
supplies, voltage to pin B of the transfer case switch. The system power will shut down if either the
5-amp TCCM fuse or the 15-amp radio fuse are removed or blown.
System Ground System ground is supplied to TCCM connector pin C10 through circuit 150. Circuit
150 is connected to the bus bar ground located on the left side of the steering column support.
Refer to Figure 1.
Turn/BU Fuse A 15-amp TURN/BU fuse supplies ignition voltage to the park/neutral position
switch. This voltage enables the park switch to send a park signal to TCCM connector pin D2.
Power Accessory Circuit Breaker The 30-amp power accessory circuit breaker supplies ignition
voltage to TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This voltage is used to control the electric-shift
motor circuit.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5493
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Inputs and Outputs
General Description
INPUTS
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) receives input signals from the following sources:
- Transfer case selector switch on the instrument panel.
- Park/neutral position switch on vehicles with automatic transmissions.
- Clutch safety switch on vehicles with manual transmissions.
- Vehicle speed sensor buffer which supplies vehicle speed signals.
- Encoder switch within the electric-shift motor which provides actual mode and range information
signals.
- Data link connector (DLC) pin J which provides diagnostic enable.
OUTPUTS
After processing the input information, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) outputs signals
to the following:
- Electric shift motor to effect mode and range shifts.
- Selector switch status lamps to provide transfer case status information.
- Diagnostic trouble codes (DTC) which are output via the selector switch status lamps.
2HI to 4HI Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the transfer case is in 2HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the
4HI contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564, and furnishing 12-volts
to pin C5 of the TCCM connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5 commands the Transfer Case
Control Module (TCCM) to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. The contacts return to the
open position as soon as the switch is released.
4HI to 2HI Selector Switch Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5494
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
If the transfer case is in 4HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the 4HI
contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564 and furnishing 12-volts to
pin C5 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5
commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. Again, the contacts return to
the open position as soon as the switch is released.
2HI to 4HI to 4LO Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the operator presses the 4LO area of the rocker switch while the transfer case is in either
2HI or 4HI, the 4LO contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1559, and
furnishing 12-volts to pin C3 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt
signal at pin C3 commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift the transfer case into
4LO. Once more, the contacts return to the open position as soon as the switch is released.
Park/Neutral Position Switch Inputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5495
Automatic Transmission Neutral Start Switch
Neutral Start Switch Voltages
OPERATION
Because range shift should only be made with the automatic transmission in neutral, the
park/neutral position switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle
automatic transmission is in either:
- Park
- Neutral
- One of the drive positions
The park/neutral position switch consists of three switches together in one unit, and it provides
three signals:
- Park - When the automatic transmission is in park, the contacts of both the park switch and the
park neutral switch are closed. When these contacts are closed, a battery voltage signal is sent to
TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 voltage). The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in park.
- Neutral - When the automatic transmission is in neutral, the contacts of the park switch are open
and the contacts of the park neutral position switch are closed. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal
is sent to TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 volts). The
TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in neutral.
- In gear - When the automatic transmission is in any other gear position, the contacts of both the
park switch and park neutral switch are open. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal is sent to TCCM
connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is neither
park or neutral.
Important
- If the backup switch connector were to be plugged in upside down, the park switch would receive
no power. Such a condition would cause a 0-voltage signal at both pin D2 and pin D16 in neutral
and in park. The transfer case, accordingly, would perform a range shift in park as well as in
neutral.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5496
- An open in circuit 75, or an open in the Turn/BU fuse would also cause this condition.
- Additionally, a park/neutral position switch that is out of adjustment may prevent a range shift in
park.
Clutch Safety Switch Inputs
Clutch Safety Switch Schematic
Clutch Safety Switch Voltage Signals
OPERATION
Because range shifts should only be made with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed, the
clutch safety switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle clutch
pedal is fully depressed or released. The clutch safety switch is connected to TCCM connector pin
D16. When the clutch pedal is released, the contacts of the clutch safety switch are open. When
these contacts are open, a battery voltage signal is seen at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the clutch is released. When the clutch is fully depressed, the
contacts of the clutch safety switch are closed. When the contacts are closed, voltage is pulled low
to 0 at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the clutch pedal is fully
depressed. Because TCCM connector pin D2 is not connected when the vehicle is equipped with a
manual transmission, the TCCM reads a 0-volt signal at pin D2 at all times. All readings are taken
while back-probing the TCCM pins with the ignition in the "Run" position. A reading of less than 0.5
volt is considered to be zero.
Vehicle Speed Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5497
Vehicle Sensor Buffer And TCCM Schematic
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor buffer informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) about the
speed of the vehicle in miles per hour. Such information is essential to inform the TCCM to prohibit
range shifts at speeds above 3 mph. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) is a variable-reluctance
magnetic sensing device that converts tone wheel rotation into a frequency and voltage output
proportional to the vehicle speed. The frequency and voltage signal is sent to the vehicle speed
sensor buffer which converts the speed sensor output into a useful pulse signal. The vehicle speed
sensor buffer then, pulses circuit 1567 to ground at a rate of 4000 pulses per mile. Whenever the
vehicle speed sensor buffer grounds circuit 1567, the voltage at TCCM connector pin D8 returns to
5 volts. The TCCM reads the 4000 pulses-per-mile (1.11 Hz per mph) signal to determine vehicle
speed.
Encoder Switch Inputs
Fig 1, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Layout
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5498
Fig 2, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Schematic
Fig 3, Encoder Switch Channel Signals And Positions
OPERATION
The four-channel encoder switch indicates the current transfer case mode and range to the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM). The encoder switch is located inside the encoder itself and
is not serviceable. The TCCM reads the status of the four channels to determine the range and
mode in which the transfer case is operating or whether the transfer case is shifting between
modes and/or ranges. The encoder assembly is composed of an inner ground ring in contact with a
three-leg wiper arm. The three legs of the wiper, spaced 120 degrees apart, make contact with the
conductive areas of the four channels. When any leg of the wiper arm is in contact with the
conductive area of any channel, a path to ground is provided to the inner ground ring. A schematic
of the encoder switch is shown in Figure 2. The channel signals in various transfer case operating
modes and ranges are shown in Figure 3. Any combination of signals not listed in Figure 3 are
considered invalid by the TCCM.
Encoder Switch Channel Positions These voltage readings can be obtained by back-probing either
the TCCM connector pins or the transfer case connector pins. For TCCM pin numbers and encoder
channels, refer to Figure 2.
Diagnostic Enable Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5499
Wiring Schematic For Enabling The Status Lamps
OPERATION
When pin J of the Data Link Connector (DLC) is connected either to pin A of the DLC or to a good
ground while the ignition is on, the diagnostics routine of the Transfer Case Control Module
(TCCM) is activated. When the diagnostics routine is activated, the transfer case selector switch
4HI and 4LO status lamps flash the diagnostic codes.
Electric Shift Motor Outputs
Electric Shift Motor Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) provides the output for the electric shift motor as the
schematic shows.
- Motor control is achieved by energizing one of the two motor control relays located in the TCCM,
by way of the transfer case selector switch.
The TCCM operates the motor in one direction by energizing one relay while the second relay is
de-energized. The TCCM operates the motor in the reverse direction by energizing the second
relay while the first relay is de-energized.
- Motor power to actuate the motor drive relays is input at TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This
power is supplied by the ignition through the 30-amp power circuit breaker.
- Motor ground is input at TCCM connector pins D12 and D13 to provide the return line for the
motor drive relays.
4HI and 4LO Status Lamps Outputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5500
Selector Switch Status Lamp Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) controls the operation of the 4HI and 4LO status lamps
in the transfer case selector switch. The status lamps also show the transfer case mode and range
of operation. The status lamps also provide a self-test when the ignition is first turned on.
Additionally, the status lamps are used to alert the driver that there is a problem somewhere in the
four-wheel drive system, and also to flash diagnostic trouble codes (DTC's).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5501
Control Module: Service and Repair
TRANSFER CASE MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. ECM (utility only). 3. Cowl side panel (pickup only). 4. Electrical
connection. 5. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 6. Module.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Module. 2. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 3. Electrical connection. 4. ECM (utility
only). 5. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Fluid Capacity ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 2.5 Pts.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5506
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
Lubricant Type .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... Dexron II E ATF *
* 1996 Models, Dexron III ATF
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Locations
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp Wiring I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5510
C274 - 4WD Indicator
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5511
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Preliminary Checks - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
1. Check condition of IGN/GAU Fuse. If fuse is Blown, locate and repair overload. Replace fuse. 2.
If fuse is not blown, proceed with the Diagnostics. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5514
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Indicator Assembly Illumination Lamp Does Not Light
One Or More Indicator Assembly Lamps Do Not Light
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Pickup
Transfer Case Select Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Pickup > Page 5519
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5520
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 4 Selector Switch Installation. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove console, then disconnect console wiring harness.
3. Remove shifter boot retaining screws and slide boot up shift lever.
4. Remove switch attaching screw, then the switch and harness, Fig. 2.
5. Position new switch on mounting bracket and install attaching screw.Ensure shift lever assembly
pawl is on the switch contact carrier.
6. Route wiring as shown in Fig. 4.
7. Place shifter boot in proper position, then install retaining screws.
8. Connect console wiring harness, then install console.
9. Connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 5525
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 5526
4WD Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp Wiring I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 5531
C274 - 4WD Indicator
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 5532
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Preliminary Checks - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
1. Check condition of IGN/GAU Fuse. If fuse is Blown, locate and repair overload. Replace fuse. 2.
If fuse is not blown, proceed with the Diagnostics. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview > Page 5535
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Indicator Assembly Illumination Lamp Does Not Light
One Or More Indicator Assembly Lamps Do Not Light
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Mounted on the back of the Electronic Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 5540
C202A - Transfer Case Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting
Control Module: Description and Operation Electric 4WD Shifting
Transfer Case 4WD Selector Switch
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
On vehicles equipped with the Model 233 transfer case, there is no transfer case selector lever in
the cab. The operator selects 4HI or 4LO by pushing a three-position (4HI, 4LO, 2HI) rocker-type
selector switch mounted on the instrument panel. During normal driving the transfer case is in the
2HI mode. The switch is spring-loaded to the center position. When the transfer case is in 2HI both
the 4HI and 4L0 switch circuits are open, and both lights are off. When shifting to 4HI or 4LO the
rocker switch will still return to the center position and the 4HI or 4LO light will be on. The above
image shows the wiring schematic of the transfer case selector switch.
Mode Shifts Mode shifts are shifts from:
- 2HI to 4HI
- 4HI to 2HI
A mode shift can be accomplished in any gear position and at any vehicle speed. If the system is in
2HI, the operator can shift into 4HI merely by pressing and releasing the 4HI area of the selector
rocker switch. The green 4HI status lamp flashes whenever a 2HI or 4HI shift is initiated and
continues to flash until the TCCM completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). After the shift
into 4HI is accomplished, the 4HI status lamp remains lit to indicate that the system is in 4HI. The
operator can shift from 4HI back to 2HI by again pressing 4HI on the selector switch. Again, the
green 4HI status lamp flashes until the shift to 2HI is complete, and then extinguishes once the shift
is complete. Both the 4HI and 4LO lamps remain oft when the vehicle is in 2HI.
Range Shifts Range shifts are shifts between the HI and LO ranges, from:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5543
- 2HI to 4LO
- 4HI to 4LO
- 4LO to 4HI
A range shift from 4L0 directly to 2HI cannot be made. The operator must first make range shift
from 4LO to 4HI, then a mode shift from 4HI to 2HI. A range shift can only be made with the
automatic transmission in neutral or with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed. The
vehicle speed must also be below three miles per hour before the shift can occur. Whenever a shift
into 4LO is initiated, the amber 4LO status lamp flashes and continues to flash until the TCCM
completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). The 4LO status lamp must glow steadily before
the vehicle transmission is shifted into gear or before the clutch pedal is released. If a range shift is
initiated when the transmission is engaged or when the vehicle speed is above 3 mph, the 4LO
status lamp flashes for 30 seconds and no range shift actually occurs; the system returns to the
position before the shift was initiated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5544
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Power and Ground
Fig. 1, Memory Power, System Power, And Ground Circuit
Fig. 2, Fuse Block And Cavity Location
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5545
POWER, CIRCUIT PROTECTION, AND GROUND
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) memory power, system power, and the ground circuit
are shown in Figure 1. The vehicle fuse block and cavity location for memory power, system power,
and motor power are shown in Figure 2.
Memory Power Trouble code memory power is protected by a 5-amp TCCM fuse. Memory power
is supplied to TCCM connector pin C6 through circuit 140.
System Power Operating power is controlled by the ignition switch and is protected by a 15-amp
radio fuse. System power is supplied to TCCM connector pin C8 through circuit 141. This fuse also
supplies, voltage to pin B of the transfer case switch. The system power will shut down if either the
5-amp TCCM fuse or the 15-amp radio fuse are removed or blown.
System Ground System ground is supplied to TCCM connector pin C10 through circuit 150. Circuit
150 is connected to the bus bar ground located on the left side of the steering column support.
Refer to Figure 1.
Turn/BU Fuse A 15-amp TURN/BU fuse supplies ignition voltage to the park/neutral position
switch. This voltage enables the park switch to send a park signal to TCCM connector pin D2.
Power Accessory Circuit Breaker The 30-amp power accessory circuit breaker supplies ignition
voltage to TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This voltage is used to control the electric-shift
motor circuit.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5546
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Inputs and Outputs
General Description
INPUTS
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) receives input signals from the following sources:
- Transfer case selector switch on the instrument panel.
- Park/neutral position switch on vehicles with automatic transmissions.
- Clutch safety switch on vehicles with manual transmissions.
- Vehicle speed sensor buffer which supplies vehicle speed signals.
- Encoder switch within the electric-shift motor which provides actual mode and range information
signals.
- Data link connector (DLC) pin J which provides diagnostic enable.
OUTPUTS
After processing the input information, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) outputs signals
to the following:
- Electric shift motor to effect mode and range shifts.
- Selector switch status lamps to provide transfer case status information.
- Diagnostic trouble codes (DTC) which are output via the selector switch status lamps.
2HI to 4HI Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the transfer case is in 2HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the
4HI contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564, and furnishing 12-volts
to pin C5 of the TCCM connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5 commands the Transfer Case
Control Module (TCCM) to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. The contacts return to the
open position as soon as the switch is released.
4HI to 2HI Selector Switch Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5547
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
If the transfer case is in 4HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the 4HI
contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564 and furnishing 12-volts to
pin C5 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5
commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. Again, the contacts return to
the open position as soon as the switch is released.
2HI to 4HI to 4LO Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the operator presses the 4LO area of the rocker switch while the transfer case is in either
2HI or 4HI, the 4LO contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1559, and
furnishing 12-volts to pin C3 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt
signal at pin C3 commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift the transfer case into
4LO. Once more, the contacts return to the open position as soon as the switch is released.
Park/Neutral Position Switch Inputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5548
Automatic Transmission Neutral Start Switch
Neutral Start Switch Voltages
OPERATION
Because range shift should only be made with the automatic transmission in neutral, the
park/neutral position switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle
automatic transmission is in either:
- Park
- Neutral
- One of the drive positions
The park/neutral position switch consists of three switches together in one unit, and it provides
three signals:
- Park - When the automatic transmission is in park, the contacts of both the park switch and the
park neutral switch are closed. When these contacts are closed, a battery voltage signal is sent to
TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 voltage). The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in park.
- Neutral - When the automatic transmission is in neutral, the contacts of the park switch are open
and the contacts of the park neutral position switch are closed. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal
is sent to TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 volts). The
TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in neutral.
- In gear - When the automatic transmission is in any other gear position, the contacts of both the
park switch and park neutral switch are open. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal is sent to TCCM
connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is neither
park or neutral.
Important
- If the backup switch connector were to be plugged in upside down, the park switch would receive
no power. Such a condition would cause a 0-voltage signal at both pin D2 and pin D16 in neutral
and in park. The transfer case, accordingly, would perform a range shift in park as well as in
neutral.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5549
- An open in circuit 75, or an open in the Turn/BU fuse would also cause this condition.
- Additionally, a park/neutral position switch that is out of adjustment may prevent a range shift in
park.
Clutch Safety Switch Inputs
Clutch Safety Switch Schematic
Clutch Safety Switch Voltage Signals
OPERATION
Because range shifts should only be made with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed, the
clutch safety switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle clutch
pedal is fully depressed or released. The clutch safety switch is connected to TCCM connector pin
D16. When the clutch pedal is released, the contacts of the clutch safety switch are open. When
these contacts are open, a battery voltage signal is seen at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the clutch is released. When the clutch is fully depressed, the
contacts of the clutch safety switch are closed. When the contacts are closed, voltage is pulled low
to 0 at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the clutch pedal is fully
depressed. Because TCCM connector pin D2 is not connected when the vehicle is equipped with a
manual transmission, the TCCM reads a 0-volt signal at pin D2 at all times. All readings are taken
while back-probing the TCCM pins with the ignition in the "Run" position. A reading of less than 0.5
volt is considered to be zero.
Vehicle Speed Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5550
Vehicle Sensor Buffer And TCCM Schematic
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor buffer informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) about the
speed of the vehicle in miles per hour. Such information is essential to inform the TCCM to prohibit
range shifts at speeds above 3 mph. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) is a variable-reluctance
magnetic sensing device that converts tone wheel rotation into a frequency and voltage output
proportional to the vehicle speed. The frequency and voltage signal is sent to the vehicle speed
sensor buffer which converts the speed sensor output into a useful pulse signal. The vehicle speed
sensor buffer then, pulses circuit 1567 to ground at a rate of 4000 pulses per mile. Whenever the
vehicle speed sensor buffer grounds circuit 1567, the voltage at TCCM connector pin D8 returns to
5 volts. The TCCM reads the 4000 pulses-per-mile (1.11 Hz per mph) signal to determine vehicle
speed.
Encoder Switch Inputs
Fig 1, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Layout
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5551
Fig 2, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Schematic
Fig 3, Encoder Switch Channel Signals And Positions
OPERATION
The four-channel encoder switch indicates the current transfer case mode and range to the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM). The encoder switch is located inside the encoder itself and
is not serviceable. The TCCM reads the status of the four channels to determine the range and
mode in which the transfer case is operating or whether the transfer case is shifting between
modes and/or ranges. The encoder assembly is composed of an inner ground ring in contact with a
three-leg wiper arm. The three legs of the wiper, spaced 120 degrees apart, make contact with the
conductive areas of the four channels. When any leg of the wiper arm is in contact with the
conductive area of any channel, a path to ground is provided to the inner ground ring. A schematic
of the encoder switch is shown in Figure 2. The channel signals in various transfer case operating
modes and ranges are shown in Figure 3. Any combination of signals not listed in Figure 3 are
considered invalid by the TCCM.
Encoder Switch Channel Positions These voltage readings can be obtained by back-probing either
the TCCM connector pins or the transfer case connector pins. For TCCM pin numbers and encoder
channels, refer to Figure 2.
Diagnostic Enable Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5552
Wiring Schematic For Enabling The Status Lamps
OPERATION
When pin J of the Data Link Connector (DLC) is connected either to pin A of the DLC or to a good
ground while the ignition is on, the diagnostics routine of the Transfer Case Control Module
(TCCM) is activated. When the diagnostics routine is activated, the transfer case selector switch
4HI and 4LO status lamps flash the diagnostic codes.
Electric Shift Motor Outputs
Electric Shift Motor Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) provides the output for the electric shift motor as the
schematic shows.
- Motor control is achieved by energizing one of the two motor control relays located in the TCCM,
by way of the transfer case selector switch.
The TCCM operates the motor in one direction by energizing one relay while the second relay is
de-energized. The TCCM operates the motor in the reverse direction by energizing the second
relay while the first relay is de-energized.
- Motor power to actuate the motor drive relays is input at TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This
power is supplied by the ignition through the 30-amp power circuit breaker.
- Motor ground is input at TCCM connector pins D12 and D13 to provide the return line for the
motor drive relays.
4HI and 4LO Status Lamps Outputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5553
Selector Switch Status Lamp Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) controls the operation of the 4HI and 4LO status lamps
in the transfer case selector switch. The status lamps also show the transfer case mode and range
of operation. The status lamps also provide a self-test when the ignition is first turned on.
Additionally, the status lamps are used to alert the driver that there is a problem somewhere in the
four-wheel drive system, and also to flash diagnostic trouble codes (DTC's).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case >
Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5554
Control Module: Service and Repair
TRANSFER CASE MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. ECM (utility only). 3. Cowl side panel (pickup only). 4. Electrical
connection. 5. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 6. Module.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Module. 2. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 3. Electrical connection. 4. ECM (utility
only). 5. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Pickup
Transfer Case Select Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Pickup > Page 5560
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5561
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 4 Selector Switch Installation. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove console, then disconnect console wiring harness.
3. Remove shifter boot retaining screws and slide boot up shift lever.
4. Remove switch attaching screw, then the switch and harness, Fig. 2.
5. Position new switch on mounting bracket and install attaching screw.Ensure shift lever assembly
pawl is on the switch contact carrier.
6. Route wiring as shown in Fig. 4.
7. Place shifter boot in proper position, then install retaining screws.
8. Connect console wiring harness, then install console.
9. Connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page
5566
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page
5567
4WD Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case >
Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case
Speed Sensor Conn.
Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor
Conn.
Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001
Date: May 17, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed
Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab
9-7X
with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive
Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is
removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer
case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the
plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past,
the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair
procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This
connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time.
A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This
new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shifter Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Shifter Transfer Case: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Shifter & Shift Lever Mounting.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove console, then the shift boot. 3. Loosen shift lever
jam nut, then unscrew shift lever. 4. Remove transfer case selector switch. 5. Raise and support
vehicle. 6. Disconnect shift rod at shifter assembly, then remove pivot and adjusting bolt, Fig. 1. 7.
Remove shifter.
INSTALLATION
1. Position shifter at bracket, then install pivot and adjusting bolt, Fig. 1. 2. Connect shift rod, then
adjust shift linkage. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install shift lever on shifter, then screw lever down until
pawl just clears bracket, then tighten shift lever an additional 1&1/2 turns and tighten jam
nut.
5. Install selector switch, shift boot and console. 6. Install battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Shift Linkage, Transfer Case > Shift Cable,
Transfer Case > Component Information > Adjustments
Shift Cable: Adjustments
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 3 Transfer Case Shift Lever Positioning. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Remove console, then pull shift boot up shift lever.
2. Loosen small bolt and washer (A) and pivot bolt (B), Fig. 2.
3. Position transfer case shift lever at 4 Hi position.
4. Install a 8 mm gage pin or 5/16 inch drill bit through shifter into bracket (C), Fig. 2.
5. Install a bolt at the transfer case lever to lock transfer case in 4 Hi, Fig. 3.
6. Torque small bolt and washer (A) to 25-35 ft. lbs., then pivot bolt (B) to 88-103 ft. lbs., Fig. 2.
7. Remove bolt installed at transfer case lever, then gage pin or drill bit from shifter and bracket.
8. Place shift boot in proper position, then install console.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn.
Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor
Conn.
Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001
Date: May 17, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed
Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab
9-7X
with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive
Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is
removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer
case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the
plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past,
the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair
procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This
connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time.
A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This
new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
The Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch (Encoder Switch) is located in the in the shift
motor on the transfer case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch > Page 5587
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5588
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5589
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair
ELECTRIC SHIFT MOTOR REPLACEMENT
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle and support with safety stands.
2. Transfer case shield. 3. Motor electrical connection. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Front output shaft
yoke. 6. Motor to transfer case bolts. 7. Motor from the transfer case.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Motor to the transfer case. 2. Bolts.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 18 Nm (13 lbs. ft.).
3. Front output shaft yoke. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Motor electrical connection. 6. Transfer case
shield. 7. Negative battery cable.
- Lower Vehicle
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid line pressure.
OPERATION
The solenoid controls line pressure by controlling actuator feed limit fluid flow acting on internal
spool valve and spring pressure. The solenoid is a normally closed solenoid valve that controls fluid
pressure when operating on a duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Component Resistance Chart
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5600
Shift Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Control Solenoid To Valve Body ..........................................................................................
................................................................................ 8 Solenoid Assembly To Pump ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 8 Solenoid Assembly To Case ....................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 18
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Electronic Component Location Views
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5603
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 1 -2 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 1-2 and 3-4
shift valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 2-3 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page 5606
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 2-3 Shift Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 2-3 shift
valves.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a normally open exhaust valve that is used with the 1-2 shift solenoid to allow four
different shifting combinations.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > 1 -2 Shift Solenoid > Page 5607
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation 3-2 Control Solenoid
PURPOSE
This electrical device, controlled by the PCM, is used to control fluid flow acting on the 3-2 shift
valve, which then controls the 2-4 band apply rate and 3-4 clutch release rate. The solenoid also
controls the 3-2 downshift feel.
OPERATION
The solenoid is a pulse width modulated solenoid that operates on a negative duty cycle.
LOCATION
The solenoid is attached to the control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L60-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
CLEAN
- Exposed ends of bottom pan screws and spray with penetrating oil.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Screws (76), oil pan (75) and gasket (73). 2. Oil filter (72) and filter seal (71).
- Filter seal may be stuck in the pump.
INSPECT
- Filter (72), open filter by prying the metal crimping away from the top of the filter (black) and pull
apart. The filter may contain evidence for root cause diagnosis. Clutch material.
- Bronze slivers indicating bushing wear.
- Steel particles.
Valve Body and Wiring Harness
VALVE BODY AND WIRING HARNESS
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5610
Valve Body Bolt Location
Control Valve And Pressure Switch Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5611
Manual Valve Link
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5612
Valve Body Checkballs
Case Checkballs And Filters
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Electrical connections from components. 2. TCC PWM Solenoid Retainer Clip (379) and
Solenoid (396). 3. TCC Solenoid bolts (68) and solenoid assembly (66) with O-ring seal (65) and
wiring harness. 4. Pressure switch assembly bolts (70) and pressure switch assembly (69). 5.
Accumulator cover bolts (58 and 59) and 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57). 6. 1-2
accumulator piston (56) and seal (55). 7. Spring (54). 8. Dipstick stop bracket (93).
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Bolt (64) and manual detent spring assembly (63).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5613
2. Wiring harness retaining bolts.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Remaining valve body bolts (62). 2. Manual valve link (89). 3. Control valve assembly (60). 4.
Bolts (58 and 59), accumulator cover (57), piston (56, spring (54) and spring (54A). 5. Bolts (77)
and plate (53). 6. Spacer plate (48) and spacer plate gaskets (47 and 52). 7. Spring (46), piston
(44), and pin (43).
- Seven checkballs are located under the valve body and one is located in the case. The large
copper flash colored ball is # 1A checkball (91).
Valve Body and Associated Parts
VALVE BODY AND ASSOCIATED PARTS
Accumulator Assembly, Spacer Plate And Gaskets
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5614
Case Checkballs And Filters
TOOL REQUIRED:
- J 25025-5 Guide Pins
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined corners that are necessary for
"cleaning" the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, "micro fine" lapping
compound 900 grit or finer should be used. Too much "lapping" of a valve will cause excessive
clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. The wiring harness pass-thru connector into the case. 2. The 3-4 accumulator pin (43) into the
case. 3. The 3-4 accumulator piston seal (45) onto the 3-4 accumulator piston. 4. The 3-4
accumulator piston (44) onto the pin.
- The end with three legs must face the valve body.
5. The 3-4 accumulator piston spring (46).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkball (91) into case as shown.
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. J 25025-5 into the case. 3. Screens onto spacer plate as shown. 4. Spacer plate to case gasket
(47) and spacer plate to valve body gasket (52) onto the spacer plate (48).
- Gasket (47) identified by a "C". Gasket (52) identified by a "V".
- Retain with Transjel TM J 36850 or equivalent.
5. Spacer plate and gaskets onto the case.
IMPORTANT
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the spacer plate and gaskets.
6. Spacer plate support (53) and bolts (77).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.)
Control Valve Body
CONTROL VALVE BODY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5615
Case Checkballs And Filters
Filter Screen - Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5616
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5617
Control Valve Assembly - Legend
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5618
Valve Body Checkball Locations
Valve Body Bolt Locations
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5619
Manual Valve Link
Outside Electrical Connector
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly thoroughly in clean solvent. A. Move the valves with a pick or small
screwdriver to dislodge any dirt or debris that may have accumulated. B. Air dry.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
IMPORTANT
- Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing roll pins and retainer clips.
- Valves, springs and bushings must be laid out on a clean surface in the exact sequence they are
removed.
1. Pressure control solenoid retainer bolt (364) retainer (378) and solenoid. 2. Bore plug retainer
clip (395), bore plug (376) and valve train (374 and 375). 3. 2-3 shift solenoid retainer (379),
solenoid (367) and valve train (368 and 369). 4. 1-2 shift solenoid retainer (379), solenoid (367)
and valve train (365 and 366). 5. Accumulator valve train retainer pin (360), bore plug (373) and
valve train (370 and 371). 6. Forward accumulator cover bolts (364) and cover (363). 7. Forward
accumulator spring (356), piston (354) and pin (355). 8. Lo overrun valve spring (362) and valve
(361). 9. Retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and forward abuse valve train (357 and 358).
10. Manual valve (340). 11. 3-2 control solenoid retainer clip (379) and solenoid (394).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5620
12. Bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and 3-2 control valve train (391 - 393). 13. 3-2
downshift bore plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (389 - 390). 14. Reverse abuse
bore plug retainer pin (360), bore plug (359) and valve train (387 - 388). 15. 3-4 shift valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve train (385 - 386). 16. 3-4 relay bore plug retainer
(395), bore plug (381) and valve train (382 - 384). 17. Torque converter clutch signal valve bore
plug retainer (395), bore plug (381) and valve (380).
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings and control valve body in clean solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
- All valves and bushings for: Porosity
- Scoring
- Nicks
- Scratches
- Springs for damaged or distorted coils.
- Valve body casting for: Porosity
- Cracks
- Inter connected oil passages
- Damaged machined surfaces
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly (350) exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and bushing passages.
- Position the pressure control solenoid so the connector tabs face outward.
NOTICE: TCC PWM solenoid (396) cannot be installed until TCC solenoid has been installed and
torqued to proper specifications.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Checkballs into the valve body assembly (350).
- Retain with Transjell TM J 36850 or equivalent.
2. Valve body assembly (350).
- Connect the manual valve link (89) to the inside detent lever (88).
- Be careful not to damage screens when installing the valve body assembly.
3. Wiring harness (66), manual spring assembly (63), pressure switch assembly(69), dipstick, stop
bracket (93) and all remaining valve body bolts.
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
4. TCC solenoid (66) and bolts (68).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
5. TCC PWM solenoid (396), and retainer clip (379).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
- Wiring harness connections to electrical components.
- To correctly hook up the wires, see the wiring diagrams.
- The pressure control solenoid (377) has two different colored connectors. The black connector
should be installed on the tab farthest from the valve body.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Parking bracket (86).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 31 Nm (23 lb. ft.).
2. The 1-2 accumulator piston seal (55) onto the 1-2 accumulator piston (56). 3. The 1-2
accumulator spring (54) and 1-2 accumulator inner spring (54A) onto the piston (56). 4. The 1-2
accumulator piston (56) into the 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57).
- The three legs on the piston must face away from the case when installed.
5. The 1-2 accumulator cover and pin assembly (57) onto the case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5621
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 11 Nm (8 lb. ft.).
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Case, Pan And Filter Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Filter seal (71) into the pump. 2. Oil filter (72). 3. Oil pan gasket (73). 4. Chip magnet (74) onto
oil pan (75). 5. Oil pan (75) and bolts (76).
TIGHTEN
- Torque to 12 Nm (9 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5622
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair 4L80-E Automatic Transmission
Pan and Filter Assembly
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Drain the transmission fluid Out case extension by rotating transmission to a vertical position. 2.
Seventeen bolts (27), using 10 mm socket, drain transmission fluid. 3. Pan (28), seal (29) and
magnet (30).
IMPORTANT
- Seal (29) is reusable.
4. Filter assembly (31).
INSPECT
- Filter neck seal (32), replace if necessary.
Wire Harness Assembly
WIRE HARNESS ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5623
Pan, Filter And Seal Removal
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Wire harness connectors from electrical components.
NOTICE: Excessive force on the case pass through connector may damage the connector.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
2. Wire harness assembly (34) from case using a 1-5/16" 12 point socket to release the connector
retaining clips.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5624
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Rotate transmission bottom pan surface up and lock in place. 2. Wire harness assembly (34)
connectors from components.
IMPORTANT
- If the wire harness assembly does not need servicing, it is not necessary to remove it from the
case.
- Use a cap to cover electrical pin at case connection.
3. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket, and transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40).
NOTICE: Be sure five O-rings are attached to transmission fluid pressure switch assembly.
4. Twenty-one bolts (35) using 10 mm socket, from valve body assembly, manual detent spring and
roller assembly (41). 5. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid level indicator stop (43), one bolt (36) using
10 mm socket, lube pipe (39), lube pipe retainer (37) and clamp (38). 6. Control valve assembly
(44) including the accumulator housing assembly (51), valve body gaskets (45 and 48), spacer
plate (46) and accumulator
gasket (47).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5625
7. Manual valve (319) from control valve assembly (44) to prevent any damage. 8. Checkballs (54)
from case passages.
NOTICE: Do not use a magnet. It could cause checkball(s) to be magnetized causing metal
particles to stick to the ball.
9. Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid screen (75).
INSPECT
- Screen PWM solenoid (75), replace if necessary.
DISASSEMBLE
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5626
- Control valve assembly. A. Position as shown on a clean surface. B. Remove blind hole retainer
pins with a drill bit.
CAUTION: Some valves are under pressure - cover the bores while removing the retaining pins or
personal injury could result.
C. Remove valve trains, shift solenoids (311 and 313), PCS (320), PWM solenoid (323), PCS
screen (302) and shift solenoid filter (317). D. Valves, springs, bushings and pistons must be laid
out on a clean surface.
CLEAN
- All valves, springs, bushings, pistons, control valve body and accumulator housing in clean
solvent.
- Dry using compressed air.
INSPECT
1. All valves, pistons and bushings for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
2. Pistons for:
- Seal damage.
3. Springs for:
- Damaged or distorted coils.
4. Valve body casting and accumulator housing for:
- Porosity.
- Cracks.
- Interconnected passages.
- Damaged machined surfaces.
5. Solenoid connectors and filter (317). 6. PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid) screen (302).
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY/ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5627
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5628
Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5629
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5630
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5631
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: The use of a honing stone, fine sandpaper or crocus cloth is not recommended for
servicing stuck valves. All valve lands have sharply machined comers that are necessary for
cleaning the bore. If these corners are rounded, foreign material could wedge between the valve
and the bore causing the valve to stick. If it is found necessary to clean a valve, micro fine lapping
compound 900 grit (J 38459) or finer should be used. Too much lapping of the valve will cause
excessive clearances and increase the chance of a valve not operating.
CLEAN
- Control valve assembly and accumulator housing (51) thoroughly in clean solvent.
- Air dry.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5632
Accumulator Housing Assembly
ACCUMULATOR HOUSING ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5633
Accumulator Housing Assembly
DISASSEMBLE
1. Six bolts (53), using 8 mm socket. 2. Accumulator housing assembly. 3. Gasket accumulator
housing (47). 4. Spacer plate (46). 5. Gasket (45) valve body spacer. 6. Snap ring (402) from
outside housing, pin (408), snap ring (402), piston (407) and spring (49). 7. 3rd clutch piston (405)
and spring (50). 8. Seals (404 and 406).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5634
CLEAN
- All components.
INSPECT
- All valves, pistons, springs and seals for:
- Porosity.
- Scoring.
- Nicks.
- Scratches.
Accumulator Housing Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5635
ASSEMBLE
- Accumulator housing assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the positions of the pistons.
Control Valve Assembly
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
Control Valve Assembly
ASSEMBLE
- Control valve assembly components exactly as shown. Notice the position of the valve lands and
bushing passages.
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5636
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY AND ACCUMULATOR HOUSING
Control Valve Assembly/Accumulator Housing
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
TOOL REQUIRED:
- Guide Pin J 25025-5
ASSEMBLE
1. Guide pin J 25025-5 into valve body. Located at back bolt hole of detent spring and roller
assembly bolt bole. 2. Gasket (45) valve body to spacer plate. 3. Spacer plate (46). 4. Gasket (47)
accumulator housing to spacer plate. 5. Accumulator housing assembly (51) onto valve body
assembly (44).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5637
6. Six bolts (53) using (8 mm) socket through accumulator housing into valve body assembly.
Torque Sequence And Guide Pin Location
NOTE: Start accumulator housing bolts finger tight and work towards opposite end.
TIGHTEN
- Bolt (53) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
7. Remove guide pin J 25025-5.
Fig. 11 Check Ball Location.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5638
Fig. 10 Control Valve Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5639
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Install checkballs (54) in proper location into case fluid passages. Use TRANSJEL TM J 36850
or equivalent to hold in place.
NOTICE: Do not use any type of grease to retain parts during assembly of this unit. Greases other
than the recommended assembly lube will change transmission fluid characteristics and cause
undesirable shift conditions and/or filter clogging.
- # 2 checkball is used only on RCP RDP, ZJP and ZLP models.
2. PWM solenoid screen (75).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5640
3. Gasket (48) spacer plate to case. 4. Manual valve (319) into valve body. 5. Complete valve body
assembly (44) onto case (7). Use 1 25025-5 guide pin set.
IMPORTANT
- Attach manual valve to detent lever.
6. Transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40) onto valve body assembly (44). 7. Spring and
roller assembly (41) into place. 8. Three wiring clamps (33), fluid indicator stop (43) and lube pipe
clamp (38). 9. Twenty-one bolts (35). Using 10 mm socket.
10. Six bolts (76) using 8 mm socket into transmission fluid pressure switch assembly (40). 11.
Lube pipe (39) long end into case, short end into valve body. 12. Lube pipe retainer (37) with short
bolt (36).
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (35, 36 and 76) to 11 Nm (97 lb. in.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5641
Torque Sequence, Control Valve And Switch Assembly
NOTICE: Torque valve body bolts in a spiral pattern starting from the center. If bolts are torqued at
random, valve bores may be distorted and inhibit valve operation.
13. Attach wiring harness (34) to 5 connectors.
- Put large end into case first, pressure switch hook up, 1-2 shift solenoid (purple) and 2-3 shift
solenoid (tan), PWM (Pulse Width Modulated) solenoid and PCS (Pressure Control Solenoid).
Pan and Filter Assembly
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 4L60-E Automatic Transmission > Page 5642
PAN AND FILTER ASSEMBLY
Installing Pan And Filter
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Seal (32) inside of case (7). 2. Filter assembly (31). 3. Bottom pan seal (29). 4. Magnet (30) into
bottom pan. 5. Pan (29). 6. Seventeen bolts (27) using 10 mm socket.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts (27) to 24 Nm (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4
Clutch Friction/Plates
File In Section: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 47-71-41
Date: January, 1995
Subject: New 2-4 Band Assembly, 3-4 Clutch Friction and Steel Plates and Torque Clutch PWM
Solenoid
Models: 1995
Buick Roadmaster
1995 Cadillac Fleetwood
1995 Chevrolet Camaro, Caprice, Corvette
1995 Pontiac Firebird
1995 Chevrolet and GMC Truck C/K Models and M/L, G Vans
1994-95 Chevrolet and GMC Truck S/T Models
1994 Oldsmobile Bravada
(1994 Models with RPO +CTF Package)
Transmission Applications: 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E (RPO M30)
A new 2-4 Band Assembly was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year and
1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The 2-4 Band friction material has changed appearance from a
brown material to a gray/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 2-4 Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Before replacing the 2-4 Band
inspect it for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before Replacing the Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly inspect for scoring or signs of
excessive heat. The 2-4 Band and/or Reverse Input Housing and Drum Assembly should be
replaced ONLY if the above listed damage is found.
Note:
The new 2-4 Band Assembly will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60
transmissions.
A new 3-4 clutch friction plate was introduced at the start of production for the 1995 Model Year
and 1994 Bravadas and S/T Trucks. The 3-4 clutch plate friction material has changed appearance
from a brown material to a green/black material. This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1995 Hydra-Matic 4L60-E transmission, do NOT assume that the 3-4 clutch
friction plates are burned/damaged due to their dark color. This dark color is normal. Before
replacing the 3-4 clutch friction plates inspect for scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Before replacing the 3-4 clutch steel plates inspect for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The 3-4
clutch friction plates and/or 3-4 clutch steel plates should be replaced ONLY if the above listed
damage is found.
Note:
The new 3-4 friction plates will NOT service past model Hydra-Matic 4L60-E or 4L60 transmissions.
A new Torque Converter Clutch PWM Solenoid was introduced at the start of production for the
1995 Model Year and 1994 Bravadas and S/T trucks. The new torque converter clutch PWM
solenoid is used to control fluid acting on the converter clutch valve, which then controls TCC apply
and release. The solenoid is attached to the control valve body assembly within the transmission.
The TCC PWM solenoid is used to provide smooth engagement of the torque converter by
operating on a negative duty cycle percent of "ON" time.
It a fault is detected in the TCC PWM circuit, DTC 83 will set.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 5647
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-4 Band, TCC Solenoid, 3-4 Clutch Friction/Plates > Page 5648
Included is a Service Manual update for the 1-2 and 3-4 accumulator spring color chart. Replace
these pages in your 1995 Service Manual.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5649
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
Inside automatic transmission attached to valve body.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5650
C216 - TCC
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5651
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transmission through the torque converter. This reduces
the slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy.
For the converter clutch to apply, two hydraulic conditions must be met: Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
- The control module completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Control module control is based on the input of these sensors: Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS): Vehicle equipped with A/C will allow TCC engagement at about 35
mph when the A/C is selected "ON". Engagement will occur at a vehicle speed of about 30 mph (25
mph for 92) when A/C is selected "OFF".
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Engine at normal operating temperature (above
65°C/149°F).
- Throttle Position Sensor (TPS): Output not changing, indicating a steady road speed.
- Transmission Fluid (TFT) sensor.
Control module is also controlled by these switches: Brake switch closed: 12 volts supplied when brake is depressed.
- Transmission Range (TR) pressure switch assembly.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
The Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch (Encoder Switch) is located in the in the shift
motor on the transfer case.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Electronic Shift Transfer Case Position Switch > Page 5657
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 5658
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
C154 - Front Axle Switch
C155 - Front Axle Switch In-Line
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 5659
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair
ELECTRIC SHIFT MOTOR REPLACEMENT
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable.
- Raise vehicle and support with safety stands.
2. Transfer case shield. 3. Motor electrical connection. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Front output shaft
yoke. 6. Motor to transfer case bolts. 7. Motor from the transfer case.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Motor to the transfer case. 2. Bolts.
TIGHTEN
- Bolts to 18 Nm (13 lbs. ft.).
3. Front output shaft yoke. 4. Front propeller shaft. 5. Motor electrical connection. 6. Transfer case
shield. 7. Negative battery cable.
- Lower Vehicle
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
Instrument cluster.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations
Four-Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp Wiring I/P
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5669
C274 - 4WD Indicator
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5670
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Indicator Assembly provides visual information about the operating
mode and gear range of the driveline. Voltage is supplied to the IGN/GAU Fuse and Indicator
Assembly with the Ignition Switch in START or RUN. The circuit is completed through the Selector
Quadrant Switch, which provides a ground path to light various Indicator Assembly Lamps.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 1, the "2WHL" Indicator Assembly Lamp is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 2, the "4 HIGH" Indicator Assembly Lamp is
lit. At this time, the Front Axle Switch is closed and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle
Display is lit.
With the Selector Quadrant Switch in detent position 4, the "4 LOW" Indicator Lamp is lit. At this
time, the Front Axle Switch is closed, and the Indicator Assembly Front and Rear Axle Display is lit.
A signal is sent to the Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (4WAL) whenever the 4WD is engaged.
This signal turns off the 4WAL systems to prevent operation during 4WD operation.
Preliminary Checks - Four-Wheel Drive Indicator
1. Check condition of IGN/GAU Fuse. If fuse is Blown, locate and repair overload. Replace fuse. 2.
If fuse is not blown, proceed with the Diagnostics. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5673
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Indicator Assembly Illumination Lamp Does Not Light
One Or More Indicator Assembly Lamps Do Not Light
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Mounted on the back of the Electronic Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5679
C202A - Transfer Case Control Module
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting
Control Module: Description and Operation Electric 4WD Shifting
Transfer Case 4WD Selector Switch
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
On vehicles equipped with the Model 233 transfer case, there is no transfer case selector lever in
the cab. The operator selects 4HI or 4LO by pushing a three-position (4HI, 4LO, 2HI) rocker-type
selector switch mounted on the instrument panel. During normal driving the transfer case is in the
2HI mode. The switch is spring-loaded to the center position. When the transfer case is in 2HI both
the 4HI and 4L0 switch circuits are open, and both lights are off. When shifting to 4HI or 4LO the
rocker switch will still return to the center position and the 4HI or 4LO light will be on. The above
image shows the wiring schematic of the transfer case selector switch.
Mode Shifts Mode shifts are shifts from:
- 2HI to 4HI
- 4HI to 2HI
A mode shift can be accomplished in any gear position and at any vehicle speed. If the system is in
2HI, the operator can shift into 4HI merely by pressing and releasing the 4HI area of the selector
rocker switch. The green 4HI status lamp flashes whenever a 2HI or 4HI shift is initiated and
continues to flash until the TCCM completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). After the shift
into 4HI is accomplished, the 4HI status lamp remains lit to indicate that the system is in 4HI. The
operator can shift from 4HI back to 2HI by again pressing 4HI on the selector switch. Again, the
green 4HI status lamp flashes until the shift to 2HI is complete, and then extinguishes once the shift
is complete. Both the 4HI and 4LO lamps remain oft when the vehicle is in 2HI.
Range Shifts Range shifts are shifts between the HI and LO ranges, from:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5682
- 2HI to 4LO
- 4HI to 4LO
- 4LO to 4HI
A range shift from 4L0 directly to 2HI cannot be made. The operator must first make range shift
from 4LO to 4HI, then a mode shift from 4HI to 2HI. A range shift can only be made with the
automatic transmission in neutral or with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed. The
vehicle speed must also be below three miles per hour before the shift can occur. Whenever a shift
into 4LO is initiated, the amber 4LO status lamp flashes and continues to flash until the TCCM
completes the shift (or until 30 seconds elapses). The 4LO status lamp must glow steadily before
the vehicle transmission is shifted into gear or before the clutch pedal is released. If a range shift is
initiated when the transmission is engaged or when the vehicle speed is above 3 mph, the 4LO
status lamp flashes for 30 seconds and no range shift actually occurs; the system returns to the
position before the shift was initiated.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5683
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Power and Ground
Fig. 1, Memory Power, System Power, And Ground Circuit
Fig. 2, Fuse Block And Cavity Location
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5684
POWER, CIRCUIT PROTECTION, AND GROUND
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) memory power, system power, and the ground circuit
are shown in Figure 1. The vehicle fuse block and cavity location for memory power, system power,
and motor power are shown in Figure 2.
Memory Power Trouble code memory power is protected by a 5-amp TCCM fuse. Memory power
is supplied to TCCM connector pin C6 through circuit 140.
System Power Operating power is controlled by the ignition switch and is protected by a 15-amp
radio fuse. System power is supplied to TCCM connector pin C8 through circuit 141. This fuse also
supplies, voltage to pin B of the transfer case switch. The system power will shut down if either the
5-amp TCCM fuse or the 15-amp radio fuse are removed or blown.
System Ground System ground is supplied to TCCM connector pin C10 through circuit 150. Circuit
150 is connected to the bus bar ground located on the left side of the steering column support.
Refer to Figure 1.
Turn/BU Fuse A 15-amp TURN/BU fuse supplies ignition voltage to the park/neutral position
switch. This voltage enables the park switch to send a park signal to TCCM connector pin D2.
Power Accessory Circuit Breaker The 30-amp power accessory circuit breaker supplies ignition
voltage to TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This voltage is used to control the electric-shift
motor circuit.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5685
Control Module: Description and Operation TCCM Inputs and Outputs
General Description
INPUTS
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) receives input signals from the following sources:
- Transfer case selector switch on the instrument panel.
- Park/neutral position switch on vehicles with automatic transmissions.
- Clutch safety switch on vehicles with manual transmissions.
- Vehicle speed sensor buffer which supplies vehicle speed signals.
- Encoder switch within the electric-shift motor which provides actual mode and range information
signals.
- Data link connector (DLC) pin J which provides diagnostic enable.
OUTPUTS
After processing the input information, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) outputs signals
to the following:
- Electric shift motor to effect mode and range shifts.
- Selector switch status lamps to provide transfer case status information.
- Diagnostic trouble codes (DTC) which are output via the selector switch status lamps.
2HI to 4HI Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the transfer case is in 2HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the
4HI contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564, and furnishing 12-volts
to pin C5 of the TCCM connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5 commands the Transfer Case
Control Module (TCCM) to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. The contacts return to the
open position as soon as the switch is released.
4HI to 2HI Selector Switch Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5686
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
If the transfer case is in 4HI and the operator presses the 4HI area of the rocker switch, the 4HI
contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1564 and furnishing 12-volts to
pin C5 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt signal at pin C5
commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift into 4HI. Again, the contacts return to
the open position as soon as the switch is released.
2HI to 4HI to 4LO Selector Switch Input
4WD Selector Switch Wiring Schematic
OPERATION
When the operator presses the 4LO area of the rocker switch while the transfer case is in either
2HI or 4HI, the 4LO contacts of the selector switch close, connecting circuits 141 and 1559, and
furnishing 12-volts to pin C3 of the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) connector. The 12-volt
signal at pin C3 commands the TCCM to signal the electric-shift motor to shift the transfer case into
4LO. Once more, the contacts return to the open position as soon as the switch is released.
Park/Neutral Position Switch Inputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5687
Automatic Transmission Neutral Start Switch
Neutral Start Switch Voltages
OPERATION
Because range shift should only be made with the automatic transmission in neutral, the
park/neutral position switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle
automatic transmission is in either:
- Park
- Neutral
- One of the drive positions
The park/neutral position switch consists of three switches together in one unit, and it provides
three signals:
- Park - When the automatic transmission is in park, the contacts of both the park switch and the
park neutral switch are closed. When these contacts are closed, a battery voltage signal is sent to
TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 voltage). The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in park.
- Neutral - When the automatic transmission is in neutral, the contacts of the park switch are open
and the contacts of the park neutral position switch are closed. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal
is sent to TCCM connector pin D2, while connector pin D16 is pulled to ground (0 volts). The
TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is in neutral.
- In gear - When the automatic transmission is in any other gear position, the contacts of both the
park switch and park neutral switch are open. In this condition, a 0-voltage signal is sent to TCCM
connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the automatic transmission is neither
park or neutral.
Important
- If the backup switch connector were to be plugged in upside down, the park switch would receive
no power. Such a condition would cause a 0-voltage signal at both pin D2 and pin D16 in neutral
and in park. The transfer case, accordingly, would perform a range shift in park as well as in
neutral.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5688
- An open in circuit 75, or an open in the Turn/BU fuse would also cause this condition.
- Additionally, a park/neutral position switch that is out of adjustment may prevent a range shift in
park.
Clutch Safety Switch Inputs
Clutch Safety Switch Schematic
Clutch Safety Switch Voltage Signals
OPERATION
Because range shifts should only be made with the manual transmission clutch fully depressed, the
clutch safety switch informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) that the vehicle clutch
pedal is fully depressed or released. The clutch safety switch is connected to TCCM connector pin
D16. When the clutch pedal is released, the contacts of the clutch safety switch are open. When
these contacts are open, a battery voltage signal is seen at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM
interprets this signal to mean the clutch is released. When the clutch is fully depressed, the
contacts of the clutch safety switch are closed. When the contacts are closed, voltage is pulled low
to 0 at TCCM connector pin D16. The TCCM interprets this signal to mean the clutch pedal is fully
depressed. Because TCCM connector pin D2 is not connected when the vehicle is equipped with a
manual transmission, the TCCM reads a 0-volt signal at pin D2 at all times. All readings are taken
while back-probing the TCCM pins with the ignition in the "Run" position. A reading of less than 0.5
volt is considered to be zero.
Vehicle Speed Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5689
Vehicle Sensor Buffer And TCCM Schematic
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor buffer informs the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) about the
speed of the vehicle in miles per hour. Such information is essential to inform the TCCM to prohibit
range shifts at speeds above 3 mph. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) is a variable-reluctance
magnetic sensing device that converts tone wheel rotation into a frequency and voltage output
proportional to the vehicle speed. The frequency and voltage signal is sent to the vehicle speed
sensor buffer which converts the speed sensor output into a useful pulse signal. The vehicle speed
sensor buffer then, pulses circuit 1567 to ground at a rate of 4000 pulses per mile. Whenever the
vehicle speed sensor buffer grounds circuit 1567, the voltage at TCCM connector pin D8 returns to
5 volts. The TCCM reads the 4000 pulses-per-mile (1.11 Hz per mph) signal to determine vehicle
speed.
Encoder Switch Inputs
Fig 1, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Layout
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5690
Fig 2, Electric Shift Encoder Switch Schematic
Fig 3, Encoder Switch Channel Signals And Positions
OPERATION
The four-channel encoder switch indicates the current transfer case mode and range to the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM). The encoder switch is located inside the encoder itself and
is not serviceable. The TCCM reads the status of the four channels to determine the range and
mode in which the transfer case is operating or whether the transfer case is shifting between
modes and/or ranges. The encoder assembly is composed of an inner ground ring in contact with a
three-leg wiper arm. The three legs of the wiper, spaced 120 degrees apart, make contact with the
conductive areas of the four channels. When any leg of the wiper arm is in contact with the
conductive area of any channel, a path to ground is provided to the inner ground ring. A schematic
of the encoder switch is shown in Figure 2. The channel signals in various transfer case operating
modes and ranges are shown in Figure 3. Any combination of signals not listed in Figure 3 are
considered invalid by the TCCM.
Encoder Switch Channel Positions These voltage readings can be obtained by back-probing either
the TCCM connector pins or the transfer case connector pins. For TCCM pin numbers and encoder
channels, refer to Figure 2.
Diagnostic Enable Input
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5691
Wiring Schematic For Enabling The Status Lamps
OPERATION
When pin J of the Data Link Connector (DLC) is connected either to pin A of the DLC or to a good
ground while the ignition is on, the diagnostics routine of the Transfer Case Control Module
(TCCM) is activated. When the diagnostics routine is activated, the transfer case selector switch
4HI and 4LO status lamps flash the diagnostic codes.
Electric Shift Motor Outputs
Electric Shift Motor Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) provides the output for the electric shift motor as the
schematic shows.
- Motor control is achieved by energizing one of the two motor control relays located in the TCCM,
by way of the transfer case selector switch.
The TCCM operates the motor in one direction by energizing one relay while the second relay is
de-energized. The TCCM operates the motor in the reverse direction by energizing the second
relay while the first relay is de-energized.
- Motor power to actuate the motor drive relays is input at TCCM connector pins D14 and D15. This
power is supplied by the ignition through the 30-amp power circuit breaker.
- Motor ground is input at TCCM connector pins D12 and D13 to provide the return line for the
motor drive relays.
4HI and 4LO Status Lamps Outputs
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Electric 4WD Shifting > Page 5692
Selector Switch Status Lamp Schematic
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) controls the operation of the 4HI and 4LO status lamps
in the transfer case selector switch. The status lamps also show the transfer case mode and range
of operation. The status lamps also provide a self-test when the ignition is first turned on.
Additionally, the status lamps are used to alert the driver that there is a problem somewhere in the
four-wheel drive system, and also to flash diagnostic trouble codes (DTC's).
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5693
Control Module: Service and Repair
TRANSFER CASE MODULE REPLACEMENT
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. ECM (utility only). 3. Cowl side panel (pickup only). 4. Electrical
connection. 5. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 6. Module.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Module. 2. Module to cowl panel screws (pickup only). 3. Electrical connection. 4. ECM (utility
only). 5. Negative battery cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Stoplamp/TCC Brake Switch > Page 5700
I/P Harness Wiring, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5701
C217 - Brake Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs.
Pressure Plugs (1/8 - 27) .....................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 8 Pressure Plugs (1/4 - 18) ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 18 Pressure Switches ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
This device is a set of five presure switches (two normally closed and three normally open), that
detect fluid pressure within the valve body passages and signals the PCM which transmission
range is selected (PRNDL).
OPERATION
The five pressure switches are connected to three signal circuits referred to as range signals A, B,
C. The combination of pressure switch states determines the voltage signal (B+ or 0) on each
range signal to the PCM.
LOCATION
The transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly is attached to the control valve body within
the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
COMPONENT .....................................................................................................................................
...................................................... Torque/Ft.Lbs. Vehicle Speed Sensor Retainer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 8
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Automatic Transmission Electrical Components
PURPOSE
The Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) Sensor is used by the control module to control: Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) apply and release schedule.
- Hot mode determination.
- Shift quality.
OPERATION
The TFT is a thermistor used to indicate transmission fluid temperature. The control module sends
a 5.0 volt signal to the TFT through a resistor in the computer and measures the voltage. High
sensor resistance produces high signal input voltage which corresponds to low fluid temperature.
Low sensor resistance produces low signal input voltage which corresponds to high fluid
temperature. With the TFT varying its resistance, the control module can sense transmission fluid
temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION
The sensor is part of the transmission range fluid pressure switch assembly and is attached to the
control valve body within the transmission.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Pickup
Transfer Case Select Switch
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Pickup > Page 5719
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5720
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Transfer Case Shift Linkage. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
Fig. 4 Selector Switch Installation. Except Bravada, Sonoma GT, Syclone & Typhoon
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove console, then disconnect console wiring harness.
3. Remove shifter boot retaining screws and slide boot up shift lever.
4. Remove switch attaching screw, then the switch and harness, Fig. 2.
5. Position new switch on mounting bracket and install attaching screw.Ensure shift lever assembly
pawl is on the switch contact carrier.
6. Route wiring as shown in Fig. 4.
7. Place shifter boot in proper position, then install retaining screws.
8. Connect console wiring harness, then install console.
9. Connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch
Transfer Case Electric Shift Motor
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 5725
Electric Shift Transfer Case Wiring
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Electric Shift Transfer Case Switch > Page 5726
4WD Components
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor Conn.
Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Updated Transfer Case Speed Sensor
Conn.
Bulletin No.: 06-04-21-001
Date: May 17, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Updated Transfer Case Connector Service Kit Now Available For Transfer Case Speed
Sensor Wire Harness Connector that Comes Loose Or Connector Retainer Clip Breaks
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab
9-7X
with Four-Wheel Drive or All-Wheel Drive
Technicians may find that when the transfer case speed sensor wire harness connector is
removed, the connector lock flexes/bends and does not return to the original position. The transfer
case speed sensor wire harness connector then has no locking device. On older vehicles, the
plastic connector retainer becomes brittle and the clip may break as soon as it is flexed. In the past,
the only service fix was to install a wire harness connector service pack, P/N 88987183. This repair
procedure involved splicing a new service connector with an integral connector lock. This
connector service kit is of the same design and was still prone to failure over time.
A new connector service repair kit is now available, P/N 15306187, that is an updated design. This
new kit should be used whenever the speed sensor wire harness connector requires replacement.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction
Technical Service Bulletin # 99-041 Date: 000501
Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
File in: Product
Section: Campaigns
Bulletin No: 99041
Dates: May, 2000
SUBJECT: 99041 - INCORRECT FRONT AXLE STATUS SIGNAL TO EBC4 ABS
MODELS: 1991-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC 4WD T UTILITIES 1994-1996 CHEVROLET AND
GMC 4WD T PICKUP TRUCKS
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS CAMPAIGN WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. YOU WILL RECEIVE A DEALER LISTING AS PHASES ARE RELEASED.
CONDITION
General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in certain
1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T pickup
trucks. Some of these vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch that signals the antilock brake
system (ABS) module when the vehicle is in four-wheel drive (4WD) may malfunction. The ABS
module is designed with two different operating algorithms; one for two-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied tot he rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunctioning switch may send an incorrect signal tot he ABS
module. If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result a vehicle crash.
CORRECTION
Dealers are to install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and an additional switch
to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in 4WD.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5741
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5742
Involved are certain 1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and
GMC 4WD T pickup truck built within these VIN breakpoints as shown.
IMPORTANT
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) or GM
Access Screen (Canada only) or DCS Screen 445 (IPC only) before beginning campaign repairs.
[Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
Involved vehicles have been identified by Vehicle Identification Number. Computer listing
containing the complete Vehicle Identification, customer name address data have been prepared,
and are being furnished to involved dealers with the campaign bulletin. The customer name
address data furnished will enable dealers to follow up with the campaign bulletin has no involved
vehicles currently assigned.
These dealer listings may contain customer names and addresses obtained from Motor Vehicle
Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any other purpose is a
violation of law in several states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of
this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this campaign.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts required to complete this campaign are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO = Daily Replenishment Order, in an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Part Number Description Quantity/Vehicle
88880028 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1991-94 Utility)
88880029 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1995-96 Utility, 1994-96 Pickup)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5743
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For US IPC
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the
instructions outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the
campaign number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service.
This Information may be inserted with a typewriter a ball point pen.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For CANADA
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the instruction
outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the campaign
number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service. This
information may be inserted with a typewriter or a ball point pen.
CLAIM INFORMATION
Submit a Product Campaign Claim with the information indicated.
Refer to the General Motors WINS claims processing Manual for details on Product Campaign
Claim Submission.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For US and CANADA
Customers will be notified of this campaign on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
customer letter included with this bulletin.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5744
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For IPC
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the attached suggested dealer letter.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - For US and IPC (US States, Territories, and
Possessions)
The US National Traffic end Motor Vehicle safety Act provides that each vehicle that is subject to
recall campaign of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the
customer has tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of vehicle is
prima facie evidence of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately
repaired within a reasonable time the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably
equivalent vehicle at no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for
depreciation. To avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made
to promptly schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as
possible. In the recall campaign notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration if the campaign is not completed within a
reasonable time.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - ALL
All unsold new vehicle in dealers' possession and subject to this campaign must be held an
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this campaign bulletin before customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this campaign at no charge to customers, regardless
of mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. This could be done by mailing to such customers, a copy of the customer
letter accompanying this bulletin. Campaign follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose,
since the customer may not as yet have received the notification letter. In summary, whenever a
vehicle subject to this campaign enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your dealership for service in
the future, you must take the steps necessary to be sure the campaign correction has been made
before selling or releasing the vehicle.
Disclaimer
1991-94 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching bolt.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the bolt removed in the previous step.
Important
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coolant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the bolt or nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5745
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 1 and tighten the
bolt to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted bon the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is routed
along the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel well towards the cowl area of the
engine compartment. On some vehicle this hose may be covered with a black convoluted
protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at me point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conitions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness is shown in Figure 1 and secure it to the existing Underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front exle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area above the brake booster assembly, and jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Loate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5746
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1994 T-Pickup
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Locate the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly so that the hole in the bracket align
with the front inboard nut that is molded into the top of the coolant reservoir as shown in Figure 2.
3. Using the bolt provided in the kit, switch the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly to the
coolant reservoir by hand at starting the bolt.
4. With the vacuum switch, bracket and hose assembly positioned as shown in Figure 2, tighten the
bolt to 10 Nm (88 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This hose is routed up from the axle
vacuum actuator and then rearward towards the cowl area inside the right fender as shown in
Figure 2.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is a part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5747
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the harness as shown in Figure 2 and secure the new harness to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kits.
10. Disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector, located in the
area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and jumper in the new
wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to engage
the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1995-96 T-Pickup and 1995-96 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching nut and discard.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the new nut contained in the kit.
Important:
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coalant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5748
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 3 and tighten the
nut to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is route along
the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel welt towards the cowl area of the engine
compartment. On come vehicle this hose may be covered with black convoluted protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that Will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line le tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the looking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness as shown in Figure 3 and secure it to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and
jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May > 00 > Recall - ABS Front
Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5749
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft)
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
Owner Letter
99041
(Sample Of Notification Used)
May, 2000
Dear General Motors Customer:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Reason For This Recall: General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle
safety exists in certain 1991-1996 4WD wheel drive (4WD) Blazers and Jimmys, and 1994-1996
4WD S-10 and Sonoma pickup trucks. Some of these Vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch
that signals the antilook brake system (ADS) module when the vehicle is in 4WD may malfunction.
The ABS module is designed with two different operating algorithms: one for 2-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied to the rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunction switch may send an incorrect signal to the ABS module.
If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result in a vehicle crash.
What Will Be Done: Your dealer will install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and
an additional switch to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in
4WD. This service will be performed for you at no charge.
How Long Will The Repair Take? The length of time required to perform this service correction is
approximately 30 minutes. Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If
your dealer has a large number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant.
Please ask your dealer if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed to schedule
process and repair your vehicle.
Contacting Your Dealer: Please contact your Chevrolet/GMC dealer as soon as possible to arrange
a service date. Parts are available and instructions for making this correction have been sent to
your dealer. Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer is best equipped to obtain parts and provide services to
correct you vehicle as promptly as possible. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service
date within a reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at
the listed number below:
Division Number Deaf, Hearing Impaired or Speech
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583 Utilize Telecommunication Devices
If, after contacting the appropriate Customer Assistance Center, you are still not satisfied that we
have done our best to remedy this condition without charge and within a reasonable time, you may
wish to write the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400 Seventh Street,
SW, Washington, DC 20590 or call 1-800-424-9393 (Washington, DC residents use
(202-366-0123).
Customer Reply Card: The customer reply card identifies your vehicle. Presentation of this card to
your dealer will assist in making necessary correction in the shortest possible time. If you no longer
own this vehicle, please let us know by completing the attached and mailing it in the postage paid
envelope.
We are sorry to cause you this inconvenience; however, we have taken this action in the interest of
your safety and continued satisfaction with our products.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
Technical Service Bulletin # 99-041 Date: 000501
Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction
File in: Product
Section: Campaigns
Bulletin No: 99041
Dates: May, 2000
SUBJECT: 99041 - INCORRECT FRONT AXLE STATUS SIGNAL TO EBC4 ABS
MODELS: 1991-1996 CHEVROLET AND GMC 4WD T UTILITIES 1994-1996 CHEVROLET AND
GMC 4WD T PICKUP TRUCKS
DUE TO THE AVAILABILITY OF PARTS, THIS CAMPAIGN WILL BE ADMINISTERED IN
PHASES. YOU WILL RECEIVE A DEALER LISTING AS PHASES ARE RELEASED.
CONDITION
General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in certain
1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T pickup
trucks. Some of these vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch that signals the antilock brake
system (ABS) module when the vehicle is in four-wheel drive (4WD) may malfunction. The ABS
module is designed with two different operating algorithms; one for two-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied tot he rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunctioning switch may send an incorrect signal tot he ABS
module. If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result a vehicle crash.
CORRECTION
Dealers are to install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and an additional switch
to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in 4WD.
VEHICLES INVOLVED
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5755
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5756
Involved are certain 1991-1996 Chevrolet and GMC 4WD T utilities and 1994-1996 Chevrolet and
GMC 4WD T pickup truck built within these VIN breakpoints as shown.
IMPORTANT
Dealers should confirm vehicle eligibility through GMVIS (GM Vehicle Inquiry System) or GM
Access Screen (Canada only) or DCS Screen 445 (IPC only) before beginning campaign repairs.
[Not all vehicles within the above breakpoints may be involved.]
Involved vehicles have been identified by Vehicle Identification Number. Computer listing
containing the complete Vehicle Identification, customer name address data have been prepared,
and are being furnished to involved dealers with the campaign bulletin. The customer name
address data furnished will enable dealers to follow up with the campaign bulletin has no involved
vehicles currently assigned.
These dealer listings may contain customer names and addresses obtained from Motor Vehicle
Registration Records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any other purpose is a
violation of law in several states/provinces/countries. Accordingly, you are urged to limit the use of
this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this campaign.
PARTS INFORMATION
Parts required to complete this campaign are to be obtained from General Motors Service Parts
Operations (GMSPO). Please refer to your "involved vehicles listing" before ordering parts. Normal
orders should be placed on a DRO = Daily Replenishment Order, in an emergency situation, parts
should be ordered on a CSO = Customer Special Order.
Part Number Description Quantity/Vehicle
88880028 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1991-94 Utility)
88880029 Switch Kit, Elek Brk Cont Frt 1
Drv Axle Vac (1995-96 Utility, 1994-96 Pickup)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5757
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For US IPC
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the
instructions outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the
campaign number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service.
This Information may be inserted with a typewriter a ball point pen.
CAMPAIGN IDENTIFICATION LABEL - For CANADA
Place a Campaign Identification Label on each vehicle corrected in accordance with the instruction
outlined in this Product Campaign Bulletin. Each label provides a space to include the campaign
number and the five (5) digit dealer code of the dealer performing the campaign service. This
information may be inserted with a typewriter or a ball point pen.
CLAIM INFORMATION
Submit a Product Campaign Claim with the information indicated.
Refer to the General Motors WINS claims processing Manual for details on Product Campaign
Claim Submission.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For US and CANADA
Customers will be notified of this campaign on their vehicles by General Motors (see copy of
customer letter included with this bulletin.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5758
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION - For IPC
Letters will be sent to known owners of record located within areas covered by the US National
Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. For owners outside these areas, dealers should notify
customers using the attached suggested dealer letter.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - For US and IPC (US States, Territories, and
Possessions)
The US National Traffic end Motor Vehicle safety Act provides that each vehicle that is subject to
recall campaign of this type must be adequately repaired within a reasonable time after the
customer has tendered it for repair. A failure to repair within sixty days after tender of vehicle is
prima facie evidence of failure to repair within a reasonable time. If the condition is not adequately
repaired within a reasonable time the customer may be entitled to an identical or reasonably
equivalent vehicle at no charge or to a refund of the purchase price less a reasonable allowance for
depreciation. To avoid having to provide these burdensome remedies, every effort must be made
to promptly schedule an appointment with each customer and to repair their vehicle as soon as
possible. In the recall campaign notification letters, customers are told how to contact the US
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration if the campaign is not completed within a
reasonable time.
DEALER CAMPAIGN RESPONSIBILITY - ALL
All unsold new vehicle in dealers' possession and subject to this campaign must be held an
inspected/repaired per the service procedure of this campaign bulletin before customers take
possession of these vehicles.
Dealers are to service all vehicles subject to this campaign at no charge to customers, regardless
of mileage, age of vehicle, or ownership, from this time forward.
Customers who have recently purchased vehicles sold from your vehicle inventory, and for which
there is no customer information indicated on the dealer listing, are to be contacted by the dealer.
Arrangements are to be made to make the required correction according to the instructions
contained in this bulletin. This could be done by mailing to such customers, a copy of the customer
letter accompanying this bulletin. Campaign follow-up cards should not be used for this purpose,
since the customer may not as yet have received the notification letter. In summary, whenever a
vehicle subject to this campaign enters your vehicle inventory, or is in your dealership for service in
the future, you must take the steps necessary to be sure the campaign correction has been made
before selling or releasing the vehicle.
Disclaimer
1991-94 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching bolt.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the bolt removed in the previous step.
Important
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coolant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the bolt or nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5759
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 1 and tighten the
bolt to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted bon the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is routed
along the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel well towards the cowl area of the
engine compartment. On some vehicle this hose may be covered with a black convoluted
protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at me point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conitions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness is shown in Figure 1 and secure it to the existing Underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front exle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area above the brake booster assembly, and jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Loate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5760
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1994 T-Pickup
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Locate the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly so that the hole in the bracket align
with the front inboard nut that is molded into the top of the coolant reservoir as shown in Figure 2.
3. Using the bolt provided in the kit, switch the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly to the
coolant reservoir by hand at starting the bolt.
4. With the vacuum switch, bracket and hose assembly positioned as shown in Figure 2, tighten the
bolt to 10 Nm (88 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This hose is routed up from the axle
vacuum actuator and then rearward towards the cowl area inside the right fender as shown in
Figure 2.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line is tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is a part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the locking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5761
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the harness as shown in Figure 2 and secure the new harness to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kits.
10. Disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector, located in the
area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and jumper in the new
wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft).
16. Ensure the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to engage
the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
1995-96 T-Pickup and 1995-96 T-Utility
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the front lower coolant reservoir attaching nut and discard.
3. Install the new vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly at the front lower coolant reservoir
attaching location using the new nut contained in the kit.
Important:
The bracket must be rotated/positioned and held as close to the coalant reservoir as possible
during the tightening of the nut to maintain maximum clearance between the battery and the
vacuum switch.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5762
4. Position the vacuum switch, bracket, and hose assembly as shown in Figure 3 and tighten the
nut to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
5. Locate the vacuum hose leading from the front axle vacuum actuator, located under the battery
tray, to the vacuum switch mounted on the transfer case. This vacuum hose typically is route along
the right front frame rail rearward up along the wheel welt towards the cowl area of the engine
compartment. On come vehicle this hose may be covered with black convoluted protective sleeve.
6. Select a point on the vacuum hose, which was located in the previous step, that Will be lower in
the vehicle than the new vacuum switch and will not result in the loading or stretching of either the
existing or new hoses when they are connected together.
Important
The location where the vacuum line le tapped into must be lower than the vacuum switch to ensure
condensation cannot accumulate in the switch, possibly resulting in a switch malfunction.
7. Cut the existing vacuum hose at the point located in the previous step, and connect the ends of
the cut vacuum hose to the tee fitting that is part of the new vacuum switch and hose assembly.
8. Connect the new wiring harness to the vacuum switch and ensure the looking feature of the
connector is engaged.
Important:
Ensure that the new harness is routed and secured in such a manner that it will not come in contact
with any moving parts or be exposed to any other conditions that may result in damage to the
harness.
9. Route the new harness as shown in Figure 3 and secure it to the existing underhood
components at the locations indicated (1) using the tie straps provided in the kit.
10. Locate and disconnect the existing underhood front axle switch wiring harness connector,
located in the area of the left front inner wheel well skirt under the brake master cylinder, and
jumper in the new wiring harness.
11. Raise the vehicle and suitably support.
12. Locate the transfer case selector switch positioned on top of the transfer case.
13. Remove any foreign material from around the transfer case selector switch or vacuum
connector.
Important:
Ensure that the O-ring is removed and discarded.
14. Disconnect the vacuum connector, remove and discard the transfer case selector switch and
the O-ring.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > 4WD Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for 4WD Switch: > 99-041 > May >
00 > Recall - ABS Front Axle Signal Malfunction > Page 5763
15. Hand start the new transfer case selector switch and tighten to 24 Nm (18 lb ft)
16. Ensure that the alignment feature of the vacuum harness connector is oriented correctly to
engage the alignment post/pin of the transfer case selector switch and connect the harness to the
switch.
17. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
18. Install the GM Campaign Identification Label.
Owner Letter
99041
(Sample Of Notification Used)
May, 2000
Dear General Motors Customer:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Reason For This Recall: General Motors has decided that a defect which relates to motor vehicle
safety exists in certain 1991-1996 4WD wheel drive (4WD) Blazers and Jimmys, and 1994-1996
4WD S-10 and Sonoma pickup trucks. Some of these Vehicles exhibit a condition in which a switch
that signals the antilook brake system (ADS) module when the vehicle is in 4WD may malfunction.
The ABS module is designed with two different operating algorithms: one for 2-wheel drive (2WD)
operation and another for 4WD drive operation. This allows the ABS system to compensate for the
braking torque applied to the rear wheels through the drivetrain when the vehicle is in 4WD drive.
When the vehicle is in 2WD, a malfunction switch may send an incorrect signal to the ABS module.
If this occurs during an ABS stop, a somewhat longer stopping distance could result. If this
occurred when minimum stopping distance was required, it could result in a vehicle crash.
What Will Be Done: Your dealer will install a new transfer case selector switch, wiring harness, and
an additional switch to ensure that the ABS receives the 4WD signal only when the drivetrain is in
4WD. This service will be performed for you at no charge.
How Long Will The Repair Take? The length of time required to perform this service correction is
approximately 30 minutes. Additional time may be required to schedule and process your vehicle. If
your dealer has a large number of vehicles awaiting service, this additional time may be significant.
Please ask your dealer if you wish to know how much additional time will be needed to schedule
process and repair your vehicle.
Contacting Your Dealer: Please contact your Chevrolet/GMC dealer as soon as possible to arrange
a service date. Parts are available and instructions for making this correction have been sent to
your dealer. Your Chevrolet/GMC dealer is best equipped to obtain parts and provide services to
correct you vehicle as promptly as possible. Should your dealer be unable to schedule a service
date within a reasonable time, you should contact the appropriate Customer Assistance Center at
the listed number below:
Division Number Deaf, Hearing Impaired or Speech
Chevrolet 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438
GMC 1-800-462-8782 1-800-462-8583 Utilize Telecommunication Devices
If, after contacting the appropriate Customer Assistance Center, you are still not satisfied that we
have done our best to remedy this condition without charge and within a reasonable time, you may
wish to write the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, 400 Seventh Street,
SW, Washington, DC 20590 or call 1-800-424-9393 (Washington, DC residents use
(202-366-0123).
Customer Reply Card: The customer reply card identifies your vehicle. Presentation of this card to
your dealer will assist in making necessary correction in the shortest possible time. If you no longer
own this vehicle, please let us know by completing the attached and mailing it in the postage paid
envelope.
We are sorry to cause you this inconvenience; however, we have taken this action in the interest of
your safety and continued satisfaction with our products.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations
ABS Main Relay: Locations
FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (4WAL)
Brake Pressure Modulator Valve
The relay is located inside the Brake Pressure Modulator Valve (BPMV) and is not serviced
seperately.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations
Steering Column
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations > Page 5770
C221 - Data Link Connector
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Forward Lamps Harness, LH Side
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (EHCU)
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (EHCU)
Fig. 34 ABS Connector Terminal Identification.
Fig. 32 ALDL Connector Terminal Identification.
ABS Connector Terminals.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Four-Wheel Antilock Brake Module (EHCU) > Page 5776
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Rear Wheel Antilock Brake Module (RWAL EHCU)
Fig. 13 RWAL System Electrical Connectors.
RWAL system electrical connectors.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5777
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 225 EHCU/BPMV Mounting.
(EHCU) Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit / (BPMV) Brake Pressure Modulator Valve Module is not
serviceable and must be replaced as a unit.
1. Remove washer tank attaching bolts, then position aside.
2. Remove EHCU/BPMV electrical connectors.
3. Disconnect module brake lines.
Use caution not to get brake fluid on paint or electrical connections.
4. Remove upper to lower bracket assembly attaching bolts.
5. Remove EHCU/BPMV module and upper bracket assembly from vehicle.
6. Remove upper mounting bracket to EHCU/BPMV module attaching bolts, Fig. 225. 7. Reverse
procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Torque EHCU/BPMV module to bracket attaching bolts to 5 ft. lbs. b. Torque EHCU/BPMV
bracket assembly attaching bolts to 20 ft. lbs. c. Torque brake line fittings to 16 ft. lbs. d. Bleed
EHCU/BPMV module. See: Brake Bleeding
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Assembly, Traction Control > Component Information > Locations
Forward Lamps Harness, LH Side (W/Four-Wheel Antilock Brakes)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Assembly, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Pressure Valve
Hydraulic Assembly: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Pressure Valve
Fig. 86 APV Valve Assembly Replacement
The APV valve is not serviceable. It should be replaced when the DTC code charts show that it's
the cause of a malfunction.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect brake pipe fittings from APV. 3. Disconnect
4-way electrical connector from APV, Fig. 86. 4. Remove APV to bracket attaching bolts. 5.
Remove APV valve from vehicle. 6. Reverse procedure to install, torque APV to bracket attaching
bolts to 21 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Assembly, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Anti-Lock Pressure Valve > Page 5783
Hydraulic Assembly: Service and Repair Isolation/Dump Valve Assembly
Fig. 46 ECU & Control Valve Assembly Installation
1. Disconnect brake lines from control valve, the plug lines and open fittings. 2. Remove bolts (25)
securing control valve, Fig. 46, and support valve assembly.
Do not allow valve assembly to hang from wiring.
3. Disconnect electrical connectors and remove control valve assembly. 4. Reverse procedure to
install, then bleed brakes as needed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Fig. 225 EHCU/BPMV Mounting.
(EHCU) Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit / (BPMV) Brake Pressure Modulator Valve Module is not
serviceable and must be replaced as a unit.
1. Remove washer tank attaching bolts, then position aside.
2. Remove EHCU/BPMV electrical connectors.
3. Disconnect module brake lines.
Use caution not to get brake fluid on paint or electrical connections.
4. Remove upper to lower bracket assembly attaching bolts.
5. Remove EHCU/BPMV module and upper bracket assembly from vehicle.
6. Remove upper mounting bracket to EHCU/BPMV module attaching bolts, Fig. 225. 7. Reverse
procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Torque EHCU/BPMV module to bracket attaching bolts to 5 ft. lbs. b. Torque EHCU/BPMV
bracket assembly attaching bolts to 20 ft. lbs. c. Torque brake line fittings to 16 ft. lbs. d. Bleed
EHCU/BPMV module. See: Brake Bleeding
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor ...........................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 900-2000 ohms
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5790
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 2. Disconnect brake caliper
assembly and position aside. 3. Remove rotor, then hub and bearing assembly. 4. Disconnect
wheel sensor electrical connector 5. Remove sensor wire form upper control arm clip. 6. Remove
sensor and splash shield assembly attaching bolts, then remove sensor. 7. Reverse procedure to
install.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair General Information
BLEEDING BRAKE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Bleeding is necessary if air has entered the hydraulic brake system.
It may be necessary to bleed the system at all four wheels if a low fluid level allowed air to enter the
system, or the brake pipes have been disconnected at the master cylinder or combination valve. If
a pipe is disconnected at one wheel, then only bleed that wheel.
The time required to bleed the hydraulic system when the master cylinder is removed can be
reduced by bleeding the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5795
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE BLEEDING
The 4WAL brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is
trapped in it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the
BPMV. There are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels.
Open the internal bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it
must be bled after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 provided that
the dimple is removed from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5796
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed.
6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools. 9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the function tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5797
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With VCM/Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
VCM/FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is trapped in
it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the BPMV. There
are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels. Open the internal
bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it must be bled
after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required:
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool (Three required) - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 providing you
remove the dimple from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5798
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed. 6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools. 9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the tunction tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5799
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With Rear Wheel Antilock Brake System
REAR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false DTCs could be set to memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWALI4WAL Cartridge Kit or 7000001 Mass Storage Cartridge
1. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 2. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
it needed. 3. Bleed wheel cylinders and calipers. 4. Turn ignition switch "ON" and do three function
tests with the Tech-1 scan tool. 5. Re-bleed the rear brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
6. Evaluate brake pedal feel. 7. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5800
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
General Information
BLEEDING BRAKE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Bleeding is necessary if air has entered the hydraulic brake system.
It may be necessary to bleed the system at all four wheels if a low fluid level allowed air to enter the
system, or the brake pipes have been disconnected at the master cylinder or combination valve. If
a pipe is disconnected at one wheel, then only bleed that wheel.
The time required to bleed the hydraulic system when the master cylinder is removed can be
reduced by bleeding the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle.
With Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE BLEEDING
The 4WAL brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is
trapped in it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the
BPMV. There are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels.
Open the internal bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it
must be bled after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 provided that
the dimple is removed from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5801
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed.
6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools. 9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the function tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
With VCM/Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
VCM/FOUR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The brake pressure modulator valve (BPMV) should be bled after replacement or if air is trapped in
it. Bleeding should not be necessary if the fluid is not contaminated or no air is in the BPMV. There
are internal bleed valves on each side of the BPMV that open internal channels. Open the internal
bleed valves 1/4 to 1/2 turn before bleeding. Should the module need bleeding, it must be bled
after the master cylinder and before the wheel cylinders and calipers.
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false trouble codes could be set to
memory.
Tools Required:
- J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool (Three required) - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWAL/4WAL Cartridge Kit or 3000003 Mass Storage Cartridge - A modified J
35856 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool can be used in place of J 39177 providing you
remove the dimple from it first.
Important: Expect to use two quarts of brake fluid to thoroughly bleed the system.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5802
Fig. 59 EHCU/BPMV Module Bleeding
1. Open the internal bleed valves on the sides of the BPMV 1/4 to 1/2 turn each (A). 2. Install J
39177 on the left high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV. 3. Install J 39177 on the
right high pressure accumulator bleed stem (C) of the BPMV.
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
4. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 5. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
if needed. 6. Bleed the brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
NOTICE: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener, use
ONLY the exact part number for that application. General Motors will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. General Motors will also call out the fasteners that require
thread lockers or thread sealant. UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED, do not use supplemental
coatings (paints, greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint
interfaces. Generally, such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping
force, and may damage the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening
sequence and specifications. Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and
systems.
7. Close the internal bleed valves. Tighten Internal bleed valves (A) to 7 Nm (60 lbs. in.). 8.
Remove the three J 39177 tools.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5803
9. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill if needed.
10. With the ignition switch "ON" and the engine off, do six function tests with the Tech-1 scan tool.
11. Repeat the wheel cylinder and caliper bleed procedure to remove the air that purged from the
BPMV during the tunction tests. 12. Apply firm pressure to the brake pedal and evaluate brake
pedal feel. 13. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
- Make sure you have a good, hard brake pedal before starting the engine and moving the vehicle.
With Rear Wheel Antilock Brake System
REAR WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
NOTICE: The ignition switch must be in the "OFF" position or false DTCs could be set to memory.
Tools Required: - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool - TK 00000 Tech-1 Scan
Tool - TK 02650 RWALI4WAL Cartridge Kit or 7000001 Mass Storage Cartridge
1. Install J 39177 on the combination valve. 2. Check the master cylinder reservoir fluid level and fill
it needed. 3. Bleed wheel cylinders and calipers. 4. Turn ignition switch "ON" and do three function
tests with the Tech-1 scan tool. 5. Re-bleed the rear brakes as described under Pressure Bleeding.
6. Evaluate brake pedal feel. 7. Repeat the bleed procedure if needed.
Hydraulic System Flushing
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM FLUSHING
Flushing is done at each bleeder valve similar to the bleeding procedure. The difference-is that the
bleeder valve is opened 1 1/2 turns and fluid is forced through the pipes, hoses, and bleeder valves
until it comes out clear in color. Refer to Hydraulic System, Service and Repair.
Check the master cylinder fluid level after flushing at each bleeder valve and refill as required. After
flushing, make sure the master cylinder reservoir is filled to the correct level.
Manual Bleeding
MANUAL BLEEDING
NOTICE: Brake fluid will damage electrical connections and painted surfaces. Use shop cloths,
suitable containers, and tender covers to prevent brake fluid from contacting these areas. Always
re-seal and wipe off brake fluid containers to prevent spills.
Tool Required: J 28434 Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Wrench
- Relieve the vacuum reserve by applying the brakes several times with the ignition "OFF"
1. Fill the master cylinder reservoirs with Delco Supreme No. 11 Hydraulic Brake Fluid (GM P/N
1052535) or an equivalent DOT 3 motor vehicle
brake fluid.
- Maintain the fluid level during bleeding.
2. If the master cylinder is suspected to have air in the bore, bleed it before any wheel cylinder or
caliper.
A. Disconnect the forward brake pipe connection at the master cylinder. B. Allow the brake fluid to
flow from the connector port. C. Connect the brake pipe but do not tighten. D. Slowly apply the
brake pedal and allow the air to bleed from the loose fitting. E. Tighten the fitting before releasing
the pedal. F. Wait 15 seconds. G. Repeat this sequence, including the 15-second wait, until all air
is purged from the bore. H. After all air has been removed from the forward connection, repeat this
procedure for the rear pipe.
3. If the BPMV of the 4WAL system is replaced or suspected to have air trapped inside, it must be
bled next. Refer to With ABS.
4. Bleed each wheel in the following sequence:
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5804
A. Right rear B. Left rear C. Right front D. Left front
5. Attach J 28434 to the wheel cylinder/caliper bleeder valve.
- Immerse the opposite end of the hose into a container partially filled with clean brake fluid.
6. Slowly apply the brake pedal one time and hold. 7. Loosen the bleeder valve to purge the air
from the wheel cylinder/caliper. 8. Tighten the bleeder valve and slowly release the pedal. 9. Wait
15 seconds.
10. Repeat this sequence, including the 15-second wait, until all air is purged from the wheel
cylinder/caliper. 11. Tighten the bleeder valve to 7 N.m (62 lbs. in.). 12. Continue steps 5 through
11 at each wheel until the system is bled. 13. Check the brake pedal for "sponginess" and the
brake warning lamp for an indication of unbalanced pressure. Repeat the bleeding procedure to
correct either of these conditions.
Pressure Bleeding
PRESSURE BLEEDING
A diaphragm-type pressure bleeder must be used. It must have a rubber diaphragm between the
air supply and brake fluid to prevent air, moisture, oil, and other contaminants from entering the
hydraulic system.
NOTICE: Brake fluid will damage electrical connections and painted surfaces. Use shop cloths,
suitable containers, and fender covers to prevent brake fluid from contacting these areas. Always
reseal and wipe off brake fluid containers to prevent spills.
Tools Required: - J 29567 Brake Bleeder Adapter - J 39177 Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding
Tool - J 28434 Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Wrench
1. Fill the pressure tank at least 2/3 full of brake fluid. The bleeder must be bled each time fluid is
added. 2. Charge the bleeder to 140-170 kPa (20-25 psi).
Combination Valve Pressure Bleeding Tool
3. Use J 39177 to depress and hold the valve stem on the combination valve.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
General Information > Page 5805
4. Install the bleeder adapter. 5. If the BPMV of the 4WAL system is replaced or suspected to air
trapped inside, it must be bled next. 6. Bleed each wheel in the following sequence:
A. Right rear B. Left rear C. Right front D. Left front
7. Connect the hose from the bleeder to the adapter at the master cylinder. 8. Open the tank valve.
9. Attach J 28434 to a bleeder valve.
10. Immerse the opposite end of the hose into a contamer partially filled with clean brake fluid. 11.
Open the bleeder valve at least 3/4 of a turn and allow the fluid to flow until no air is seen in the
fluid. 12. Tighten the bleeder valve to 7 Nm (62 lbs. in.). 13. Repeat steps 9 through 12 at all the
wheels. 14. Check the brake pedal for "sponginess".
- Repeat the bleeding procedure if this condition is found.
15. Remove J 39177. 16. Disconnect the hose from the bleeder adapter. 17. Remove the bleeder
adapter. 18. Fill the master cylinder to the proper level.
Master Cylinder Bench Bleeding
MASTER CYLINDER BENCH BLEEDING
Bench bleed the master cylinder to remove the air from it prior to installation. This reduces the
amount of bleeding needed after it is installed on the vehicle.
1. Plug the outlet ports and mount the master cylinder in a vise with the front end tilted slightly
down. 2. Fill the reservoir with clean brake fluid. 3. Using a tool with a smooth rounded end, stroke
the primary piston about 25 mm (1 inch) several times.
- As air is bled from the master cylinder, the primary piston will not travel the full 25-mm (1-inch)
stroke.
4. Reposition the master cylinder in the vise with the front end tilted slightly up. 5. Again stroke the
primary piston about 25 mm (1 inch) several times. 6. Reposition the master cylinder in the vise to
the level position. 7. Loosen the plugs one at a time and push the piston into the bore to force the
air from the cylinder.
- To prevent air from being sucked back into the cylinder, tighten the plug(s) before allowing the
piston to return to its original position.
8. Fill the reservoir.
- Normal bleeding procedures should be followed after the master cylinder is installed.
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Warning Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
Following is a list of abbreviations used in the wiring diagrams. The abbreviations have been
developed in such a way that their meaning should be clear. Use this page as a reference to
determine the meaning of an abbreviation if necessary.
A
Ampere
A/C Air Conditioner
AC Alternating Current
ACC Accessory
AIR Air Injection Reaction
AIR/COND Air Conditioner
AMP Ampere
ANT Anticipate
ASM Assembly
ASSY Assembly
AUD Audio
AUTO Automatic
AUX Auxiliary
BAT
Battery
BATT Battery
Bi-LEV Bi-Level
BLK Black
BLT Belt
BLU Blue
BOT Bottom
BRK Brake
BRN Brown
BTSI Brake/Trans Shift Interlock
BU Backup
BUZZ Buzzer
CD
Compact Disc
CHMSL Center High Mount Stoplamp
CID Cubic Inch Displacement
CIR/BRK Circuit Breaker
CIRO Circuit
CLSTR Cluster
CNTRL Control
COMP Compartment
COMP Compressor
CONN Connector
CONV Convenience
CRNK Crank
CTSY Courtesy
CYL
Cylinder
DC Direct Current
DEF Defrost
DK Dark
DIAG Diagnostic
DIM Dimmer
DIR Directional
DISC Discrete
DIV Diverter
DLC Data Link Connector
DM Dome
DR Door
DRL
Daytime Running Lamps (Canadian Only)
ECM Engine Control Module
EGR Exhaust Gas Recirculation
ELEC Electric
ENG Engine
EPR Exhaust Pressure Regulator
ETR Electronically Tuned Radio
EXC Except
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5810
F-PUMP Fuel Pump
FLASH Flasher
FRT Front
4WD Four-Wheel Drive
GAU Gauges
GEN
Generator
GRA Gray
GRD Ground
GRN Green
HAND Handling
HAZ Hazard
HD Heavy Duty
HDLP Headlamp
HI High
HTR Heater
IAC Idle Air Control
IGN Ignition
ILLUM Illumination
I/P
Instrument Panel
INC Increased
IND Indicator
INJ Injector
INST Instrument
INSTR Instrument
INTER Interior
LD Light Duty
LH Left Hand
LO Low
LP Lamp
LPS Lamps
LT
Light
LTR Lighter
M Motor
MAN Manual
MAP Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX Maximum
MED Medium
MRKR Marker
MTR Manually Tuned Radio
MULT Multiple
NAT Natural
NEU Neutral
NO Normally Open
NC
Normally Closed
ORN Orange
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PK Park
PLR Puller
PNK Pink
PNL Panel
PPL Purple
PRESS Pressure
PVAC Partial Vacuum
PWR Power
RCVR Receiver
REF
Reference
RESIST Resistance
RH Right Hand
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RPO Regular Production Option
RST Rust
RWAL Rear Wheel Antilock
SEN Sensor
SEND Sender
SIG Signal
SIL Silver
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5811
SIR Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
SKT Socket
SOL Solenoid
SPEEDO Speedometer
STR Stripe
STRG
Steering
SW Switch
TACH Tachometer
TBI Throttle Body Fuel Injection
TCC Torque Converter Clutch
TCM Transmission Control Module
TEMP Temperature
TIL Taillamp
TP Throttle Position
TRANS Transmission
TYP Typical
V Volt
VAC Vacuum
VCM
Vehicle Control Module
VEN Vent
VLV Valve
VSS Vehicle Speed Sensor
W/ With
W/O Without
W/S Windshield
W/WASHER Window Washer
WDO Window
WHT White
WGR Wiring
YEL Yellow
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5812
example, "Section 20" is the engine control section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Symbol
HANDLING ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE PARTS
Many solid-state electrical components can be damaged by electrostatic discharge(ESD). Some
will display a label, but many will not.
NOTE: In order to avoid possibly damaging any components, observe the following: 1. Body
movement produces an electrostatic charge. To discharge personal static electricity, touch a
ground point (metal) on the vehicle. This
should be done anytime you: ^
Slide across the vehicle seat.
^ Sit down or stand up.
^ Do any walking.
2. Do not touch exposed electric terminals or components with your fingers or tools. Remember,
the connector you are checking might be tied
into a circuit that could be damaged by electrostatic discharge.
3. When using a screwdriver or similar tool to disconnect a connector, never let the tool come into
contact with or come between exposed
terminals.
4. Never jumper, ground, or use test equipment probes on any components or connectors unless
specified in diagnosis. When using test
equipment, always connect the ground lead first.
5. Do not remove the solid-state component from its protective packaging until you are ready to
install the part. 6. Always touch the solid-state component's package to ground before opening.
Solid-state components can also be damaged if:
^ They are bumped or dropped.
^ They are laid on any metal benches or components that operate electrically such as a TV radio,
or oscilloscope.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5813
Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5814
Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5815
Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
SOLID-STATE SYMBOLS
A group of special symbols is used to represent electronic circuits used in the Solid-State modules.
These symbols are greatly simplified versions of the actual circuits. They can be very useful for
troubleshooting purposes if properly used. It is important to remember that these symbols apply
only to modules with all connectors in place and supply voltages on.